SEDRA/SMITH INSTRUCTOR’S SOLUTIONS MANUA FOR Microelectronic Circuits INTERNATIONAL SEVENTH EDITION Adel S. Sedra University of Waterloo New York Oxford OXFORD UNIVERSITY PRESS Oxford University Press is a department of the University of Oxford. It furthers the University’s objective of excellence in research, scholarship, and education by publishing worldwide. Oxford New York Auckland Cape Town Dar es Salaam Hong Kong Karachi Kuala Lumpur Madrid Melbourne Mexico City Nairobi New Delhi Shanghai Taipei Toronto With offices in Argentina Austria Brazil Chile Czech Republic France Greece Guatemala Hungary Italy Japan Poland Portugal Singapore South Korea Switzerland Thailand Turkey Ukraine Vietnam Copyright 2017 by Oxford University Press For titles covered by Section 112 of the US Higher Education Opportunity Act, please visit www.oup.com/us/he for the latest information about pricing and alternate formats. Published by Oxford University Press 198 Madison Avenue, New York, New York 10016 http://www.oup.com Oxford is a registered trademark of Oxford University Press All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior permission of Oxford University Press. ISBN: 978-0-19-933916-7 Exercise Solutions (Chapters 1-17) Problem Solutions (Chapters 1-17) Preface This Instructor’s Solution Manual (ISM) contains complete solutions for all exercises and end-of-chapter problems included in the book Microelectronic Circuits, International Seventh Edition by Adel S. Sedra and Kenneth C. Smith. Most of the solutions are new; however, I have used and/or adapted some of the solutions from the ISM of the International Sixth Edition. Credit for these goes to the problem solvers listed therein. This manual has greatly benefited from the careful work of the accuracy checkers listed below. These colleagues and friends worked diligently to ensure that the 2,030 solutions are free of error. Despite all of our combined efforts, however, there is little doubt that some errors remain, and for these I take full responsibility. I will be most grateful to instructors who discover errors and point them out to me. Please send all corrections and comments by email to: sedra@uwaterloo.ca. Adel Sedra Waterloo, Ontario, Canada October 2015 Accuracy Checkers • Professor Tony Chan Carusone, University of Toronto - Assisted by graduate students Jeffrey Wang and Luke Wang • Professor Vincent Gaudet, University of Waterloo • Professors Shahriar Mirabbasi and Mandana Amiri, University of British Columbia • ProfessorWai Tung Ng, University of Toronto • Professor Olivier Trescases, University of Toronto • Professor Amir Yazdani, Ryerson University Exercise 1–1 Rs Ex: 1.1 When output terminals are open-circuited, as in Fig. 1.1a: For circuit a. v oc = v s (t) vs (t) For circuit b. v oc = is (t) × Rs vo When output terminals are short-circuited, as in Fig. 1.1b: For circuit a. isc = RL If RL = 100 k: v s (t) Rs v o = 10 mV × For circuit b. isc = is (t) 100 = 9.9 mV 100 + 1 If RL = 10 k: For equivalency v o = 10 mV × Rs is (t) = v s (t) 10 9.1 mV 10 + 1 If RL = 1 k: Rs a v o = 10 mV × 1 = 5 mV 1+1 If RL = 100 : vs (t) v o = 10 mV × 100 0.91 mV 100 + 1 K For v o = 0.8v s , b RL = 0.8 RL + Rs Figure 1.1a Since Rs = 1 k, a is (t) RL = 4 k Ex: 1.4 Using current divider: Rs io b is 10 A RL Rs Figure 1.1b Ex: 1.2 io = is × Rs voc vs isc = 10 μA v oc 10 mV = = 1 k isc 10 μA Ex: 1.3 Using voltage divider: v o (t) = v s (t) × Given is = 10 μA, Rs = 100 k. For RL = 1 k, io = 10 μA × 100 = 9.9 μA 100 + 1 For RL = 10 k, io = 10 μA × v oc = 10 mV Rs = isc Rs Rs + RL RL Rs + RL Given v s (t) = 10 mV and Rs = 1 k. 100 9.1 μA 100 + 10 For RL = 100 k, io = 10 μA × 100 = 5 μA 100 + 100 For RL = 1 M, io = 10 μA × 0.9 μA For io = 0.8is , 100 = 0.8 100 + RL ⇒ RL = 25 k 100 K 100 K + 1 M Exercise 1–2 Ex: 1.5 f = 1 1 = −3 = 1000 Hz T 10 ω = 2πf = 2π × 103 rad/s Ex: 1.6 (a) T = 1 1 = s = 16.7 ms f 60 1 1 (b) T = = −3 = 1000 s f 10 (c) T = 1 1 = 6 s = 1 μs f 10 Ex: 1.7 If 6 MHz is allocated for each channel, then 470 MHz to 806 MHz will accommodate 806 − 470 = 56 channels 6 Since the broadcast band starts with channel 14, it will go from channel 14 to channel 69. Ex: 1.8 P = 1 T T Ex: 1.9 (a) D can represent 15 distinct values between 0 and +15 V. Thus, v A = 0 V ⇒ D = 0000 v A = 1 V ⇒ D = 0001 v A = 2 V ⇒ D = 0010 v A = 15 V ⇒ D = 1111 (b) (i) +1 V (ii) +2 V (iii) +4 V (iv) +8 V (c) The closest discrete value represented by D is 5 V; thus D = 0101. The error is −0.2 V, or −0.2/5.2 × 100 = −4%. Ex: 1.10 Voltage gain = 20 log 100 = 40 dB Current gain = 20 log 1000 = 60 dB Power gain = 10 log Ap = 10 log (Av Ai ) v2 dt R = 10 log 105 = 50 dB 0 V V2 1 × ×T = T R R Alternatively, = 2 P = P1 + P3 + P5 + · · · 2 4V 2 1 4V 1 = √ + √ R R 2π 3 2π 2 4V 1 + √ + ··· R 5 2π 8 1 1 1 V2 × 2 × 1+ + + + ··· = R π 9 25 49 Ex: 1.11 Pdc = 15 × 8 = 120 mW √ (6/ 2)2 PL = = 18 mW 1 Pdissipated = 120 − 18 = 102 mW η= PL 18 × 100 = 15% × 100 = Pdc 120 Ex: 1.12 v o = 1 × 10 10−5 V = 10 μV 10 + 10 6 It can be shown by direct calculation that the infinite series in the parentheses has a sum that approaches π 2 /8; thus P becomes V 2/R as found from direct calculation. (10 × 10−6 )2 = 10−11 W 10 With the buffer amplifier: Fraction of energy in fundamental vo = 1 × = 8/π 2 = 0.81 Fraction of energy in first five harmonics 1 1 8 = 0.93 = 2 1+ + π 9 25 PL = v 2o /RL = =1× PL = Ri RL × Av o × Ri + Rs RL + Ro 10 1 ×1× = 0.25 V 1+1 10 + 10 v 2o 0.252 = 6.25 mW = RL 10 0.25 V vo = 0.25 V/V = vs 1V Fraction of energy in first seven harmonics 1 1 1 8 + = 0.95 = 2 1+ + 9 25 49 π Voltage gain = Fraction of energy in first nine harmonics 1 1 1 1 8 + + = 0.96 = 2 1+ + π 9 25 49 81 Power gain (Ap ) ≡ Note that 90% of the energy of the square wave is in the first three harmonics, that is, in the fundamental and the third harmonic. = −12 dB PL Pi where PL = 6.25 mW and Pi = v i i1 , v i = 0.5 V and ii = 1V = 0.5 μA 1 M + 1 M Exercise 1–3 This figure belongs to Exercise 1.15. Stage 1 Stage 2 100 k vs vi1 1 M 10vi1 Thus, Pi = 0.5 × 0.5 = 0.25 μW and Ap = 1 k 1 k 6.25 × 10−3 = 25 × 103 0.25 × 10−6 vi2 100vi2 100 k vL 100 Ex: 1.16 Refer the solution to Example 1.3 in the text. v i1 = 0.909 V/V vs v i1 = 0.909 v s = 0.909 × 1 = 0.909 mV 10 log Ap = 44 dB v i2 v i2 v i1 = × = 9.9 × 0.909 = 9 V/V vs v i1 vs Ex: 1.13 Open-circuit (no load) output voltage = Av o v i v i2 = 9 × v S = 9 × 1 = 9 mV Output voltage with load connected = Av o v i 0.8 = RL RL + Ro 1 ⇒ Ro = 0.25 k = 250 Ro + 1 Ex: 1.14 Av o = 40 dB = 100 V/V 2 v2 RL PL = o = Av o v i RL RL RL + Ro 2 1 = v 2i × 100 × 1000 = 2.5 v 2i 1+1 Pi = v 2i v 2i = Ri 10,000 Ap ≡ PL 2.5v 2 = −4 i 2 = 2.5 × 104 W/W Pi 10 v i 10 log Ap = 44 dB v i3 v i3 v i2 v i1 = × × = 90.9 × 9.9 × 0.909 vs v i2 v i1 vs = 818 V/V v i3 = 818 v s = 818 × 1 = 818 mV vL vL v i3 v i2 v i1 = × × × vs v i3 v i2 v i1 vs = 0.909 × 90.9 × 9.9 × 0.909 744 V/V v L = 744 × 1 mV = 744 mV Ex: 1.17 Using voltage amplifier model, the three-stage amplifier can be represented as Ro vi Ex: 1.15 Without stage 3 (see figure above) vL = v s 1 M 100 k (10) 100 k + 1 M 100 k + 1 k 100 ×(100) 100 + 1 k vL = (0.909)(10)(0.9901)(100)(0.0909) vs = 81.8 V/V Ri Avovi Ri = 1 M Ro = 10 Av o = Av 1 ×Av 2 ×Av 3 = 9.9×90.9×1 = 900 V/V The overall voltage gain Ri RL vo = × Av o × vs Ri + Rs RL + Ro Exercise 1–4 For RL = 10 : Ex: 1.20 Using the transresistance circuit model, the circuit will be Overall voltage gain = 10 1M × 900 × = 409 V/V 1 M + 100 K 10 + 10 ii Ro For RL = 1000 : Overall voltage gain = is Rs Ri 1000 1M × 900 × = 810 V/V 1 M + 100 K 1000 + 10 Rmii RL ∴ Range of voltage gain is from 409 V/V to 810 V/V. ii Rs = is Ri + Rs Ex: 1.18 ii v o = Rm ii × io RL RL + Ro vo RL = Rm ii RL + Ro is Rs Ri Ro RL Ais ii ii = is Rs Rs + Ri io = Ais ii Now vo vo ii Rs RL = × = Rm × ii is RL + Ro Ri + Rs is = Rm RL Rs × Rs + Ri RL + Ro Ex: 1.21 Ro Rs Ro = Ais is Ro + RL Rs + Ri Ro + RL Thus, Rs Ro io = Ais is Rs + Ri Ro + RL Ex: 1.19 Ri vs vi = vs vi Ri Ri Ri + Rs v o = Gm v i (Ro RL ) Ri (Ro RL ) = Gm v s Ri + Rs Thus, Ri vo = Gm (Ro RL ) vs Ri + Rs Ro Gmvi RL vo v b = ib rπ + (β + 1)ib Re = ib [rπ + (β + 1)Re ] But v b = v x and ib = ix , thus vx vb = = rπ + (β + 1)Re Rin ≡ ix ib Ex: 1.22 f 10 Hz 10 kHz 100 kHz 1 MHz Gain 60 dB 40 dB 20 dB 0 dB vo Exercise 1–5 Gain (dB) Ex: 1.24 Refer to Fig. E1.24 60 40 V2 = Vs 20 dB/decade 20 1 10 0 10 10 10 10 10 10 f (Hz) 3 dB frequency Ri Ri s = 1 1 Rs + Ri + Ri Rs + s+ sC C(Rs + Ri ) which is an HP STC function. 1 ≤ 100 Hz f3dB = 2πC(Rs + Ri ) C≥ 1 = 0.16 μF 2π(1 + 9)103 × 100 Ex: 1.23 Rs 1 k Vi Ri GmVi Ro RL Vo CL Vs Ri 9 k Vo = Gm Vi [Ro RL CL ] = C Gm Vi 1 1 + + sCL Ro RL Vo Gm 1 Thus, = × 1 1 sCL Vi + 1+ 1 1 Ro RL + Ro RL Ex: 1.25 T = 50 K ni = BT 3/2 e−Eg/(2kT ) −5 ×50) = 7.3 × 1015 (50)3/2 e−1.12/(2×8.62×10 9.6 × 10−39 /cm3 T = 350 K ni = BT 3/2 e−Eg/(2kT ) −5 ×350) = 7.3 × 1015 (350)3/2 e−1.12/(2×8.62×10 = 4.15 × 1011 /cm3 Gm (RL Ro ) Vo = Vi 1 + sCL (RL Ro ) Ex: 1.26 ND = 1017 /cm3 which is of the STC LP type. From Exercise 1.1, ni at DC gain = Gm (RL Ro ) = 10 × (RL 50) T = 350 K = 4.15 × 1011 /cm3 nn = ND = 1017 /cm3 To obtain a dc gain of at least 40 dB (i.e., 100), 10(RL 50) ≥ 100 ni2 pn ∼ = ND ⇒ RL ≥ 12.5 k = ω0 = (4.15 × 1011 )2 1017 = 1.72 × 106 /cm3 1 CL (RL Ro ) 1 = CL (12.5 50) × 103 For ω0 to be a least 2π × 100 × 103 , the highest value allowed for CL is CL = V2 1 = 159.2 pF 2π × 10 × 10 × 103 5 Ex: 1.27 At 300 K, ni = 1.5 × 1010 /cm3 pp = NA Want electron concentration = np = 1.5 × 1010 = 1.5 × 104 /cm3 106 ∴ NA = pp = ni2 np Exercise 1–6 = (1.5 × 1010 )2 1.5 × 104 = 1.5 × 10 /cm 16 Dn = μn VT = 1350 × 25.9 × 10−3 ∼ = 35 cm2 /s 3 Dp = μp VT = 480 × 25.9 × 10−3 ∼ = 12.4 cm2 /s Ex: 1.28 (a) νn−drift = −μn E Here negative sign indicates that electrons move in a direction opposite to E. We use νn-drift = 1350 × 1 ∵ 1 μm = 10−4 cm 2 × 10−4 = 6.75 × 106 cm/s = 6.75 × 104 m/s (b) Time taken to cross 2-μm length = 2 × 10−6 30 ps 6.75 × 104 (c) In n-type silicon, drift current density Jn is Ex: 1.31 Equation (1.50), 2s 1 1 + V0 W = q NA ND 2s NA + ND = V0 q NA ND 2s NA + ND W2 = V0 q NA ND 1 q NA ND V0 = W2 2 s NA + ND Jn = qnμn E 1V 2 × 10−4 = 1.6 × 10−19 × 1016 × 1350 × = 1.08 × 104 A/cm2 Ex: 1.32 In a p+ n diode NA ND 2s 1 1 Equation (1.50), W = + V0 q NA ND (d) Drift current In = AJn thus = 27 μA −8 Note that 0.25 μm = 0.25 × 10 2 Ex: 1.29 Jn = qDn 2 cm . dn(x) dx W n0 = 10 /cm = 10 /(μm) 5 3 3 Dn = 35 cm2 /s = 35 × (104 )2 (μm)2 /s dn 105 − 0 = = 105 μm−4 dx 1 dn(x) Jn = qDn dx = 1.6 × 10 −6 = 56 × 10 × 35 × 10 × 10 NA NA =W ND NA + ND 8 ND ND NA W =W NA ND 5 For In = 1 mA = Jn × A 1 mA 10 μA ⇒A= = 18 μm2 Jn 56 μA/(μm)2 3 Ex: 1.30 Using Eq. (1.45), Equation (1.53), QJ = Aq Aq 2 Dp Dn = = VT μn μp NA NA + ND since NA A/μm2 = 56 μA/μm 2s · V0 qND Equation (1.52), xp = W = 35 × 108 (μm)2 /s −19 W Equation (1.51), xn = W From Fig. E1.5, 17 1 1 as compared to , NA ND We can neglect the term = 0.25 × 10−8 × 1.08 × 104 NA ND W NA + ND NA ND W NA = AqND W NA ND V0 Equation (1.54), QJ = A 2s q NA + ND NA ND A 2s q ND V0 since NA NA = A 2s qND V0 Exercise 1–7 Ex: 1.33 In Example 1.10, NA = 1018 /cm3 and = 6.08 × 10−5 cm = 0.608 μm ND = 1016 /cm3 Using Eq. (1.53), NA ND W QJ = Aq NA + ND 18 10 × 1016 = 10−4 × 1.6 × 10−19 × 6.08 × 1018 + 1016 In the n-region of this pn junction nn = ND = 1016 /cm3 pn = n2i (1.5 × 1010 )2 = = 2.25 × 104 /cm3 nn 1016 As one can see from above equation, to increase minority-carrier concentration (pn ) by a factor of 2, one must lower ND (= nn ) by a factor of 2. 10−5 cm = 9.63 pC Reverse current I = IS = Aqn2i Ex: 1.34 Equation (1.65) IS = Since Aqn2i = 10−14 × 1.6 × 10−19 × (1.5 × 1010 )2 10 18 × + 5 × 10−4 × 1016 10 × 10−4 × 1018 Dp Dn + . Lp ND Ln NA Dp Dn and have approximately Lp Ln similar values, if NA = 7.3 × 10−15 A ND , then the term Dp can be neglected as compared to . Lp ND Dn Ln NA Dp ∴ IS ∼ = Aqn2i Lp ND Ex: 1.35 IS = Aqn2i Dp Dn + Lp ND Ln NA = 10−4 × 1.6 × 10−19 × (1.5 × 1010 )2 ⎛ ⎜ ×⎜ ⎝ 10 5 × 10−4 × + 16 10 2 ⎞ ⎟ 18 ⎟ −4 18 ⎠ 10 × 10 × 10 = 1.46 × 10−14 A I = IS (eV /V T − 1) −3 ) IS eV /V T = 1.45 × 10−14 e0.605/(25.9×10 = 0.2 mA 2s q Ex: 1.36 W = = 2 × 1.04 × 10−12 1.6 × 10−19 1 1 + NA ND 1 1018 = = 3.2 pF Equation (1.71), Cj0 Cj = VR 1+ V0 3.2 × 10−12 = 2 1+ 0.814 + 1 (V0 − VF ) (0.814 − 0.605) 1016 = 1.66 × 10−5 cm = 0.166 μm Ex: 1.37 W = Ex: 1.38 Equation (1.72), q N N 1 s A D Cj0 = A 2 NA + ND V0 1.04 × 10−12 × 1.6 × 10−19 = 10−4 2 1018 × 1016 1 0.814 1018 + 1016 = 1.72 pF 2s q 2 × 1.04 × 10−12 1.6 × 10−19 1 1 + NA ND 1 1018 + (V0 + VR ) 1 1016 Dp Dn + Lp ND Ln NA (0.814 + 2) Ex: 1.39 Cd = d dQ = (τ T I ) dV dV d [τ T × IS (eV /V T − 1)] dV d (eV /V T − 1) = τ T IS dV 1 V /V T e = τ T IS VT τT = × IS eV /V T VT τT ∼ I = VT = Exercise 1–8 Ex: 1.40 Equation (1.75), τp = ND = 1016 /cm3 L2p Dp Assuming NA −4 2 (5 × 10 ) 10 = 25 ns = In Example 1.10, NA = 1018 /cm3 , Equation (1.81), τT I Cd = VT ND , τ T τ p = 25 ns 25 × 10−9 ∴ Cd = 0.1 × 10−3 25.9 × 10−3 = 96.5 pF Chapter 1–1 (e) P = I 2 R ⇒ I = P/R I = 1000 mW/1 k = 31.6 mA 5V V = = 5 mA R 1 k 5V V = = 5 k (b) R = I 1 mA (c) V = IR = 0.1 mA × 10 k = 1 V 1.1 (a) I = V = IR = 31.6 mA × 1 k = 31.6 V 1V V = = 0.01 A = 10 mA (d) I = R 100 Note: Volts, milliamps, and kilohms constitute a consistent set of units. 1.2 (a) P = I 2 R = (20 × 10−3 )2 × 1 × 103 = 0.4 W −3 2 (b) P = I R = (40 × 10 ) × 1 × 10 1.4 See figure on next page, which shows that there are 17 possible resistance values: 5.7, 6.7, 8, 8.6, 10, 13.3, 14.3, 17.1, 20, 23.3, 28, 30, 40, 46.7, 50, 60, and 70 k. 1.5 Shunting the 10 k by a resistor of value of R result in the combination having a resistance Req , 1 Thus, R should have a -W rating. 2 2 Note: V, mA, k, and mW constitute a consistent set of units. 3 Req = 10R R + 10 = 1.6 W Thus, for a 1% reduction, Thus, the resistor should have a 2-W rating. R = 0.99 ⇒ R = 990 k R + 10 (c) P = I 2 R = (1 × 10−3 )2 × 100 × 103 = 0.1 W 1 Thus, the resistor should have a -W rating. 8 (d) P = I 2 R = (4 × 10−3 )2 × 10 × 103 = 0.16 W Thus, the resistor should have a 1 -W rating. 4 (e) P = V 2 /R = 202 /(1 × 103 ) = 0.4 W Thus, the resistor should have a 1 -W rating. 2 (f) P = V /R = 11 /(1 × 10 ) = 0.121 W 2 2 For a 5% reduction, R = 0.95 ⇒ R = 190 k R + 10 For a 10% reduction, R = 0.90 ⇒ R = 90 k R + 10 For a 50% reduction, R = 0.50 ⇒ R = 10 k R + 10 Shunting the 10 k by (a) 1 M results in 3 1 Thus, a rating of W should theoretically suffice, 8 1 though W would be prudent to allow for 4 inevitable tolerances and measurement errors. 1.3 (a) V = IR = 5 mA × 1 k = 5 V P = I 2 R = (5 mA)2 × 1 k = 25 mW (b) R = V /I = 5 V/1 mA = 5 k P = VI = 5 V × 1 mA = 5 mW Req = 10 10 × 1000 = = 9.9 k 1000 + 10 1.01 a 1% reduction; (b) 100 k results in Req = 10 × 100 10 = = 9.09 k 100 + 10 1.1 a 9.1% reduction; (c) 10 k results in Req = 10 = 5 k 10 + 10 a 50% reduction. (c) I = P/V = 100 mW/10 V = 10 mA R = V /I = 10 V/10 mA = 1 k (d) V = P/I = 1 mW/0.1 mA = 10 V R = V /I = 10 V/0.1 mA = 100 k 1.6 VO = VDD R2 R1 + R2 To find RO , we short-circuit VDD and look back into node X, RO = R2 R1 = R1 R2 R1 + R2 Chapter 1–2 This figure belongs to 1.4. 10 10 10 40 46.7 20 20 20 10 40 20 30 40 10 10 40 50 20 6.7 20 40 60 10 10 40 20 70 20 40 40 8.0 10 13.3 20 40 8.6 40 14.3 20 17.1 10 20 20 5.7 10 40 20 40 10 40 23.3 10 10 20 40 1.7 Use voltage divider to find VO VO = 5 2 =2V 2+3 28 5 V 3 k Equivalent output resistance RO is VO RO = (2 k 3 k) = 1.2 k The extreme values of VO for ±5% tolerance resistor are VOmin = 5 2(1 − 0.05) 2(1 − 0.05) + 3(1 + 0.05) 2 k RO = 1.88 V VOmax = 5 = 2.12 V 2(1 + 0.05) 2(1 + 0.05) + 3(1 − 0.05) The extreme values of RO for ±5% tolerance resistors are 1.2 × 1.05 = 1.26 k and 1.2 × 0.95 = 1.14 k. Chapter 1–3 1.8 9 V 9 V 10 k 6 V R 20 // 10 k 6.67 k 10 k 10 k 3 V R 10 // 10 // 10 3.33 k 3 V R 10 k // 20 k 6.67 k 10 k 10 k 10 k (c) (a) 9 V 9 V 10 k 10 k 10 k 6 V 4.5 V 10 k 10 k R 10 // 10 5 k R 10 // 10 // 10 3.33 k (b) (d) 15 V Voltage generated: +3V [two ways: (a) and (c) with (c) having lower output resistance] +4.5 V (b) +6V [two ways: (a) and (d) with (d) having a lower output resistance] R 10 k 5.00 V 1.9 15 V 4.7 k 10 k VO 4.7 k Thus 1 1 1 + = 10 R 9.4 ⇒ R = 156.7 ≈ 157 k Now, VO = 15 4.7 = 4.80 V 10 + 4.7 To increase VO to 10.00 V, we shunt the 10-k resistor by a resistor R whose value is such that 10 R = 2 × 4.7. RO = 10 k R 4.7 k 9.4 = 3.133 k 3 To make RO = 3.33, we add a series resistance of approximately 200 , as shown on the next page. = 9.4 4.7 = Chapter 1–4 This figure belongs to 1.9. that the current through it will be 0.8I ; thus 15 V 157 k R 4 The input resistance of the divider, Rin , is 0.2IR = 0.8IR1 ⇒ R1 = 10 k R 1 = R 4 5 Now if R1 is 10% too high, that is, if Rin = R R1 = R 200 R 4 the problem can be solved in two ways: R1 = 1.1 VO 4.7 k RO (a) Connect a resistor R2 across R1 of value such that R2 R1 = R/4, thus R R2 (1.1R/4) = R2 + (1.1R/4) 4 1.10 I1 I R1 I2 V R2 1.1R2 = R2 + 11R = 2.75 R 4 1.1R 11R Rin = R 4 4 R R =R = 4 5 ⇒ R2 = V = I (R1 R2 ) R1 R2 =I R1 + R2 V R2 I1 = =I R1 R1 + R2 V R1 I2 = =I R2 R1 + R2 0.2I I 2 I 3 I 3 RL 10 k R 4 (b) Connect a resistor in series with the load resistor R so as to raise the resistance of the load branch by 10%, thereby restoring the current division ratio to its desired value. The added series resistance must be 10% of R (i.e., 0.1R). ⇒ R = 5 k IL R 0.8 I 0.2 I 0.1R 1.1R 4 I 1.12 R 0.2 I 0.8 I Rin I R 11R 4 } 10I /3 = 2IR/3 1.1R 4 R Rin 1.11 Connect a resistor R in parallel with RL . To make IL = I /3 (and thus the current through R, 2I /3), R should be such that I 1.1R 4 R1 Rin To make the current through R equal to 0.2I , we shunt R by a resistance R1 having a value such Rin = 1.1R 1.1R 4 1.1R 5 that is, 10% higher than in case (a). = Chapter 1–5 1.13 For RL = 10 k , when signal source generates 0−0.5 mA, a voltage of 0−2 V may appear across the source (b) Same procedure is used for (b) to obtain 0.5 k 2 0.75 V 3 is 00.5 mA RL vs (c) Between terminals 1 and 3, the open-circuit voltage is 1.5 V. When we short circuit the voltage source, we see that the Thévenin resistance will be zero. The equivalent circuit is then R 1 To limit v s ≤ 1 V, the net resistance has to be ≤ 2 k. To achieve this we have to shunt RL with a resistor R so that (R RL ) ≤ 2 k. 1.5 V R RL ≤ 2 k. 3 RRL ≤ 2 k R + RL 1.15 For RL = 10 k R ≤ 2.5 k The resulting circuit needs only one additional resistance of 2 k in parallel with RL so that v s ≤ 1 V. The circuit is a current divider, and the current through RL is now 0–0.1 mA. 1.14 (a) Between terminals 1 and 2: 1 1 k 1.5 V VTh 2 1 k RTh 1 k RTh 1 k 1 0.5 k 0.75 V 2 (cont’d on the next page) Chapter 1–6 12.31 k 0.77 V Now, subtracting Eq. (1) from Eq. (3) yields I 40I2 = 20 3 k ⇒ I2 = 0.5 mA Substituting in Eq. (2) gives 2I1 = 5 − 7 × 0.5 mA Now, when a resistance of 3 k is connected between node 4 and ground, I= ⇒ I1 = 0.75 mA 0.77 12.31 + 3 I3 = I1 + I2 = 0.05 mA = 0.75 + 0.5 = 1.25 mA 1.16 (a) Node equation at the common mode yields V = I3 R3 I3 = I1 + I2 Using the fact that the sum of the voltage drops across R1 and R3 equals 10 V, we write 10 = I1 R1 + I3 R3 = 10I1 + (I1 + I2 ) × 2 = 12I1 + 2I2 R1 10 k I2 = 0.5 mA I3 = 1.25 mA V = 2.5 V Thus, 10 − V 5−V V + = 10 5 2 I1 V I1 = 0.75 mA 10 − V 5−V V + = R1 R2 R3 5 V I2 To summarize: (b) A node equation at the common node can be written in terms of V as 10 V R2 5 k = 1.25 × 2 = 2.5 V I3 ⇒ 0.8V = 2 R3 2 k ⇒ V = 2.5 V Now, I1 , I2 , and I3 can be easily found as I1 = That is, 12I1 + 2I2 = 10 (1) 10 − 2.5 10 − V = 10 10 = 0.75 mA 5 − 2.5 5−V = 5 5 Similarly, the voltage drops across R2 and R3 add up to 5 V, thus I2 = 5 = I2 R2 + I3 R3 = 0.5 mA = 5I2 + (I1 + I2 ) × 2 I3 = which yields 2I1 + 7I2 = 5 (2) Equations (1) and (2) can be solved together by multiplying Eq. (2) by 6: 12I1 + 42I2 = 30 (3) V 2.5 = 1.25 mA = R3 2 Method (b) is much preferred, being faster, more insightful, and less prone to errors. In general, one attempts to identify the lowest possible number of variables and write the corresponding minimum number of equations. Chapter 1–7 1.17 Find the Thévenin equivalent of the circuit to the left of node 1. current Vx /2 k and Ix will be the sum of the two current, Ix = 2Vx Vx = 2 k 1 k Between node 1 and ground, RTh = (1 k 1.2 k) = 0.545 k VTh = 10 × 1.2 = 5.45 V 1 + 1.2 Find the Thévenin equivalent of the circuit to the right of node 2. Thus, Req ≡ Vx = 1 k Ix Now, if R4 is raised to 1.2 k, the symmetry will be broken. To find Is we use Thévenin’s theorem as shown in the figures on the next page. Thus, I5 = 0.545Vx − 0.5Vx = 0.022Vx 0.5 + 1 + 0.545 Vx + 0.022 Vx × 0.5 2 = 0.5Vx × 1.022 = 0.511Vx V1 = Between node 2 and ground, V2 = V1 + I5 R5 = 0.533Vx RTh = 9.1 k 11 k = 4.98 k VTh = 10 × Vx − V1 = 0.489Vx 1 k Vx − V2 I2 = = 0.467Vx 1 k Ix = I1 + I2 = 0.956Vx I1 = 11 = 5.47 V 11 + 9.1 The resulting simplified circuit is 0.545 k 1 I5 2 4.98 k ⇒ Req ≡ R5 2 k 5.45 V I5 = V5 5.47 V 5.47 − 5.45 4.98 + 2 + 0.545 = 2.66 μA V5 = 2.66 μA × 2 k = 5.32 mV 1.18 From the symmetry of the circuit, there will be no current in R5 . (Otherwise the symmetry would be violated.) Thus each branch will carry a Vx = 1.05 k Ix 1.19 Refer to Fig. P1.19. Using the voltage divider rule at the input side, we obtain rπ vπ = vs rπ + Rs (1) At the output side, we find v o by multiplying the current gm v π by the parallel equivalent of ro and RL , v o = −gm v π (ro RL ) (2) Finally, v o /v s can be obtained by combining Eqs. (1) and (2) as rπ vo =− gm (ro RL ) vs rπ + Rs Chapter 1–8 This figure belongs to Problem 1.18. (c) ω = 6.28 × 102 rad/s ω = 102 Hz f = 2π 1 T = = 10−2 s f (d) T = 10 s f = 1 = 10−1 Hz T ω = 2πf = 6.28 × 10−1 rad/s (e) f = 60 Hz T= 1 = 1.67 × 10−2 s f ω = 2πf = 3.77 × 102 rad/s (f) ω = 1 krad/s = 103 rad/s ω = 1.59 × 102 Hz f = 2π 1 T = = 6.28 × 10−3 s f (g) f = 1900 MHz = 1.9 × 109 Hz T= 1 = 5.26 × 10−10 s f ω = 2π f = 1.194 × 1010 rad/s 1.21 (a) Z = 1 k at all frequencies (b) Z = 1 /jωC = − j At f = 60 Hz, 1 2πf × 10 × 10−9 Z = − j265 k At f = 100 kHz, Z = − j159 At f = 1 GHz, Z = − j0.016 (c) Z = 1 /jωC = − j At f = 60 Hz, 1 2πf × 10 × 10−12 Z = − j0.265 G At f = 100 kHz, Z = − j0.16 M At f = 1 GHz, Z = − j15.9 (d) Z = jωL = j2πf L = j2πf × 10 × 10−3 1.20 (a) T = 10−4 ms = 10−7 s At f = 60 Hz, Z = j3.77 1 = 107 Hz f = T At f = 100 kHz, Z = j6.28 k At f = 1 GHz, Z = j62.8 M ω = 2πf = 6.28 × 107 rad/s (b) f = 1 GHz = 109 Hz T= 1 = 10−9 s f ω = 2πf = 6.28 × 10 rad/s 9 (e) Z = jωL = j2πf L = j2πf (1 × 10−6 ) f = 60 Hz, Z = j0.377 m f = 100 kHz, Z = j0.628 f = 1 GHz, Z = j6.28 k Chapter 1–9 1.22 (a) Z = R + 1 jωC (b) v s = v oc = 0.1 V is = isc = 1 μA 1 = 10 + j2π × 10 × 103 × 10 × 10−9 3 v oc 0.1 V = 0.1 M = 100 k = isc 1 μA Rs = = (1 − j1.59) k (b) Y = = 1 + jωC R 1.24 The observed output voltage is 1 mV/ ◦ C, which is one half the voltage specified by the sensor, presumably under open-circuit conditions: that is, without a load connected. It follows that that sensor internal resistance must be equal to RL , that is, 5 k. 1 + j2π × 10 × 103 × 0.01 × 10−6 104 = 10−4 (1 + j6.28) Z= = 104 1 = Y 1 + j6.28 1.25 Rs 10 (1 − j6.28) 1 + 6.282 4 = (247.3 − j1553) vs 1 (c) Y = + jωC R 1 + j2π × 10 × 103 × 100 × 10−12 = 100 × 103 −5 = 10 (1 + j0.628) Z= 105 1 + j0.628 (d) Z = R + jωL = 40 1+ 1.23 (2) 1 + (Rs /10) =4 1 + (Rs /100) Rs is Thévenin equivalent v oc = v s Rs ⇒ RS = 50 k Substituting in Eq. (2) gives Norton equivalent v s = 60 mV The Norton current is can be found as is = isc = is v s = is Rs vs 60 mV = 1.2 μA = Rs 50 k 1.26 Rs Thus, v oc isc (a) v s = v oc = 1 V vs v oc 1V = = 10 k isc 0.1 mA io vo is = isc = 0.1 mA Rs = (1) = 10 Rs 10 Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2) gives = (100 + j628), Rs = Rs 100 and vs = 100 + j6.28 × 100 vs RL vo = vs RL + Rs Rs vo = vs 1+ RL 1+ = 100 + j2π × 10 × 103 × 10 × 10−3 RL vo Thus, vs = (71.72 − j45.04) k v o = v s − io Rs is io Rs vo Chapter 1–10 Highest value = 1 V 1 2π Period T = = = 10−3 s f0 ω0 1 Frequency f = = 1 kHz I vo Open-circuit (io 0) vs voltage Slope Rs vs is Rs 0 io Short-circuit (vo 0) current 1.27 Case ω (rad/s) f (Hz) T (s) a 3.14 × 1010 5 × 109 0.2 × 10−9 b 2 × 10 3.18 × 10 c 6.28 × 10 d 3.77 × 102 60 1.67 × 10−2 e 6.28 × 104 1 × 104 1 × 10−4 f 6.28 × 105 1 × 105 1 × 10−5 9 8 10 −9 3.14 × 10 1 × 10−10 1 × 10 10 1.31 The two harmonics have the ratio 126/98 = 9/7. Thus, these are the 7th and 9th harmonics. From Eq. (1.2), we note that the amplitudes of these two harmonics will have the ratio 7 to 9, which is confirmed by the measurement reported. Thus the fundamental will have a frequency of 98/7, or 14 kHz, and peak amplitude of 63 × 7 = 441 mV. √ The rms value of the fundamental will be 441/ 2 = 312 mV. To find the peak-to-peak amplitude of the square wave, we note that 4V/π = 441 mV. Thus, Peak-to-peak amplitude π = 2V = 441 × = 693 mV 2 1 1 = 71.4 μs Period T = = f 14 × 103 1.32 Decimal Binary 1.28 (a) v = 10 sin(2π × 103 t), V √ (b) v = 120 2 sin(2π × 60),V 0 0 6 110 11 1011 28 11100 59 111011 (c) v = 0.1 sin(2000t), V (d) v = 0.1 sin(2π × 103 t), V √ 1.29 (a) Vpeak = 117 × 2 = 165 V √ (b) Vrms = 33.9/ 2 = 24 V √ (c) Vpeak = 220 × 2 = 311 V √ (d) Vpeak = 220 × 2 = 311 kV 1.33 b3 b2 b1 b0 Value Represented 0 0 0 0 +0 0 0 0 1 +1 0 0 1 0 +2 0 0 1 1 +3 0 1 0 0 +4 0 1 0 1 +5 0 1 1 0 +6 0 1 1 1 +7 1 0 0 0 –0 1 0 0 1 –1 1 0 1 0 –2 1 0 1 1 –3 1 1 0 0 –4 Average value = 0.5 V 1 1 0 1 –5 Peak-to-peak value = 1 V 1 1 1 0 –6 1 1 1 1 –7 1.30 Comparing the given waveform to that described by Eq. (1.2), we observe that the given waveform has an amplitude of 0.5 V (1 V peak-to-peak) and its level is shifted up by 0.5 V (the first term in the equation). Thus the waveform looks as follows: v 1V T 0 Lowest value = 0 V ... t Chapter 1–11 Note that there are two possible representations of zero: 0000 and 1000. For a 0.5-V step size, analog signals in the range ±3.5 V can be represented. Input Steps Code +2.5 V +5 b1 is the MSB (c) iOmax = 10 V 10 k 1 1 1 1 + 2 + 3 + 4 21 2 2 2 0101 −3.0 V −6 1110 +2.7 +5 0101 −2.8 −6 1110 1.34 (a) For N bits there will be 2N possible levels, from 0 to VFS . Thus there will be (2N − 1) discrete steps from 0 to VFS with the step size given by Step size = (b) bN is the LSB VFS 2N − 1 This is the analog change corresponding to a change in the LSB. It is the value of the resolution of the ADC. (b) The maximum error in conversion occurs when the analog signal value is at the middle of a step. Thus the maximum error is + 1 1 1 1 + 6 + 7 + 8 25 2 2 2 = 0.99609375 mA Corresponding to the LSB changing from 0 to 1 the output changes by (10/10) × 1/28 = 3.91 μA. 1.36 There will be 44,100 samples per second with each sample represented by 16 bits. Thus the throughput or speed will be 44, 100 × 16 = 7.056 × 105 bits per second. 1.37 (a) Av = vO 10 V = 100 V/V = vI 100 mV or 20 log 100 = 40 dB Ai = 0.1 A iO v O /RL 10 V/100 = = = iI iI 100 μA 100 μA = 1000 A/A or 20 log 1000 = 60 dB Step Ap = v O iO vO iO = × = 100 × 1000 v I iI vI iI = 105 W/W or 10 log 105 = 50 dB 1 VFS 1 × step size = 2 2 2N − 1 This is known as the quantization error. 5V ≤ 2 mV (c) N 2 −1 (b) Av = 2N − 1 ≥ 2500 For N = 12, Resolution = 5 = 1.2 mV 212 − 1 Quantization error = 1.2 = 0.6 mV 2 1.35 (a) When bi = 1, the ith switch is in position 1 and a current (Vref /2i R) flows to the output. Thus iO will be the sum of all the currents corresponding to “1” bits, that is, Vref b1 b2 bN + + · · · + iO = R 21 22 2N vO 1V = 1 × 105 V/V = vI 10 μV or 20 log 1 × 105 = 100 dB Ai = 2N ≥ 2501 ⇒ N = 12, = iO v O /RL 1 V/10 k = = iI iI 100 nA 0.1 × 10−3 0.1 mA = = 1000 A/A 100 nA 100 × 10−9 or 20 log Ai = 60 dB Ap = v O iO vO iO = × v I iI vI iI = 1 × 105 × 1000 = 1 × 108 W/W or 10 log AP = 80 dB (c) Av = vO 5V = 5 V/V = vi 1V or 20 log 5 = 14 dB Chapter 1–12 Ai = iO v O /RL 5 V/10 = = iI iI 1 mA or 20 log 11 = 20.8 dB Ai = 0.5 A = 500 A/A = 1 mA 22 mA = 22 A/A 1 mA or 20 log Ai = 26.8 dB √ po (2.2/ 2)2 /100 Ap = = pi 0.2 10−3 √ × √ 2 2 = or 20 log 500 = 54 dB v O iO vO iO = × v I iI vI iI Ap = io 2.2 V/100 = ii 1 mA = 5 × 500 = 2500 W/W or 10 log Ap = 34 dB = 242 W/W 1.38 For ±5 V supplies: The largest undistorted √ sine-wave output is of 4-V peak amplitude or 4/ 2 = 2.8 Vrms . Input needed is 14 mVrms . For ±10-V supplies, the largest undistorted sine-wave output is of 9-V peak amplitude or 6.4 Vrms . Input needed is 32 mVrms . vO VDD 1.0 200 V/V or 10 log AP = 23.8 dB Supply power = 2 × 3 V ×20 mA = 120 mW √ v2 (2.2/ 2)2 = 24.2 mW Output power = orms = RL 100 24.2 = 0.1 mW (negligible) 242 Amplifier dissipation Supply power − Output power Input power = = 120 − 24.2 = 95.8 mW Amplifier efficiency = vI = VDD 1.0 Output power × 100 supply power 24.2 × 100 = 20.2% 120 RL RL + Ro RL Ri = Av o v s Ri + Rs RL + Ro 1.40 v o = Av o v i For ±15-V supplies, the largest undistorted sine-wave output is of 14-V peak amplitude or 9.9 Vrms . The input needed is 9.9 V/200 = 49.5 mVrms . Rs 1.39 vs +3 V 1 mA t Ri Av ovi RL vi 20 mA (average) vo vi vi 2.2 V ii Ro 0.2 V 20 mA (average) 3 V RL 100 Thus, Ri RL vo = Av o vs Ri + Rs RL + Ro (a) Av o = 100, Ri = 10Rs , RL = 10Ro : 10Rs 10Ro vo = 100 × × vs 10Rs + Rs 10Ro + Ro = 82.6 V/V or 20 log 82.6 = 38.3 dB vo 2.2 Av = = vi 0.2 = 11 V/V (b) Av o = 100, Ri = Rs , RL = Ro : vo 1 1 = 100 × × = 25 V/V or 20 log 25 = 28 dB vs 2 2 Chapter 1–13 vo RL = vs RL + Rs (c) Av o = 100 V/V, Ri = Rs /10, RL = Ro /10: Rs /10 Ro /10 vo = 100 vs (Rs /10) + Rs (Ro /10) + Ro = = 0.826 V/V or 20 log 0.826 = −1.7 dB 100 100 + 100 k 0.001 V/V Rs 100 k 1.41 100 vo 100vi 500 vi 1 M which is clearly a much worse situation. Indeed inserting the amplifier increases the gain by a factor 8.3/0.001 = 8300. 20 log Av o = 40 dB ⇒ Av o = 100 V/V vo Av = vi 500 = 100 × 500 + 100 = 83.3 V/V 1.43 1V 1 M For a peak output sine-wave current of 20 mA, the peak output voltage will be 20 mA × 500 = 10 V. Correspondingly v i will be a sine wave with a peak value of 10 V/A √ v = 10/83.3, or an rms value of 10/(83.3 × 2) = 0.085 √ V. Corresponding output power = (10/ 2)2 /500 = 0.1 W 1.42 Rs vs vi Ri Av ovi vo = 1 V × RL ×1× 100 1vi vo 1 M 1 M + 200 k 100 100 + 20 100 1 × = 0.69 V 1.2 120 vo = 0.69 V/V or −3.2 dB Voltage gain = vs = Current gain = Ro vi v 2o /500 = A2v × 104 = 1.39 × 107 W/W v 2i /1 M or 10 log (1.39 × 107 ) = 71.4 dB. 20 200 k or 20 log 83.3 = 38.4 dB Ap = vo RL 100 vs v o /100 = 0.69 × 1.2 × 104 v s /1.2 M vo = 8280 A/A or Power gain = v 2o /100 v 2s /1.2 M 78.4 dB = 5713 W/W or 10 log 5713 = 37.6 dB vo 100 10 k × 1000 × = vs 10 k + 100 k 100 + 1 k 100 10 × 1000 × = 8.26 V/V = 110 1100 The signal loses about 90% of its strength when connected to the amplifier input (because Ri = Rs /10). Also, the output signal of the amplifier loses approximately 90% of its strength when the load is connected (because RL = Ro /10). Not a good design! Nevertheless, if the source were connected directly to the load, (This takes into account the power dissipated in the internal resistance of the source.) 1.44 (a) Case S-A-B-L (see figure on next page): vo vo v ib v ia = × × = vs v ib v ia vs 10 100 × 100 × × 10 × 100 +1000 10 + 10 100 100 + 100 Chapter 1–14 This figure belongs to 1.44, part (a). This figure belongs to 1.44, part (b). This figure belongs to Problem 1.45. vo = 22.7 V/V and gain in dB 20 log 22.7 = vs Av 2 = 27.1 dB = 9.09 V/V (b) Case S-B-A-L (see figure above): Av 3 = v o v ia v ib vo = · · vs v ia v ib v s 100 × = 100 × 100 + 10 K 100 K 10 × × 100 K + 1 K 10 K 10 K + 100 K vo = 0.89 V/V and gain in dB is 20 log 0.89 = vs −1 dB. Obviously, case a is preferred because it provides higher voltage gain. 1.45 In Example 1.3, when the first and the second stages are interchanged, the circuit looks like the figure above, and v i1 100 k = 0.5 V/V = vs 100 k + 100 k Av 1 = v i2 1 M = 100 × v i1 1 M + 1 k = 99.9 V/V v i3 10 k = 10 × v i2 10 k + 1 k vL 100 = 0.909 V/V =1× v i3 100 + 10 Total gain = Av = vL = Av 1 × Av 2 × Av 3 v i1 = 99.9 × 9.09 × 0.909 = 825.5 V/V The voltage gain from source to load is vL vL v i1 v i1 = × = Av · vs v i1 vS vS = 825.5 × 0.5 = 412.7 V/V The overall voltage has reduced appreciably. This is because the input resistance of the first stage, Rin , is comparable to the source resistance Rs . In Example 1.3 the input resistance of the first stage is much larger than the source resistance. 1.46 Each of stages #1, 2, ..., (n − 1) can be represented by the equivalent circuit: vo v i1 v i2 v i3 v in vo = × × × ··· × × vs vs v i1 v i2 v i(n−1) v in where Chapter 1–15 This figure belongs to 1.46. Rs 10 k vs 5 mV #1 #2 #n vi1 vi2 vin vo RL 200 Ri1 10 k Ron 1 k 1 k #m vim vi(m 1) vim Ri(m 1) v i1 10 k = 0.5 V/V = vs 10 k + 10 k 10 k 10 k vi(m 1) 10vim Thus Ri = 40 k. vo 200 = 1.67 V/V = 10 × v in 1 k + 200 v i2 10 k v i3 v in = = ··· = = 10× v i1 v i2 v i(n−1) 10 k + 10 k = 9.09 V/V For Ri = 40 k. ii = 0.1 μA peak, and = 2 mA = 2 × 104 A/A 0.1 μA Overall power gain ≡ Thus, 2 V/1 k v o /RL = ii 0.1 μA Overall current gain = vo = 0.5 × (9.09)n−1 × 1.67 = 0.833 × (9.09)n−1 vs 2 √ 2 −3 v 2orms /RL v s(rms) × ii(rms) 2 1000 vo For v s = 5 mV and v o = 3 V, the gain must be vs ≥ 600, thus = 0.833 × (9.09)n−1 ≥ 600 = 8 × 106 W/W ⇒ n=4 (This takes into account the power dissipated in the internal resistance of the source.) Thus four amplifier stages are needed, resulting in vo = 0.833 × (9.09)3 = 625.7 V/V vs and correspondingly = vo vs 2V = 400 V/V 0.005 V (b) The smallest Ri allowed is obtained from 0.1 μA = × 0.1 × 10−6 √ 2 5 mV ⇒ Rs + Ri = 50 k Rs + Ri (c) If ( Av o v i ) has its peak value limited to 3 V, the largest value of RO is found from Ro Rs 10 k v o = 625.7 × 5 mV = 3.13 V 1.47 (a) Required voltage gain ≡ 5 × 10 √ 2 ii vs 5-mV peak =3× Ri vi vo Av ovi RL 1 k RL 1 = 2 ⇒ Ro = RL = 500 RL + Ro 2 (If Ro were greater than this value, the output voltage across RL would be less than 2 V.) Chapter 1–16 This figure belongs to 1.48. 0.5 M 30 mV rms 10 k vi1 ∼ 1 M 10vi1 vi2 (d) For Ri = 40 k and Ro = 500 , the required value Av o can be found from 400 V/V = 10 k 100vi2 10 k vi3 1vi3 vo 100 v i3 10 k = 100 × = 90.9 v i2 10 k + 1 k ⇒ v i3 = 100 mV × 90.9 = 9.09 V 1 40 × Av o × 40 + 10 1 + 0.5 100 vo =1× = 0.833 v i3 100 + 20 ⇒ Av o = 750 V/V (e) Ri = 100 k(1 × 105 ) ⇒ v o = 9.09 × 0.833 = 7.6 V Ro = 100 (1 × 10 ) 2 400 = 20 1 k Po = 1000 100 × Av o × 100 + 10 1000 + 100 v 2orms 7.62 = 0.57 W = RL 100 which exceeds the required 0.5 W. Also, the signal throughout the amplifier chain never drops below 20 mV (which is greater than the required minimum of 10 mV). ⇒ Av o = 484 V/V 1.48 Deliver 0.5 W to a 100- load. Source is 30 mV rms with 0.5-M source resistance. Choose from these three amplifier types: A Ri 1 M B Ri 10 k C Ri 10 k Av 10 V/ V Av 100 V/ V Av 1 V/ V Ro 10 k Ro 1 k Ro 20 1.49 From the equivalent circuit of the output side of a voltage amplifier [Fig. 1.16(b)]: v o = (Av o v i ) RL RL + Ro 200 = (Av o v i ) 1000 1000 + Ro (1) 195 = (Av o v i ) 780 780 + Ro (2) Dividing Eq. (2) by Eq. (1), we have 1000 + Ro 195 = 0.78 200 780 + Ro Choose order to eliminate loading on input and output: ⇒ Ro = 100 A, first, to minimize loading on 0.5-M source (Av o v i ) = 200[(1000 + 100)/1000] = 220 mV B, second, to boost gain C, third, to minimize loading at 100- output. We first attempt a cascade of the three stages in the order A, B, C (see figure above), and obtain 1.50 The equivalent circuit at the output side of a current amplifier loaded with a resistance RL is shown. Since io 1 1 M v i1 = = 1 M + 0.5 M 1.5 vs 1 = 20 mV 1.5 10 k =5 = 10 × 10 k + 10 k ⇒ v i1 = 30 × v i2 v i1 ⇒ v i2 = 20 × 5 = 100 mV Aisii Ro RL Chapter 1–17 io = (Ais ii ) Ro Ro + RL we can write 1 = (Ais ii ) Ro Ro + 1 (1) and 0.5 = (Ais ii ) Ro Ro + 12 (2) 1.53 To obtain the weighted sum of v 1 and v 2 Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2), we have Ro + 12 ⇒ Ro = 10 k Ro + 1 2= v o = 10v 1 + 20v 2 we use two transconductance amplifiers and sum their output currents. Each transconductance amplifier has the following equivalent circuit: 10 + 1 = 1.1 mA Ais ii = 1 × 10 1.51 vi Rs 1 k Ri 2 k vs vi Gmvi Ro RL Ro 10 k Gm 20 mA/V vo The parallel connection of the two amplifiers at the output and the connection of RL means that the total resistance at the output is RL = 1 k 10 k. Thus the 3 component of v o due to v 2 will be Ri Rs + Ri 10 k 10 k 10 k = 2 2 = vs 1+2 3 v o2 = v 2 v o = Gm v i (RL Ro ) 10 10 × Gm2 × 10 + 10 3 = v 2 × 0.5 × 20 × 20 × 1 vi = 60 20 + 1 20 2 = 60 × v s 21 3 Overall voltage gain ≡ vo = 38.1 V/V vs 1.52 i2 ix vx Gmvi Consider first the path for the signal requiring higher gain, namely v 2 . See figure at top of next page. Ro = 20 k = vs Ri 10 k Gm = 60 mA/V vi = vs ⎫ ix = i1 + i2 ⎪ ix = v x /Ri + gm v x ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ 1 ⎬ i1 = v i /Ri ⎪ ix = v x + gm Ri ⎪ i2 = gm v i ⎪ ⎪ 1 v ⎪ x ⎪ ⎪ = ⎭ i 1/R x i + gm vi = vx Ri = = Rin 1 + gm Ri vi i1 Ri gmvi 10 = 33.3v 2 3 To reduce the gain seen by v 2 from 33.3 to 20, we connect a resistance Rp in parallel with RL , 10 Rp = 2 k 3 ⇒ Rp = 5 k We next consider the path for v 1 . Since v 1 must see a gain factor of only 10, which is half that seen by v 2 , we have to reduce the fraction of v 1 that appears at the input of its transconductance amplifier to half that that appears at the input of the v 2 transconductance amplifier. We just saw that 0.5 v 2 appears at the input of the v 2 transconductance amplifier. Thus, for the v 1 transconductance amplifier, we want 0.25v 1 to appear at the input. This can be achieved by shunting the input of the v 1 transconductance Chapter 1–18 This figure belongs to Problem 1.53. amplifier by a resistance Rp1 as in the following figure. 1+ Rs1 10 k v1 Thus, Rp1 Ri1 vi1 10 k Rs1 =4 (Rp1 Ri1 ) ⇒ Rp1 Ri1 = Rp1 10 = 10 Rs1 = 3 3 10 3 The value of Rp1 can be found from ⇒ Rp1 = 5 k (Rp1 Ri1 ) = 0.25 (Rp1 Ri1 ) + Rs1 The final circuit will be as follows: Chapter 1–19 For Rs varying in the range 1 k to 10 k and load current variation limited to 10%, select Ri to be sufficiently low: 1.54 Voltage amplifier: Rs 1 to 10 k Ro vs Ri vo Avo vi vi io RL 1 k to 10 k Ri ≤ Rsmin 10 Ri = 1 k = 100 = 1 × 102 10 For RL varying in the range 1 k to 10 k and the load current variation limited to 10%, Ro is selected sufficiently large: For Rs varying in the range 1 k to 10 k and v o limited to 10%, select Ri to be sufficiently large: Ro ≥ 10 R Lmax Ri ≥ 10 Rsmax Ro = 10 × 10 k Ri = 10 × 10 k = 100 k = 1 × 105 For RL varying in the range 1 k to 10 k, the load voltage variation limited to 10%, select Ro sufficiently low: = 100 k = 1 × 105 Now we find Ais : Rsmin Ro × Ais × Rsmin + Ri Ro + RLmax RLmin 10 1 k = 100 = 1 × 102 Ro = 10 Now find Av o : Ri RLmin v omin = 10 mV × × Av o Ri + Rsmax Ro + RLmin iomin = 10 μA × 100 k 100 k + 10 k 1 k × Av o × 100 + 1 k ⇒ Av o = 121 V/V ⇒ Ais = 121 A/A Ro ≤ 1 × 10−3 = 10 × 10−6 × Ais 1 = 10 × 10−3 × io Ri 100 k 100 k + 10 k Current amplifier equivalent circuit: ii Ro vi 1 k 1 k + 100 Ri vo Avovi Ro Ais ii Ri = 1 × 102 , Ais = 121 A/A, Values for the voltage amplifier equivalent circuit are Ro = 1 × 105 Ri = 1 × 10 , Av o = 121 V/V, and 5 Ro = 1 × 102 1.56 Transconductance amplifier: 1.55 Current amplifier: ii is 10 A Rs 1 k to Ri 10 k io Ais ii Ro RL 1 k to 10 k Rs 1 to 10 k io vs Ri 10 mV nominal vi Gmvi Ro RL 1 to 10 k Chapter 1–20 For Rs varying in the range 1 to 10 k, and io limited to 10%, we have to select Ri sufficiently large; Ri ≥ 10Rsmax The overall current gain can be found as io v o /RL 5 V/2 k = = is 1 μA 1 μA = Ri = 100 k = 1 × 105 For RL varying in the range 1 to 10 k, the change in io can be kept to 10% if Ro is selected sufficiently large; 2.5 mA = 2500 A/A 1 μA or 68 dB. Ap = v 2o /RL = ii2 Ri Ro ≥ RLmax 52 /(2 × 103 ) 2 200 10−6 × 5 × 103 200 + 5 = 2.63 × 106 W/W or 64.2 dB Thus Ro = 100 k = 1 × 105 For v s = 10 mV, iomin = 10−2 Ri Ro Gm Ri + Rsmax Ro + RLmax 10−3 = 10−2 100 100 Gm 100 + 10 100 + 10 1.58 Gm = 1.21 × 10−1 A/V = 121 mA/V In 100 k vi 1.57 Ro = = 2 k v o = 10 × Out Gmvi 100 k Gm 121 mA/V Open-circuit output voltage 10 V = Short-circuit output current 5 mA 2 =5V 2+2 The node equation at E yields the current through RE as (βib + ib ) = (β + 1)ib . The voltage v c can be found in terms of ib as v c = −βib RL (1) The voltage v b can be related to ib by writing for the input loop: v b = ib rπ + (β + 1)ib RE Thus, v b = [rπ + (β + 1)RE ]ib (2) Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2) yields βRL vc =− vb rπ + (β + 1)RE Av = vo 10(2/4) = vi 1 × 10−6 × (200 5) × 103 Q.E.D The voltage v e is related to ib by v e = (β + 1)ib RE 1025 V/V or 60.2 dB Ai = = io v o /RL = ii v i /Ri v o Ri 5 k = 1025 × v i RL 2 k = 2562.5 A/A or 62.8 dB That is, v e = [(β + 1)RE ]ib Dividing Eq. (3) by Eq. (2) yields ve (β + 1)RE = vb (β + 1)RE + rπ (3) Chapter 1–21 amplifier circuit. In developing the model of Fig. 1.16(a), we assumed that the amplifier is unilateral (i.e., has no internal feedback, or that the input side does not know what happens at the output side). If we neglect this internal feedback, that is, assume g12 = 0, we can compare the two models and thus obtain: Dividing the numerator and denominator by (β + 1) gives ve RE = vb RE + [rπ /(β + 1)] Q.E.D 1.59 Ri = 1/g11 gm gmv1 v1 100 mA/V R 5 k Ro = g22 vo R Av o = g21 1.61 Circuits of Fig. 1.22: io R v2 gmv2 Vi Vo Vi C R For (a) Vo = Vi ∴ vo = 0 V v 1 = 1.01 V v 2 = 0.99 V ∴ v o = 100 × 5 × 0.02 = 10 V 1.60 g22 I1 g12 I2 g21V1 V1 1/g11 I2 V2 Ro I1 V1 I2 Ri 1/sC 1/sC + R Vo 1 = Vi 1 + sCR v1 = v2 = 1 V (b) v o = io RL = gm R(v 1 − v 2 ) Vo (a) io = gm v 1 − gm v 2 C AvoV1 V2 which is of the form shown for the low-pass function in Table 1.2 with K = 1 and ω0 = 1/RC. ⎛ ⎞ ⎜ For (b) Vo = Vi ⎝ ⎟ 1 ⎠ R+ sC R Vo sRC = Vi 1 + sCR Vo = Vi s s+ 1 RC which is of the form shown in Table 1.2 for the high-pass function, with K = 1 and ω0 = 1/RC. 1.62 The correspondences between the current and voltage variables are indicated by comparing the two equivalent-circuit models above. At the outset we observe that at the input side of the g-parameter model, we have the controlled current source g12 I2 . This has no correspondence in the equivalent-circuit model of Fig. 1.16(a). It represents internal feedback, internal to the Rs Vs Ri Ci Vi Chapter 1–22 1 sCi 1 Ri + Vi sCi ⎛ = 1 Vs ⎜ Ri sCi Rs + ⎜ ⎝ 1 Ri + sCi f0 = Ri Ri 1 + sCi Ri ⎞ = Ri R + s ⎟ 1 + sCi Ri ⎟ ⎠ ω0 1 = 2π 2π × 1 × 10−6 (10 + 40) × 103 = 3.18 Hz 1 K 40 |T (jω0 )| = √ = √ = 0.57 V/V 10 + 40 2 2 1.64 Using the voltage divider rule, Ri = Rs + sCi Ri Rs + Ri Ri Vi = = Vs (Rs + Ri ) + sC i Ri Rs Ri (Rs + Ri ) Ci Ri Rs 1+s Rs + Ri which is a low-pass STC function with Ri and ω0 = 1/[Ci (Ri Rs )]. K= Rs + Ri Vs Vl = Vs For Rs = 10 k, Ri = 40 k, and Ci = 5 pF, ω0 = f0 = C Rs 1 = 25 Mrad/s 5 × 10−12 × (40 10) × 103 25 = 4 MHz 2π = RL Vl RL RL + Rs + RL RL + Rs 1 sC s s+ 1 C(RL + Rs ) which is of the high-pass STC type (see Table 1.2) with K= 1.63 Using the voltage-divider rule. RL RL + Rs ω0 = 1 C(RL + Rs ) For f0 ≤ 100 Hz R1 Vi 1 ≤ 100 2πC(RL + Rs ) C R2 Vo ⇒C≥ 1 2π × 100(20 + 5) × 103 Thus, the smallest value of C that will do the job is C = 0.064 μF or 64 nF. T (s) = Vo = Vi T (s) = R2 R2 + R1 + R2 R1 + R2 1 sC ⎛ ⎞ ⎜ ⎜ ⎝ ⎟ ⎟ ⎠ 1 s+ C(R1 + R2 ) s 1.65 The given measured data indicate that this amplifier has a low-pass STC frequency response with a low-frequency gain of 40 dB, and a 3-dB frequency of 104 Hz. From our knowledge of the Bode plots for low-pass STC networks [Fig. 1.23(a)], we can complete the table entries and sketch the amplifier frequency response. which from Table 1.2 is of the high-pass type with R2 K= R1 + R2 1 ω0 = C(R1 + R2 ) As a further verification that this is a high-pass network and T(s) is a high-pass transfer function, see that as s ⇒ 0, T (s) ⇒ 0; and as s → ∞, T (s) = R2 /(R1 + R2 ). Also, from the circuit, observe as s → ∞, (1/sC) → 0 and Vo /Vi = R2 /(R1 + R2 ). Now, for R1 = 10 k, R2 = 40 k and C = 1 μF, f (Hz) |T |(dB) ∠T (◦ ) 0 40 0 100 40 0 1000 40 0 104 37 −45◦ 105 20 −90◦ 106 0 −90◦ Chapter 1–23 This figure belongs to 1.65. R 10 k C T , dB 40 37 30 20 dB/decade 3 dB 20 V R 100 k R 1 k V R 100V 1 k V For f01 ≤ 100 Hz, 10 0 10 102 103 104 105 106 f (Hz) 1 ≤ 100 2πC1 (10 + 100) × 103 ⇒ C1 ≥ 1.66 Since the overall transfer function is that of three identical STC LP circuits in cascade (but with no loading effects, since the buffer amplifiers have infinite input and zero output resistances) the overall gain will drop by 3 dB below the value at dc at the frequency for which the gain of each STC circuit is 1 dB down. This frequency is found as follows: The transfer function of each STC circuit is T (s) = 1 1+ 1 = 1.4 × 10−8 F 2π × 110 × 103 × 102 Thus we select C1 = 1 × 10−7 F = 0.1 μF. The actual corner frequency resulting from C1 will be f01 = 1 = 14.5 Hz 2π × 10−7 × 110 × 103 For the output circuit, f02 = 1 2πC2 (Ro + RL ) For f02 ≤ 100 Hz, s ω0 where 1 ≤ 100 2πC2 (1 + 1) × 103 ω0 = 1/CR ⇒ C2 ≥ Thus, 1 = 0.8 × 10−6 2π × 2 × 103 × 102 Select C2 = 1 × 10−6 = 1 μF. 1 |T (jω)| = 1+ ω ω0 2 1 = −1 ω1 dB 2 1+ ω0 20 log ⇒1+ ω1 dB ω0 This will place the corner frequency at f02 = 1 = 80 Hz 2π × 10−6 × 2 × 103 T (s) = 100 s 1+ 2πf01 s 1+ s 2πf02 2 = 100,1 ω1dB = 0.51ω0 ω1dB = 0.51/CR 1.67 For the input circuit, the corner frequency f01 is found from f01 = C 1 2πC1 (Rs + Ri ) 1.68 Since when C is connected to node A the 3-dB frequency is reduced by a large factor, the value of C must be much larger than whatever parasitic capacitance originally existed at node A (i.e., between A and ground). Furthermore, it must be that C is now the dominant determinant of the amplifier 3-dB frequency (i.e., it is dominating over whatever may be happening at node B or anywhere else in the amplifier). Thus, we can write 200 kHz = 1 2πC(Ro1 Ri2 ) Chapter 1–24 ⇒ (Ro1 Ri2 ) = 1 2π × 200 × 103 × 1 × 10−9 = 0.8 k A #1 #2 B #3 Av, dB 1 nF C The Bode plot for the overall transfer function can be obtained by summing the dB values of the two individual plots and then shifting the resulting plot vertically by 60 dB (corresponding to the factor 1000 in the numerator). The result is as follows: 60 50 40 Ro1 20 dB/decade 20 dB/decade 30 20 vo1 C 10 Ri2 0 1 Now Ri2 = 100 k. f = 10 Av ~ – 40 10 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 f (Hz) 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 (Hz) 60 60 60 57 60 40 20 0 (dB) 57 0.8 k Thus Ro1 Similarly, for node B, 20 kHz = 1 2πC(Ro2 Ri3 ) ⇒ Ro2 Ri3 = 1 2π × 20 × 103 × 1 × 10−9 = 7.96 k The designer should connect a capacitor of value Cp to node B where Cp can be found from ⇒ Cp = 1.70 Ti (s) = Vi (s) 1/sC 1 1 = = Vs (s) 1/sC 1 + R1 sC1 R1 + 1 LP with a 3-dB frequency Ro2 = 8.65 k 10 kHz = Bandwidth = 105 − 102 = 99,900 Hz f0i = 1 1 = = 159 kHz 2πC1 R1 2π10−11 105 For To (s), the following equivalent circuit can be used: 1 2πCp (Ro2 Ri3 ) C2 R2 1 2π × 10 × 103 × 7.96 × 103 GmR2Vi = 2 nF Vo R3 Note that if she chooses to use node A, she would need to connect a capacitor 10 times larger! Vo R3 = −Gm R2 Vi R2 + R3 + 1/sC 2 1.69 The LP factor 1/(1 + jf /105 ) results in a Bode plot like that in Fig. 1.23(a) with the 3-dB frequency f0 = 105 Hz. The high-pass factor 1/(1 + 102 /jf ) results in a Bode plot like that in Fig. 1.24(a) with the 3-dB frequency To (s) = f0 = 102 Hz. which is an HP, with = −Gm (R2 R3 ) s s+ 1 C2 (R2 + R3 ) Chapter 1–25 3-dB frequency = = 1 2πC 2 (R2 + R3 ) Ri ≥ Rs f0 = 1 1+ × − 909.1 × s 2π × 159 × 103 s s + (2π × 14.5) 20 dB/decade 159 kHz Bandwidth = 159 kHz – 14.5 Hz (1) 1 1 + RL R0 1 1 ≥ 2πCL f3dB − Ro RL Ro ≤ (a) To satisfy constraint (1), namely, x Vs Vi ≥ 1 − 100 1 2πf3dB CL − (4) 1 RL (c) To satisfy constraint (c), we first determine the dc gain as we substitute in Eq. (1) to obtain x Ri ≥1− Rs + Ri 100 (2) dc gain = Ri Gm (Ro RL ) Rs + Ri For the dc gain to be greater than a specified value A0 , Thus 1 R s + Ri ≤ x Ri 1− 100 Ri Gm (Ro RL ) ≥ A0 Rs + Ri The first factor on the left-hand side is (from constraint (2)) greater or equal to (1 − x/100). Thus x 1 Rs 100 ≤ x −1= x Ri 1− 1− 100 100 A0 x (Ro RL ) 1− 100 Gm ≥ which can be expressed as (5) Substituting Rs = 10 k and x = 10% in (3) results in 100 Ri ≥ 10 − 1 = 90 k 100 x 1− Ri 100 ≥ x Rs 100 resulting in Substituting f3dB = 2 MHz, CL = 20 pF, and RL = 10 k in Eq. (4) results in Rs V s 1 1 + ≥ 2πCL f3dB RL Ro 159 kHz Ri 1.71 Vi = Vs Rs + Ri 1 2πCL To obtain a value for f0 greater than a specified value f3dB we select Ro so that 1 1 1 + ≥ f3dB 2πCL RL Ro 59.2 dB 14.5 Hz 1 1 1 ω0 = 2π 2π CL (RL Ro ) Thus, f0 = 20 dB/decade (3) (b) The 3-dB frequency is determined by the parallel RC circuit at the output 1 = 14.5 Hz 2π100 × 10−9 × 110 × 103 ∴ T (s) = Ti (s)To (s) = 100 −1 x Vi Ri Ro Gm Vi RL Vo CL Ro ≤ 1 2π × 2 × 10 × 20 × 10−12 − 6 = 6.61 k 1 104 Chapter 1–26 Substituting A0 = 100, x = 10%, RL = 10 k, and Ro = 6.61 k, Eq. (5) results in 100 = 27.9 mA/V 10 (10 6.61) × 103 1− 100 which, using Eq. (1), can be expressed in the alternate form 1 R2 R1 + R2 Gm ≥ Vo = Vi 1.72 Using the voltage divider rule, we obtain Thus when the attenuator is compensated (C1 R1 = C2 R2 ), its transmission can be determined either by its two resistors R1 , R2 or by its two capacitors. C1 , C2 , and the transmission is not a function of frequency. Z2 Vo = Vi Z1 + Z2 where 1 1 and Z2 = R2 Z1 = R1 sC1 sC2 It is obviously more convenient to work in terms of admittances. Therefore we express Vo /Vi in the alternate form Vo Y1 = Vi Y1 + Y2 1 + sC1 Vo R1 = 1 1 Vi + + s(C1 + C2 ) R1 R2 1.73 The HP STC circuit whose response determines the frequency response of the amplifier in the low-frequency range has a phase angle of 5.7◦ at f = 100 Hz. Using the equation for ∠T (jω) from Table 1.2, we obtain tan−1 f0 = 5.7◦ ⇒ f0 = 10 Hz 100 −tan−1 103 = −5.7◦ ⇒ f0 f0 1 20 log 1+ This transfer function will be independent of frequency (s) if the second factor reduces to unity. 10 100 2 = −0.04 dB Similarly, at the drop in gain f = 1 kHz is caused by the LP STC network. The drop in gain is This in turn will happen if 1 1 1 1 = + C1 R1 C1 + C2 R1 R2 1+ 10 kHz At f = 100 Hz, the drop in gain is due to the HP STC network, and thus its value is 1 C1 R1 1 1 1 s+ + (C1 + C2 ) R1 R2 s+ which can be simplified as follows: C1 + C2 1 1 = R1 + C1 R1 R2 = The LP STC circuit whose response determines the amplifier response at the high-frequency end has a phase angle of −5.7◦ at f = 1 kHz. Using the relationship for ∠T (jω) given in Table 1.2, we obtain for the LP STC circuit. and substitute Y1 = (1/R1 ) + sC1 and Y2 = (1/R2 ) + sC2 to obtain C1 = C1 + C2 R1 1+ R2 1 20 log 1+ (1) R1 C2 =1+ C1 R2 1000 10, 000 2 = −0.04 dB The gain drops by 3 dB at the corner frequencies of the two STC networks, that is, at f = 10 Hz and f = 10 kHz. or 1.74 Use the expression in Eq. (1.2), with C1 R1 = C2 R2 B = 7.3 × 1015 cm−3 K −3/2 ; When this condition applies, the attenuator is said to be compensated, and its transfer function is given by k = 8.62 × 10−5 eV/K; and Eg = 1.12 V Vo C1 = Vi C1 + C2 we have T = −55◦ C = 218 K: Chapter 1–27 ni = 2.68 × 106 cm−3 ; N = 1.9 × 1016 ni That is, one out of every 1.9 × 1016 silicon atoms is ionized at this temperature. T = 0◦ C = 273 K: ni = 1.52 × 109 cm−3 ; N = 3.3 × 1013 ni ◦ T = 20 C = 293 K: −5 ×398) = 7.3 × 1015 × (398)3/2 e−1.12/(2×8.62×10 = 4.72 × 1012 /cm3 pn = n2i = 2.23 × 108 /cm3 ND At 398 K, hole concentration is pn = 2.23 × 108 /cm3 ni = 8.60 × 109 cm−3 ; N = 5.8 × 1012 ni T = 75◦ C = 348 K: N = 1.4 × 1011 ni = 3.70 × 10 cm ; ni −3 11 At 398 K, ni = BT 3/2 e−Eg /2kT T = 125◦ C = 398 K: 1.78 Hole concentration in intrinsic Si = ni ni = BT 3/2 e−Eg /2kT −5 ×300) = 7.3 × 1015 (300)3/2 e−1.12/(2×8.62×10 = 1.5 × 1010 holes/cm3 ni = 4.72 × 1012 cm−3 ; N = 1.1 × 1010 ni 1.75 Use Eq. (1.2) to find ni , ni = BT 3/2 e−Eg /2kT In phosphorus-doped Si, hole concentration drops below the intrinsic level by a factor of 108 . ∴ Hole concentration in P-doped Si is pn = 1.5 × 1010 = 1.5 × 102 cm−3 108 Substituting the values given in the problem, 3/2 −1.42/(2×8.62×10−5 ×300) ni = 3.56 × 10 (300) e = 2.2 × 10 carriers/cm 3 14 6 1.76 Since NA ni , we can write pp ≈ NA = 5 × 1018 cm−3 Now, nn ND and pn nn = n2i nn = n2i /pn = (1.5 × 1010 ) 1.5 × 102 2 = 1.5 × 1018 cm−3 ND = nn = 1.5 × 1018 atoms/cm3 Using Eq. (1.3), we have 1.79 (a) The resistivity of silicon is given by Eq. (1.41): n2 np = i = 45 cm−3 pp For intrinsic silicon, 1.77 T = 27◦ C = 273 + 27 = 300 K At 300 K, ni = 1.5 × 1010 /cm3 p = n = ni = 1.5 × 1010 cm−3 Using μn = 1350 cm2 /V · s and μp = 480 cm2 /V · s, and q = 1.6 × 10−19 C we have Phosphorus-doped Si: nn ND = 1017 /cm3 pn = n2i (1.5 × 1010 ) = = 2.25 × 103 /cm3 ND 1017 ρ = 2.28 × 105 -cm. 2 Using R = ρ · L with L = 0.001 cm and A Hole concentration = pn = 2.25 × 103 /cm3 A = 3 × 10−8 cm2 , we have T = 125◦ C = 273 + 125 = 398 K R = 7.6 × 109 . Chapter 1–28 (b) nn ≈ ND = 5 × 1016 cm−3 ; pn = n2i = 4.5 × 103 cm−3 nn 10 μm Using μn = 1200 cm2 /V · s and 3 V μp = 400 cm2 /V · s, we have ρ = 0.10 -cm; R = 3.33 k. νp-drift = μp E = 480 × 3000 −3 (c) nn ≈ ND = 5 × 10 cm ; 18 pn = = 1.44 × 106 cm/s n2i = 45 cm−3 nn νn-drift = μn E = 1350 × 3000 = 4.05 × 106 cm/s Using μn = 1200 cm2 /V · s and μp = 400 cm2 /V · s, we have −3 ρ = 1.0 × 10 4.05 × 106 νn = = 2.8125 νp 1.44 × 106 -cm; R = 33.3 . νn = 2.8125 νp As expected, since ND is increased by 100, the resistivity decreases by the same factor. (d) pp ≈ NA = 5 × 1016 cm−3 ; np = or n2i nn Or, alternatively, it can be shown as νn μn E 1350 μn = = = νp μp E μp 480 = 2.8125 = 4.5 × 103 cm−3 ρ = 0.31 -cm; R = 10.42 k (e) Since ρ is given to be 2.8 × 10−6 -cm, we directly calculate R = 9.33 × 10−2 . 1.80 Cross-sectional area of Si bar 1.82 pn0 = 2 n2i (1.5 × 1010 ) = = 2.25 × 104 /cm3 ND 1016 From Fig. P1.82, = 5 × 4 = 20 μm2 108 pn0 − pn0 dp =− dx W Since 1 μm = 10−4 cm, we get since 1 nm = 10−7 cm = 20 × 10−8 cm2 108 × 2.25 × 104 dp =− dx 50 × 10−7 Current I = Aq(pμp + nμn )E = 20 × 10 −8 × 1.6 × 10 −19 1V (10 × 500 + 10 × 1200) × 10 × 10−4 16 1.81 Electric field: E= = Hence Jp = −qDp dp dx = −1.6 × 10−19 × 12 × (−4.5 × 1017 ) = 0.864 A/cm2 3V 3V = 10 μm 10 × 10−6 m 3V 10 × 10−4 cm = 3000 V/cm 108 pn0 50 × 10−7 = −4.5 × 1017 4 = 160 μA − 1.83 Use Eq. (1.45): Dp Dn = = VT μn μp Dn = μn VT and Dp = μp VT where VT = 25.9 mV. Chapter 1–29 Doping Concentration μn μp Dn Dp (carriers/cm3 ) cm2 /V · s cm2 /V · s cm2 /s cm2 /s Intrinsic Depletion width 1350 480 35 12.4 16 1200 400 31 10.4 W = 17 750 260 19.4 6.7 18 380 160 9.8 4.1 10 10 10 2 s q W = 1 1 + V0 ← Eq. (1.50) NA ND 2 × 1.04 × 10−12 1 1 + × 0.754 1.6 × 10−19 1017 1016 1.84 Using Eq. (1.46) and NA = ND = 0.328 × 10−4 cm = 0.328 μm = 5 × 1016 cm−3 and ni = 1.5 × 1010 cm−3 , Use Eqs. (1.51) and (1.52) to find xn and xp : we have V0 = 778 mV. Using Eq. (1.50) and −14 F/cm, we have s = 11.7 × 8.854 × 10 −5 W = 2 × 10 cm = 0.2 μm. The extension of the depletion width into the n and p regions is given in Eqs. (1.51) and (1.52), respectively: xn = W NA xn = W · = 0.1 μm NA + ND xp = W xp = W · NA 1017 = 0.328 × 17 NA + ND 10 + 1016 = 0.298 μm ND 1016 = 0.328 × 17 NA + ND 10 + 1016 = 0.03 μm ND = 0.1 μm NA + ND Since both regions are doped equally, the depletion region is symmetric. Use Eq. (1.53) to calculate charge stored on either side: Using Eq. (1.53) and A = 20 μm2 = 20 × 10−8 cm2 , the charge magnitude on each side of the junction is QJ = Aq QJ = 1.6 × 10−14 C. = 100 μm2 = 100 × 10−8 cm2 VT at 300 K = 25.9 mV Hence, QJ = 4.8 × 10−14 C 1.86 Equation (1.50): = 0.754 V 2 s q W = W W , where junction area × 0.328 × 10−4 Using Eq. (1.46), built-in voltage V0 is obtained: NA ND = 25.9 × 10−3 × V0 = VT ln n2i 1017 × 1016 ln 2 1.5 × 1010 Holes QJ = 100 × 10−8 × 1.6 × 10−19 1.85 From Table 1.3, NA ND NA + ND xp xn Electrons Since NA 1 1 + NA ND W V0 = ND , we have 2 s 1 V0 q ND qND 2 ·W 2 s V0 , 1017 · 1016 1017 + 1016 Chapter 1–30 Here W = 0.2 μm = 0.2 × 10−4 cm 1.90 Equation (1.63): So V0 = 2 1.6 × 10−19 × 1016 × 0.2 × 10−4 2 × 1.04 × 10 −12 = 0.31 V NA ND QJ = Aq W ∼ = AqND W NA + ND ND , we have QJ = 3.2 fC. since NA 1.87 V0 = VT ln NA ND n2i I= Aqn2i Dp Dn + Lp ND Ln NA Here Ip = Aqn2i In = Aqn2i eV /VT − 1 Dp V /VT e −1 Lp ND Dn V /VT −1 e Ln NA Dp Ln NA Ip = · · In Dn Lp ND If NA or ND is increased by a factor of 10, then new value of V0 will be 10 N A ND V0 = VT ln n2i The change in the value of V0 is VT ln10 = 59.6 mV. = 10 10 1018 × × 16 20 5 10 Ip = 100 In Now I = Ip + In = 100 I n + In ≡ 1 mA In = 1.88 Using Eq. (1.46) with NA = 1017 cm−3 , ND = 1016 cm−3 , and ni = 1.5 × 1010 , we have V0 = 754 mV Using Eq. (1.55) with VR = 5 V, we have W = 0.907 μm. Using Eq. (1.56) with A = 1 × 10−6 cm2 , we have QJ = 13.2 × 10−14 C. 1 mA = 0.0099 mA 101 Ip = 1 − In = 0.9901 mA 1.91 Equation (1.65): IS = Aqn2i Dp Dn + Lp ND Ln NA A = 100 μm2 = 100 × 10−8 cm2 2 IS = 100 × 10−8 × 1.6 × 10−19 × 1.5 × 1010 1.89 Equation (1.55): 2 s 1 1 W = + (V0 + VR ) q NA ND = 2 s q 1 1 + NA ND V0 1 + VR V0 VR 1+ V0 5 × 10−4 × 1016 + 18 10 × 10−4 × 1017 = 7.85 × 10−17 A I∼ = IS eV /VT ∼ = 0.3 mA Equation (1.56): NA N D Qj = A 2 s q NA + ND 10 = 7.85 × 10−17 × e750/25.9 = W0 = A 2 sq NA N D NA + ND = QJ 0 1 + · (V0 + VR ) VR V0 · 1 + V0 1.92 ni = BT 3/2 e−Eg /2kT At 300 K, 3/2 ni = 7.3 × 1015 × (300) ×e−1.12/(2×8.62×10 = 1.4939 × 1010 /cm2 VR V0 n2i (at 300 K) = 2.232 × 1020 ) −5 ×300 Chapter 1–31 Cj0 = 100 × 10−8 At 305 K, = 2.152 × 1010 1.04 × 10−12 × 1.6 × 10−19 1017 × 1016 1 2 1017 + 1016 0.754 n2i (at 305 K) = 4.631 × 1020 = 31.6 fF ni = 7.3 × 1015 × (305) so 3/2 × e−1.12/(2×8.62×10 ) −5 ×305 n2i (at 305 K) = 2.152 n2i (at 300 K) Thus IS approximately doubles for every 5◦ C rise in temperature. 1.93 Equation (1.63): V /V Dp Dn I = Aqn2i + e T −1 Lp ND Ln NA So Ip = Aqn2i In = Aqn2i I Ip = Cj0 VR m 1+ V0 Aqn2i 1+ Aqn2i 1 0.75 1/3 = 0.3 pF ND , thus Ip In and Dp V /VT e −1 Lp ND 0.4 pF For VR = 10 V, Cj = 1+ 10 0.75 1/3 = 0.16 pF For this case using Eq. (1.65): IS 0.4 pF For VR = 1 V, Cj = Dn V /VT e −1 Ln NA For p −n junction NA = 14.16 fF 1.95 Equation (1.73), Cj = Dp V /VT −1 e Lp ND + Cj0 31.6 fF = Cj = VR 3 1+ 1+ V0 0.754 Dp = 104 × 10−8 × 1.6 × 10−19 Lp ND 2 × 1.5 × 1010 10 10 × 10−4 × 1017 1.96 Equation (1.67): α = A 2 sq = 3.6 × 10−16 A I = IS eV /VT − 1 = 1.0 × 10−3 NA ND NA + ND Equation (1.69): −3 3.6 × 10−16 eV /(25.9×10 ) − 1 = 1.0 × 10−3 α Cj = √ 2 V0 + VR ⇒ V = 0.742 V Substitute for α from Eq. (1.67): NA ND √ A 2 sq N + ND s ×√ Cj = √ A 2 V0 + VR s 1.94 Equation (1.72): q N N 1 s A D Cj0 = A 2 NA + ND V0 NA ND V0 = VT ln n2i 2 s q 10 × 10 = 25.9 × 10−3 × ln 2 1.5 × 1010 = 0.754 V =A s× 17 16 = sA 2 s q = sA W 1 NA + ND NA ND 1 1 1 + NA ND (V0 + VR ) (V0 + VR ) Chapter 1–32 (b) The current I = Ip + In . 1.97 Equation (1.75): 2 L2p 10 × 10−4 = τp = Dp 10 −4 (Note: 1 μm = 10 Find current component Ip : pn (xn ) = pn0 eV /V T and pn0 = cm.) τp = 100 ns Ip = AJp = AqDp QP = τ p Ip (Eq. 1.76) n2i ND dp dx dp pn (xn ) − pn0 pn0 eV /V T − pn0 = = dx Wn − xn Wn − xn V /V e T −1 = pn0 Wn − xn 2 eV /V T − 1 ni = ND (Wn − xn ) = 100 × 10−9 × 0.1 × 10−3 = 10 × 10−12 C τp I Cd = VT 100 × 10−9 = × 0.1 × 10−3 25.9 × 10−3 ∴ Ip = AqDp = 386 pF = Aqn2i 1.98 Equation (1.81): τT I Cd = VT τT × 1 × 10−3 5 pF = 25.9 × 10−3 dp dx Dp × eV /V T − 1 (Wn − xn )ND Similarly, Dn × eV /V T − 1 Wp − xp NA In = Aqn2i I = Ip + In τ T = 5 × 10−12 × 25.9 Dp Dn = + (Wn − xn ) ND Wp − xp NA × eV /V T − 1 Aqn2i = 129.5 ps For I = 0.1 mA: τT ×I Cd = VT 129.5 × 10−12 = × 0.1 × 10−3 = 0.5 pF 25.9 × 10−3 The excess change, Qp , can be obtained by multiplying the area of the shaded triangle of the pn (x) distibution graph by Aq. 1.99 (a) pn, np n region p region pn(xn) pn(x) np (xp) np (x) pn0 np0 Wp xp 0 xn Depletion region Widths of p and n regions Wn Chapter 1–33 Qp = Aq × 1 [pn (xn ) − pn0 ] (Wn − xn ) 2 Thus, τT = 1 Wn2 , and 2 Dp = 1 Aq pn0 eV /V T − pn0 (Wn − xn ) 2 = 1 Aqpn0 eV /V T − 1 (Wn − xn ) 2 dQ dI = τT dV dV V /V But I = IS e T − 1 = ni 2 1 Aq (Wn − xn ) eV /V T − 1 2 ND IS eV /V T dI = dV VT = 1 (Wn − xn )2 · Ip 2 Dp I so Cd ∼ . = τT · VT 1 Wn2 · Ip for Wn 2 DP (c) For Q Q 1 Wn2 I 2 Dp Qp , I xn Ip , Cd = (d) Cd = I VT 1 Wn2 1 × 10−3 = 8 × 10−12 F 2 10 25.9 × 10−3 Solve for Wn : Wn = 0.64 μm Exercise 2–1 Ex: 2.1 The minimum number of terminals required by a single op amp is 5: two input terminals, one output terminal, one terminal for positive power supply, and one terminal for negative power supply. The minimum number of terminals required by a quad op amp is 14: each op amp requires two input terminals and one output terminal (accounting for 12 terminals for the four op amps). In addition, the four op amps can all share one terminal for positive power supply and one terminal for negative power supply. Therefore: v 3 = μGm R(v 2 − v 1 ) That is, the open-loop gain of the op amp is A = μGm R. For Gm = 10 mA/V and μ = 100, we have: A = 100 × 10 × 10 = 104 V/V, or equivalently, 80 dB. Ex: 2.4 The gain and input resistance of the inverting amplifier circuit shown in Fig. 2.5 are R2 − and R1 , respectively. Therefore, we have: R1 Ex: 2.2 Relevant equations are: v 3 = A(v 2 − v 1 ); v Id = v 2 − v 1 , 1 v Icm = (v 1 + v 2 ) 2 R1 = 100 k and (a) Thus: 2 v3 = 0 − 3 = −0.002 V = −2 mV A 10 = v 2 − v 1 = 0 − (−0.002) = +0.002 V v1 = v2 − v Id = 2 mV 1 v Icm = (−2 mV + 0) = −1 mV 2 − R2 = −10 ⇒ R2 = 10 R1 R1 R2 = 10 × 100 k = 1 M Ex: 2.5 R 10 k (b) −10 = 103 (5 − v 1 ) ⇒ v 1 = 5.01 V vi v Id = v 2 − v 1 = 5 − 5.01 = −0.01 V = −10 mV 1 1 (v 1 + v 2 ) = (5.01 + 5) = 5.005 V 2 2 v Icm = ii vo 5V (c) v 3 = A(v 2 − v 1 ) = 103 (0.998 − 1.002) = −4 V v Id = v 2 − v 1 = 0.998 − 1.002 = −4 mV v Icm = 1 1 (v 1 + v 2 ) = (1.002 + 0.998) = 1 V 2 2 (d) −3.6 = 10 [v 2 − (−3.6)] = 10 (v 2 + 3.6) 3 3 ⇒ v 2 = −3.6036 V v Id = v 2 − v 1 = −3.6036 − (−3.6) = −0.0036 V = −3.6 mV 1 1 (v 1 + v 2 ) = [−3.6 + (−3.6036)] 2 2 −3.6 V From Table 1.1 we have: v o ; that is, output is open circuit Rm = i i io = 0 The negative input terminal of the op amp (i.e., v i ) is a virtual ground, thus v i = 0: v o = v i − Rii = 0 − Rii = −Rii v o Rii Rm = =− = −R ⇒ Rm = −R ii io = 0 ii = −10 k vi Ri = and v i is a virtual ground (v i = 0), ii 0 = 0 ⇒ Ri = 0 ii v Icm = thus Ri = Ex: 2.3 From Fig. E2.3 we have: v 3 = μv d and Since we are assuming that the op amp in this transresistance amplifier is ideal, the op amp has zero output resistance and therefore the output resistance of this transresistance amplifier is also zero. That is Ro = 0 . v d = (Gm v 2 − Gm v 1 )R = Gm R(v 2 − v 1 ) Exercise 2–2 R 10 k R1 10 k 0.5 mA Rf v1 vo R2 vi Ex: 2.7 v2 vO Connecting the signal source shown in Fig. E2.5 to the input of this amplifier, we have: v i is a virtual ground that is v i = 0, thus the current flowing through the 10-k resistor connected between v i and ground is zero. Therefore, v o = v i − R × 0.5 mA = 0 − 10 k × 0.5 mA = −5 V. Ex: 2.6 R1 1 k v1 1V we want to have: Rf =1 and R1 Rf =5 R2 Therefore 10 V 10 V ⇒ Rf ≥ 10 k ≤ 1 mA ⇒ Rf ≥ Rf 1 mA iO iL Since it is required that v O = −(v 1 + 5v 2 ), It is also desired that for a maximum output voltage of 10 V, the current in the feedback resistor not exceed 1 mA. i2 R2 10 k i1 For the circuit shown above we have: Rf Rf v1 + v2 vO = − R1 R2 vO RL 1 k Let us choose Rf to be 10 k, then Rf R1 = Rf = 10 k and R2 = = 2 k 5 Ex: 2.8 v 1 is a virtual ground, thus v 1 = 0 V ii = 1 V − v1 1−0 = = 1 mA R1 1 k Assuming an ideal op amp, the current flowing into the negative input terminal of the op amp is zero. Therefore, i2 = i1 ⇒ i2 = 1 mA v O = v 1 − i2 R2 = 0 − 1 mA × 10 k = −10 V iL = vo −10 V = = −10 mA RL 1 k vO = iO = iL − i2 = −10 mA − 1 mA = −11 mA Voltage gain = 20 dB Current gain = 20 dB −10 V vO = = −10 V/V or 1V 1V −10 mA iL = −10 A/A or = i1 1 mA Power gain −10(−10 mA) PL = 100 W/W or 20 dB = Pi 1 V × 1 mA PL Note that power gain in dB is 10 log10 . Pi = Ra Ra Rc Rc v1 + v2 R1 Rb R2 Rb Rc − v3 R3 We want to design the circuit such that v O = 2v 1 + v 2 − 4v 3 Thus we need to have Ra R1 Rc Rb = 2, Ra R2 Rc Rb = 1, and Rc =4 R3 From the above three equations, we have to find six unknown resistors; therefore, we can arbitrarily choose three of these resistors. Let us choose Ra = Rb = Rc = 10 k. Exercise 2–3 Using the superposition principle to find the contribution of v 1 to v O , we set v 2 = v 3 = 0. Then we have (refer to the solution of Exercise 2.9): v O = 6v 1 Then we have 10 Rc = = 2.5 k R3 = 4 4 Rc 10 10 Ra × = 2, ⇒ =2 R1 Rb R1 10 To find the contribution of v 2 to v O , we set v 1 = v 3 = 0, then: v O = 4v 2 ⇒ R1 = 5 k Rc 10 10 Ra =1 × =1⇒ R2 Rb R2 10 To find the contribution of v 3 to v O we set v 1 = v 2 = 0, then 9 k v 3 = −9v 3 1 k Combining the contributions of v 1 , v 2 , and v 3 to v O we have: v O = 6v 1 + 4v 2 − 9v 3 . vo = − ⇒ R2 = 10 k Ex: 2.9 Using the superposition principle to find the contribution of v 1 to the output voltage v O , we set v 2 = 0 Ex: 2.11 9 k R2 i 1 k R1 vO vO v1 2 k vi v2 3 k v + (the voltage at the positive input of the op amp 3 v 1 = 0.6v 1 is: v + = 2+3 9 k Thus v O = 1 + v + = 10 × 0.6v 1 = 6v 1 1 k To find the contribution of v 2 to the output voltage v O we set v 1 = 0. Then v + = vO R2 R2 =1+ =2⇒ = 1 ⇒ R1 = R2 vi R1 R1 If v O = 10 V, then it is desired that i = 10 μA. Thus, i= 10 V 10 V = 10 μA ⇒ R1 + R2 = R1 + R2 10 μA R1 + R2 = 1 M and R1 = R2 ⇒ R1 = R2 = 0.5 M 2 v 2 = 0.4v 2 2+3 Ex: 2.12 Hence 9 k vO = 1 + v + = 10 × 0.4v 2 = 4v 2 1 k (a) R2 Combining the contributions of v 1 and v 2 R1 v vI to v O , we have v O = 6v 1 + 4v 2 vO Ex: 2.10 9 k v I − v − = v O /A ⇒ v − = v I − v O /A 1 k 2 k v1 v3 But from the voltage divider across v O , vO v− = vO R1 R1 + R2 Equating Eq. (1) and Eq. (2) gives v2 3 k (1) vO R1 vO = vI − R1 + R2 A (2) Exercise 2–4 which can be manipulated to the form 1 + (R2 /R1 ) 1 + (R2 /R1 ) 1+ A (b) For R1 = 1 k and R2 = 9 k the ideal value 9 for the closed-loop gain is 1 + , that is, 10. The 1 10 actual closed-loop gain is G = . 1 + 10/A vO = vI If A = 103 , then G = 9.901 and G − 10 × 100 = −0.99% −1% 10 For v I = 1 V, v O = G × v I = 9.901 V and 10 mA iL = =∞ iI 0 v O × iL 10 × 10 PL =∞ = = PI v I × iI 1×0 Ex: 2.14 (a) Load voltage = 1 k × 1 V 1 mV 1 k + 1 M (b) Load voltage = 1 V = v O = A(v + − v − ) ⇒ v + − v − = vO 10 V = = 10 V/V or 20 dB vi 1V Ex: 2.15 9.901 vO = A 1000 9.9 mV If A = 104 , then G = 9.99 and = −0.1%. For v I = 1 V, v O = G × v I = 9.99 V, therefore, v+ − v− = 9.99 vO = = 0.999 mV 1 mV A 104 (a) R1 = R3 = 2 k, R2 = R4 = 200 k If A = 105 , then G = 9.999 and = −0.01% Since R4 /R3 = R2 /R1 we have: For v I = 1 V, v O = G × v I = 9.999 thus, Ad = 9.999 vO = = 0.09999 mV v+ − v− = A 105 0.1 mV (b) Rid = 2R1 = 2 × 2 k = 4 k Since we are assuming the op amp is ideal, Ro = 0 Ex: 2.13 (c) iI = 0 A, v 1 = v I = 1 V Acm ≡ 1V v1 = = 1 mA 1 k 1 k i2 = i1 = 1 mA i1 = v1 vI 1 V iO vO 1 k 9 k i2 i1 vO R2 200 = 100 V/V = = vI2 − vI1 R1 2 iI iL 1 k vO R4 = v I cm R3 + R4 1− R2 R3 R1 R4 The worst-case common-mode gain (i.e., the largest Acm ) occurs when the resistor tolerances are such that the quantity in parentheses is maximum. This in turn occurs when R2 and R3 are at their highest possible values (each one percent above nominal) and R1 and R4 are at their lowest possible values (each one percent below nominal), resulting in Acm = R4 R3 + R4 | Acm | 1− 1.01 × 1.01 0.99 × 0.99 The corresponding CMRR is 10 V vO = = 10 mA 1 k 1 k iO = iL + i2 = 11 mA R4 200 ×0.04 ×0.04 0.04 V/V R3 + R4 202 v O = v 1 + i2 × 9 k = 1 + 1 × 9 = 10 V iL = CMRR = or 68 dB. | Ad | 100 = = 2500 | Acm | 0.04 Exercise 2–5 Ex: 2.16 We choose R3 = R1 and R4 = R2 . Then for the circuit to behave as a difference amplifier with a gain of 10 and an input resistance of 20 k, we require R2 = 10 and R1 R RId = 2R1 = 20 k ⇒ R1 = 10 k and C i Ad = Ex: 2.18 vi(t) i R2 = Ad R1 = 10 × 10 k = 100 k vO (t) 1 CR t 冮0vI (t) Therefore, R1 = R3 = 10 k and R2 = R4 = 100 k. The signal waveforms will be as shown. vI (t) Ex: 2.17 Given v Icm = +5 V 10 V v Id = 10 sin ωt mV 2R1 = 1 k, R2 = 0.5 M 2 ms t 0 R3 = R4 = 10 k 1 1 v I 1 = v Icm − v Id = 5 − × 0.01 sin ωt 2 2 = 5 − 0.005 sin ωt V 10 V 1 v I 2 = v Icm + v Id 2 = 5 + 0.005 sin ωt V 10 V vO (t) t v − (op amp A1 ) = v I 1 = 5 − 0.005 sin ωt V v − (op amp A2 ) = v I 2 = 5 + 0.005 sin ωt V v Id = v I 2 − v I 1 = 0.01 sin ωt v Id v O1 = v I 1 − R2 × 2R1 = 5 − 0.005 sin ωt − 500 k × 0.01 sin ωt 1 k = (5 − 5.005 sin ωt) V v Id v O2 = v I 2 + R2 × 2R1 When v I = +10 V, the current through the capacitor will be in the direction indicated, i = 10 V/R, and the output voltage will decrease linearly from +10 V to −10 V. Thus in (T /2) seconds, the capacitor voltage changes by 20 V. The charge equilibrium equation can be expressed as i(T /2) = C × 20 V = (5 + 5.005 sin ωt) V v + (op amp A3 ) = v O2 × 10 V R4 10 = v O2 R3 + R4 10 + 10 1 1 v O2 = (5 + 5.005 sin ωt) 2 2 = (2.5 + 2.5025 sin ωt)V 10 T 10T 1 = 20C ⇒ CR = = × 2 × 10−3 R 2 40 4 = 0.5 ms = Ex: 2.19 v − (op amp A3 ) = v + (op amp A3 ) = 10.01 sin ωt V = 1(1 + 1000) × 0.01 sin ωt R Vi = (2.5 + 2.5025 sin ωt) V R4 R2 1+ v Id vO = R3 R1 0.5 M 10 k 1+ × 0.01 sin ωt 10 k 0.5 k C Vo The input resistance of this inverting integrator is R; therefore, R = 10 k. Exercise 2–6 10−3 s = 0.1 μF 10 k From Eq. (2.27) the transfer function of this integrator is: C= 1 Vo ( jω) =− Vi ( jω) jωCR For ω = 10 rad/s, the integrator transfer function has magnitude Vo 1 = V 1 × 10−3 = 100 V/V i ◦ and phase φ = 90 . For ω = 1 rad/s, the integrator transfer function has magnitude Vo 1 = V 1 × 10−3 = 1000 V/V i and phase φ = 90◦ . The frequency at which the integrator gain magnitude is unity is 1 1 ωint = = −3 = 1000 rad/s CR 10 and phase φ = −90◦ . If we add a resistor in series with the capacitor to limit the high-frequency gain of the differentiator to 100, the circuit would be: R C R1 Vi is 10−3 s, we have: CR = 10−3 s ⇒ For ω = 103 rad/s, the differentiator transfer function has magnitude Vo = 103 × 10−2 = 10 V/V V i Since the desired integration time constant Vo At high frequencies the capacitor C acts like a short circuit. Therefore, the high-frequency gain R of this circuit is: . To limit the magnitude of R1 this high-frequency gain to 100, we should have: 1 M R R = = 10 k = 100 ⇒ R1 = R1 100 100 Ex: 2.20 Ex: 2.21 Refer to the model in Fig. 2.28 and observe that R v + − v − = VOS + v 2 − v 1 = VOS + v Id Vi C Vo and since v O = v 3 = A(v + − v − ), then v O = A(v Id + VOS ) C = 0.01 μF is the input capacitance of this differentiator. We want CR = 10−2 s (the time constant of the differentiator); thus, R= 10−2 = 1 M 0.01 μF From Eq. (2.33), the transfer function of the differentiator is Vo (jω) = −jωCR Vi (jω) Thus, for ω = 10 rad/s the differentiator transfer function has magnitude Vo = 10 × 10−2 = 0.1 V/V V i and phase φ = −90◦ . (1) where A = 104 V/V and VOS = 5 mV. From Eq. (1) we see that v id = 0 results in v O = 50 V, which is impossible; thus the op amp saturates and v O = +10 V. This situation pertains for v Id ≥ −4 mV. If v Id decreases below −4 mV, the op-amp output decreases correspondingly. For instance, v Id = −4.5 mV results in v O = +5 V; v Id = −5 mV results in v O = 0 V; v Id = −5.5 mV results in v O = −5 V; and v Id = −6 mV results in v O = −10 V, at which point the op amp saturates at the negative level of −10 V. Further decreases in v Id have no effect on the output voltage. The result is the transfer characteristic sketched in Fig. E2.21. Observe that the linear range of the characteristic is now centered around v Id = −5 mV rather than the ideal situation of v Id = 0; this shift is obviously a result of the input offset voltage VOS . Exercise 2–7 VO = IOS R2 = 10 nA × 10 k = 0.01 V Ex: 2.25 Using Eq. (2.41) we have: 2 mV VOS t ⇒ 12 = 2 mV + t CR 1 ms 12 V − 2 mV × 1 ms 6 s ⇒t= 2 mV v O = VOS + RF C R Vi (b) If at room temperature (25◦ C), VOS is trimmed to zero and (i) the circuit is operated at a constant temperature, the peak of the input sine wave can be increased to 10 mV. (ii) However, if the circuit is to operate in the temperature range of 0◦ C to 75◦ C (i.e., at a temperature that deviates from room temperature by a maximum of 50◦ C), the input offset voltage will drift from by a maximum of 10 μV/◦ C × 50◦ C = 500 μV or 0.5 mV. This will reduce the allowed peak amplitude of the input sinusoid to 9.5 mV. With this value of R3 , the new value of the output dc voltage [using Eq. (2.40)] is: Ex: 2.23 VOS (a) If the amplifier is capacitively coupled in the manner of Fig. 2.31(a), then the input offset voltage VOS will see a unity-gain amplifier [Fig. 2.31(b)] and the cc offset voltage at the output will be equal to VOS , that is, 3 mV. Thus, almost the entire output range of ±10 V will be available for signal swing, allowing a sine-wave input of approximately 10-mV peak without the risk of output clipping. Obviously, in this case there is no need for output trimming. (b) We need to select a value of the coupling capacitor C that will place the 3-dB frequency of the resulting high-pass STC circuit at 100 Hz, thus 100 = 1 2πCR1 ⇒C= 1 = 1.6 μF 2π × 100 × 1 × 103 Ex: 2.24 From Eq. (2.37) we have: VO = IB1 R2 IB R2 = 100 nA × 1 M = 0.1 V From Eq. (2.39) the value of resistor R3 (placed in series with positive input to minimize the output offset voltage) is R3 = R1 Ex: 2.22 (a) The inverting amplifier of −1000 V/V gain will exhibit an output dc offset voltage of ±VOS (1 + R2 /R1 ) = ±3 mV × (1 + 1000) = ±3.03 V. Now, since the op-amp saturation levels are ±10 V, the room left for output signal swing is approximately ±7 V. Thus to avoid op-amp saturation and the attendant clipping of the peak of the output sinusoid, we must limit the peak amplitude of the input sine wave to approximately 7 V/1000 = 7 mV. R2 = R1 R2 10 k × 1 M = R1 + R2 10 k + 1 M = 9.9 k R3 = 9.9 k 10 k Vo With the feedback resistor RF , to have at least ±10 V of output signal swing available, we have to make sure that the output voltage due to VOS has a magnitude of at most 2 V. From Eq. (2.36), we know that the output dc voltage due to VOS is RF RF ⇒ 2 V = 2 mV 1 + VO = VOS 1 + R 10 k RF = 1000 ⇒ RF 10 M 10 k The corner frequency of the resulting STC 1 network is ω0 = CRF 1+ We know RC = 1 ms and R = 10 k ⇒ C = 0.1 μF Thus ω0 = f0 = 1 = 1 rad/s 0.1 μF × 10 M 1 ω0 = = 0.16 Hz 2π 2π Ex: 2.26 20 log A0 = 106 dB ⇒ A0 = 200,000 V/V ft = 3 MHz fb = ft /A0 = 3 MHz = 15 Hz 200,000 Exercise 2–8 At fb , the open-loop gain drops by 3 dB below its value at dc; thus it becomes 103 dB. For f fb , | A| ft /f ; thus At f = 300 Hz, | A| = 3 MHz = 104 V/V 300 Hz or 80 dB At f = 3 kHz, | A| = 3 MHz = 103 V/V 3 kHz or 60 dB At f = 12 kHz, which is two octaves higher than 3 kHz, the gain will be 2 × 6 = 12 dB below its value at 3 kHz; that is, 60 − 12 = 48 dB. At f = 60 kHz, | A| = 3 MHz = 50 V/V 60 kHz or 34 dB Since the nominal dc gain is much lower than A0 , f3dB ft = 1+ R2 R1 2 MHz = 20 kHz 100 Ex: 2.29 For the input voltage step of magnitude V the output waveform will still be given by the exponential waveform of Eq. (2.58) if ωt V ≤ SR SR SR ⇒V ≤ resulting in that is, V ≤ ωt 2πft V ≤ 0.16 V Ex: 2.27 From Appendix F we know that the 10% to 90% rise time of the output waveform of the form of 2.2 . Eq. (2.58) is tr 2.2 × time constant = ωt A0 = 106 V/V or 120 dB Thus, tr 0.35 μs The gain falls off at the rate of 20 dB/decade. Thus, it reaches 40 dB at a frequency four decades higher than fb , If an input step of amplitude 1.6 V (10 times as large compared to the previous case) is applied, the output will be slew-rate limited and thus linearly rising with a slope equal to the slew rate, as shown in the following figure. 104 fb = 10 kHz ⇒ fb = 1 Hz The unity-gain frequency ft will be two decades higher than 10 kHz, that is, vo ft = 100 × 10 kHz = 1 MHz Alternatively, we could have found ft from Slope SR 1.6 V ft = A0 fb = 106 × 1 Hz = 1 MHz At a frequency f 0 fb , tr | A| = ft /f tr = For f = 1 kHz, | A| = 1 MHz = 103 V/V or 60 dB 1 kHz Ex: 2.28 20 log A0 = 106 dB ⇒ A0 = 200,000 V/V ft = 2 MHz For a noninverting amplifier with a nominal dc gain of 100, R2 1+ = 100 R1 0.9 × 1.6 − 0.1 × 1.6 1 V/μs ⇒ tr = 1.28 μs Ex: 2.30 From Eq. (2.59) we have: fM = SR = 15.915 kHz 15.9 kHz 2πVO max Using Eq. (2.60), for an input sinusoid with frequency f = 5 fM , the maximum possible amplitude that can be accommodated at the output without incurring SR distortion is: fM 1 VO = VO max = 10 × = 2 V (peak) 5fM 5 t Chapter 2–1 2.1 The minimum number of pins required by dual op amp is 8. Each op amp has 2 input terminals (4 pins) and one output terminal (2 pins). Another 2 pins are required for power supplies. Similarly, the minimum number of pins required by quad op amp is 14: 4 × 2 + 4 × 1 + 2 = 14 Gain A = = 1 × 106 × 40 × 10−3 = 40,000 V/V v1 Gmv1 i 2.2 Refer to Fig. P2.2. v+ = vI × vO = Rm Gm v2 − v1 Rmi vO 1 k 1 = vI 1 k + 1 M 1001 v2 1 v O = Av + = Av I 1001 vO A = 1001 vI Gmv2 4 1 A = 4004 V/V = 1001 × 2.5 Refer to Fig. E2.3. v d = R(Gm2 v 2 − Gm1 v 1 ) v O = v 3 = μv d = μR (Gm2 v 2 − Gm1 v 1 ) 2.3 vO = vd = v2 − v1 vO v O /v d 1 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 – 2 1.00 1.00 0.00 0.00 – 3 1.00 (b) 1.00 4 1.00 1.10 0.10 10.1 101 5 2.01 2.00 –0.01 –0.99 99 6 1.99 2.00 0.01 1.00 100 7 5.10 (d) –5.10 # v1 (a) v2 (c) we have v O = Ad v Id + Acm v Icm Experiments 4, 5, and 6 show that the gain is approximately 100 V/V. The missing entry for experiment #3 can be predicted as follows: 1.00 vO = = 0.01 V. A 100 (b) v 1 = v 2 − v d = 1.00 − 0.01 = 0.99 V (a) v d = The missing entries for experiment #7: −5.10 = −0.051 V (c) v d = 100 (d) v 2 = v 1 + v d = 5.10 − 0.051 = 5.049 V All the results seem to be reasonable. 2.4 i = Gm (v 2 − v 1 ) v O = Rm i = Rm Gm (v 2 − v 1 ) 1 1 μR(Gm v 2 + Gm v 2 − Gm v 1 + Gm v 1 ) 2 2 1 v O = μRGm (v 2 − v 1 ) + μRGm (v 1 + v 2 ) 2 v Id 2v Icm ⇒ Ad = μRGm , Acm = μRGm Ad = 20 log Gm CMRR = 20 log Acm Gm For a CMRR ≥ 60 dB, Gm Gm ≥ 1000 ⇒ ≤ 0.1% Gm Gm 1 (v 1 + v 2 ) 2 v d = 0.005 sin(2π1000)t = v 1 − v 2 2.6 v cm = 2 sin(2π60)t = v 1 = v cm − v d /2 = sin(120π)t − 0.0025 sin(2000πt) v 2 = v cm + v d /2 = sin(120πt) + 0.0025 sin(2000πt) 2.7 Circuit a b c d v o /v i (V/V) −100 = −5 20 –5 –5 –5 Rin (k) 20 20 20 20 Chapter 2–2 10 k 10 k vI 10 k vO = −0.5 V/V vI 2.8 vO Note that in circuit (b) the 20-k load resistance has no effect on the closed-loop gain because of the zero output resistance of the ideal op amp. In circuit (c), no current flows in the 20-k resistor connected between the negative input terminal and ground (because of the virtual ground at the inverting input terminal). In circuit (d), zero current flows in the 20-k resistor connected in series with the positive input terminal. Rin = 10 k (smallest gain magnitude) R2 10 k 10 k R1 10 k vO vO vI vI 10 k 10 k vO = −0.5 V/V vI Closed-loop gain is R2 10 k vO =− =− vI R1 10 k 10 k = −1 V/V For v I = +1.00 V, Rin = 20 k (smallest gain magnitude) 10 k 10 k vI v O = −1 × 1.00 vO = − 1.00 V The two resistors are 1% resistors vO = 10(1 − 0.01) = 0.98 V/V v 10(1 + 0.01) I min vO = 10(1 + 0.01) = 1.02 V/V v 10(1 − 0.01) I max vO = −2 V/V vI Thus the measured output voltage will range from −0.98 V to −1.02 V. 2.10 2.9 There are four possibilities: 10 k 10 k vI 10 k gain magnitude) (a) G = −1 V/V (b) G = −10 V/V (c) G = −0.1 V/V (d) G = −100 V/V (e) G = −10 V/V 2.11 (a) G = −1 V/V = vO Rin = 10 k (largest gain magnitude) −R2 ⇒ R1 = R2 = 10 k R1 (b) G = −2 V/V = vO = −2 V/V vI Rin = 5 k (largest −R2 ⇒ R1 = 10 k, R2 = 20 k R1 (c) G = −5 V/V = −R2 ⇒ R1 = 10 k, R2 = 50 k R1 Chapter 2–3 46 dB = 20 log |G| (d) G = −100 V/V = −R2 ⇒ R1 = 10 k, R2 = 1 M R1 |G| = 200 ∴ R2 vO = −200 V/V = − vI R1 ⇒ R2 = 200R1 ≤ 1 M 2.12 For the largest possible input resistance, choose R2 R2 = 1 M 1 M = 5 k 200 Rin = R1 = 5 k R1 = R1 vI vO 2.15 The circled numbers indicate the order of the analysis steps. The additional current supplied by the op amp comes from the power supplies (not shown). R2 vO = −10 V/V = − vI R1 3 1 mA 10 k ⇒ R2 = 10R1 1 k Total resistance used is 110 k 1 V ∴ R1 + R2 = 110 k 1 mA 2 6 6 mA 0V 1 10 V 4 5 mA 5 2 k R1 + 10R1 = 110 k R1 = 10 k and R2 = 10R1 = 100 k 2.13 2.16 The circuit will be as follows: R +10 V R 15 V 15 k Average = +5 V Highest = +10 V Lowest = 0 V Variation of the −15-V supply by ±1% results in a ±1% variation in the output voltage. Thus the total variation in the output voltage can be ±3%, resulting in VO in the range 4.85 V to 5.15 V. R2 R1 V 5 V If R1 and R2 have ±1% tolerance, then VO will exhibit ±2% variability and thus will be in the range of 5 × 1.02 = 5.1 V to 5 × 0.98 = 4.9 V. 2.14 Gain is 46 dB vI 5 k 0V vO 2.17 R1 = R1nominal (1 ± x%) R2 = R2nominal (1 ± x%) |G| = R2 R2nominal 1 ± x% = R1 R1nominal 1 ± x% Chapter 2–4 2.20 Thus, |G|max R2nominal × (1 + 2x%) R1nominal |G|min R2nominal × (1 − 2x%) R1nominal ii ii vi Thus, the tolerance of the closed-loop gain is ±2x%. For Gnominal = −100 and x = 1, the closed-loop gain will be in the range −98 V/V to −102 V/V. Rf vo A (a) For A = ∞: v i = 0 v o = −ii Rf 2.18 (a) Choose R1 = 1 k and R2 = 200 k. (b) G = − R2 /R1 1 + R2 /R1 1+ A 200 = −192.3 V/V =− 1 + 200 1+ 5000 To restore the gain to −200 V/V, we need to change the effective value of R1 to R1 , −200 = − 200/R1 1 + 200/R1 1+ 5000 Rm = vo = −Rf ii Rin = vi =0 ii (b) For A finite: v i = − vo , v o = v i − ii Rf A Rf −v o vo =− − ii Rf ⇒ Rm = 1 A ii 1+ A Rf vi = Ri = ii 1+A ⇒ vo = 2.21 Thus, 200 200 200 1 + = 200 + R1 5000 R1 0.96 × 200 = 200.04 R1 ⇒ R1 = 0.960 k This effective value can be realized by shunting R1 (1 k) with Ra , 1 1 1 = + ⇒ Ra = 24 k 0.960 1 Ra (c) From Appendix J, we find the closest available 1% resistor as either 23.7 k or 24.3 k. v O = −Av − = v − − ii R2 ii R2 = v − (1 + A) v− = ii R2 1+A Again v I = ii R1 + v − = ii R1 + ii 2.19 Output voltage ranges from –10 V to +10 V and open-loop gain is 5000 V/V ∴ Voltage at the inverting input terminal will −10 10 vary from to (i.e., –2 mV to +2 mV). 5000 5000 Thus the virtual ground will depart by a maximum of ±2 mV. So Rin = R2 1+A vI R2 = R1 + ii A+1 2.22 Closed-loop gain G= vO = vI −(R2 /R1 ) 1 + R2 /R1 1+ A Q.E.D. Chapter 2–5 Gain error = 1 + (R2 /R1 ) × 100 A 1 1 1 = + R1 R1 Rc 0.1% 1% 10% R2 R2 R2 A 1000 1 + 100 1 + 10 1 + R1 R1 R1 Substituting in Eq. (1), R1 Rc R2 R2 1+ + R1 Rc 1+ A 1+ R2 Vo =− Vi R1 Gain with resistance R1a R2 R1 vI R2 Vo = − , we have to make Vi R1 To make R1a R1 = Rc 1+ vO That is, A R2 R2 + R1 Rc A R1 R1 =1+G+G Rc Rc which yields R2 R1 R1a R1 + R1a |G| R2 1+ R1 1+ A A−G Rc = R1 1+G 2.24 (a) |G| = where we have neglected the small effect of R1a on the denominator. R2 R2 R1 + R1a R1 1+ R1 R1a R1 R1a = |G| = R2 R2 1+ 1+ R1 R1 1+ 1+ A A R2 , use To restore the gain to its nominal value of R1 R1 = R1a So R1a R1a 1+ A R2 R1 = 100 10% 1000R1 100R1 10R1 2.23 Refer to Fig. P2.23. Vo = Vi −R2 /R1 1 + R2 /R1 1+ A where R1 = R1 Rc Thus, |G| − |G| = (1) R2 /R1 1 + R2 /R1 1+ A− A Dividing Eq. (2) by Eq. (1), we have 1 + R2 /R1 1+ |G| A = 1− 1 + R2 /R1 |G| 1+ A− A 1 1 − |G| A− A A = 1 + R2 /R1 |G| 1+ A− A ⎞ ⎛ 1 1 ⎜ R2 ⎟ − 1⎠ 1+ ⎝ A R1 A 1− A = R2 /R1 1+ A− A 1+ 1% R2 /R1 1 + R2 /R1 1+ A (1) If A is reduced by A, |G| will be correspondingly reduced by |G|, Thus 100R1 = 0.1% Q.E.D For A A |G| |G| R2 R1 1 and 1 + 1+ A R2 R1 A A R2 R1 A, (2) Chapter 2–6 Thus, |G| / |G| 1 + R2 /R1 A/ |A| A (b) Q.E.D |G| A R2 ≤ 0.001 = 100, = 0.1, |G| R1 A A ≥ (1 + 100) × 0.1/0.001 2.26 From Example 2.2, vO R2 R4 R4 =− 1+ + vI R1 R2 R3 Here R1 = R2 = R4 = 1 M 1 1M v ∴ O =− 1+1+ =− 2+ vI R3 R3 That is, Amin 104 V/V. vO 1 M +2=− vI R3 2.25 (a) Equation (2.5): R3 = − G= vO = vI −R2 /R1 R2 1+ 1+ A R1 and Gnominal = − R2 R1 Gain error G − Gnominal G = − 1 = Gnominal Gnominal − 1 + R2 /R1 1 A − 1 = = (1 + R /R ) 1 + R /R 2 1 2 1 1 + 1 + A A = 1 1+ 1 =1+ R2 R1 R2 R1 Solving for A, we get R2 1 A= 1+ −1 R1 1 = (1 − Gnominal ) −1 (b) Gnominal = −100 = − R3 = − (c) 1 M = 125 k (−10 + 2) vO 1 M = −2 V/V, R3 = − =∞ vI (−2 + 2) (a) Rin = R1 = 200 vO −R2 R4 R4 (b) = + 1+ = −500 vI R1 R2 R3 A 1+ vO = −100 V/V vI 1 M R3 = − = 10.2 k (−100 + 2) vO (b) = −10 V/V vI (a) 2.27 R2 /R1 = 500, R2 = 100 k ⇒ R1 = 200 A 1+ 1 M vO +2 vI R2 R1 Rin = 1 k = R1 If R2 = R1 = R4 = 100 k ⇒ R3 = 200 Rin = R1 = 100 k 2.28 iI = So vI vI , v x = −iI R2 = − R2 R1 R1 vx R2 =− vI R1 R1 = 1 k R2 R2 = 100R1 = 100 k Again Gnominal = −100 and max = 10% 1 ∴ A = (1 − Gnominal ) −1 1 = [1 − (−100)] −1 0.1 = 101 × 9 A = 909 V/V 100 k 500 − 2 R4 vx R2 iI iI vI R1 0V vO Chapter 2–7 Now, because of the virtual ground at the negative input terminal of the op amp, v O appears across the series combination of R4 and (R2 R3 ); thus vx = vO = vO (R2 R3 ) (R2 R3 ) + R4 R2 R3 R2 R3 + R2 R4 + R3 R4 vO R2 R3 + R2 R4 + R3 R4 = vx R2 R3 R4 R4 = 1+ + R3 R2 vO vO vx = vI vx vI R2 R4 R4 =− + 1+ R1 R3 R2 See Fig. 2. We utilize the results of (a) above as follows: At node 1 we have a resistance R to ground and, looking left, a resistance R. These two resistances must carry equal currents ⇒ I1 = I . A node equation at node 1 results in the current through (R/2) as 2I . At node 2, we have a resistance R to ground and an equal resistance looking to the left. These two resistances must carry equal currents ⇒ I2 = 2I . A node equation at 2 results in the current leaving node 2 as 4I . We continue in the same fashion to find I3 = 4I and the current from 3 to 4 as 8I . (c) V1 = −I1 R = −IR V2 = −I2 R = −2IR Q.E.D. V3 = −I3 R = −4IR 2.29 (a) R1 = R V4 = V3 − R R R R2 = (R R) + = + = R 2 2 2 R R R3 = (R2 R) + = (R R) + = R 2 2 R R R4 = (R3 R) + = (R R) + = R 2 2 R × 8I = −8IR 2 2.30 (a) I1 = 1V = 0.1 mA 10 k I2 = I1 = 0.1 mA See Fig. 1. −I 2 × 10 k = −I3 × 100 ≡ Vx R R/2 2 1 R/2 3 R/2 4 ∴ I3 = I2 × 10 k 100 = 0.1 × 100 I R I1 R I2 R I3 I4 = 10 mA Now IL = I2 + I3 = 10.1 mA and Vx = −I2 × 10 k = −0.1 × 10 k = −1 V (b) Vx = RL IL + VO = 10.1 RL + VO RL = Figure 1 (b) Vx − VO −1 − (−13) = = 1.19 k 10.1 mA 10.1 (c) 100 ≤ RL ≤ 1 k I R I 1 R 2 R I1 I 0V 2I R/2 4I R/2 R I2 2I 3 8I R/2 4 IL stays fixed at 10.1 mA. VO = Vx − RL IL = −1 − RL × 10.1 I3 4I RL = 100 , VO = −2.01 V; RL = 1 k, VO = −11.1 V Figure 2 ∴ −11.1 V ≤ VO ≤ −2.01 V Chapter 2–8 2.32 2.31 1.5 V iI 10 k I1 R1 Vx IL I2 I i RL R R2 which is independent of the value of RL . Now, for our specific design: IL = 3.1 mA I = 0.1 mA 1.5V = 15 k 0.1 mA R1 3.1 = 0.1 1 + R2 R= R1 ⇒ = 30 R2 Choosing R2 = 500 ⇒ R1 = 15 k. The circuit will work properly as long as the op amp does not saturate (i.e., as long as VO ≤ −10 V). But VO = Vx − IL RL = −IR1 − IL RL = −0.1 × 15 − 3.1RL R R1 R1 IL = I + I = 1+ I R2 R2 RL iI The circuit shown in Fig. P2.30 (redrawn above) provides a constant current through RL that is independent of the value of RL . The current through RL is determined by the input current and the ratio of the two resistors R1 and R2 . Specifically, I1 = I , Vx = −I1 R1 , I2 = −Vx /R2 = I1 (R1 /R2 ) = I (R1 /R2 ), thus iL vx vO (a) v x = −iI × 10 i = −v x /R = iI (10/R) 10 iL = iI + i = iI 1 + R Thus, 10 iL =1+ iI R For iL = 11 ⇒ R = 1 k. iI (b) Rin = 0 (because of the virtual ground at the input). Ro = ∞ (because iL is independent of the value of RL ). (c) If iI is in the direction shown in the figure above, the maximum allowable value of iI will be determined by v O reaching −12 V, at which point v x = −iI max × 10 and v O = −12 = v x − iLmax × 1 = −10 iI max − 11 iI max ⇒ iI max = 12 = 0.57 mA 21 If iI is in a direction opposite to that shown in the figure, then v x = 10iI v O = v x + iL RL = 10iI + 11iI = 21iI The maximum value of iI will result in v O = +12 V. Thus 12 = 21iI max ⇒ iI max = 12 = 0.57 mA 21 The maximum allowed value for RL can now be found by substituting VO = −10 V, thus Thus, the allowable range of iI is RL = 2.74 k −0.57 mA ≤ iI ≤ +0.57 mA Chapter 2–9 (d) Since Rin = 0, the value of the source resistance will have no effect on the resulting iL , 2.34 Rf iL = 0.2 × 11 = 2.2 mA i1 R1 v1 R2 2.33 v2 xR4 vO To obtain an input resistance of 100 k, we select R1 = 100 k. From Example 2.2 we have R2 vO =− vI R1 (1 − x)R4 (1 − x)R4 + 1+ R2 R3 + xR4 ∴ R1 , R2 ≥ 20 k Rf Here = 2, if R1 = 20 k, Rf = 40 k R1 Rf 1 = ⇒ R2 = 2Rf = 80 k R2 2 The minimum gain magnitude is obtained when x = 1, 2.35 R2 vO =− = −1 vI R1 v1 Thus, R2 = 100 k. The maximum gain magnitude is obtained when x = 0, R2 vO =− vI R1 ⇒1+ R4 R4 1+ + = −100 R2 R3 100 100 = 100 + 100 R3 ⇒ R3 = 100 = 1.02 k 98 When the potentiometer is set exactly in the middle, x = 0.5 and R2 vO =− vI R1 =− 100 100 0.5R4 0.5R4 + 1+ R2 R3 + 0.5R4 0.5 × 100 0.5 × 100 1+ + 100 1.02 + 0.5 × 100 = −2.48 V/V 10 k Rf 50 k 10 k v1 10 k v2 vO Rf Rf Rf v1 + v1 + v2 R1 R2 R3 50 50 50 =− v1 + v1 + v2 10 10 10 = −(10v 1 + 5v 2 ) vO = − Now v 1 = 1 V and v 2 = −1 V v O = −(10 × 1 − 5) = −5 V 2.36 v1 Rf R1 R2 v2 For v 1 and v 2 , we assume R1 The output of the weighted summer circuit is Rf Rf vO = − v1 + v2 R1 R2 v2 v O = − 2v 1 + 2 v1 v2 i1 = and i2 = R1 R2 Since i1 , i2 ≤ 50 μA for 1-V input signals (1x) R4 vI vO i2 R3 R2 vO Chapter 2–10 (b) v O = −(v 1 + v 2 + 2v 3 + 2v 4 ) v 2 = 1.5 V 100 k v The output signal required is 100 k 100 k 100 k v 1 = 3 sin ωt v v 100 k vO v v O = −3 sin ωt − 3 100 k v t 0 3 Rf R1 Rf R2 Rf R3 Rf R4 100 k = 1 ⇒ R1 = 100 k = 1 ⇒ R2 = 100 k 100 k 2 100 k = 2 ⇒ R4 = 2 = 2 ⇒ R3 = Ri1 = 100 k, Ri2 = 100 k, Ri3 = 50 k, Ri4 = 50 k For the summer circuit, we should have (c) v O = −(v 1 + 5v 2 ) Rf Rf = 1 and =2 R1 R2 100 k Select Rf = 2R2 = 20 k. Thus R2 = 10 k, and R1 = 20 k. v 100 k v 2.37 (a) v O = −(v 1 + 2v 2 + 3v 3 ) 100 k Rf = 2 ⇒ R2 = 50 k R2 R1 = 100 k 100 k 5 Ri1 = 100 k R2 = Rf 100 k = 1 ⇒ R3 = R3 3 Ri2 = 20 k 100 k v v (d) v O = −6v 1 R 100 k R1 = 100 k 100 k v 100 k Rf = 1 ⇒ R1 = 100 k, R1 100 k 100 k 100 k 100 k 100 k 6 v 100 k 100 k 100 k v 100 k 100 k v1 100 k Ri2 = 50 k 100 k Ri3 = 33.3 k 100 k Ri1 = 100 k 100 k vO Chapter 2–11 Ri1 = 100 = 1.67 k 6 To obtain v O = v 1 + 2v 2 − 3v 3 − 5v 4 , we can arbitrarily select Rc = Rb , then Suggested configurations: Ra =1 R1 v O = −(2v 1 + 2v 2 + 2v 3 ) 100 k Ra =2 R2 If we select R2 = 10 k, then Ra = 20 k and R1 = 20 k. 100 k v1 and 100 k For the second summer, to obtain 100 k v2 100 k vO then Rc =3 R3 and 100 k v3 vO = −3 v3 vO = −5 v4 100 k requires Rc =5 R4 We can select Rc = Rb = 60 k, resulting in R3 = 20 k and R4 = 12 k. v O = −(3v 1 + 3v 2 ) 100 k 100 k 2.39 100 k 100 k v1 vO 100 k v2 100 k 100 k In order to have coefficient = 0.5, connect one of vO the input resistors to v O . = 0.5. v1 Here the first inverting amplifier simply inverts v 1 , resulting at its output in 100 k v1 100 k −v 1 = −2 sin(2π × 60t) − 0.01 sin(2π × 1000t) 100 k 100 k 100 k vO The second amplifier provides the sum of −v 1 and v 2 , that is, (v 2 − v 1 ) multiplied by a gain of 100. Thus 100 k v O = −100(v 2 − v 1 ) 100 k = 1 sin(2π × 1000t), V 2.38 Using the circuit of Fig. 2.11: The value of R can be selected (arbitrarily but conveniently) as R = 10 k. 2.40 This is a weighted summer circuit: Rf Rf Rf Rf vO = − vO + v1 + v2 + v3 R0 R1 R2 R3 We may write: v 0 = 5V × a0 , v 2 = 5V × a2 , v 1 = 5V × a1 , v 3 = 5V × a3 , Chapter 2–12 5 5 5 5 a0 + a1 + a2 + a3 80 40 20 10 2.42 R3 10 k a a1 a2 a3 0 v O = −Rf + + + 16 8 4 2 R2 10 k Rf 0 vO = − 2 a0 + 21 a1 + 22 a2 + 23 a3 16 R1 10 k v O = −Rf vI vO For −12 V ≤ v O ≤ 0, Rf 0 2 × 1 + 2 × 1 + 2 2 × 1 + 23 × 1 16 = Short-circuit R2 : vO =2 vI Short-circuit R3 : vO =1 vI 15Rf = 12 16 ⇒ Rf = 12.8 k R2 2.41 10 k R3 R2 10 k 10 k vI (a) vO R2 =1=1+ vI R1 Set R2 = 0 and eliminate R1 vO R2 (b) =2=1+ vI R1 R2 = 1; set R1 = R2 = 10 k R1 (c) vO R2 = 21 = 1 + vI R1 R2 = 20; set R1 = 10 k, R2 = 200 k R1 (d) vO 2.43 V− = V+ = V ; thus the current in the V moving-coil meter will be I = , independent of R the resistance of the meter. To obtain I = 100 μA when V = 10 V, we select 10 = 100 k R= 0.1 mA The meter resistance does not affect the voltmeter calibration. 2.44 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P2.44: (a) Using superposition, we first set v P1 = v P2 , . . . , = 0. The output voltage that results in response to v N 1 , v N 2 , . . . , v Nn is Rf Rf Rf v ON = − vN1 + vN2 + · · · + v Nn RN 1 RN 2 RNn Then we set v N 1 = v N 2 = · · · = 0, then: RN = RN 1 RN 2 RN 3 · · · RNn The circuit simplifies to that shown below. v OP = 1 + vO R2 = 100 = 1 + vI R1 R2 = 99; set R1 = 10 k, R2 = 990 k R1 vO R2 vO =1+ vI R1 R1 v I R1 +v P2 Rf RN ⎛ ⎜ ×⎜ ⎝v P1 1/RP1 1 1 1 + + ··· + RP0 RP1 RPn ⎞ ⎟ 1/RP2 1/RPn ⎟ · · · + v Pn 1 1 ⎠ 1 1 + ··· + + ··· + RP0 RPn RP0 RPn Chapter 2–13 Rf 2.45 Rf RN vI3 vOP vP1 Rp1 RN RP1 vI1 Rp2 vO RP2 vP2 vI2 RP4 vPn Rpn vI4 RP0 RP0 RF RP v OP = 1 + v P1 RN RP1 RP RP + v P2 + ··· + v Pn RP2 RPn Adapting the expression given in Problem 2.44 to the circuit above yields Rf Rf RP vO = − vI3 + 1 + vI1 RN RN RP1 RP RP + vI2 + vI4 RP2 RP4 where RP = RP0 RP1 · · · RPn when all inputs are present: where RP = RP0 RP1 RP2 RP3 . v O = v ON + v OP Rf Rf =− vN1 + vN2 + · · · + RN 1 RN 2 Rf RP RP vN1 + vN2 + · · · 1+ RN RP1 RP2 We require v O = −9v I 3 + v I 1 + 2v I 2 + 4v I 4 Equating the coefficients of v I 3 , we have Rf =9 RN (b) v O = −4v N 1 + v P1 + 3v P2 Rf = 4, RN 1 = 10 k ⇒ Rf = 40 k RN 1 Rf RP RP =1 =1⇒5 1+ RN RP1 RP1 Rf RP RP =3 =3⇒5 1+ RP2 RP2 RN Selecting RN = 10 k ⇒ Rf = 90 k. (1) (2) Thus, 1 1 1 1 1 , = + + in Substituting for RP RP RP0 RP1 RP2 Eqs. (1) and (2) and selecting (arbitrarily) RP0 = 10 k results in RP1 = 10 k and RP2 = 3.33 k. The result is the following circuit: 40 k vN vp 10 k 3.33 k vp 10 k 10 RP RP =1⇒ = 0.1 RP1 RP1 (1) Similarly, equating the coefficients of v I 2 gives 10 RP RP =2⇒ = 0.2 RP2 RP2 (2) and equating the coefficients of v I 4 gives 10 k Equating the coefficients of v I 1 provides Rf RP =1 1+ RN RP1 10 v RP RP =4⇒ = 0.4 RP4 RP4 (3) Now, summing Eqs. (1), (2), and (3) provides 1 1 1 + + = 0.7 (4) RP RP1 RP2 RP4 But, 1 1 1 1 1 = + + + RP RP0 RP1 RP2 RP4 Chapter 2–14 1 R2 1−x vO =1+ −1 =1+ =1+ vI R1 x x Thus, 1 1 1 1 1 − = + + RP RP0 RP1 RP2 RP4 (5) Equations (4) and (5) can be combined to obtain ∴ 1 vO = vI x 0≤x≤1⇒∞≥ RP RP = 0.7 ⇒ RP0 = 1− RP0 0.3 (6) vO ≥1 vI Add a resistor as shown: vO (1 − x) × 10 k =1+ vI x × 10 k + R vO = 11 For v I max Selecting RP0 = 10 k Equation (6) ⇒ RP = 3 k Equation (1) ⇒ RP1 = 30 k Equation (2) ⇒ RP2 = 15 k Equation (3) ⇒ RP4 = 7.5 k x = 0, 10 = R4 R3 + R4 R2 vO R4 1 + R2 /R1 = 1+ = vI R1 R3 + R4 1 + R3 /R4 2.46 v + = v I vO 10 k = 11 = 1 + vI R 10 k R R = 1 k 2.49 10 k v O1 = −10v 1 Setting v 1 = 0, we obtain the output component due to v 2 as 10R 10R v O2 = v 2 1 + = 10v 2 R 10R + R The total output voltage is For v 1 = 10 sin(2π × 60t) − 0.1 sin(2π × 1000 t) vO 10 k vO = vI v O = v O1 + v O2 = 10(v 2 − v 1 ) 1 k vI 1 k 2.47 Refer to Fig. P2.47. Setting v 2 = 0, we obtain the output component due to v 1 as 10 10 1+ 1 + 10 1 v O = 10v I Rin = 11 k v 2 = 10 sin(2π × 60t) + 0.1 sin(2π × 1000 t) 2.50 v O = 2 sin(2π × 1000t) 1 M 2.48 10 V 1 k v x1 1x vI vO (a) Source is connected directly. v O = 10 × R vI vO iL = 1 10 mV 1001 vO 10 mV = = 10 μA 1 k 1 k Current supplied by the source is 10 μA. Chapter 2–15 for a noninverting amplifier: 1 M 10 V Rin = ∞ 1 k Case Gain (V/V) Rin R1 R2 a –10 10 k 10 k 100 k b –1 100 k 100 k 100 k c –2 100 k 100 k 200 k d +1 ∞ ∞ 0 e +2 ∞ 100 k 100 k f +11 ∞ 10 k 100 k g –0.5 20 k 20 k 10 k (b) Inserting a buffer. v O = 10 V 10 V = 10 mA iL = 1 k Current supplied by the source is 0. The load current iL comes from the power supply of the op amp. G =1+ R2 R1 vO 2.53 For a non inverting amplifier [Eq. (2.11)]: G0 G0 1+ A G= 2.51 = G0 − G × 100 G0 for an inverting amplifier (Eq. 2.5): vO/A vO = vI G0 1 − G0 1+ A Case G 0 (V/V) a b c d e f g –1 1 –1 10 –10 –10 +1 vO A vI vO = vI − G= vO A 1 1 A Error of gain magnitude vO − 1 v 1 I =− 1 A+1 = |G0 | − |G| × 100 |G0 | A (V/V) G (V/V) (%) 10 10 100 10 100 1000 2 –0.83 0.91 –0.98 5 –9 –9.89 0.67 17 9 2 50 10 1.1 33 1+ 2.54 G= A (V/V) 1000 100 10 vO (V/V) vO 0.999 0.990 0.909 Gain error –0.1% –1% –9.1% 2.52 For an inverting amplifier Rin = R1 , R2 G=− R1 G0 G0 /A × 100 G0 − G × 100 = , ≤x G0 G0 G0 1+ 1+ A A G0 A ≥ 100 ⇒ A ≥ 100 − 1 G0 x G0 x A F 1+ or ⇒ A ≥ G0 F, where F = x F 0.01 4 10 0.1 3 10 1 10 2 10 10 100 100 −1 x x Chapter 2–16 Thus for: 10 102 x = 0.01: G0 (V/V) 1 A (V/V) 104 105 106 103 104 7 8 10 10 too high to be practical x = 0.1: G0 (V/V) 1 10 102 103 104 A (V/V) 103 104 105 106 107 x = 1: G0 (V/V) 1 10 10 10 10 A (V/V) 102 103 104 105 106 2 3 4 x = 10: G0 (V/V) 1 10 102 103 104 A (V/V) 10 102 103 104 105 2.55 Refer to Fig. P2.55. When potentiometer is set to the bottom: 30 × 25 = −10 V v O = v + = −15 + 25 + 100 + 25 and to the top: 30 × 25 = +10 V v O = −15 + 25 + 100 + 25 ⇒ −10 V ≤ v O ≤ + 10 V 2 × 10 =1V 20 1− R3 R2 × R1 R4 R4 R3 1 − 0.99 × R3 R4 Acm = 0.0095 Neglecting the effect of resistance variation on Ad , R2 100 = 20 V V = R1 5 Ad CMRR = 20 log Acm 20 = 20 log 0.0095 Ad = = 66.4 dB 2.57 If we assume R3 = R1 , R4 = R2 , then Eq. (2.20): Rid = 2R1 ⇒ R1 = (b) Ad = 20 = 10 k 2 R2 = 1 V/V ⇒ R2 = 10 k R1 (c) Ad = R2 = 100 V/V ⇒ R2 = 1 M = R4 R1 R1 = R3 = 10 k R2 v id R1 vO R2 Ad = = = 20 V/V v id R1 (d) Ad = R2 = 0.5 V/V ⇒ R2 = 5 k = R4 R1 R1 = R3 = 10 k From Eq. (2.20) 2.58 Refer to Fig. P2.58: Rid = 2R1 = 2 × 5 k = 10 k Considering that v − = v + : R2 vO − v1 v2 = ⇒ vO = v2 − v1 2 2 v1 =R v 1 only: Ri = I v1 + R1 vO R4 R I v1 R R3 R2 = 5 V/V ⇒ R2 = 50 k = R4 R1 R1 = R3 = 10 k vO = vO The two resistance ratios ∴ R1 = R2 = R3 = R4 = 10 k From Eq. (2.16), vI2 100 × 100 + 5 (a) Ad = 2.56 R1 = R3 = 5 k, R2 = R4 = 100 k R4 R2 Equation (2.15): = = 20 R3 R1 vI1 R4 R4 + R3 (Refer to Fig. 2.16.) Pot has 20 turns, and for each turn: v O = Acm = R2 R4 and differ by 1%. R1 R3 R4 R2 = 0.99 R1 R3 Now for this case, Acm can be found from Eq. (2.19) R v 2 only: Ri = 0V v2 = 2R I R Chapter 2–17 R Since R vO R2 R4 = : R1 R3 Rs Rs +1= + 1 ⇒ R1 = R3 ⇒ R2 = R4 R1 R3 2.60 I v2 R R2 R i1 v between 2 terminals: v Ri = = 2R I R1 vO vicm R Ricm i2 R 0V v R3 R4 vO I R R When R2 /R1 = R4 /R3 , the output voltage v O will be zero. Thus, v icm i1 = R1 + R2 and v I connected to both input terminals vI vI vI + = I= 2R 2R R Ri = R i2 = v icm R3 + R4 Thus, ii = v icm R 1 1 + R1 + R2 R3 + R4 and vI/2R R vI/2 I vI vI 2 Ricm = (R1 + R2 ) (R3 + R4 ) vO vI/2R R 2.61 From Eq. (2.19), vO R4 R2 R3 = 1− Acm ≡ v Icm R4 + R3 R1 R4 R The second factor in this expression is the one that in effect determines Acm . Now, for the circuit under consideration, all resistors are nominally equal to 10 k, but each has a tolerance of ±x%. Thus the second factor will have a maximum magnitude when R2 and R3 are at their lowest value and R1 and R4 are at their highest values, that is, 2.59 For an ideal difference amp, we need: Rs + R1 Rs + R3 = R2 R4 Rs /R3 + 1 Rs /R1 + 1 = R2 /R1 R4 /R3 R2 = R3 = 10(1 − 0.01x) R1 = R4 = 10(1 + 0.01x) R2 v1 Rs R1 vO v2 Rs Q.E.D. Substituting in the expression for Acm , we have (1 − 0.01x)2 10(1 + 0.01x) 1− Acm = 20 (1 + 0.01x)2 Now, for 0.01x R3 1, Acm = 0.5(1 + 0.01x) × 0.04x R4 Acm 0.02x V/V Chapter 2–18 To obtain CMRR = 80 dB, Ad = 1 Ad 50 = CMRR = Acm x 50 or 20 log dB x x(%) 0.1 Acm (V/V) 1 5 0.002 0.02 0.1 CMRR (dB) 54 34 20 2.62 From Eq. (2.19), R4 R2 R3 Acm = 1− R4 + R3 R1 R4 The second factor in this expression in effect determines Acm . The largest, |Acm |, will occur when R2 and R3 are at their lowest (or highest) values and R1 and R4 are at their highest (or lowest) values, as thiswill provide the maximum R2 R3 deviation of from unity. Thus, R1 R4 R2 = R2nominal (1 − ) R1 = R1nominal (1 + ) R4 = R4nominal (1 + ) where R4nominal R2nominal = =K R1nominal R3nominal Substituting in the expression for Acm , R4nominal (1 + ) × R4nominal (1 + ) + R3nominal (1 − ) (1 − )2 1− (1 + )2 Acm = Acm 2.63 See solution to Problem 2.62 above. Specifically, if the resistors have a tolerance of x%, then K +1 CMRR = 20 log 4(x/100) where K is the nominal differential gain. Here we are required to obtain K = 1000 Rin = 2 k Thus, R1 = R3 = 1 k and R2 = R4 = 1 M. To obtain a CMRR of 88 dB, we write 1001 88 = 20 log 4(x/100) 1001 × 100 = 25, 118.86 4x ⇒ x 1% R3 = R3nominal (1 − ) For 101 = 104 4 101 = 0.25 × 10−2 4 × 104 That is, the resistor tolerance should be a maximum of 0.25%. 1, 2.64 (a) Refer to Fig. P2.64 and Eq. (2.19): R4 R2 R3 1− Acm = R3 + R4 R1 R4 100.100 100 1− = 100 + 100 100.100 Acm = 0 Refer to 2.17: ⇒ Ad = R4 R2 = R1 R3 R2 =1 R1 (b) v A = v B K × 4 K +1 100 k Since Ad = K Ad CMRR = A cm vcm = K +1 4 which in dB becomes K +1 CMRR = 20 log 4 vcm 100 k 100 k A B 100 k Q.E.D. For Ad = 100 V/V and = 0.01, 101 CMRR = 20 log = 68 dB 0.04 v A = v cm 100 100 + 100 vO Chapter 2–19 v cm v cm and v B = 2 2 ⇒ −5 V ≤ v cm ≤ 5 V the range of v Icm will be vA = −3 V ≤ v Icm ≤ +3 V (c) The circuit becomes as shown below: 2.65 Refer to Fig. P2.65. Using superposition: 100 kΩ vI1 v O = v O1 + v O2 100 kΩ 10 kΩ vI2 Calculate v O1 : v + = A vO 100 kΩ 10 kΩ βv O1 = v− 2 βv O1 βυ O1 − vO v1 2 = 2 ⇒ v O1 = R R β −1 B v1 − 100 kΩ Calculate v O2 : v O2 v O2 v O2 = v+ ⇒ v2 − = − βv O2 2 2 2 v2 ⇒ v O2 = 1−β v− = Applying Thévenin’s theorem to v I 1 together with the associated (100-k, 10-k) voltage divider, and similarly to v I 2 and the associated (100-k, 10-k) voltage divider, we obtain the following circuit: 100 k (1011) v (1011) v I2 (100 // 10) k = vO v1 v2 + β −1 1−β 1 (v 2 − v 1 ) 1−β Ad = (100 // 10) k I1 v O = v O1 + v O2 = vO 1 = v2 − v1 1−β Ad = 10 V/V ⇒ β = 0.9 = Q.E.D R6 R5 + R6 RId = 2R = 2 M ⇒ R = 1 M R5 + R6 ≤ 100 k R ⇒ R5 + R6 ≤ 10 k 100 Selecting R6 = 6.8 k vO = 100 k (100 10) k 10 10 vI2 − vI1 11 11 = 10(v I 2 − v I 1 ) 6.8 = 0.9 ⇒ R5 = 756 6.8 + R5 For v I 1 = v I 2 = v Icm , v O = 0, thus 2.66 See partial analysis on circuit diagram on next page. Acm = 0 From input loop: For v I 2 − v I 1 = v Id , v Id = 2i1 R1 v O = 10 v Id From the loop containing R2 , +, −, R2 : Thus, Ad = 10. To obtain the input common-mode range, we note that for v I 1 = v I 2 = v Icm , v+ = v− = 10 100 v Icm × 11 100 + (100 10) = 0.833v Icm For v + and v − in the range −2.5 V ≤ v + , v − ≤ +2.5 V v G = i1 R2 + 0 + i1 R2 = 2i1 R2 Thus, we can find the current through RG as v G /RG = 2i1 (R2 /RG ). Finally, from the loop containing v O , R2 , RG , and R2 : R2 v O = −2i1 1 + 2 R2 − 2i1 R2 RG R2 = −4i1 R2 1 + RG (1) Chapter 2–20 This figure belongs to Problem 2.66. i1 i1 2i1 i1 R1 0 R2 vId vG 0 RG 2i1 i1 R2 R RG 2 2i1 R2 R1 2i1 R2 RG R2 RG vO R2 R2 i1 i1 2i1 Substituting for 2i1 from Eq. (1), we obtain the gain as R2 R2 vO 1+ Q.E.D. = −2 v Id R1 RG R2 RG The circuit on the left ideally has infinite input resistance (iii) vO = +2 V/V vi R2 = 1. R1 Connect C and O together, and D to ground. 25 k 2.67 (a) Refer to Eq. (2.17): Ad = vI (iv) 25 k 25 k 25 k C O vI vO 25 k B 25 k 25 k B D 2.68 Refer to the figure on next page: v B = v A = 3 + 0.05 sin ωt, V Two possibilities: v C = v D = 3 − 0.05 sin ωt, V 25 k A 25 k vO D i = (v B − v C )/2R1 A Current through R2 , 2R1 , and R2 is C C 25 k vi O vO 25 k D B C O D vO (ii) = +1 V/V vi vO 25 k A 25 k B D 25 k vI 25 k B O vO 1 = + V/V vi 2 vO = −1 V/V vi A vI 25 k C A (b) (i) = 0.05 sin ωt, mA v E = v B + iR2 = 3 + 2.55 sin ωt, V v F = v C − iR2 = 3 − 2.55 sin ωt, V vO Chapter 2–21 This figure belongs to Problem 2.68. 1 v F = 1.5 − 1.275 sin ωt, V 2 v O = (v F − v E ) × 1 = −5.1 sin ωt, V vG = vH = R2 R2 1 = 1+ 1+ v Icm + v Id R1 2 R1 R2 v Od = v O2 − v O1 = 1 + v Id R1 1 R2 (v O1 + v O2 ) = 1 + v Icm 2 R1 2.69 (a) Refer to Fig. 2.20(a). R2 = 101. If The gain of the first stage is 1 + R1 the op amps of the first stage saturate at ±12 V then −12 V ≤ 101v Icm ≤ +12 V v Ocm = ⇒ −0.12 V ≤ v Icm ≤ 0.12 V Acm1 = 1 + As explained in the text, the disadvantage of circuit in Fig.2.20(a) isthat v Icm is amplified by a R2 gain equal to 1 + in the first stage and R1 therefore a very small v Icm range is acceptable to avoid saturation. Ad 1 CMRR = 20 log A (b) In Fig. 2.20(b), when v Icm is applied, v − for both A1 and A2 is the same and therefore no current flows through 2R1 . This means the voltage at the output of A1 and A2 is the same as v Icm . ⇒ −12 V ≤ v Icm ≤ 12 V This circuit allows for a much larger range of v Icm . Ad 1 = 1 + R2 R1 R2 R1 cm1 = 0 dB (b) Refer to the circuit in Fig. 2.20(b): 1 v I 1 = v Icm − v Id 2 1 v I 2 = v Icm + v Id 2 1 v − (A1 ) = v I 1 = v Icm − v Id 2 1 v − (A2 ) = v I 2 = v Icm + v Id 2 2.70 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. 2.20(a). 1 v I 1 = v Icm − v Id 2 1 v I 2 = v Icm + v Id 2 R2 v O1 = 1 + vI1 R1 R2 R2 1 1+ = 1+ v Icm − v Id R1 2 R1 R2 v O2 = 1 + vI2 R1 Current through R1 in the upward direction is i= v − (A2 ) − v − (A1 ) v Id = 2R1 2R1 v O1 = v − (A1 ) − iR2 = v Icm − 1 R2 v Id 1+ 2 R1 v O2 = v − (A2 ) + iR2 = v Icm + R2 1 1+ v Id 2 R1 R2 v Od = v O2 − v O1 = 1 + v Id R1 Chapter 2–22 v Ocm = 1 (v O1 + v O2 ) = v Icm 2 Ad 1 = 1 + If 2R1 is reduced to 1 k, Ad increases to 201 V/V while Acm remains unchanged at 0.02 V/V. Thus, CMRR increases to about 80 dB. We conclude that increasing the gain of the first stage increases CMRR. R2 R1 Acm1 = 1 = 20 log 1 + R2 R1 cm1 Ad 1 CMRR = 20 log A 2.72 (a) Comment: In circuit (a), the first stage amplifies the differential signal and the common-mode signal equally. On the other hand, in circuit (b), the first stage amplifies the differential signal by R2 1+ and the common-mode signal by R1 unity, thus providing a substantial CMRR. Circuit (a) is useless as a differential amplifier! 2.71 Ideally, R4 R2 Ad = 1+ R3 R1 (1) Acm = 0 CMRR = ∞ For R2 = R3 = R4 = 100 k, and 2R1 = 10 k. 100 = 21 V/V Ad = 1 1 + 5 Acm = 0 CMRR = ∞ If all resistors have ±1% tolerance, the differential gain will be slightly affected; Eq. (1) indicates that in the worst case Ad can deviate by approximately ±4% of the nominal value. The common-mode gain, however, undergoes dramatic change because of the significant effect of resistor tolerances on the operation of the difference amplifier in the second stage. Equation (2.19) can be employed to evaluate the worst-case common-mode gain. For our case, Acm2 = 0.5[1 − (1 ± 0.04] = ± 0.02 The common-mode gain of the first stage will remain approximately unity. Thus the ±1% resistor tolerances will mainly affect the common-mode gain of the instrumentation amplifier, increasing it in the worst case to |Acm | = 0.02 Correspondingly, the CMRR will be reduced to CMRR = 20 log 20 log 21 0.02 | Ad | | Acm | = 60.4 dB as opposed to the ideal infinite value! vB 20 =1+ = 3 V/V vA 10 30 vC = −3 V/V =− vA 10 (b) v O = v B − v C = 6v A ⇒ vO = 6 V/V vA Chapter 2–23 (c) v B and v C can be ±14 V, or 28 V P-P. −28 V ≤ v O ≤ 28 V, or 56 V P-P (d) The phase relation between input and output remains unchanged. 28 v Orms = √ = 19.8 V 2 2.75 |T | = 2.73 See analysis on the circuit diagrams below: Also, Note that circuit (a) has the advantage of infinite input resistance. However, it has the limitation that the load impedance must be floating. This constraint is removed in circuit (b), but the input resistance is finite (2R1 ). RC = 2.74 1 Vo (s) =− Vi (s) sCR 1 Vo (jω) =− Vi (jω) jωCR Vo = 1 ∠φ = +90◦ V ωCR i For C = 1 nF and R = 10 k, CR = 1 × 10−9 × 10 × 104 = 10−4 s 1 = 104 rad/s. (a) |Vo /Vi | = 1 at ω = CR 104 = 1.59 kHz. Correspondingly, f = 2π (b) At f = 1.59 kHz, the output sine wave leads the input sine wave by 90◦ . (c) If the frequency is lowered by a factor of 10, the gain increases by a factor of 10 and, correspondingly, the output voltage increases by a factor of 10. This figure belongs to Problem 2.73. 1 . If |T | = 100 V/V at ωRC f = 10 kHz, then for |T | = 1 V/V, f has to be 10 kHz ×100 = 1 MHz. 1 1 = 0.159 μs = ωint 2π × 1 MHz 2.76 CR = 1 s and Rin = 100 k. ⇒ R = 100 k 1 = 10 μF C= 100 × 103 When a dc voltage of −1 V is applied, a dc current of 1 V/100 k = 0.01 mA will flow as shown in the figure below. C 10 F 100 k 1V 0.01 mA 0.01 mA The capacitor voltage v O will rise linearly from its initial value of −10 V. Thus, vO = = It − 10 C 10−5 t − 10 = t − 10, V 10 × 10−6 vO Chapter 2–24 Thus v O will reach 0 V at t = 10 s and will reach 10 V at t = 20 s See figure below. 1 1 = 1 at ωint = . ωRC RC 1 For ωint = 10 krad/s, RC = 4 = 10−4 s. Now 10 Rin = 100 k, thus R = 100 k and 10−4 s C= 5 = 10−9 F = 1 nF. For a 2-V, 100-μs 10 2V input pulse, a current of = 0.02 mA 100 k flows into R and C, causing v O to decrease linearly from its initial value of 0 V according to 2.77 |T | = vO = − = I t C −0.02 × 10−3 t = −0.02 × 106 t 1 × 10−9 At t = 100 μs, v O becomes 1 ⇒ CR = 1.59 μs CR For Rin = 10 k, R = 10 k, and 2.78 2π × 100 × 103 = 1.59 × 10−6 = 159 pF 104 To limit the dc gain to 40 dB (i.e., 100 V/V), we connect a resistance RF across C (as in Fig. 2.25) with RF = 100 R = 1 M. C= The resulting low-pass filter will have a 3-dB frequency of 1 1 = f3dB = 2πCRF 2π × 159 × 10−12 × 106 = 1 kHz When a 10-μs, 1-V pulse (see Fig. 1) is applied at the input, a current of 1 V/10 k = 0.1 mA flows into the integrator. Now we consider two cases: with and without RF . v O (100 μs) = −0.02 × 106 × 100 × 10−6 = −2 V and the output voltage then remains constant at this value. See figures on next column. When v I = 2 sin 104 t, the output will be a sine wave of the same frequency but phase-shifted by −270◦ (or +90◦ ), and its magnitude will be 2 V × integrator gain at ω = 104 rad/s. The gain is given by 1 1 = 4 =1 |T | = ωRC 10 × 10−4 Thus, v O = −2 sin(104 t − 90◦ ) Figure 1 Chapter 2–25 (a) For an integrator without RF , the 0.1-mA current flows through C and the output voltage decreases linearly from 0 V as v O (t) = − where t is in μs. At the end of the pulse, t = 10 μs, v O (10 μs) = −100(1 − e−10/159 ) = −6.1 V It C Beyond t = 10 μs, the capacitor discharges through RF . Thus, including RF results in the nonideal integrator response shown in Fig. 3. 0.1 × 10−3 =− t 159 × 10−12 = −0.63 × 106 t, V At the end of the pulse, t = 10 μs, resulting in v O (10 μs) = −0.63 × 106 × 10 × 10−6 = −6.3 V See Fig. 2. vO (V) Figure 3 10 t (s) 6.28 2.79 Each pulse provides a constant current of 1V through the capacitor and thus deposits a R 1V charge of × 10 μs on the capacitor, resulting R in a change of the output voltage of − Figure 2 10−5 1 × 10 × 10−6 = − −3 = −0.01 V RC 10 Therefore a total of 100 pulses are required to cause a change of −1 V in v O (t). (b) For an integrator with RF , the 0.1-mA current flows through the parallel combination of C and RF . The result is vi (t) t (ms) v O (t) = v Ofinal − (v Ofinal − v Oinitial )e−t/τ where vo (t), mV v Ofinal = −IRF = −0.1 × 10−3 × 106 = −100 V v Oinitial = 0 τ = CRF = 159 × 10−12 × 106 = 159 μs Thus, v O (t) = −100(1 − e−t/159 ), V t (ms) 10 20 30 Chapter 2–26 2.80 1 = 0.16 nF 2π × 1 × 103 × 106 C= C From the Bode plot shown in previous column, the unity-gain frequency is 100 kHz. R2 R1 Vi Vo Let Z2 = R2 1 and Z1 = R1 sC Vo Z2 Y1 1/R1 =− =− =− 1 Vi Z1 Y2 + sC R2 Vo =− Vi This function is of the STC low-pass type, having R2 a dc gain of − and a 3-dB frequency R1 1 CR2 Z2 /Z1 1 + Z2 /Z1 1+ A For Z1 = R, Z2 = 1/sC, and A = A0 , Vo =− Vi =− (R2 /R1 ) =− 1 + sCR2 ω0 = 2.81 Equation (2.5) can be generalized as follows: =− 1/sCR 1 1 1+ + A0 sA0 CR 1 1 1 1 CR(1 + ) s + A0 (A0 + 1)CR A0 /[(A0 + 1)CR] 1 s+ (A0 + 1)CR which is low-pass STC function. The pole (or 3-dB) frequency is Rin = R1 = 10 k dc gain = 40 dB = 100 ∴ 100 = R2 ⇒ R2 = 100R1 = 1 M R1 ωP = 1 (A0 + 1)CR The ideal integrator has ωP = 0. Observe that as A0 → ∞, ωP → 0. The dc gain is −A0 , which is the dc gain of the op amp. If an ideal Miller integrator is fed with a −1-V pulse signal of width T = CR, the output voltage can be found as follows: The −1-V pulse will cause a current I = 1 V/R to be drawn through R and C. The capacitor voltage, which is v O , will rise linearly according to vO = 1 1 It = t C CR Thus, at t = T (the end of the pulse) the output voltage reaches 1 V and then stays constant at this value. 3-dB frequency at 1 kHz 1 ∴ ω0 = 2π × 1 × 10 = CR2 3 If the integrator is made with an op amp having a finite A0 = 1000, the response to the −1-V step will be that of an STC low-pass circuit. Thus, Chapter 2–27 v O = v Ofinal − (v Ofinal − v Oinitial )e−t/τ i=C d vI = 0.1 × 10−6 × slope dt where = 0.1 × 10−6 × v Ofinal = −1 V × dc gain = −1 V × −1000 = 0.4 mA = 1000 V v Oinitial = 0 V 1 = (A0 + 1)CR = 1001CR τ= ωP The peak value of the output square wave in = iR = 0.4 mA × 20 k Thus, =8V v O = 1000(1 − e−t/1000CR ) At t = T , which is equal to CR, vI (V) v O (T ) = 1000(1 − e−0.001 ) = −0.9995 −1 V 2.82 2 0.5 × 10−3 1 Vo = −sCR = −jωCR, Vi Vo = ωCR V i 2 0 For R = 10 k and C = 1 nF, CR = 1 × 10−9 × 10 × 103 = 10 μs t (ms) 1 1 1 1 Vo = 1 at ω = ω0 = = Vi CR 10 × 10−6 = 100 krad/s 100 = 15.9 kHz or f0 = 2τ Vo = ωCR = ω = f V ω0 f0 i Vo For f = 10 f0 ; = 10, and the output sine Vi wave will have 10-V peak-to-peak amplitude. The (−jω) factor in the transfer function means inversion and +90◦ phase shift, thus vO (V) 8V 0 1 2 t (ms) 8 V v O = −5 sin (106 t + 90◦ ), V The output wave has the same frequency as the input signal. 2.83 R 20 k i i vI The average value of the output is zero. C 0.1 μF 0 vO iR To increase the value of the output to 12 V = 8 V × 1.5, the value of R has to be increased by 1.5 times: 20 k × 1.5 = 30 k Chapter 2–28 ω0 (unity-gain frequency) = 103 rad/s 2.84 Vo At ω = 0.1 ω0 , = 0.1 V/V, φ = 270◦ V vI i Vo At ω = 10 ω0 , = 10 V/V, φ = 270◦ V 1V i 0 0.2 ms When a series input resistor R1 is added as shown, then the high-frequency gain is limited to R2 /R1 . Thus, t R vO (V) C R1 Vi 0.2 ms Vo t 100 k R2 = = 1 k 100 100 The circuit now has an STC high-pass response with a lower 3-dB frequency R1 = 5 v O = −CR 1 1 = −8 = 100 krad/s CR1 10 × 103 100 s 100 s Vo =− =− Vi s + ω3dB s + 105 For s = jω, ω3dB = d vI dt −jω100 100 Vo = = −j Vi jω + 105 (105 /ω) + j Therefore: For 0 ≤ t ≤ 0.2 ms: v O = −1 ms × 1V = −5 V 0.2 ms and v O = 0 otherwise. At ω = 104 rad/s, Vo 10 = √ 100 = √ 9.95 V/V V 100 + 1 1 + 0.01 i φ = 180◦ + 90◦ − tan−1 0.1 = 180◦ + 84.3◦ Both these results differ slightly from the ideal values. 2.85 Vo = −sCR = −10−3 s Vi 2.86 R2 C = 10 nF = 10−8 F R= 10−3 s = 100 k 10−8 F ω Vo = −j10−3 ω = −j 3 Vi 10 R1 C Vi Vo = ω V 103 i φ = 180◦ + 90◦ (an inversion + a phase lead of 90◦ ) Vo Z2 =− =− Vi Z1 R2 R1 + 1 sC Vo Chapter 2–29 Vo R2 /R1 (jω) = − Vi [1 + (ω1 /jω)][1 + j(ω/ω2 )] Thus, (R2 /R1 )s Vo =− 1 Vi s+ CR1 where which is that of an STC high-pass type. R2 High-frequency gain (s → ∞) = − R1 ω1 = 1 C1 R1 and (a) For ω For a high-frequency input resistance of 1 k, we select R1 = 1 k. For a high-frequency gain of 40 dB, R2 /R1 Vo − Vi 1 + (ω1 /jω) R2 = 100 ⇒ R2 = 100 k R1 (b) For ω1 For f3dB = 2 kHz, Vo −(R2 /R1 ) Vi Q.E.D. ω1 , ω ω2 (c) For ω ω2 ⇒ C = 79 nF The magnitude of the transfer function reduces from 40 dB to unity (0 dB) in two decades. Thus f (unity gain) = 1 C2 R2 Assuming ω2 ω1 , then 1 3-dB frequency (ω3dB ) = CR1 1 = 2 × 103 2πCR1 ω2 = 2000 f3dB = = 20 Hz 100 100 R2 /R1 Vo − Vi 1 + j(ω/ω2 ) The resulting Bode plot will be as shown: Design: Gain of 40 dB ⇒ f1 = 200 Hz ⇒ R2 = 100 R1 1 = 200 2πC1 R1 2.87 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P2.87. f2 = 200 kHz ⇒ Z2 1 Vo =− =− Vi Z1 Z1 Y2 = − 1 R1 + sC1 1 1 + sC2 R2 R2 /R1 = − 1 1+ (1 + sC2 R2 ) sC1 R1 1 = 200 × 103 2πC2 R2 Input resistance (at ω ω1 ) = 2 k ⇒ R1 = 2 k Thus, R1 = 2 k, R2 = 200 k, C1 0.4 μF, and C2 4 pF. Chapter 2–30 2.88 Inverting configuration: 2.91 (a) IB = (IB1 + IB2 )/2 R2 VO = VOS 1 + R1 −0.2 = VOS 1 + R2 R1 = VOS Open input: v O = v + + R2 IB1 = VOS + R2 IB1 100 1+ 2 ⇒ VOS 4 mV 2.89 VOS = ±2 mV VO = 0.01 sin ωt × 100 + VOS × 100 = 1 sin ωt ± 0.2 V 5.3 = VOS + 10,000IB1 (1) Input connected to ground: v O = v + + R2 VOS IB1 + R1 R2 = VOS 1 + + R2 IB1 R1 5 = VOS × 101 + 10,000IB1 (2) Equations (1), (2) ⇒ 100VOS = −0.3 ⇒ VOS = −3 mV ⇒ IB1 = 530 nA IB IB1 = 530 nA 2.90 Input offset voltage = 3 mV and both flow into the op-amp input terminals. Output dc offset voltage = 3 mV × closed loop gain (b) VOS = −3 mV = 3 mV × 1000 =3V The maximum amplitude of an input sinusoid that results in an output peak amplitude of 12 – 3 = 9 V is given by vi = 9 = 9 mV 1000 If amplifier is capacitively coupled then v i max = 12 = 12 mV 1000 (c) In this case, Since R is very large, we may ignore VOS compared to the voltage drop across R. VOS RIB , Also Eq. (2.46) holds: R3 = R1 R2 Chapter 2–31 5-k resistance in series with R3 . The resulting dc offset voltage at the output will be therefore from Eq. (2.40): VO = IOS × R2 ⇒ IOS = −0.6 10 M VO = IOS R2 = 0.2 × 100 = 20 mV Since IOS can be of either polarity, IOS = −60 nA VO = ±20 mV The same result could have been found by replacing R3 in Eq. (1) by (R3 + R4 ) where R4 = 5 k. 2.92 If the signal source resistance is 15 k, then the resistances can be equalized by adding a 5-k resistor in series with the negative input lead of the op amp. R2 = 100 k R1 = 100 k 9 R3 = 5 k 2.93 IB1 = 2 ± 0.1, μA, VOS = 0 IB2 = 2 ± 0.1, μA R3 IB1 − IB2 R1 C1 R1 VO = −IB2 R3 + R2 R2 From Eq. (2.38): Thus, R2 VO = IB1 R2 − IB2 R3 1 + R1 C2 (1) R3 The maximum value of VO is obtained when IB1 = 2.1 μA and IB2 = 1.9 μA, 100 VOmax = 2.1 × 100 − 1.9 × 5 1 + 100/9 = 210 − 95 = 115 mV The minimum value of VO is obtained when IB1 = 1.9 μA and IB2 = 2.1 μA, R2 = R3 = 100 k 1+ R2 = 100 R1 VOmin = 1.9 × 100 − 2.1 × 5 × 10 = 190 − 105 = 85 mV Thus the dc offset at the output will be in the range of 85 mV to 115 mV. The bulk of the dc offset at the output, that due to IB , can be reduced to zero by making the dc resistances seen by the two input terminals equal. Currently, the positive input terminal sees a resistance R3 = 5 k and the negative input terminal sees a resistance equal 100 to R1 R2 = 100 = 10 k. Thus the two 9 resistances can be made equal by connecting a R1 = 100 k = 1.01 k 99 1 1 = 2π × 100 ⇒ C1 = R1 C1 1.01 × 2π × 105 = 1.58 μF 1 1 = 2π × 10 ⇒ C2 = R3 C2 2π × 106 = 0.16 μF vO Chapter 2–32 = 1001VOS 2.94 1 M VA 1 M = 1001 × 3 mV 3V I A large capacitor placed in series with the 1-k resistor results in 1 k 1 M VOS I VO VOS v − = v + = VOS VA = 2VOS = 6 mV I= VOS 6 mV = = 6 nA 1 M 1 M VO = VA + 1 M × I+ = 2 VOS + 1 M × VA 1 k v + = v − = VOS VOS 2 VOS + 1 M 1 k No dc current flows through R1 , C branch ∴ VO = VA + VOS = 2 VOS + VOS = 2003 VOS = 3 VOS = 2003 × 3 mV = 3 × 3 mV ∼ =6V = 9 mV For capacitively coupled input, 1 M I0 VA 2.95 1 M 1 M 1 k (1000/99) k VO VOS 100 = 1 + v + = v − = VOS I =0 VO (a) VO = 200 × 10−9 × 1 × 106 = 0.2 V VA = VOS VO = VA + 1 M × R2 ⇒ R1 = 10.1 k R1 (b) Largest output offset is VOS = VOS + 1000VOS 1 k VO = 2 mV × 100 + 0.2 V = 400 mV = 0.4 V Chapter 2–33 (c) For bias current compensation, we connect a resistor R3 in series with the positive input terminal of the op amp, with R3 = R1 R2 , R3 = 10 k 1 M 10 k IOS = 0.4 V = 0.4 μA. Thus, the possible 1 M range of IOS is 0.2 μA to 0.4 μA. case, IOS = 2.98 200 = 20 nA 10 1 M The offset current alone will result in an output offset voltage of 10 nF 10 k IOS × R2 = 20 × 10−9 × 1 × 106 = 20 mV R3 (d) VO = 200 mV + 20 mV = 220 mV = 0.22 V IB1 Vos Vo IB2 2.96 At 0◦ C, we expect ±20 × 25 × 1000 μV = ±500 mV = ±0.5 V ◦ At 75 C, we expect ±20 × 50 × 1000 μ = ±1 V We expect these quantities to have opposite polarities. 2.97 R3 = R1 R2 = 10 k 1 M = 9.09 k Now, with the input grounded and assuming VOS = 0, the measured +0.3-V at the output is entirely due to IOS , that is, (a) R3 = R RF = 10 k 1 M ⇒ R3 = 9.9 k (b) As discussed in Section 2.8.2, the dc output voltage of the integrator when the input is RF grounded is VO = VOS 1 + + IOS RF R 1 M VO = 2 mV 1 + + 20 nA × 1 M 10 k = 0.202 V + 0.02 V VO = 0.222 V 0.3 = IOS R2 = IOS × 1 M Thus, IOS = 0.3 μA If VOS = ±1 mV, then it alone will result in an output voltageof R2 VOS 1 + = VOS × 101 = ±101 mV or R1 +0.1 V If VOS is positive, 0.1 V of the output 0.3-V offset will be due to VOS , leaving 0.2 V as the result of 0.2 V IOS ; thus in this case, IOS = = 0.2 μA. On 1 M the other hand, if VOS is negative, then −0.1 V of the output 0.3 V is due to VOV , with the result that IOS must be causing 0.4 V of output offset. In this 2.99 ft = A0 fb A0 fb (Hz) ft (Hz) 105 102 107 106 1 106 105 103 108 107 10−1 106 2 × 105 10 2 × 106 2.100 At very low frequencies, the gain is A0 , thus 20 log A0 = 98 dB ⇒ A0 80,000 V/V Chapter 2–34 At f = 100 kHz, the gain is 40 dB or 100 V/V. Thus 2.102 The gain drops by 20 dB at f 10fb . Thus (a) A0 = 2 × 105 V/V ft = 100 kHz × 100 = 10 MHz fb = 10 MHz = 125 Hz. Since ft = A0 fb ⇒ fb = 80,000 5 × 102 = 50 Hz 10 ft = A0 fb = 2 × 105 × 50 = 107 Hz = 10 MHz 2.101 f = 10 kHz |A| = 20 × 103 (b) A0 = 20 × 105 V/V f = 100 kHz |A| = 4 × 103 fb = Thus, a change of a decade in f does not result in a factor of 10 reduction in gain; in fact, the gain reduces by only a factor of 5. It follows that the first frequency (10 kHz) is less than fb . Therefore, we must use the exact expression for |A|, that is, A0 1 + (10/fb )2 = 20 × 103 (1) A0 1 + (100/fb )2 = 4 × 103 (2) 1 + (100/fb )2 =5 1 + (10/fb )2 ⇒1+ 102 2500 1002 = 25 1 + = 25 + 2 2 2 fb fb fb fb = 0.1 GHz = 10 MHz 10 ft = A0 fb = 100 × 10 = 1 GHz (e) A0 = 25 V/mV = 25 × 103 V/V fb = 250 = 25 kHz 10 fb = A0 × fb = 25 × 103 × 25 × 103 = 625 MHz 2.103 Gnominal = −50 ⇒ 10,000 2500 − 2 = 24 fb2 fb 0.1 MHz = 10 kHz 10 (d) A0 = 100 V/V fb = Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2), we have (c) A0 = 1800 V/V ft = A0 fb = 1800 × 10 = 18 MHz Substituting the given data, we obtain ft = A0 fb = 20 × 105 × 1 = 2 MHz fb = A0 |A| = 1 + (f /fb )2 10 = 1 Hz 10 R2 = 50 R1 A0 = 104 7500 = 17.68 kHz 24 ft = 106 Hz Now, substituting in Eq. (1) yields A0 = 20 × 103 1 + 10 17.68 f3dB of closed-loop amplifier = 2 = 22,976 V/V and the unity-gain frequency is ft = A0 fb = 22.976 × 103 × 17.68 × 103 = 406.2 MHz = 106 = 19.61 kHz 51 G=− 50 1+j f f3dB ft 1+ R2 R1 Chapter 2–35 50 |G| = 1 + (f /f3dB )2 f3dB = 50 = 49.75 V/V For f = 0.1 f3dB , |G| = √ 1.01 For f3dB = 5 MHz, ft = 10 MHz 50 For f = 10 f3dB , |G| = √ = 4.975 V/V 1 + 100 which is a 20-dB reduction. 2.104 ft = 20 MHz and closed-loop gain 1+ R2 = 100 V/V R1 f3dB = ft 1+ R2 R1 = 1+j ⇒ φ = −tan−1 R2 1+ R1 = ft 2 (d) G = −2 V/V ⇒ f3dB = ft R2 1+ R1 = 20 MHz = 200 kHz 100 ft 3 For f3dB = 5 MHz, ft = 15 MHz f3dB = ft R2 1+ R1 = f f3db ft 1001 (f) G = +1 V/V ⇒ f f3dB = f3dB ft 1+ R2 R1 = ft (g) G = −1 V/V ⇒ φ = 84◦ , f = f3dB × tan 84◦ = 1.9 MHz f3dB = 2.105 (a) G = −50 V/V ⇒ R2 1+ R1 = R2 = 50 R1 1+ R2 R1 R2 1+ R1 = ft 2 For f3dB = 1 MHz, ft = 2 MHz 2.106 f3dB = ft = 1 MHz (b) G = +50 V/V ⇒ 1 + ft ft R2 =1 R1 ft 51 For f3dB = 100 kHz ⇒ ft = 100 × 51 = 5.1 MHz f3dB = R2 =0 R1 For f3dB = 1 MHz, ft = 1 MHz f = f3dB × tan 6◦ = 21 kHz ft R2 = 1000 R1 For f3dB = 10 kHz, ft = 10 × 1001 = 10.1 MHz For φ = −6◦ f3dB = R2 =2 R1 (e) G = −1000 V/V ⇒ 100 G( jω) = ft = R2 = 50 R1 1+ 1 2 = 1 + f 2 with f f3dB f in MHz ft 50 |G| = 0.99 ⇒ f = 0.142 MHz For f3dB = 100 kHz, ft = 5 MHz (c) G = +2 V/V ⇒ 1 + 1 |G| = R2 =2 R1 The follower behaves like a low-pass STC circuit 1 1 μs = with a time constant τ = 2π 2π × 106 tr = 2.2τ = 0.35 μs. Chapter 2–36 2.107 1 + R2 = 10 ⇒ R1 = 1 k and R2 = 9 k R1 When a 100-mV (i.e., 0.1-V) step is applied at the input, the output will be v O = 0.1 × 10(1 − e−t/τ ), V 1+ f3dB f1 f3dB = f1 2 = √ √ 2 2−1 Q.E.D (b) 40 dB = 20 log G0 ⇒ G0 = 100 = 1 + R2 R1 where τ= f3dB = 1 ω3dB v O reaches 1% of the 1-V final value at time t, ft R2 1+ R1 = 2 MHz = 20 kHz 100 1 − e−t/τ = 0.99 (c) Each stage should have 20-dB gain or R2 1+ = 10 and therefore a 3-dB frequency of R1 e−t/τ = 0.01 f1 = 2 × 106 = 2 × 105 Hz 10 t = 4.6τ The overall f3dB = 2 × 105 √ 2−1 For t to be 200 ns, = 128.7 kHz, 200 = 43.49 ns τ= 4.6 Thus we require a closed-loop 3-dB frequency 1 or τ ω3dB = f3dB = 1 1 = = 3.66 MHz 2πτ 2π × 43.49 × 10−9 Correspondingly, the op amp must have an ft of ft = f3dB R2 1+ R1 = 36.6 MHz 2.108 (a) Assume two identical stages, each with a gain function: G= G0 ω = jf 1+j 1+ ω1 f1 G0 2.109 ft = 100 × 5 = 500 MHz if a single op amp is used. With an op amp that has only ft = 40 MHz, the possible closed-loop gain at 5 MHz is |A| = 40 = 8 V/V 5 To obtain an overall gain of 100 would require three such amplifiers, cascaded. Now, if each of the stages has a low-frequency (dc) closed-loop 40 MHz. gain K, then its 3-dB frequency will be K Thus for each stage the closed-loop gain is: K |G| = ⎛ ⎞2 f ⎜ ⎟ 1 + ⎝ 40 ⎠ G0 2 f 1+ f1 G= overall gain of the cascade is which is 6.4 times greater than the bandwidth achieved using a single op amp, as in case (b) above. K G02 2 f 1+ f1 The gain will drop by 3 dB when which at f = 5 MHz becomes K 2 K 1+ 8 |G5MHz | = Chapter 2–37 ⎢ ⎢ For overall gain of 100: 100 = ⎢ ⎢ ⎣ ⎥ ⎥ K ⎥ 2 ⎥ K ⎦ 1+ 8 2.112 i 100 kΩ 1 kΩ vI ⇒ K = 5.7 1 iO ⎤3 ⎡ vO Thus for each cascade stage: f3dB = iL 40 5.7 RL f3dB = 7 MHz The 3-dB frequency of the overall amplifier, f1 , can be calculated as ⎡ ⎢ ⎢ ⎢ ⎢ ⎣ ⎤3 ⎥ 3 ⎥ 5.7 ⎥ = (5.7) ⇒ f1 = 3.6 MHz √ 2 ⎥ 2 ⎦ f 1+ 7 (a) RL = 1 k for v Omax = 10 V: Vp = Vp = 0.1 V When the output is at its peak, 10 = 10 mA iL = 1 k i= 2.110 (a) R2 = K, f3dB = R1 ft R2 1+ R1 = ft 1+K GBP = Gain × f3dB GBP = K (b) 1 + ft K = ft 1+K K +1 R2 = K, R1 GBP = K f3dB = ft K ft = ft K 10 100 −10 = −0.1 mA; therefore 100 k iO = 10 + 0.1 = 10.1 mA is well under iOmax = 20 mA. At the negative peak of the output voltage, v O = −10 V, iL = −10 mA, i = 0.1 mA, and iO = −10.1 mA, again well under the 20-mA maximum allowed. (b) RL = 200 If output is at its peak: iL = 10 V = 50 mA 0.2 which exceeds iOmax = 20 mA. Therefore v O cannot go as high as 10 V. Instead: For the same closed-loop gain, the noninverting configuration realizes a higher GBP, and it is independent of the closed-loop gain and equal to ft of the op amp. 20 mA = vp = vO 20 vO + ⇒ vO = 4V 200 100 k 5.01 4 = 0.04 V = 40 mV 100 (c) RL = ?, iOmax = 20 mA = 2.111 The peak value of the largest possible sine wave that can be applied at the input without output clipping is ±14 V = 0.14 V = 140 mV. 100 140 Thus the rms value = √ 100 mV 2 20 − 0.1 = 10 V 10 V + RLmin 100 k 10 ⇒ RLmin = 502 RLmin 2.113 Op-amp slew rate = 10 V/μs. For the input pulse to rise 2 V, it will take 2 = 0.2 μs. 10 Chapter 2–38 ∴ The minimum pulse width = W = 0.2 μs dv O = SR ⇒ 10ωmax = 40 × 10+6 ⇒ ωmax dt max The output will be a triangular with 2-V peak and 10 V/μs slopes. = 4 × 106 rad/s ⇒ fmax = 637 kHz vi (V) 2.116 (a) Vi = 0.5, Vo = 10 × 0.5 = 5 V 2 Output distortion will be due to slew-rate limitation and will occur at the frequency for dv O which = SR dt max t W ωmax × 5 = 10 × 106 ωmax = 2 × 106 rad/s and fmax = 318.3 kHz vO (V) (b) The output will distort at the value of Vi that dv O results in = SR. dt max 2 ω × 10Vimax = SR t Vimax = 10 × 106 = 0.795 V 2π × 200 × 103 × 10 (c) Vi = 50 mV Vo = 500 mV = 0.5 V 2.114 Slope of the triangle wave = Thus 10 V = SR T /2 10 × 2 = 20 V/μs T ⇒ T = 1 μs or f = ⇒f = 1 = 1 MHz T For a sine wave vO = V̂o sin (2π × 1 × 106 t) dv O = 2π × 1 × 106 V̂o = SR dt max ⇒ V̂o = 20 × 106 = 3.18 V 2π × 106 × 1 2.115 v O = 10 sin ωt ⇒ = 10ω cos ωt ⇒ Slew rate begins at the frequency for which ω × 0.5 = SR dv O dt dv O dt max 10 × 106 = 3.18 MHz 2π × 0.5 However, the small-signal 3-dB frequency is f3dB = ft 1+ R2 R1 = 20 × 106 = 2 MHz 10 Thus the useful frequency range is limited to 2 MHz. (d) For f = 50 kHz, the slew-rate limitation occurs at the value of Vi given by ωi × 10Vi = SR ⇒ Vi = 10 × 106 2π × 50 × 103 × 10 = 3.18 V = 10ω Such an input voltage, however, would ideally result in an output of 31.8 V, which exceeds VOmax . The highest frequency at which this output is possible is that for which Thus Vimax = VOmax = 1 V peak. 10 Exercise 3–1 Ex: 3.1 Refer to Fig. 3.3(a). For v I ≥ 0, the diode conducts and presents a zero voltage drop. Thus v O = v I . For v I < 0, the diode is cut off, zero current flows through R, and v O = 0. The result is the transfer characteristic in Fig. E3.1. (c) V5V I0A Ex: 3.2 See Fig. 3.3a and 3.3b. During the positive half of the sinusoid, the diode is forward biased, so it conducts resulting in v D = 0. During the negative half cycle of the input signal v I , the diode is reverse biased. The diode does not conduct, resulting in no current flowing in the circuit. So v O = 0 and v D = v I − v O = v I . This results in the waveform shown in Fig. E3.2. 2.5 k 5 V (d) V0V 10 V vˆI = = 10 mA R 1 k 1 dc component of v O = vˆO π 1 10 = vˆI = π π = 3.18 V 05 2.5 2 mA Ex: 3.3 îD = I 2.5 k 5 V (e) I 3V Ex: 3.4 0 V3V 2V (a) 0 1V 5 V I 2.5 k I 1 k 50 2 mA 2.5 (f) 3 3 mA 1 5 V V0V 1 k 0 3 V (b) 0 2 V 5 V 1 V 2.5 k I0A V5V I Ex: 3.5 Vavg = 10 π 10 10 k 50 + R = π = 1 mA π ∴ R = 3.133 k 51 1 4 mA I V1V Exercise 3–2 R 10 k Ex: 3.6 I2 V2 − V1 = 2.3 V T log I1 At room temperature VT = 25 mV VCC 5 V 10 V2 − V1 = 2.3 × 25 × 10−3 × log 0.1 I2 I1 I2 V2 = V1 + 2.3 × VT log I1 V2 − V1 = 2.3 × VT log Ex: 3.7 i = IS ev /VT (1) 1 (mA) = IS e (2) 0.7/VT Dividing (1) by (2), we obtain (v −0.7)/VT ⇒ v = 0.7 + 0.025 ln(i) where i is in mA. Thus, VD = 115 mV i (mA) = e ID First iteration V2 = 0.7 + 2.3 × 25 × 10−3 log = 0.679 V Second iteration 5 − 0.679 = 0.432 mA I2 = 10 k V2 = 0.7 + 2.3 × 25.3 × 10−3 log for i = 0.1 mA, v = 0.7 + 0.025 ln(0.1) = 0.64 V = 0.679 V 0.68 V and for i = 10 mA, we get almost the same voltage. v = 0.7 + 0.025 ln(10) = 0.76 V 0.43 1 0.432 1 ∴ The iteration yields ID = 0.43 mA, VD = 0.68 V Ex: 3.8 T = 125 − 25 = 100◦ C b. Use constant voltage drop model: IS = 10−14 × 1.15T VD = 0.7 V = 1.17 × 10−8 A Ex: 3.9 At 20◦ C I = constant voltage drop 5 − 0.7 = 0.43 mA ID = 10 k 1V = 1 μA 1 M Ex: 3.11 Since the reverse leakage current doubles for every 10◦ C increase, at 40◦ C 10 V I R I = 4 × 1 μA = 4 μA ⇒ V = 4 μA × 1 M = 4.0 V @ 0◦ C I= 1 μA 4 2.4 V 1 ⇒ V = × 1 = 0.25 V 4 Ex: 3.10 a. Use iteration: Diode has 0.7 V drop at 1 mA current. Assume VD = 0.7 V ID = 5 − 0.7 = 0.43 mA 10 k Diodes have 0.7 V drop at 1 mA ∴ 1 mA = IS e0.7/VT (1) At a current I (mA), I = IS eVD /VT Use Eq. (3.5) and note that Using (1) and (2), we obtain V1 = 0.7 V, I1 = 1 mA I = e(VD −0.7)/VT (2) Exercise 3–3 For an output voltage of 2.4 V, the voltage drop 2.4 = 0.8 V across each diode = 3 Now I, the current through each diode, is (d) V 0.7 V I = e(0.8−0.7)/0.025 = 54.6 mA 10 − 2.4 R= 54.6 × 10−3 0.7 5 2.5 1.72 mA I 2.5 k = 139 5 V (e) Ex: 3.12 I 3V (a) 0 5 V V 3 0.7 2.3 V 2V 0 1V 2.5 k 5 0.7 I 1.72 mA 2.5 2.3 1 2.3 mA I V 0.7 V 1 k (f) 5V 5 1.7 1 3.3 mA I (b) 5 V 3 V 2.5 k V 1 0.7 0 2 V I0A 1 k 1.7 V 0 1 V I V5V (c) Ex: 3.13 rd = VT ID ID = 0.1 mA rd = 25 × 10−3 = 250 0.1 × 10−3 ID = 1 mA rd = 25 × 10−3 = 25 1 × 10−3 ID = 10 mA rd = 25 × 10−3 = 2.5 10 × 10−3 V5V Ex: 3.14 For small signal model, iD = v D /rd 2.5 k I0A where rd = VT ID For exponential model, 5 V iD = IS eV /V T (1) Exercise 3–4 iD2 = e(V2 −V1 ) /V T = ev D /V T iD1 iD = iD2 − iD1 = iD1 ev D /V T − iD1 = iD1 ev D /V T − 1 c. If iD = 5 − i L = 5 − 1 = 4 mA. (2) In this problem, iD1 = ID = 1 mA. Using Eqs. (1) and (2) with VT = 25 mV, we obtain v D (mV) iD (mA) iD (mA) small exponential signal model a b c d − 10 −5 +5 + 10 − 0.4 − 0.2 + 0.2 + 0.4 − 0.33 − 0.18 + 0.22 + 0.49 Across each diode the voltage drop is ID VD = VT ln IS 4 × 10−3 = 25 × 10−3 × ln 4.7 × 10−16 = 0.7443 V Voltage drop across 4 diodes = 4 × 0.7443 = 2.977 V so change in VO = 2.977 − 3 = −23 mV. Ex: 3.16 For a zener diode VZ = VZ0 + IZ rZ 10 = VZ0 + 0.01 × 50 VZ0 = 9.5 V Ex: 3.15 For IZ = 5 mA, 15 V VZ = 9.5 + 0.005 × 50 = 9.75 V For IZ = 20 mA, R IL VO VZ = 9.5 + 0.02 × 50 = 10.5 V Ex: 3.17 15 V R I 5.6 V a. In this problem, VO 20 mV = 20 . = iL 1 mA ∴ Total small-signal resistance of the four diodes = 20 20 ∴ For each diode, rd = = 5 . 4 VT 25 mV ⇒5= . But rd = ID ID ∴ ID = 5 mA 15 − 3 = 2.4 k. 5 mA b. For VO = 3 V, voltage drop across each diode 3 = = 0.75 V 4 and R = iD = IS eV /VT IS = iD eV /VT = 5 × 10−3 = 4.7 × 10−16 A e0.75/0.025 0 to 15 mA The minimum zener current should be 5 × IZk = 5 × 1 = 5 mA Since the load current can be as large as 15 mA, we should select R so that with IL = 15 mA, a zener current of 5 mA is available. Thus the current should be 20 mA, leading to R= 15 − 5.6 = 470 20 mA Maximum power dissipated in the diode occurs when IL = 0 is Pmax = 20 × 10−3 × 5.6 = 112 mV Exercise 3–5 a. The diode starts conduction at Ex: 3.18 v S = VD = 0.7 V 15 V √ v S = Vs sin ωt, here Vs = 12 2 I 200 15 5.1 49.5 mA 0.2 k 50 mA At ωt = θ, VZ v S = Vs sin θ = VD = 0.7 V √ 12 2 sin θ = 0.7 0.7 θ = sin−1 2.4◦ √ 12 2 Conduction starts at θ and stops at 180 − θ. Thus, at no load VZ 5.1 V ∴ Total conduction angle = 180 − 2θ = 175.2◦ For line regulation: b. v O,avg vo 200 vi vo 7 mV = = 33.8 vi 200 + 7 V 200 VO IL rZ V O −IL (rZ 200 ) = IL IL mA = −6.8 (Vs sin φ − VD ) d φ θ 1 [−Vs cos φ − VD φ]φ=π−θ φ−θ 2π 1 [Vs cos θ − Vs cos (π − θ) − VD (π − 2θ)] = 2π But cos θ 1, cos (π − θ) − 1, and π − 2θ π VD 2Vs − 2π 2 VD Vs − = π 2 √ For Vs = 12 2 and VD = 0.7 V √ 12 2 0.7 v O,avg = − = 5.05 V π 2 c. The peak diode current occurs at the peak diode voltage. √ 12 2 − 0.7 V − VD ∴ îD = s = R 100 = 163 mA √ PIV = +V S = 12 2 v O,avg = For load regulation: VZ0 (π−θ ) = 7 Line regulation = 1 = 2π 17 V mV mA Ex: 3.20 vS input Ex: 3.19 Vs vS Vs 12 2 output VD 0 ( ) VD 0 u u 2 t VS a. As shown in the diagram, the output is zero between (π − θ) to (π + θ) = 2θ t Exercise 3–6 Here θ is the angle at which the input signal reaches VD . Vs ∴ Vs sin θ = VD VD θ = sin−1 Vs VD 2θ = 2 sin−1 Vs (a) VO,avg = π . 2 Peak current Vs − VD Vs sin (π /2) − VD = = R R If v S is 12 V(rms), √ √ then Vs = 2 × 12 = 12 2 √ 12 2 − 0.7 Peak current = 163 mA 100 Nonzero output occurs for angle = 2 (π − 2θ ) The fraction of the cycle for which v O > 0 is 2 (π − 2θ) × 100 2π 0.7 2 π − 2 sin−1 √ 12 2 × 100 = 2π = (Vs sin φ − 2VD ) d φ cos (π − θ) ≈ − 1 π − 2θ ≈ π. Thus ⇒ VO,avg 2Vs − 2VD π √ 2 × 12 2 − 1.4 = 9.4 V = π Peak voltage (b) Peak diode current = R √ Vs − 2VD 12 2 − 1.4 = = R 100 = 156 mA √ PIV = Vs − VD = 12 2 − 0.7 = 16.3 V Ex: 3.22 Full-wave peak rectifier: D1 vO vS vS 97.4 % Average output voltage VO is √ Vs 2 × 12 2 VO = 2 − VD = − 0.7 = 10.1 V π π Peak diode current îD is √ Vs − VD 12 2 − 0.7 îD = = R 100 1 2π 2 [−Vs cos φ − 2VD φ]π−θ φ=θ 2π 1 = [Vs cos φ − Vs cos(π − θ) − 2VD (π − 2θ)] π But cos θ ≈ 1, for θ small. c. Peak current occurs when φ = Vs 2V sin–1 D VS = 1 −θ [−Vs cos φ − VD φ]πφ=θ π Vs − VD , π input t 0 θ 2 output 2VD b. Average value of the output signal is given by ⎡ ⎤ (π −θ) 1 ⎣ 2× VO = (Vs sin φ − VD ) d φ ⎦ 2π = Ex: 3.21 R C D2 Vp t Vr{ assume ideal diodes t = 163 mA PIV = Vs − VD + VS √ √ = 12 2 − 0.7 + 12 2 = 33.2 V T 2 The ripple voltage is the amount of voltage reduction during capacitor discharge that occurs Exercise 3–7 when the diodes are not conducting. The output voltage is given by If t = 0 is at the peak, the maximum diode current occurs at the onset of conduction or at t = −ωt. v O = Vp e−t/RC During conduction, the diode current is given by T /2 Vp − Vr = Vp e− RC ← discharge is only half T . the period. We also assumed t 2 T /2 Vr = Vp 1 − e− RC T /2 , for CR RC T /2 Thus Vr Vp 1 − 1 + RC T /2 e− RC 1 − Vr = Vp 2fRC (a) T/2 Q.E.D. QSUPPLIED = QLOST iCav t = CV r Vp Vp iD,av − IL t = C = 2fRC 2fR Vp π ωR iD,av = Vp π + IL ωtR where ωt is the conduction angle. Note that the conduction angle has the same expression as for the half-wave rectifier and is given by Eq. (3.30), 2Vr ∼ ωt = (b) Vp Substituting for ωt, we get ⇒ iD,av = πVp 2Vr ·R Vp = IL 1 + π d v S + iL dt t=−ωt assuming iL is const. iL Vp = IL R d Vp cos ωt + IL dt = −C sin ω t × ωVp + IL =C = −C sin(−ωt) × ωVp + IL For a small conduction angle Vp 2Vr ⇒ iD,max = Cωt × ωVp + IL Sub (b) to get 2V r iD,max = C ωVp + IL Vp Substituting ω = 2πf and using (a) together with Vp /R IL results in Vp Q.E.D. iDmax = IL 1 + 2π 2Vr Ex: 3.23 D4 ac line voltage D1 vO vS R D2 C D3 + IL Since the output is approximately held at Vp , Vp ≈ IL · Thus R Vp ⇒ iD,av ∼ + IL = π IL 2Vr iD,max = C sin(−ωt) ≈ − ωt. Thus To find the average diode current, note that the charge supplied to C during conduction is equal to the charge lost during discharge. = iD = iC + iL Q.E.D. The output voltage, v O , can be expressed as v O = Vp − 2VD e−t/RC At the end of the discharge interval v O = Vp − 2VD − Vr The discharge occurs almost over half of the time period T /2. For time constant RC T 2 Exercise 3–8 e−t/RC 1 − T 1 × 2 RC Ex: 3.24 1 T ∴ VP − 2VD − Vr = Vp − 2VD 1 − × 2 RC ⇒ Vr = Vp − 2VD i vI i T × 2RC iD vO √ Here Vp = 12 2 and Vr = 1 V iR VD = 0.8 V T= 1 k 1 1 = s f 60 √ 1 = (12 2 − 2 × 0.8) × 1 2 × 60 × 100 × C √ (12 2 − 1.6) C= = 1281 μF 2 × 60 × 100 Without considering the ripple voltage, the dc output voltage √ = 12 2 − 2 × 0.8 = 15.4 V If ripple voltage is included, the output voltage is √ Vr = 14.9 V = 12 2 − 2 × 0.8 − 2 IL = vA vD 14.9 0.15 A 100 The conduction angle ωt can be obtained using √ Eq. (3.30) but substituting Vp = 12 2 − 2 × 0.8: 2Vr 2×1 ωt = = √ Vp 12 2 − 2 × 0.8 The average and peak diode currents can be calculated using Eqs. (3.34) and (3.35): Vp 14.9 V iDav = IL 1 + π , , where IL = 2Vr 100 √ Vp = 12 2 − 2 × 0.8, and Vr = 1 V; thus iDmax = I 1 + 2π iD = IS ev D /VT iD = e(v D −0.7)/V T 1 mA iD ⇒ v D = VT ln + 0.7 V 1 mA For v I = 10 mV, v O = v I = 10 mV It is an ideal op amp, so i+ = i− = 0. 10 mV = 10 μA 1 k 10 μA + 0.7 = 0.58 V v D = 25 × 10−3 ln 1 mA ∴ iD = iR = v A = v D + 10 mV = 0.58 + 0.01 = 0.59 V For v I = 1 V = 0.36 rad = 20.7◦ iDav = 1.45 A The diode has 0.7 V drop at 1 mA current. Vp 2Vr vO = vI = 1 V 1 vO = = 1 mA 1 k 1 k v D = 0.7 V iD = VA = 0.7 V + 1 k × 1 mA = 1.7 V For v I = −1 V, the diode is cut off. ∴ vO = 0 V v A = −12 V = 2.76 A PIV of the diodes Ex: 3.25 √ = VS − VDO = 12 2 − 0.8 = 16.2 V To provide a safety margin, select a diode capable of a peak current of 3.5 to 4A and having a PIV rating of 20 V. vI vO R IL Exercise 3–9 v I ≥ 0 ∼ diode is cut off, loop is open, and the opamp is saturated: vO = 0 V v I ≤ 0 ∼ diode conducts and closes the negative feedback loop: vO = vI For v I ≤ −5 V, diode D1 conducts and 1 (+v I + 5) 2 vI V = −2.5 + 2 For v I ≥ 5 V, diode D2 conducts and v O = −5 + 1 (v I − 5) 2 vI V = 2.5 + 2 v O = +5 + Ex: 3.26 10 k 10 k Both diodes are cut off for −5V ≤ v I ≤ + 5V and v O = v I vO 5V v O vI D2 D1 5V Ex: 3.27 Reversing the diode results in the peak output voltage being clamped at 0 V: 10 k t 10 V Here the dc component of v O = VO = −5 V Chapter 3–1 3.3 3.1 1 (a) I 1.5 V VD D1 1 V (a) Cutoff D2 V2V 2 V Conducting 1 I 2 k 1.5 V I VD 2 (3) 2 k 2.5 mA 3 V (b) (b) 3 V (a) The diode is reverse biased, thus I =0A VD = −1.5 V 2 k Conducting 3 (1) 2 1 mA I D1 1 V V1V (b) The diode is forward biased, thus VD = 0 V 2 V D2 1.5 V = 1.5 A I= 1 3.2 Refer to Fig. P3.2. (a) Diode is conducting, thus 3.4 (a) V = −3 V I= Cutoff vO +3 − (−3) = 0.6 mA 10 k 5V (b) Diode is reverse biased, thus 0 t I =0 V = +3 V V p+ = 5 V Vp− = 0 V f = 1 kHz (c) Diode is conducting, thus (b) V = +3 V I= vO +3 − (−3) = 0.6 mA 10 k (d) Diode is reverse biased, thus I =0 V = −3 V 0 t 5 V Vp+ = 0 V Vp− = −5 V f = 1 kHz Chapter 3–2 (c) D1 shorts to ground when v I > 0 and is cut off when v I < 0 whereby the output follows v I . vO vO 0 V (h) 0 t t Neither D1 nor D2 conducts, so there is no output. v O = 0 V ∼ The output is always shorted to ground as D1 conducts when v I > 0 and D2 conducts when v I < 0. (d) (i) vO = 0 V vO vO 5V 5V t t Vp+ = 5 V, Vp− = 0 V, f = 1 kHz 2.5 V Vp+ = 5 V, Vp− = −2.5 V, f = 1 kHz Both D1 and D2 conduct when v I > 0 When v I > 0, D1 is cut off and v O follows v I . (e) When v I < 0, D1 is conducting and the circuit becomes a voltage divider where the negative peak is vO 1 k × −5 V = −2.5 V 1 k + 1 k 5V 5 V t (j) vO 5V Vp+ = 5 V, Vp− = −5 V, f = 1 kHz D1 conducts when v I > 0 and D2 conducts when v I < 0. Thus the output follows the input. 2.5 V t (f) Vp+ = 5 V, Vp− = −2.5 V, vO 5V t Vp+ = 5 V, Vp− = 0 V, f = 1 kHz When v I > 0, the output follows the input as D1 is conducting. When v I < 0, D1 is cut off and the circuit becomes a voltage divider. (k) f = 1 kHz vO D1 is cut off when v I < 0 5V (g) 1V vO t t 5 V 5 V 4 V Vp+ = 1 V, Vp− = −4 V, f = 1 kH3 Vp+ = 0 V, Vp− = −5 V, f = 1 kHz When v I > 0, D1 is cut off and D2 is conducting. The output becomes 1 V. Chapter 3–3 When v I < 0, D1 is conducting and D2 is cut off. The output becomes: determine the conduction angle of D2 , (π − 2θ), where 3 = 30◦ θ = sin−1 6 Thus vO = vI + 1 V 3.5 A B X 0 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 1 Y π − 2θ = 180◦ − 60 = 120◦ 0 1 1 1 The average value of iB will be 60 × 120◦ = 20 mA iB |av = 360◦ If the peak value of v I is reduced by 10%, i.e. from 6 V to 5.4 V, the peak value of iB does not change. The conduction angle of D2 , however, changes since θ now becomes 3 θ = sin−1 = 33.75◦ 5.4 and thus X = AB, Y = A + B X and Y are the same for A=B X and Y are opposite if A = B π − 2θ = 112.5◦ 3.6 Thus the average value of iB becomes 60 × 112.5◦ = 18.75 mA iB |av = 360◦ 3.7 The case for the highest current in a single diode is when only one input is high: VY = 5 V VY ≤ 0.2 mA ⇒ R ≥ 25 k R 3.8 The maximum input current occurs when one input is low and the other two are high. 5−0 ≤ 0.2 mA R R ≥ 25 k From Fig. P3.6 we see that when v I < VB ; that is, v I < 3 V, D1 will be conducting the current I and iB will be zero. When v I exceeds the battery voltage (3 V), D1 cuts off and D2 conducts, thus steering I into the battery. Thus, iB will have the waveform shown in the figure. Its peak value will be 60 mA. To obtain the average value, we first 3.9 The analysis is shown on the circuit diagrams below. These figures belong to Problem 3.9. reverse biased 10 10 5 k 5 k 5 k V I 10 10 10 2.5 V 5 20 k I 2.5 0.1 mA 5 20 V 0.1 20 2 V (a) I0 2.5 V V 1.5 V V 1.5 2.5 1 V (b) Chapter 3–4 I = 0.25 mA 3.10 3 V V =0V 0.33 mA 12 k 1 V D1 OFF I0 √ 120 2 ≥ 4.2 k 40 The largest reverse voltage appearing across the diode is equal to the peak input voltage: √ 120 2 = 169.7 V 3.11 R ≥ D2 ON V 1 V 0.33 mA 3.12 For v I > 0 V: D is on, v O = v I , iD = v I /R For v I < 0 V: D is off, v O = 0, iD = 0 6 k 3 V (a) (a) If we assume that both D1 and D2 are conducting, then V = 0 V and the current in D2 will be [0 − (−3)]/6 = 0.5 mA. The current in the 12 k will be (3 − 0)/12 = 0.25 mA. A node equation at the common anodes node yields a negative current in D1 . It follows that our assumption is wrong and D1 must be off. Now making the assumption that D1 is off and D2 is on, we obtain the results shown in Fig. (a): I =0 V = −1 V 3 V 3.13 6 k 3 – 0 0.5 mA 6 0V 0.25 mA D1 ON D2 ON 0 – (–3) 12 0.25 mA V0 12 k 3 V (b) (b) In (b), the two resistors are interchanged. With some reasoning, we can see that the current supplied through the 6-k resistor will exceed that drawn through the 12-k resistor, leaving sufficient current to keep D1 conducting. Assuming that D1 and D2 are both conducting gives the results shown in Fig. (b): Chapter 3–5 Conduction stops at π − θ. 3.14 ∴ Fraction of cycle that current flows is R D vI 12 V π − 2θ × 100 = 25% 2π Average diode current = 1 −17 cos φ − 12φ φ = 3π/4 = 103 mA 2π 8 φ = π/4 Peak diode current 17 − 12 = 0.625 A = 8 Peak reverse voltage = vI A 12 V 0 A + 12 = 29 V 2 3.15 conduction occurs V RED 3V ON 0 OFF –3 V OFF GREEN OFF - D1 conducts OFF - No current flows ON - D2 conducts kT q v I = A sin θ = 12 ∼ conduction through D occurs 3.16 VT = For a conduction angle (π − 2θ ) that is 25% of a cycle where k = 1.38 × 10−23 J/K = 8.62 × 10−5 eV/K 1 π − 2θ = 2π 4 π θ= 4 A = 12/sin θ = 17 V T = 273 + x◦ C q = 1.60 × 10−19 C Thus VT = 8.62 × 10−5 + (273 × x◦ C), V ∴ Peak-to-peak sine wave voltage x [◦ C] VT [mV] = 2A = 34 V −55 0 +40 +125 Given the average diode current to be 1 2π 2π A sin φ − 12 d φ = 100 mA R 0 1 2π −17 cos φ − 12φ R φ = 0.75π = 0.1 φ = 0.25π R = 8.3 A − 12 = 0.6 A Peak diode current = R Peak reverse voltage = A + 12 = 29 V For resistors specified to only one significant digit and peak-to-peak voltage to the nearest volt, choose A = 17 so the peak-to-peak sine wave voltage = 34 V and R = 8 . 18.8 23.5 27.0 34.3 for VT = 25 mV at 17◦ C 3.17 I1 = IS e0.7/VT = 10−3 i2 = IS e0.5/VT i2 i2 = −3 = e i1 10 i2 = 0.335 μA 0.5 − 0.7 0.025 3.18 i = I S ev /0.025 ∴ 10,000IS = IS ev /0.025 Conduction starts at v I = A sin θ = 12 v = 0.230 V 17 sin θ = 12 π rad θ= 4 At v = 0.7 V, i = IS e0.7/0.025 = 1.45 × 1012 IS Chapter 3–6 3.19 I = IS eVD /VT 10−3 = IS e0.7/VT (1) For VD = 0.71 V, I = IS e0.71/VT (2) (b) VD = 0.650 V, ID = 1 mA ⇒ IS = 5.11 × 10−15 A; 10% of ID gives VD = 0.59 V (c) VD = 0.650 V, ID = 10 μA ⇒ IS = 5.11 × 10−17 A; Combining (1) and (2) gives 10% of ID gives VD = 0.59 V I = 10−3 e(0.71 − 0.7)/0.025 (d) VD = 0.700 V, ID = 100 mA ⇒ IS = 6.91 × 10−14 A; = 1.49 mA 10% of ID gives VD = 0.64 V For VD = 0.8 V, I = IS e0.8/VT (3) Combining (1) and (3) gives I = 10−3 × e(0.8 − 0.7)/0.025 3.21 The voltage across three diodes in series is 2.0 V; thus the voltage across each diode must be 0.667 V. Using ID = IS eVD /VT , the required current I is found to be 3.9 mA. If 1 mA is drawn away from the circuit, ID will be 2.9 mA, which would give VD = 0.794 V, giving an output voltage of 1.98 V. The change in output voltage is −22 mV. = 54.6 mA Similarly, for VD = 0.69 V we obtain I = 10−3 × e(0.69 − 0.7)/0.025 = 0.67 mA 3.22 and for VD = 0.6 V we have I I = 10−3 e(0.6 − 0.7)/0.025 = 18.3 μA To increase the current by a factor of 10, VD must be increased by VD , 10 = e ⇒ ID1 D1 VD /0.025 −VD /VT Let a decrease by a factor of 10 in ID result in a decrease of VD by V: ID = IS eVD /VT ID = IS e(VD −V)/VT = IS eVD /VT · e−V /V T 10 Taking the ratio of the above two equations, we have 10 = e V /V T ⇒ V 60 mV Thus the result in each case is a decrease in the diode voltage by 60 mV. (a) VD = 0.700 V, ID = 1 A ⇒ IS = 6.91 × 10−13 A; 10% of ID gives VD = 0.64 V D2 VD VD = 0.025 ln10 = 57.6 mV 3.20 IS can be found by using IS = ID · e ID2 . ID1 = IS1 eVD /VT (1) VD /VT (2) ID2 = IS2 e Summing (1) and (2) gives ID1 + ID2 = (IS1 + IS2 )eVD /VT But ID1 + ID2 = I Thus I = (IS1 + IS2 ) eVD /VT (3) From Eq. (3) we obtain I VD = VT ln IS1 + IS2 Also, Eq. (3) can be written as IS2 I = IS1 eVD /VT 1 + IS1 (4) Chapter 3–7 ID1 = 10I S eVD1 /VT Now using (1) and (4) gives ID1 = I IS1 =I 1 + (IS2 /IS1 ) IS1 + IS2 Taking the ratio of the two equations above, we have 7 1 V /V T 1 (VD2 −VD1 )/VT ID2 = = = e e ID1 3 10 10 70 ⇒ V = 0.025 ln = 78.7 mV 3 We similarly obtain ID2 = I IS2 =I 1 + (IS1 /IS2 ) IS1 + IS2 3.23 Connecting an identical diode in parallel would reduce the current in each diode by a factor of 2. Writing expressions for the currents, we have ID = IS eVD /VT ID = IS e(VD −V)/VT = IS eVD /VT · e−V /V T 2 Taking the ratio of the above two equations, we have 2 = eV /V T ⇒ V = 17.3 mV To instead achieve V = 60 mV, we need I1 − I2 1 0.06/0.025 ID2 e = = = 1.1 ID1 I2 10 Solving the above equation with I1 still at 10 mA, we find I2 = 4.76 mA. 3.26 We can write the following node equation at the diode anodes: ID2 = 10 mA − V /R Thus the result is a decrease in the diode voltage by 17.3 mV. ID1 = V /R We can write the following equation for the diode voltages: 3.24 V = VD2 − VD1 We can write the following diode equations: I ID2 = IS eVD2 /VT ID1 = IS eVD1 /VT D1 D2 D3 I1 2I1 4I1 D4 8I1 I1 0.1 mA The junction areas of the four diodes must be related by the same ratios as their currents, thus Taking the ratio of the two equations above, we have 10 mA − V /R ID2 = e(VD2 −VD1 )/VT = eV /V T = ID1 V /R To achieve V = 50 mV, we need 10 mA − 0.05/R ID2 = e0.05/0.025 = 7.39 = ID1 0.05/R Solving the above equation, we have R = 42 A4 = 2A3 = 4A2 = 8 A1 With I1 = 0.1 mA, I = 0.1 + 0.2 + 0.4 + 0.8 = 1.5 mA 3.25 We can write a node equation at the anodes: ID2 = I1 − I2 = 7 mA ID1 = I2 = 3 mA We can write the following equation for the diode voltages: V = VD2 − VD1 If D2 has saturation current IS , then D1 , which is 10 times larger, has saturation current 10IS . Thus we can write ID2 = IS eVD2 /VT 3.27 For a diode conducting a constant current, the diode voltage decreases by approximately 2 mV per increase of 1◦ C. T = −20◦ C corresponds to a temperature decrease of 40◦ C, which results in an increase of the diode voltage by 80 mV. Thus VD = 770 mV. T = + 85◦ C corresponds to a temperature increase of 65◦ C, which results in a decrease of the diode voltage by 130 mV. Thus VD = 560 mV. 3.28 For a diode conducting a constant current, the diode voltage decreases by approximately 2 mV per increase of 1◦ C. A decrease in VD by 100 mV corresponds to a junction temperature increase of 50◦ C. Chapter 3–8 Taking the ratio of the above two equations, we have The power dissipation is given by PD = (10 A) (0.6 V) = 6 W ID1 = IS e(VD1 −VD2 )/VT ⇒ VD1 − VD2 ID2 ID1 = VT ln ID2 The thermal resistance is given by 50◦ C T = 8.33◦ C/W = PD 6W 3.29 For ID = 1 mA, we have 1 × 10−3 A = −230 mV V = VT ln 10 A 10 V I R1 ⇒ VD = 570 mV D1 V1 D2 V2 For ID = 3 mA, we have 3 × 10−3 A = −202 mV V = VT ln 10 A ⇒ VD = 598 mV Assuming VD changes by –2 mV per 1◦ C increase in temperature, we have, for ±20◦ C changes: For ID = 1 mA, 530 mV ≤ VD ≤ 610 mV At 20◦ C: For ID = 3 mA, 558 mV ≤ VD ≤ 638 mV VR1 = V2 = 520 mV R1 = 520 k 520 mV = 1 μA I= 520 k Since the reverse current doubles for every 10◦ C rise in temperature, at 40◦ C, I = 4 μA ID2 40°C 4 μA 40 mV 520 mV V2 = 480 + 2.3 × 1 × 25 log 4 = 514.6 mV VR1 = 4 μA × 520 k = 2.08 V 1 μA 4 V2 = 560 − 2.3 × 1 × 25 log 4 At 0◦ C, I = = 525.4 mV 1 VR1 = × 520 = 0.13 V 4 3.30 Given two different voltage/current measurements for a diode, we can write ID1 = IS eVD1 /VT ID2 = IS eVD2 /VT 3.31 Given two different voltage/current measurements for a diode, we have ID1 = IS e(VD1 −VD2 )/VT ⇒ VD1 − VD2 ID2 ID1 = VT ln ID2 20°C For the first diode, with ID = 0.1 mA and 1 μA 480 Thus the overall range of VD is between 530 mV and 638 mV. V2 VD = 700 mV, we have ID = 1 mA: 1.0 = 57.6 mV 0.1 ⇒ VD = 757.6 mV V = VT ln ID = 3 mA: V = VT ln 3 0.1 = 85 mV ⇒ VD = 785 mV For the second diode, with ID = 1 A and VD = 700 mV, we have ID = 1.0 mA: 0.001 V = VT ln = −173 mV 1 ⇒ VD = 527 mV Chapter 3–9 ID = 3 mA: 0.003 1 ⇒ VD = 555 mV = 0.661 V For i = 0.4 mA, v = 0.668 V = −145 mV V = VT ln Now we can refine the diagram to obtain a better estimate For both ID = 1.0 mA and ID = 3 mA, the difference between the two diode voltages is approximately 230 mV. Since, for a fixed diode current, the diode voltage changes with temperature at a constant rate (–2 mV per ◦ C temp. increase), this voltage difference will be independent of temperature! 0.4 i (mA) 0.35 Load line 3.32 R 1 kΩ VDD i v 1V 0.30 0.660 0.664 v (V) 0.67 From this graph we get the operating point IS = 10−15 A = 10−12 mA i = 0.338 mA, v = 0.6635 V Calculate some points Now we compare graphical results with the exponential model. v = 0.6 V, i = IS ev /V T At i = 0.338 mA i 0.338 = 0.025 × ln v = VT ln IS 10−12 = 10−12 e0.6/0.025 0.03 mA v = 0.65 V, v = 0.7 V, i i 0.2 mA = 0.6637 V 1.45 mA Make a sketch showing these points and load line and determine the operating point. The points for the load line are obtained using ID = VDD − VD R The difference between the exponential model and graphical results is = 0.6637 − 0.6635 = 0.0002 V = 0.2 mV 3.33 i (mA) 500 2.0 Diode characteristic 1V 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 i v Load line 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 v (V) From this sketch one can see that the operating point must lie between v = 0.65 V to v = 0.7 V i For i = 0.3 mA, v = VT ln IS 3 = 0.025 × ln 10−12 1 − 0.7 = 0.6 mA 0.5 k b) Diode has 0.7 V drop at 1 mA current. Use Eq. (3.5): i2 v 2 = v 1 + 2.3VT log i1 a) ID = 1. v = 0.7 V 1 − 0.7 = 0.6 mA 1 i= 0.5 k Chapter 3–10 2. v = 0.7 + 2.3 × 0.025 log 0.6 1 0.825 V. Applying this voltage to the diode gives current ID = 20.1 mA. We can then find the resistor value using = 0.6872 V 1 − 0.6872 = 0.6255 mA 2 i= 0.5 0.6255 3. v = 0.7 + 2.3 × 0.025 log 1 R= 3.36 Constant voltage drop model: = 0.6882 V 1 − 0.6882 = 0.6235 mA 3 i= 0.5 k 0.6235 4. v = 0.7 + 2.3 × 0.025 log 1 V − 0.7 R V − 0.6 Using v D = 0.6 V, ⇒ iD2 = R For the difference in currents to be only 1%, Using v D = 0.7 V, ⇒ iD1 = = 0.6882 V 1 − 0.6882 = 0.6235 mA 4 i= 0.5 k Stop as we are getting the same result. 3.34 ⇒ iD2 = 1.01iD1 V − 0.6 = 1.01 (V − 0.7) V = 10.7 V R 1 k 1V ID 15 V − 3.3 V = 582 20.1 mA VD For V = 3 V and R = 1 k: 3 − 0.7 = 2.3 mA At VD = 0.7 V, iD1 = 1 3 − 0.6 = 2.4 mA At VD = 0.6 V, iD2 = 1 2.4 iD2 = 1.04 = iD1 2.3 Thus the percentage difference is 4%. IS = 10−15 A = 10−12 mA Use the iterative analysis procedure: 1 − 0.7 = 0.3 mA 1. VD = 0.7 V, ID = 1K ID 0.3 = 0.025 ln 2. VD = VT ln IS 10−12 || 3.37 Available diodes have 0.7 V drop at 2 mA current since 2VD = 1.4 V is close to 1.3 V, use N parallel pairs of diodes to split the 1 mA current evenly, as shown in the figure next. N = 0.6607 V 1 − 0.6607 = 0.3393 mA 1K 0.3393 = 0.6638 V 3. VD = 0.025 ln 10−12 ID = 1 − 0.6638 = 0.3362 mA 1K 0.3362 = 0.6635 V 4. VD = 0.025 ln 10−12 ID = 1 − 0.6635 = 0.3365 mA 1 k Stop here as we are getting almost same value of ID and VD ID = 3.35 We first find the value of IS for the diode, given by IS = ID e−VD /VT with ID = 1 mA and VD = 0.75 V. This gives IS = 9.36 × 10−17 A. In order to have 3.3 V across the 4 series-connected diodes, each diode drop must be ⫹ V 1 mA ⫺ The voltage drop across each pair of diodes is 1.3 V. ∴ Voltage drop across each diode 1.3 = = 0.65 V. Using 2 I2 = I1 e(V2 −V1 )/VT = 2e(0.65−0.7)/0.025 = 0.2707 mA Thus current through each branch is 0.2707 mA. The 1 mA will split in = 1 = 3.69 branches. 0.2707 Choose N = 4. There are 4 pairs of diodes in parallel. Chapter 3–11 ∴ We need 8 diodes. 3.39 Current through each pair of diodes 1 mA = 0.25 mA = 4 ∴ Voltage across each pair 0.25 = 2 0.7 + 0.025 ln 2 (a) 3 V 10 k = 1.296 V V SPECIAL NOTE: There is another possible design utilizing only 6 diodes and realizing a voltage of 1.313 V. It consists of the series connection of 4 parallel diodes and 2 parallel diodes. I 3 V V = −3 + 0.7 = −2.3 V 3 + 2.3 I= 10 = 0.53 mA 3.38 Refer to Example 3.2. (a) (b) 10 V 5 I 1.861 10 k 0.86 mA 4 3 V 10 0 1 mA 10 10 k V0V 3 V 1 0.7 V 5 k 2 0.7 10 5 1.86 mA Cutoff I 3 V 10 V I =0A (b) V = 3 − I (10) = 3 V 10 V 5 k ID2 I0 V 0.7 V Cutoff 10 k (c) I V 10 k ID2 10 V 10 − (−10) − 0.7 = 1.29 mA 15 VD = −10 + 1.29 (10) + 0.7 = 3.6 V ID2 = 3 V 3 V V = 3 − 0.7 = 2.3 V 2.3 + 3 = 0.53 mA I= 10 Chapter 3–12 3.41 (d) 3 V +3V I Cutoff ID2 12 k V I0 ON 0.7 V D2 V D1 ID2 Cutoff 3 V 6 k I =0A 3 V (a) V = −3 V 3V 3.40 (a) 30.7 0.383 mA 6 Cutoff 1 V 0.7 V D1 2 V 6 k V D2 2 k I 0.383 0.25 0.133 mA ON D2 D1 ON 0(3) 12 0.25 mA I V0V 12 k 3 V 3 V (b) 3 − 0.7 − (−3) = 0.294 mA 12 + 6 V = −3 + 0.294 × 6 = −1.23 V V = 2 − 0.7 (a) ID2 = = 1.3 V 1.3 − (−3) I= 2 = 2.15 mA Check that D1 is off: Voltage at the anode of D1 = V + VD2 = −1.23 + 0.7 = −0.53 V which keeps D1 off. (b) (b) See analysis on Fig. (b). 3 V I = 0.133 mA I 2 k V =0V 3.42 1 V D1 V 10 10 5 k 0.7 V V 2 V D2 Cutoff V = 1 + 0.7 = 1.7 V 3 − 1.7 = 0.65 mA I= 2 10 5 10 10 2.5 V I 20 k (a) Chapter 3–13 5 k V 5 k 0 mA 1.5 V 2.5 V Maximum allowable voltage signal change when the current change is limited to ±10% is found as follows: The current varies from 0.9 to 1.1 iD2 = eV /VT iD1 (b) For 0.9, V = 25 ln (0.9) = −2.63 mV 2.5 − 0.7 (a) I = = 0.072 mA 5 + 20 V = 0.072 × 20 = 1.44 V For 1.1, V = 25 ln (1.1) = +2.38 mV For ±10% current change the voltage signal change is from –2.63 mV to +2.38 mV (b) The diode will be cut off, thus I =0 3.45 The dc current I flows through the diode VT and giving rise to the diode resistance rd = I the small-signal equivalent circuit is represented by V = 1.5 − 2.5 = −1 V 3.43 Rs vI iD v I ,peak − 0.7 ≤ 40 mA R √ 120 2 − 0.7 R≥ = 4.23 k 40 √ Reverse voltage = 120 2 = 169.7 V. iD,peak = rd vs R rd VT /I VT = vs = vs VT rd + RS VT + IRS + RS I 25 mV Now, v o = 10 mV × 25 mV + 103 I vo = vs × I vo The design is essentially the same since the supply voltage 0.7 V 1 mA 0.24 mV 0.1 mA 2.0 mV 1 μA 9.6 mV 3.44 Use the exponential diode model to find the percentage change in the current. 1 0.025 vs = vs × 2 0.025 + 103 I ⇒ I = 25 μA iD = IS ev /VT iD2 = e(V2 −V1 )/VT = ev /VT iD1 For +5 mV change we obtain iD2 = e5/25 = 1.221 iD1 % change 1.221 − 1 iD2 − iD1 × 100 = × 100 = iD1 1 = 22.1% For –5 mV change we obtain iD2 = e−5/25 = 0.818 iD1 0.818 − 1 iD2 − iD1 × 100 × 100 = % change = iD1 1 = −18.1% vo For v o = 3.46 As shown in Problem 3.45, VT 0.025 vo = = vi VT + RS I 0.025 + 104 I Here RS = 10 k (1) The current changes are limited ±10%. Using exponential model, we get iD2 = ev /VT = 0.9 to 1.1 iD1 iD2 and here v = 25 × 10−3 ln iD1 For 0.9, v = −2.63 mV For 1.1, v = 2.38 mV The variation is –2.63 mV to 2.38 mV for ±10% current variation. Thus the largest symmetrical Chapter 3–14 output signal allowed is 2.38 mV in amplitude. To obtain the corresponding input signal, we divide this by (v o /v i ): vˆs = 2.38 mV v o /v i (2) Now for the given values of v o /v i calculate I and v̂ S using Equations (1) and (2) vo vi I in mA v̂ s in mV 0.5 0.1 0.01 0.001 0.0025 0.0225 0.2475 2.4975 vo = 900 × 10−3 = 0.9 V/V vi vo = 990 × 10−3 = 0.99 V/V I = 990 μA, vi I = 900 μA, I = 1 mA = 1000 μA, vo = 1000 × 10−3 = 1 V/V vi 3.48 4.76 23.8 238 2380 I D1 D3 3.47 vo 1 mA C 2 vo C1 D1 vi R D2 D2 10 k D4 vi I I When both D1 and D2 are conducting, the small-signal model is rd1 vi vo rd2 where we have replaced the large capacitors C1 and C2 by short circuits: rd 2 vo = vi rd 1 + rd 2 Thus vo = I, vi VT I 1 m −I = = VT VT 1m + I 1m−I where I is in mA Now I = 0 μA, vo =0 vi vo = 1 × 10−3 = 0.001 V/V vi vo = 10 × 10−3 = 0.01 V/V = 10 μA, vi vo = 100 × 10−3 = 0.1 V/V = 100 μA, vi vo = 500 × 10−3 = 0.5 V/V = 500 μA, vi vo = 600 × 10−3 = 0.6 V/V = 600 μA, vi a. The current through each diode is I : 2 2VT VT 0.05 = = I I I 2 From the equivalent circuit rd = R vo = vi R + (2rd I 2rd ) = R R + rd vo vi rd 0 μA ∞ 0 1 μA 50 k 0.167 10 μA 5 k 0.667 100 μA 500 0.952 1 mA 50 0.995 10 mA 5 0.9995 I = 1 μA, I I I I rd rd rd rd vo vI R Equivalent Circuit 10 k Chapter 3–15 b. For signal current to be limited to ±10% of I (I is the biasing current), the change in diode voltage can be obtained from the equation v̂ i = v̂ o + 5 mV = 1 V + 5 mV = 1.005 V. See also the figure below. iD = eVD /V T = 0.9 to 1.1 I v D = −2.63 mV to +2.32 mV ±2.5 mV so the signal voltage across each diode is limited to 2.5 mV when the diode current remains within 10% of the dc bias current. ∴ v o = 10 − 2.5 − 2.5 = 5 mV 5 mV = 0.5 μA and i = 10 k 2.5 mV 2.5 mV 3.49 i vo 10 mV R 2.5 mV I 10 k 2.5 mV D1 The current through each diode 0.5 μA = 0.25 μA 2 The signal current i is 0.5 μA, and this is 10% of the dc biasing current. = vI i2 D2 i1 i3 v1 v3 v 2 v4 D3 iO vO i4 R 10 k D4 I ∴ DC biasing current I = 0.5 × 10 = 5 μA c. Now I = 1 mA. ∴ ID = 0.5 mA Maximum current derivation 10%. 0.5 = 0.05 mA ∴ id = 10 and i = 2id = 0.1 mA. ∴ Maximum v o = i × 10 k = 0.1 × 10 =1V I = 1 mA Each diode exhibits 0.7 V drop at 1 mA current. Using diode exponential model we have i2 v 2 − v 1 = VT ln i1 and v 1 = 0.7 V, i1 = 1 mA i ⇒ v = 0.7 + VT ln 1 From the results of (a) above, for I = 1 mA, v o /v i = 0.995; thus the maximum input signal will be = 700 + 25 ln(i) v̂ i = v̂ o /0.995 = 1/0.995 v O = 0, iO = 0, and the current I = 1 mA divide equally between the D3 , D4 side and the D1 , D2 side. I i1 = i2 = i3 = i4 = = 0.5 mA 2 v = 700 + 25 ln(0.5) 683 mV = 1.005 V The same result can be obtained from the figure above where the signal across the two series diodes is 5 mV, thus Calculation for different values of v O : Chapter 3–16 v 1 = v 2 = v 3 = v 4 = 683 mV 3.50 Representing the diode by the small-signal resistances, the circuit is From the circuit, we have v I = −v 1 + v 3 + v O = −683 + 683 + 0 = 0 V 1 For v O = 1 V, iO = = 0.1 mA 10 k Because of symmetry of the circuit, we obtain iO I = 0.5 + 0.05 = 0.55 mA and i3 = i2 = + 2 2 i4 = i1 = 0.45 mA i2 v 3 = v 2 = 700 + 25 ln = 685 mV 1 i4 v 4 = v 1 = 700 + 25 ln = 680 mV 1 (V) iO i3 = i2 i4 = i1 v 3 = v 2 v 4 = v 1 (mA) (mA) (mA) (mV) (mV) v I = −v 1 + v 3 + v O (V) vO 0 0 0.5 0.5 683 683 0 +1 0.1 0.55 0.45 685 680 1.005 +2 0.2 0.6 0.4 ∼ 687 677 2.010 +5 0.5 0.75 0.25 ∼ 693 665 5.028 +9 0.9 0.95 0.05 ∼ 699 ∼ 625 9.074 0.995 0.005 ∼ 700 568 10.09 9.99 0.999 0.9995 0.0005 ∼ 700 510 10.18 10 1 0 10.7 rd vi C vo VT rd ID 1 sC 1 = 1 1 + sCrd rd + sC 1 Vo = Vi 1 + jωCrd ωCrd Phase shift = −tan−1 1 VT = −tan−1 ωC I Vo = Vi v I = −v 1 + v 2 + v O = −0.680 For phase shift of −45◦ , we obtain −45 = −tan−1 2π × 100 × 103 × 10 0.025 × 10−9 × I +0.685 + 1 = 1.005 V ⇒ I = 157 μA Similarly, other values are calculated as shown in the table. The largest values of v O on positive and negative side are +10 V and −10 V, respectively. This restriction is imposed by the current I = 1 mA 157 μA to 157 × 10 μA 10 Range is 15.7 μA to 1570 μA A similar table can be generated for the negative values. It is symmetrical. 3.51 + 9.9 0.99 1 0 700 Now I varies from Range of phase shift is −84.3◦ to −5.71◦ For v I > +10.7, v O will be saturated at +10 V and it is because I = 1 mA. Similarly, for v I < −10.7 V, v O will be saturated at −10 V. V R For I = 0.5 mA, the output will saturate at 0.5 mA ×10 k = 5 V. vo (V ) I 1 mA 10 I 0.5 mA 5 (a) 10.7 5.68 5.68 5 VO 10.7 v1 (V) = VO rd = = + V R + rd VT /I VT R+ I VT IR + VT For no load, I = V + − 0.7 V + − VO = . R R Chapter 3–17 ∴ VT VO = V + VT + (V + − 0.7) (b) At no load, ID = rd = R V rd VT ID VO = − (rd IL R) = − VO (b) If m diodes are in series, we obtain VO mr d mVT = = V + mr d + R mVT + IR 1 ID ID + V + − 0.7 VT =− VT × ID =− V + − 0.7 VT × ID VT + V + − 0.7 For mVT mVT + (V + − 0.7m) 1 1 1 + rd R =− Small-signal model = V + − 0.7 R 1 VT +1 V + − 0.7 mV VO ≤5 IL mA 5 mV VT V + − 0.7 ≤ × ID VT + V + − 0.7 mA mV 15 − 0.7 25 ≤5 × ID 0.025 + 15 − 0.7 mA i.e., (c) For m = 1 VO VT = = 1.75 mV/V V + VT + V + − 0.7 For m = 4 ID ≥ 4.99 mA ID 5 mA VO mVT = = 8.13 mV/V V + mVT + 15 − m × 0.7 R= 15 − 0.7 V + − 0.7 = ID 5 mA 3.52 R = 2.86 k V Diode should be a 5-mA unit; that is, it conducts 5 mA at VD = 0.7 V, thus 5 × 10−3 = IS e0.7/0.025 . R ⇒ IS = 3.46 × 10−15 A IL (c) For m diodes connected in series we have VO ID = V + − 0.7m R and rd = VO So now IL VT ID VO = −(R IL mrd ) = − rd R =− 1 ID ID + V + − 0.7m mVT =− mV T ID Small-signal model (a) From the small-signal model VO = −I L (rd R) VO = − (rd R) IL mV T +1 − 0.7m V+ =− V + − 0.7m mVT + ID V − 0.7m + mVT 1 1 1 + R mrd Chapter 3–18 choose the 15-mA supply. Note, however, that the price paid is increased power dissipation. 3.53 3.54 5 V I vO 1.5 V VO I IL R IL ID Vo ID RL IL varies from 2 to 7 mA To supply a load current of 2 to 7 mA, the current I must be greater than 7 mA. So I can be only 10 mA or 15 mA. Now let us evaluate VO for both 10-mA and 15-mA sources. For the 10-mA source: Since IL varies from 2 to 7 mA, the current ID will varry from 8 to 3 mA. Diode has 0.7 V drop at 1 mA current VO = 1.5 V when RL = 1.5 k ID = IS eV /V T 1 × 10−3 = IS e0.7/0.025 ⇒ IS = 6.91 × 10−16 A 1.5 = 0.75 V. 2 = 6.91 × 10−16 × e0.75/0.025 Voltage drop across each diode = Correspondingly, the voltage across each diode changes by VD where ∴ ID = IS eV /V T 3 =e 8 IL = 1.5/1.5 = 1 mA ⇒ VD /VT 3 VD = 25 ln = −24.5 mV 8 and the output voltage changes by VO = 2 × VD = −49 mV With I = 15 mA, the diodes current changes from 13 to 8 mA. Correspondingly, the voltage across each diode changes by VD where 8 =e 13 ⇒ VD /VT 8 VD = 25 ln = −12.1 mV 13 and the output voltage changes by VO = 2 × VD = −24.2 mV which is less than half that obtained with the 10-mA supply. Thus, from the point of view of reducing the change in VO as IL changes, we = 7.38 mA I = ID + IL = 7.39 mA + 1 mA = 8.39 mA ∴R= 5 − 1.5 = 417 8.39 mA Use a small-signal model to find voltage VO when the value of the load resistor, RL , changes: rd = VT 0.025 = 3.4 = ID 7.39 When load is disconnected, all the current I flows through the diode. Thus ID = 1 mA VO = ID × 2rd = 1 × 2 × 3.4 = 6.8 mV With RL = 1 k, Chapter 3–19 IL 1.5 V = 1.5 mA 1 IL = IL = 0.5 mA I= ID = −0.5 mA 5 − 1.4 5 − VO = = 18 mA R 0.2 ID = I − IL = 18 − 9.33 = 8.67 mA VO = −0.5 × 2 × 3.4 Iteration #2: = −3.4 mV 8.67 = 0.696 V VD = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 10 With RL = 750 , IL VO 1.4 = 9.33 mA = RL 0.15 1.5 = 2 mA 0.75 VO = 1.393 V IL = 9.287 mA IL = 1 mA ID = −1 mA I= VO = −1 × 2 × 3.4 5 − 1.393 = 18.04 mA 0.2 ID = 18.04 − 9.287 = 8.753 mA = −6.8 mV Iteration #3: With RL = 500 , IL 8.753 = 0.697 VD = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 10 1.5 = 3 mA 0.5 VO = 1.393 V IL = 2.0 mA IL = 9.287 ID = −2.0 mA I = 18.04 mA VO = −2 × 2 × 3.4 ID = 8.753 = −13.6 mV No further iterations are necessary and VO = 1.39 V 3.55 5 V (b) With no load: Iteration #1: I R 200 VD = 0.7 V VO = 1.4 V D1 ID D2 IL RL 150 VO I= 5 − 1.4 = 18 mA 0.2 ID = I = 18 mA Iteration #2: 18 VD = 0.7 + 0.025 ln = 0.715 V 10 (a) Iteration #1: VO = 1.429 V VD = 0.7 V I = 17.85 mA VO = 2VD = 1.4 V ID = 17.85 mA Chapter 3–20 Iteration #3: Iteration #3: 17.85 VD = 0.7 + 0.025 ln = 0.714 V 10 17.18 VD = 0.7 + 0.025 ln = 0.714 V 10 VO = 1.43 V VO = 1.428 V I = 17.86 mA No further iterations are needed and ID = 17.86 mA VO = 1.43 V No further iterations are warranted and (e) From the above we see that as VSupply changes from 5 V to 3.232 V (a change of −35.4%) the output voltage changes from 1.39 V to 1.29 V (a change of −7.19%). VO = 1.43 V (c) VO = 1.39 − 0.1 = 1.29 V IL = VD = 1.29 = 8.6 mA 0.15 1.29 = 0.645 V 2 As VSupply changes from 5 V to 6.786 V (a change of +35.4%) the output voltage changes from 1.39 V to 1.43 V (a change of +2.88%). Thus the worst-case situation occurs when VSupply is reduced, and ID = 10 × e(0.645−0.7)/0.025 = 1.11 mA I = IL + ID = 8.6 + 1.11 = 9.71 mA VSupply = VO + IR = 1.29 + 9.71 × 0.2 = 3.232 V which is a reduction of 1.768 V or −35.4%. (d) For VSupply = 5 + 1.786 = 6.786 V, Iteration #1: VD = 0.7 V VO = 1.4 V IL = 9.33 mA 6.768 − 1.4 I= = 26.84 0.2 ID = I − IL = 26.84 − 9.33 = 17.51 mA Iteration #2: 17.51 VD = 0.7 + 0.025 ln = 0.714 V 10 Percentage change in VO per 1% change in 7.19 = 0.2% VSupply = 35.4 3.56 VZ = VZ0 + IZT rz (a) 10 = 9.6 + 0.05 × rz ⇒ rz = 8 For IZ = 2IZT = 100 mA, VZ = 9.6 + 0.1 × 8 = 10.4 V P = 10.4 × 0.1 = 1.04 W (b) 9.1 = VZ0 + 0.01 × 30 ⇒ VZ0 = 8.8 V At IZ = 2IZT = 20 mA, VZ = 8.8 + 0.02 × 30 = 9.4 V P = 9.4 × 20 = 188 mW (c) 6.8 = 6.6 + IZT × 2 VO = 1.428 V ⇒ IZT = 0.1 A IL = 9.52 mA At IZ = 2IZT = 0.2 A, I = 26.70 mA VZ = 6.6 + 0.2 × 2 = 7 V ID = 17.18 mA P = 7 × 0.2 = 1.4 W Chapter 3–21 (d) 18 = 17.6 + 0.005 × rz At knee, ⇒ rz = 80 IZK = 0.25 mA At IZ = 2IZT = 0.01 A, VZ = 17.6 + 0.01 × 80 = 18.4 V P = 18.4 × 0.01 = 0.184 W = 184 mW (e) 7.5 = VZ0 + 0.2 × 1.5 rz = 750 FIRST DESIGN: 9-V supply can easily supply current Let IZ = 20 mA, well above knee. ⇒ VZ0 = 7.2 V ∴ R= At IZ = 2IZT = 0.4 A, VZ = 7.2 + 0.4 × 1.5 = 7.8 V 9 − 6.8 = 110 20 Line regulation = P = 7.8 × 0.4 = 3.12 W = 3.57 VZ = VZ0 + IZT rZ 9.1 = VZ0 + 0.02 × 10 VO rZ = VS rZ + R 5 5 + 110 = 43.5 ⇒ VZ0 = 8.9 V mV V SECOND DESIGN: limited current from 9-V supply At IZ = 10 mA, VZ = 8.9 + 0.01 × 10 = 9.0 V At IZ = 50 mA, VZ = 8.9 + 0.05 × 10 = 9.4 V IZ = 0.25 mA VZ = VZK VZO − calculate VZ0 from VZ = VZ0 + rZ IZT 3.58 (a) Three 6.8-V zeners provide 3 × 6.8 = 20.4 V with 3 ×10 = 30- resistance. Neglecting R, we have Load regulation = −30 mV/mA. (b) For 5.1-V zeners we use 4 diodes to provide 20.4 V with 4 ×30 = 120- resistance. Load regulation = −120 mV/mA 3.59 6.8 = VZ0 + 5 × 0.02 VZ0 = 6.7 V ∴R= 8 − 6.7 = 5.2 k 0.25 LINE REGULATION = 750 VO = VS 750 + 5200 mV V = 126 9V±1V 3.60 10 V R VO I R IZ VO VZ IZ IL GIVEN PARAMETERS VZ = 6.8V, rz = 5 (a) IZ = 20 mA RL Chapter 3–22 11 V I = R VO VZ (1.5 1.5 0.03 = 0.15 0.03) + 0.167 For VS = +1 V (10% high), and VO = 7.65 V. VO = +0.15 V For VS = −1 V (10% low), and VO = 7.35 V. VO = −0.15 V rZ When the load is removed and VS = 11 V, we can use the zener model to determine VO . Refer to Fig. (b). To determine VZ0 , we use VZ0 VZ = VZ0 + IZT rz 7.5 = VZ0 + 0.01 × 30 (b) ⇒ VZ0 = 7.2 V From Fig. (b) we have 9 V I= 11 − 7.2 = 19.3 mA 0.167 + 0.03 Thus I R VO = VZ0 + Irz VO VZ 0.5 mA IL RL = 7.2 + 0.0193 × 30 = 7.78 V To determine the smallest allowable value of RL while VS = 9 V, refer to Fig. (c). Note that IZ = 0.5 mA, thus VZ = VZK I= (c) To obtain VO = 7.5 V, we must arrange for IZ = 10 mA (the current at which the zener is specified). VZ0 = 7.2 V 9 − 7.2 = 10.69 mA 0.167 IL = I − IZ = 10.69 − 0.5 = 10.19 mA RL = VO 7.2 = = 707 IL 10.19 VO = 7.2 V Now, IL = VO 7.5 = = 5 mA RL 1.5 3.61 VS 15 V 10% Thus I = IZ + IL = 10 + 5 = 15 mA I R and VO VZ 10 − VO 10 − 7.5 R= = = 167 I 15 When the supply undergoes a change VS , the change in the output voltage, VO , can be determined from VO (RL rz ) = VS (RL rz ) + R IZ IL RL Chapter 3–23 VZ = VZ0 + IZT rz and RL is at its lowest value, to maintain regulation, the zener current must be at least equal to IZK , thus 9.1 = VZ0 + 0.009 × 40 ⇒ VZ0 = 8.74 V IZ = 0.5 mA For IZ = 10 mA, VZ = VZK VZ = 8.74 + 0.01 × 40 = 9.14 V IL = I= 9.14 = 9.14 mA 1 k 8.74 13.5 − 8.74 = 15.87 mA 0.3 IL = I − IZ = 15.87 − 0.5 = 15.37 mA I = IZ + IL = 10 + 9.14 = 19.14 mA R= VZ0 15 − 9.14 = 306 19.4 RL = VZ 8.74 = 589 = IL 15.37 Select R = 300 The lowest value of output voltage = 8.74 V Denoting the resulting output voltage VO , we obtain Line regulation = I= IL = 15 − VO 0.3 (1) VO 1 (2) VO − VZ0 VO − 8.74 = IZ = rz 0.04 = 113 mV/V Load regulation = −(rz = −(40 (3) Since I = IZ + IL , we can use (1)–(3) to obtain VO : VO − 8.74 15 − VO = + VO 0.3 0.04 VS rz (rz RL RL ) + R (0.04 1) = ±1.5 × (0.04 1) + 0.3 = ±0.17 V If IL is reduced by 50%, then IL = I= IZ = 1 9.15 × = 4.6 mA 2 1 15 − VO 0.3 Or using the results obtained in this problem: For a reduction in IL of 4.6 mA, thus Load regulation = − ⇒ VO = 9.31 V which is an increase of 0.16 V. When the supply voltage is low, VS = 13.5 V VO = +0.16 V, 160 = −35 mV/mA 4.6 3.62 (a) VZT = VZ0 + rz IZT 10 = VZ0 + 7 (0.025) ⇒ VZ0 = 9.825 V (b) The minimum zener current of 5 mA occurs when IL = 20 mA and VS is at its minimum of 20(1 − 0.25) = 15 V. See the circuit below: VS 15 V R VO − 8.74 0.04 15 − VO VO − 8.74 = + 4.6 0.3 0.04 R) 300) = −35 mV/mA ⇒ VO = 9.15 V VO = 170 mV 1.5 V 20 mA VO IZmin 5 mA IZ RL Chapter 3–24 R≤ 15 − VZ0 20 + 5 where we have used the minimum value of VS , the maximum value of load current, and the minimum required value of zener diode current, and we assumed that at this current VZ VZ0 . Thus, R≤ 15 − 9.825 + 7 25 ⇒ VZ = 10.32 V 25 − 10.32 = 70.9 mA IZmax = 0.207 PZ = 10.32 × 70.9 = 732 mW 3.63 ≤ 207 . ∴ use R = 207 (c) Line regulation = 7 mV = 33 207 + 7 V vS vO R ±25% change in v S ≡ ± 5 V VO changes by ±5 × 33 = ±0.165 mV ±0.165 × 100 = ±1.65% 10 corresponding to (d) Load regulation = − (rZ = −(7 Using the constant voltage drop model: R) ideal 207) = −6.77 VD 0.7 V or –6.77 V/A VO = −6.77 × 20 mA = −135.4 mV R 1 k vS 0.1354 × 100 = −1.35% corresponding to − 10 (e) The maximum zener current occurs at no load IL = 0 and the supply at its largest value of 1 20 + (20) = 25 V. 4 vO (a) v O = v S + 0.7 V, v O = 0, For v S ≤ − 0.7 V for v S ≥ −0.7 V VZ = VZ0 + rZ IZ vO 25 V 0.7 V 0 vS 207 slope 1 VZ IL 0 (b) 10 V vS vO t 0.7 V 25 − VZ = 9.825 + 7 × 207 207VZ = 207 (9.825) + 7 (25) − 7VZ 10 V 0.7 V u Chapter 3–25 3.65 (c) The diode conducts at an angle 0.7 θ = sin−1 = 4◦ and stops 10 0.7 V at π − θ = 176◦ vS R 1 k vO Thus the conduction angle is π − 2θ = 172◦ or 3 rad. v O,avg = = −1 2π π −θ vS (V) (10 sin φ − 0.7) d φ θ 2.5 1.8 −1 [−10 cos φ − 0.7φ]πθ −θ 2π = −2.85 V 0.7 0 (d) Peak current in diode is 10 − 0.7 = 9.3 mA 1 t1 T 4 t2 T 2 t T 2.5 (e) PIV occurs when v S is at its the peak and v O = 0. PIV= 10 V 3.64 D vD vS vO R iD = IS ev D /V T = 0.324 V iD = e[v D −v D (at 1 mA)]/V T iD (1 mA) iD v D − v D (at 1 mA) = VT ln 1 mA v D = v D (at 1 mA) + VT ln v O /R 1 vO = vS − vD = v S − v D (at 1 mA) − VT ln where R is in k. First find t1 and t2 0.7 2.5 = T t1 4 ⇒ t1 = 0.07 T T t2 = − t1 2 T = − 0.07 T 2 t2 = 0.43 T 1 v O (ave.) = × area of shaded triangle T T 1 − t1 = × (2.5 − 0.7) × T 4 1 1 − 0.07 = × 1.8 × T 4 T v 3.66 ideal 0.7 V 12 : 1 vS 10 Vrms O R 120 Vrms 60 Hz 1 k vO Chapter 3–26 √ vˆO = 10 2 − 0.7 = 13.44 V fraction of a cycle for which one of the two 2(3.04) diodes conduct = × 100 = 96.8% 2π Conduction begins at √ 10 2 sin θ = 0.7 0.7 −1 = 2.84◦ θ = sin √ 10 2 Note that during 96.8% of the cycle there will be conduction. However, each of the two diodes conducts for only half the time, i.e., for 48.4% of the cycle. = 0.0495 rad v O,avg Conduction ends at π − θ . 1 = π ∴ Conduction angle = π − 2θ = 3.04 rad = 8.3 V The diode conducts for iL,avg = 3.04 × 100 = 48.4% of the cycle 2π v O,avg 1 = 2π π −θ √ (10 2sinφ − 0.7) d φ θ θ 8.3 = 8.3 mA 1 k 3.68 12 : 1 D4 = 4.15 V iD,avg π−θ √ (10 2sinφ − 0.7)d φ 10 Vrms vs 120 Vrms v O,avg = = 4.15 mA R D1 R 1 k D3 D2 VD 0.7 V 3.67 √ Peak voltage across R = 10 2 − 2VD √ = 10 2 − 1.4 = 12.74 V vS 10 2 V 1.4 V t θ = sin−1 1.4 √ = 5.68◦ = 0.1 rad 10 2 Fraction of cycle that D1 & D2 conduct is π − 2θ × 100 = 46.8% 2π √ vˆO = 10 2 − VD = 13.44 V Conduction starts at θ = sin−1 0.7 √ = 10 2 2.84◦ = 0.05 rad and ends at π − θ . Conduction angle = π − 2θ = 3.04 rad in each half cycle. Thus the Note that D3 & D4 conduct in the other half cycle so that there is 2 (46.8) = 93.6% conduction interval. v O,avg = 2 2π π−θ θ √ (10 2sinφ − 2VD ) d φ Chapter 3–27 √ π −θ 1 −12 2 cos φ − 1.4φ θ π √ 2(12 2 cos θ ) 1.4 (π − 2θ ) − = π π = (b) For VO,avg = 100 V = 7.65 V 2 · Vs − 1.4 π π ⇒ Vs = 101.4 = 159 V 2 √ 120 2 = 1.07 to 1 Turns ratio = 159 iR,avg = 100 V = v O,avg 7.65 = = 7.65 mA R 1 3.69 vS vS 120 Vrms R vO 3.71 The circuit is a full-wave rectifier with center tapped secondary winding. The circuit can − be analyzed by looking at v + O and v O separately. vS vS D1 D3 Refer to Fig. 3.24. For VD Vs , conduction angle v O,avg = π, and vO vS vS 2 2 Vs − VD = Vs − 0.7 π π (a) For v O,avg = 10 V π × 10.7 = 16.8 V 2 √ 120 2 = 10.1 to 1 Turns ratio = 16.8 D4 R D2 Vs = (b) For v O,avg = 100 V π × 100.7 = 158.2 V 2 √ 120 2 = 1.072 to 1 Turns ratio = 158.2 Vs = 3.70 Refer to Fig. 3.25 For 2VD Vs VO,avg = 2 2 Vs − 2VD = Vs − 1.4 π π (a) For VO,avg = 10 V 2 10 V = · Vs − 1.4 π π ∴ V̂s = 11.4 = 17.9 V 2 √ 120 2 = 9.5 to 1 Turns ratio = 17.9 v O, avg = = 1 2π (VS sinφ − 0.7) d φ = 12 2Vs − 0.7 = 12 π where we have assumed Vs 0.7 V and thus the conduction angle (in each half cycle) is almost π. Vs = 12 + 0.7 π = 19.95 V 2 Thus voltage across secondary winding = 2VS 40 V Chapter 3–28 (b) (i) Using Eq (3.30), we have the conduction angle = Looking at D4 , PIV = VS − VO− ωt ∼ = = VS + (VS − 0.7) = 2VS − 0.7 = = 39.2 V = If choosing a diode, allow a safety margin by moving a factor of 1.5, thus PIV 2Vr / Vp − VD 2 × 0.1 Vp − 0.7 Vp − 0.7 √ 0.2 = 0.447 rad 60 V ∴ Fraction of cycle for conduction = 3.72 R 12 : 1 120 Vrms 10 Vrms VS R 1 k C vO 0.447 × 100 2π = 7.1% 2 × 0.01 (ii) ωt Fraction of cycle = Vp Vr VpVD (i) Vr ∼ = Vp − VD T CR 0.1 Vp − VD = Vp − VD C= [Eq. (3.28)] T CR 1 = 166.7 μF 0.1 × 60 × 103 Vr = 0.01 Vp − VD Vp − VD T = CR C = 1667 μF 1 (a) (i) v O, avg = Vp − VD − VΓ 2 √ 1 √ 10 2 − 0.7 0.1 = 10 2 − 0.7 − 2 √ 0.1 = 10 2 − 0.7 1 − 2 (ii) v O, avg = 13.37 V 0.141 × 100 = 2.24% 2π (c) (i) Use Eq (3.31): ⎛ ⎞ 2 Vp − VD ⎠ iD,avg = IL ⎝1 + π Vr 2 Vp − VD v O,avg 1+π = R 0.1 Vp − VD = 12.77 2 1 + π 0.1 103 = 192 mA (ii) For = 12.77 V Vp − 0.7 = 0.141 rad Vp − 0.7 √ 0.01 = 10 2 − 0.7 1 − 2 (ii) iD,avg = √ 13.37 1 + π 200 3 10 = 607 mA (d) Adapting ⎛ Eq. (3.32), we obtain ⎞ 2 Vp − VD ⎠ (i) iD,peak = IL ⎝1 + 2π Vr 2 12.77 = 1 + 2π 0.1 103 = 371 mA (ii) iD,peak 13.37 2 1 + 2π = 0.01 103 = 1201 mA 1.2 A Chapter 3–29 Vp − VD 2fCR 3.73 (i) Vr = 0.1 Vp − VD = The factor of 2 accounts for discharge occurring 1 . only during half of the period, T /2 = 2f C= 1 1 = 83.3 μF = (2fR) 0.1 2 (60) 103 × 0.1 (ii) C = 1 = 833 μF 2 (60) × 103 × 0.01 1 (a) (i) VO = Vp − VD − Vr 2 0.1 = Vp − VD 1 − 2 0.1 = (13.44) 1 − 2 = 12.77 V 0.01 (ii) VO = (13.44) 1 − 2 (b) (i) Fraction of cycle = 2Vr / Vp − VD = π = 13.37 V 2ωt × 100 2π × 100 1 2 (0.1) × 100 = 14.2% π √ 2 2 (0.01) (ii) Fraction of cycle = × 100 2π = 4.5% = (c) Use Eq. (3.34): (i) iD, avg = IL 1 + π = 12.77 1+π 1 (ii) iD, avg = 310 mA 1 = 833 μF 2 (0.01) fR 1 (a) VO = Vp − 2VD − Vr 2 1 Vp − 2VD × 0.1 (i) VO = Vp − 2VD − 2 = Vp − 2VD × 0.95 √ = (10 2 − 2 × 0.7) × 0.95 = 12.1 V √ (ii) VO = (10 2 − 2 × 0.7) × 0.995 = 12.68 V 2ωt × 100 (b) (i) Fraction of cycle = 2π √ 2 (0.1) = × 100 = 14.2% π √ 2 (0.01) (ii) Fraction of cycle = × 100 = 4.5% π 12.1 1 1+π = 97 mA (c) (i) iD, avg = 1 0.2 √ 12.68 1 + π/ 0.02 = 249 mA (ii) iD, avg = 1 12.1 1 1 + 2π = 182 mA (d) (i) îD = 1 0.2 12.68 1 1 + 2π = 576 mA (ii) îD = 1 0.02 3.75 0.7 V Vp − VD 2Vr 1 = 102.5 mA 2 (0.1) 1 13.37 1+π√ = 1 2 (0.01) (d) Use Eq. (3.35): 1 (i) îD = IL 1 + 2π √ = 192 mA 2 (0.1) 1 = 607 mA (ii) îD = IL 1 + 2π √ 0.02 3.74 (i) Vr = 0.1 Vp − VD × 2 = C= (ii) C = Vp − 2VD 2fCR Vp − 2VD 1 = 83.3 μF Vp − 2VD 2 (0.1) fR 120 Vrms 60 Hz vS R 200 VO = 12 V ± 1 V (ripple) RL = 200 (a) VO = Vp − VD − 1 ⇒ Vp = 13 + 0.7 = 13.7 V 13.7 Vrms = √ = 9.7 V 2 Vp − VD (b) Vr = fCR 2= 13.7 − 0.7 60 × C × 200 ⇒C= 13 = 542 μF 2 × 60 × 200 C vO Chapter 3–30 This voltage appears across each half of the transformer secondary. Across the entire secondary we have 2 × 9.7 = 19.4 V (rms). Vp VpVD t Vp PIV (c) When the diode is cut off, the maximum reverse voltage across it will occur when v S = −Vp . At this time, v O = VO and the maximum reverse voltage will be PIV Maximum reverse voltage = VO + Vp = 12 + 13.7 = 25.7 V (b) Vr = Using a factor of safety of 1.5 we obtain 2= PIV = 1.5 × 25.7 = 38.5 V (d) iDav = IL 1 + π 2(Vp − VD ) Vr In specifying the PIV for the diodes, one usually uses a factor of safety of about 1.5, 2(Vp − VD ) (e) iDmax = IL 1 + 2π Vr 2(13.7 − 0.7) 12 1 + 2π = 0.2 2 PIV = 1.5 × 25.7 = 38.5 V Vp − VD (d) iDav = IL 1 + π 2 Vr 13.7 − 0.7 12 1+π = 0.2 2×2 = 399 mA = 1.42 A D1 120 Vrms 60 Hz C R D2 (a) VO = Vp − VD − 1 ⇒ Vp = VO + VD + 1 = 13 + 0.7 = 13.7 V Vrms 13.7 = √ = 9.7 V 2 Vp − VD (e) iDmax = IL 1 + 2π 2 Vr 13.7 − 0.7 12 1 + 2π = 0.2 2×2 3.76 Vs 0.7 V Vs 0.7 V 12 = 271 μF 2 × 2 × 60 × 200 (c) Maximum reverse voltage across D1 occurs when v S = −Vp . At this point v O = VO . Thus maximum reverse voltage = VO + Vp = 12 + 13.7 = 25.7. The same applies to D2 . 2(Vp − VD ) VO 1+π = RL Vr 2(13.7 − 0.7) 12 1+π = 0.2 2 = 739 mA 13.7 − 0.7 2 × 60 × 200 × C ⇒C= Vp − VD 2fCR vO = 739 mA 3.77 120 Vrms 60 Hz D4 D1 C R vS vO D2 D3 Chapter 3–31 12 V 11.3 11.3 Vr 10.2 V (a) VO = Vp − 2VD − 1 ⇒ Vp = VO +2VD +1 = 12+2×0.7+1 = 14.4 V 14.4 Vrms = √ = 10.2 V 2 Vp − 2 VD (b) Vr = 2fCR } T 0 14.4 − 1.4 = 271 μF 2 × 2 × 60 × 200 (c) The maximum reverse voltage across D1 occurs when Vs = −Vp = −14.4 V. At this time D3 is conducting, thus ⇒C= Vr 1.13 V 4 t (c) During the diode’s off interval (which is almost equal to T ) the capacitor discharges and its voltage is given by Maximum reverse voltage = −Vp + VD3 = −14.4 + 0.7 = −13.7 V v O (t) = 11.3 e−t/CR The same applies to the other three diodes. In specifying the PIV rating for the diode we use a factor of safety of 1.5 to obtain where C = 100 μF and R = 100 , thus PIV = 1.5 × 13.7 = 20.5 V Vp − 2 VD (d) iDav = IL 1 + π 2 Vr 14.4 − 1.4 12 1+π = 0.2 2×2 At the end of the discharge interval, t = 400 mA Vp − 2 VD 2 Vr 14.4 − 0.7 12 1 + 2π = 0.2 2×2 CR = 100 × 10−6 × 100 = 0.01 s T and v O = 11.3 e−T /CR Since T = 0.001 s is much smaller than CR, T v O 11.3 1 − CR The ripple voltage Vr can be found as T Vr = 11.3 − 11.3 1 − CR (e) iDmax = IL 1 + 2π 11.3 × 0.001 11.3T = = 1.13 V CR 0.01 The average dc output voltage is = = 740 mA 1.13 Vr = 11.3 − = 10.74 V 2 2 To obtain the interval during which the diode conducts, t, refer to Fig. (c). v O = 11.3 − 3.78 vI C 100 F R 100 vO Vr 12 = T /4 t ⇒ (a) 1.13 × 1 Vr × (T /4) = 12 12 × 4 = 23.5 μs vI 12 V 11.3 V t= Vr vO Now, using the fact that the charge gained by the capacitor when the diode is conducting is equal to the charge lost by the capacitor during its discharge interval, we can write vI iCav × t t = C Vr ⇒ iCav = C Vr 100 × 10−6 × 1.13 = 4.8 A = t 23.5 × 10−6 iDav = iCav + iLav T (b) 1 ms 12 V where iLav is the average current through R during the short interval t. This is approximately 11.3 11.3 = = 0.113 A. Thus R 100 Chapter 3–32 iDav = 4.8 + 0.113 = 4.913 A Finally, to obtain the peak diode current, we use iDmax = iCmax + iLmax dv I 11.3 =C + dt R 11.3 12 + =C× T /4 R = 100 × 10−6 × 12 × 4 11.3 + −3 1 × 10 100 = 4.8 + 0.113 = 4.913 A which is equal to the average value. This is a result of the linear v I which gives rise to a constant capacitor current during the diode conduction interval. Thus iCmax = iCav = 4.8 A. Also, the maximum value of iL is approximately equal to its average value during the short interval t. 3.79 Refer to Fig. P3.71 and let a capacitor C be connected across each of the load resistors R. The − two supplies v + O and v O are identical. Each is a full-wave rectifier similar to that of the tapped-transformer circuit. For each supply, VO = 12 V Vr = 1 V (peak to peak) Thus v O = 12 ± 0.5 V It follows that the peak value of v S must be 12.5 + 0.7 = 13.2 V and the total rms voltage across the secondary will be = 2 × 13.2 = 18.7 V (rms) √ 2 120 = 6.43:1 18.7 To deliver 100-mA dc current to each load, Transformer turns ratio = 12 = 120 0.1 Now, the value of C can be found from R= Vr = 1= Vp − 0.7 2fCR 12.5 2 × 60 × C × 120 iDmax = IL (1 + 2π (Vp − 0.7)/2 Vr ) = 0.1(1 + 2π 12.5/2 ) = 1.671 A To determine the required PIV rating of each diode, we determine the maximum reverse voltage that appears across one of the diodes, say D1 . This occurs when v S is at its maximum negative value −Vp . Since the cathode of D1 will be at +12.5 V, the maximum reverse voltage across D1 will be 12.5 + 13.2 = 25.7 V. Using a factor of safety of 1.5, then each of the four diodes must have PIV = 1.5 × 25.7 = 38.6 V 3.80 Refer to Fig. P3.80. When v I is positive, v A goes positive, turning on the diode and closing the negative feedback loop around the op amp. The result is that v − = v I , v O = 2v − = 2v I , and v A = v O + 0.7. Thus (a) v I = +1 V, v − = +1 V, v O = +2 V, and v A = +2.7 V. (b) v I = +3 V, v − = +3 V, v O = +6 V, and v A = +6.7 V. When v I goes negative, v A follows, the diode turns off, and the feedback loop is opened. The op amp saturates with v A = −13 V, v − = 0 V and v O = 0 V. Thus (c) v I = −1 V, v − = 0 V, v O = 0 V, and v A = −13 V. (d) v I = −3 V, v − = 0 V, v O = 0 V, and v A = −13 V. Finally, if v I is a symmetrical square wave of 1-kHz frequency, 5-V amplitude, and zero average, the output will be zero during the negative half cycles of the input and will equal twice the input during the positive half cycles. See figure. vO 10 V 5 V ⇒ C = 868 μF To specify the diodes, we determine iDav and iDmax , iDav = IL (1 + π (Vp − 0.7)/2 Vr ) = 0.1(1 + π 12.5/2 ) = 785 mA 0 vI 5 V 1 ms t Chapter 3–33 Thus, v O is a square wave with 0-V and +10-V levels, i.e. 5-V average and, of course, the same frequency (1 kHz) as the input. 3.81 v I > 0: D1 conducts and D2 cutoff (b) See figure (b) on next page. Here v O = v I for v I ≥ 2.5 V. At v I = 2.5 V, v O = 2.5 V and the diode begins to conduct. The diode will be conducting 1 mA and exhibiting a drop of 0.7 at v O = 2.3 V. The corresponding value of v I v I = v O − iR = 2.3 − 1 × 1 = +1.3 V v I < 0: D1 cutoff, vO = −1 D2 conducts ∼ vI As v I decreases below 1.3 V, the diode current increases, but the diode voltage remains constant at 0.7 V. Thus v O flattens at about 2.3 V. vO (a) v I = +1 V (c) See figure (c) on next page. For v I ≤ −2.5 V, the diode is off, and v O = v I . At v I = −2.5 V the diode begins to conduct and its current reaches 1 mA at v I = −1.3 V (corresponding to v O = −2.3 V). As v I further increases, the diode current increases but its voltage remains constant at 0.7 V. Thus v O flattens, as shown. vO = 0 V (d) See figure (d) on next page. slope 1 vI v A = −0.7 V Keeps D2 off so no current flows through R 3.83 3 V ⇒ v− = 0 V Virtual ground as feedback loop is closed through D1 (b) v I = +3 V D1 vO = 0 V v A = −0.7 V v− = 0 V R = 0.5 k vI vo i (c) v I = −1 V D2 v O = +1 V v A = 1.7 V v− = 0 V 3 V ∼ Virtual ground as negative feedback loop is closed through D2 and R. (d) v I = −3 V ⇒ v O = +3 V v A = +3.7 V v− = 0 V 3.82 (a) See figure (a) on next page. For v I ≤ 3.5 V, i = 0 and v O = v I . At v I = 3.5 V, the diode begins to conduct. At v O = 3.7 V, the diode is conducting i = 1 mA and thus v I = v O + i × 1 k = 4.7 V For v I > 4.7 V the diode current increases but the diode voltage remains constant at 0.7 V, thus v O flattens and v O vs. v I becomes a horizontal line. In practice, the diode voltage increases slowly and the line will have a small nonzero slope. (a) From Fig. (a) we see that for −3.5 V ≤ v I ≤ +3.5 V, diodes D1 and D2 will be cut off and i = 0. Thus, v O = v I . For v I ≥ +3.5 V, diode D1 begins to conduct and its voltage reaches 0.7 V (and thus v O = +3.7 V) at i = 1 mA. The corresponding value of v I is v I = v O − iR v I = 3.7 + 1 × 0.5 = +4.2 V For v I ≥ 4.2 V, the voltage of diode D1 remains 0.7 V and v O saturates at +3.7 V. A similar description applies for v I ≤ −3.5 V. Here D2 conducts at v I = −3.5 V and its voltage becomes 0.7 V, and hence v O = −3.7 V, at i = 1 mA (in the direction into v I ) at v I = −4.2 V. For v I ≤ −4.2 V, v O = −3.7 V. Chapter 3–34 These figures belong to Problem 3.82. vO (V) 3.7 3.5 3 V D i vI (V) vO vI R 1 k slope 1 3.5 4.7 (a) vO (V) 3 V slope 1 2.5 2.3 D i vO vI R 1 k 1.3 vI (V) 2.5 (b) vO (V) 2.5 vI R 1 k 1.3 vI (V) vO i 2.3 D 2.5 3 V slope 1 (c) vO (V) vI R 1 k i vO 4.7 3.5 vI (V) D slope 1 3.5 3 V 3.7 (d) Chapter 3–35 This figure belongs to Problem 3.83, part b. vO (V) 3.7 3.5 4.2 3.5 3.5 0 4.2 vI (V) slope 1 (Not to scale) 3.5 3.7 D1 and D2 OFF D1 OFF D2 ON D1 ON D2 OFF (b) Figure (b) shows a sketch of the transfer characteristic of this double limiter. 3.85 3.84 See figure. 3 V vI D1 D1 Z vO R 0.5 k vO D4 D2 vI 1 k (a) D2 D3 vO (V) 3.7 3.5 slope 1 (a) 2.5 2.3 (Not to scale) 1.8 2.5 D1 ON D2 OFF 3.5 4.2 D1 & D2 OFF (b) D1 OFF D2 ON vI (V) The limiter thresholds and the output saturation levels are found as 2 × 0.7 + 6.8 = 8.2 V. The transfer characteristic is given in Fig. (b). See figure on next page. Chapter 3–36 This figure belong to Problem 3.85, part b. Z All diodes and zener are OFF Z 3.86 3.87 (a) 10 k vI vO 1 k vI vO D1 D2 (b) 10 k Diodes have 0.7 V drop at 1 mA current vO vI ∴ For diode D1 iD = e(v O −0.7)/VT 1 mA iD = 1 × 10−3 e(v O −0.7)/VT (c) v O = 0.7 + VT ln 10 k vI vO iD 1 mA v I = v O + iD × 1 k v I for the different values of v O . For D2 , v I = v O − iD × 1 k Chapter 3–37 3.89 From the figure we see that √ v Oav = −5 2 = −7.07 V 3.90 vO (V) 0.8 (a) to 55.4 10 V 10 V 2 1 1 vI (V) 2 (b) 20 V 0V 0.8 (c) 0V It is a soft limiter with a gain K L+ 0.7 V, L− −0.7 V 1 and 20 V (d) 0V 3.88 20 V R (e) 1.5 V vO 1 k vI 1.5 V 10 V 10 V (f) Here there are two different time constants involved. To calculate the output levels, we shall consider the discharge and charge wave forms. In the nonlimiting region 1000 vO = ≥ 0.94 vI 1000 + R R ≤ 63.8 During T1 , v O = V1 e−t/RC At = T1 = T , v O = V1 = V1 e−T /RC Chapter 3–38 V1 0 From (1) and (2) we find that V1́ V2 T1 V1 = 2|V2 | t V2́ Then using (1) and neglecting αV1 yields T2 3 |V2 | = 20 ⇒ |V2 | = 6.67 V V1 = 13.33 V where for T CR V1 (1 − T /CR) = V1 (1 − α) V1 The result is where α 1 13.33 V During the interval T2 , we have 6.67 V |v O | = |V2 | e−t/(CR/2) At the end of T2 , t = T , and v O = |V2 | (g) where 18 V |V2 | = |V2 | e−T /(CR/2) T |V2 | 1 − = |V2 | (1 − 2α) RC/2 2 V Now V1 + |V2 | = 20 ⇒ V1 + |V2 | − αV 1 = 20 (1) and V2 + V1 = 20 ⇒ V1 + |V2 | − 2α |V2 | = 20 (2) (h) Using a method similar to that employed for case (f) above, we obtain 13.33 V 6.67 V Exercise 4–1 IS 10−16 = = 10−18 A β 100 IC 1 mA = VT ln = 25 ln IS 10−16 Ex: 4.1 iC = IS ev BE /VT iC2 v BE2 − v BE1 = VT ln iC1 0.1 v BE2 = 700 + 25 ln 1 = 25 × 29.9336 = 642 mV = 748 mV v BE3 10 = 700 + 25 ln 1 ISB = VBE Ex: 4.6 = 758 mV VCC 5 V Ex: 4.2 ∴ α = β β +1 10 A 150 50 <α< 50 + 1 150 + 1 RC C B 0.980 < α < 0.993 bIB Ex: 4.3 IC = IE − IB = 1.460 mA − 0.01446 mA = 1.446 mA 1.446 IC = 0.99 = α= IE 1.460 E v BE = 690 mV 1.446 IC = 100 = β= IB 0.01446 IC = 1 mA For active range VC ≥ VB , IC = IS ev BE /VT IS = IC = RCmax = 1.446 e700/25 ev BE /VT 1.446 = 28 mA = 10−15 A e Ex: 4.4 β = α 1−α For α = 0.99, β = IB = IB = 5 − 0.69 1 = 4.31 k = and IC = 10 mA 0.99 = 99 1 − 0.99 IC 10 = = 0.1 mA β 99 For α = 0.98, β = VCC − 0.690 IC 0.98 = 49 1 − 0.98 IC 10 = = 0.2 mA β 49 Ex: 4.5 Given: IS = 10−16 A, β = 100, I C = 1 mA Ex: 4.7 IS = 10−15 A AreaC = 100 × AreaE ISC = 100 × IS = 10−13 A Ex: 4.8 iC = IS ev BE /VT − ISC ev BC /VT for iC = 0 IS ev BE /VT = ISC ev BC /VT ISC ev BE /VT = v /V IS e BC T = e(v BE −v BC )/VT ISC IS We write ∴ VCE = VBE − VBC = VT ln = 10−16 × 1.01 = 1.01 × 10−16 A For collector Area = 100 × Emitter area 100 = 115 mV VCE = 25 ln 1 1 ISE = ISC /α = IS = 1 + β Exercise 4–2 Ex: 4.9 IC = IS ev BE /VT − ISC ev BC /VT Ex: 4.12 1.5 V IS IB = ev BE /VT + ISC ev BC /VT β IC β forced = < β IB sat 2 mA VC 0.5 V IS ev BE /VT − ISC ev BC /VT = β v /V IS e BE T + βI SC ev BC /VT VBE IS e(v BE −v BC )/VT − ISC = β (v −v )/V IS e BE BC T + βISC =β e − ISC /IS eVCE sat /VT + βISC /IS Q.E.D. e200/25 − 100 + 100 × 100 RE 1.5 V e200/25 = 100 × 0.2219 ≈ 22.2 RC = Ex: 4.10 1.5 − VC 1.5 − 0.5 = IC 2 = 0.5 k = 500 2 mA E IS /a B Since at IC = 1 mA, VBE = 0.8 V, then at IC = 2 mA, 2 VBE = 0.8 + 0.025 ln 1 = 0.8 + 0.017 = 0.817 V IS ev EB /VT aiE C 10 V IS v BE /VT e α 51 −14 v BE /VT 2 mA = 10 e 50 2 50 14 × 10 VBE = 25 ln × 51 103 IE = VE = −VBE = −0.817 V 2 2 mA = = 2.02 mA α 0.99 VE − (−1.5) IE = RE IE = Thus, −0.817 + 1.5 = 0.338 k 2.02 = 338 RE = Ex: 4.13 10 V = 650 mV β 50 IE = ×2 IC = β +1 51 = 1.96 mA IC 1.96 = ⇒ 39.2 μA IB = β 50 Ex: 4.11 IC = IS ev BE /VT = 1.5 A ∴ VBE = VT ln 1.5/10−11 IC 5 k VC IB VE 0.7 V 10 k IE = 25 × 25.734 = 643 mV VE VBE 2 IE ( a ) mA VCE sat /VT β forced = 100 RC 10 V Exercise 4–3 IE = −0.7 + 10 VE − (−10) = 10 10 and VC = −10 + 1.65 × 5 = −1.75 V = 0.93 mA Since VC < VB , the transistor is indeed operating in the active mode. Assuming active-mode operation, IB = 0.93 IE = = 0.0182 mA β +1 50 + 1 Ex: 4.15 = 18.2 μA IC = IE − IB = 0.93 − 0.0182 = 0.91 mA 2 mA VC = 10 − IC × 5 VE = 10 − 0.91 × 5 = 5.45 V Since VC > VB , the transistor is operating in the active mode, as assumed. VC RC 1 k IC Ex: 4.14 10 V 5 V IE 5 k VE IB The transistor is operating at a constant emitter current. Thus, a change in temperature of +30◦ C results in a change in VEB by VEB = −2 mV × 30 = −60 mV VB IB VC 100 k IC 5 k Thus, VE = −60 mV Since the collector current remains unchanged at αIE , the collector voltage does not change: 10 V VB = 1.0 V Thus, IB = VB = 0.01 mA 100 k VE = +1.7 V Thus, IE = 10 − 1.7 10 − VE = = 1.66 mA 5 k 5 and β +1= 1.66 IE = 166 = IB 0.01 ⇒ β = 165 VC = 0 V Ex: 4.16 Refer to Fig. 4.19(a): v CE iC = IS ev BE /VT + ro (1) Now using Eqs. (4.21) and (4.22), we can express ro as ro = VA IS ev BE /VT Substituting in Eq. (1), we have v CE iC = IS ev BE /VT 1 + VA which is Eq. (4.18). Ex: 4.17 ro = Q.E.D. VA 100 = IC IC 165 β = = 0.994 α= β +1 165 + 1 At IC = 0.1 mA, ro = 1 M Assuming active-mode operation, At IC = 1 mA, ro = 100 k IC = αIE = 0.994 × 1.66 = 1.65 mA At IC = 10 mA, ro = 10 k Exercise 4–4 Ex: 4.18 IC = VCE ro Ex: 4.20 For VBB = 0 V, IB = 0 and the transistor is cut off. Thus, where VA 100 = 100 k = ro = IC 1 IC = 0 11 − 1 = 0.1 mA 100 Thus, IC becomes 1.1 mA. VC = VCC = +10 V and IC = Ex: 4.21 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 4.22 and let VBB = 1.7 V. The current IB can be found from IB = Ex: 4.19 VCC 10 V VBB IB IC RB 10 k Assuming operation in the active mode, IC = β IB = 50 × 0.1 = 5 mA RC 10 k VBE 0.7 V VBB − VB 1.7 − 0.7 = 0.1 mA = RB 10 VCE (a) For operation in the active mode with VCE = 5 V, Thus, VC = VCC − RC IC = 10 − 1 × 5 = 5 V which is greater than VB , verifying that the transistor is operating in the active mode, as assumed. (a) To obtain operation at the edge of saturation, RC must be increased to the value that results in VCE = 0.3 V: IC = VCC − VC 10 − 5 = 0.5 mA = RC 10 RC = IB = IC 0.5 = = 0.01 mA β 50 = VBB = VBE + IB RB VCC − 0.3 IC 10 − 0.3 = 1.94 k 5 (b) For operation at the edge of saturation, (b) Further increasing RC results in the transistor operating in saturation. To obtain saturation-mode operation with VCE = 0.2 V and βforced = 10, we use VCE = 0.3 V IC = βforced × IB VCC − VCE 10 − 0.3 = = 0.97 mA IC = RC 10 = 10 × 0.1 = 1 mA = 0.7 + 0.01 × 10 = 0.8 V IB = 0.97 IC = = 0.0194 mA β 50 VBB = VB + IB RB = 0.7 + 0.0194 × 10 = 0.894 V (c) For operation deep in saturation with βforced = 10, we have VCE 0.2 V 10 − 0.2 = 0.98 mA 10 IC 0.98 = 0.098 mA = IB = βforced 10 IC = VBB = VB + IB RB = 0.7 + 0.098 × 10 = 1.68 V The value of RC required can be found from RC = = VCC − VCE IC 10 − 0.2 = 9.8 k 1 Ex: 4.22 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 4.23(a) with the base voltage raised from 4 V to VB . If at this value of VB , the transistor is at the edge of saturation then, VC = VB − 0.4 V Since IC IE , we can write VE VB − 0.7 10 − VC = = RC RE RE Exercise 4–5 10 − (VB − 0.5) 4.7 VB − 0.7 IE = 6IB = 3.3 Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2), we have Thus, IC = 5IB = VB − 0.7 10 − (VB − 0.4) = 4.7 3.3 ⇒ VB = +4.7 V (1) (2) 10.5 − VB 3.3 5 = × 6 VB − 0.7 4.7 Ex: 4.23 ⇒ VB = +5.18 V 10 V 0.5 mA RC VC 6 V Ex: 4.25 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 4.26(a). The largest value for RC while the BJT remains in the active mode corresponds to VC = +0.4 V VB 4 V VE 3.3 V RE 0.5 mA Since the emitter and collector currents remain unchanged, then from Fig. 4.26(b) we obtain IC = 4.6 mA Thus, RC = To establish a reverse-bias voltage of 2 V across the CBJ, VC = +6 V = VC − (−10) IC +0.4 + 10 = 2.26 k 4.6 Ex: 4.26 From the figure we see that 10 V 10 − 6 = 8 k RC = 0.5 and 3.3 = 6.6 k RE = 0.5 where we have assumed α 1. 1 mA RE VE 0.7 V VC 4 V 1 mA Ex: 4.24 10 V 10 V IC 5IB 4.7 k VB 0.5 RC For a 4-V reverse-biased voltage across the CBJ, VC = −4 V VB Refer to the figure. IB VB 0.7 6IB IC = 1 mA = 3.3 k VC − (−10) RC −4 + 10 = 6 k 1 10 − VE RE = IE ⇒ RC = The figure shows the circuit with the base voltage at VB and the BJT operating in saturation with VCE = 0.2 V and βforced = 5. Assuming α = 1, RE = 10 − 0.7 = 9.3 k 1 Exercise 4–6 Ex: 4.27 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 4.27: IB = Ex: 4.30 15 V 5 − 0.7 = 0.043 mA 100 To ensure that the transistor remains in the active mode for β in the range 50 to 150, we need to select RC so that for the highest collector current possible, the BJT reaches the edge of saturation, that is, VCE = 0.3 V. Thus, 2.78 mA 2 k 9.44 V Q2 IC3 2.75 mA Q3 VC2 VCE = 0.3 = 10 − RC ICmax IC3 /b where VE3 2.7 k ICmax = βmax IB 470 IC3 a = 150 × 0.043 = 6.45 mA Thus, RC = 10 − 0.3 = 1.5 k 6.45 From the figure we see that IC3 × 0.47 α For the lowest β, VE3 = IC = βmin IB IC3 × 0.47 + 0.7 (1) α A node equation at the collector of Q2 yields = 50 × 0.043 = 2.15 mA and the corresponding VCE is VCE = 10 − RC IC = 10 − 1.5 × 2.15 = 6.775 V VC2 = VE3 + 0.7 = 2.75 = IC3 VC2 + 2.7 β Substituting for VC2 from Eq. (1), we obtain 2.75 = Thus, VCE will range from 0.3 V to 6.8 V. (0.47 IC3 /α) + 0.7 IC3 + 2.7 β Substituting α = 0.99 and β = 100 and solving for IC3 results in Ex: 4.28 Refer to the solution of Example 4.10. VBB − VBE IE = RE + [RBB /(β + 1)] 5 − 0.7 = 1.177 mA = 3 + (33.3/51) IC3 = 13.4 mA Now, VE3 and VC2 can be determined: IC3 13.4 × 0.47 = × 0.47 = +6.36 V α 0.99 = VE3 + 0.7 = +7.06 V VE3 = VC2 IC = αIE = 0.98 × 1.177 = 1.15 mA Thus the current is reduced by Ex: 4.31 5 V IC = 1.28 − 1.15 = 0.13 mA which is a −10% change. Q1 off Ex: 4.29 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 4.30(b). The total current drawn from the power supply is I = 0.103 + 1.252 + 2.78 = 4.135 mA 10 k 5 V 0 IE IB Q2 on IE Thus, the power dissipated in the circuit is P = 15 V × 4.135 mA = 62 mW 5 V VE IE 1 1 k Exercise 4–7 From the figure we see that Q1 will be off and Q2 will be on. Since the base of Q2 will be at a voltage higher than −5 V, transistor Q2 will be operating in the active mode. We can write a loop equation for the loop containing the 10-k resistor, the EBJ of Q2 and the 1-k resistor: −IE × 1 − 0.7 − IB × 10 = −5 Substituting IB = IE /(β + 1) = IE /101 and rearranging gives IE = 5 − 0.7 = 3.9 mA 10 +1 101 Q1 will be saturated. Assuming this to be the case, the analysis steps will be as follows: VCEsat |Q1 = 0.2 V VE = 5 V − VCEsat = +4.8 V 4.8 V = 4.8 mA 1 k = VE + VBE1 = 4.8 + 0.7 = +5.5 V IE1 = VB1 10 − 5.5 = 0.45 mA 10 = IE1 − IB1 = 4.8 − 0.45 = 4.35 mA IB1 = IC1 βforced = Thus, IC 4.35 = = 9.7 IB 0.45 VE = −3.9 V which is lower than βmin , verifying that Q1 is indeed saturated. VB2 = −4.6 V Finally, since Q2 is off, IC2 = 0 IB = 0.039 mA Ex: 4.32 With the input at + 10 V, there is a strong possibility that the conducting transistor Ex: 4.33 VO = +10 − BVBCO = 10 − 70 = −60 V This figure belongs to Exercise 4.32. 5 V 4 5.5 V Q1 on VCEsat 0.2 V 10 k 4.8 V 10 V 5 10 5.5 0.45 mA 10 1 3 Q2 off 5 V 4.8 mA 1 k 2 Chapter 4–1 4.1 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Active Saturation Active Saturation Active Cutoff β= IC = 80 IB α= 80 β = = 0.988 β +1 81 4.7 α 4.2 The EB junctions have a 4:1 area ratio. 0.5 0.8 0.9 0.95 0.98 0.99 0.995 0.999 α β= 1−α 1 4 1 2 9 19 49 99 199 999 IC = IS eVBE /VT 0.5 × 10−3 = IS1 × e0.75/0.025 ⇒ IS1 = 4.7 × 10−17 A 4.8 β 10 20 50 100 200 500 1000 IS2 = 4IS1 = 1.87 × 10−16 A β α= 0.5 0.67 0.91 0.95 0.98 0.99 0.995 0.998 0.999 β +1 4.3 IC1 = 10−13 e700/25 = 0.145A = 145 mA 4.9 β = −18 700/25 IC2 = 10 e = 1.45 μA For the first transistor 1 to conduct a current of 1.45 μA, its VBE must be 1.45 × 10−6 VBE1 = 0.025 ln 10−13 = 0.412 V 4.4 AE1 200 × 200 IS1 = = = 250,000 IS2 AE2 0.4 × 0.4 IC1 = IS1 eVBE1 /VT IC2 = IS2 e VBE2 /VT For IC1 = IC2 we have e(VBE2 −VBE1) /VT = IS1 = 250,000 IS2 VBE2 − VBE1 = 0.025 ln(250,000) = 0.31 V 10−3 = 2 × 10−15 eVBE /VT 10−3 VBE = 0.025 ln = 0.673 V 2 × 10−15 New technology: 10−3 = 2 × 10−18 eVBE /VT 10−3 VBE = 0.025 ln = 0.846 V 2 × 10−18 (1) α → α + α β → β + β β + β = α + α 1 − α − α (2) Subtracting Eq. (1) from Eq. (2) gives β = α α + α − 1 − α − α 1−α β = α (1 − α − α)(1 − α) (3) Dividing Eq. (3) by Eq. (1) gives α 1 β = β α 1 − α − α For α 1, the second factor on the right-hand side is approximately equal to β. Thus α β β Q.E.D. β α For 4.5 Old technology: α 1−α β = −10% and β = 100, β −10% α = −0.1% α 100 4.10 Transistor is operating in active region: β = 50 → 300 IB = 10 μA IC = βIB = 0.5 mA → 3 mA IE = (β + 1)IB = 0.51 mA → 3.01 mA Maximum power dissipated in transistor is 4.6 IB = 10 μA IB × 0.7 V + IC × VC IC = 800 μA = 0.01 × 0.7 + 3 × 10 30 mW Chapter 4–2 4.11 For iB = 10 μA, 4.14 First we determine IS , β, and α: iC = iE − iB = 1000 − 10 = 990 μA 1 × 10−3 = IS e700/25 β= ⇒ IS = 6.91 × 10−16 A iC 990 = 99 = iB 10 β 99 α= = = 0.99 β +1 100 β= IC 1 mA = 100 = IB 10 μA For iB = 20 μA, α= β 100 = = 0.99 β +1 101 iC = iE − iB = 1000 − 20 = 980 μA Then we can determine ISE and ISB : β= iC 980 = 49 = iB 20 ISE = IS = 6.98 × 10−16 A α α= β 49 = = 0.98 β +1 50 ISB = IS = 6.91 × 10−18 A β For iB = 50 μA, The figure below and on next page shows the four large-signal models, corresponding to Fig. 4.5(a) to (d), together with their parameter values. iC = iE − iB = 1000 − 50 = 950 μA β= iC 950 = 19 = iB 50 α= β 19 = = 0.95 β +1 20 4.12 iC = IS ev BE /VT = 5 × 10−15 e0.7/0.025 = 7.2 mA 7.2 7.2 iB will be in the range mA to mA, that is, 50 200 144 μA to 36 μA. iE will be in the range (7.2 + 0.144) mA to (7.2 + 0.036) mA, that is, 7.344 mA to 7.236 mA. 4.13 See table below. This table belongs to Problem 4.13. Transistor a b c d e VBE (mV) 700 690 580 780 820 IC (mA) 1.000 1.000 0.230 10.10 73.95 IB (μA) 10 20 5 120 1050 IE (mA) 1.010 1.020 0.235 10.22 75 α 0.99 0.98 0.979 0.988 0.986 β 100 46 84 70 IS (A) 50 −16 6.9 × 10 −15 1.0 × 10 −14 1.9 × 10 −16 2.8 × 10 4.2 × 10−16 Chapter 4–3 C (b) The figure shows the circuit, where α= iC aiE 100 β = = 0.99 β +1 101 5 × 10−15 IS = = 5.05 × 100−15 A α 0.99 The voltage at the emitter VE is ISE = iB B VE = −VDE v BE = −VT ln(IE /ISE ) 2 × 10−3 = −0.025 ln 5.05 × 10−15 DE ISE IS /a iE = −0.668 V E a 0.99 ISE 6.98 1016 A The voltage at the collector VC is found from VC = 5 − IC × 2 = 5 − αIE × 2 = 5 − 0.99 × 2 × 2 = 1.04 V 4.16 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 4.6(b). ISB = 5 × 10−15 IS = = 10−16 A β 50 0.5 × 10−3 IC = = 10−5 A β 50 IB VB = VBE = VT ln ISB −5 10 = 0.025 ln 10−16 IB = (d) B iC iB C vBE DB IS ISB b biB = 0.633 V We can determine RB from iE RB = E b 100 ISB 6.91 1018 A 15 − 0.633 = 1.44 M 10−5 To obtain VCE = 1 V, we select RC according to = 4.15 5 V RC = 2 k VC C aiE DE E = VCC − VCE IC 15 − 1 = 28 k 0.5 4.17 IS = 10−15 A B iE VCC − VB IB VE 2 mA Thus, a forward-biased EBJ conducting a current of 1 mA will have a forward voltage drop VBE : I VBE = VT ln IS −3 10 = 0.025 ln = 0.691 V 10−15 ISC = 100IS = 10−13 A Chapter 4–4 Thus, a forward-biased CBJ conducting a 1-mA current will have a forward voltage drop VBC : VBC = VT ln −3 1 × 10 1 × 10−13 4.19 The equations utilized are v BC = v BE − v CE = 0.7 − v CE iBC = ISC ev BC /VT = 10−13 ev BC /0.025 = 0.576 V iBE = ISB ev BE /VT = 10−17 e0.7/0.025 When forward-biased with 0.5 V, the emitter–base junction conducts iB = iBC + iBE I = IS e0.5/0.025 Performing these calculations for v CE = 0.4 V, 0.3 V, and 0.2 V, we obtain the results shown in the table below. = 10−15 e0.5/0.025 = 0.49 μA iC = IS ev BE /VT − iBC = 10−15 e0.7/0.025 − iBC and the CBJ conducts 4.20 I = ISC e0.5/0.025 = 10−13 e0.5/0.025 = 48.5 μA 4.18 Dividing Eq. (4.14) by Eq. (4.15) and substituting iC /iB = βforced gives βforced = IS ev BE /VT − ISC ev BC /VT (IS /β)ev BE /VT + ISC ev BC /VT Dividing the numerator and denominator of the right-hand side by ISC ev BC /VT and replacing v BE − v BC by VCEsat gives IS eVCEsat /VT − 1 ISC βforced = 1 IS eVCEsat /VT + 1 β ISC This equation can be used to obtain eVCEsat /VT and hence VCEsat as IS 1 + βforced eVCEsat /VT = ISC 1 − βforced /β ⇒ VCEsat = VT ln ISC 1 + βforced IS 1 − βforced /β 50 10 5 where Q.E.D. 10−14 IS = = 2 × 10−16 A β 50 10 × 10−6 = 0.025 ln 2 × 10−16 ISB = For β = 100 and ISC /IS = 100, we can use this equation to obtain VCEsat corresponding to the given values of βforced . The results are as follows: βforced The emitter–base voltage VEB is found as the voltage drop across the diode DB , whose scale current is ISB = IS /β, it is conducting a 10-μA current. Thus, 10 μA VEB = VT ln ISB VEB = 0.616 V Thus, VB = −VEB = −0.616 V The collector current can be found as 1 IC = βIB VCEsat (V) 0.231 0.178 0.161 0.133 = 50 × 10 = 500 μA = 0.5 mA This table belongs to Problem 4.19. v CE (V) v BC (V) iBC (μA) iBE (μA) iB (μA) iC (mA) iC /iB 0.4 0.3 0.016 14.46 14.48 1.446 100 0.3 0.4 0.89 14.46 15.35 1.445 94 0.2 0.5 14.46 62.96 1.398 29 48.5 Chapter 4–5 The collector voltage can now be obtained from VC = −5 + IC × 8.2 = −5 + 0.5 × 8.2 = −0.9 V 4.22 IB = 5 IE = = 0.238 A = 238 mA β +1 20 + 1 The emitter current can be found as IC = IS eVEB /VT IE = IB + IC = 10 + 500 = 510 μA αIE = IS eVEB /VT = 0.51 mA where 20 = 0.95 α= 21 IS = αIE e−VEB /VT 4.21 = 0.95 × 5e−(0.8/0.025) = 6 × 10−14 A A transistor that conducts IC = 1 mA with VEB = 0.70 V has a scale current IS = 1 × 10−3 e−0.70/0.025 = 6.9 × 10−16 A The emitter–base junction areas of these two transistors will have the same ratio as that of their scale currents, thus 6 × 10−14 EBJ area of first transistor = 87 = EBJ area of second transistor 6.9 × 10−16 Referring to the figure, we see that IE = IB + IC = IC + IC β 4.23 The two missing large-signal equivalent circuits for the pnp transistor are those corresponding to the npn equivalent circuits in Fig. 4.5(b) and 4.5(d). They are shown in the figure. Thus, IC = IE 1+ 1 β = E 1 1+ 1 10 = 0.909 mA IB = 0.091 mA For direction of flow, refer to the figure. IB VEB = VT ln ISB iB iE v EB DE (IS /a) B where IS 10−15 = = 10−16 A β 10 0.091 × 10−3 = 0.025 ln 10−16 aiE ISB = VEB = 0.688 V Thus, VE = VB + VEB = 0 + 0.688 = 0.688 V If a transistor with β = 1000 is substituted, IC = IE 1 1+ β = 1 1+ 1 1000 = 0.999 mA Thus, IC changes by 0.999 − 0.909 = 0.09 mA, a 9.9% increase. iC C Chapter 4–6 V7 − 0.7 + 10 V7 + 9.3 = (1) 3 3 Since IB = 0, the collector current will be equal to the current through the 9.1-k resistor, 4.24 = +10 − V7 9.1 Since α1 1, IC = IE = I6 resulting in IC = 4.25 (a) Refer to Fig. P4.25(a). 10.7 − 0.7 = 2 mA 5 k Assuming operation in the active mode, I1 = IC = αI1 I1 = 2 mA (2) V7 + 9.3 10 − V7 = 9.1 3 ⇒ V7 = −4.5 V and I6 = −4.5 + 9.3 V7 + 9.3 = = 1.6 mA 3 3 4.26 (a) V2 = −10.7 + IC × 5 = −10.7 + 2 × 5 = −0.7 V Since V2 is lower than VB , which is 0 V, the transistor is operating in the active mode, as assumed. (b) Refer to Fig. P4.25(b). Since VC = −4 V is lower than VB = −2.7 V, the transistor is operating in the active mode. −4 − (−10) = 2.5 mA 2.4 k IC IC = 2.5 mA IE = α V3 = +12 − IE × 5.6 = 12 − 2.5 × 5.6 = −2 V Since VC is lower than VB , the transistor is operating in the active region. From the figure corresponding to Fig. P4.26(a), we see that (c) Refer to Fig. P4.25(c) and use IB = 0.0215 mA IC = 0 − (−10) = 0.5 mA IC = 20 Assuming active-mode operation, and utilizing the fact that β is large, IB 0 and V4 2 V IC = 1 mA Thus, β≡ 1 IC = 46.5 = IB 0.0215 (b) Since VC < VB , the transistor is indeed operating in the active region. IC IC = 0.5 mA α (d) Refer to Fig. P4.25(d). Since the collector is connected to the base with a 10-k resistor and β is assumed to be very high, the voltage drop across the 10-k resistor will be close to zero and the base voltage will be equal to that of the collector: I5 = IE = VB = V7 This also implies active-mode operation. Now, VE = VB − 0.7 Thus, VE = V7 − 0.7 I6 = VE − (−10) 3 Observe that with VC at 3 V and VB at 4.3 V, the transistor is operating in the active region. Refer to the analysis shown in the figure, which leads to β≡ 3.952 IC = = 82.3 IB 0.048 Chapter 4–7 VE = +0.68 V (c) and 2.5 − 0.68 = 3.64 k 0.5 The maximum allowable value for RC while the transistor remains in the active mode corresponds to VC = +0.4 V. Thus, 0.4 − (−2.5) = 5.86 k RCmax = 0.495 RE = 4.28 VCC IE RC Observe that the transistor is operating in the active region and note the analysis performed on the circuit diagram. Thus, VC IB IC = IE − IB = 3 − 0.04 = 2.96 mA VB and IB IC 2.96 β≡ = 74 = IB 0.04 4.27 IC IE 2.5 V IE 0.5 mA RE VE Since the meter resistance is small, VC VB and the transistor is operating in the active region. To obtain IE = 1 mA, we arrange that VBE = 0.7 V. Since VC VB , VC must be set to 0.7 by selecting RC according to VC = 0.7 = VCC − IE RC Thus, VC 0.5 V IC RC 2.5 V From the figure we see that VC = −0.5 V is lower than the base voltage (VB = 0 V); thus the transistor will be operating in the active mode. β 100 IE = × 0.5 IC = αIE = β +1 100 + 1 = 0.495 mA VC − (−2.5) RC = IC −0.5 + 2.5 = = 4.04 k 4 k 0.495 The transistor VEB can be found from 0.5 mA VEB = 0.64 + VT ln 0.1 mA 0.7 = 9 − 1 × RC ⇒ RC = 8.3 k Since the meter reads full scale when the current flowing through it (in this case, IB is 50 μA), a full-scale reading corresponds to 1 mA IC = 20 β≡ IB 50 μA If the meter reads 1/5 of full scale, then IB = 10 μA and 1 mA β= = 100 10 μA A meter reading of 1/10 full scale indicates that 1 mA = 200 β= 5 μA = 0.68 V 4.29 Refer to Fig. 4.15(a) with RC = 5.1 k and RE = 6.8 k. Assuming VBE 0.7 V, then VE = −0.7 V, and −0.7 − (−15) = 2.1 mA IE = 6.8 IC = αIE 2.1 mA Thus, VC = 15 − 2.1 × 5.1 4.3 V Chapter 4–8 4.30 1.5 V (a) IC a 0.26 0.98 0.26 0.255 mA 4 2.7 k VC 1.5 0.255 2.7 0.81 V 5 6 I I I 0.005 mA B E C 0.8 V 1 a VE 0.8 V 2 0.8 (1.5) 2.7 0.26 mA 1.5 V 2.7 k 3 IE 1.5 V (b) 1.5 0.8 2 0.35 mA 3 6 IE IB IE IC 0.007 mA IB 1 0.8 V 2 k VE 0.8 V 2 VC 1.5 2 0.343 0.81 V 5 2 k IC a 0.35 4 0.98 0.35 0.343 1.5 V 3 V (c) 3 IE 3 1.8 0.12 mA 10 10 k VE 1.8 V 2 1 V 6 1 0.8 V IB IC/50 2.4 A 4 IC a 0.12 0.98 0.12 0.118 mA VC 0.118 2 0.236 V 5 2 k 3 V (d) 4 IC a 0.15 0.147 mA 8.2 k VC 3 0.147 8.2 1.8 V 5 1.5 V 0.15 6 IB 50 3 A IB 3 V IE E 4.7 0.8 V 1 0.7 0.15 mA 4.7 a VE 1.5 0.8 0.7 2 4.7 k Chapter 4–9 In all circuits shown in Fig. P4.30, we assume active-mode operation and verify that this is the case at the end of the solution. The solutions are indicated on the corresponding circuit diagrams; the order of the steps is shown by the circled numbers. 1 v BE /VT IE = IS 1 + e β (3) When the base is left open-circuited, iB = 0 and Eq. (1) yields IS v BE /VT e ICBO = β 4.31 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P4.31. Since VC = 0.5 V is greater than VB , the transistor will be operating in the active mode. The transistor VBE can be found from 0.2 mA VBE = 0.8 + 0.025 ln 1 mA or equivalently, = 0.76 V 4.34 Since the BJT is operating at a constant emitter current, its |VBE | decreases by 2 mV for every ◦ C rise in temperature. Thus, Thus, VE = −0.76 V IC β +1 101 = IC = 0.2 × IE = α β 100 = 0.202 mA Substituting for IS e (4) v BE /VT in Eqs. (2) and (3) gives iC = iE = (β + 1)ICBO |VBE | at 0◦ C = 0.7 + 0.002 × 25 = 0.75 V |VBE | at 100◦ C = 0.7 − 0.002 × 75 = 0.55 V The required value of RE can be found from 4.35 (a) If the junction temperature rises to 50◦ C, which is an increase of 30◦ C, the EB voltage decreases to VE − (−1.5) RE = IE v EB = 692 − 2 × 30 = 632 mV −0.76 + 1.5 = 3.66 k 0.202 To establish VC = 0.5 V, we select RC according to RE = RC = IS ev BE /VT = βICBO (b) First, we evaluate VT at 20◦ C and at 50◦ C: VT = 1.5 − 0.5 = 5 k 0.2 kT q where k = 8.62 × 10−5 eV/K. Thus, 4.32 ICBO approximately doubles for every 10◦ C rise in temperature. A change in temperature from 25◦ C to 125◦ C—that is, an increase of 100◦ C—results in 10 doublings or, equivalently, an increase by a factor of 210 = 1024. Thus ICBO becomes ICBO = 10 nA × 1024 = 10.24 μA At 20◦ C, T = 293 K and VT = 8.62 × 10−5 × 293 = 25.3 mV At 50◦ C, T = 323 K and VT = 8.62 × 10−5 × 323 = 27.8 mV If the transistor is operated at v BE = 700 mV, then (i) At 20◦ C, iE becomes 4.33 iE = 0.5e(700−692)/25.3 = 0.69 mA (ii) At 50◦ C, iE becomes iE = 0.5e(700−632)/27.8 = 5.77 mA 4.36 v BE = 0.7 V at iC = 10 mA For v BE = 0.5 V, From the figure we can write IS v BE /VT e − ICBO IB = β IC = IS ev BE /VT + ICBO iC = 10e(0.5−0.7)/0.025 = 3.35 μA (1) At a current IC and a BE voltage VBE , the slope of the iC –v BE curve is IC /VT . Thus, (2) Slope at VBE of 700 mV = 10 mA = 400 mA/V 25 mV Chapter 4–10 Slope at VBE of 500 mV = = 0.134 mA/V 3.35 μA 25 mV 4.38 R2 68 k I2 400 3000 Ratio of slopes = 0.134 I1 R1 6.8 k IB VBE 4.37 Use Eq. (4.18): v CE iC = IS ev BE /VT 1 + VA At 25◦ C, assume IE = 1 mA. Thus, vBE 0.65 V 0.70 V 0.72 V 0.73 V 0.74 V (V) iC (mA) iC (mA) iC (mA) iC (mA) iC (mA) 0 0.196 1.45 3.21 4.81 7.16 15 0.225 1.67 3.70 5.52 8.24 VBE 0.68 V = 0.1 mA = R1 6.8 k 1 = 0.11 mA 101 Note that the currents in R1 and R2 differ only by the small base current, 0.01 mA. Had I1 and I2 been equal, then we would have had = 0.1 + for the given value of v BE . The slope of each straight line is equal to this value divided by 100 V (VA ). Thus we obtain 0.2 I1 = which is the value assumed. IE I2 = I1 + IB = I1 + β +1 iC = 10−15 ev BE /VT A Intercept (mA) VBE = 0.68 V IE = I − I1 = 1.1 − 0.1 = 1 mA To find the intercept of the straight-line characteristics on the ic axis, we substitute v CE = 0 and evaluate v BE (V) 0.65 VE I 1.1 mA with IS = 10−15 A and VA = 100 V, to get v CE iC = 10−15 ev BE /0.025 1 + 100 vCE IE 0.70 0.72 0.73 0.74 1.45 3.22 4.80 7.16 Slope (mA/V) 0.002 0.015 0.032 0.048 0.072 I1 R1 = VBE I2 R2 I1 R2 = VBE R2 R1 VE = −(I1 R1 + I2 R2 ) R2 (1) = −VBE 1 + R1 6.8 = −11 VBE = −7.48 V = −VBE 1 + 0.68 which gives this circuit the name “VBE multiplier.” A more accurate value of VE can be obtained by taking IB into account: VE = −(I1 R1 + I2 R2 ) R2 = − VBE + VBE + IB R2 R1 R2 VBE − IB R2 =− 1+ R1 (2) = −7.48 − 0.01 × 68 = −8.16 V As temperature increases, an approximate estimate for the temperature coefficient of VE can be obtained by assuming that IE remains constant and ignoring the temperature variation of β. Thus, we would be neglecting the temperature change of the (IB R2 ) terms in Eq. (2). From Eq. (2) we Chapter 4–11 can obtain the temperature coefficient of VE by utilizing the fact the VBE changes by – 2.2 mV/◦ C. Thus, 4.41 iC (mA) Temperature coefficient of VE R2 =− 1+ × −2.2 R1 = −11 × −2.2 = +24.2 mV/◦ C At 75◦ C, which is a temperature increase of 50◦ C, 1.3 1.1 VA 0 5 0.3 10 15 v CE (V) VE = −8.16 + 24.2 × 50 = −6.95 V As a check on our assumption of constant IE , let us find the value of IE at 75◦ C: I1 (75◦ C) = = VBE (75◦ C) R1 0.68 − 2.2 × 10−3 × 50 6.8 Slope of iC –v CE line corresponding to v BE = 710 mV is 0.2 mA 1.3 − 1.1 = = 0.02 mA/V Slope = 15 − 5 10 V Near saturation, VCE = 0.3 V, thus iC = 1.1 − 0.02 × (5 − 0.3) = 1.006 1 mA iC will be 1.2 mA at, = 0.084 mA IE (75◦ C) = I − I1 (75◦ C) = 1.1 − 0.084 = 1.016 mA which is reasonably close to the assumed value of 1 mA. 1.2 − 1.1 = 10 V 0.02 The intercept of the iC –v CE straight line on the iC axis will be at v CE = 5 + iC = 1.1 − 5 × 0.02 = 1 mA Thus, the Early voltage is obtained as iC (at v CE = 0) VA 1 = 50 V ⇒ VA = 0.02 VA 50 V = = 50 k ro = IC 1 mA Slope = 4.39 ro = VA 50 V = IC IC Thus, At IC = 1 mA, ro = At IC = 100 μA, 50 V = 50 k 1 mA ro = 50 V = 500 k 0.1 mA 4.40 ro = 1/slope = 1/(0.8 × 10−5 ) = 125 k ro = VA IC 125 k = VA ⇒ VA = 125 V 1 mA At IC = 10 mA, ro = which is the inverse of the slope of the iC –v CE line. VA 125 V = = 12.5 k IC 10 mA 4.42 The equivalent circuits shown in the figure correspond to the circuits in Fig. 4.19. Chapter 4–12 E (b) (c) For operation deep in saturation with βforced = 10: iE vEB B VCE = 0.2 V DB (IS/b) biB ro C iB iC IC = VCC − VCE 10 − 0.2 = = 9.8 mA RC 1 IB = IC 9.8 = 0.98 mA = βforced 10 VBB = IB RB + VBE iC 1 mA = 100 = iB 10 μA iC 0.08 mA βac = = = 80 iB v CE constant 1.0 μA 4.43 β = iC = iB × βac + v CE ro where ro = VA 100 = = 100 k IC 1 Thus, iC = 2 × 80 + 2 × 103 = 180 μA 100 = 0.18 mA = 0.98 × 10 + 0.7 = 10.5 V 4.45 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P4.44 (with VBB = VCC ) and to the BJT equivalent circuit of Fig. 4.21. IC = VCC − 0.2 RC IB = VCC − 0.7 RB βforced ≡ IC IB Thus, βforced = VCC − 0.2 VCC − 0.7 RB RC (1) Pdissipated = VCC (IC + IB ) 4.44 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P4.44. = VCC (βforced IB + IB ) (a) For active-mode operation with VC = 2 V: = (βforced + 1)VCC IB IC = VCC − VC 10 − 2 = = 8 mA RC 1 IB = 8 IC = = 0.16 mA β 50 VBB = IB RB + VBE = 0.16 × 10 + 0.7 = 2.3 V (b) For operation at the edge of saturation: VCE = 0.3 V IC = VCC − VCE 10 − 0.3 = 9.7 mA = RC 1 IB = 9.7 IC = = 0.194 mA β 50 (2) For VCC = 5 V and βforced = 10 and Pdissipated ≤ 20 mW, we can proceed as follows. Using Eq. (1) we can determine (RB /RC ): 5 − 0.2 RB 10 = 5 − 0.7 RC ⇒ RB = 8.96 RC Using Eq. (2), we can find IB : (10 + 1) × 5 × IB ≤ 20 mW ⇒ IB ≤ 0.36 mA Thus, VBB = IB RB + VBE VCC − 0.7 ≤ 0.36 mA RB = 0.194 × 10 + 0.7 = 2.64 V ⇒ RB ≥ 11.9 k (3) Chapter 4–13 From the table of 1% resistors in Appendix J we select Thus, RB = 12.1 k IC = 5 − 0.3 = 4.7 mA 1 RC = 1.35 k IB = 4.7 IC = = 0.094 mA β 50 From the table of 1% resistors in Appendix J we select RB = 4.3 4.3 = 45.7 k = IB 0.094 Substituting in Eq. (3), we have RC = 1.37 k For these values: 5 − 0.2 = 3.5 mA IC = 1.37 5 − 0.7 = 0.36 mA IB = 12.1 Thus, 4.47 3 V 1 k IE 1.3 mA 3 IC VC 3 1.3 1 1.7 V 4 3.5 = 9.7 βforced = 0.36 Pdissipated = VCC (IC + IB ) 2 V VE 2 0.7 1.3 V 1 1.3 IE 1.3 mA 2 1 = 5 × 3.86 = 19.2 mW 1 k 4.46 5 V VB 4.3 V RB 10 k V ECsat (a) 3 V 0.2 V VC 3 1 1 2 V VC 4.8 V IB 4 1.7 V IC 1 k VE 1.0 V 1 1.0 IE 1 1 mA 2 1 k Assume saturation-mode operation. From the figure we see that (b) 4.8 VC = = 4.8 mA 1 k 1 VB 4.3 = 0.43 mA = IB = RB 10 3 V IC = 0 3 1 k Thus, βforced ≡ IC 4.8 = = 11.2 IB 0.43 Since 11.2 is lower than the transistor β of 50, we have verified that the transistor is operating in saturation, as assumed. VC = VCC − VECsat = 5 − 0.2 = 4.8 V To operate at the edge of saturation, VEC = 0.3 V and IE 1 mA 3 IC 1 k IC /IB = β = 50 VC 3 0 3 V 4 0V VE 0 V 1 k 0 2 (c) 1 Chapter 4–14 The analysis and the results are given on the circuit diagrams of Figs. 1 through 3 (see preceding page). The circled numbers indicate the order of the analysis steps. 4.48 For βforced = 2, IC =2 IB 3.5 − VB =2 2VB − 4.2 3 V 1 k 3 (VB 0.4) IC 1 VC VB 0.4 VCE 0.3 V VB V 0.7 IE B 1 IB = IE − IC = 2VB − 4.2 VB 0.7 1 k ⇒ VB = 2.38 V 4.49 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P4.49. (a) For VB = −1 V, VE = VB − VBE = −1 − 0.7 = −1.7 V IE = −1.7 + 3 VE − (−3) = = 1.3 mA 1 1 Assuming active-mode operation, we have Figure 1 IC = αIE IE = 1.3 mA Figure 1 shows the circuit with the value of VB that results in operation at the edge of saturation. Since β is very high, IC IE VC = +3 − IC × 1 = 3 − 1.3 = +1.7 V Since VC > VB − 0.4, the transistor is operating in the active mode as assumed. (b) For VB = 0 V, 3 − (VB − 0.4) VB − 0.7 = 1 1 VE = 0 − VBE = −0.7 V ⇒ VB = 2.05 V IE = 3 V IC Assuming operation in the active mode, we have 1 k IB VB 0.5 VCEsat 0.2 V VB IE −0.7 − (−3) = 2.3 mA 1 VB 0.7 1 k IC = αIE IE = 2.3 mA VC = +3 − IC × 1 = 3 − 2.3 = +0.7 V Since VC > VB − 0.4, the BJT is operating in the active mode, as assumed. (c) For VB = +1 V, VE = 1 − 0.7 = +0.3 V Figure 2 Figure 2 shows the circuit with the value of VB that results in the transistor operating in saturation, with IE = VB − 0.7 = VB − 0.7 1 IC = 3 − (VB − 0.5) = 3.5 − VB 1 IE = 0.3 − (−3) = 3.3 mA 1 Assuming operation in the active mode, we have IC = αIE IE = 3.3 mA VC = 3 − 3.3 × 1 = −0.3 V Now VC < VB − 0.4, indicating that the transistor is operating in saturation, and our original assumption is incorrect. It follows that Chapter 4–15 VC = VE + VCEsat = 0.3 + 0.2 = 0.5 V IC = 3 − VC 3 − 0.5 = = 2.5 mA 1 1 IB = IE − IC = 3.3 − 2.5 = 0.8 mA βforced = IC 2.5 = 3.1 = IB 0.8 (d) When VB = 0 V, IE = 2.3 mA. The emitter current becomes 0.23 mA at IE = VB − 0.7 − (−3) = VB + 2.3 1 VC = VE + VCEsat = VB − 0.7 + 0.2 = VB − 0.5 IC = 3 − (VB − 0.5) = 3.5 − VB 1 IB = IE − IC = 2 VB − 1.2 IC 3.5 − VB = =2 IB 2 VB − 1.2 ⇒ VB = +1.18 V VB = −3 + 0.23 × 1 + 0.7 = −2.07 V 4.50 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P4.50. (e) The transistor will be at the edge of conduction when IE 0 and VBE = 0.5 V, that is, VE = 1 V VB = −3 + 0.5 = −2.5 V IE = In this case, VB = VE − 0.7 = 0.3 V VE = −3 V VC = +3 V (f) The transistor reaches the edge of saturation when VCE = 0.3 V but IC = αIE IE : VE = VB − 0.7 IE = VB − 0.7 − (−3) = VB + 2.3 1 VC = VE + 0.3 = VB − 0.4 IC = 3 − VC 3 − VB + 0.4 = = 3.4 − VB 1 1 IB = 3−1 = 0.4 mA 5 VB 0.3 = = 0.006 mA 50 k 50 IC = IE − IB = 0.4 − 0.006 = 0.394 mA VC = −3 + 5 × 0.394 = −1.03 V Observe that VC < VB , confirming our implicit assumption that the transistor is operating in the active region. β= IC 0.394 = = 66 IB 0.006 α= IC 0.394 = 0.985 = IE 0.4 Since IC IE 4.51 VCC 3 V 3.4 − VB = VB + 2.3 VB = 0.55 V For this value, VE = 0.55 − 0.7 = −0.15 V 0.1 mA RC 1 k R1 0 VB 1.2 V VC = −0.15 + 0.3 = +0.15 V (g) For the transistor to operate in saturation with βforced = 2, VE = VB − 0.7 RE 1 k R2 Figure 1 Chapter 4–16 4.52 From Fig. 1 we see that R1 + R2 = VCC 3 VCC = = 30 k 0.1 mA 0.1 3 V R2 = 1.2 R1 + R2 RE IB R2 3× = 1.2 30 RB 20 k R1 = 30 − 12 = 18 k VC IC For β = 100, to obtain the collector current, we replace the voltage divider with its Thévenin equivalent, consisting of R2 12 =3× = 1.2 V R1 + R2 18 + 12 3 V Writing a loop equation for the EBJ loop, we have = IE × 2.2 + 0.7 + 3 V ⇒ IE = IC RC 2.2 k 3 = IE RE + VEB + IB RB RB = R1 R2 = 12 18 = 7.2 k VBB VE VB ⇒ R2 = 12 k VBB = 3 × 2.2 k IE RC 1 k VC RB (1) IE × 20 β +1 3 − 0.7 = 0.86 mA 20 2.2 + 41 VE = 3 − 0.86 × 2.2 = +1.11 V VB = VE − 0.7 = +0.41 V IB Assuming active-mode operation, we obtain IE RE 1 k IC = αIE = 40 × 0.86 = 0.84 mA 41 VC = −3 + 0.84 × 2.2 = −1.15 V Figure 2 Refer to Fig. 2. Assuming active-mode operation, we can write a loop equation for the base–emitter loop: VBB = IB RB + VBE + IE RE 1.2 = IE × 7.2 + 0.7 + IE × 1 β +1 ⇒ IE = 1.2 − 0.7 = 0.47 mA 7.2 1+ 101 IC = αIE = 0.99 × 0.47 = 0.46 mA VC = +3 − 0.46 × 1 = +2.54 V Since VB = IE RE + VBE = 0.47 + 0.7 = 1.17 V, we see that VC > VB − 0.4, and thus the transistor is operating in the active region, as assumed. Since VC < VB + 0.4, the transistor is operating in the active mode, as assumed. Now, if RB is increased to 100 k, the loop equation [Eq. (1)] yields IE = 3 − 0.7 = 0.5 mA 100 2.2 + 41 VE = 3 − 0.5 × 2.2 = +1.9 V VB = VE − VEB = 1.9 − 0.7 = +1.2 V Assuming active-mode operation, we obtain IC = αIE = 40 × 0.5 = 0.48 mA 41 VC = −3 + 0.48 × 2.2 = −1.9 V Since VC < VB + 0.4, the transistor is operating in the active mode, as assumed. Chapter 4–17 If with RB = 100 k, we need the voltages to remain at the values obtained with RB = 20 k, the transistor must have a β value determined as follows. For IE to remain unchanged, 4.54 5 V IB 3 − 0.7 3 − 0.7 = 20 100 2.2 + 2.2 + 41 β +1 ⇒ RB RC 1 k VC 20 100 = 41 β +1 β +1= IC VB 410 = 205 2 IE VE RE 1 k β = 204 4.53 3 V IE A loop equation for the EB loop yields 5 = IB RB + VBE + IE RE RE ⇒ IE = VE 0.7 V IE = VBC 1 V VC 1 V IC RC 5 − 0.7 RB RE + β +1 4.3 RB 1+ 101 (a) For RB = 100 k, IE = 3 V 4.3 = 2.16 mA 100 1+ 101 VE = IE RE = 2.16 × 1 = 2.16 V Refer to the figure. To obtain IE = 0.5 mA we select RE according to RE = Assuming active-mode operation, we obtain 3 − 0.7 = 4.6 k 0.5 IC = αIE = 0.99 × 2.16 = 2.14 mA To obtain VC = −1 V, we select RC according to RC = −1 − (−3) = 4 k 0.5 and VC = 5 − 2.14 × 1 = +2.86 V Since VC > VB − 0.4, the transistor is operating in the active region, as assumed. where we have utilized the fact that α 1 and thus IC IE = 0.5 mA. From the table of 5% resistors in Appendix J we select RE = 4.7 k VB = VE + 0.7 = 2.86 V RC = 3.9 k For these values, (b) For RB = 10 k, IE = 4.3 = 3.91 mA 10 1+ 101 VE = 3.91 × 1 = 3.91 V VB = 3.91 + 0.7 = 4.61 V 3 − 0.7 IE = = 0.49 mA 4.7 Assuming active-mode operation, we obtain IC IE = 0.49 mA IC = αIE = 0.99 × 3.91 = 3.87 mA VBC = 0 − VC = −(−3 + 0.49 × 3.9) = −1.1 V VC = 5 − 3.87 = +1.13 V Chapter 4–18 Since VC < VB − 0.4, the transistor is operating in saturation, contrary to our original assumption. Therefore, we need to redo the analysis assuming saturation-mode operation, as follows: VB = VE + 0.7 VC = VE + VCEsat = VE + 0.2 5 − VB IB = RB 4.3 − VE 5 − VE − 0.7 = = 10 10 5 − VC 5 − VE − 0.2 = IC = RC 1 = 4.8 − VE IE = VE VE = VE = RE 1 (1) VC = 3.2 V Now checking the currents, IB = 5 − 3.7 = 1.3 mA 1 IC = 5 − 3.2 = 1.8 mA 1 Thus, the transistor is operating at a forced β of βforced = (2) IC 1.8 = = 1.4 IB 1.3 which is much lower than the value of β, confirming operation in saturation. (3) Substituting from Eqs. (1), (2), and (3) into IE = IB + IC gives 4.55 For the solutions and answers to parts (a) through (e), see the corresponding circuit diagrams. VE = 0.43 − 0.1 VE + 4.8 − VE ⇒ VE = 2.5 V VC = 2.7 V IC VB = 3.2 V 5 − 3.2 = 0.18 mA IB = 10 5 − 2.7 = 2.3 mA IC = 1 Thus, 2.3 IC = = 12.8 IB 0.18 3 V (a) 0.5 mA 3.6 k V2 3 0.5 3.6 1.2 V 43 k IB 0 0V V1 0.7 V which is lower than the value of β, verifying saturation-mode operation. 0.5 mA (c) For RB = 1 k, we assume saturation-mode operation: VB = VE + 0.7 VC = VE + 0.2 5 − (VE + 0.7) = 4.3 − VE IB = 1 5 − (VE + 0.2) IC = = 4.8 − VE 1 VE IE = = VE 1 These values can be substituted into (b) 3 V 3.6 k ~ 0.5 mA V3 3 0.5 3.6 1.2 V ~0 IB IE = IB + IC VE 0.7 V to obtain 4.7 k VE = 4.3 − VE + 4.8 − VE I4 0.7 (3) 0.5 mA 4.7 ⇒ VE = 3 V VB = 3.7 V 3 V Chapter 4–19 3 V a (d) 3 V (c) 3 1.45 6.2 0.25 mA IE 0.5 mA 3.6 k V8 0.75 0.7 1.45 V 0.75 V ~ 0 mA V7 3 0.5 3.6 1.2 V 43 k 6.2 k 110 k IB 0 V6 V5 0.7 V 0 V9 3 0.25 10 0.5 V 0.75 V 4.7 k IE 0.7 (–3) 4.7 0.5 mA 3 V 10 k 0.25 mA 3 V 3 V (e) 6 480 0.0125 mA I 3 1.45 IE 0.25 mA 6.2 6.2 k 180 k V11 0.75 0.7 1.45 V V10 3 0.0125 300 0.75 V 0 V12 3 10 0.25 10 k 0.5 V 300 k 0.25 mA 3 V 4.56 (a) 3 V IC a 0.5 0.99 0.5 0.495 mA 3.6 k VB 0.005 43 0.215 V V2 3 0.495 3.6 1.218 V 43 k IB 0.5 101 0.005 mA V1 0.215 0.7 0.915 V 0.5 mA 3 V (a) See solution and answer on the figure, which corresponds to Fig. P4.55(a). Chapter 4–20 (b) 3 V a 0.5 0.495 mA 3.6 k IB 0.5 101 V3 3 0.495 3.6 1.218 V 0.005 mA VE 0.7 4.7 k I4 0.7 (3) 4.7 0.5 mA 3 V (b) See solution and answer on the figure, which corresponds to Fig. P4.55(b). (c) (d) 3 V IC 3 V 3.6 k IE V7 V6 0.75 V 43 k 6.2 k V8 IB IB IE /(b 1) 110 k V5 V9 4.7 k IE IC 3 V 10 k 3 V (c) (d) Writing an equation for the loop containing the BEJ of the transistor leads to IE = 3 − 0.7 = 0.449 mA 43 4.7 + 101 V5 = −3 + 0.449 × 4.7 = −0.9 V An equation for the loop containing the EBJ of the transistor yields IE = 3 − 0.75 − 0.7 = 0.213 mA 110 6.2 + 101 V6 = −0.9 + 0.7 = −0.2 V V8 = +3 − 0.213 × 6.2 = +1.7 V IC = αIE = 0.99 × 0.449 = 0.444 mA IC = αIE = 0.99 × 0.213 = 0.21 mA V7 = 3 − 0.444 × 3.6 = +1.4 V V9 = −3 + 0.21 × 10 = −0.9 V Chapter 4–21 This figure belongs to Problem 4.56, part (e). 3 V 3 V IE IE 6.2 k 6.2 k 180 k V11 VBB V10 3 V V12 IC 10 k 3 V (e) (e) See figure above. First, we use Thévenin’s theorem to replace the voltage divider feeding the base with VBB and RB : 6 × 300 = +0.75 V = −3 + 480 Since VC = 2 V is lower than VB , which is +2.3 V, the transistor will be operating in the active mode. Thus, IC = βIB = 50 × 0.023 = 1.15 mA To obtain VC = 2 V, we select RC according to RC = RB = 180 300 = 112.5 k Next we write an equation for the loop containing the EBJ to obtain IE = RB 10 k 300 k VBB V10 V12 IC V11 IB IB VC 2V = 1.74 k = IC 1.15 mA Now, if the transistor is replaced with another having β = 100, then IC = 100 × 0.023 = 2.3 mA 3 − 0.75 − 0.7 = 0.212 mA 112.5 6.2 + 101 which would imply VC = 2.3 × 1.74 = 4 V V11 = +3 − 0.212 × 6.2 = +1.7 V V10 = 1.7 − 0.7 = +1 V which is impossible because the base is at 2.3 V. Thus the transistor must be in the saturation mode and IC = αIE = 0.99 × 0.212 = 0.21 mA VC = VE − VECsat V12 = −3 + 0.21 × 10 = −0.9 V = 3 − 0.2 = 2.8 V 4.58 4.57 5 V 3 V RE IE 2.3 V IB 100 k VC IC RC RB VC IC IB = 2.3 V = 0.023 mA 100 k RC 5 V Chapter 4–22 We required IE to be nominally 1 mA (i.e., at β = 100) and to remain within ±10% as β varies from 50 to 150. Writing an equation for the loop containing the EBJ results in To obtain the value of RC , we note that at the nominal emitter current value of 1 mA, VC = −1 V, 5 − 0.7 IE = RB RE + β +1 −1 − (−5) = 4.04 k 0.99 Specified to the nearest kilohm, Thus, RC = 4 k 4.3 4.3 RE + RB 51 (1) = IEmin (2) 4.3 RE + RC = =1 RB RE + 101 RB 151 IC = αIE = 0.99 mA Finally, for our design we need to determine the range obtained for collector current and collector voltage for β ranging from 50 to 150 with a nominal value of 100. We compute the nominal value of IE from 4.3 = 0.96 mA 50 4+ 101 We utilize Eqs. (2) and (3) to compute IEmin and IEmax , IEnominal = = IEmax (3) If we set IEmin = 0.9 mA and solve Eqs. (1) and (2) simultaneously, we obtain RE = 3.81 k 4.3 = 0.86 mA 50 4+ 51 4.3 = 0.99 mA = 50 4+ 151 IEmin = IEmax RB = 49.2 k Substituting theses values in Eqs. (2) and (3) gives Thus, IEmin = 0.9 mA 0.99 IEmax = = 1.03 IEnominal 0.96 IEmax = 1.04 mA 0.86 IEmin = 0.9 = IEnominal 0.96 Obviously, this is an acceptable design. Alternatively, if we set IEmax in Eq. (3) to 1.1 mA and solve Eqs. (1) and (3) simultaneously, we obtain which meet our specifications. The collector currents are RE = 3.1 k RB = 119.2 k ICnominal = 0.99 × 0.96 = 0.95 mA ICmin = 0.99 × 0.86 = 0.85 mA ICmax = 0.99 × 0.99 = 0.98 mA and the collector voltages are Substituting these values in Eqs. (2) and (3) gives VCnominal = −5 + 0.95 × 4 = −1.2 V IEmin = 0.8 mA VCmin = −5 + 0.85 × 4 = −1.6 V IEmax = 1.1 mA Obviously this is not an acceptable design (IEmin is 20% lower than nominal). Therefore, we shall use the first design. Specifying the resistor values to the nearest kilohm results in RE = 4 k RB = 50 k VCmax = −5 + 0.98 × 4 = −1.1 V 4.59 Figure 1 on next page shows the circuit with β = ∞; the required voltage values are indicated. The resistor values are obtained as follows: V2 = −0.7 V V2 − (−5) 0.5 mA ⇒ R1 = 8.6 k R1 = Chapter 4–23 This figure belongs to Problem 4.59. 5 V 0.5 mA 0.5 mA 1 mA R3 R2 R5 V4 0 V7 1 V Q2 V3 = 0 Q1 0 0.5 mA V2 Q3 R1 V5 = –2 V R4 0.5 mA V6 R6 1 mA –5 V Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 4.59. 5 V I1 IE2 10 k 8.2 k 3.9 k V4 IB2 V7 Q2 IC3 IC1 Q1 IC2 V3 V2 IE1 8.2 k IB3 Q3 I2 V5 IE3 V6 2.4 k 6.2 k –5 V Figure 2 R2 = 5−0 5 − V3 = = 10 k 0.5 0.5 V4 = 0 + 0.7 = 0.7 V Consulting the table of 5% resistors in Appendix J, we select the following resistor values: R3 = 5 − 0.7 5 − V4 = = 8.6 k 0.5 0.5 R1 = 8.2 k R2 = 10 k R3 = 10 k R4 = −2 + 5 V5 − (−5) = = 6 k 0.5 0.5 R4 = 6.2 k R5 = 3.9 k R6 = 2.4 k V6 = V5 − 0.7 = −2 − 0.7 = −2.7 V R6 = V6 − (−5) −2.7 + 5 = = 2.3 k 1 1 R5 = 5 − V7 5−1 = = 4 k 1 1 The circuit with the selected resistor values is shown in Fig. 2. Analysis of the circuit proceeds as follows: V2 = −0.7 V Chapter 4–24 IE1 = V2 − (−5) −0.7 + 5 = = 0.524 mA 8.2 8.2 IC1 = αIE1 = 0.99 × 0.524 = 0.52 mA (b) For v I = +2 V, Q1 will be conducting and Q2 will be cut off, and the circuit reduces to that in Fig. 1. 2.5 V The current I1 through the 10-k resistor is given by IE2 101 I1 = IC1 − IB2 = IC1 − 10 k 2 V Q1 IB VB Noting that the voltage drop across the 10 k resistor is equal to (IE2 × 8.2 + 0.7), we can write VE IE I1 × 10 = 8.2IE2 + 0.7 1 k Thus, IE2 = 8.2IE2 + 0.7 10 0.52 − 101 ⇒ IE2 = 0.542 mA V4 = 5 − 0.542 × 8.2 = 0.56 V V3 = 0.56 − 0.7 = −0.14 V Figure 1 Since VB will be lower than +2 V, VC will be higher than VB and the transistor will be operating in the active mode. Thus, IE = IC2 = αIE2 = 0.99 × 0.542 = 0.537 mA I2 = IC2 − IB3 = 0.537 − IE3 101 Since the voltage drop across the 6.2-k resistor is equal to (0.7 + IE3 × 2.4), I2 × 6.2 = 0.7 + 2.4IE3 2 − 0.7 = 1.1 mA 10 1+ 51 VE = +1.1 V VB = 1.8 V (c) For v I = −2.5, Q1 will be off and Q2 will be on, and the circuit reduces to that in Fig. 2. IE3 = 0.7 + 2.4IE3 6.2 0.537 − 101 ⇒ IE3 = 1.07 mA V6 = −5 + 1.07 × 2.4 = −2.43 V V5 = V6 + 0.7 = −1.73 IC3 = α × IE3 = 0.99 × 1.07 = 1.06 mA Figure 2 V7 = −3.9 × 1.06 = 0.87 V Since VB > −2.5, VC will be lower than VB and Q2 will be operating in the active region. Thus 4.60 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P4.60. IE = (a) For v I = 0, both transistors are cut off and all currents are zero. Thus VE = −IE × 1 = −1.5 V VB = 0 V VB = −1.5 − 0.7 = −2.2 V and VE = 0 V 2.5 − 0.7 = 1.5 mA 10 1+ 51 Chapter 4–25 (d) For v I = −5 V, Q1 will be off and Q2 will be on, and the circuit reduces to that in Fig. 3. Assuming saturation-mode operation, the terminal voltages are interrelated as shown in the figure, which corresponds to Fig. P4.61(a). Thus we can write IE = VE = VE 1 IC = 5 − (VE + 0.2) = 0.5 − 0.1(VE + 0.2) 10 IB = 5 − (VE + 0.7) = 0.25 − 0.05(VE + 0.7) 20 Now, imposing the constraint Figure 3 Here we do not know whether Q2 is operating in the active mode or in saturation. Assuming active-mode operation, we obtain 5 − 0.7 = 3.6 mA 10 1+ 51 VE = −3.6 V IE = IC + IB results in VE = 0.5 − 0.1(VE + 0.2) + 0.25 − 0.05(VE + 0.7) IE = ⇒ VE = 0.6 V VB = −4.3 V VC = 0.8 V which is impossible, indicating that our original assumption is incorrect and that Q2 is saturated. Assuming saturation-mode operation, we obtain VB = 1.3 V VE = VC + VECsat = −2.5 + 0.2 = −2.3 V −VE = 2.3 mA IE = 1 k VB = VE − 0.7 = −3 V −3 − (−5) = 0.2 mA IB = 10 IC = IE − IB = 2.3 − 0.2 = 2.1 mA IC 2.1 = = 10.5 βforced = IB 0.2 IC = 5 − 0.8 = 0.42 mA 10 IB = 5 − 1.3 = 0.185 mA 20 βforced = 0.42 = 2.3 0.185 which is less than the value of β1 verifying saturation-mode operation. (b) which is lower than β, verifying that Q2 is operating in saturation. 5 V IE 4.61 (a) 5 V 20 k VE IC 10 k IB 1 k VE + 0.2 VE – 0.7 VE – 0.2 IB 10 k IC 1 k VE + 0.7 V VE IE 1 k (a) –5 V (b) Assuming saturation-mode operation, the terminal voltages are interrelated as shown in the Chapter 4–26 shown in the figure, which corresponds to Fig. P4.61(c), we denote the voltage at the emitter of Q3 as V and then obtain the voltages at all other nodes in terms of V , utilizing the fact that a saturated transistor has |VCE | = 0.2 V and of course |VBE | = 0.7 V. Note that the choice of the collector node to begin the analysis is arbitrary; we could have selected any other node and denoted its voltage as V . We next draw a circle around the two transistors to define a “supernode.” A node equation for the supernode will be figure, which corresponds to Fig. P4.61(b). We can obtain the currents as follows: IE = 5 − VE = 5 − VE 1 IC = VE − 0.2 = VE − 0.2 1 IB = VE − 0.7 − (−5) = 0.1 VE + 0.43 10 Imposing the constraint IE3 + IC4 = IB3 + I + IE4 IE = IB + IC (1) where results in IE3 = 5 − (V + 0.2) = 0.48 − 0.1V 10 (2) ⇒ VE = +2.27 V IC4 = 5 − (V − 0.5) = 0.183 − 0.033V 30 (3) VC = +2.07 V IB3 = 5 − (V − 0.5) = 0.1V − 0.05 10 (4) 5 − VE = VE − 0.2 + 0.1 VE + 0.43 VB = 1.57 V I= 2.07 IC = = 2.07 mA 1 IE4 = 1.57 − (−5) IB = = 0.657 mA 10 βforced = V = 0.05V 20 (5) V − 0.7 = 0.1V − 0.07 10 (6) Substituting from Eqs. (2)–(6) into Eq. (1) gives 0.48 − 0.1V + 0.183 − 0.033V = 0.1V − 0.05 + 0.05V + 0.1V − 0.07 IC 2.07 = 3.2 = IB 0.657 ⇒ V = 2.044 V which is lower than the value of β, verifying saturation-mode operation. Thus (c) We shall assume that both Q3 and Q4 are operating in saturation. To begin the analysis VC3 = V = 2.044 V This figure belongs to Problem 4.61, part (c). 5 V IE3 IC4 10 k 30 k Supernode V + 0.2 V – 0.5 Q3 IB3 10 k V – 0.5 V I Q4 20 k V – 0.7 10 k IE4 (c) Chapter 4–27 VC4 = V − 0.5 = 1.54 V Thus, Next we determine all currents utilizing Eqs. (2)–(6): ID1 × 40 = IE1 × 2 IE3 = 0.276 mA IC4 = 0.116 mA ⇒ ID1 = 0.05IE1 IB3 = 0.154 mA I = 0.102 mA But IE4 = 0.134 ID1 = The base current of Q4 can be obtained from IB4 = IE4 − IC4 = 0.134 − 0.116 = 0.018 mA Thus, Finally, the collector current of Q3 can be found as IE1 = IC3 = I + IB4 = 0.102 + 0.018 = 0.120 βforced4 0.069 = 1.38 mA 1.4 mA 0.05 VE1 = IE1 × 2 = 2.77 V 2.8 V The forced β values can now be found as βforced3 = 9 − 0.7 = 0.069 mA 0.07 mA 80 + 40 VB1 = VE1 + 0.7 = 3.5 V IC3 0.120 = 0.8 = IB3 0.154 IC1 = IE1 = 1.38 mA 1.4 mA IC4 0.116 = = = 6.4 IB4 0.018 V2 = 9 − IC1 × 2 = 9 − 1.38 × 2 6.2 V Both βforced values are well below the β value of 50, verifying that Q3 and Q4 are in deep saturation. VC1 = V2 − VD2 = 6.2 − 0.7 = 5.5 V VE2 = V2 = 6.2 V 9 − 6.2 = 28 mA 100 4.62 (a) Consider first the case β = ∞ and R open circuited. The circuit is shown in Fig. 1 below, where β = ∞ and R is open circuited. Since VD1 = VBE1 , we have IE2 = V1 = VE1 VC2 = 28 × 0.1 = 2.8 V IC2 = IE = 28 mA This figure belongs to Problem 4.62, part (a). 9 V 2 k IC1 80 k IE2 100 V2 ID1 VC1 0 VB1 ID1 D1 V1 40 k Q2 0 IC1 Q1 IC2 IE2 IE1 VE1 VC2 100 2 k Figure 1 VE2 D2 β = ∞, and R is open circuited Chapter 4–28 VE1 = 1.22 × 2 = 2.44 V VB1 = 2.44 + 0.7 = 3.14 V IC1 = αIE1 = 0.99 × 1.22 = 1.21 mA R 2 k 2.8 V Observing that VE2 = V2 , we see that the voltage drops across the 2-k resistor and the 100- resistor are equal, thus 2.8 V 0 ID2 × 2 = IE2 × 0.1 ⇒ ID2 = 0.05IE2 Figure 2 As the base current of Q2 is approximately 0.01IE2 , a node equation at C1 yields Now connecting the resistance R = 2 k between C1 and E2 (see Fig. 2) both of which at 2.8 V, will result in zero current through R; thus all voltages and currents remain unchanged. ID2 = IC1 − 0.01IE2 Thus, (b) We next consider the situation with β = 100, first with R disconnected. The circuit is shown in Fig. 3 below. 0.05IE2 = IC1 − 0.01IE2 ⇒ 0.06IE2 = IC1 Once again we observe that VE1 = V1 , thus IE2 = IE1 × 2 = ID1 × 40 ID2 = 0.05 × 20.13 = 1 mA ⇒ ID1 = 0.05IE1 VC1 = 9 − 1 × 2 − 0.7 = 6.3 V The base current of Q1 is IE1 /101 0.01IE1 . Thus, the current through the 80-k resistor is 0.05IE1 + 0.01IE1 = 0.06IE1 and VE2 = 6.3 + 0.7 = 7 V IC2 = αIE2 = 0.99 × 20.13 = 20 mA VB1 = VE1 + 0.7 = 2IE1 + 0.7 0.06IE1 IC1 1.21 = = 20.13 mA 0.06 0.06 VC2 = 20 × 0.1 = 2 V 9 − (2IE1 + 0.7) 9 − VB1 = = 80 80 Finally, with the resistance R connected between E1 and C2 , it will conduct a current that we can initially estimate as ⇒ IE1 = 1.22 mA 9 V VE 2 D2 Q2 IC1 VB1 ID1 0.05 IE1 100 V2 0.06 IE1 D1 IE 2 2 k ID2 80 k 0.01IE 2 Q1 0.01IE IE1 V1 40 k VE1 2 k Figure 3 VC2 100 Chapter 4–29 9V IE 2 100 2 k 80 k V2 VE2 (ID1 IB1) (IC1 IB2) VC1 VB1 D1 ID1 VE2 D2 IC1 Q2 IB2 Q1 IB1 V1 40 k IC2 I IE1 VE1 R VC2 2 k 100 2 k Figure 4 I= 2.44 − 2 VE1 − VC2 = = 0.22 mA R 2 This is a substantial amount compared to IE1 = 1.22 mA, requiring that we redo the analysis with R in place. The resulting circuit is shown in Fig. 4 above. Denoting the emitter voltage of Q1 , VE1 , and the current through R as I , the analysis proceeds as follows: IC2 = 10.1VE1 − 21.2I α ID2 × 2 = IE2 × 0.1 IE2 = 2(0.395VE1 + 1.2I ) = 0.1(10.1VE1 − 21.2I ) ⇒ I = 0.05VE2 Voltage drop across 80-k resistor = (0.03 VE1 + 0.01I ) × 80 = 9 − VE1 − 0.7 Substituting I = 0.05 VE2 gives V1 = VE1 VE1 = 2.41 V VE1 V1 = = 0.025VE1 ID1 = 40 40 VE1 + I = 0.5VE1 + I IE1 = 2 IE1 IB1 = = 0.005VE1 + 0.01I 101 I = 0.12 mA I80 k = ID1 + IB1 = 0.03VE1 + 0.01I IC1 = 1.31 mA VC2 = VE1 − I × 2 = VE1 − 2I ID1 = 1.09 mA IC2 = −I + IB2 = VC2 = 10VE1 − 21I 0.1 IC2 = 0.1VE1 − 0.21I 101 IC1 = αIE1 = 0.495VE1 + 0.99I ID2 = IC1 − IB2 = 0.395VE1 + 1.2I Substituting these quantities in the equations above gives VB1 = 2.41 + 0.7 = 3.11 V IE1 = 1.325 mA VC1 = 9 − 1.09 × 2 − 0.7 = 6.12 V VE2 = 6.82 V 9 − 6.82 = 21.8 mA 0.1 = 0.99 × 21.8 = 21.6 mA IE2 = IC2 VC2 = 2.17 V Exercise 5–1 Ex: 5.1 ox 34.5 pF/m = 8.625 fF/μm2 = Cox = tox 4 nm Similarly, VDS = 1 V results in saturation-mode operation and ID = 0.25 mA. μn = 450 cm2 /V · S Ex: 5.6 VA = VA L = 50 × 0.8 = 40 V k n = μn Cox = 388 μA/V2 λ= VOV = (v GS − Vt ) = 0.5 V 1 W W = k n VOV ⇒ = 5.15 gDS = 1 k L L L = 0.18 μm, so W = 0.93 μm Ex: 5.2 Cox = ox 34.5 pF/m = 8.6 fF/μm2 = tox 4 nm μn = 450 cm2 /V · s k n = μn Cox = 387 μA/V2 ID = 1 W 2 W k V = 0.3 mA, = 20 2 n L OV L ∴ V OV = 0.28 V VDS, min = VOV = 0.28 V, for saturation 1 = 0.025 V−1 VA VDS = 1 V > VOV = 0.5 V ⇒ Saturation: I D = 1 W 2 k V (1 + λVDS ) 2 n L OV 1 16 × 200 × × 0.52 (1 + 0.025 × 1) 2 0.8 = 0.51 mA VA 40 = = 80 k ro = ID 0.5 ID = where ID is the value of ID without channel-length modulation taken into account. V DS 2V ⇒ IO = = 0.025 mA ro = I O 80 k Ex: 5.7 5 V 1 W 2 k V in saturation 2 n L OV Change in ID is: Ex: 5.3 ID = VG ID (a) double L, 0.5 VD (b) double W , 2 (c) double VOV , 22 = 4 Vtp = −1 V (d) double VDS , no change (ignoring length modulation) k p = 60 μA/V2 (e) changes (a)–(d), 4 W = 10 ⇒ k p = 600 μA/V2 L (a) Conduction occurs for VSG ≥ |Vtp | = 1 V Case (c) would cause leaving saturation if VDS < 2VOV Ex: 5.4 For saturation v DS ≥ VOV , so VDS must be changed to 2VOV ID = 1 W 2 k V , so ID increases by a factor of 4. 2 n L OV Ex: 5.5 VOV = 0.5 V 1 VOV = gDS = L 1 k W 1 ∴ k n = k n = = 2 mA/V2 L 1 × 0.5 W k n For v DS = 0.5 V = VOV , the transistor operates in saturation, and ID = 1 W 2 k V = 0.25 mA 2 n L OV ⇒ VG ≤ 5 − 1 = 4 V (b) Triode region occurs for VDG ≥ |Vtp | = 1 V ⇒ VD ≥ VG + 1 (c) Conversely, for saturation VDG ≤ |Vtp | = 1 V ⇒ VD ≤ VG + 1 (d) Given λ ∼ =0 ID = 1 W k |VOV |2 = 75 μA 2 pL ∴ |VOV | = 0.5 V = VSG − |Vtp | ⇒ VSG = |VOV | + |Vtp | = 1.5 V VG = 5 − |VSG | = 3.5 V VD ≤ VG + 1 = ≤4.5 V Exercise 5–2 (e) For λ = −0.02 V−1 and |VOV | = 0.5 V, ID = 75 μA and ro = 1 = 667 k |λ|ID (f) At VD = 3 V, VSD = 2 V 1 W k |VOV |2 (1 + |λ||VSD |) 2 nL = 75 μA (1.04) = 78 μA ID = Saturation mode (v GD = 0 < Vtn ) : VD = 0.7 V = 1.8 − ID RD 1 W μ Cox (VD − Vtn )2 = 0.032 mA 2 n L 1.8 − 0.7 ∴R= = 34.4 k 0.032 mA ID = Ex: 5.10 At VD = 0 V, VSD = 5 V 1.8 V ID = 75 μA (1.10) = 82.5 μA ro = VDS 3V = 667 k = ID 4.5 μA R2 R1 which is the same value found in (c). Ex: 5.8 1 1 60 W 2 ⇒ 0.3 = × ID = μn Cox VOV 2 L 2 1000 120 2 V ⇒ × 3 OV VOV = 0.5 V ⇒ VGS = VOV + Vt = 0.5 + 1 = 1.5 V VS = −1.5 V ⇒ RS = Q1 Since Q2 is identical to Q1 and their VGS values are the same, ID2 = ID1 = 0.032 mA For Q2 to operate at the triode–saturation boundary, we must have VS − VSS ID VD2 = VOV = 0.2 V −1.5 − (−2.5) 0.3 RS = 3.33 k = RD = Q2 ∴ R2 = VDD − VD 2.5 − 0.4 = 7 k = ID 0.3 1.8 V − 0.2 V = 50 k 0.032 mA Ex: 5.11 RD = 12.4 × 2 = 24.8 k VGS = 5 V, assume triode region: ⎫ 1 2 ⎪ W ID = k n (VGS − Vt )VDS − VDS ⎪ ⎬ L 2 ⇒ ⎪ ⎪ VDD − VDS ⎭ ID = R V2 5 − VDS = 1 × (5 − 1)VDS − DS 24.8 2 Ex: 5.9 1.8 V R VD 2 − 8.08VDS + 0.4 = 0 ⇒ VDS ⇒ VDS = 0.05 V < VOV ⇒ triode region ID = 5 − 0.05 = 0.2 mA 24.8 Ex: 5.12 As indicated in Example 5.6, Vtn = 0.5 V μn Cox = 0.4 mA/V2 VD ≥ VG − Vt for the transistor to be in the saturation region. VDmin = VG − Vt = 5 − 1 = 4 V 0.72 μm W = = 4.0 L 0.18 μm ID = 0.5 mA ⇒ RDmax = λ=0 = 10 − 4 = 12 k 0.5 VDD − VDmin ID Exercise 5–3 2.5 V Ex: 5.13 ID = 0.32 mA = 1 W 2 1 2 k n VOV = × 1 × VOV 2 L 2 QN ⇒ VOV = 0.8 V VGS = 0.8 + 1 = 1.8 V VI 2.5 V VO VG = VS + VGS = 1.6 + 1.8 = 3.4 V RG2 = 3.4 VG = = 3.4 M I 1 μA RG1 = 5 − 3.4 = 1.6 M 1 μA RS = 10 k VS = 5 k 0.32 VD = 3.4 V, then RD = IDN = 5 − 3.4 = 5 k 0.32 RL 1 × 1(2.5 − VO − 1)2 2 IDN = 0.5(1.5 − VO )2 Also: VO = RL IDN = 10IDN IDN = 0.5(1.5 − 10IDN )2 Ex: 5.14 2 ⇒ 100IDN − 32IDN + 2.25 = 0 ⇒ IDN 1.8 V = 0.104 mA RD IDP = 0, V O = 10 × 0.104 = 1.04V ID VO IDP QP 10 k –2.5 V Vtp = −0.4 V –2.5 V k p = 0.1 mA/V2 W 10 μm = ⇒ k p = 5.56 mA/V2 L 0.18 μm VSG = |Vtp | + |VOV | = 0.4 + 0.6 = 1 V VS = +1 V Since VDG = 0, the transistor is operating in saturation, and 1 2 ID = k p VOV = 1 mA 2 1.8 − 1 ∴ R= = 0.8 k = 800 1 Ex: 5.15 v I = 0: since the circuit is perfectly symmetrical, v O = 0 and therefore VGS = 0, which implies that the transistors are turned off and IDN = IDP = 0. v I = 2.5 V: if we assume that the NMOS is turned on, then v O would be less than 2.5 V, and this implies that PMOS is off (VSGP < 0) . IDN = 1 W k (VGS − Vt )2 2 nL VI = −2.5 V: Again if we assume that Qp is turned on, then VO > −2.5 V and VGS1 < 0, which implies that the NMOS QN is turned off. IDN = 0 Because of the symmetry, IDP = 0.104, VO = −IDP × 10 k = −1.04 V √ √ 0.7 + 3 − 0.7 Ex: 5.16 Vt = 0.8 + 0.4 = 1.23 V Ex: 5.17 v DSmin = v GS + |Vt | =1+2=3V 1 × 2 [1 − (−2)]2 2 = 9 mA ID = Chapter 5–1 5.1 Cox = 9 fF/μm2 , VOV = 0.2 V VGS (V) L = 0.36 μm, VDS = 0 V W = 3.6 μm Q = Cox .W .L.VOV = 2.33 fC 5.2 k n = μn Cox C/V C 1 m2 F F = = = = V · s m2 V·s V·s s V2 = VOV (V) gDS rDS (mA/V) () 0.5 0 0 ∞ 1.0 0.5 2.5 400 1.5 1.0 5.0 200 2.0 1.5 7.5 133 2.5 2.0 10 100 A V2 Since k n = k n W/L and W/L is dimensionless, k n has the same dimensions as k n ; that is, A/V2 . 5.5 The transistor size will be minimized if W/L is minimized. To start with, we minimize L by using the smallest feature size, 5.3 With v DS small, compared to VOV , Eq. (5.13a) applies: L = 0.18 μm rDS 1 = W (μn Cox ) (VOV ) L rDS = 1 k n (W/L) (v GS − Vt ) rDS = 1 k n (W/L) v OV (a) VOV is doubled → rDS is halved. factor = 0.5 (b) W is doubled → rDS is halved. factor = 0.5 (c) W and L are doubled → rDS is unchanged. factor = 1.0 (d) If oxide thickness tox is halved, and ox tox Cox = Two conditions need to met for v OV and rDS Condition 1: rDS,1 = = 250 ⇒ (W/L) v OV,1 = 10 then Cox is doubled. If W and L are also halved, rDS is halved, factor = 0.5. Condition 2: rDS,2 = 5.4 k n = 5 mA/V2 , Vtn = 0.5 V, iD = k n (v GS − Vt )v DS = k n v OV v DS 1 = k n v OV rDS iD 500 A 375 A 250 A 125 A 0 1 400 × 10−6 (W/L) v OV,2 = 1000 ⇒ (W/L) v OV,2 = 2.5 small v DS gDS = 1 400 × 10−6 (W/L)v OV,1 vGS 2.5 V vGS 2.0 V If condition 1 is met, condition 2 will be met since the over-drive voltage can always be reduced to satisfy this requirement. For condition 1, we want to decrease W/L as much as possible (so long as it is greater than or equal to 1), while still meeting all of the other constraints. This requires our using the largest possible v GS,1 voltage. v GS,1 = 1.8 V so v OV,1 = 1.8 − 0.5 = 1.3 V, and W/L = vGS 1.5 V vGS 1.0 V vGS 0.5 V vDS 50 mV 10 10 = = 7.69 v OV ,1 1.3 Condition 2 now can be used to find v GS,2 v OV ,2 = 2.5 2.5 = = 0.325 W/L 7.69 ⇒ v GS,2 = 0.825 V ⇒ 0.825 V ≤ v GS ≤ 1.8 V Chapter 5–2 ∂iD ∂v DS v DS = VDS −1 ∂ 1 = k n VOV v DS − v 2DS ∂v DS 2 ∂ 2 −1 ∂ = kn v DS (v OV v DS ) − 1/2 ∂v DS ∂v DS −1 1 = k n VOV − · 2VDS 2 1 = k n (VOV − VDS ) 1 If VDS = 0 ⇒ rds = k n VOV 1.25 If VDS = 0.2VOV ⇒ rds = VOV 1 If VDS = 0.5VOV ⇒ rds = k n (VOV − 0.5VOV ) 2 = 1/k n (0.5VOV ) = k n VOV 1 If VDS = 0.8VOV ⇒ rds = k n (VOV − 0.8VOV ) 5 = 1/k n (0.2VOV ) = k n VOV If VDS = VOV , 1 ⇒∞ rds = 0 5.6 rds = 1/ VGS = 0.72 V VDS ≥ 0.22 V (c) gDS = ∴ VOV = 0.47 V. VGS = 0.97 V. 5.9 Vtp = −0.7 V (a) |VSG | = |Vtp | + |VOV | = 0.7 + 0.4 = 1.1 V ⇒ VG = −1.1 V (b) For the p-channel transistor to operate in saturation, the drain voltage must not exceed the gate voltage by more than |Vtp |. Thus v Dmax = −1.1 + 0.7 = −0.4 V Put differently, VSD must be at least equal to |VOV |, which in this case is 0.4 V. Thus v Dmax = −0.4 V. (c) In (b), the transistor is operating in saturation, thus ID = 5.7 VDS sat = VOV VOV = VGS − Vt = 1 − 0.5 = 0.5 V ⇒ VDS sat = 0.5 V 2 1 4 mA × × (0.5 V) 2 2 V iD = 0.5 mA iD = 5.8 Lmin = 0.25 μm tox = 6 nm m2 cm2 = 460 × 10−4 V·s V·s ox 34.5 pF/m (a) Cox = = tox 6 nm pF F = 5.75 × 10−3 2 m μm2 μn = 460 k n = μn Cox = 265 μA/V2 20 W = , k n = 21.2 mA/V2 L 0.25 ∴ 0.5 mA = ID = VOV = 0.22 V 1 k p |VOV |2 2 1 × k p × 0.42 2 0.5 = ⇒ k p = 6.25 mA/V2 In saturation: 1 W 1 2 2 = k n VOV VOV iD = k n 2 L 2 (b) For 1 = k n VOV 100 1 2 k n VOV 2 For VD = −20 mV, the transistor will be operating in the triode region. Thus 1 ID = k p v SD |VOV | − v 2SD 2 1 = 6.25 0.02 × 0.4 − (0.02)2 2 = 0.05 mA For VD = −2 V, the transistor will be operating in saturation, thus ID = 1 1 k p |VOV |2 = × 6.25 × 0.42 = 0.5 mA 2 2 5.10 iD = 1 W k |VOV |2 2 nL For equal drain currents: μn Cox Wp Wn = μp Cox L L Wp μ 1 = 2.5 = n = Wn μp 0.4 k n = μn Cox Chapter 5–3 5.11 For small v DS , iD k n 1 = 2.645 1 × 2 − × 1 = 4 mA 2 and v DS = 1.5 V (b) v GS = 2 V W (VGS − Vt )VDS , L1 1 W k n (VGS − Vt ) L 1 = 100 × 10−6 × 20 × (5 − 0.7) rDS = 116.3 VDS = rDS × iD = 116.3 mV rDS = VDS = iD v OV = v GS − Vt = 2 − 0.5 = 1.5 V Thus, v DS = v OV ⇒ saturation region, 1 1 iD = k n v 2OV = × 2.645 × 1.52 2 2 = 3 mA For the same performance of a p-channel device: Wp Wp μ Wn = n = 2.5 ⇒ = × 2.5 Wn μp L L (c) v GS = 2.5 V v OV = 2.5 − 0.5 = 2 V 5.12 tox = 6 nm, μn = 460 cm2 /V·s, Vt = 0.5 V, and W/L = 10. k n = μn Cox 3.45 × 10−11 W = 460×10−4 × ×10 L 6 × 10−9 v OV = 2.5 − 0.5 = 2 V = 2.645 mA/V 2 (a) v GS = 2.5 V Thus, v DS > v OV ⇒ saturation region, 1 iD = k n v 2OV 2 1 = × 2.645 × 22 = 5.3 mA 2 v DS = 1 V and v OV = v GS − Vt = 2 V Thus v DS < v OV ⇒ triode region, 1 ID = k n v DS v OV − v 2DS 2 5.13 See Table below. This table belongs to 5.13. L (μm) 0.5 0.25 0.18 0.13 tox (nm) fF Cox μm2 ox = 34.5 pF/m μA k n V2 (μn = 500 cm2 /V·s) mA kn V2 W = 10 for L A(μm2 ) W for = 10 L VDD (V) 10 5 3.6 2.6 3.45 6.90 9.58 13.3 173 345 479 665 1.73 3.45 4.79 6.65 2.50 0.625 0.324 0.169 Vt (V) ID (mA) for VGS = VDS = VDD , P(mW) P mW A μm2 Devices Chip ID = P = VDD ID 1 k n (VDD − Vt )2 2 v DS = 0.2 V Thus, v DS < v OV ⇒ triode region, 1 iD = k n v DS v OV − v 2DS 2 1 2 = 2.645[0.2 × 2 − 0.2 ] = 1 mA 2 (d) v GS = v DS = 2.5 V Wp = 50 L = 20 × 2.5 ⇒ and 5 2.5 1.8 1.3 0.7 0.5 0.4 0.4 16 6.90 4.69 2.69 80 17.3 8.44 3.50 32 27.7 26.1 20.7 n 4n 7.72n 14.8n Chapter 5–4 This figure belongs to 5.14, part (a). Fig. 1 1 5.14 iD = k n v OV v DS − v 2DS 2 1 iD = v OV v DS − v 2DS kn 2 (1) Figure 1 shows graphs for iD /k n versus v DS for various values of v OV . Since the right-hand side of Eq. (1) does not have any MOSFET parameters, these graphs apply for any n-channel MOSFET with the assumption that λ = 0. They also apply to p-channel devices with v DS replaced by v SD , k n by k p , and v OV with |v OV |. The slope of each graph at v DS = 0 is found by differentiating Eq. (1) relative to v DS with v OV = VOV and then substituting v DS = 0. The result is d (iD /k n ) = VOV d v DS v DS =0, v OV =VOV Figure 1 shows the tangent at v DS = 0 for the graph corresponding to v OV = VOV 3 . Observe that 1 2 it intersects the horizontal line iD /k n = VOV 3 at 2 1 v DS = VOV 3 . Finally, observe that the curve 2 representing the boundary between the triode region and the saturation region has the equation iD /k n = iD /kn (V2) 1 2 v 2 DS Figure 2 shows the graph for the relationship 1 iD /kn v 2OV 2 0 1 V VOV 2 OV vOV (V) Fig. 2 Here also observe that this relationship (and graph) is universal and represents any MOSFET. The slope at v OV = VOV is d (iD /k n ) = VOV d v OV v OV =VOV Replacing k n by k p and v OV by |v OV | adapts this graph to PMOS transistors. 5.15 For triode-region operation with v DS small, iD k n (v GS − Vt )v DS Thus 1 iD /k n = v 2OV 2 rDS ≡ which describes the MOSFETs operation in the saturation region, that is, 1= v DS ≥ v OV Slope VOV 1 2 V 2 OV v DS 1 = iD k n (v GS − Vt ) 1 1 = k n (1.2 − 0.8) 0.4 k n ⇒ k n = 2.5 mA/V Chapter 5–5 1 2.5(VGS − 0.8) 1 0.2 = 2.5(VGS − 0.8) rDS = 5.19 iD = k n (v GS − Vt )v DS (k) ⇒ VGS = 2.8 V For a device with twice the value of W, k n will be twice as large and the resistance values will be half as large: 500 and 100 , respectively. = 0.4 mA/V and ⇒ Dividing Eq. (2) by Eq. (1), we have 2= For k n = 50 μA/V2 W = 20 L Vt = 0.5 V W 1 × 0.4 × × (1.8 − 0.5)2 2 L For v GS = 2 V and v DS = 0.1 V, 1 iD = k n (v GS − Vt )v DS − v 2DS 2 1 = 1 (2 − 0.5) × 0.1 − × 0.12 2 = 0.145 mA = 145 μA For v GS = 2 V, pinch-off will occur for W = 5.92 L v DS = v GS − Vt = 2 − 0.5 = 1.5 V For L = 0.18 μm and the resulting drain current will be W = 1.07 μm iD = 5.18 For VGS = VDS = 1 V, the MOSFET is operating in saturation, = 1 k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 0.4 = 1 k n (1 − Vt )2 2 (1) 0.1 = 1 k n (0.8 − Vt )2 2 (2) Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2) and taking square roots gives 1 − Vt 0.8 − Vt ⇒ Vt = 0.6 V Substituting in Eq. (1), we have 0.4 = 1 k n × 0.42 2 ⇒ k n = 5 mA/V2 1 k n (v GS − Vt )2 2 1 × 1 × (2 − 0.5)2 2 = 1.125 mA ID = 2= 1.5 − Vt 1 − Vt ⇒ k n = 1000 μA/V2 For v GS = v DS = 1.8 V, the MOSFET is operating in saturation. Thus, to obtain ID = 2 mA, we write 2= (2) 25 = k n × 0.5 × 0.05 VGS = 0.5 + 0.5 = 1 V 5.17 50 = k n (1.5 − Vt ) × 0.05 Substituting in Eq. (1) yields VGS = 0.5 + 0.25 = 0.75 V 1 2 ID = 0.2 = × 1.6 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.5 V and VDS ≥ 0.5 V 2 (1) ⇒ Vt = 0.5 V 5.16 Vtn = 0.5 V, k n = 1.6 mA/V2 1 2 ID = 0.05 = × 1.6 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.25 V and VDS ≥ 0.25 V k n 25 = k n (1 − Vt ) × 0.05 5.20 For the channel to remain continuous, v DS ≤ v GS − Vt Thus for v GS = 1.0 V to 1.8 V and Vt = 0.4, v DS ≤ 1 − 0.4 That is, v DSmax = 0.6 V. W 20 = = 20 k n = 100 μA/V2 L 1 W k n = k n = 100 × 20 = 2000 μA/V2 L 5.21 = 2 mA/V2 Chapter 5–6 5.23 For operation as a linear resistance, iD = k n (v GS − Vt )v DS iD and rDS ≡ = vDS v DS 1 = iD k n (v GS − Vt ) 1 2(v GS − 0.8) At v GS = 1.0 V, rDS = v DS = v GS 1 = 2.5 k 2(1 − 0.8) iD = At v GS = 4.8 V, rDS = 1 = 0.125 k 2(4.8 − 0.8) 1 k n (v DS − Vt )2 2 ∴ v DS = 2iD + Vt kn Thus, rDS will vary in the range of 2.5 k to 125 . (a) If W is halved, k n will be halved and rDS will vary in the range of 5 k to 250 . (b) If L is halved, k n will be doubled and rDS will vary in the range of 1.25 k to 62.5 . (c) If both W and L are halved, k n will remain unchanged and rDS will vary in the original range of 2.5 k to 125 . 5.22 (a) Refer to Fig. P5.22. For saturation-mode operation of an NMOS transistor, v DG ≥ −Vtn ; thus v DG = 0 results in saturation-mode operation. Similarly, for a p-channel MOSFET, saturation-mode operation is obtained for v GD ≥ −|Vtp |, which includes v GD = 0. Thus, the diode-connected MOSFETs of Fig. P5.22 have the i−v relationship 1 W i = k (v − |Vt |)2 (1) 2 L where k represents in the PMOS case. k n in the NMOS case and k p (b) If either of the MOSFETs in Fig. P5.22 is biased to operate at v = |Vt | + |VOV |, then its incremental resistance r at the bias point can be obtained by differentiating Eq. (1) relative to v and then substituting v = |Vt | + |VOV | as follows: W ∂i = k (v − |Vt |) ∂v L ∂i W = k VOV ∂v v =|Vt |+VOV L ∂i W r=1 Q.E.D =1 k VOV ∂v L 5.24 VDS = VD – VS VGS = VG − VS VOV = VGS − Vt = VGS − 1.0 According to Table 5.1, three regions are possible. Case VS VG VD VGS VOV VDS Region of operation a +1.0 +1.0 +2.0 b +1.0 +2.5 +2.0 +1.5 +0.5 +1.0 Sat. c +1.0 +2.5 +1.5 +1.5 +0.5 +0.5 Sat. d +1.0 +1.5 Sat.∗ e 0 0 0 –1.0 +1.0 +0.5 –0.5 –1.0 +2.5 1.0 +2.5 +1.5 +1.0 f +1.0 +1.0 +1.0 g –1.0 0 h –1.5 0 i –1.0 0 j +0.5 +2.0 +0.5 +1.5 +0.5 Cutoff Triode 0 –1.0 0 Cutoff 0 +1.0 0 +1.0 Sat. 0 +1.5 +0.5 +1.5 Sat. +1.0 +1.0 0 +2.0 Sat. 0 Triode ∗ With the source and drain interchanged. Chapter 5–7 5.25 The cutoff–saturation boundary is determined by v GS = Vt , thus v GS = 0.4 V at the boundary. The saturation–triode boundary is determined by v GD = Vt , and v DS = VDD = 1 V, and since v GS = v GD + v DS , one has v GS = 0.4 + 1.0 = 1.4 V at the boundary. 5.27 ro = VA 20 = , 0.1 mA ≤ iD ≤ 1 mA iD iD ⇒ 20 k ≤ ro ≤ 200 k ro = v DS v DS 1 ⇒ iD = = iD ro ro At iD = 0.1 mA, iD = 5 μA, iD = 5% iD At iD = 1 mA, iD = 50 μA, iD = 5% iD 5.28 iD 0.52 mA 0.50 mA vDS 1V 5.26 (a) Let Q1 have a ratio (W/L) and Q2 have a ratio 1.03 (W/L). Thus ID1 = ID2 1 W kn (1 − Vt )2 2 L W 1 × 1.03 × (1 − Vt )2 = k n 2 L Thus, ID2 = 1.03 ID1 That is, a 3% mismatch in the W/L ratios results in a 3% mismatch in the drain currents. (b) Let Q1 have a threshold voltage Vt = 0.6 V and Q2 have a threshold voltage Vt + Vt = 0.6 + 0.01 = 0.61 V. Thus ID1 1 W = k n (1 − 0.6)2 2 L ID2 = 1 W kn (1 − 0.61)2 2 L and ID2 (1 − 0.61)2 = = 0.95 ID1 (1 − 0.6)2 That is, a 10-mV mismatch in the threshold voltage results in a 5% mismatch in drain currents. ro = 2V v DS 1 = 50 k = iD v GS const. 0.02 VA ∼ = ID ro = 0.5 × 50 = 25 V λ= 1 = 0.04 V−1 VA 5.29 VA = VA L, where VA is completely process VA dependent. Also, ro = . Therefore, to achieve iD desired ro (which is 5 times larger), we should increase L (L = 5 × 1 = 5 μm). To keep ID unchanged, the unchanged. Therefore: W ratio must stay L W is kept at 10) L VA = ro iD = 100 k × 0.2 mA = 20 V (for the standard device) W = 5 × 10 = 50 μm (so VA = 5 × 20 = 100 V (for the new device) 5.30 L = 1.5 μm = 3× minimum. Thus 0.03 V−1 = 0.01 V−1 3 If v DS is increased from 1 V to 5 V, the drain current will change from λ= ID = 100 μA = ID (1 + λ × 1) = 1.01 ID to ID + ID = ID (1 + λ × 5) = 1.05 ID Chapter 5–8 where ID is the drain current without channel-length modulation taken into account. Thus 5.34 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.26 and let VD1 = 2 V and VD2 = 2.5 V. If the two devices are matched, 1 2 ID1 = k n (1 − Vt )2 1 + 2 VA 1 2.5 ID2 = k n (1 − Vt )2 1 + 2 VA 1 2 0.5 ID = ID2 − ID1 = k n (1 − Vt ) 2 VA 100 1.01 ID = and 100 + ID = 1.05 ID = 1.05 × 100 = 104 μA 1.01 ID = 4 μA or 4% ⇒ To reduce ID by a factor of 2, we need to reduce λ by a factor of 2, which can be obtained by doubling the channel length to 3 μm. 0.5 ID 0.01 = 1 VA 2 k n (1 − Vt ) 2 ⇒ VA = 50 V (or larger to limit the mismatch in ID to 1%). 5.31 VA = VA L = 20 × 1.5 = 30 V If VA = 100 V/μm, the minimum required channel length is 0.5 μm. 1 1 = = 0.033 V−1 VA 30 1 W 2 ID = k n (1 + λVDS ) VOV 2 L 15 1 × 0.52 (1 + 0.033 × 2) = × 0.2 × 2 1.5 |v GS | = 3 V, |v DS | = 4 V = 0.267 mA |v DS | > |VOV | ⇒ saturation mode λ= ro = 1 k 2 n 5.35 Vtp = 0.8 V, |VA | = 40 V iD = 3 mA |VOV | = |v GS | − |Vtp | = 2.2 V v GS = −3 V VA 30 = 1 15 W 2 × 0.2 × × 0.52 VOV 2 1.5 L v SG = +3 V v DS = −4 V = 120 k ID = v SD = 4 V VDS 1V = = 0.008 mA ro 120 k Vtp = −0.8 V VA = −40 V λ = −0.025 V−1 1 iD = k p (v GS − Vtp )2 (1 + λ v DS ) 2 1 3 = k p [−3 − (−0.8)]2 (1 − 0.025 × −4) 2 5.32 Quadrupling W and L keeps the current ID unchanged. However, the quadrupling of L increases VA by a factor of 4 and hence increases ro by a factor of 4. Halving VOV results in decreasing ID by a factor of 4. Thus, this alone increases ro by a factor of 4. The overall increase in ro is by a factor of 4 × 4 = 16. ⇒ k p = 1.137 mA/V2 5.36 PMOS with Vtp = –1 V Case VS VG VD 5.33 NMOS 1 2 −1 3 −1 4 −1 −1 a +2 +2 0 0 0 2 Cutoff b +2 +1 0 +1 0 2 Cutoff–Sat. c +2 0 0 +2 1 2 Sat. +1 +2 1 1 Sat–Triode +1.5 +2 1 λ 0.05 V VA 20 V 50 V 10 V 100 V d +2 0 ID 0.5 mA 2 mA 0.1 mA 0.2 mA e +2 0 ro 40 k 25 k 100 k 500 k f +2 0 0.02 V 0.1 V 0.01 V VSG |VOV | VSD Region of operation +2 +2 1 0.5 Triode 0 Triode Chapter 5–9 5.37 VGD ≥ − 1.5 V 3 V Case c – vG 200 (2 − |Vt |)2 = ⇒ |Vt | = 1.0, 800 (3 − |Vt |)2 VGD ≥ − 1.0 V 1 V ∴ sat ∴ sat Case d 1 k n (2 − Vt )2 72 sat 2 = 1 2 triode 270 k n (4 − Vt ) VDS − VDS 2 Vtp = −0.5 V (after failing assumption that both cases are sat.) v G = +3 V → 0 V As v G reaches +2.5 V, the transistor begins to conduct and enters the saturation region, since v DG will be negative. The transistor continues to operate in the saturation region until v G reaches 0.5 V, at which point v DG will be 0.5 V, which is equal to |Vtp |, and the transistor enters the triode region. As v G goes below 0.5 V, the transistor continues to operate in the triode region. 5.39 Refer to the circuits in Fig. P5.39. (a) V1 = VDS = VGS = 1 V (b) V2 = +1 − VDS = 1 − 1 = 0 V (c) V3 = VSD = VSG = 1 V (d) V4 = +1.25 − VSG = 1.25 − 1 = 0.25 V 5.38 Case a, assume, sat, Now place a resistor R in series with the drain. For the circuits in (a) and (b) to remain in saturation, VD must not fall below VG by more than Vt . Thus, 100 (1 − Vt )2 ⇒ Vt = 0.5, = 400 (1.5 − Vt )2 VGD ≤ Vt IR ≤ Vt ∴ sat; Rmax = Case b — same procedure, except use VSG and VSD . 0.5 Vt = = 5 k I 0.1 For the circuits in (c) and (d) to remain in saturation, VD must not exceed VG by more than |Vt |. Thus 50 (2 − 1Vt 1)2 ⇒ |Vt | = 1.5, = 450 (3 − 1Vt 1)2 This table belongs to 5.38. Case Transistor a b c d 1 2 3 4 VS VG VD ID (V) (V) (V) (μA) 0 1 2.5 100 0 1.5 2.5 400 5 3 –4.5 50 5 2 –0.5 450 5 3 4 200 5 2 0 800 –2 0 0 72 –4 0 –3 270 Type NMOS Mode Sat. W L (μ A/V2 ) (V) 800 0.5 400 –1.5 400 –1 100 +0.8 μCox Vt Sat. PMOS Sat. Sat. PMOS Sat. Sat. NMOS Sat. Triode Chapter 5–10 IR ≤ |Vt | Since VDG > 0, the MOSFET is in saturation. which yields Rmax = 5 k. Now place a resistor RS in series with the MOSFET source. The voltage across the current source becomes W 2 1 μn Cox VOV 2 L 5 1 2 × VOV 0.1 = × 0.4 × 2 0.4 ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V (a) VCS = 2.5 − VDS − IRS VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.5 + 0.2 = 0.7 ID = (1) To keep VCS at least at 0.5 V, the maximum RS can be found from VS = 0 − VGS = −0.7 V RS = VS − (−1) −0.7 + 1 = 3 k = ID 0.1 RD = 0.7 1 − VD 1 − 0.3 = = 7 k = ID 0.1 0.1 0.5 = 2.5 − 1 − 0.1 × RSmax ⇒ RSmax = 10 k V1 = 2.5 − 0.5 = 2 V (b) VCS = 1 − VDS − IRS − (−1.5) 5.41 = 2.5 − VDS − IRS 1 V which is identical to Eq. (1). Thus ID RSmax = 10 k RD V2 = −1.5 + 0.5 = −1 V 0.2 V (c) VCS = 2.5 − IRS − VSD VGS 0.6 V which yields 0.6 V RSmax = 10 k RS V3 = 2.5 − 0.5 = 2 V (d) VCS = 1.25 − IRS − VSD − (−1.25) 1 V = 2.5 − VSD − IRS which yields RSmax = 10 k V4 = −1.25 + 0.5 = −0.75 V 5.40 1 V ID 0.1 mA RD RS = VD 0.3 V 0.1 mA VS RS 1 V Since VDG > 0, the MOSFET is operating in saturation. Thus 1 ID = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 1 = × 4 × (0.6 − 0.4)2 2 = 0.08 mA 0.8 1 − VD 1 − 0.2 = = 10 k = RD = ID 0.08 0.08 −0.6 − (−1) −0.6 + 1 = = 5 k ID 0.08 For ID to remain unchanged from 0.08 mA, the MOSFET must remain in saturation. This in turn can be achieved by ensuring that VD does not fall below VG (which is zero) by more than Vt (0.4 V). Thus 1 − ID RDmax = −0.4 RDmax = 1.4 = 17.5 k 0.08 Chapter 5–11 5.43 5.42 1.3 V VDD 1.8 V RD ID2 ID1 ID R2 R VD2 Q2 VGS Q1 VD1 1 W k (VGS − Vt )2 2 nL W 1 = × 0.4 × (1.3 − 0.4)2 2 L W = 0.162 L ID = (a) ID1 = 50 μA 0.05 = 1 1.44 2 × 0.4 × V 2 0.36 OV ⇒ VOV = 0.25 V W RD L VGS1 = Vt + VOV VD = 1.3 − ID RD = 1.3 − 0.162 = 0.5 + 0.25 = 0.75 V For the MOSFET to be at the edge of saturation, we must have VD1 = VGS1 = 0.75 V VDD − VD1 1.8 − 0.75 = 21 k R= = ID1 0.05 (b) Note that both transistors operate at the same VGS and VOV , and ID2 = 0.5 mA But ID2 = 1 W2 2 kn VOV 2 L2 0.5 = 1 W2 × 0.4 × × 0.252 2 0.36 VD = VOV = 1.3 − 0.4 = 0.9 Thus 0.9 = 1.3 − 0.162 ⇒ W RD L W RD 2.5 k L Q.E.D 5.44 1.3 V RD 0.1 mA VD ⇒ W2 = 14.4 μm which is 10 times W1 , as needed to provide ID2 = 10ID1 . Since Q2 is to operate at the edge of saturation, VDS2 = VOV Thus, VOV = VGS − Vt VD2 = 0.25 V = 1.3 − 0.4 = 0.9 and To operate at the edge of saturation, we must have R2 = = VDD − VD2 ID2 1.8 − 0.25 = 3.1 k 0.5 VD = VOV = 0.9 V Thus, RD = 1.3 − 0.9 = 4 k 0.1 Chapter 5–12 5.45 VDD 1.8 V VD ID 5.47 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.47. All three transistors are operating in saturation with ID = 90 μA. For Q1 , ID = 1 W1 μn Cox (VGS1 − Vt )2 2 L1 90 = W1 1 × 90 × (0.8 − 0.5)2 2 L1 R ⇒ W1 = 22.2 L1 W1 = 22.2 × 0.5 = 11.1 μm ID = 180 μA R= and VD = 1 V 1 VD = = 5.6 k ID 0.18 Transistor is operating in saturation with |VOV | = 1.8 − VD − |Vt | = 1.8 − 1 − 0.5 = 0.3 V: ID = 1 W k |VOV |2 2 pL 180 = ⇒ W 1 × 100 × × 0.32 2 L W = 40 L W = 40 × 0.18 = 7.2 μm 5.46 Refer to Fig. P5.46. Both Q1 and Q2 are operating in saturation at ID = 0.5 mA. For Q1 , ID = 0.5 = ⇒ 1 W1 2 μn Cox V 2 L1 OV 1 W1 = 16 × 0.25 = 4 μm For Q2 , we have 1 W2 2 ID = μn Cox VOV 2 2 L2 ⇒ ID = 1 W2 μn Cox (VGS2 − Vt )2 2 L2 90 = W2 1 × 90 × (1.5 − 0.8 − 0.5)2 2 L2 ⇒ W2 = 50 L2 W2 = 50 × 0.5 = 25 μm For Q3 , ID = 1 W3 μn Cox (VGS3 − Vt )2 2 L3 90 = 1 W3 × 90 × (2.5 − 1.5 − 0.5)2 2 L3 ⇒ W3 =8 L3 W3 = 8 × 0.5 = 4 μm W1 1 × 0.25 × (1 − 0.5)2 2 L1 W1 = 16 L1 0.5 = For Q2 , W2 1 × 0.25 × (1.8 − 1 − 0.5)2 2 L2 W2 = 44.4 L2 5.48 Refer to the circuits in Fig. 5.24 (page 338): VGS = 5 − 6ID ID = = 1 W k (VGS − Vt )2 2 nL 1 × 1.5 × (5 − 6ID − 1.5)2 2 which results in the following quadratic equation in ID : 36ID2 − 43.33ID + 12.25 = 0 W2 = 44.4 × 0.25 = 11.1 The physically meaningful root is 2.5 − 1.8 = 1.4 k R= 0.5 ID = 0.45 mA Chapter 5–13 This should be compared to the value of 0.5 mA found in Example 5.6. The difference of about 10% is relatively small, given the large variations in k n and Vt (50% increase in each). The new value of VD is 5.50 VDD iD R VD = VDD − RD ID = 10 − 6 × 0.45 = +7.3 V vO as compared to +7 V found in Example 5.6. We conclude that this circuit is quite tolerant to variations in device parameters. 5.49 VDD 10 V 1 A RG1 0.5 mA RS VS VG 6 V 5 V RG2 RD 0.5 mA vI Assuming linear operation in the triode region, we can write vO 50 mV = 1 mA = iD = rDS 50 W (v GS − Vt )v DS iD = k n L 1 = 0.5 × W × (1.3 − 0.4) × 0.05 L W = 44.4 L 1.3 − 0.05 VDD − v O = R= iD 1 ⇒ = 1.25 k Refer to the circuit in the figure above, RG1 = = VDD − VG 1 μA 10 − 6 = 4 M 1 RG2 = 6 = 6 M 1 μA RD = 5V = 10 k 0.5 mA To determine VS , we use 1 W ID = k p (VSG − |Vt |)2 2 L 0.5 = 1 × 4 × (VSG − 1.5)2 2 ⇒ VSG = 2 V Thus, VS = VG + VSG = 6 + 2 = 8 V RS = 10 − 8 = 4 k 0.5 5.51 (a) Refer to Fig. P5.51(a): Assuming saturation-mode operation, we have 1 2 k n VOV 2 1 2 2 = × 4 VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 1 V ID = VGS = |Vt | + VOV = 1 + 1 = 2 V V1 = 0 − VGS = −2 V V2 = 5 − 2 × 2 = +1 V Since VDG = +1 V, the MOSFET is indeed in saturation. Refer to Fig. P5.51(b): The transistor is operating in saturation, thus 1 2 k n VOV 2 1 2 2 = × 4 × VOV ⇒ VOV = 1 V 2 VGS = 2 V ID = ⇒ V3 = 2 V Chapter 5–14 Refer to Fig. P5.51(c): Assuming saturation-mode operation, we have ID = 2= 1 k p |VOV |2 2 1 × 4 × |VOV |2 2 5.52 (a) Refer to Fig. P5.52(a): The MOSFET is operating in saturation. Thus ID = 1 2 k n VOV 2 10 = 1 2 × 500 × VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 1 V VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.8 + 0.2 = 1 V VSG = |Vt | + |VOV | = 1 + 1 = 2 V V1 = 0 − VGS = −1 V V4 = VSG = 2 V (b) Refer to Fig. P5.52(b): The MOSFET is operating in saturation. Thus V5 = −5 + ID × 1.5 = −5 + 2 × 1.5 = −2 V Since VDG < 0, the MOSFET is indeed in saturation. Refer to Fig. P5.51(d): Both transistors are operating in saturation at equal |VOV |. Thus 2= 1 × 4 × |VOV |2 ⇒ |VOV | = 1 V 2 VSG = |Vt | + |VOV | = 2 V V6 = 5 − VSG = 5 − 2 = 3 V V7 = +5 − 2 VSG = 5 − 2 × 2 = 1 V (b) Circuit (a): The 2-mA current source can be replaced with a resistance R connected between the MOSFET source and the −5-V supply with R= V1 − (−5) −2 + 5 = = 1.5 k 2 mA 2 Circuit (b): The 2-mA current source can be replaced with a resistance R, R= 5 − V3 5−2 = = 1.5 k 2 mA 2 Circuit (c): The 2-mA current source can be replaced with a resistance R, 5 − V4 5−2 R= = = 1.5 k 2 mA 2 Circuit (d): The 2-mA current source can be replaced with a resistance R, R= V7 1 = = 0.5 k 2 mA 2 We use the nearest 1% resistor, which is 499 . 100 = 1 2 × 500 × VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.63 V 2 VGS = 0.8 + 0.63 = 1.43 V V2 = −1.43 V (c) Refer to Fig. P5.52(c). The MOSFET is operating in saturation. Thus 1= 1 2 × 0.5 × VOV ⇒ VOV = 2 V 2 VGS = 0.8 + 2 = 2.8 V V3 = −2.8 V (d) Refer to Fig. P5.52(d). The MOSFET is operating in saturation. Thus 10 = 1 2 × 500 × VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V 2 VGS = 0.8 + 0.2 = 1 V V4 = 1 V (e) Refer to Fig. P5.52(e). The MOSFET is operating in saturation. Thus 1= 1 2 × 0.5 × VOV ⇒ VOV = 2 V 2 VGS = 0.8 + 2 = 2.8 V V5 = VGS = 2.8 V (f) Refer to Fig. P5.52(f). To simplify our solution, we observe that this circuit is that in Fig. P5.56(d) with the 10-μA current source replaced with a 400-k resistor. Thus VG = V4 = +1 V 5−1 = 0.01 mA = 10 μA. and, as a check, ID = 400 (g) Refer to Fig. P5.52(g). Our work is considerably simplified by observing that this circuit is similar to that in Fig. P5.52(e) with the Chapter 5–15 1-mA current source replaced with a 2.2-k resistor. Thus V7 = V5 = 2.8 V and, as a check, 5 − 2.8 = 1 mA. ID = 2.2 (h) Refer to Fig. P5.52(h). Our work is considerably simplified by observing that this circuit is similar to that in Fig. P5.52(a) with the 10-μA current source replaced with a 400-k resistor. Thus V8 = V1 = −1 V and, as a check, −1 + 5 ID = = 0.01 mA = 10 μA. 400 V4 = 2.5 V Now, compare the part of the circuit consisting of Q2 and the 1-k resistor. We observe the similarity of this part with the circuit between the gate of Q2 and ground in Fig. P5.53(a). It follows that for the circuit in Fig. P5.53(b), we can use the solution of part (a) above to write ID2 = 0.66 mA and VGS2 = 1.84 V Thus, 5.53 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.53(a). Transistor Q1 is operating in saturation. Assume that Q2 also is operating in saturation, V5 = V4 − VGS2 = 2.5 − 1.84 = 0.66 V VGS2 = 0 − V2 = −V2 Since Q1 is conducting an equal ID and has the same VGS , and ID1 = 0.66 mA V2 = −2.5 + ID × 1 ⇒ V3 = V4 + VGS1 = 2.5 + 1.84 = 3.34 V ⇒ ID = V2 + 2.5 We could, of course, have used the circuit symmetry, observed earlier, to write this final result. Now, ID = and VGS1 = 1.84 V 1 k n (VGS2 − Vt )2 2 Substituting ID = V2 + 2.5 and VGS2 = −V2 , V2 + 2.5 = 5.54 10 V 1 × 1.5(−V2 − 0.9)2 2 2 (V2 + 2.5) = V22 + 1.8 V2 + 0.81 1.5 VSG VSD R IR V22 + 0.467 V2 − 2.523 = 0 ⇒ V2 = −1.84 V Thus, I ID = V2 + 2.5 = −1.84 + 2.5 = 0.66 mA and Fig. 1 VGS2 = 1.84 V Since Q1 is identical to Q2 and is conducting the same ID , then VGS1 = 1.84 V ⇒ V1 = 2.5 − 1.84 = 0.66 V which confirms that Q1 is operating in saturation, as assumed. (a) From Fig. 1 we see that VDG = IR Since for the PMOS transistor to operate in saturation, VDG ≤ |Vtp | It follows the (b) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.53(b). From symmetry, we see that IR ≤ |Vtp | Q.E.D Chapter 5–16 (b) (i) R = 0, the condition above is satisfied and ID = I = 0.1 = 1 k p |VOV |2 2 1 × 0.2 × |VOV |2 2 Now, for triode-mode operation, 1 2 ID = k p (VSG − |Vtp |)VSD − VSD 2 1 0.1 = 0.2 (VSG − 1)(VSG − 3) − (VSG − 3)2 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 1 V VSG = |Vtp | + |VOV | = 1 + 1 = 2 V 2 − 2VSG − 4 = 0 ⇒ VSG VG = 10 − 2 = 8 V ⇒ VSG = 3.24 V VD = VG = 8 V VSD = VSG − 3 = 0.24 V VSD = 2 V (iv) R = 100 k (ii) R = 10 k 10 V IR = 0.1 × 10 = 1 V VSG which just satisfies the condition for saturation-mode operation in (a) above. Obviously ID and |VOV | will be the same as in (i) above. VSG = 2 V 100 k VSD 10 V VG = 8 V VD = VG + IR = 8 + 1 = 9 V 0.1 mA VSD = 1 V (iii) R = 30 k Fig. 3 IR = 0.1 × 30 = 3 V which is greater than |Vtp |. Thus the condition in (a) above is not satisfied and the MOSFET is operating in the triode region. From Fig. 2, 10 V VSG VSD 3V 30 k Here also (see Fig. 3) the MOSFET will be operating in the triode region, and VSD = VSG − 10 V Since we expect VSD to be very small, we can 2 neglect the VSD term in the expression for ID and write ID k p (VSG − |Vt |)VSD 0.1 = 0.2(VSG − 1)(VSG − 10) 2 ⇒ VSG − 11VSG + 9.5 = 0 ⇒ VSG = 10.055 V VSD = VSG − 10 = 0.055 V 0.1 mA Fig. 2 From Fig. 2, we see that VSD = VSG − 3 5.55 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.55(a). Since the two NMOS transistors are identical and have the same ID , their VGS values will be equal. Thus VGS = 3 = 1.5 V 2 V2 = 1.5 V Chapter 5–17 VOV = VGS − Vt = 1.0 V 1 W 2 VOV I1 = ID = μn Cox 2 L = 5.56 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.56. First consider Q1 and Q2 . Both are operating in saturation and since they are identical, they have equal VGS : 1 3 × 270 × × 1 2 1 VGS1 = VGS2 = Thus, = 405 μA (b) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.55(b). Here QN and QP have the same ID = I3 . Thus 1 W 2 VOVN I3 = μn Cox 2 L I3 = (1) (2) Equating Eqs. (1) and (2) and using 2 2 = VOVP : μn Cox = 3μp Cox gives 3VOVN √ ID2 = ID1 = = 1 W 2 μp Cox VOVP 2 L |VOVP | = 5 = 2.5 V 2 3 VOVN 1 W μn Cox (VGS1 − Vt )2 2 L 1 10 × 50 × (2.5 − 1)2 2 1 = 562.5 μA Now, Q3 has the same VGS at Q1 and is matched to Q1 . Thus if we assume that Q3 is operating in saturation, we have ID3 = ID1 = 562.5 μA Thus, I2 = 562.5 μA Now, VGSN = VOVN + Vt = VOVN + 0.5 √ VSGP = |VOVP | + |Vt | = 3 VOVN + 0.5 But This is the same current that flows through Q4 , which is operating in saturation and is matched to Q3 . Thus VGS4 = VGS3 = VGS1 = 2.5 V Thus, VSGP + VGSN = 3 √ ( 3 + 1)VOVN + 1 = 3 ⇒ VOVN = 0.732 V VOVP = 1.268 V V2 = 5 − VGS4 = 2.5 V This is equal to the voltage at the gate of Q3 ; thus Q3 is indeed operating in saturation, as assumed. VSGP = 1.768 V If Q3 and Q4 have W = 100 μm, nothing changes for Q1 and Q2 . However, Q3 , which has the same VGS as Q1 but has 10 times the width, will have a drain current 10 times larger than Q1 . Thus V4 = VGSN = 1.232 V ID2 = ID3 = 10 ID1 = 10 × 562.5 μA VGSN = 1.232 V I3 = 3 1 × 270 × × 0.7322 = 217 μA 2 1 (c) Refer to Fig. P5.55(c). Here the width of the PMOS transistor is made 3 times larger than that of the NMOS transistor. This compensates for the factor 3 in the process transconductance parameter, resulting in k p = k n , and the two transistors are matched. The solution will be identical to that for (a) above with = 5.625 mA Transistor Q4 will carry I2 but will retain the same VGS as before, thus V2 remains unchanged at 2.5 V. 5.57 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P5.57. 3 V5 = = 1.5 V 2 (a) Q1 and Q2 are matched. Thus, from symmetry, we see that the 200-μA current will split equally between Q1 and Q2 : I6 = 405 μA ID1 = ID2 = 100 μA Chapter 5–18 V1 = V2 = 2.5 − 0.1 × 20 = 0.5 V 2φf = 0.6 V To find V3 , we determine VGS of either Q1 and Q2 (which, of course, are equal), and ID1 = 1 W μn Cox 2 L (VGS − Vt )2 1 VSB = 0 to 4 V At VSB = 0, Vt = Vt0 = 1.0 V 1 100 = × 125 × 20 × (VGS − 0.7)2 2 At ⇒ VGS = 0.983 V VSB = 4 V, √ √ Vt = 1 + 0.5[ 0.6 + 4 − 0.6 ] Thus, = 1.69 V V3 = −0.983 V (b) With VGS1 = VGS2 , but (W/L)1 = 1.5(W/L)2 , transistor Q1 will carry a current 1.5 times that in Q2 , that is, ID1 = 1.5ID2 If the gate oxide thickness is increased by a factor of 4, Cox will decrease by a factor of 4 and Eq. (5.31) indicates that γ will increase by a factor of 4, becoming 2. Thus at VSB = 4 V, √ √ Vt = 1 + 2[ 0.6 + 4 − 0.6 ] = 3.74 V But, ID1 + ID2 = 200 μA 5.59 |Vt | = |Vt0 | + γ Thus √ √ = 0.7 + 0.5[ 0.75 + 3 − 0.75 ] ID1 = 120 μA = 1.24 V ID2 = 80 μA Thus, V1 = 2.5 − 0.12 × 20 = 0.1 V Vt = −1.24 V V2 = 2.5 − 0.08 × 20 = 0.9 V To find V3 , we find VGS from the ID equation for either Q1 or Q2 , ID1 W 1 = μn Cox (VGS − Vt )2 2 L 1 120 = 2φf + |VSB | − 1 × 125 × 20 × (VGS − 0.7)2 2 ⇒ VGS = 1.01 V 1 W 5.60 (a) iD = k n (v GS − Vt )2 2 L 1 ∂k n W ∂iD = (v GS − Vt )2 ∂T 2 ∂T L W ∂Vt −k n (v GS − Vt ) L ∂T ∂k /k 2 ∂iD /iD ∂Vt = n n − ∂T ∂T VGS − Vt ∂T V3 = −1.01 V For 5.58 Using Eq. (5.30), we can write and Vt = Vt0 + γ [ 2φf + VSB − ∂iD /iD = −0.002/◦ C, VGS = 5 V ∂T ∂Vt = −2 mV/◦ C = −0.002 V/◦ C ∂T 2φf ] where and Vt0 = 1.0 V Vt = 1 V γ = 0.5 V1/2 −0.002 = ∂k n /k n 2 × −0.002 − ∂T 5−1 2φf Chapter 5–19 ⇒ ∂k n /k n = −0.003/◦ C ∂T or − 0.3%/◦ C 1 2 5.61 iD = k n (v GS − Vtn )v DS − v DS , 2 for v DS ≤ v GS − Vtn 1 k n (v GS − Vtn )2 (1 + λ v DS ), 2 for v DS ≥ v GS − Vtn iD = For v DS = 2 V, iD = 0.4(1 + 0.02 × 2) = 0.416 mA For v DS = 3 V, iD = 0.4(1 + 0.02 × 3) = 0.424 mA For v DS = 10 V, For our case, Vtn = −2 V, k n = 0.2 mA/V2 , λ = 0.02 V−1 and v GS = 0. Thus 1 iD = 0.2 2 v DS − v 2DS , 2 iD = 0.4(1 + 0.02 v DS ), For v DS = 1 V, 1 = 0.3 mA iD = 0.2 2 − 2 for v DS ≤ 2 V for v DS ≥ 2 V iD = 0.4(1 + 0.02 × 10) = 0.48 mA If the device width W is doubled, k n is doubled, and each of the currents above will be doubled. If both W and L are doubled, k n remains unchanged. However, λ is divided in half; thus for v DS = 2 V, iD becomes 0.408 mA; for v DS = 3 V, iD becomes 0.412 mA; and for v DS = 10 V, iD becomes 0.44 mA. Exercise 6–1 Ex: 6.1 Refer to Fig. 6.2(a) and 6.2(b). Av = −k n VOV RD Coordinates of point A: Vt and VDD ; thus 0.4 V and 1.8 V. To determine the coordinates of point B, we use Eqs. (6.7) and (6.8) as follows: √ 2k n RD VDD + 1 − 1 VOV B = k n RD √ 2 × 4 × 17.5 × 1.8 + 1 − 1 = 4 × 17.5 −10 = −0.4 × 10 × VOV × 17.5 = 0.213 V Thus, VOV = 0.14 V VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.4 + 0.14 = 0.54 V 1 W 2 VOV ID = k n 2 L 1 × 0.4 × 10 × 0.142 = 0.04 mA 2 RD = 17.5 k = Thus, VGS B = Vt + VOV B = 0.4 + 0.213 = 0.613 V and VDS = VDD − RD ID VDS B = VOV B = 0.213 V = 1.8 − 17.5 × 0.04 = 1.1 V Thus, coordinates of B are 0.613 V and 0.213 V. At point C, the MOSFET is operating in the triode region, thus 1 iD = k n (v GS C − Vt )v DS C − v 2DS C 2 If v DS C is very small, iD k n (v GS C − Vt )v DS C = 4(1.8 − 0.4)v DS C = 5.6v DS C , mA Ex: 6.3 But iD = VDD − v DS C VDD 1.8 = 0.1 mA = RD 17.5 RD 0.1 = 0.018 V = 18 mV, which Thus, v DS C = 5.6 is indeed very small, as assumed. Av = − IC RC VT 1 × RC ⇒ RC = 8 k 0.025 − IC RC −320 = − VC = VCC = 10 − 1 × 8 = 2 V Since the collector voltage is allowed to decrease to +0.3 V, the largest negative swing allowed at the output is 2 − 0.3 = 1.7 V. The corresponding input signal amplitude can be found by dividing 1.7 V by the gain magnitude (320 V/V), resulting in 5.3 mV. Ex: 6.4 5 V Ex: 6.2 Refer to Example 6.1 and Fig. 6.4(a). RG RD vo Design 1: VOV = 0.2 V, VGS = 0.6 V ID = 0.8 mA vi Now, Av = −k n VOV RD Thus, ⇒ RD = 12.5 k Refer to the solution of Example 6.3. From vo Eq. (6.47), Av ≡ = −gm RD (note that RL vi is absent). VDS = VDD − RD ID Thus, = 1.8 − 12.5 × 0.08 = 0.8 V gm RD = 25 Design 2: Substituting for gm = k n VOV , we have RD = 17.5 k k n VOV RD = 25 −10 = −0.4 × 10 × 0.2 × RD Exercise 6–2 where k n = 1 mA/V2 , thus vt vt +i = + gm v t ro ro it = VOV RD = 25 (1) Next, consider the bias equation ∴ Req = vt 1 = ro it gm VGS = VDS = VDD − RD ID Thus, Ex: 6.6 Vt + VOV = VDD − RD ID Substituting Vt = 0.7 V, VDD = 5 V, and VDD 1 1 1 2 2 2 k n VOV = × 1 × VOV = VOV 2 2 2 we obtain 1 2 RD (2) 0.7 + VOV = 5 − VOV 2 Equations (1) and (2) can be solved to obtain ID = iD RD vDS vgs vGS VOV = 0.319 V and VGS RD = 78.5 k The dc current ID can be now found as 1 2 k n VOV = 50.9 μA 2 To determine the required value of RG we use Eq. (6.48), again noting that RL is absent: ID = Rin = RG 1 + gm RD 0.5 M = VDD = 5 V VGS = 2 V Vt = 1 V λ=0 k n = 20 μA/V2 RG 1 + 25 RD = 10 k ⇒ RG = 13 M Finally, the maximum allowable input signal v̂ i can be found as follows: Vt 0.7 V = = 27 mV v̂ i = |Av | + 1 25 + 1 W = 20 L (a) VGS = 2 V ⇒ VOV = 1 V VDS Ex: 6.5 1 W 2 k V = 200 μA 2 n L OV = VDD − ID RD = +3 V ID = (b) gm = k n (c) Av = it Req D 0 vt (d) v gs = 0.2 sinωt V v ds = −0.8 sinωt V ro (e) Using Eq. (6.28), we obtain G i S v ds = −gm RD = −4 V/V v gs v DS = VDS + v ds ⇒ 2.2 V ≤ v DS ≤ 3.8 V i 1 gm W VOV = 400 μA/V = 0.4 mA/V L iD = 1 k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 1 + k n (VGS − Vt )v gs + k n v 2gs 2 iD = 200 + 80 sinωt + 8 sin2 ωt, μA Exercise 6–3 = [200 + 80 sinωt + (4 − 4 cos2ωt)] = 204 + 80 sinωt − 4 cos2ωt, μA ID shifts by 4 μA. gm = Thus, 2HD = î2ω îω = 4 μA = 0.05 (5%) 80 μA Ex: 6.7 (a) gm = 16 1 × 60 × × (1.6 − 1)2 2 0.8 ID = 216 μA = 2 ID 2 × 216 = = 720 μA/V |VOV | 1.6 − 1 = 0.72 mA/V λ = 0.04 ⇒ VA = ro = 2 ID VOV 1 1 = = 25 V/μm λ 0.04 VA × L 25 × 0.8 = 92.6 k = ID 0.216 ID = 1 W 2 1 k V = × 60 × 40 × (1.5 − 1)2 2 n L OV 2 ID = 300 μA = 0.3 mA, VOV = 0.5 V Ex: 6.11 2 ID VA 2VA × = gm ro = VOV ID VOV 2 × 0.3 = 1.2 mA/V 0.5 VA 15 = 50 k = ro = ID 0.3 VA × L = VA gm = (b) ID = 0.5 mA ⇒ gm = = = 100 V/V Ex: 6.12 Given: gm = gm = 1.55 mA/V VA 15 = 30 k = ID 0.5 ∂iC ∂v BE iC = IC where IC = IS eVBE /VT ∂iC IS eVBE /VT IC = = ∂v BE VT VT Ex: 6.8 ID = 0.1 mA, gm = 1 mA/V, k n = 50 μA/V2 Thus, gm = 2 ID 2 × 0.1 = 0.2 V ⇒ VOV = VOV 1 gm = ID = 1 W 2 W 2 ID k n VOV ⇒ = 2 2 L L k n VOV = 2 × 12.5 × 0.8 0.2 W 2 μn Cox ID L 2 × 60 × 40 × 0.5 × 103 ro = L = 0.8 μm ⇒ gm ro = 2 × 0.1 = 100 50 × 0.22 1000 IC VT Ex: 6.13 IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V = gm = VT 25 mV Ex: 6.14 Ex: 6.9 W VOV L Same bias conditions, so same VOV and also same L and gm for both PMOS and NMOS. gm = μn Cox μn Cox Wn = μp Cox Wp ⇒ ⇒ Wp = 2.5 Wn Ex: 6.10 1 W ID = k p (VSG − |Vt |)2 2 L μp Wn = 0.4 = μn Wp IC = 0.5 mA (constant) β = 50 gm = β = 200 IC 0.5 mA = VT 25 mV = 20 mA/V = 20 mA/V 0.5 0.5 IC = = IB = β 50 200 = 10 μA rπ = = 2.5 μA β 50 200 = = gm 20 20 = 2.5 k = 10 k Exercise 6–4 ic = βib = β Ex: 6.15 β = 100 gm = IC = 1 mA = 1 mA = 40 mA/V 25 mV β v be = gm v be rπ ie = ib + βib = (β + 1)ib = (β + 1) VT αVT 25 mV = 25 = re = IE IC 1 mA rπ = v be rπ = β 100 = = 2.5 k gm 40 v be rπ v be v be = rπ (β + 1) re Ex: 6.18 Ex: 6.16 IC 1 mA = = 40 mA/V gm = VT 25 mV v ce = −gm RC Av = v be C gmvbe ib = −40 × 10 B = −400 V/V re VC = VCC − IC RC vbe = 15 − 1 × 10 = 5 V v C (t) = VC + v c (t) E = (VCC − IC RC ) + Av v be (t) v be − gm v be re 1 = v be − gm re β 1 − = v be rπ/β+1 rπ β +1 β v be = v be − = rπ rπ rπ ib = = (15 − 10) − 400 × 0.005 sinωt = 5 − 2 sinωt iB (t) = IB + ib (t) where 1 mA IC = = 10 μA IB = β 100 and ib (t) = = gm v be (t) β Ex: 6.19 40 × 0.005 sinωt 100 10 V = 2 sinωt, μA Thus, RE 10 k iB (t) = 10 + 2 sinωt, μA CC1 Ex: 6.17 vi ib B ic CC2 C vbe bib rp RC 7.5 k E 10 V vo Exercise 6–5 10 − 0.7 = 0.93 mA 10 IC = αIE = 0.99 × 0.93 VE = −0.1 − 0.7 = −0.8 V IE = (b) gm = = 0.92 mA VC = −10 + IC RC = −10 + 0.92 × 7.5 = −3.1 V Av = vo αRC = vi re where re = Av = IC 0.99 = 40 mA/V VT 0.025 rπ = β 100 = 2.5 k gm 40 ro = VA 100 = 101 100 k = IC 0.99 (c) Rsig = 2 k RB = 10 k rπ = 2.5 k 25 mV = 26.9 0.93 mA gm = 40 mA/V 0.99 × 7.5 × 103 = 276.2 V/V 26.9 For v̂ i = 10 mV, v̂ o = 276.2 × 10 = 2.76 V Ex: 6.20 10V RC = 8 k RL = 8 k ro = 100 k Vy Vy Vπ = × Vsig Vsig Vπ = RB rπ × −gm (RC RL ro ) (RB rπ ) + Rsig = 10 2.5 × −40(8 8 100) (10 2.5) + 2 −0.5 × 40 × 3.846 = −77 V/V 8 k If ro is negelected, X Y 10 k Z I 1 mA Vy = −80, for an error Vsig of 3.9%. Ex: 6.21 2ID 2 × 0.25 = 2 mA/V = gm = VOV 0.25 Rin = ∞ Av o = −gm RD = −2 × 20 = −40 V/V Ro = RD = 20 k RL 20 = −40 × RL + Ro 20 + 20 IE = 1 mA Av = Av o 100 × 1 = 0.99 mA 101 1 × 1 = 0.0099 mA IB = 101 (a) VC = 10 − 8 × 0.99 = 2.08 2.1 V = −20 V/V IC = VB = −10 × 0.0099 = −0.099 −0.1 V This figure belongs to Exercise 6.20c. Gv = Av = −20 V/V v̂ i = 0.1 × 2VOV = 0.2 × 2 × 0.25 = 0.05 V v̂ o = 0.05 × 20 = 1 V Exercise 6–6 Ex: 6.22 IC = 0.5 mA gm = IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V = VT 0.025 V rπ = β 100 = 5 k = gm 20 Rin = rπ = 5 k Av o = −gm RC = −20 × 10 = −200 V/V Ro = RC = 10 k Av = Av o 5 RL = −200 × RL + Ro 5 + 10 = −66.7 V/V Gv = Rin 5 Av = × −66.7 Rin + Rsig 5+5 = −33.3 V/V For IC = 0.5 mA and β = 100, v̂ π = 5 mV ⇒ v̂ sig = 2 × 5 = 10 mV re = v̂ o = 10 × 33.3 = 0.33 V VT αVT 0.99 × 25 = = 50 IE IC 0.5 rπ = (β + 1)re 5 k Although a larger fraction of the input signal reaches the amplifier input, linearity considerations cause the output signal to be in fact smaller than in the original design! For v̂ sig = 100 mV, Rsig = 10 k and with v̂ π limited to 10 mV, the value of Re required can be found from 10 Re + 100 = 10 1 + 50 5 Ex: 6.23 Refer to the solution to Exercise 6.21. If v̂ sig = 0.2 V and we wish to keep v̂ gs = 50 mV, 3 then we need to connect a resistance Rs = in gm the source lead. Thus, ⇒ Re = 350 3 = 1.5 k Rs = 2 mA/V = 40.4 k Gv = −β = −100 RD RL Gv = Av = − 1 + Rs gm =− Rin = (β + 1)(re + Re ) = 101 × (50 + 350) 2020 = −5 V/V 0.5 + 1.5 v̂ o = Gv v̂ sig = 5 × 0.2 = 1 V (unchanged) 1 = 10 mA/V 0.1 k But Ex: 6.24 From the following figure we see that gm = v̂ sig = îb Rsig + v̂ π + îe Re Thus, 2ID VOV 2ID 0.2 ⇒ ID = 1 mA ie Rsig + v̂ π + îe Re β +1 v̂ π v̂ π Rsig + v̂ π + Re (β + 1)re re Rsig Re v̂ sig = v̂ π 1 + + rπ re 10 = −19.8 V/V 10 + 101 × 0.4 Ex: 6.25 1 = Rsig = 100 gm ⇒ gm = = RC RL Rsig + (β + 1)(re + Re ) 10 = = Gv = Q.E.D Rin × gm RD Rin + Rsig = 0.5 × 10 × 2 = 10 V/V Exercise 6–7 1 = 200 gm Ex: 6.26 IC = 1 mA VT VT 25 mV = 25 = re = IE IC 1 mA Rin = re = 25 ⇒ gm = 5 mA/V But gm = k n Av o = gm RC = 40 × 5 = 200 V/V Ro = RC = 5 k RL 5 = 100 V/V = 200 × Av = Av o RL + Ro 5+5 W VOV L Thus, 5 = 0.4 × W × 0.25 L Ex: 6.27 W = 50 L 1 W 2 ID = k n VOV 2 L 1 = × 0.4 × 50 × 0.252 2 = 0.625 mA Rin = re = 50 RL = 1 k to 10 k Rin × Av Gv = Rin + Rsig = 25 × 100 = 0.5 V/V 25 + 5000 ⇒ IE = VT 25 mV = = 0.5 mA re 50 IC IE = 0.5 mA Gv = RC RL re + Rsig ⇒ Correspondingly, Gv = RL RL = RL + Ro RL + 0.2 will range from Gv = RC RL 40 = (50 + 50) 1 = 0.83 V/V 1 + 0.2 to RC RL = 4 k Gv = 10 = 0.98 V/V 10 + 0.2 Ex: 6.28 Refer to Fig. 6.41(c). Ro = 100 Thus, Ex: 6.30 1 = 100 ⇒ gm = 10 mA/V gm IC = 5 mA But gm = VT VT 25 mV =5 = IE IC 5 mA Rsig = 10 k RL = 1 k 2ID VOV Rin = (β + 1) (re + RL ) Thus, 10 × 0.25 = 1.25 mA 2 RL 1 = 0.91 V =1× v̂ o = v̂ i × RL + Ro 1 + 0.1 ID = v̂ gs = v̂ i re = 1 gm 1 + RL gm Ex: 6.29 Ro = 200 =1× 0.1 = 91 mV 0.1 + 1 = 101 × (0.005 + 1) = 101.5 k Gv o = 1 V/V Rout = re + Rsig β +1 10,000 = 104 101 RL RL = Gv = Rsig RL + Rout RL + re + β +1 =5+ = 1 = 0.91 V/V 1 + 0.104 Exercise 6–8 vπ = vsig v̂ sig v̂ sig re re + RL + Rsig β +1 Rsig RL = v̂ π 1 + + (β + 1) re re 1000 10,000 =5 1+ + = 1.1 V/V 5 101 × 5 Correspondingly, v̂ o = Gv × 1.1 = 0.91 × 1.1 = 1 V VS = −5 + 6.2 × 0.49 = −1.96 V VD = 5 − 6.2 × 0.49 = +1.96 V RG should be selected in the range of 1 M to 10 M to have low current. Ex: 6.33 2 ⇒ VOV Ex: 6.31 1 W ID = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 L 0.5 = 1 × 1(VGS − 1)2 2 ⇒ VGS = 2 V If Vt = 1.5 V, then ID = ⇒ 1 × 1 × (2 − 1.5)2 = 0.125 mA 2 0.125 − 0.5 ID = −0.75 = −75% = ID 0.5 1 W 2 k V 2 n L OV 0.5 × 2 =1 = 1 = 1 V ⇒ VGS = 1 + 1 = 2 V ID = 0.5 mA = ⇒ VOV 5−2 = 6 k 0.5 ⇒ RD = 6.2 k (standard value). For this RD we have to recalculate ID : = VD ⇒ RD = ID = 1 × 1 × (VGS − 1)2 2 1 (VDD − RD ID − 1)2 2 (VGS = VD = VDD − RD ID ) = 1 (4 − 6.2 ID )2 ⇒ ID ∼ = 0.49 mA 2 VD = 5 − 6.2 × 0.49 = 1.96 V ID = Ex: 6.32 RD = VDD − VD 5−2 = 6 k = ID 0.5 → RD = 6.2 k ID = 1 W 2 1 2 k V ⇒ 0.5 = × 1 × VOV 2 n L OV 2 Ex: 6.34 Refer to Example 6.12. (a) For design 1, RE = 3 k, R1 = 80 k, and R2 = 40 k. Thus, VBB = 4 V. IE = ⇒ VOV = 1 V VBB − VBE R1 R2 RE + β +1 ⇒ VGS = VOV + Vt = 1 + 1 = 2 V For the nominal case, β = 100 and ⇒ VS = −2 V 4 − 0.7 = 1.01 1 mA 4080 3+ 101 For β = 50, RS = VS − VSS −2 − (−5) = 6 k = ID 0.5 → RS = 6.2 k If we choose RD = RS = 6.2 k, then ID will change slightly: 1 × 1 × (VGS − 1)2 . Also 2 = −VS = 5 − RS ID ID = VGS 2 ID = (4 − 6.2 ID )2 ⇒ 38.44 ID2 − 51.6 ID2 + 16 = 0 ⇒ ID = 0.49 mA, 0.86 mA ID = 0.86 results in VS > 0 or VS > VG , which is not acceptable. Therefore ID = 0.49 mA and IE = 4 − 0.7 = 0.94 mA 4080 3+ 51 For β = 150, IE = 4 − 0.7 = 1.04 mA 4080 3+ 151 Thus, IE varies over a range approximately 10% of the nominal value of 1 mA. IE = (b) For design 2, RE = 3.3 k, R1 = 8 k, and R2 = 4 k. Thus, VBB = 4 V. For the nominal case, β = 100 and Exercise 6–9 4 − 0.7 = 0.99 1 mA 48 3.3 + 101 For β = 50, To maintain active-mode operation at all times, the collector voltage should not be allowed to fall below the value that causes the CBJ to become forward biased, namely, −0.4 V. Thus, the lowest possible dc voltage at the collector is −0.4 V + 2V = +1.6 V. Correspondingly, IE = 4 − 0.7 = 0.984 mA 48 3.3 + 51 For β = 150, IE = RC = 4 − 0.7 = 0.995 mA 48 3.3 + 151 Thus, IE varies over a range of 1.1% of the nominal value of 1 mA. Note that lowering the resistances of the voltage divider considerably decreases the dependence on the value of β, a highly desirable result obtained at the expense of increased current and hence power dissipation. 10 − 1.6 10 − 1.6 = 8.4 k IC 1 mA IE = Ex: 6.36 Refer to Fig. 6.54. For IE = 1 mA and VC = 2.3 V, VCC − VC RC IE = 1= 10 − 2.3 RC ⇒ RC = 7.7 k Now, using Eq. (6.147), we obtain Ex: 6.35 Refer to Fig. 6.53. Since the circuit is to be used as a common-base amplifier, we can dispense with RB altogether and ground the base; thus RB = 0. The circuit takes the form shown in the figure below. 10 V IE = VCC − VBE RB RC + β +1 10 − 0.7 RB 7.7 + 101 ⇒ RB = 162 k 1= Selecting standard 5% resistors (Appendix J), we use RC RB = 160 k vo and RC = 7.5 k The resulting value of IE is found as 10 − 0.7 = 1.02 mA 160 7.5 + 101 and the collector voltage will be IE = RE vi 5V To establish IE = 1mA, IE = 5 − VBE RE 1 mA = 5 − 0.7 RE VC = VCC − IE RC = 2.3 V Ex: 6.37 Refer to Fig. 6.55(b). VS = 3.5 and ID = 0.5 mA; thus RS = VS 3.5 = 7 k = ID 0.5 VDD = 15 V and VD = 6 V; thus RD = VDD − VD 15 − 6 = = 18 k ID 0.5 mA ⇒ RE = 4.3 k To obtain VOV , we use IC vo = gm RC , where gm = = vi VT 40 mA/V. To maximize the voltage gain, we select RC as large as possible, consistent with obtaining a ±2-V signal swing at the collector. 1 2 k n VOV 2 1 2 0.5 = × 4VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.5 V The voltage gain ID = Exercise 6–10 Thus, VGS = Vt + VOV = 1 + 0.5 = 1.5 V We now can obtain the dc voltage required at the gate, VG = VS + VGS = 3.5 + 1.5 = 5 V Using a current of 2 μA in the voltage divider, we have 5V = 2.5 M RG2 = 2 μA The voltage drop across RG1 is 10 V, thus RG1 = 10 V = 5 M 2 μA This completes the bias design. To obtain gm and ro , we use 2ID 2 × 0.5 = = 2 mA/V gm = VOV 0.5 VA 100 = 200 k = ID 0.5 ro = Ex: 6.38 Refer to Fig. 6.55(a) and (c) and to the values found in the solution to Exercise 6.37 above. Rin = RG1 RG2 = 52.5 = 1.67 M Ro = RD ro = 18200 = 16.5 k 5V = 100 k 0.05 mA The base current is IE 0.5 mA = 5 μA IB = β +1 100 RB2 = The current through RB1 is IRB1 = IB + IRB2 = 5 + 50 = 55 μA Since the voltage drop across RB1 is VCC − VB = 10 V, the value of RB1 can be found from 10 V = 182 k RB1 = 0.055 μA The value of RE can be found from IE = VB − VBE RE 5 − 0.7 = 8.6 k 0.5 The value of RC can be found from ⇒ RE = VC = VCC − IC RC 6 = 15 − 0.99 × 0.5 × RC RC 18 k This completes the bias design. The values of gm , rπ , and ro can be found as follows: Rin gm (ro RD RL ) Rin + Rsig gm = IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V VT 0.025 V 1.67 × 2 × (2001820) 1.67 + 0.1 rπ = β 100 = 5 k = gm 20 ro = VA 100 = 200 k IC 0.5 Gv = − =− Ex: 6.40 Refer to Fig. 6.56(a). For VB = 5 V and 50-μA current through RB2 , we have = −17.1 V/V Ex: 6.39 To reduce v gs to half its value, the unbypassed Rs is given by Rs = 1 gm Rin = RB1 RB2 rπ From the solution to Exercise 6.37 above, gm = 2 mA/V. Thus Rs = 1 = 0.5 k 2 Neglecting ro , Gv is given by Gv = − Ex: 6.41 Refer to Fig. 6.56(b) and to the solution of Exercise 6.40 above. Rin RD RL ×− 1 Rin + Rsig + Rs gm 1.67 1820 =− × 1.67 + 0.1 0.5 + 0.5 = −8.9 V/V = 182 100 5 = 4.64 k Ro = RC ro = 18 200 = 16.51 k Gv = − Rin gm (RC RL ro ) Rin + Rsig Gv = − 4.64 × 20 × (18 20 200) 4.64 + 10 = −57.3 V/V Ex: 6.42 Refer to the solutions of Exercises 6.40 and 6.41 above. With Re included (i.e., left unbypassed), the input resistance becomes [refer to Fig. 6.57(b)] Exercise 6–11 50 × 20(88) 50 + 50 Rin = RB1 RB2 [(β + 1)(re + Re )] = Thus, = 40 V/V 10 = 182 100 [101(0.05 + Re )] VT = where we have substituted re = IE 25 = 50 . The value of Re is found from the 0.5 equation above to be Re = 67.7 RC RL Rin Rin + Rsig re + Re Gv = −0.99 × 18 20 10 10 + 10 0.05 + 0.0677 = −39.8 V/V Ex: 6.43 Refer to Fig. 6.58. Rin = 50 = re RE re re = 50 = VT IE ⇒ IE = 0.5 mA IC = αIE IE = 0.5 mA VC = VCC − RC IC For VC = 1 V and VCC = 5 V, we have 1 = 5 − RC × 0.5 ⇒ RC = 8 k To obtain the required value of RE , we note that the voltage drop across it is (VEE − VBE ) = 4.3 V. Thus, 4.3 = 8.6 k 0.5 Rin gm (RC RL ) Gv = Rin + Rsig RE = Ex: 6.44 Refer to Fig. 6.59. Consider first the bias design of the circuit in Fig. 6.59(a). Since the required IE = 1 mA, the base current 1 IE = 0.01 mA. For a dc voltage β +1 101 drop across RB of 1 V, we obtain IB = The overall voltage gain can be found from Gv = −α v̂ o = 40 v̂ sig = 40 × 10 mV = 0.4 V 1V = 100 k 0.01 mA The result is a base voltage of –1 V and an emitter voltage of –1.7 V. The required value of RE can now be determined as −1.7 − (−5) 3.3 RE = = = 3.3 k IE 1 mA RB = Rin = RB [(β + 1)[re + (RE ro RL )] where ro = VA 100 V = 100 k = IC 1 mA Rin = 100 (100 + 1)[0.025 + (3.3 100 1)] = 44.3 k Rin 44.3 vi = = = 0.469 V/V v sig Rin + Rsig 44.3 + 50 RE ro RL vo = = 0.968 V/V vi re + (RE ro RL ) vo = 0.469 × 0.968 = 0.454 V/V Gv ≡ v sig RB + Rsig Rout = ro RE re + β +1 100 50 = 100 3.3 0.025 + 101 = 320 Chapter 6–1 6.1 Coordinates of point A: v GS = Vt = 0.5 V and v DS = VDD = 5 V. corresponding peak input signal is v̂ gs = 0.78 0.78 V = = 19.5 mV | Av | 40 To obtain the coordinates of point B, we first use Eq. (6.6) to determine VGS B as √ 2k n RD VDD + 1 − 1 VGS B = Vt + k n RD √ 2 × 10 × 20 × 5 + 1 − 1 = 0.5 + 10 × 20 = 0.5 + 0.22 = 0.72 V The vertical coordinate of point B is VDS B , VDS B = VGS B − Vt = VOV B = 0.22 V VDD − VOV B VOV B /2 2 − VOV B 14 = VOV B /2 ⇒ VOV B = 0.25 V 6.2 VDS B = VOV B = 0.5 V Now, using Eq. (6.15) at point B, we have Av = −k n VOV RD Thus, 1 1 2 ID B = k n VDS = × 5 × 0.52 = 0.625 mA B 2 2 The value of RD required can now be found as VDD − VDS B RD = ID B 5 − 0.5 = 7.2 k = 0.625 If the transistor is replaced with another having twice the value of k n , then ID B will be twice as large and the required value of RD will be half that used before, that is, 3.6 k. 6.3 Bias point Q: VOV = 0.2 V and VDS = 1 V. IDQ = 1 2 k n VOV 2 1 × 10 × 0.04 = 0.2 mA 2 VDD − VDS 5−1 RD = = = 20 k IDQ 0.2 = Coordinates of point B: Equation (6.6): √ 2k n RD VDD + 1 − 1 VGS B = Vt + k n RD √ 2 × 10 × 20 × 5 + 1 − 1 = 0.5 + 10 × 20 = 0.5 + 0.22 = 0.72 V Equations (6.7) and (6.8): √ 2k n RD VDD + 1 − 1 VDS B = = 0.22 V k n RD Av = −k n RD VOV = −10 × 20 × 0.2 = −40 V/V The lowest instantaneous voltage allowed at the output is VDS B = 0.22 V. Thus the maximum allowable negative signal swing at the output is VDSQ − 0.22 = 1 − 0.22 = 0.78 V. The 6.4 From Eq. (6.18): | Av max | = B B Thus, −14 = −k n RD × 0.25 ⇒ k n RD = 56 To obtain a gain of −12 V/V at point Q: −12 = −k n RD VOV Q = −56VOV Q Thus, 12 VOV Q = = 0.214 V 56 To obtain the required VDS Q , we use Eq. (6.17), VDD − VDS Q Av = − VOV Q /2 2 − VDS Q −12 = − 0.214/2 ⇒ VDS = 0.714 V Q 6.5 RD = 20 k k n = 200 μA/V2 VRD = 1.5 V VGS = 0.7 V Av = −10 V/V Av = −k n VOV RD 1 2 VRD = ID RD = k n VOV RD 2 −2 −10 Av = = VRD VOV 1.5 ∴ VOV = 0.30 V Vt = VGS −VOV = 0.40 V Av −10 kn = = VOV RD −0.3 × 20 = 1.67 mA/V2 Chapter 6–2 k n = k n ∴ W = 1.67 mA/V2 L remains in saturation is 1.61 V and the corresponding output voltage is 0.61 V. Thus, the maximum amplitude of input sine wave is (1.61 − 1.5) = 0.11 V. That is, v GS ranges from 1.5 − 0.11 = 1.39 V, at which W = 8.33 L iD = 6.6 1 × 1 × (1.39 − 1)2 = 0.076 mA 2 and VDD v DS = 5 − 0.076 × 24 = 3.175 V and v GS = 1.5 + 0.11 = 1.61 V at which v DS = 0.61 V. iD RD vDS Thus, the large-signal gain is 0.61 − 3.175 = −11.7 V/V 1.61 − 1.39 ⵑ vgs VGS mA W =1 2 VDD = 5 V, k n L V RD = 24 k, Vt = 1 V (a) Endpoints of saturation transfer segment: whose magnitude is slightly less (−2.5%) than the incremental or small-signal gain (−12 V/V). This is an indication that the transfer characteristic is not a straight line. 6.7 At sat/triode boundary v GS B = VGS + v̂ gs v DS B = VDS − v̂ o v̂ o = max downward amplitude , we get Point A occurs at VGS = Vt = 1 V, iD = 0 v̂ o v DS B = v GS B − Vt = VGS + − Vt | Av | Point A = (1 V, 5 V) ( VGS , VDS ) = VDS − v̂ o Point B occurs at sat/triode boundary ( VGD = Vt ) VOV + VGD = 1 V ⇒ V GS − [ 5 − iD RD ] = 1 1 (1)(24) [ VGS − 1 ]2 − 1 = 0 VGS − 5 + 2 2 − 23VGS + 6 = 0 12VGS VGS = 1.605 V iD = 0.183 mA VDS = 0.608 V Point B = ( +1.61 V, 0.61 V ) v̂ o = VDS − v̂ o | Av | VDS − VOV v̂ o = 1 + | A1v | (1) For VDD = 5 V, VOV = 0.5 V, and W k n = 1 mA/V2 , we use L −2(VDD − VDS ) Av = VOV and Eq. (1) to obtain (b) For VOV = VGS −Vt = 0.5 V, we have VGS = 1.5 V 1 ID = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 1 = × 1(1.5 − 1)2 2 ID = 0.125 mA VDS = +2.00 V v̂ o v̂ i V DS Av 1V −16 471 mV 29.4 mV 1.5 V −14 933 mV 66.7 mV −12 1385 mV 115 mV 2.5 V −10 1818 mV 182 mV 2V Point Q = ( 1.50 V, 2.00 V ) Av = −k n VOV RD = −12 V/V For VDS = 1 V, Av = −16 = −k n VOV RD (c) From part (a) above, the maximum instantaneous input signal while the transistor ID RD = 4 V, ID = 0.125 mA ∴ RD = 32 k Chapter 6–3 solving the resulting quadratic equation results in 6.8 k n RD = 213.7 vDS which can be substituted into Eq. (2) to obtain VDS B = 0.212 V The value of VDS at the bias point can now be found from Eq. (1) as VDS Q = 0.212 + 0.5 = 0.712 V (b) The gain achieved can be found as Q VDSQ Av = −k n RD VOV = −213.7 × 0.2 = −42.7 V/V 0.5 0.5 v̂ gs = = = 11.7 mV | Av | 42.7 0.5 V B VDSB VOV (c) ID = 100 μA vˆ gs Vt vGS VDSB To obtain maximum gain while allowing for a −0.5-V signal swing at the output, we bias the MOSFET at point Q where VDS Q = VDS B + 0.5 V (1) as indicated in the figure above. Now, VDS B is given by Eq. (6.8) [together with Eq. (6.7)], √ 2k n RD VDD + 1 − 1 VDS B = (2) k n RD RD = VDD − VDS Q ID 5 − 0.712 = 42.88 k = 0.1 213.7 (d) k n = = 4.98 mA/V2 42.88 4.98 W = = 24.9 L 0.2 6.9 VDD From the figure we see that VDS B = VOV + v̂ gs Q2 where VOV = 0.2 V (given) and v̂ gs 0.5 V = | Av | = 0.5 0.5 2.5 = = k n RD VOV k n RD × 0.2 k n RD vO vI Q1 iD (3) Thus, 2.5 VDS B = 0.2 + k n RD Substituting for VDS B from Eq. (2), we obtain √ 2.5 2k n RD VDD + 1 − 1 = 0.2 + k n RD k n RD Substituting VDD = 5 V, rearranging the equation to obtain a quadratic equation in k n RD , and given Vt1 = Vt2 = Vt 1 W [ VDD − v O − Vt ]2 For Q2 , iD = k n 2 L 2 1 W [ v I − Vt ]2 For Q1 , iD = k n 2 L 1 For Vt ≤ v I ≤ v O + Vt , equate iD1 and iD2 Chapter 6–4 W L = Similarly, [ VDD − v O + Vt ]2 2 W L [ v I − Vt ] 2 1 [ VDD − v O − Vt ] = v O = VDD − Vt + Vt −v I For ( W/L )1 ( W/L )2 IC VCE (mA) (V) Av (V/V) POS Neg v O (V) v O (V) ( W/L)1 · [ v I − Vt ] ( W/L )2 0.5 4.5 –20 0.5 4.2 1.0 4.0 –40 1.0 3.7 ( W/L )1 ( W/L )2 2.5 2.5 –100 2.5 2.2 4.0 1.0 –160 4.0 0.7 4.5 0.5 –180 4.5 0.2 50 √ 0.5 = 10, 5 0.5 ( W/L )1 = ( W/L )2 6.12 √ Av = − 10 = −3.16 V/V 6.10 Refer to Fig. 6.6. VCC − VCE Av = − VT 5−1 = −160 V/V =− 0.025 The transistor enters saturation when v CE ≤ 0.3 V, thus the maximum allowable output voltage swing is 1 − 0.3 = 0.7 V. The corresponding maximum input signal permitted v̂ be is v̂ be = 0.7 V 0.7 = = 4.4 mV | Av | 160 IC RC VCC − VCE =− VT VT On the verge of saturation Av = − 6.11 VCE − v̂ ce = 0.3 V For linear operation, v ce = Av v be 5 V IC VCE − | Av v̂ be | = 0.3 RC 1 k vO v be VBE ( 5 − IC RC ) − | Av | × 5 × 10−3 = 0.3 But | Av | = IC RC VT Thus, IC RC = | Av |VT and 5 − | Av |VT − | Av | × 5 × 10−3 = 0.3 For IC = 0.5 mA, we have IC RC 0.5 Av = − = −20 V/V =− VT 0.025 VCE = VCC − IC RC | Av |( 0.025 + 0.005 ) = 5 − 0.3 | Av | = 156.67. Note AV is negative. ∴ Av = −156.67 V/V max +v O = 5 − 4.5 = 0.5 V Now we can find the dc collector voltage. Referring to the sketch of the output voltage, we see that max −v O = 4.5 − 0.3 = 4.2 V VCE = 0.3 + | Av | 0.005 = 1.08 V = 5 − 0.5 = 4.5 V Chapter 6–5 This figure belongs to Problem 6.13. 5 V 2.5 V 10 k 5 k Thévenin vO 0.3 mA vI vO In the results obtained, tabulated below, VCEsat = 0.3 V and VCC is the nearest 0.5 V to VCCmin . 6.13 See figure above Av = − 0.3 mA vI 10 k IC RC 0.3 × 5 = −60 V/V =− VT 0.025 Case Av (V/V) P (V) | Av |VT VCCmin VCC 6.14 To obtain an output signal of peak amplitude P volts and maximum gain, we bias the transistor at VCE = VCEsat + P The resulting gain will be VCC − VCE Av = − VT which results in VCC of a −20 0.2 0.5 1.0 1.0 b −50 0.5 1.25 2.05 2.5 c −100 0.5 2.5 3.3 3.5 d −100 1.0 2.5 3.8 4.0 e −200 1.0 5.0 6.3 6.5 f −500 1.0 12.5 13.8 14.0 g −500 2.0 12.5 14.8 15.0 VCC = VCE + | Av |VT Thus the minimum required VCC will be VCCmin = VCEsat + P + | Av |VT 6.15 (a) See figure below but we have to make sure that the amplifier can support a positive peak amplitude of P, that is, (b) See figure on next page Note that in part (b) the graph is shifted right by +5 V and up by +5 V. | Av |VT ≥ P This figure belongs to Problem 6.15(a). vO 0.5 V 0 B vI vI 0.3 V vO RC 5 V A 5 V Chapter 6–6 This figure belongs to Problem 6.15(b). vO 5 V 5V vI B 4.7 V vO RC A 0 0 v CE 6.16 iC = IS e 1+ VA VCE IC = IS eVBE /VT 1 + VA 6.17 (a) Using Eq. (6.23) yields | Av max | = −60 = − VCE 1 eVBE /VT VA VT dv CE 1 −RC IS eVBE /VT dv BE VA 1 1 IC − RC A = −RC IC VCE VA v VT 1+ VA Thus, = −RC IS 1 + Av = −IC RC /VT IC RC 1+ VA + VCE 3 − VCE VCC − VCE =− VT 0.025 ⇒ VCE = 1.5 V (c) IC = 0.5 mA IC RC = VCC − VCE = 3 − 1.5 = 1.5 V RC = 1.5 = 3 k 0.5 (d) IC = IS eVBE /VT 0.5 × 10−3 = 10−15 eVBE /0.025 ⇒ VBE = 0.673 V Q.E.D (e) Assuming linear operation around the bias point, we obtain Substituting IC RC = VCC − VCE , we obtain (VCC − VCE )/VT Av = − VCC − VCE 1+ VA + VCE Q.E.D 5−3 Av (without the Early effect) = − 0.025 = −80 V/V Av (with the Early effect) = v ce = Av × v be = −60 × 5 sin ωt = −300 sin ωt, mV = −0.3 sin ωt, V (f) ic = For VCC = 5 V, VCE = 3 V, and VA = 100 V, = −78.5 V/V VCC − 0.3 3 − 0.3 = 108 V/V = VT 0.025 (b) Using Eq. (6.22) with Av = −60 yields v CE = VCC − RC iC BE v =V , v =V BE BE CE CE vI v BE /VT VCE = VCC − RC IC dv CE Av = dv 4.5 V 5 V −80 2 1+ 100 + 3 −v ce = 0.1 sin ωt, mA RC 0.5 mA IC = = 0.005 mA β 100 ic 0.1 ib = = sin ωt = 0.001 sin ωt, mA β 100 (g) IB = (h) Small-signal input resistance ≡ = 5 mV = 5 k 0.001 mA v̂ be v̂ b Chapter 6–7 Peak-to-peak v C swing = 4 − 1 = 3 V (i) vBE For point Q at VCC /2 = 2.5 V, we obtain vbe VBE 5 mV VCE = 2.5 V, 0.673 V IC = 2.5 mA IB = 25 μA IB = 0 t vCE VCE ⇒ VBB = IB RB + 0.7 = 2.5 + 0.7 = 3.2 V 1.8 V vce VBB − 0.7 = 25 μA RB 1.5 V 0.3 V 1.2 V 0 iC (mA) IC 6.20 See the graphical construction that follows. t 0.6 mA 0.1 mA 0.5 mA 0.4 mA 0 t iB (A) IB ib 1 A 6 A 5 A 4 A 0 t 6.18 Av = − But Av ≡ IC RC VT v O − iC RC = = −gm RC v BE v BE Thus, gm = IC /VT For a transistor biased at IC = 0.5 mA, we have 0.5 gm = = 20 mA/V 0.025 6.19 For this circuit: VCC = 10 V, β = 100, RC = 1 k, VA = 100 V, IB = 50 μA (dc bias), At v CE = 0, iC = βiB ∴ IC = 50 × 100 = 5 mA (dc bias) Given the base bias current of 50 mA, the dc or bias point of the collector current IC , and voltage VCE can be found from the intersection of the load Chapter 6–8 line and the transistor line L1 of iB = 50 μA. Specifically: 6.21 Substituting v gs = Vgs sin ωt in Eq. (6.28), iD = Eq. of L1 ⇒ iC = IC ( 1 + v CE /VA ) = 5 ( 1 + v CE /100 ) VCC − v CE = 10 − v CE RC ∴ 10 − v CE = 5 + 0.05v CE VCE = v CE = 4.76 V Now for a signal of 30-μA peak superimposed on IB = 50 μA, the operating point moves along the load line between points N and M. To obtain the coordinates of point M, we solve the load line and line L2 to find the intersection M, and the load line and line L3 to find N: 6.22 ID = v GS = VGS For point M: iC = 8 + (8/100)v CE and iC = 10 − v CE ∴ iC M = 8.15 mA, 1 Vgs × 100 Q.E.D 4 VOV For Vgs = 10 mV, to keep the second-harmonic distortion to less than 1%, the minimum overdrive voltage required is 1 0.01 × 100 = 0.25 V VOV = × 4 1 = IC = iC = 10 − v CE = 5.24 mA v CE M = 1.85 V 1 1 2 k n VOV = × 10 × 0.22 = 0.2 mA 2 2 + v gs , where v gs = 0.02 V v OV = 0.2 + 0.02 = 0.22 V 1 1 iD = k n v 2OV = × 10 × 0.222 = 0.242 mA 2 2 Thus, id = 0.242 − 0.2 = 0.042 mA For point N: iC = 2 + 0.02v CE and iC = 10 − v CE v CE N = 7.84 V, 1 k n (VGS − Vt )2 + k n (VGS − Vt )Vgs sin ωt 2 1 1 1 + k n Vgs2 ( − cos 2 ωt) 2 2 2 Second-harmonic distortion 1 k n Vgs2 4 × 100 = k n (VGS − Vt )Vgs = = 5 + 0.05v CE Load line ⇒ iC = 1 k n (VGS − Vt )2 + k n (VGS − Vt )Vgs sin ωt 2 1 + k n Vgs2 sin2 ωt 2 iC N = 2.16 mA Thus the collector current varies as follows: For v gs = −0.02 V, v OV = 0.2 − 0.02 = 0.18 V 1 1 iD = k n v 2OV = × 10 × 0.182 = 0.162 mA 2 2 Thus, id = 0.2 − 0.162 = 0.038 mA 2.91 mA 8.15 mA 5.24 mA i 5.99 mA, peak to peak 2.16 mA 3.08 mA Thus, an estimate of gm can be obtained as follows: 0.042 + 0.038 = 2 mA/V gm = 0.04 Alternatively, using Eq. (6.33), we can write gm = k n VOV = 10 × 0.2 = 2 mA/V which is an identical result. And the collector voltage varies as follows: 3.08 V 7.84 V 4.76 V v 5.99 V 1.85 V 2.91 V 6.23 (a) ID = 1 k n (VGS − Vt2 ) 2 1 × 5(0.6 − 0.4)2 = 0.1 mA 2 VDS = VDD − ID RD = 1.8 − 0.1 × 10 = 0.8 V = (b) gm = k n VOV = 5 × 0.2 = 1 mA/V (c) Av = −gm RD = −1 × 10 = −10 V/V 1 (d) λ = 0.1 V−1 , VA = = 10 V λ Chapter 6–9 VA 10 = 100 k = ID 0.1 Av = −gm (RD ro ) To just maintain saturation-mode operation, v GS max = v DS min + Vt = −1(10 100) = −9.1 V/V which results in ro = VOV + v̂ i = VDS − | Av |v̂ i 6.24 Av = −10 = −gm RD = −gm × 20 Substituting for | Av | from Eq. (1) yields gm = 0.5 mA/V To allow for a −0.2-V signal swing at the drain while maintaining saturation-region operation, the minimum voltage at the drain must be at least equal to VOV . Thus VDS = 0.2 + VOV VDD − VDS 1 VOV 2 1.8 − 0.2 − VOV −10 = − 0.5VOV Av = − 2(VDD − VDS ) v̂ i VOV VDS [1 + 2(v̂ i /VOV )] = VOV + v̂ i + 2VDD (v̂ i /VOV ) ⇒ VDS = Since VOV + v̂ i + 2VDD (v̂ i /VOV ) 1 + 2(v̂ i /VOV ) Q.E.D For VDD = 2.5 V, v̂ i = 20 mV and m = 15 VOV = mv̂ i = 15 × 20 = 0.3 V ⇒ VOV = 0.27 V VDS = The value of ID can be found from gm = VOV + v̂ i = VDS − 0.3 + 0.02 + 2 × 2.5 × (0.02/0.3) 1 + 2(0.02/0.3) = 0.576 V 2ID VOV Av = − 2 × ID 0.27 ⇒ ID = 0.067 mA 0.5 = 2(VDD − VDS ) 2(2.5 − 0.576) =− VOV 0.3 = −12.82 V/V v̂ o = | Av |v̂ i = 12.82 × 20 mV = 0.256 V The required value of k n can be found from 1 2 k n VOV 2 1 0.067 = k n × 0.272 2 To operate at ID = 200 μA = 0.2 mA, RD = 2.5 − 0.576 = 9.62 k 0.2 ⇒ k n = 1.83 mA/V2 ID = 1 2 k n VOV 2 ID = Since k n = 0.2 mA/V2 , the W/L ratio must be 0.2 = W 1.83 kn = = = 9.14 L kn 0.2 1 k n × 0.32 2 ⇒ k n = 4.44 mA/V2 Finally, The required W/L ratio can now be found as VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.4 + 0.27 = 0.67 V kn 4.44 W = = = 44.4 L kn 0.1 6.25 Av = −gm RD Upon substituting for gm from Eq. (6.42), we can write 2ID RD Av = − VOV =− 2(VDD − VDS ) VOV Q.E.D v GS max = VGS + v̂ i = Vt + VOV + v̂ i v DS min = VDS − | Av |v̂ i (1) 6.26 Given μn = 500 cm2 /V·s, μp = 250 cm2 /V·s, and Cox = 0.4 fF/μm2 , k n = μn Cox = 20 μA/V2 k p = 10 μA/V2 See table on next page. Chapter 6–10 v i = gm v gs 6.27 VDD 1 + RS gm v d = −gm v gs RD v s = +gm v gs RS RD vs RS +gm RS = = 1 vi 1 + gm RS + RS gm vd −RD −gm RD = = 1 vi 1 + gm RS + RS gm ∴ vd vi vs RS 6.28 VDD VSS G vgs vi vo RL 10 k 1 gm S vs RS RG 10 M RD gmvgs vi I 500 μA vd D Vt = 0.5 V VA = 50 V Given VDS = VGS = 1 V. Also, ID = 0.5 mA. 2ID VOV = 0.5 V, gm = = 2 mA/V VOV Chapter 6–11 ro = 15 V VA = 100 k ID 0.5 mA vo = −gm ( RG RL ro ) = −18.2 V/V vi For ID = 1 mA: √ 1 VOV increases by = 2 to 0.5 √ 2 × 0.5 = 0.707 V. 10 M 16 k 7 V 1.5 V 5 M VGS = VDS = 1.207 V gm = 2.83 mA/V, ro = 50 k and vo = −23.6 V/V vi 0.5 mA 7 k Figure 1 6.29 For the NMOS device: 1 W 2 ID = 100 = μn Cox VOV 2 L 10 1 2 × VOV = × 400 × 2 0.5 ⇒ VOV = 0.16 V 2ID 2 × 0.1 mA = 1.25 mA/V = gm = VOV 0.16 VA = 5L = 5 × 0.5 = 2.5 V VA 2.5 = 25 k = ro = ID 0.1 For the PMOS device: 1 W 2 ID = 100 = μp Cox VOV 2 L 10 1 2 = × 100 × × VOV 2 0.5 ⇒ VOV = 0.316 V 2ID 2 × 0.1 = = 0.63 mA/V gm = VOV 0.316 VA = 6L = 6 × 0.5 = 3 V VA 3 = 30 k = ro = ID 0.1 From the voltage divider, we have 5 =5V VG = 15 10 + 5 From the circuit, we obtain VG = VGS + 0.5 × 7 = 1.5 + 3.5 = 5 V which is consistent with the value provided by the voltage divider. Since the drain voltage (+7 V) is higher than the gate voltage (+5 V), the transistor is operating in saturation. From the circuit VD = VDD − ID RD = 15 − 0.5 × 16 = +7 V, as assumed Finally, VGS = 1.5 V, thus VOV = 1.5 − Vt = 1.5 − 1 = 0.5 V 1 1 2 = × 4 × 0.52 = 0.5 mA ID = k n VOV 2 2 which is equal to the given value. Thus the bias calculations are all consistent. 2ID 2 × 0.5 (b) gm = = = 2 mA/V VOV 0.5 VA 100 ro = = = 200 k ID 0.5 (c) See Fig. 2 below. 6.30 (a) Open-circuit the capacitors to obtain the bias circuit shown in Fig. 1, which indicates the given values. This figure belongs to Problem 6.30, part (c). Rsig 200 k vo vsig vgs 10 M 5 M gmvgs 200 k Rin Figure 2 16 k 16 k Chapter 6–12 (d) Rin = 10 M 5 M = 3.33 M 6.32 v gs Rin 3.33 = = v sig Rin + Rsig 3.33 + 0.2 5 V = 0.94 V/V vo = −gm (200 16 16) v gs 0.5 mA VC = −2 × 7.69 = −15.38 V/V v gs vo vo = × = −0.94 × 15.38 v sig v sig v gs vBE = −14.5 V/V 6.31 (a) Using the exponential characteristic: ic = IC ev be /VT − IC giving VC = VCC − RC IC For v BE = 705 mV ⇒ v be = 5 mV iC = IC ev be /VT (b) Using small-signal approximation: Thus, With v BE = 0.700 V = 5 − 5 × 0.5 = 2.5 V ic = ev be /VT − 1 IC ic = gm v be = 5 k = 0.5 × e5/25 = 0.611 mA IC · v be VT v C = VCC − RC iC = 5 − 5 × 0.611 = 1.95 V v ce = v C − VC = 1.95 − 2.5 = −0.55 V v ce 0.55 V Voltage gain, Av = =− v be 5 mV ic v be = IC VT See table below. For signals at ±5 mV, the error introduced by the small-signal approximation is 10%. The error increases to above 20% for signals at ±10 mV. = −110 V/V Using small-signal approximation, we write Av = −gm RC where IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V = VT 0.025 V gm = Av = −20 × 5 = −100 V/V v be i c /I C i c /I C Error (mV) Exponential Small signal (%) Thus, the small-signal approximation at this signal level (v be = 5 mV) introduces an error of −9.1% in the gain magnitude. +1 +0.041 +0.040 –2.4 –1 –0.039 –0.040 +2.4 +2 +0.083 +0.080 –3.6 –2 –0.077 –0.080 +3.9 +5 +0.221 +0.200 –9.7 –5 –0.181 –0.200 +10.3 re = +8 +0.377 +0.320 –15.2 where –8 –0.274 –0.320 +16.8 α= +10 +0.492 +0.400 –18.7 –10 –0.330 –0.400 +21.3 +12 +0.616 +0.480 –22.1 0.99 × 25 mV 50 0.5 mA At IC = 50 μA = 0.05 mA, –12 –0.381 –0.480 +25.9 gm = 6.33 At IC = 0.5 mA, IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V = VT 0.025 V β 100 = 5 k = rπ = gm 20 mA/V gm = VT αVT = IE IC 100 β = = 0.99 β +1 100 + 1 re = IC 0.05 = = 2 mA/V VT 0.025 Chapter 6–13 β 100 = 50 k = gm 2 mA/V αVT 0.99 × 25 mV re = 500 = IC 0.5 mA and rπ = | Av | = gm RC = then 6.34 For gm = 30 mA/V, IC gm = ⇒ IC = gm VT = 30×0.025 = 0.75 mA VT β β = rπ = gm 30 mA/V For rπ ≥ 3 k, we require β ≥ 90 That is, βmin = 90. IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V α 0.99 re = = 25 gm 40 mA/V β 100 rπ = = = 2.5 k gm 40 mA/V Av = −gm RC = −40 × 5 = −200 V/V 6.35 gm = v̂ o = | Av |v̂ be = 200 × 5 mV = 1 V VC = 1 V, 6.36 VCC = 3 V, 3−1 IC = = 1 mA 2 IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = gm = VT 0.025 V v be = 0.005 sin ωt V̂be IC RC = 0.3 VT which can be manipulated to yield VCC − 0.3 IC RC = V̂be 1+ VT Since the voltage gain is given by IC RC Av = − VT then VCC − 0.3 Av = VT + V̂be VCC − IC RC − (1) For VCC = 3 V and V̂be = 5 mV, 3 − 0.3 = 2.25 V IC RC = 5 1+ 25 Thus, VCE = VCC − IC RC = 3 − 2.25 = 0.75 V RC = 2 k ic = gm v be = 0.2 sin ωt, mA iC (t) = IC + ic = 1 + 0.2 sin ωt, mA v C (t) = VCC − RC iC = 3 − 2(1 + 0.2 sin ωt) V̂o = VCE − 0.3 = 0.75 − 0.3 = 0.45 V 3 − 0.3 = −90 V/V Av = − 0.025 + 0.005 Check: IC RC 2.25 = −90 V/V =− Av = −gm RC = − VT 0.025 V̂o = | Av | × V̂be = 90 × 5 = 450 mV = 0.45 V 6.38 Transistor α = 1 − 0.4 sin ωt, V iB (t) = iC (t)/β = 0.01 + 0.002 sin ωt, mA vc 0.4 = −80 V/V =− Av = v be 0.005 6.37 Since V̂be is the maximum value for acceptable linearity, the largest signal at the collector will be obtained by designing for maximum gain magnitude. This in turn is achieved by biasing the transistor at the lowest VCE consistent with the transistor remaining in the active mode at the negative peak of v o . Thus VCE − | Av |V̂be = 0.3 a b 1.000 0.990 c d 0.980 1 50 ∞ e ∞ 100 IC (mA) 1.00 0.99 IE (mA) 1.00 1.00 IB (mA) 0 0.010 0.020 0 gm (mA/V) 40 39.6 40 40 25 24.5 25 100 re () 25 rπ () ∞ 100 g 9 15.9 1.00 1.00 0.248 4.5 17.5 1.02 1.00 0.25 5 18.6 0.002 0.5 1.10 9.92 180 700 5 1.34 50 22.7 2.525 k 1.25 k ∞ 10.1 k 6.39 IC = 1 mA, f 0.990 0.900 0.940 β β = 100, gm = IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V rπ = β 100 = = 2.5 k gm 40 mA/V ro = VA 100 V = = 100 k IC 1 mA where we have assumed VCEsat = 0.3 V. Since VCE = VCC − IC RC IC RC VT VA = 100 V Chapter 6–14 These figures belong to Problem 6.39. B C rp vp E rp 2.5 k, C B rp ro gmvp ib E ro 100 k, gm 40 mA/V b 100 C C gmvp B vp ro ai B ro re re i E E re 24.75 , gm 40 mA/V 100 β = = 0.99 α= β +1 100 + 1 VT αVT 0.99 × 25 mV = = = 24.75 re = IE IC 1 mA 6.40 gmvbe B ib vbe vbe re ro 100 k, a 0.99 ib = v be g − gm Q.E.D 6.41 Refer to Fig. 6.26. v be α = v be ic = αie = α re re = gm v be Q.E.D 6.42 The large-signal model of Fig. 4.5(d) is shown in Fig. 1. iB E C vBE v be ib = − gm v be re 1 = v be − gm re Since α re = gm m α 1−α = gm v be α gm v be = β v be β = = rπ Rin ≡ ib gm B Rin ro bib DB ( ISB IS ) b biB E Figure 1 For v BE undergoing an incremental change v be from its equilibrium value of VBE , the current iB Chapter 6–15 C changes from IB by an increment ib , which is related to v be by the incremental resistance of DB at the bias current IB . This resistance is given by VT /IB , which is rπ . aiE The collector current βiB changes from βIB to β(IB + ib ). The incremental changes around the equilibrium or bias point are related to each other by the circuit shown in Fig. 2, B ie re vbe ib B E C vbe Figure 2 bib rp which is the small-signal T model of Fig. 6.26(b). Q.E.D. E 6.44 Refer to Fig. P6.44: Figure 2 which is the hybrid-π model of Fig. 6.24(b). Q.E.D. 6.43 The large-signal T model of Fig. 4.5(b) is shown below in Fig. 1. VC = 3 − 0.2 × 10 = 1 V VT 25 mV = 125 = re = IE 0.2 mA Replacing the BJT with the T model of Fig. 6.26(b), we obtain the equivalent circuit shown below. C aiE B iE DE IS ISE a vBE ( ) E Figure 1 If iE undergoes an incremental change ie from its equilibrium or bias value IE , the voltage v BE will correspondingly change by an incremental amount v be (from its equilibrium or bias value VBE ), which is related to ie by the incremental resistance of diode DE . The latter is equal to VT /IE , which is re . The incremental change ie in iE gives rise to an incremental change αie in the current of the controlled source. The incremental quantities can be related by the equivalent circuit model shown in Fig. 2, v c = −ie × 10 k where ie = − vi vi =− re 0.125 k Thus, vc 10 k = vi 0.125 k = 80 V/V Chapter 6–16 This figure belongs to Problem 6.45. 6.45 C vπ = rπ Rin ≡ ib rπ vπ = v sig rπ + Rsig aie v o = −gm v π RC vo = −gm RC vπ v x B ie re The overall voltage gain can be obtained as follows: vo vo vπ = v sig v π v sig E v r x ix rπ = −gm RC rπ + Rsig = −gm rπ =− RC rπ + Rsig βRC rπ + Rsig ix Since v x appears across re and ix = ie = small-signal resistance r is given by Q.E.D. r≡ vx , the re vx vx = = re ix ie 6.46 v ce = | Av |v be | Av | = gm RC = 50 × 2 = 100 V/V For v ce being 1 V peak to peak, 1V = 0.01 V peak to peak 100 v be = ib = 6.48 Refer to Fig. P6.48. Replacing the BJT with the T model of Fig. 6.26(b) results in the following amplifier equivalent circuit: v be rπ C aie where β 100 = 2 k = gm 50 rπ = B ie Thus, ib = ib vi 0.01 V = 0.005 mA peak to peak 2 k re E Re vo Rin 6.47 Replacing the BJT with the T model of Fig. 6.26(b), we obtain the circuit shown in next column above. Rin ≡ vi vi = ib (1 − α)ie Chapter 6–17 6.50 Refer to Fig. P6.50. The transistor is biased at IE = 0.33 mA. Thus From the circuit we see that vi ie = re + Re Thus, re + Re Rin = 1−α But 1 1−α = β +1 Thus, Rin = (β + 1)(re + Re ) re = VT 25 mV = 75 = IE 0.33 mA Replacing the BJT with its T model results in the following amplifier equivalent circuit. Q.E.D. From the equivalent circuit, we see that v o and v i are related by the ratio of the voltage divider formed by re and Re : Re vo = Q.E.D. vi Re + re 6.49 Refer to Fig. P6.49. 200 β = = 0.995 α= β +1 201 IC = α × IE = 0.995 × 10 = 9.95 mA VC = IC RC = 9.95 × 0.1 k = 0.995 V 1V Replacing the BJT with its hybrid-π model results in the circuit shown below. IC 10 mA = 400 mA/V gm = VT 0.025 V β 200 rπ = = 0.5 k = gm 400 Rib = rπ = 0.5 k The input resistance Rin can be found by inspection to be Rin = re = 75 To determine the voltage gain (v o /v i ) we first find ie : Rin = 10 k 0.5 k = 0.476 k vπ Rin 0.476 = = = 0.322 V/V v sig Rin + Rsig 0.476 + 1 vo = −gm RC = −400 × 0.1 = −40 V/V vπ vo = −40 × 0.322 = −12.9 V/V v sig ie = − vi vi vi =− =− Rsig + re 150 0.15 k The output voltage v o is given by v o = −α ie (RC RL ) = −0.99 ie × (12 12) = −0.99 × 6ie For = −0.99 × 6 × v o = ±0.4 V/V ±0.4 = ∓0.01 V = ∓10 mV vb = vπ = −40 ±0.4 v sig = = ∓31 mV −12.9 Thus, vo = 39.6 V/V vi This figure belongs to Problem 6.49. Rsig 1 k vb vo vsig vp Rin 10 k Rib rp gmvp RC −v i 0.15 Chapter 6–18 This figure belongs to Problem 6.51. B vsig vp gmvp rp ro C vo RL very high 6.51 The largest possible voltage gain is obtained when RL → ∞, in which case IC VA vo = −gm ro = − v sig VT IC To obtain maximum gain and the largest possible signal swing at the output for v eb of 10 mV, we select a value for RC that results in VA =− VT which is the highest allowable voltage at the collector while the transistor remains in the active region. Since For VA = 25 V, vo 25 =− v sig 0.025 VC + | Av | × 0.01 V = +0.4 V VC = −5 + IC RC −5 + 0.5RC = −1000 V/V then vo 125 For VA = 125 V, =− v sig 0.025 −5 + 0.5RC + gm RC × 0.01 = 0.4 Substituting gm = 20 mA/V results in = −5000 V/V RC = 7.7 k The overall voltage gain achieved is vo Rin = × gm RC v sig Rin + Rsig 6.52 5 V RE Rsig 50 vsig 50 × 20 × 7.7 50 + 50 = 77 V/V = 6.53 Refer to Fig. P6.53 on next page. Since β is very large, the dc base current can be neglected. Thus the dc voltage at the base is determined by the voltage divider, Rin re 50 vo RC 100 = 2.5 V 100 + 100 and the dc voltage at the emitter will be VB = 5 VE = VB − 0.7 = 1.8 V 5 V VT IE ⇒ IE = 0.5 mA re = 50 = Thus, 5 − VE = 0.5 mA RE where VE 0.7 V ⇒ RE = 8.6 k The dc emitter current can now be found as VE 1.8 IE = = 0.5 mA = RE 3.6 and IC IE = 0.5 mA Replacing the BJT with the T model of Fig. 6.26(b) results in the equivalent circuit model for the amplifier shown on next page. vi ie = RE + re RE v o1 = ie RE = v i RE + re Chapter 6–19 This figure belongs to Problem 6.53. vo2 aie RC ie re vi RE v o1 = vi RE + re 100 k 100 k vi RC RE + re v o2 αRC =− vi RE + re For α 1, RE v o Rsig + Rin io = ii v sig RL Q.E.D. v o2 = −αie RC = −α re = vo1 = Gv Q.E.D. Rsig + Rin RL = 79.4 × VT 25 mV = = 50 IE 0.5 mA 6.55 (a) v o1 3.6 = 0.986 V/V = vi 3.6 + 0.05 20 + 100 = 4762 A/A 2 Rin = 0.95 Rin + Rsig Rin = 0.95 Rin + 100 v o2 3.3 = 0.904 V/V =− vi 3.6 + 0.05 ⇒ Rin = 1.9 M (b) With RL = 2 k, If v o1 is connected to ground, RE will in effect be short-circuited at signal frequencies, and v o2 /v i will become v o2 αRC 3.3 = −66 V/V =− =− vi re 0.05 v o = Av o v i 2 2 + Ro With RL = 1 k, v o = Av o v i 1 1 + Ro Thus the change in v o is 6.54 See figures below and on next page. Rin RL Av o Gv = Rin + Rsig RL + Ro v o = Av o v i 1 2 − 2 + Ro 1 + Ro To limit this change to 5% of the value with RL = 2 k, we require 2 1 2 − = 0.05 2 + Ro 1 + Ro 2 + Ro 2 100 × 100 × 100 + 20 2 + 0.1 = 79.4 V/V vo io = RL v sig ii = Rsig + Rin = ⇒ Ro = 1 k = 111 9 This figure belongs to Problem 6.54. Rsig 20 k Ro 100 vsig vi Rin 100 k Av ovi RL vo 2 k Av o 100 Chapter 6–20 This figure belongs to Problem 6.55. Rsig Ro vsig Rin vi Av ovi RL (c) Gv = 10 = = vo Rin RL Av o Rin + Rsig RL + Ro To determine Gm (at least conceptually), we short-circuit the output of the equivalent circuit in Fig. 1(b). The short-circuit current will be 1.9 2 × Av o × 1.9 + 0.1 2 + 0.111 io = Gm v i ⇒ Av o = 11.1 V/V Thus Gm is defined as io Gm = v i RL = 0 The values found about are limit values; that is, we require Rin ≥ 1.9 M and is known as the short-circuit transconductance. From Fig. 2 below, Ro ≤ 111 Av o ≥ 11.1 V/V Rin vi = v sig Rin + Rsig v o = Gm v i (Ro RL ) 6.56 The circuit in Fig. 1(b) (see figure below) is that in Fig. P6.56, with the output current source expressed as Gm v i . Thus, for equivalence, we write Av o Gm = Ro Thus, Rin vo = Gm (Ro RL ) v sig Rin + Rsig These figures belong to Problem 6.56. Ro io Rin vi Avovi io Norton vo equivalent of output circuit vi Avovi Ro Gmvi Rin (a) (b) Figure 1 Rsig vsig vi Figure 2 Rin Gmvi Ro RL vo Ro vo Chapter 6–21 6.58 Refer to Fig. P6.58. To determine Rin , we simplify the circuit as shown in Fig. 1, where vi vi Rin ≡ = R1 Rin , where Rin ≡ ii if 6.57 v o Gv o = v sig RL = ∞ Now, setting RL = ∞ in the equivalent circuit in Fig. 1(b), we can determine Gv o from Rin Av o Gv o = Rin + Rsig RL =∞ Thus, Denoting Rin with RL = ∞ as Ri , we can express Gv o as Rin ≡ Gv o = Ri Av o Ri + Rsig v i = if Rf + (if − gm v i )(R2 RL ) v i [1 + gm (R2 RL )] = if [Rf + (R2 RL )] and Q.E.D. Rin = R1 Rin From the equivalent circuit in Fig. 1(a), the overall voltage Gv can be obtained as Gv = Gv o RL RL + Rout Rf + (R2 RL ) vi = if 1 + gm (R2 RL ) Rf + (R2 RL ) 1 + gm (R2 RL ) = R1 Q.E.D. Q.E.D. This figure belongs to Problem 6.57. Rsig Rout vsig vi Rin Gv ovsig RL vo (a) Rsig Ro vsig vi Rin This figure belongs to Problem 6.58. Figure 1 RL vo (b) Figure 1 Av ovi Chapter 6–22 To determine Av o , we open-circuit RL and use the circuit in Fig. 2, where Rf if vi gmvi R1 vo R2 R2 vo With Rf , 1 49.8 × −10 × 49.8 + 100 1 + 0.1 = −3 V/V Gv = Without Rf , 1 100 × −10 × = −4.5 V/V Gv = 100 + 100 1 + 0.1 6.59 Rsig = 1 M, RL = 10 k gm = 2 mA/V, RD = 10 k Gv = −gm (RD RL ) Figure 2 vo if = gm v i + R2 = −2(10 10) = −10 V/V 6.60 RD = 2RL = 30 k vo v i = if Rf + v o = gm v i + Rf + vo R2 Rf v i (1 − gm Rf ) = v o 1 + R2 −10 = −gm (30 15) Thus, ⇒ gm = 1 mA/V 1 − gm Rf vo = Rf vi 1+ R2 which can be manipulated to the form 2ID VOV 2 × ID 1= 0.25 ⇒ ID = 0.125 mA = 125 μA Av o ≡ Av o = −gm R2 1 − 1/gm Rf 1 + (R2 /Rf ) Q.E.D. Finally, to obtain Ro we short-circuit v i in the circuit of Fig. P6.58. This will disable the controlled source gm v i . Thus, looking between the output terminals (behind RL ), we see R2 in parallel with Rf , Ro = R2 Rf Q.E.D. For R1 = 100 k, Rf = 1 M, gm = 100 mA/V R2 = 100 and RL = 1 k 1000 + (0.1 1) = 100 99.1 Rin = 100 1 + 100(0.1 1) = 49.8 k Without Rf present (i.e., Rf = ∞), Rin = 100 k and 1 − (1/100 × 1000) Av o = −100 × 0.1 0.1 1+ 1000 −10 V/V Without Rf , −Av o = 10 V/V and Ro = 0.1 1000 0.1 k = 100 Without Rf , Ro = 100 . Thus the only parameter that is significantly affected by the presence of Rf is Rin , which is reduced by a factor of 2! Rin RL Gv = Av o Rin + Rsig RL + Ro VOV = 0.25 V Gv = −gm (RD RL ) gm = If RD is reduced to 15 k, Gv = −gm (RD RL ) = −1 × (15 15) = −7.5 V/V 6.61 Rin = ∞ 1 W 2 ID = μn Cox VOV 2 L 1 2 320 = × 400 × 10 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.4 V 2ID 2 × 0.32 gm = = = 1.6 mA/V VOV 0.4 Av o = −gm RD = −1.6 × 10 = −16 V/V Ro = RD = 10 k RL Gv = Av o RL + Ro 10 = −8 V/V = −16 × 10 + 10 0.2 V Peak value of v sig = = 25 mV. 8 6.62 (a) See figure on next page. 2ID 2 × 0.3 = 3 mA/V = (b) gm1 = gm2 = VOV 0.2 RD1 = RD2 = 10 k RL = 10 k Chapter 6–23 This figure belongs to Problem 6.62. Rsig 200 k vsig vgs1 gm1vgs1 Gv = gm2vgs2 RD2 R L vo v gs2 vo × v gs1 v gs2 (b) β = 50, | Gv | = = −gm1 RD1 × −gm2 (RD2 RL ) 10 (10/50) + 0.025 = 44.4 V/V = 3 × 10 × 3 × (10 10) β = 150, | Gv | = = 450 V/V 10 (10/150) + 0.025 = 109.1 V/V IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V = 6.63 gm = VT 0.025 V β 100 rπ = = 5 k = gm 20 mA/V Rin = rπ = 5 k Ro = RC = 10 k Av o = −gm RC = −20 × 10 = −200 V/V RL 10 = −200 × RL + Ro 10 + 10 = −100 V/V Rin Gv = Av Rin + Rsig Av = Av o 5 × −100 5 + 10 = −33.3 V/V = For v̂ π = 5 mV, v̂ sig can be found from v̂ π = v̂ sig × RD1 vgs2 Rin 5 = v̂ sig × Rin + Rsig 5 + 10 ⇒ v̂ sig = 15 mV Correspondingly, v̂ o will be v̂ o = Gvv̂ sig = 15 × 33.3 = 500 mV = 0.5 V 6.64 | Gv | = RL (Rsig /β) + (1/gm ) RL = 10 k, Rsig = 10 k, gm = IC VT 1 = 40 mA/V 0.025 Nominal β = 100 = 10 (a) Nominal | Gv | = (10/100) + 0.025 = 80 V/V Thus, | Gv | ranges from 44.4 V/V to 109.1 V/V. (c) For | Gv | to be within ±20% of nominal (i.e., ranging between 64 V/V and 96 V/V), the corresponding allowable range of β can be found as follows: 10 64 = (10/βmin ) + 0.025 ⇒ βmin = 76.2 10 96 = (10/βmax ) + 0.025 ⇒ βmax = 126.3 (d) By varying IC , we vary the term 1/gm in the denominator of the | Gv | expression. If β varies in the range 50 to 150 and we wish to keep | Gv | within ±20% of a new nominal value of | Gv | given by 10 Gv = nominal (10/100) + (1/gm ) then 10 0.8 Gv nominal = (10/50) + (1/gm ) That is, 10 8 = 0.1 + (1/gm ) 0.2 + (1/gm ) 1 = 0.3 or gm = 3.33 mA/V ⇒ gm 10 Gv = = 25 V/V nominal 0.1 + 0.3 10 Gv = min 0.2 + 0.3 = 20 V/V (−20% of nominal) We need to check the value obtained for β = 150, 10 Gv = = 27.3 V/V max 10/150 + 0.3 Chapter 6–24 which is less than the allowable value of 1.2 Gv nominal = 30 V/V. Thus, the new bias current is 16 = 20 20 = 1 + gm Rs 1 + 2Rs ⇒ Rs = 125 IC = gm × VT = 3.33 × 0.025 = 0.083 mA Gv = 25 V/V 6.68 gm = 6.65 (a) See figure below. re nominal (b) RC1 = RC2 = 10 k Rsig = 10 k IC 0.25 mA = 10 mA/V = VT 0.025 V rπ 1 = rπ 2 = β 100 = 10 k = gm 10 1 = 50 gm Rin = (β + 1)(re + Re ) = 101(50 + 250) = 30.3 k αRC 0.99 × 12 Av o = − =− re + Re 0.3 Ro = RC = 12 k RL Av = Av o RL + Ro 12 = −20 V/V = −40 × 12 + 12 Rin Gv = × Av Rin + Rsig RL = 10 k gm1 = gm2 = IC 0.5 = 20 mA/V = VT 0.025 rπ 1 10 vπ1 = = = 0.5 V/V v sig rπ 1 + Rsig 10 + 10 vπ2 = −gm1 (RC1 rπ 2 ) = −10(10 10) vπ1 = −50 V/V vo = −gm2 (RC2 RL ) vπ2 30.3 × −20 = −15 V/V 30.3 + 10 Rin + Rsig v̂ π = 5 mV ⇒ v̂ sig = v̂ π Rin = = −10(10 10) = −50 V/V vo vπ2 vπ1 vo = × × v sig vπ2 vπ1 v sig 30.3 + 10 = 6.65 mV 30.3 v̂ o = v̂ sig × | Gv | v̂ sig = 5 × = −50 × −50 × 0.5 = 1250 V/V = 6.65 × 15 6.66 gm effective = −40 V/V gm 1 + gm Rs 100 mV 6.69 Rin = (β + 1)(re + Re ) 5 2= 1 + 5Rs ⇒ Rs = 0.3 k = 300 15 = 75(re + Re ) 15 k re + Re = = 200 75 Rin re v̂ π = v̂ sig Rin + Rsig re + Re re 15 5 = 150 × 15 + 30 re + Re re = 0.1 ⇒ re + Re But re + Re = 200 , thus 6.67 Including Rs reduced the gain by a factor of 2, thus 1 + gm Rs = 2 1 1 = 2 mA/V = ⇒ gm = Rs 0.5 The gain without Rs is −20 V/V. To obtain a gain of −16 V/V, we write re = 20 This figure belongs to Problem 6.65. Rsig 10 k vsig vp1 rp1 vp2 gm1vp1 rp2 vo gm2vp2 RC1 RC2 RL Chapter 6–25 which requires a bias current IE of VT 25 mV = = 1.25 mA IE = re 20 IC IE = 1.25 mA Re = 180 Rin Gv = Rin + Rsig −α × Total resistance in collector × Total resistance in emitter −0.99 × 6 15 × = 15 + 30 0.2 −10 V/V v̂ 0 = 0.15 × | Gv | = 1.5 V 6.70 Using Eq. (6.113), we have RC RL Gv = −β Rsig + (β + 1)(re + Re ) RC RL − (Rsig /β) + (re + Re ) 10 | Gv | = (10/β) + 0.025 + Re Without Re , 10 | Gv | = (10/β) + 0.025 For the nominal case, β = 100, 10 Gv = = 80 V/V nominal 0.1 + 0.025 For β = 50, 10 Gv = = 44.4 V/V low 0.2 + 0.025 For β = 150, 10 Gv = 109.1 V/V = high (1/15) + 0.025 Thus, | Gv | ranges from 44.4 V/V to 109.1 V/V with a nominal value of 80 V/V. This is a range of −44.5% to +36.4% of nominal. To limit the range of | Gv | to ±20% of a new nominal value, we connect a resistance Re and find its value as follows. With Re , 10 Gv = nominal (10/100) + 0.025 + Re 10 = 0.125 + Re Now, β = 50, 10 Gv = low 0.225 + Re To limit this value to −20% of Gv nominal , we use 10 10 = 0.8 × 0.225 + Re 0.125 + Re ⇒ Re = 0.275 k = 275 With this value of Re , 10 Gv = = 25 V/V nominal 0.125 + 0.275 Gv 10 0.225 + 0.275 = 20 V/V (−20% of nominal) 10 Gv = high (1/15) + 0.025 + 0.275 = 27.3 V/V (+9.1% of nominal) low = 6.71 Rin = 1 1 = 0.5 k = gm 2 mA/V Rin × gm (RD RL ) Rin + Rsig 0.5 × 2(5 5) = 0.5 + 0.75 = 2 V/V Gv = For Rin = Rsig = 0.75 k 1 = 0.75 ⇒ gm = 1.33 mA/V gm Since gm = 2k n ID , then to change gm by a factor 1.33 = 0.67, ID must be changed by a factor of 2 (0.67)2 = 0.45. 6.72 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P6.72. Since Rsig re , most of isig flows into the emitter of the BJT. Thus ie isig and ic = αie isig Thus, v o = ic RC = isig RC 6.73 For Rin = Rsig = 50 , re = 50 and, with α 1, VT 25 mV = = 0.5 mA IC re 50 gm = IC /VT = 20 mA/V Rin gm (RC RL ) Gv = Rin + Rsig 50 × 20 × (10 10) 50 + 50 = 50 V/V Gv = VT 25 mV = = 125 IE 0.2 mA 0.2 mA = 8 mA/V 0.025 V 6.74 Rin = re = gm = IC VT Rin gm (RC RL ) Rin + Rsig 0.125 × 8(10 10) = 8 V/V = 0.125 + 0.5 Gv = Chapter 6–26 v̂ π = v̂ sig Rin Rin + Rsig 10 = v̂ sig 0.125 0.125 + 0.5 Av nominal = Av high = 0.93 ⇒ v̂ sig = 50 mV v̂ o = Gv v̂ sig = 8 × 50 = 400 mV = 0.4 V 6.75 Rsig 1 gm RL (+10% above nominal) 1.5 Av low = 1.5 + 0.357 = 0.81 (−5% from nominal) 1 = Ro = 0.357 k gm ⇒ gm = 2.8 mA/V To find ID , we use gm = 2k n ID i i vsig 2 = 0.85 V/V 2.357 5 = 5.357 50 mV (peak) 0.5 V (peak) From the figure above, we have 1 = 0.1 × RL gm = 0.1 × 2 = 0.2 k ⇒ ID = gm2 /2k n 2.82 = 1.6 mA 2 × 2.5 1 2 ID = k n VOV 2 1 2 1.6 = × 2.5 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 1.13 V = 6.77 Rsig/(b + 1) gm = 5 mA/V gm = 2k n ID 5 = 2 × 5 × ID ID = 2.5 mA vsig At the peak of the sine wave, 0.5 V = 0.25 mA, thus id = 2 k iDmax = ID + 0.25 = 2.75 mA re RL vbe vo iDmin = ID − 0.25 = 2.25 mA v̂ sig = v̂ gs + v̂ o = 0.05 + 0.5 = 0.55 V v̂ o = 0.5 V RL = 2 k RL RL + Ro 2 Av nominal = 2 + Ro 1.5 Av low = 1.5 + Ro 5 Av high = 5 + Ro For Av high = 1.1 Av nominal 6.76 Av = 5 1.1 × 2 = 5 + Ro 2 + Ro ⇒ Ro = 0.357 k v̂ be = 5 mV From the figure above we see that re 5 mV = RL 500 mV RL = 20 100 VT 25 mV IE = = = 1.25 mA re 20 ⇒ re = At the peak of the output sine wave, we have îe = v̂ o 0.5 = 0.25 mA = RL 2 Chapter 6–27 v̂ be = 10 mV RL × v̂ be v̂ o = re 500 = × 10 12.5 = 400 mV = 0.4 V v̂ o 0.4 = = 0.488 V v̂ sig = Gv 0.82 Thus, iEmax = 1.25 + 0.25 = 1.5 mA and iEmin = 1.25 − 0.25 = 1.0 mA From the figure, we have Gv = = vo = v sig RL RL + re + 2 2 + 0.02 + 200 101 Rsig β +1 (c) Gv o = 1 Rout = re + = 0.5 V/V = 111.5 Thus, v̂ sig Thus, v̂ o 0.5 V = = =1V Gv 0.5 V/V RL RL + Rout 500 =1× = 0.82 V/V 500 + 111.5 which is the same value obtained in (a) above. Gv = Gv o 6.78 IC = 2 mA re = Rsig 10,000 = 12.5 + β +1 101 VT IE VT 25 = = 12.5 IC 2 For RL = 250 , RL Gv = Gv o RL + Rout 250 =1× = 0.69 V/V 250 + 111.5 (a) Rin = (β + 1) (re + RL ) = 101 × (12.5 + 500) = 51.76 k Rin 51.76 vb = = v sig Rin + Rsig 51.76 + 10 6.79 Rout = re + = 0.84 V/V 5000 β +1 10,000 250 = re + β +1 150 = re + vb vo vo = × v sig v sig vb = 0.84 × Rsig β +1 RL RL + re Subtracting Eq. (1) from Eq. (2), we have 5000 β +1 β + 1 = 50 0.5 = 0.84 × 0.5 + 0.0125 100 = = 0.82 V/V Substituting in Eq. (1) yields (b) 5000 50 ⇒ re = 50 RL Gv = Rsig RL + re + β +1 1000 = 0.8 V/V = 10, 000 1000 + 50 + 50 150 = re + Rsig ai B i re vsig RL Rin vbe vo 6.80 (a) Refer to Fig. P6.80. vc −ic RC = v sig ib RB + ie (re + RE ) =− ic ib RC ie RB + (re + RE ) ib (1) (2) Chapter 6–28 = −β RC RB + (β + 1)(re + RE ) =− ve −ie RE = v sig ib RB + ie (re + RE ) = RC RL ro Rsig 1 + β gm Thus, 10 ro 1 0.1 + gm | Gv | = RE RB + re + RE β +1 where ro and (b) vc ic RC ie vsig ie = − 1 are in kilohms and are given by gm VA 25 V = IC IC mA (2) 1 VT 0.025 V = = gm IC IC mA (3) I C (mA) 1/g m (k) r o (k) | Gv | (V/V) RE Y v sig re + RE ic = −ic RC = −αie RC −ic RC vc RC = =α v sig ie (re + RE ) re + RE 6.81 With the Early effect neglected, we can write Gv = −100 V/V With the Early effect taken into account, the effective resistance in the collector is reduced from RC = 10 k to (RC ro ), where ro = ro = (1) VA 100 V = = 100 k IC 1 mA (RC ro ) = 10 100 = 9.1 k 0.1 0.250 250 27.5 0.2 0.125 125 41.2 0.5 0.050 50 55.6 1.0 0.025 25 57.1 1.25 0.020 20 55.6 Observe that initially | Gv | increases as IC is increased. However, above about 1 mA this trend reverses because of the effect of ro . From the table we see that gain of 50 is obtained for IC between 0.2 and 0.5 mA and also for IC above 1.25 mA. Practically speaking, one normally uses the low value to minimize power dissipation. The required value of IC is found by substituting for ro and 1/gm from Eqs. (2) and (3), respectively, in Eq. (1) and equating Gv to 50. The result (after some manipulations) is the quadratic equation. IC2 − 2.25IC + 0.625 = 0 The two roots of this equation are IC = 0.325 mA and 1.925 mA; our preferred choice is IC = 0.325 mA. 6.83 Thus, Gv becomes Gv = −100 × 9.1 k 10 k i = −91 V/V 0 6.82 Adapting Eq. (6.114) gives RC RL ro Gv = −β Rsig + (β + 1)re RC RL ro =− Rsig β +1 + re β β Rsig G vsig ro vg i 1 gm RL vo Chapter 6–29 v g = v sig RS = Noting that ro appears in effect in parallel with RL , v o is obtained as the ratio of the voltage divider formed by (1/gm ) and (RL ro ), Gv = vo vo = = v sig vg (RL ro ) (RL ro ) + 1 gm Also, With RL removed, ro = 0.98 Gv = 1 ro + gm (1) With RL = 500 , (500 ro ) Gv = = 0.49 1 (500 ro ) + gm (2) ro 1 = gm 49 VDD =3V 3 3 ⇒ RD = = 3 k 1 VG = VS + VGS ID RD = Q.E.D. From Eq. (1), we have 3 = 3 k 1 =3+2=5V Thus the voltage drop across RG2 (5 V) is larger than that across RG1 (4 V). So we select RG2 = 22 M and determine RG1 from 4V RG1 = RG2 5V ⇒ RG1 = 0.8RG2 = 0.8 × 22 = 17.6 M Substituting in Eq. (2) and solving for ro gives ro = 25,000 = 25 k RG1 = 18 M Thus 1 25,000 = gm 49 ⇒ gm = 1.96 mA/V 6.84 VDD 9 V RG1 Using only two significant figures, we have ID RD VD VG VS Note that this will cause VG to deviate slightly from the required value of 5 V. Specifically, RG2 VG = VDD RG2 + RG1 22 =9× = 4.95 V 22 + 18 It can be shown (after simple but somewhat tedious analysis) that the resulting ID will be ID = 0.986 mA, which is sufficiently close to the desired 1 mA. Since VD = VDD − ID RD +6 V and VG 5 V, and the drain voltage can go down to VG − Vt = 4 V, the drain voltage is 2 V above the value that causes the MOSFET to leave the saturation region. RS RG2 6.85 5 V ID = 1 mA 1 2 k n VOV 2 1 2 1 = × 2 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 1 V RD ID = VG 0 VGS = Vt + VOV = 1 + 1 = 2 V Now, selecting VS = ID RS = 3 VDD =3V 3 0 ID RG RS 10 M 5 V Chapter 6–30 For ID = 0.5 mA 1 2 0.5 = k n VOV 2 1 2 = × 1 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 1 V 6.87 5 V VGS = Vt + VOV = 1 + 1 = 2 V ID RD VD Since VG = 0 V, VS = −VGS = −2 V RG which leads to VS − (−5) −2 + 5 RS = = 6 k = IC 0.5 VD is required to be halfway between cutoff (+5 V) and saturation (0 − Vt = −1 V). Thus VS ID RS VD = +2 V 5 V and 5−2 RD = = 6 k 0.5 ID = 0.5 mA = 6.86 ⇒ VGS = 1.5 V VDD RG1 RD ID VG 5 V ID RG2 1 × 4(VGS − 1)2 2 RS 3 k Since VG = 0 V, VS = −1.5 V, and −1.5 − (−5) RS = = 7 k 0.5 Maximum gain is obtained by using the largest possible value of RD , that is, the lowest possible value of VD that is consistent with allowing negative voltage signal swing at the drain of 1 V. Thus VD − 1 = v Dmin = VG − Vt = 0 − 1 ⇒ VD = 0 V VS = ID RS = 3ID VGS = 5 − VS = 5 − 3ID 1 ID = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 1 = × 2(5 − 3ID − 1)2 2 = 16 − 24ID + 9ID2 9ID2 − 25I + 16 = 0 where we have assumed that the signal voltage at the gate is small. Now, VD = 0 = VDD − ID RD 0 = 5 − 0.5 × RD ⇒ RD = 10 k 6.88 ID = 1.78 mA or 1 mA VDD The first answer is physically meaningless, as it would result in VS = 5.33 V, which is greater than VG , implying that the transistor is cut off. Thus, ID = 1 mA. If a transistor for which k n = 3 mA/V2 is used, then 1 ID = × 3(5 − 3ID − 1)2 2 = 1.5(16 − 24I + 9ID2 ) 9ID2 − 24.67ID + 16 = 0 whose physically meaningful solution is ID = 1.05 mA RD ID VG 5 V VS 2 V ID RS 2 k Chapter 6–31 ID = 2V = 1 mA 2 k RD = 3 k 1 ID = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 1 1 = × 2(VG − VS − Vt )2 2 1 = (5 − 2 − Vt )2 ID = 1 k p (VSG − |Vt |)2 2 1= 1 × 0.5(VSG − 1)2 2 Vt = 2 V VS = VG + 3 = 3 + 3 = 6 V But ⇒ VSG = 3 V If Vt = 1.5 V, then we have RS = VS = ID RS = 2ID VGS = VG − VS = 5 − 2ID 1 ID = × 2(5 − 2ID − 1.5)2 2 = VG = 4 − |Vt | = 2 V ID = 1.2 mA VS = 2.4 V 6.89 VDD 10 V R2 = VG 2V = 0.2 M = IG 10 μA R1 = VDD − VG 8V = 0.8 M = IG 10 μA VD = 3 V IG RD = 3 k RS ID VS VG R2 10 − 6 = 4 k 1 (b) |Vt | = 2 V and k p = 1.25 mA/V2 4ID2 − 15ID + 12.25 = 0 R1 VDD − VS ID VD 3 V ID 1 mA RD ID = 1 k p (VSG − |Vt |)2 2 1= 1 × 1.25(VSG − 2)2 2 VSG = 3.265 V VS = VG + 3.265 = 2 + 3.265 = 5.265 V ID = 1 mA and VD = 3 V RS = 10 − 5.265 = 4.7 k 1 Thus, VD 3V = = 3 k ID 1 mA For the transistor to operate 1 V from the edge of saturation RD = 6.90 VDD VD = VG + |Vt | − 1 Thus, RD ID 3 = VG + |Vt | − 1 VG + |Vt | = 4 V (a) |Vt | = 1 V and k p = 0.5 mA/V2 VG = 3 V VG 3V R2 = = 0.3 M = IG 10 μA VDD − VG 7V R1 = = 0.7 M = IG 10 μA VD = 3 V 0V RG VGS VSS ID RS Chapter 6–32 (a) VGS + ID RS = VSS But ID = SVIDt ≡ 1 W kn (VGS − Vt )2 2 L k n (VGS − Vt )Vt 1 k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 2Vt 2Vt =− =− VGS − Vt VOV =− = K(VGS − Vt )2 ID K ⇒ VGS = Vt + Vt = ±5%, and Vt VOV = 0.25 V, we have ID Vt = SVIDt ID Vt ID + ID RS = VSS K Differentiating relative to K, we have Vt + ID 1 ∂ID − 2 K ∂K K ∂ID K 1 = √ ∂K ID 1 + 2 KID RS SKID = 1/[1 + 2 KID RS ] + RS ∂ID =0 ∂K Q.E.D K = ±0.1, and (b) K = 100 μA/V2 , K Vt = 1 V. We require ID = 100 μA and ID = ±0.01. Thus, ID 0.01 ID /ID SKID = = = 0.1 K/K 0.10 Substituting in the expression derived in (a), 0.1 = √ 1 1 + 2 0.1 × 0.1RS ⇒ RS = 45 k To find VGS , ID = K(VGS − Vt )2 100 = 100(VGS − 1)2 VGS = 2 V VGS + ID RS = VSS 2 + 0.1 × 45 = 6.5 V (c) For VSS = 5 V and VGS = 2 V, ID RS = 3 V 3 = 30 k RS = 0.1 1 1 = SKID = √ 7 1 + 2 0.1 × 0.1 × 30 1 K 1 ID = × = × ±10% = ±1.4% ID 7 K 7 6.91 (a) With a fixed VGS , ID = 1 k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 ∂ID = −k n (VGS − Vt ) ∂Vt Q.E.D For Vt = 0.5 V, Thus, 1 0+ √ 2 ID /K ∂ID Vt k n (VGS − Vt )Vt =− ∂Vt ID ID 2 × 0.5 × ±5% 0.25 = ∓20% =− (b) For fixed bias at the gate VG and a resistance RS in the source lead, we have VG = VGS + ID RS where VGS is obtained from 1 ID = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 2ID ⇒ VGS = Vt + kn Thus Vt + 2ID + ID RS = VG kn Differentiating relative to Vt , we have 1 2 ∂ID ∂ID 1+ √ + RS =0 ∂Vt 2 2ID /k n k n ∂Vt ∂ID ∂Vt 1 + RS = −1 √ 2k n ID 1 ∂ID =− 1 ∂Vt + RS √ 2k n ID ∂ID Vt Vt SVIDt = =− ∂Vt ID ID + ID RS 2k n But 1 2ID 2 ID = k n VOV ⇒ VOV = 2 kn Thus 2Vt Q.E.D VOV + 2ID RS Vt For Vt = 0.5 V, = ±5%, and Vt ID VOV = 0.25 V, to limit to +5% we ID require SVIDt = − SVIDt = 1 Chapter 6–33 1 × 0.5(10 − 10 ID − 1)2 2 ⇒ ID2 − 1.84ID + 0.81 = 0 Thus ID = 2 × 0.5 0.25 + 2ID RS ⇒ ID RS = 0.375 V −1 = − ID = 1.11 mA or 0.73 mA For ID = 0.1 mA, 0.375 RS = = 3.75 k 0.1 The first root results in VD = −0.11 V, which is physically meaningless. Thus 6.92 (b) Vt = 2 V and k n = 1.25 mA/V2 ID = 0.73 mA VG = VD = 10 − 10 × 0.73 = 2.7 V 1 × 1.25(10 − 10ID − 2)2 2 ⇒ ID2 − 1.616ID + 0.64 = 0 ID = 5V ID = 0.92 mA or 0.695 mA RD ID 0 RG VD VG VGS The first root can be shown to be physically meaningless, thus ID = 0.695 mA VG = VD = 10 − 10 × 0.695 = 3.05 V 6.94 VDD 5 V 1 × 10(VGS − Vt )2 2 ⇒ VGS = 1.2 V 5 − 1.2 = 19 k RD = 0.2 ID = 0.2 = ~ – 1 mA RD RG1 6.93 VD IG 1 mA VDD 10 V RG2 RG 10 M VGS 0 RD 10 k ID ID VDS 1 2 k n VOV 2 1 2 1 = × 8VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.5 V ID = Since the transistor leaves the saturation region of operation when v D < VOV , we select VD = VOV + 2 VGS = VDD − ID RD = 10 − 10ID (a) Vt = 1 V and k n = 0.5 mA/V2 1 ID = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 VD = 2.5 V Since IG ID , we can write VDD − VD 5 − 2.5 = 2.5 k = RD = ID 1 VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.8 + 0.5 = 1.3 V Chapter 6–34 Thus the voltage drop across RG2 is 1.3 V and that across RG1 is (2.5 − 1.3) = 1.2 V. Thus RG2 is the larger of the two resistances, and we select RG2 = 22 M and find RG1 from RG1 1.2 ⇒ RG1 = 20.3 M = RG2 1.3 Specifying all resistors to two significant digits, we have RD = 2.5 k, RG1 = 22 M, and RG1 = 20 M. 6.95 RB1 × 3 = 0.710 RB1 + RB2 RB2 = 3.225 RB1 Given that RB1 and RB2 are 1% resistors, the maximum and minimum values of the ratio RB2 /RB1 will be 3.225 × 1.02 = 3.2895 and 3.225 × 0.98 = 3.1605. The resulting VBE will be 0.699 V and 0.721 V, respectively. Correspondingly, IC will be ⇒ To obtain IC = 1 mA, we write 1 mA IC IB = = = 0.01 mA β 100 Thus, RB = VCC − VBE IB 3 − 0.7 = 230 k 0.01 Since β ranges from 50 to 150 and IB is fixed at 0.01 mA, the collector current IC will range from 0.01 × 50 = 0.5 mA to 0.01 × 150 = 1.5 mA. Correspondingly, VCE will range from (3 − 0.5 × 2) = 1 V to (3 − 1.5 × 2) = 0 V. The latter value implies that the high-β transistor will leave the active region of operation and saturate. Obviously, this bias method is very intolerant of the inevitable variations in β. Thus it is not a good method for biasing the BJT. 6.97 VCC 9 V ICmax = 1 × e(0.710−0.699)/0.025 = 1.55 mA 0.06 mA and ICmin = 1 × e R1 (0.710−0.721)/0.025 0.6 mA RC 3V VCE 3 V ICmin = 0.64 mA VCE will range from VCEmin = 3 − 1.55 × 2 = −0.1 V which is impossible, implying that the transistor will saturate at this value of dc bias! R2 RE 3V VCEmax = 3 − 0.64 × 2 = 1.72 V It should be clear that this biasing arrangement is useless, since even the small and inevitable tolerances in RB1 and RB2 caused such huge variations in IC that in one extreme the transistor left the active mode of operation altogether! Initial design: β = ∞ RC = RE = 3V = 5 k 0.6 6.96 R1 + R2 = 9 = 150 k 0.06 VB = VE + VBE = 3 + 0.7 = 3.7 V VCC 3 V R2 = RC 2 k VCE RB IB 3.7 = 61.7 k 0.06 R1 = 150 − 61.7 = 88.3 k Using 5% resistors from Appendix J, and selecting R1 and R2 so as to obtain a VBB that is slightly higher than 3.7 V, we write R1 = 82 k and R2 = 62 k RE = 5.1 k and RC = 5.1 k Chapter 6–35 VBB = VCC IE = 62 R2 = 3.875 =9× R1 + R2 62 + 82 VBB − VBE RB RE + β +1 where RB = R1 R2 = 62 82 = 35.3 k IE = 3.875 − 0.7 = 0.58 mA 35.3 5.1 + 91 VE = 0.58 × 5.1 = 3.18 VB = 3.88 V IC = αIE = 90 × 0.58 = 0.57 mA 91 VC = 6.1 V IR2 VB 3.88 = = 0.063 mA = R2 62 IB = 0.58 IE = = 0.006 mA and β +1 91 For this value, VBB − VBE IE nominal = 0.946 RE VBB − VBE IE low = 0.90 = 0.95 IE nominal RE V BE − VBE IE high = 0.963 = 1.02 IE nominal RE Thus, the maximum allowable ratio is RB = 5.73 RE VBB − VBE (b) IE = RB /RE RE 1 + β +1 VBB − VBE IE RE = 5.73 1+ β +1 VBB − VBE VCC = 5.73 3 1+ 101 ⇒ VBB = VBE + 0.352VCC (c) VCC = 5 V IR1 = 0.069 mA VBB = 0.7 + 0.352 × 5 = 2.46 V 6.98 Refer to Fig. 6.52. RE = (a) IE = VBB − VBE RB RE + β +1 RB = 5.73 × RE = 19.08 k VBB = VCC VBB − VBE IE nominal = RB RE + 101 IE high 2.46 = 5 VBB − VBE VBB − VBE = RB RB RE + RE + 101 51 RB /RE 101 0.95 = RB /RE 1+ 51 RB ⇒ = 5.73 RE R2 R1 + R2 R1 R2 = 5RB R1 + R2 = 5 × 19.08 high 1+ R2 R1 + R2 2.46R1 = 5 VBB − VBE = RB RE + 151 VBE − VBE IE low = RB RE + 51 Let’s constrain IE low to be equal to IE nominal × 0.95 and then check IE : 0.95 VCC /3 5/3 = 3.33 k = IE 0.5 ⇒ R1 = 38.8 k 1 1 − = 37.5 k R2 = 1 RB R1 (d) VCE = VCC − RC IG 1 = 5 − RC × 0.99 × 0.5 ⇒ RC = 8.1 k Check design: VBB = VCC 37.5 R2 =5× R1 + R2 37.5 + 38.8 = 2.46 V RB = R1 R2 = 37.5 38.8 = 19.07 k Chapter 6–36 IE nominal = 2.46 − 0.7 = 0.5 mA 19.07 3.33 + 101 IE low = 2.46 − 0.7 = 0.475 mA 19.07 3.33 + 51 , and which is 5% lower than IE Thus, IC = 0.432 − 0.39 = 0.042 mA for a percentage increase of IC 0.042 × 100 = × 100 = 10.8% IC 0.39 nominal IE 2.46 − 0.7 = 0.509 mA = high 19.07 3.33 + 151 . which is 1.8% higher than IE 6.100 5 V nominal 6.99 3 V RC IC VC IB RC VC VE RB RE 0.7 V RE 0.4 mA IE 5 V 3 V −0.7 − (−3) RE = 0.4 = 5.75 k To maximize gain while allowing for ±1 V signal swing at the collector, design for the lowest possible VC consistent with VC − 1 = −0.7 + VCEsat = −0.7 + 0.3 = −0.4 V VC = 0.6 V VCC − VC 3 − 0.6 = 6.2 k = RC = IC 0.39 As temperature increases from 25◦ C to 125◦ C, (i.e., by 100◦ C), VBE decreases by 2 mV × 100 = 0.2 V − 200 mV. Thus IE increases by = RE 0.2 V = 0.035 mA to become 0.435 mA. The 5.75 k collector current becomes β × 0.435 IC = β +1 where β is the increased value of 150, 150 IC = × 0.435 mA 151 = 0.432 mA Required: IC = 0.5 mA and VC = VE + 2. (a) β = ∞ VB = 0 VE = −0.7 V VE − (−5) 4.3 IE = 0.5 = = RE RE ⇒ RE = 8.6 k VC = VE + 2 = −0.7 + 2 = +1.3 V VCC − VC 5 − 1.3 RC = = = 7.4 k IC 0.5 (b) βmin = 50 IE 0.5 IBmax = = 0.01 mA 51 51 IE RE = 0.5 × 8.6 = 4.3 V IBmax RBmax = 0.1IE RE = 0.43 V 0.43 RBmax = = 43 k 0.01 (c) Standard 5% resistors: RB = 43 k RE = 8.2 k RC = 7.5 k (d) β = ∞: VB = 0, VE = −0.7 V Chapter 6–37 −0.7 − (−5) = 0.52 mA 8.2 IC = 0.52 mA An equal positive swing is just possible. For β = 150: 3 − 0.7 IE = = 0.56 mA 120 3.3 + 151 VC = 3 − IE RC = 3 − 0.56 × 3.3 = 1.15 V IE = VC = 5 − 0.52 × 7.5 = 1.1 V β = 50: 5 − 0.7 = 0.48 mA 43 8.2 + 51 VE = −5 + 0.48 × 8.2 = −1.064 V IE = Allowable negative signal swing at the collector = 1.15 − 0.3 = 0.85 V. An equal positive swing is possible. VB = −0.364 V 50 × 0.48 = 0.47 mA IC = αIE = 51 VC = 5 − 0.47 × 7.5 = 1.475 V 6.102 3 V 6.101 1.01 mA 3 V RC 0.01 mA IE IE/(b 1) 1.5 V RC 1 mA VC RB IC RB Figure 1 IE VC = VCEsat + 1 V = 1.3 V 3 − 1.3 = 0.5 mA IE = RC ⇒ RC = 3.4 k IE 0.5 IB = = 0.005 mA β +1 101 VC = VBE + IB RB (a) From the circuit diagram of Fig. 1, we can write 3 − 1.5 RC = 1.5 k 1.01 mA 1.5 = 0.01RB + VBE = 0.01RB + 0.7 ⇒ RB = 80 k (b) Selecting 5% resistors, we have 1.3 = 0.7 + 0.005 × RB RC = 1.5 k ⇒ RB = 120 k RB = 82 k VCC − VBE IE = RB RC + β +1 3 − 0.7 = = 0.99 mA 82 1.5 + 101 IC = αIE = 0.99 × 0.99 = 0.98 mA Standard 5% resistors: RC = 3.3 k RB = 120 k If the actual BJT has β = 50, then 3 − 0.7 VCC − VBE = 0.41 mA = IE = RB 120 RC + 3.3 + β +1 51 VC = 3 − IE RC = 3 − 0.41 × 3.3 = 1.65 V Allowable negative signal swing at the collector is as follows: VC − VCEsat = 1.65 − 0.3 = 1.35 V VC = 3 − 1.5 × 0.99 = 1.52 V (c) β = ∞: VCC − VBE 3 − 0.7 IC = IE = = 1.53 mA = RC 1.5 VC = 0.7 V Chapter 6–38 (d) From the circuit diagram of Fig. 2, we can write 3 V IC 1 mA I = 1.01 mA VC = 1.5 V = IB RB + VBE 0.7 V IB2 IB IC β 1 =1 1+ β IC 2IB RB1 I = IC + IB = IC + RC 2IB IC = 1 mA IB 1.5 = 0.01 × RB + 0.7 RB2 RB = 80 k Figure 2 6.104 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P6.104. Replacing VCC together with the voltage divider (R1 , R2 ) by its Thévenin equivalent results in the circuit shown below. 1 IC = = 0.01 mA β 100 0.7 0.7 RB2 = = IB2 0.01 = 70 k IB = IO aIE 1.5 = 2IB RB1 + 0.7 0.8 = 2 × 0.01 × RB1 IE /(b1) RB1 = 40 k 3 − 1.5 1.5 RC = = 1.47 k = IC + 2IB 1.02 For β = ∞: 0.7 0.7 IB = 0, IB2 = = = 0.01 mA RB2 70 IB1 = IB2 = 0.01 mA RB IE VBB RE VC = 0.01RB1 + 0.7 = 0.01 × 40 + 0.7 = 1.1 V 3 − 1.1 3 − 1.1 = 1.29 = RC 1.47 IC = 1.28 mA IC + 0.01 = 6.103 where VBB = VCC R2 R1 + R2 and RB = (R1 R2 ) I Now, VC IB RB VBB = IC IE = IE RB + VBE + IE RE β +1 VBB − VBE RE + (R1 R2 )/(β + 1) IC = αIE =α VCC [R2 /(R1 + R2 )] − VBE RE + (R1 R2 )/(β + 1) Chapter 6–39 To obtain IO = 0.5 mA, 6.105 0.5 = VCC R1 I IO 0 Q1 10 VCC = 2RE 2RE ⇒ RE = 10 k R1 = R2 = 8.6 k 6.106 VB 5 V I Q2 IO RE 50.7 R IE R2 R 0.7 V VCC − VBE1 − VBE2 R1 + R2 VB = IR2 + VBE2 + VBE1 I= IO VE3 = VB − VBE3 VE3 = IR2 + VBE2 + VBE1 − VBE3 R2 = (VCC − VBE1 − VBE2 ) + VBE1 R1 + R2 +VBE2 − VBE3 VE α R2 IO = = (VCC − VBE1 − VBE2 ) RE RE R1 + R2 + VBE1 + VBE2 − VBE3 Now, for R1 = R2 and the currents in all junctions equal, VBE1 = VBE2 = VBE3 = VBE 1 1 IO = (VCC − 2VBE ) × + VBE RE 2 VCC Q.E.D IO = 2RE Thus, VCC IO RE = 2 VCC + VBE VB = 2 VCC I = (VB − 2VBE )/R2 = − VBE R2 2 But since I must be equal to IO , we have VCC /2 − VBE VCC = 2RE R2 Thus, VCC − 2VBE R1 = R2 = RE VCC For VCC = 10 V and VBE = 0.7 V, 10 − 1.4 = 0.86RE R1 = R2 = RE 10 IO = αIE 0.5 mA IE = 0.5 mA 5 − 0.7 = 8.6 k 0.5 = 0.7 − VECsat = 0.7 − 0.3 ⇒R= v Cmax = +0.4 V 6.107 Refer to the equivalent circuit in Fig. 6.55(b). Rin Gv = − gm (RD RL ro ) Rin + Rsig =− RG gm (RD RL ro ) RG + Rsig 10 × 3 × (10 20 100) 10 + 1 = −17 V/V =− 6.108 (a) Refer to Fig. P6.108. The dc circuit can be obtained by opening all coupling and bypass capacitors, resulting in the circuit shown in Fig. 1 on next page. See analysis on figure. VGS = 2 − 1 = 1 V VOV = VGS − Vt = 1 − 0.7 = 0.3 V Since VD at 2.5 V is 1.2 V higher than VS + VOV = 1 + 0.3 = 1.3 V, the transistor is indeed operating in saturation. (Equivalent Chapter 6–40 To remain in saturation, v̂ DS ≥ v̂ GS − Vt 2.5 − 8.1v̂ gs ≥ 2 + v̂ gs − 0.7 This is satisfied with equality at 2.5 − 1.3 = 0.132 V v̂ gs = 9.1 The corresponding value of v̂ sig is 120 + 120 = 2 × 0.132 = 0.264 V v̂ sig = v̂ gs 120 The corresponding amplitude at the output will be | Gv |v̂ sig = 4.1 × 0.264 = 1.08 V Figure 1 VD = 2.5 V is higher than VG − Vt = 1.3 V by 1.2 V.) 1 2 ID = k n VOV 2 1 0.5 = k n × 0.33 2 ⇒ k n = 11.1 mA/V2 (d) To be able to double v̂ sig without leaving saturation, we must reduce v̂ gs to half of what would be its new value; that is, we must keep v̂ gs unchanged. This in turn can be achieved by connecting an unbypassed Rs equal to 1/gm , 1 = 300 Rs = 3.33 mA/V Since v̂ gs does not change, the output voltage also will not change, thus v̂ o = 1.08 V. (b) The amplifier small-signal equivalent-circuit model is shown in Fig. 2 below. 6.109 Refer to Fig. P6.109. Rin = RG1 RG2 = 300 k 200 k = 120 k 2ID 2 × 0.5 gm = = 3.33 mA/V = VOV 0.3 VA 50 = 100 k = ro = ID 0.5 Rin gm (ro RD RL ) Gv = − Rin + Rsig 120 × 3.33 × (100 5 5) =− 120 + 120 = −4.1 V/V (c) VG = 2 V, v̂ GS = 2 + v̂ gs , (a) DC bias: |VOV | = 0.3 V ⇒ VSG = |Vtp | + |VOV | = 1 V Since VG = 0 V, VS = VSG = +1 V, and 2.5 − 1 = 0.3 mA ID = RS 1.5 = 5 k ⇒ RS = 0.3 (b) Gv = −gm RD where VD = 2.5 V gm = v̂ DS = 2.5 − | Av |v̂ gs 2ID 2 × 0.3 = = 2 mA/V VOV 0.3 Thus, where −10 = −2RD ⇒ RD = 5 k | Av | = gm (ro RD RL ) = 8.1 V/V This figure belongs to Problem 6.108. Rsig vsig RG1 RG2 vgs gmvgs Rin RG RG1 // RG2 Figure 2 ro RD 5 k RL 5 k vo Chapter 6–41 (c) v G = 0 V (dc) + v sig v Gmin = −v̂ sig v̂ D = VD + | Gv |v̂ sig where VD = −2.5 + ID RD = −2.5 + 0.3 × 5 = −1 V To remain in saturation, v̂ D ≤ v̂ G + |Vtp | −1 + 10 v̂ sig ≤ −v̂ sig + 0.7 Satisfying this constraint with equality gives v̂ sig = 0.154 V and the corresponding output voltage v̂ d = | Gv |v̂ sig = 1.54 V (d) If v̂ sig = 50 mV, then VD + | Gv |v̂ sig = −v̂ sig + |Vtp | where VD = −2.5 + ID RD = −2.5 + 0.3RD | Gv | = gm RD = 2RD Thus −2.5 + 0.3RD + 2RD v̂ sig = −v̂ sig + |Vtp | −2.5 + 0.3RD + 2RD × 0.05 = −0.05 + 0.7 0.4RD = 3.15 ⇒ RD = 7.875 k Gv = −gm RD = −2 × 7.875 = −15.75 V/V 6.110 Refer to Fig. P6.110. 1 = 50 gm2 1 A/V = 20 mA/V 50 If Q1 is biased at the same point as Q2 , then ⇒ gm2 = gm1 = gm2 = 20 mA/V id 1 = gm1 × 5 (mV) = 20 × 0.005 = 0.1 mA v d 1 = id 1 × 50 = 0.1 × 50 = 5 mV v o = id 1 RD = 1 V RD = v o = 14.3 × v i2 = 14.3 × 0.5v i vo = 7.15 V/V vi 6.112 (a) DC bias: Refer to the circuit in Fig. P6.112 with all capacitors eliminated: Rin at gate = RG = 10 M and Ri2 = 6.111 (a) Refer to the circuit of Fig. P6.111(a): v o1 10 10 Av o ≡ = = = 0.99 V/V 1 1 vi 10 + 10 + gm 10 1 Ro = 10 k = 0.1 10 = 99 gm (b) Refer to Fig. P6.111(b): 1 Rin = 10 k = 10 0.1 = 99 gm vo 5 2 = = 10(5 2) = 14.3 V/V v i2 1/gm Rin (c) v i2 = (Av o v i ) Rin + Ro 99 = 0.99 × v i × 99 + 99 0.5v i 1V = 10 k 0.1 mA VG = 0, thus VS = −VGS , where VGS can be obtained from 1 2 ID = k n VOV 2 1 2 0.4 = × 5 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.4 V VGS = Vt + 0.4 = 0.8 + 0.4 = 1.2 V VS = −1.2 V −1.2 − (−5) = 9.5 k RS = 0.4 To remain in saturation, the minimum drain voltage must be limited to VG − Vt = 0 − 0.8 = −0.8 V. Now, to allow for 0.8-V negative signal swing, we must have VD = 0 V and 5−0 = 12.5 k 0.4 2ID 2 × 0.4 = 2 mA/V (b) gm = = VOV 0.4 VA 40 = = 100 k ro = ID 0.4 (c) If terminal Z is connected to ground, the circuit becomes a CS amplifier, vy RG = × −gm (ro RD RL ) Gv = − v sig RG + Rsig RD = 10 × 2 × (100 12.5 10) 10 + 1 = −9.6 V/V =− Chapter 6–42 (d) If terminal Y is grounded, the circuit becomes a CD or source-follower amplifier: vz (RS ro ) = 1 vx (RS ro ) + gm (9.5 100) = 0.946 V/V = 1 (9.5 100) + 2 Looking into terminal Z, we see Ro : 1 Ro = RS ro gm 1 = 473 = 9.5 100 2 (e) If X is grounded, the circuit becomes a CG amplifier. VOV = 0.2 V VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.6 + 0.2 = 0.8 V From the voltage divider (R1 , R2 : see Fig. 1), we can write R1 0.5 VD = VD = 0.5VD VGS = R1 + R2 0.5 + 0.5 Thus VD = 2VGS = 1.6 V 1 2 ID = k n VOV 2 1 = × 5 × 0.22 = 0.1 mA 2 VD 1.6 V = = 1.6 μA Idivider = 1 M 1 M IRD = 0.1 + 0.0016 RD RD = vy 0.102 mA VDD − VD 10 − 1.6 = = 82.4 k IRD 0.102 2ID 2 × 0.1 = 1 mA/V = VOV 0.2 (c) Replacing the MOSFET with its T model results in the amplifier equivalent circuit shown in Fig. 2. At the output node, (b) gm = vsg isig 50 A RS v o = i[RD (R1 + R2 )] v o = iRD Rsig 100 k (1) vo The figure shows the circuit prepared for signal calculations. 1 v sg = isig × Rsig RS gm 1 (k) = 50 × 10−3 (mA) 100 9.5 2 = 0.024 V R2 i 0 bvo i 1/gm R1 v y = (gm RD )v sg vsig = (2 × 12.5) × 0.024 = 0.6 V 6.113 (a) DC bias: Figure 2 VDD 10 V RD RD R2 0.5 M VD R1 0.5 M RD where = RD (R1 + R2 ). The voltage at the gate is a fraction β of v o with R1 β= R1 + R2 Now, the current i can be found from v sig − βv o i= = gmv sig − βgmv o (2) 1/gm Substituting for i from Eq. (2) into Eq. (1) yields v o = (gm v sig − βgm v o )RD VGS Thus gm RD vo = v sig 1 + βgm RD Figure 1 Chapter 6–43 = = 1/β 1/β 1+ gm RD 1 + (R2 /R1 ) 1 + R2 /R1 1+ gm RD (3) Q.E.D The input resistance Rin can be obtained as follows: v sig Rin = i Substituting for i from Eq. (1) yields v sig R Rin = vo D v sig and replacing by the inverse of the gain vo expression in Eq. (3) gives Rin = RD 1 1 + gm RD 1 + (R2 /R1 ) 1 R1 1 + gm RD Q.E.D gm R1 + R2 (d) Substituting numerical values: 1 + (0.5/0.5) vo = 1 + (0.5/0.5) v sig 1+ 1 × (82.4 1000) 2 = 1.95 V/V = 2 1+ 76.13 R2 Note that the gain 1 + = 2, similar to that R1 of an op amp connected in the noninverting configuration! Rin = 0.5 1 1 + 1 × (82.4 1000) 1 0.5 + 0.5 = 39.1 k Rin = 6.114 (a) DC bias: = 0.107 mA The current in the voltage divider is VD 4 = = 1.6 μA = 0.0016 mA R1 + R2 2.5 Thus the current through RD will be (0.107 + 0.0016) 0.109 mA and 10 − 4 VDD − VD RD = = = 55 k 0.109 0.109 2ID 2 × 0.107 (b) gm = = = 1.07 mA/V VOV 0.2 VA 60 ro = = 561 k = ID 0.107 (c) Upon replacing the MOSFET with its hybrid-π model, we obtain the small-signal equivalent circuit of the amplifier, shown in Fig. 2 on the next page. I= Node equation at the output: v o − v gs vo vo + + + gm v gs = 0 RD ro R2 1 1 1 1 vo + + = −gm 1 − v gs RD ro R2 gm R2 Thus, v o = − gm (RD ro VDD 10 V VD R1 0.5 M Figure 1 VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.6 + 0.2 = 0.8 V 1 R2 ) 1 − v gs gm R2 (1) R2 R1 + vo (2) R1 + R2 R1 + R2 Substituting for v gs from Eq. (2) into Eq. (1) yields R2 R1 v o = −Av sig − Av o R1 + R2 R1 + R2 where 1 A = gm (RD ro R2 ) 1 − gm R2 Thus, R1 R2 v sig = −A vo 1 + A R1 + R2 R1 + R2 R2 −A vo R1 + R2 = R1 v sig 1+A R1 + R2 v gs = v sig R2 2 M ID A Next, we express v gs in terms of v sig and v o using superposition: RD VGS From the voltage divider (R1 , R2 : see Fig. 1), we can write R1 0.5 VGS = VD = VD R1 + R2 0.5 + 2 VD = 5VGS = 5 × 0.8 = 4 V 1 VDS 2 ID = k n VOV 1 + 2 VA 1 4 ID = × 5 × 0.22 1 + 2 60 Chapter 6–44 This figure belongs to Problem 6.114(c). (vo vgs)⁄R2 R2 R1 vsig vo gmvgs vgs RD ro Figure 2 −R2 /R1 1 + R2 /R1 1+ A Thus, R2 /R1 vo =− 1 + R2 /R1 v sig 1+ gm (RD ro R2 )(1 − 1/gm R2 ) RB = R1 R2 = 15 27 = 9.643 k = IC = Q.E.D Substituting numerical values yields vo = v sig 2/0.5 − 1 + (2/0.5) 1+ 1.07(55 561 2000)(1 − 1/1.07 × 2000) = − 4 5 1+ 52.6 0.99(5.357 − 0.7) = 1.85 mA 9.643 2.4 + 101 gm = IC 1.85 mA = 74 mA/V = VT 0.025 V rπ = β 100 = = 1.35 k gm 74 Replacing the BJT with its hybrid-π model results in the equivalent circuit shown at the bottom of the page: Rin = R1 R2 rπ = RB rπ = 9.643 1.35 = 1.18 k Rin vπ 1.18 = = 0.371 V/V = v sig Rin + Rsig 1.18 + 2 = −3.65 V/V vo = −gm (RC RL ) vπ Note that the gain is nearly equal to −R2 /R1 = − 4, which is the gain of an op amp connected in the inverting configuration. = −74(3.9 2) = −97.83 vo = −0.371 × 97.83 = −36.3 V/V v sig 6.115 Refer to the circuit of Fig. P6.115. IC = α(VBB − VBE ) RB RE + β +1 6.116 Refer to the circuit of Fig. P6.116. DC design: VB = 5 V, where VBB = VCC R2 15 = 5.357 V = 15 × R2 + R1 15 + 27 VBE = 0.7 V VE = 4.3 V This figure belongs to Problem 6.115. Rsig vo vsig R1 R2 vp Rin rp gmvp RC RL Chapter 6–45 For VE 4.3 = 2.15 k = IE = 2 mA, RE = IE 2 5 IR2 = 0.2 mA, R2 = = 25 k 0.2 2 IE = 0.02 mA IB = β +1 101 IR1 = IR2 + IB = 0.2 + 0.02 = 0.22 mA VCC − VB 15 − 5 R1 = = 45.5 k = IR1 0.22 Choosing 5% resistors: RE = 2.2 k, R1 = 47 k, R2 = 24 k For these values, VBB − VBE IE = RB RE + β +1 where 24 R2 = 5.07 V = 15 × VBB = VCC R1 + R2 24 + 47 RB = R1 R2 = 47 24 = 15.89 k 5.07 − 0.7 = 1.85 mA IE = 15.89 2.2 + 101 VB = IE RE + VBE = 1.85 × 2.2 + 0.7 = 4.8 V IC = αIE = 0.99 × 1.85 = 1.84 mA IC 1.84 gm = = 73.4 mA/V = VT 0.025 β 100 rπ = = 1.36 k = gm 73.4 Rin = R1 R2 rπ = 47 24 1.36 = 1.25 k Rin 1.25 vπ = = = 0.385 V/V v sig Rin + Rsig 1.25 + 2 For an overall gain of −40 V/V, 40 vo = −104 V/V =− vπ 0.385 But vo = −gm (RC RL ) vπ −104 = −73.4 (RC 2) which is slightly higher than the required gain, and we will obtain VC = 15 − 5.1 × 1.84 = 5.6 V which allows for only 1.2-V negative signal swing. 6.117 Refer to the circuit of Fig. P6.117. DC voltage drop across RB = 0.2 V, and IB RB = 0.2 V I RB = 0.2 V β +1 IRB = 0.2 × 101 (1) Rin = RB rπ = 10 k VT RB = 10 IB 0.025 RB = 10 I /(β + 1) 0.025 × 101 RB = 10 I 0.025 × 101 I = 10 0.025 × 101 RB + I 0.025 × 101RB = 10 IRB + 0.025 × 101 Substituting for IRB from Eq. (1) yields RB × 0.025 × 101RB = 10 0.2 × 101 + 0.025 × 101 0.025RB = 10 0.225 ⇒ RB = 90 k 0.2 × 101 I= = 0.22 mA 90 To maximize the open-circuit voltage gain between base and collector while ensuring that the instantaneous collector voltage does not fall below (v B − 0.4) when v be is as high as 5 mV, we impose the constraint (RC 2) = 1.416 VC − | Av o | × 0.005 = VB + 0.005 − 0.4 RC = 4.86 k where We can select either 4.7 k or 5.1 k. With 4.7 k, the gain will be vo = −0.385 × 73.4 × (4.7 2) = −39.6 V/V v sig which is slightly lower than the required −40 V/V, and we will obtain VC = VCC − IC RC VC = 15 − 4.7 × 1.84 = 6.4 V allowing for about 2 V of negative signal swing at the collector. If we choose 5.1 k, the gain will be vo = −0.385 × 73.4 × (5.1 2) = −40.6 V/V v sig (2) = 5 − 0.99 × 0.22RC = 5 − 0.22RC | Av o | = gm RC = 0.99 × 0.22 RC = 8.7RC 0.025 and VB = − 0.22 × 90 = −0.2 V 101 Thus, 5 − 0.22RC − 8.7RC × 0.005 = −0.2 − 0.395 Chapter 6–46 β 100 = 5 k = gm 20 vo 5 Gv = =− × 20 × (5 10) v sig 5 + 2.5 ⇒ RC = 21.2 k rπ = Selecting 5% resistors, we find RB = 91 k RC = 22 k and specifying I to one significant digit gives I = 0.2 mA αIC 0.2 gm = = 8 mA/V VT 0.025 Av o = −gm RC = −8 × 22 = −176 V/V β 100 = = 12.5 k rπ = gm 8 Rin = RB rπ = 91 12.5 = 11 k 11 × 8(22 20) Gv = − 20 + 11 = −29.7 V/V 6.119 Refer to the circuit of Fig. P6.119. (a) DC analysis of each of the two stages: VBB = VCC 47 R2 = 4.8 V = 15 R1 + R2 100 + 47 RB = R1 R2 = 100 47 = 32 k IE = VBB − VBE RB RE + β +1 4.8 − 0.7 = 0.97 mA 32 3.9 + 101 IC = αIE 1 mA = 6.118 Refer to the circuit of Fig. P6.118. (a) IE = 0.5 mA. Writing a loop equation for the base–emitter circuit results in IB Rsig + VBE + IE RE = 3 IE Rsig + VBE + IE RE = 3 β +1 0.5 × 2.5 + 0.7 + 0.5RE = 3 101 ⇒ RE = 4.6 k (b) IC = αIE = −44.4 V/V VC = VCC − IC RC = 15 − 1 × 6.8 = 8.2 V (b) See figure below. IC gm = = 40 mA/V VT β rπ = = 2.5 k gm (c) Rin1 = R1 R2 rπ = RB rπ = 32 2.5 = 2.32 k v b1 Rin 2.32 = 0.32 V/V = = v sig Rin + Rsig 2.32 + 5 0.5 mA VC = 0.5 = 3 − 0.5RC (d) Rin2 = R1 R2 rπ = Rin1 = 2.32 k v b2 v b2 = = −gm (RC Rin2 ) v b1 v π1 ⇒ RC = 5 k IC 0.5 mA (c) gm = = 20 mA/V = VT 0.025 V = −40(6.8 2.32) = −69.2 V/V This figure belongs to Problem 6.118. Rsig vo vsig 1 mA rp vp gmvp This figure belongs to Problem 6.119. RC RL Chapter 6–47 vo vo = = −gm (RC RL ) v b2 vπ2 = −40(6.8 2) = −61.8 V/V vo v b2 v b1 vo = × × = −61.8 (f) v sig v b2 v b1 v sig (e) × − 69.2 × 0.32 = 1368.5 V/V From Fig. 1 we see that IC = 0.495 mA VC = IB × 200 k + IE × 0.2 k + VBE = 0.005 × 200 + 0.5 × 0.2 + 0.7 = 1.18 V (b) 6.120 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P6.120: Rin = 200 k (β + 1)(re + Re ) For v be to be limited to 5 mV, the signal between base and ground will be 10 mV (because of the 5 mV across Re ). The limit on v sig can be obtained by dividing the 10 mV by v b /v sig , 10 mV = 15 mV 0.668 Correspondingly, at the output we have v̂ sig = v̂ o = | Gv |v̂ sig = 13.4 × 15 = 200 mV = 0.2 V 6.121 (a) 0.5 mA VC 0.495 mA 200 k i = 200 50.5 = 40.3 k vb Rin 40.3 = 0.668 V/V = = v sig Rin + Rsig 40.3 + 20 vo Total resistance in collector = −α vb Total resistance in emitter 20 20 − = −20 V/V 0.25 + 0.25 vo Gv = = −0.668 × 20 = −13.4 V/V v sig i 200 k vi = 200 [101 × (0.25 + 0.25)] vo vo vi 200 IE = 0.1 mA VT 25 mV re = = = 250 IE 0.1 mA IC 0.1 mA gm = = 4 mA/V VT 0.025 V Note that the emitter has a resistance Re = 250 . 0.5 mA 200 Figure 1 re 50 200 Figure 2 From Fig. 2, we have IC 0.495 = 20 mA/V VT 0.025 VT re = = 50 IE vi vi = i= re + Re 50 + 200 vi vi = = = 4 v i , mA 250 0.25 k Node equation at the output: vo vo − vi + αi + =0 20 200 vo vi vo + 0.99 × 4v i + − =0 20 200 200 1 1 1 vo + = −v i 4 × 0.99 − 20 200 200 vo = −71.9 V/V vi gm = 6.122 (a) IE = 3 − 0.7 100 1+ β +1 β = 50: 2.3 = 0.78 mA 100 1+ 51 VE = IE RE = 0.78 V IE = 0.005 mA 20 k VB = VE + 0.7 = 1.48 V β = 200: 2.3 IE = = 1.54 mA 100 1+ 201 Chapter 6–48 VE = IE RE = 1.54 V The dc emitter current is equal to 0.5 mA, and IC = αIE 0.5 mA; also, VT 25 mV = = 50 re = IE 0.5 mA Rin = re = 50 −v sig −v sig = ie = re + Rsig 50 + 50 −v sig −v sig = = 100 0.1 k At the output node, VB = VE + 0.7 = 2.24 V (b) Rin = 100 (β + 1)[re + (1 1)] = 100 (β + 1)(re + 0.5) β = 50: VT 25 mV re = = 32.1 = IE 0.78 mA Rin = 100 [51 × (0.0321 + 0.5)] = 21.3 k v o = −αie (5 100) v sig (5 100) =α 0.1 vo 5 100 47.6 V/V =α v sig 0.1 β = 200: VT 25 mV re = = 16.2 = IE 1.54 mA Rin = 100 [201 × (0.0162 + 0.5)] = 50.9 k vb Rin (c) = v sig Rin + Rsig 6.124 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P6.124. For dc analysis, open-circuit the two coupling capacitors. Then replace the 9-V source and the two 20-k resistors by their Thévenin equivalent, namely, a 4.5-V source and a 10-k series resistance. The latter can be added to the 10-k resistor that is connected to the base. The result is the circuit shown in Fig. 1, which can be used to calculate IE . (1 1) 500 vo = = (re in ) vb (1 1) + re 500 + re β = 50: vb 21.3 = 0.68 V/V = v sig 21.3 + 10 vo 500 = 0.94 V/V = vb 500 + 32.1 vo = 0.68 × 0.94 = 0.64 V/V v sig 9 V β = 200: 4.5 V 20 k vb 50.9 = = 0.836 V/V v sig 50.9 + 10 vo 500 = = 0.969 V/V vb 500 + 16.2 vo = 0.836 × 0.969 = 0.81 V/V v sig IE 2 k Figure 1 6.123 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P6.123. vo 100 k ie ie 5 k 4.5 − 0.7 20 2+ β +1 3.8 = 1.73 mA 20 2+ 101 IC = αIE = 0.99 × 1.73 mA = re 50 Rsig 50 v sig Rin re 50 (a) IE = = 1.71 mA IC gm = = 68.4 mA/V VT VT 25 mV re = = 14.5 = IE 1.73 mA = 0.0145 k Chapter 6–49 rπ = (β + 1)re = 101 × 0.0145 = 1.4645 k (c) When CB is open-circuited, the equivalent circuit becomes that shown in Fig. 3. (b) Replacing the BJT with its T model (without ro ) and replacing the capacitors with short circuits results in the equivalent-circuit model shown in Fig. 2. Figure 3 Thus, Figure 2 Rin = 20 k Rib = 20 k (β + 1)(Re + 2) From Fig. 2 we see that re (10 2) v e = ie + ie 10 re + ie re v b = v e + ie re = ie (10 2) 1 + 10 re ii = (1 − α)ie + ie 10 ie re + ie = β +1 10 We can now obtain Rin from re (10 2) 1 + + re vb 10 Rin ≡ = 1 re ii + β + 1 10 re + (β + 1)re (β + 1)(10 2) 1 + 10 = re 1 + (β + 1) 10 = 101 × (10 2) × (1 + 0.00145) + 101 × 0.0145 1 + 101 × 0.00145 168.577 + 1.4645 = 148.3 k 1 + 0.14645 vb Rin 148.3 = = = 0.937 v sig Rin + Rsig 148.3 + 10 re ie 1 + (10 2) ve vo 10 = = re vb vb ie 1 + (10 2) + ie re 10 1.00145 × (10 2) = 1.00145 × (10 2) + 0.0145 = 0.991 V/V vo Gv ≡ = 0.937 × 0.991 = 0.93 V/V v sig = = 20 101 × 2.0145 = 18.21 k which is greatly reduced because of the absence of bootstrapping. The latter causes the lower node of the 10-k base-biasing resistor to rise with the output voltage, thus causing a much reduced signal current in the 10-k resistor and a correspondingly larger effective resistance across the amplifier input. The reduced Rin will result in a reduction in v b /v sig , Rin vb 18.21 = = v sig Rin + Rsig 28.21 = 0.646 V/V 2 vo = = 0.993 vb 2 + 0.0145 vo = 0.646 × 0.993 Gv ≡ v sig = 0.64 V/V which is much reduced relative to the value obtained with bootstrapping. 6.125 (a) Applying Thévenin’s theorem to the base-biasing circuit of Q1 results in the dc circuit shown below. From our partial analysis on the figure, we can write IE1 = 0.1 mA IE2 = 5 mA Chapter 6–50 VB1 can be obtained as where VB1 = 2.5 − 2 μA × 0.5 M = 1.5 V re2 = and VB2 can be found as vo v b2 VB2 = VB1 − 0.7 = 0.8 V 25 mV =5 5 mA 1000 = = 0.995 V/V 1000 + 5 Rib2 = (β2 + 1)(re2 + RL ) = 101 × 1.005 = 101.5 k 0.5 M (c) Rin = 1 M 1 M (β + 1)(re1 + Rib2 ) 100 51 2.5 V 2 A 100 A 0.1 mA where VT 25 mV re = = = 250 = 0.25 k IE1 0.1 mA 0.05 mA 50 A 50 A Rin = 0.5 M [51 × (0.25 + 101.5)] k 5 mA = 0.5 M 5.2 M = 456 k v e1 Rib 101.5 = = v b1 Rib + re1 101.5 + 0.25 (b) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P6.125. With a load resistance RL = 1 k connected to the output terminal, the voltage gain v o /v b2 can be found as vo RL = v b2 RL + re1 = 0.9975 V/V v b1 Rin 456 = = = 0.82 V/V v sig Rin + Rsig 456 + 100 vo (e) = 0.82 × 0.9975 × 0.995 = 0.814 V/V v sig (d) Exercise 7–1 Ex: 7.1 In the current source of Example 7.1 (Fig. 7.1) we have IO = 100 μA and we want to reduce the change in output current, IO , corresponding to a 1-V change in output voltage, VO , to 1% of IO . That is, IO = VO 1V = 0.01IO ⇒ ro2 ro2 = 0.01 × 100 μA ro2 = 1V = 1 M 1 μA ro2 = VA × L 20 × L ⇒ 1 M = IO 100 μA ⇒L= 100 V = 5 μm 20 V/ μm To keep VOV of the matched transistors the same W of the transistor should as that in Example 7.1, L remain the same. Therefore, 10 μm W = ⇒ W = 50 μm 5 μm 1 μm So the dimensions of the matched transistors Q1 and Q2 should be changed to W = 50 μm and L = 5 μm Ex: 7.2 For the circuit of Fig. 7.4 we have I2 = IREF (W/L)2 (W/L)3 , I3 = IREF (W/L)1 (W/L)1 and I5 = I4 (W/L)5 (W/L)4 Since all channel lengths are equal, that is, L1 = L2 = · · · = L5 = 1 μm and IREF = 10 μA, I2 = 60 μA, I3 = 20 μA, I4 = I3 = 20 μA, and I5 = 80 μA, ⇒ W L = 2 120 = 15 ⇒ W2 200 × (0.2)2 = 15 × L2 W2 = 15 μm, W2 W2 = 6 ⇒ W1 = = 2.5 μm W1 6 W3 = 2 ⇒ W3 = 2 × W1 = 5 μm W1 To allow the voltage at the drain of Q5 to go up to within 0.2 V of positive supply, we need VOV 5 = 0.2 V: 1 W V2 I5 = k p 2 L 5 OV 5 μA W 1 80 μA = 80 2 (0.2)2 ⇒ 2 V L 5 2 × 80 W = = 50 ⇒ W5 = 50 L5 L 5 80 × (0.2)2 W5 = 50 μm 50 μm W5 = 4 ⇒ W4 = = 12.5 μm W4 4 Thus: W1 = 2.5 μm, W2 = 15 μm, W3 = 5 μm W4 = 12.5 μm, and W5 = 50 μm Ex: 7.3 From Eq. (7.21) we have ⎞ ⎛ ⎟ ⎜ VO − VBE m ⎟ ⎜ 1+ IO = IREF ⎝ m+1⎠ VA2 1+ β ⎞ ⎛ 5 − 0.7 1 ⎟ ⎜ 1+ IO = 1 mA⎝ 1+1⎠ 100 1+ 100 = 1.02 mA IO = 1.02 mA Ro = ro2 = VA 100 V = = 98 k 100 k IO 1.02 mA we have I2 = IREF I2 W2 W2 60 = =6 ⇒ = W1 IREF W1 10 I3 = IREF W3 I3 20 W3 ⇒ = = =2 W1 W1 IREF 10 I5 = I4 W5 I5 80 W5 ⇒ = = =4 W4 W4 I4 20 To allow the voltage at the drain of Q2 to go down to within 0.2 V of the negative supply voltage, we need VOV 2 = 0.2 V: 1 1 W W 2 VOV = V2 k I2 = μn Cox 2 2 L 2 2 n L 2 OV 2 1 μA W 60 μA = 200 2 (0.2)2 2 V L 2 Ex: 7.4 VCC R IREF IO VO Q1 Q2 From Eq. (7.23), we have IREF VO − VBE 1+ IO = 1 + (2/β) VA Exercise 7–2 IO where VBE = VT ln IS 0.5 × 10−3 = 0.025 ln = 0.673 V 10−15 2 − 0.673 IREF 1+ ⇒ 0.5 mA = 1 + (2/100) 50 IREF = W L = 12.5 1 To obtain Ais = 5 (W/L)2 (W/L)1 5 = Ais = 1.02 = 0.497 mA 1.026 mA − VBE VCC − VBE ⇒R= R IREF IREF = 0.5 mA VCC ⇒ ⇒ W L = 5 × 12.5 = 62.5 2 Ro = ro2 = 5 − 0.673 = 8.71 k 0.497 mA VOmin = VCEsat = 0.3 V R= VA2 VA2 = ID2 5ID1 Thus, For VO = 5 V, From Eq. (7.23) we have VO − VBE IREF 1+ IO = 1 + (2/β) VA 0.497 5 − 0.673 V 1+ = 0.53 mA IO = 1 + (2/100) 50 40 k = VA2 5 × 0.1 ⇒ VA2 = 20 V But L2 VA2 = VA2 20 = 20 × L2 ⇒ L2 = 1 μm Ex: 7.5 I1 = I2 = · · · = IN = IC |QREF Selecting L1 = L2 , then At the input node, IREF = IC |QREF + IB |QREF + IB1 + · · · + IBN L1 = L2 = 1 μm = IC |QREF + (N + 1) IB |QREF W1 = 12.5 μm = IC |QREF + ⇒ IC |QREF = W2 = 62.5 μm (N + 1) IC |QREF β IREF N +1 1+ β Ex: 7.7 Thus, I1 = I2 = · · · = IN = IREF N +1 1+ β For β = 100, to limit the error to 10%, 0.1 = N +1 N +1 = β 100 Q.E.D Using Eq. (7.42): W · gm = 2μn Cox L For ID = 10 μA, we have gm = 2(387 μA/V2 )(10)(10 μA) = 0.28 mA/V ⇒N =9 Using Eq. (7.46): Ex: 7.6 A0 = VA Rin 1 gm1 = Now, Rin = 1 k, thus 5 V/μm 2(387 μA/V2 )(10)(0.36)2 √ 10 μA Since gm varies with But 2(μn Cox ) 1= 2μn Cox (W/L) √ ID A0 = 50 V/V gm1 = 1 mA/V gm1 = 2 × 0.4 × W L W L ID ID1 1 × 0.1 1 1 ID and A0 with √ , ID for ID = 100 μA ⇒ gm = 0.28 mA/V = 0.88 mA/V 100 10 1/2 Exercise 7–3 A0 = 50 1/2 10 100 IC1 = I = 100 μA = 0.1 mA = 15.8 V/V For ID = 1 mA, we have 1/2 1 gm = 0.28 mA/V = 2.8 mA/V 0.010 0.010 1/2 A0 = 50 = 5 V/V 1 Ex: 7.8 VDD Q3 IC1 0.1 mA = 4 mA/V = VT 25 mV Rin = rπ1 = β1 100 = = 25 k gm 1 4 mA/V VA 50 V = = 500 k I 0.1 mA |VA | 50 V = = 500 k ro2 = I 0.1 mA A0 = gm1 ro1 = (4 mA/V) (500 k) = 2000 V/V ro1 = Av = −gm1 (ro1 ro2 ) = −(4 mA/V) × Q2 vO IREF gm1 = (500 k 500 k) = −1000 V/V Q1 vI Ex: 7.10 Refer to Fig. 7.18(b), vo = iRL vsig = i(Rs + Rin ) Thus, Since all transistors have the same 7.2 μm W = , L 0.36 μm RL vo = vsig Rs + Rin Q.E.D we have Ex: 7.11 Since gm ro 1, we use Eq. (7.54), IREF = ID3 = ID2 = ID1 = 100 μA W gm1 = 2μn Cox ID1 L 1 = 2 387 μA/V2 Rin 7.2 (100 μA) 0.36 RL 0 ro (gm ro )ro ∞ Rin 1 gm 2 gm ro ∞ = 1.24 mA/V ro1 = ro2 = 1 RL + gm gm ro VAn 5 V/μm (0.36 μm) L1 = = 18 k ID1 0.1 mA Ex: 7.12 For gm ro 1, we use Eq. (7.58), |VAp |L2 Rout ro + (gm ro )Rs = ID2 6 V/μm (0.36 μm) = 21.6 k 0.1 mA to obtain Voltage gain is Av = −gm1 (ro1 ro2 ) Rs Av = − (1.24 mA/V) (18 k 21.6 k) Rout 0 ro (gm ro )ro ∞ ro (gm ro )ro (gm ro ) ro ∞ 2 = −12.2 V/V Ex: 7.13 Av o remains unchanged at gm ro . With a load resistance RL connected, Ex: 7.9 VCC VBIAS Q2 I vi Rin Av = Av o RL RL + Ro = (gm ro ) RL RL + (1 + gm Rs )ro vo Q1 Ex: 7.14 Use Eq. (7.63) Rin re ro + RL RL ro + β +1 Exercise 7–4 Ex: 7.19 to obtain RL 0 ro (β + 1)ro ∞ Rin re 2 re 1 rπ 2 rπ VDD 1.8 V VG4 1.1 V Q4 VG3 0.8 V Ex: 7.15 Using Eq. (7.68), Q3 Rout ro + (gm ro )(Re rπ ) vO we obtain VG2 1.0 V Re 0 re Rout ro 2 ro rπ Q2 ∞ ro β + 1 ro (β + 1)ro 2 (β + 1)ro Q1 VI 0.7 V Ex: 7.16 Ro = [1 + gm (Re rπ )]ro where gm = 40 mA/V, rπ = β = 2.5 k, gm Re = 0.5 k, and ro = If all transistors are matched and are obviously operating at the same ID , then all |VOV | will be equal and equal to that of Q1 , namely, |VOV | = 0.7 − 0.5 = 0.2 V VA 10 = = 10 k IC 1 Thus, VD1 = VS2 = VG2 − Vtn − VOV Ro = [1 + 40(0.5 2.5)] × 10 = 1.0 − 0.5 − 0.2 = 0.3 V = 177 k The lowest vDS2 can go is |VOV | = 0.2 V Without emitter degeneration, ∴ v O min = VDS1 + VDS2 = 0.3 + 0.2 = 0.5 V Ro = ro = 10 k Similarly, VSG4 = VSG3 = 0.7 V VD4 = VS3 = VG3 + |Vt | + |VOV | Ex: 7.17 Since the CG transistor Q2 increases the output resistance by a factor approximately equal to gm2 ro2 , = 0.8 + 0.5 + 0.2 = 1.5 V K gm2 ro2 vO max = VD4 − vSD3min = 1.5 − 0.2 = 1.3 V 0.55 μm and Ex: 7.18 If L is halved L = 2 |VA | = VA · L, we obtain 0.55 μm = 1.375 V |VA | = 5 V/μm 2 Ex: 7.20 Refer to Fig. 7.33. Ro = Since ID = W = L gm1 = gm2 = gm3 = gm4 = = 2 mA/V ro1 = ro2 = ro3 = ro4 = |VA | 2 (1.375 V)2 |VA | = · |VOV |/2 ID (0.3 V) (100 μA) = 126 k 1 μ Cox 2 p W L |VOV |2 1 + VSD |VA | 2 (100 μA) 0.3 V 2 2 90 μA/V (0.3 V) 1 + 1.375 V W = 20.3 L vSD3 can go as low as |VOV | , so 2 ID 2 × 0.2 = |VOV | 0.2 |VA | 2 = 10 k = ID 0.2 Ron = (gm2 ro2 )ro1 = (2 × 10) × 10 = 200 k Rop = (gm3 ro3 )ro4 = (2 × 10) × 10 = 200 k Ro = Ron Rop = 200 200 = 100 k Av = −gm1 Ro = −2 × 100 = −200 V/V Ex: 7.21 gm1 = gm2 = gm = 0.1 mA ID = = 1 mA/V VOV (0.2/2) V 2 Exercise 7–5 ro1 = ro2 = ro = (a) ID1 = I and ID2 = I VA 2V = 20 k = ID 0.1 mA so, gm ro = 1 mA/V (20 k) = 20 (a) For RL = 20 k, Rin2 = RL + ro2 20 k + 20 k = 1.9 k = 1 + gm2 ro2 1 + 20 ∴ Av1 = −gm1 (ro1 Rin2 ) = −1 mA/V (20 1.9) = −1.74 V/V or If we use the approximation of Eq. (7.83), Rin2 ≈ RL 1 20 k 1 + = + = 2 k gm2 ro2 gm2 20 1 mA/V then Av1 = −1 mA/V (20 k 2 k) = −1.82 V/V Continuing, from Eq. (7.80), Av = −gm1 [(gm2 ro2 ro1 ) RL ] Av = −1 mA/V {[(20) (20 k)] 20 k} = −19.0 V/V Av 2 = Av −19.0 = 10.5 V/V = Av 1 −1.82 (b) The minimum voltage required across current source I1 would be |VOV | = 0.2 V, since it is made with a single transistor. If a 0.1-VPP signal swing is to be allowed at the drain of Q1 , the highest dc bias voltage would be 0.1 Vpp 1 = 1.8 − 0.2 − (0.1) 2 2 = 1.55 V (c) V SG2 = |VOV | + Vtp = 0.2 + 0.5 = 0.7 V RL 1 400 k 1 + = + gm2 ro2 gm2 20 1 mA/V = 21 k Av 1 = −1 mA/V (20 k 21 k) = −10.2 V/V Av = −1 mA/V [(20) (20 k)] 400 k = −200 V/V Av 2 = Thus, W kp W k W L 2 = 1 ⇒ = n W L 2 kp L 1 k n L 1 k n W = kn L 1 4 W W or =4 L 2 L 1 VDD − |VOV | − (b) Now, for RL = 400 k, Rin2 Since VOV 1 = VOV 2 = 0.2 V, we have W 1 μ Cox V2 I ID2 2 p L 2 OV 2 = = =1 W 1 ID1 I μ Cox V2 2 n L 1 OV 1 Av −200 = 19.6 V/V = Av 1 −10.2 VG2 can be set at 1.55 – 0.7 = 0.85 V. (d) Since current source I2 is implemented with a cascoded current source, the minimum voltage required across it for proper operation is 2VOV = 2 (0.2 V) = 0.4 V. (e) From parts (c) and (d), the allowable range of signal swing at the output is from 0.4 V to 1.55 V – VOV or 1.35 V. so, 0.4 V ≤ vO ≤ 1.35 V. Ex: 7.23 Referring to Fig. 7.38, Ex: 7.22 Rop = (gm3 ro3 ) (ro4 rπ3 ) and VDD 1.8 V Ron = (gm2 ro2 ) (ro1 rπ2 ) I1 2I vi Q1 VG2 Q2 vo I2 I The maximum values of these resistances are obtained when ro rπ and are given by Ron = (gm2 ro2 ) rπ2 max Rop = (gm3 ro3 ) rπ3 max Since gm rπ = β, Ron = β 2 ro2 max Rop = β 3 ro3 max Exercise 7–6 Since Av = −gm1 Ron Rop , |Av max | = gm1 β 2 ro2 β 3 ro3 3.6 1 2 × 387 × × VOV 2 0.36 ⇒ VOV = 0.227 V 100 = VGS = 0.227 + 0.5 = 0.727 V Ex: 7.24 For the npn transistors, gm1 = gm2 |IC | 0.2 mA = = 8 mA/V = |VT | 25 mV VOmin = VG3 − Vt3 = VGS4 + VGS1 − Vt3 β 100 = 12.5 k = gm 8 mA/V Thus, rπ 1 = rπ 2 = ro1 = ro2 = |VA | 5V = 25 k = |IC | 0.2 mA = Vt + 2 VOV VOmin = 2VGS − Vt = 0.5 + 2 × 0.227 = 0.95 V From Fig. 7.38, Ron = (gm2 ro2 ) (ro1 rπ 2 ) = (8 mA/V) (25 k) (25 k 12.5 k) Ron = 1.67 M For the pnp transistors, gm3 = gm4 = rπ 3 = rπ 4 |IC | 0.2 mA = 8 mA/V = VT 25 mV β 50 = 6.25 k = = gm 8 mA/V ro3 = ro4 = |VA | 4V = 20 k = |IC | 0.2 mA Rop = (gm3 ro3 ) (ro4 rπ 3 ) = (8 mA/V) (20 k) (20 k 6.25 k) Rop = 762 k Av = −gm1 Ron Rop = − (8 mA/V) (1.67 M 762 k) Av = −4186 V/V gm = 2 ID 2 × 0.1 = 0.88 mA/V = VOV 0.227 ro = VA VL 5 × 0.36 = 18 k = A = ID ID 0.1 Ro = (gm3 ro3 )ro2 = (0.88 × 18) × 18 = 285 k Ex: 7.26 For the Wilson mirror from Eq. (7.94), we have IO 1 = 0.9998 2 IREF 1+ 2 β Thus |IO − IREF | × 100 = 0.02% IREF whereas for the simple mirror from Eq. (7.18) we have 1 IO = 0.98 = 2 IREF 1+ β |IO − IREF | × 100 = 2% IREF Av max occurs when ro1 and ro4 are rπ . Hence Then For the Wilson current mirror, we have Ron = (gm2 ro2 ) rπ 2 = β 2 ro2 Ron = 100 (25 k) = 2.5 M Rop = (gm3 ro3 ) rπ 3 = β 3 ro3 100 × 100 k βro = = 5 M 2 2 and for the simple mirror, Ro = ro = 100 k. Ro = Rop = 50 (20 k) = 1 M Finally, Av max = −(8 mA/V) (2.5 M 1.0 M) Av max = −5714 V/V Ex: 7.27 For the two current sources designed in Example 7.6, we have gm = IC 10 μA mA = = 0.4 VT 25 mV V VA 100 V = = 10 M, IC 10 μA β rn = = 250 k gm ro = Ex: 7.25 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 7.39. All transistors are operating at ID = IREF = 100 μA and equal VOV , found from 1 W 2 VOV ID = μn Cox 2 L For the current source in Fig. 7.43(b), we have Ro = ro2 = ro = 10 M Exercise 7–7 For the current source in Fig. 7.43, from Eq. (7.102), we have Rout [1 + gm (RE rn )] ro From Example 7.6, RE = R3 = 11.5 k; therefore, mA Rout 1 + 0.4 (11.5 k 250 k) 10 M V ∴ Rout = 54 M Gv ≡ vo = −145.5 V/V vsig These results apply for both Rsig = 4 k and Rsig = 400 k. If in the CC–CE amplifier of Example 7.7, Rsig = 400 k, Gv becomes Gv = 255 × 0.99 × −160 255 + 400 = −61.7 V/V Ex: 7.30 Ex: 7.28 2ID 2 × 0.2 = 2 mA/V gm = = VOV 0.2 gmb = χ gm = 0.2 × 2 = 0.4 mA/V ro1 = ro3 = VA 5 = 25 k = ID 0.2 RL = ro1 ro3 Rsig Q1 vsig Ex: 7.29 Q2 vo 1 = 25 25 2.5 k gmb = 2.083 k RL 2.083 vo = 0.81 V/V = = 1 1 vi RL + 2.083 + gm 2 re1 Rin RE (b2 1) (re2 RE) Rout From the figure we can write Rin = (β1 + 1)[re1 + (β2 + 1)(re2 + RE )] re1 + Rsig /(β1 + 1) Rout = RE re2 + β2 + 1 vo = vsig RE re1 + Rsig /(β1 + 1) RE + re2 + β2 + 1 For IE2 = 5 mA, β1 = β2 = 100, RE = 1 k, and Rsig = 100 k, we obtain 25 mV =5 5 mA 5 5 = = 0.05 mA β2 + 1 101 re2 = gm1 = 2k n ID √ = 2×8×1 = 4 mA/V 1 = 0.25 k gm1 gm2 = 40 mA/V 100 = 2.5 k 40 Rin = ∞ vsig vsig vi = = ib = 1 1 0.25 + 2.5 + rπ 2 + rπ 2 gm1 gm1 vsig = 2.75 100 × 4 vsig vo = −βib RL = − 2.75 rπ 2 = IE1 25 mV = 500 0.05 mA Rin = 101 × (0.5 + 101 × 1.005) = 10.3 M 0.5 + (100/101) 20 Rout = 1 0.005 + 101 re1 = vo = vsig 1 0.5 + (100/101) 1 + 0.005 + 101 = 0.98 V/V Ex: 7.31 Refer to Fig. 7.49. re = 25 Rin = (β1 + 1)(2 re ) = 101 × 0.05 = 5.05 k Exercise 7–8 α2 RL 5 vo = = 100 V/V vi 2 re 0.05 vi vo vo = × vsig vsig vi Thus, Rin vo = × Rin + Rsig vi 1 vo = gm RL vi 2 = and vo = iRL where 5.05 × 100 = 50 V/V 5.05 + 5 gm = 2ID 2I = VOV VOV Thus, Ex: 7.32 2I 1 IRL vo = × RL = vi 2 VOV VOV (b) I = 0.1 mA and RL = 20 k, to obtain a gain of 10 V/V, RL i vo vi Q1 1 gm1 (a) From the figure we see that i= 1 vi = gm v i 2/gm 2 10 = 0.1 × 20 VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V Q2 i Q.E.D 1 gm2 The required W/L can be obtained from W 1 2 VOV ID = k n 2 L W 1 0.1 = × 0.2 × × 0.04 2 L ⇒ W = 25 L Chapter 7–1 7.1 Referring to Fig. 7.1, VDD = 1.3 V, IO = IREF = 100 μA, L = 0.5 μm, W = 5 μm, VA = 5 V/μm, Vt = 0.4 V, k n = 500 μA/V2 1 W 2 IO = ID = k n VOV 2 L 2I D VOV = W kn L 2 (100 μA) = 0.2 V = 5 500 μA/V2 0.5 VDS = VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.4 + 0.2 = 0.6 V 1.8 − 0.6 VDD − VGS = = 12 k R= IREF 0.1 mA 7.3 VDD VDD Q1 Q2 VO IREF R IO Set |VOV | = VDD − VOmax = 1.3 − 1.1 = 0.2 V The lowest VO will be VG = VDD − Vtp − |VOV | VDS2 = VOV = 0.2 V = 1.3 − 0.4 − 0.2 = 0.7 V RO = ro = ID ≈ VA L ID = 5 V/ μm × 0.5 μm = 25 k 100 μA VO 0.5 V = = 20 μA ro 25 K 7.2 Refer to Fig. 7.1. IO = 10% IO IO = 0.1 × 150 = 15 μA VO = 1.8 − 0.3 = 1.5 V ro = VO 1.5 V = 100 k = IO 15 μA thus 2ID 2 × 80 μA W = = = 50 L 80 μA/V2 × 0.22 μp Cox |VOV |2 7.4 Referring to Fig. 7.2, if W2 = 5 W1 and we let L1 = L2 , then we obtain IO = ID2 = IREF (W/L)2 = 20 μA × 5 = 100 μA (W/L)1 VOmin = VOV = 0.2 V But ro = 0.7 V VG = = 8.75 k ID1 80 μA 1 W |VOV |2 ID = μp Cox 2 L R= VA L VA = IO IO 10 × L ⇒ L = 1.5 μm 0.15 ⇒ VA = 15 V 100 = From Eq. (7.8): IO = VO − VGS (W/L)2 · IREF 1 + VA2 (W/L)1 VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.5 V + 0.2 V = 0.7 V VOV = VDS2min = 0.3 V Thus, ID equal 5IREF will be obtained at VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.5 + 0.3 = 0.8 V 1 W VDS 2 1+ VOV ID = k n 2 L VA W 0.8 1 × 0.09 1 + 150 = × 400 × 2 L 15 VO = VGS = 0.7 V W = 7.91 L W = 7.91 × 1.5 = 11.9 μm ⇒ 1.8 − 0.8 VDD − VGS = = 6.7 k R= IREF 0.15 For VO = VGS + 1 = 1.7 V 1.7 − 0.7 = 105 μA IO = 100 1 + 20 The corresponding increase in IO , IO is, thus, 5 μA. 7.5 Referring to the figure on the next page, suppose that Q1 has W = 10 μm, Q2 has W = 20 μm, and Q3 has W = 40 μm. Chapter 7–2 This figure belongs to Problem 7.5. To find VSG , we use the following for the diode-connected transistor(s): 1 W ID = μp Cox (VSG − |Vtp |)2 2 L VDD Q1 Q2 I1 Q3 I2 I3 IREF and substitute ID = IREF = 100 μA. Thus 1 W 100 = × 100 × (VSG − 0.6)2 2 1 μm ⇒ VSG = 0.6 + 2 W (μm) For the six cases above we obtain (1) With Q1 diode connected, 20 (W/L)2 = 200 μA = 100 μA I2 = IREF 10 (W/L)1 40 = 400 μA I3 = 100 μA 10 (2) With Q2 diode connected, and W = 20 μm, 10 = 50 μA I1 = 100 μA 20 40 = 200 μA I3 = 100 μA 20 (3) If Q3 with W = 40 μm is diode connected, 10 = 25 μA I1 = 100 μA 40 20 = 50 μA I2 = 100 μA 40 So, with only one transistor diode connected, we can get 25 μA, 50 μA, 200 μA, and 400 μA, or four different currents. (1) W = W1 = 10 μm ⇒ VSG = 1.05 V (2) W = W2 = 20 μm ⇒ VSG = 0.92 V (3) W = W3 = 40 μm ⇒ VSG = 0.82 V (4) W = W1 + W2 = 30 μm ⇒ VSG = 0.86 V (5) W = W2 + W3 = 60 μm ⇒ VSG = 0.78 V (6) W = W1 + W3 = 50 μm ⇒ VSG = 0.80 V 7.6 Refer to the circuit of Fig. P7.6. For Q2 to operate properly (i.e., in the saturation mode) for drain voltages as high as +0.8 V, and provided its width is the minimum possible, we use |VOV | = 0.2 V Note that all three transistors Q1 , Q2 , and Q3 will be operated at this value of overdrive voltage. For Q1 , Weff = 20 + 10 = 30 μm, so that 40 = 133 μA I3 = 100 μA 30 ID1 = IREF = 20 μA 1 W ID1 = μp Cox |VOV |2 2 L 1 W 1 20 = × 100 × × 0.04 2 L 1 W = 10 ⇒ L 1 (5) If Q2 and Q3 are diode connected, then For L = 0.5 μm, Weff = 20 + 40 = 60 μm, so that 10 = 16.7 μA I1 = 100 μA 60 W1 = 5 μm Now, if two transistors are diode connected, the effective width is the sum of the two widths. (4) If Q1 and Q2 are diode connected, then (6) If Q1 and Q3 are diode connected, Weff = 10 + 40 = 50 μm, so that 20 = 40 μA I2 = 100 μA 50 So three different currents are obtained with double-diode connects. Now, for I2 = 100 μA = 5IREF , we have (W/L)2 =5 (W/L)1 W ⇒ = 5 × 10 = 50 L 2 W2 = 50 × 0.5 = 25 μm Chapter 7–3 7.7 Referring to Fig. P7.5, we obtain For I3 = 40 μA = 2IREF , we obtain (W/L)3 =2 (W/L)1 W ⇒ = 20 L 3 W3 = 10 μm We next consider Q4 and Q5 . For Q5 to operate in saturation with the drain voltage as low as −0.8 V, and for it to have the minimum possible W/L, we operate Q5 at VGS1 = VGS2 so that ID2 = IREF ID2 (W/L)2 = and ID1 (W/L)1 (W/L)2 (W/L)1 ID3 = ID2 VGS3 = VGS4 , thus IO = ID4 = IREF ID4 (W/L)4 = ID3 (W/L)3 (W/L)2 (W/L)4 . (W/L)1 (W/L)3 VOV = 0.2 V This is the same overdrive voltage at which Q4 will be operating. Thus, we can write for Q4 , I4 = I3 = 40 μA and using 1 W μn Cox V2 2 L 4 OV 1 W 40 = × 400 × × 0.22 2 L 4 W ⇒ =5 L 4 ID4 = W4 = 2.5 μm Finally, since I5 = 80 μA = 2 I4 , W W =2 L 5 L 4 W ⇒ = 10 L 5 W5 = 5 μm To find the value of R, we use |VSG1 | = |Vtp | + |VOV 1 | = 0.5 + 0.2 = 0.7 V R= 1 − |VSG1 | 0.3 V = IREF 0.02 mA = 15 k 7.8 (a) If IS = 10−17 A and we ignore base currents, then IREF = IS eVBE /VT so that IREF VBE = VT ln 10−17 For IREF = 10 μA, −5 10 VBE = 0.025 ln = 0.691 V 10−17 For IREF = 10 mA, −2 10 = 0.863 V VBE = 0.025 ln 10−17 So for the range of 10 μA ≤ IREF ≤ 10 mA, 0.691 V ≤ VBE ≤ 0.863 V (b) Accounting for finite β, IO = IREF · For IREF = 10 μA, IO = |VAp |×L |VA2 | = I2 I2 10 μA = 9.62 μA 2 1+ 50 For IREF = 0.1 mA, IO = The output resistance of the current source Q2 is ro2 = 1 1 + 2/β 0.1 mA = 0.098 mA 2 1+ 100 For IREF = 1 mA, 1 mA = 0.98 mA 2 1+ 100 5 × 0.5 = 25 k = 0.1 mA IO = The output resistance of the current sink Q5 is For IREF = 10 mA, ro5 VA5 V × L = = An I5 I5 = 5 × 0.5 = 31.25 k 80 IO = 10 mA = 9.62 mA 2 1+ 50 Chapter 7–4 7.11 7.9 VDD VDD Q1 Q2 IO IREF IO = mIC1 A node equation at the collector of Q1 yields IREF For identical transistors, the transfer ratio is 1 IO = = IREF 1 + 2/β IO + IC1 = IC1 + β 1 1+ 2 50 = 0.96 Substituting IC1 = IO /m results in m m+1 1+ β IO = IREF Q.E.D. For β = 80 and the error in the current transfer ratio to be limited to 10%, that is, m ≥ 0.9m m+1 1+ β 1+ m+1 β ≤ 1 0.9 1 m+1 ≤ −1 β 0.9 m≤β 1 −1 −1 0.9 1 − 1 − 1 = 7.88 m ≤ 80 0.9 Thus, the largest current transfer ratio possible is 7.88. 7.10 Nominally, IO = IREF = 1 mA ro2 = VA2 90 = = 90 k IO 1 ro2 = VO 10 − 1 ⇒ = 90 ⇒ IO = 0.1 mA IO IO 0.1 IO = = 10% change IO 1 7.12 Equation (7.21) gives the current transfer ratio of an npn mirror with a nominal ratio of m: VO − VBE m IO = IREF 1+ m+1 VA2 1+ β This equation can be adapted for the pnp mirror of Fig. P7.12 by substituting m = 1, replacing VO with the voltage across Q3 , namely (3 − VO ), replacing VBE with VEB , and VA2 with |VA |: IO = IREF 1 + [(3 − VO − VEB )/|VA |] 1 + (2/β) (1) Now, substituting IO = 1 mA, VO = 1 V, β = 50, |VA | = 50 V, and −3 IO 10 = 0.691 V VEB = VT ln = 0.025 ln IS 10−15 results in 1 × (1 + 0.04) = 1.013 mA 3 − 1 − 0.691 1+ 50 3 − 0.691 VCC − VEB = 2.28 k = R= IREF 1.013 IREF = Maximum allowed voltage VO = 3 − 0.3 = 2.7 V. For VO = 2.7 V, Eq. (1) yields 3 − 2.7 − 0.691 50 = 0.966 mA IO = 1.013 1.04 For VO = −5 V, Eq. (1) yields 1+ 3 − (−5) − 0.691 50 = 1.116 mA IO = 1.013 1.04 Thus, the change in IO is 0.15 mA. 1+ Chapter 7–5 This figure belongs to Problem 7.13. 7.13 The solution is given in the circuit diagram. Note that the starting point is calculating the current I in the Q1 –R1 –Q2 branch. See figure above. Even without knowing exact circuitry, we can find the total power dissipation as approximately PT = PCC + PEE PT = 5 V (0.1 + 0.2 + 0.4 + 0.8) mA 7.14 There are various ways this design could be achieved, but the most straightforward is the one shown: 4 2 Q1 1 8 +5 V (0.1 + 0.5 + 1 + 2) mA PT = 7.5 mW + 18 mW = 25.5 mW 7.15 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P7.15. V2 = 2.7 − VEB = 2.7 − 0.7 = +2 V R 0.2 mA 0.4 mA 0.5 mA Q2 1 5 1 mA 10 0.8 mA 2 mA 20 V3 = 0 + VEB = +0.7 V Thus, Q3 and Q4 are operating in the active mode, and each is carrying a collector current of I /2. The same current is flowing in Q2 and Q1 ; thus I V1 = −2.7 + R 2 With this scheme, But 5 − 0.7 − 0.7 − (−5) = 86 k 0.1 mA and each transistor has EBJ areas proportional to the current required. Multiple, parallel transistors are acceptable. Thus, Note: This large value of R is not desirable in integrated form; other designs may be move suitable. ⇒ IR = 4 V R= V1 = −VBE1 = −0.7 1 −0.7 = −2.7 + IR 2 Chapter 7–6 The current I splits equally between Q5 and Q6 ; thus V4 = −2.7 + (b) I R = −2.7 + 2 = −0.7 V 2 I R = −2.7 + 1 = −1.7 V V5 = −2.7 + 2 2 Thus, Q5 and Q6 are operating in the active mode as we have implicitly assumed. Note that the values of V1 , V2 , V3 , V4 , and V5 do not depend on the value of R. Only I depends on the value of R: (a) R = 10 k ⇒ I = 4 = 0.4 mA 10 (b) R = 100 k ⇒ I = 4 = 0.04 mA 100 Figure 2 Figure 2 shows the special case of V = 0 V. As before, the voltage at X, VX , will be equal to V . Thus VX = 0 7.16 (a) That is, a virtual ground appears at X, and thus the current I that flows into X can be found from I= 5 − VX 5−0 = = 0.5 mA 10 k 10 This is the current that will be mirrored to the output, resulting in IZ = 0.5 mA. (W/L)2 (W/L)1 7.17 Ais = 4 = Since L1 = L2 , then W2 =4 W1 Figure 1 1 gm1 Rin = ro1 1 gm1 For Figure 1 shows the current conveyor circuit with Y connected to a voltage V , X fed with a current source I , and Z connected to a voltage VZ that keeps Q5 operating in the active mode. Assuming that all transistors are operating in the active mode and that β 1, so that we can neglect all base currents, we see that the current I through Q1 will flow through the two-output mirror Q3 , Q4 , and Q5 . The current I in Q5 will be drawn from Q2 , which forms a mirror with Q1 . Thus VEB2 = VEB1 and the voltage that appears at X will be equal to V . The current in Q5 will be equal to I , thus terminal Z sinks a constant current I . Rin = 500 ⇒ gm1 = 2 mA/V gm1 = 2μn Cox W L ID1 1 Thus, 2= ⇒ 2 × 0.4 × W L = 25 1 W L × 0.2 1 Chapter 7–7 RO = ro2 = VA VL = A ID2 ID2 Thus, the small-signal voltage gain will be vo = gm1 RL (W3 /W2 ) vi Thus, 20 = 20 L 4 × 0.2 7.19 Replacing Q1 and Q2 with their small-signal hybrid-π models results in the equivalent circuit shown in the figure below. Observe that the controlled source gm1 vπ1 appears across its controlling voltage vπ1 ; thus the controlled source can be replaced with a resistance (1/gm1 ). The input resistance Rin can now be obtained by inspection as ⇒ L = 0.8 μm W1 = 25 × 0.8 = 20 μm W2 = 4W1 = 80 μm 7.18 Refer to Fig. P7.18. Consider first the diode-connected transistor Q2 . From the figure we Rin = ro1 1 gm1 rπ1 rπ2 Since ro1 rπ1 , g2 d2 g2, d2 Rin vgs2 1 gm2 gm2vgs2 S3 io = gm2 vπ2 Since vπ2 = vπ1 = ii Rin , then the short-circuit current gain Ais is given by see that from a small-signal point of view it is equivalent to a resistance 1/gm2 . Thus the voltage gain of Q1 will be Ais = vd 1 1 gm1 = −gm1 × =− vi gm2 gm2 io = gm2 Rin ii = gm2 The signal current in the drain of Q1 , gm1 vi , will be mirror in the drain of Q3 ; 1 gm1 (2) rπ1 rπ2 For situations where β1 and β2 are large, we can neglect rπ1 and rπ2 in Eqs. (1) and (2) to obtain (W/L)3 W3 = gm1 vi (W/L)2 W2 which flows through RL and produces the output voltage vo , vo = id 3 RL = gm1 vi (1) rπ1 rπ2 The short-circuit output current io is given by S2 id 3 = gm1 vi 1 gm1 Rin 1/gm1 Ais gm1 /gm2 W3 RL W2 This figure belongs to Problem 7.19. C1 B1, B2 ii vp1 ro1 Rin gm1vp1 C2 rp1 io rp2 vp2 ro2 gm2vp2 Ro Chapter 7–8 7.21 Refer to Fig. 7.11. 7.20 (a) IREF = 0.1 mA IC1 g vgs d 1 mA VBE1 = 0.7 − 0.025 ln 0.1 mA g,d s = 0.642 V 1 gm gmvgs s IC1 β 0.1 = 0.002 mA 100 1 mA = 0.7 − 0.025 ln 0.002 mA =2× Figure 1 VBE3 Replacing the MOSFET with its hybrid-π model but neglecting ro results in the equivalent circuit in Fig. 1. Observing that the controlled-source gm vgs appears across its control voltage vgs , we can replace it by a resistance 1/gm , as indicated. Thus the small-signal resistance of the diode-connected MOS transistor is 1/gm . For the given values, W ID gm = 2μn Cox L √ = 2 × 0.2 × 10 × 0.1 = 0.632 mA/V = 0.545 V Vx = VBE3 + VBE1 = 1.187 V If IREF is increased to 1 mA, VBE1 = 0.7 IC3 0.02 mA 1 = 0.6 V VBE3 = 0.7 − 0.025 ln 0.02 Vx = 1.3 V Thus, 1 = 1.6 k gm Vx = 1.3 − 1.187 = 0.113 V (b) Replacing the BJT with its hybrid-π model results in the equivalent circuit in Fig. 2. Observing that the controlled-source gm vπ appears across its control voltage vπ , we can replace it by a resistance 1/gm , as indicated. Next the two parallel resistances 1/gm and rπ can be combined as 1 × rπ rπ rπ gm = re = = 1 1 + gm rπ β +1 + rπ gm When VO = Vx , the Early effect on Q1 and Q2 will be the same, and IO = IREF /(1 + 2/β 2 ) Thus, IO will be 100 = 1 + (2/1002 ) 99.98 μA, for an error of −0.02 μA or −0.02%. IREF = 100 μA ⇒ IO = 1 = 1 + (2/1002 ) 0.9998 μA, for an error of −0.0002 mA or −0.02%. For proper current-source operation, the minimum required voltage at the output is the value needed to keep Q3 in the active region, which is approximately 0.3 V. IREF = 1 mA ⇒ IO = Thus, the diode-connected BJT has a small-signal resistance re . For the given data, re = IB1 + IB2 = 2 IB1 = 2 × IC3 VT 25 mV = 250 = IE 0.1 mA This figure belongs to Problem 7.20, part (b). Figure 2 Chapter 7–9 7.22 Refer to Fig. 7.11 and observe that IC1 IREF and IC2 = IC1 ; thus each of Q1 and Q2 is operating at a collector bias current approximately equal to IREF . Transistor Q3 is operating at an emitter bias current IE3 = IB1 + IB2 = 2IB = 2IC /β = 2(1 − α) IC α Now, using ix = αie from Eq. (1), we have Thus, vx 2VT = ix IREF Rin ≡ 2(1 − α) IREF α Replacing each of the three transistors with its T model and applying an input test voltage vx to determine Rin , we obtain the equivalent circuit shown. = 2VT IREF vx = ix × Q.E.D. For IREF = 100 μA = 0.1 mA, 2 × 25 mV = 500 0.1 mA Rin = 7.23 IREF C3 IB3 aie3 ix B3 x B1 i b1 re1 ie1 ib2 B2 IO2 Q21 IO aie2 E3 IO1 b IO3 IOn IE3 Q1 C2 re3 aie1 vx IC1 Out ie3 C1 Q3 X Q22 Q23 Q2n nIO b ve re2 ie2 IO1 = IO2 = IO3 · · · = IOn = IO = IC1 The emitter of Q3 supplies the base currents for all transistor, so IE3 = In this equivalent circuit, re1 = re2 = re = re3 = VT αVT αVT = = IE IC IREF IREF = IB3 + IO = VT αVT = IE3 2(1 − α)IREF IO = IREF ie1 = ie2 = ie ix = αie1 + (1 − α)ie3 7.24 For I = 10 μA: = ie [α + 2(1 − α)2 ] α. Thus, (1) vx = ie3 re3 + ie1 re1 = 2(1 − α)ie vx = αie αVT αVT + ie 2(1 − α)IREF IREF VT VT + IREF IREF 1 n+1 1+ β2 ⇒ nmax = 0.002 × 1502 − 1 = 44 = αie + (1 − α) × 2(1 − α)ie αie 1 (n + 1) 1+ β (β + 1) n+1 ≤ 0.002 β2 From the figure we obtain ix (n + 1) IO + IO β (β + 1) For the deviation from unity to be kept ≤ 0.2% ie3 = ib1 + ib2 = 2(1 − α)ie But 2(1 − α)2 (n + 1) IO β gm = I 10 μA = = 0.4 mA/V VT 25 mV rπ = β 100 = = 250 k gm 0.4 mA/V ro = 10 V VA = = 1 M I 10 μA A0 = gm ro = VA 10 V = 400 V/V = VI 0.025 V Chapter 7–10 For I = 100 μA: VA 100 V = 200 k = IC 0.5 mA ro = 100 μA = 4 mA/V 25 mV 100 = 25 k rπ = 4 mA/V gm = Rin = rπ = β 100 = = 5 k gm 20 mA/V Av o = −A0 = −gm ro = −20×200 = −4000 V/V 10 V = 100 k ro = 100 μA Ro = ro = 200 k A0 = 4 mA/V × 100 k = 400 V/V To raise Rin by a factor of 5 by changing I , the value of I must be lowered by the same factor to I = 0.1 mA. VCC Now, gm is reduced by a factor of 5 and ro is increased by a factor of 5, keeping Av o unchanged at −4000 V/V. However, Ro will be increased to I Ro = 5 × 200 k = 1 M vo If the amplifier is fed with a signal source having Rsig = 5 k and a 100-k load resistance is connected to the output, the equivalent circuit shown below results. rπ vo = × −gm (ro RL ) vsig rπ + Rsig Q1 vi For I = 1 mA: 1 mA = 40 mA/V gm = 25 mV 100 = 2.5 k rπ = 40 mA/V =− 10 V = 10 k 1 mA A0 = 40 mA/V × 10 k = 400 V/V A0 = 2VA 2VA L 2 × 10 × 0.5 = 50 V/V = = VOV VOV 0.2 gm = 2ID VOV = −303 V/V 7.26 ro = I gm rπ 10 μA 0.4 mA/V 250 k ro A0 1 M 400 V/V 2= 40 mA/V 2.5 k 10 k 400 V/V 0.2 = ⇒ 7.25 Refer to Fig. 7.13(b). gm = 2ID ⇒ ID = 0.2 mA 0.2 ID = 100 μA 4.0 mA/V 25 k 100 k 400 V/V 1 mA 25 × 4 (1000 k 100 k) 25 + 5 IC I 0.5 mA = = 20 mA/V = VT VT 0.025 V 1 W 2 k V 2 n L OV 1 W × 0.4 × × 0.22 2 L W = 25 L W = 12.5 μm This figure belongs to Problem 7.25. Rsig 5 k vsig rp 25 k vp gmvp gm 4 mA/V ro 1 M vo RL 100 k Chapter 7–11 7.27 A0 = 2VA 2VA L = VOV VOV VA = 5 × 0.3 = 1.5 V A0 = gm ro = 1 × 15 = 15 V/V 1 W 2 μn Cox VOV 2 L W 1 × 0.22 100 = × 387 × 2 L W ⇒ = 13 ⇒ W = 3.9 μm L ID = 2ID 2I = gm = VOV VOV 2I 0.2 ⇒ I = 0.2 mA 1 W 2 VOV ID = μn Cox 2 L 2= 0.2 = VA 1.5 V = 15 k = ID 0.1 mA ro = 2×5×L 0.2 ⇒ L = 0.4 μm 20 = 7.31 gm = W 1 × 0.4 × × 0.04 2 L 2ID 2 × 0.1 = 0.4 mA/V = VOV 0.5 W = 25 ⇒ L From Table J.1 (Appendix J), we find that for the 0.5-μm process |VA | = 20 V/μm. Thus for our 1-μ-m long transistor, VA = 20 V. 7.28 ro = VA 20 V = = 200 k ID 0.1 mA A0 = gm ro = 0.4 × 200 = 80 V/V From Table J.1: μn Cox = 190 μA/V2 Now, ID = 1 W 2 μn Cox VOV 2 L 100 = The highest instantaneous voltage allowed at the drain is that which results in a voltage equal to (VOV ) across the transistor. Thus vOmax = 1.8 − 0.2 = +1.6 V IC 0.1 mA = = 4 mA/V VT 0.025 V ro = For the NMOS transistor, Rin = rπ = 2ID 4= 0.25 ⇒ ID = 0.5 mA 2ID 2 × 0.1 = 1 mA/V = VOV 0.2 From Table K.1 (Appendix K), for the 0.18-μm process we have |VA | = 5 V/μm, μn Cox = 387 μA/V VA 100 V = IC IC A0 = gm ro = 2ID gm = VOV 7.30 gm = W = 4.21 L ⇒ W = 4.21 μm ⇒ 7.32 For the BJT cell: IC IC = gm = VT 0.025 V 7.29 For the npn transistor, gm = 1 W × 190 × × 0.25 2 L 2 Thus, for our NMOS transistor whose L = 0.3 μm, VA 100 V = 4000 V/V = VT 0.025 V β 100 = gm gm For the MOSFET cell: W ID = gm = 2μn Cox L = ro = 2 × 0.2 × 40 × ID 16ID = 4 ID mA/V (ID in mA) VA 10 V = ID ID 40 A0 = gm ro = √ V/V (ID in mA) ID Rin = ∞ Chapter 7–12 BJT Cell Bias current MOSFET Cell IC = 0.1 IC = 1 ID = 0.1 ID = 1 mA mA mA mA gm = 80 × 3.16 = 253 μA/V = 0.253 mA/V and ro decreases by a factor of 10 to gm (mA/V) 4 40 1.26 4 0.18 M = 18 k 10 Thus, A0 becomes ro (k) 1000 100 100 10 A0 = 0.253 × 18 = 4.55 V/V A0 (V/V) 4000 4000 126 40 Rin (k) 25 2.5 ∞ ∞ (c) If the device is redesigned with a new value of W so that it operates at ro = VOV = 0.25 V for ID = 100 μA, 7.33 Using Eq. (7.46), A0 = 18 = 2ID 0.2 mA = 0.8 mA/V = VOV 0.25 V ro = VA L 5 × 0.36 = = 18 k ID 0.1 VA 2(μn Cox ) (WL) ID √ 5 2 × 0.4 × 8 × 0.54 × 0.54 ID ⇒ ID = 0.144 mA 7.34 2VA 2VA L 2 × 6 × 0.5 = = = 40 V/V VOV VOV 0.15 1 W 2 VOV ID = k n 2 L A0 = 100 = 1 W × 400 × × 0.152 2 L W = 22.2 L Thus, ⇒ W = 22.2 × 0.5 = 11.1 μm gm = 2ID 2 × 0.1 = = 1.33 mA/V VOV 0.15 ro = VA L 6 × 0.5 = = 30 k ID 0.1 VA L VA = ID ID From Appendix J, Table J.1, (d) If the redesigned device in (c) is operated √ at 10 μA, VOV decreases by a factor equal to 10 to 0.08 √ V, gm decreases by a factor of 10 to 0.253 mA/V, ro increases by a factor of 10 to 180 k, and A0 becomes 0.253 × 180 = 45.5 V/V which is an increase by a factor of √ 10. (e) The lowest value of A0 is obtained with the first design when operated at ID = 100 μA. The resulting A0 = 4.55 V/V. The highest value of A0 is obtained with the second design when operated at ID = 10 μA. The resulting A0 = 45.5 V/V. If in any design W/L is held constant while L is increased by a factor of 10, gm remains unchanged but ro increases by a factor of 10, resulting in A0 increasing by a factor of 10. 100 = 2ID 2 × 10 = 80 μA/V = (a) gm = VOV 0.25 VA A0 = gm ro = 0.8 × 18 = 14.4 V/V 7.36 A0 = |Av o | = 100 7.35 L = 0.36 μm, VOV = 0.25 V, ID = 10 μA ro = gm = = 5 V/μm, 5 × 0.36 = 0.18 M 10 A0 = gm ro = 80 × 0.18 = 14.4 V/V ro = 2VA 2VA = VOV 0.2 ⇒ VA = 10 V Since VA = 20 V/ μm, we have L= 10 VA = 0.5 μm = VA 20 1 W 2 k V 2 n L OV W 1 × 0.22 50 = × 200 × 2 L W ⇒ = 12.5 L ID = (b) If ID is increased to 100 μA (i.e., √ by a factor of 10), VOV increases by a factor of 10 = 3.16 to 7.37 Refer to Fig. 7.15(a). VOV = 0.25 × 3.16 = 0.79 V VSG2 = |Vtp | + |VOV | = 0.5 + 0.3 = 0.8 V √ and gm increases by a factor of 10 = 3.16 to VG = 2.5 − VSG2 = 2.5 − 0.8 = 1.7 V Chapter 7–13 1 W V2 μn Cox 2 L 1 OV 1 W 1 100 = × 200 × × 0.32 2 L 1 W ⇒ = 11.1 L 1 1 W |VOV 2 |2 ID2 = μp Cox 2 L 2 W 1 100 = × 100 × × 0.32 2 L 2 W ⇒ = 22.2 L 2 ID1 = Av = −gm1 (ro1 ro2 ) gm1 2ID 2 × 0.1 = = 0.67 mA/V = VOV 0.3 ro1 = ro2 = |VA |L 20 × 0.5 = 100 k = ID 0.1 Av = −0.67 × (100 100) = −33.5 V/V 7.39 Refer to Fig. P7.39. The gain of the first stage is Av 1 = −gm1 (ro1 /2) where (ro1 /2) is the equivalent resistance at the output of Q1 and includes ro1 in parallel with the output resistance of the current-source load, which is equal to ro1 . Similarly, the gain of the second stage is Av 2 = −gm2 (ro2 /2) Now because VAn = |VAp | = |VA | and both Q1 and Q2 are operating at equal currents I , we have ro1 = ro2 = ro The overall voltage gain Av will be Av = Av 1 Av 2 1 gm1 gm2 ro2 4 If the two transistors are operated at equal overdrive voltages, |VOV |, both will have equal gm , Av = Av = = |VAp | and 7.38 Refer to Fig. 7.15. Since VAn the channel lengths are equal, VAn = |VAp | and ro1 = ro2 = ro . Thus and gm ro = Av = −gm1 (ro1 ro2 ) = −gm1 (ro /2) 1 −40 = − gm1 ro 2 ⇒ gm1 ro = 80 A0 = 2VAn 2VAn L = VOV VOV 1 (gm ro )2 4 2×5 10 2|VA | = = |VOV | |VOV | |VOV | Av = 400 = 10 1 × 4 |VOV | 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 0.25 V 7.40 2×5×L 0.25 ⇒ L = 2 μm 80 = 3 M 200 A VSG2 = |Vtp | + |VOV | = 0.5 + 0.25 = 0.75 V VG = VDD − VSG2 = 1.8 − 0.75 = 1.05 V 1 W V2 ID1 = μn Cox 2 L 1 OV 1 W 100 = × 400 × × 0.252 2 L 1 W ⇒ =8 L 1 1 W |VOV |2 ID2 = μp Cox 2 L 2 W 1 100 = × 100 × × 0.252 2 L 2 W = 32 L 2 ID IR 2 M VGS Figure 1 (a) Neglecting the dc current in the feedback network and the Early effect, we see from Fig. 1 that ID = 200 μA. Now, using 1 W 2 VOV ID = μn Cox 2 L Chapter 7–14 The MOSFET will remain in saturation as long as VDG ≥ −Vt . Thus at the limit VDG = −0.5 V, we can determine VOV : 1 2 × 2 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.45 V 0.2 = vGmax = 0.5 + vDmin VGS + | v̂i | = 0.5 + VDS − | v̂o | VGS = Vt + VOV = 0.5 + 0.45 = 0.95 V The current in the feedback network can now be found as VGS 0.95 = = 0.475 μA IR = 2 M 2 which indeed is much smaller than the 200 μA delivered by the current source. Thus, we were justified in neglecting IR above. (b) Replacing the MOSFET with its hybrid-π model, we obtain the equivalent circuit shown in Fig. 2. ii vi RG1 2 M Rin vgs 0.5 + 2.375 − 0.95 1 1+ |Av | Substituting |Av | = 86.5, we obtain | v̂o | = 1.9 V An approximate value of | v̂o | could have been obtained from vOmin = VOV = 0.45 V VDS − | v̂o | = VOV vovi RG2 gmvgs ro vo vgs vi Figure 2 A node equation at the output node yields vo − vi vo + gm vgs + =0 ro RG2 where vgs = vi . Thus, 1 1 1 + = −vi gm − vo ro RG2 RG2 1 vo = − gm − (ro RG2 ) RG2 vi gm = | v̂o | = | v̂o | = 0.5 + 2.375 − | v̂o | |Av | Thus, RG2 3 M 0.95 + 2ID 2 × 0.2 = 0.894 mA/V = VOV 0.45 VA 20 = 100 k = ID 0.2 1 vo = − 0.89 − × (100 3000) vi 3000 ro = = −86.5 V/V To obtain the maximum allowable negative signal swing at the output, we first determine the dc voltage at the output by referring to Fig. 1, RG2 VDS = VGS 1 + RG1 3 = 0.95 × 1 + = 2.375 V 2 ⇒ | v̂o | = VDS − VOV = 2.375 − 0.45 = 1.925 V |v̂ o | = 22 mV |v̂ i | = 86.5 (c) To determine Rin , refer to Fig. 2, vi vo − vi − ii = RG1 RG2 vi Av v i − v i = − RG1 RG2 (1 − Av ) 1 + RG1 RG2 vi 1 (1 − Av ) =1 + Rin = ii RG1 RG2 1 (1 + 86.5) + = 33.7 k =1 2 3 = vi 7.41 From the results of Example 7.4, we see that the almost linear region of the transfer characteristic (i.e., region 3) is defined by VIA = 0.89 V and VIB = 0.935 V. Maximum output signal swing is achieved by biasing Q1 at the middle of this range; thus VI = 0.913 V The peak-to-peak amplitude at the output will be (VOA − VOB ) = 2.47 − 0.335 = 2.135 V. Thus the 1 peak amplitude will be (2.135) = 1.07 V. 2 7.42 Refer to Fig. 7.16(a). Ro = 100 k = ro1 ro2 Chapter 7–15 thus But ro1 |VA | 5 = ro2 = = IREF IREF VOV 1 = 0.2 V Since ID2 = ID3 = ID1 = 50 μA Thus, Av = −gm1 Ro 1 2 , we have μ Cox (W/L) VOV 2 p W 2ID2 W = = L 2 L 3 μp COX (VOV )2 −40 = −gm1 × 100 = 100 = 5 1 × 2 IREF and ID = ⇒ IREF = 25 μA 2 (50 μA) = 29.1 86 μA/V2 (0.2 V)2 ⇒ gm1 = 0.4 mA/V But gm1 = 2μn Cox W L ID1 1 W 0.4 = 2 × 0.4 × 0.025 L 1 W ⇒ =8 L 1 1 W ID1 = μn Cox V2 2 L 1 OV 1 1 2 × 400 × 8 × VOV 1 2 ⇒ VOV 1 = 0.125 V 25 = If Q2 and Q3 are operated at |VOV | = 0.125 V, 1 W |VOV |2 ID2 = ID3 = μp Cox 2 L 2,3 1 W 25 = × 100 × × 0.1252 2 L 2,3 W ⇒ = 32 L 2,3 For Q1 , 2 (50 μA) W = = 6.46 L 1 387 μA/V2 (0.2 V)2 Av must be at least −10 V/V and Av = −gm (ro1 gm1 = ro2 ) 2ID 2 × 0.05 = 0.5 mA/V = VOV 1 0.2 ro1 ro2 = 10 = 20 k 0.5 But ro1 = VA1 V L 5L = 100L = An = ID1 ID1 0.05 ro2 = |VAp |L |VA2 | 6L = 120L = = ID2 ID2 0.05 Thus, 100L 120L = 20 k ⇒ L = 0.367 μm If L is to be an integer multiple of 0.18 μm, then L = 0.54 μm 7.43 To raise the gain to 20 V/V, ro1 ro2 has to be raised to 40 k, which requires L = 2 × 0.367 = 0.734 Again, to use a multiple of 0.18 μm we select L = 0.9 μm. This represents an increase in L by a 5 0.90 = . Ws will have to increase by factor of 0.54 3 the same factor. Thus, the area of each transistor 2 5 and the total will increase by a factor of 3 area will increase as follows: For an output of 1.6 V, VSD2min = |VOV 2 | = 1.8 − 1.6 = 0.2 V, Initial total area = Area of Q1 + Area of Q2 + Area of Q3 For an output of 0.2 V, = 6.46 × 0.542 + 29.1 × 0.542 + 29.1 × 0.542 VDS1min = 0.2 V, = 18.85 μm2 Chapter 7–16 New total area = 6.46 × 0.92 + 29.1 × 0.92 + 29.1 × 0.92 Therefore the extreme values of vO for which Q1 and Q2 are in saturation 0.33 V ≤ vO ≤ 2.98 V = 52.37 μm2 (c) From (b) we can find VIA and VIB : Thus, the increase is by a factor of 2.78. VIB = VOB + Vt = 0.33 + 0.8 = 1.13 V If we solve (1) for VOA = 2.98 V, then 7.44 Refer to Fig. 7.16(a). (VIA − 0.8)2 = 0.11 (1 − 0.03 × 2.98) ⇒ VIA Note that Q2 , Q3 are not matched: = 1.116 V ID1 = 100 μA Large-signal voltage gain (a) ID2 = ID1 = 100 μA W3 ID3 (W/L)3 = = ID2 W2 (W/L)2 = (Note that VSG2 = VSG3 ) vO 2.98 − 0.33 = vI 1.13 − 1.116 vO = −189.3 V/V vi 10 = 25 μA ⇒ IREF = 25 μA 40 (b) By referring to Fig. 7.16(d), you notice that in Segment III, both Q1 and Q2 are in saturation and the transfer characteristic is quite linear. The output voltage in this segment is limited between VOA and VOB : coordinates of point A: v OA = VDD − |VOV 3 | Differentiating both sides of (1) relative to vI : ID3 25 = |VOV 3 | = 10 1 1 W × 50 × kp 2 1 2 L 3 For vO = 1.65 V, from 1 we have ⇒ ID3 = 100 μA (d) vO = VDD 3.3 = = 1.65 V 2 2 2 (vI − 0.8) = 0.11 × (−0.03) ⇒ 2 ∂vO ∂vI ∂vO = −606.1 (vI − 0.8) ∂vI ⇒ |VOV 3 | = 0.32 V (vI − 0.8)2 = 0.11 (1 − 0.03 × 1.65) ⇒ vI VOA = 3.3 − 0.32 = 2.98V = 1.123 V At point B: VOB = VIB − Vtn ∂vO ∂vI Now we find the transfer equation for the linear section: (Refer to Example 7.4) iD1 = iD2 ⇒ (Note that |VOV 2 | = |VOV 3 |) vO 1 W kn (vI − Vtn )2 1 + 2 L 1 VAn W VDD − vO 1 2 VOV 1 + = k p 3 |VAP | 2 L 2 vO 20 1 × 100 × (v I − 0.8)2 1 + 2 1 100 40 3.3 − vO 1 × 0.322 1 + = × 50 × 2 1 50 vO vO 1+ (vI − 0.8)2 = 0.322 1.066 − 50 100 1 − 0.019v O (vI − 0.8)2 = 0.11 1 + 0.01vO 0.11(1 − 0.03vO ) (v I – 0.8)2 = 0.11(1 − 0.03vO ) v I = 1.123 = −195.8 V/V (e) Rout = ro1 ro2 ro1 = VAn 100 V = = 1 M ID1 0.1 mA ro2 = VAp 50 V = 500 k = ID2 0.1 mA ⇒ Rout = 500 k Rout = 333 k gm1 = 2kn W L Now if we solve for VOB = VIB – 0.8 2 + 0.0033VOB − 0.11 = 0 ⇒ VOB = 0.33 V VOB ID1 1 = 2 × 100 × 10−6 × 20 × 100 × 10−6 1 = 0.632 mA/V Av = −gm1 (ro1 (1) 1 M ro2 ) = −210.6 V/V Comment: The three estimates of voltage gain obtained in (c), (d) and (e) are all reasonably close; about −200 V/V. Chapter 7–17 7.45 (a) 2ID 2 × 0.125 = 0.5 mA/V = VOV 1 − 0.5 gm = 1.0 V Q2 ID2 R VG Av = 1 − 2 × 0.5 × 1000 = −999 V/V (c) VD ii ID1 0 R Q1 vi 1.0 V Figure 1 vgs 2gmvgs ro/2 vo vi Rin i i vgs vi From Fig. 1 we see that since the dc currents into the gates are zero, Figure 3 VD = VG Also, since Q1 and Q2 are matched and carry equal drain currents, For the circuit in Fig. 3 we can write at the output ID1 = ID2 = ID vo vo − vi + 2gm vgs + =0 ro /2 R VSG2 = VGS1 = 1 V Substituting vgs = vi and rearranging, we obtain and thus, 1 1− vo 2gm R = −2gm 2 1 vi + R ro VG = 0 Thus, ID = 1 × 1 × (1 − 0.5)2 = 0.125 mA 2 But 2gm R 1; thus vo ro −2gm R Av = vi 2 (b) G vgs D R 2gmvgs vi vo vgs ro = vgs vi Figure 2 From Fig. 2 we see that vo = vi − 2gm vgs R But vgs = vi Thus, vo = 1 − 2gm R vi |VA | 20 = 160 k = ID 0.125 Av = −2 × 0.5(1000 80) = −74.1 V/V Rin = gmvgs Av = where gmvgs = (d) vi vi 1 = =R vo ii (vi − vo )/R 1− vi R 1000 = 13.3 k = 1 − Av 1 + 74.1 vi Rin 13.3 = 0.4 V/V = = vsig Rin + Rsig 20 + 13.3 Gv = vo vi vo = × vsig vsig vi = 0.4 × −74.1 = −29.6 V/V (e) Both Q1 and Q2 remain in saturation for output voltages that ensure that the minimum voltage across each transistor is equal to |VOV | = 0.5 V. Thus, the output voltage can range from −0.5 V to +0.5 V. Chapter 7–18 7.46 (a) IREF = IC3 = 3 − VBE3 46 k 7.48 io 3 − 0.7 46 = 0.05 mA IREF = ⇒ IC2 = 5IC3 RL 20 k IC2 = I = 0.25 mA ⇒ I = 0.25 mA 3V io 3V isig IREF Rs 20 k Q1 vi vo 46 k Rin I Q3 Q2 Rin = r o + RL 20 + 20 = 980 = 1 + gm ro 1 + 2 × 20 Since is = io , (b) |VA | = 50 V ⇒ ro1 = |VA | 30 = I 0.25 = 120 k 30 = 120 k ro2 = 0.25 Total resistance at the collector of Q1 is equal to ro1 ro2 , thus rtot = 120 k 120 k = 60 k (c) gm 1 rπ 1 = IC1 0.25 = = = 10 mA/V VT 0.025 β 50 = = 5 k gm 10 Rs 20 io = = = 0.95 A/A isig Rs + Rin 20 + 0.98 If RL increases by a factor of 10, Rin becomes Rin = 20 + 200 = 5.37 k 1 + 2 × 20 and the current gain becomes 20 io = = 0.79 A/A isig 20 + 5.37 Thus an increase in RL by a factor of 10 resulted in a decrease in the current gain from 0.95 A/A to 0.79 A/A, a change of only −17%. This indicates that the CG amplifier functions as an effective current buffer. (d) Rin = rπ 1 = 5 k Ro = ro1 ro2 = 120 k 120 k = 60 k Av = −gm 1 Ro = −10 × 60 = −600 V/V 7.47 Refer to Fig. 7.18. Rin = ro + RL 1 + gm ro 20 + 20 = = 980 1 + 2 × 20 7.49 Refer to Fig. P7.49. ID = 0.2 mA VOV = 0.2 V gm = 2ID 2 × 0.2 = = 2 mA/V VOV 0.2 ro = VA 20 = = 100 k ID 0.2 Rout = ro + Rs + gm ro Rs 500 = 100 + Rs (1 + 2 × 100) 400 2 k 201 = ID RS + VGS Rout = ro + Rs + gm ro Rs ⇒ Rs = = 20 + 1 + 2 × 20 × 1 = 61 k VBIAS RL vo = vsig Rs + Rin = ID RS + Vt + VOV = 20 = 10.1 V/V 1 + 0.98 = 0.2 × 2 + 0.5 + 0.2 = 1.1 V Chapter 7–19 7.50 Refer to Fig. P7.50. To obtain maximum output resistance, we use the largest possible Rs consistent with ID Rs ≤ 0.3 V. Thus 0.3 V = 3 k 0.1 mA Rs = Now, for Q2 we have gm = 1 mA/V and VA = 10 V Thus, ro = VA 10 V = 100 k = ID 0.1 mA Rout = ro + Rs + gm ro Rs (f) The value of vo can range from VBIAS − Vt = 1.03 − 0.8 = 0.23 V to (VDD − VOV 2 ). Since ID2 = ID1 and k n = k p , then VOV 2 = VOV 1 . Thus the maximum value of vo is 3.3 − 0.224 = 3.076 V. Thus the peak-to-peak value of vo is 3.076 − 0.23 = 2.85 V. Correspondingly, the peak-to-peak value of vsig will be 2.85 = 32 mV vsig (peak to peak) = 89 7.52 Given Eq. (7.63): Rin re = 100 + 3 + 1 × 100 × 3 ro + RL RL ro + β +1 = 403 k We can write 7.51 Refer to Fig. P7.51. 1 + (RL /ro ) 1 + (RL /ro ) Rin = = re 1 + [RL /(β + 1)ro ] 1 + (RL /101ro ) (a) ID1 = ID2 = ID3 = 100 μA Using ID1 0.1 = 1 2 = k n (W/L)1 VOV 1 , we obtain 2 1 2 × 4 × VOV 1 2 RL /ro 0 1 10 100 1000 ∞ Rin /re 1 2 10 50.8 91.8 101 Observe that the range of Rin is re to (β + 1)re . ⇒ VOV 1 = 0.224 V 7.53 Equation (7.66): VGS1 = Vt + VOV 1 = 0.8 + 0.224 = 1.024 V Rout = ro + (Re rπ ) + (Re rπ )gm ro VBIAS = VGS + ID1 Rs = ro + (re rπ )(1 + gm ro ) = 1.024 + 0.1 × 0.05 = 1.03 V For gm ro 1, (b) gm1 2ID1 2 × 0.1 = 0.9 mA/V = = VOV 1 0.224 All transistors are operating at ID = 0.1 mA and have |VA | = 20 V. Thus all have equal values for ro : ro = |VA | 20 = = 200 k ID 0.1 (c) For Q2 , RL = ro2 = 200 k, Rin = = r o + RL 1 + gm ro 200 + 200 = 2.2 k 1 + 0.9 × 200 (d) Rout = ro + Rs + gm ro Rs = 200 + 0.05 + 0.9 × 200 × 0.05 Rout ro + gm ro (Re rπ ) gm rπ Re Rout =1+ ro rπ + Re =1+ βRe (β + 1)re + Re Thus, β(Re /re ) Rout =1+ ro β + 1 + (Re /re ) For β = 100, 100(Re /re ) Rout =1+ ro 101 + (Re /re ) Re /re 0 1 Rout /ro 1 2 2.9 10 2 10 β/2 34 β 1000 51 92 = 209 k Rin 2.2 vi = 0.98 V/V = = (e) vsig Rin + Rs 2.2 + 0.05 Observe that Rout ranges from ro to (β + 1)ro , with the maximum value obtained for Re = ∞. RL 200 vo = = 90.9 V = vi Rin 2.2 vo = 90.9 × 0.98 = 89 V/V vsig 7.54 Refer to Fig. P7.54. To obtain the short-circuit current gain k, we replace the BJT with its T model and short circuit the collector to Chapter 7–20 io kisig Thus, Rout = 500 + (10 25) × 2001 ai i = 14.8 M ro Thus the CB amplifier has a current gain of nearly unity and a very high output resistance: a near-ideal current buffer! re E A more exact value of k can be obtained using Eq. (1); k = 0.975. i1 isig Rsig 7.55 Refer to Fig. P7.55. I = IC = αIE = 0.99 × ro = ground, resulting in the circuit shown in the figure. VA 100 V = 100 k = IC 1 mA where gm = Thus, 1/re 1 1 1 + + re ro Rsig IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V gm ro = 40 × 100 = 4000 rπ = and i1 = isig β 100 = 2.5 k = gm 40 RE = 4.3 k 1/ro 1 1 1 + + re ro Rsig Thus, Rout = 100 + (4.3 2.5) × 4001 = 6.4 M At the collector node, we can write io ≡ kisig = i1 − αi For Thus, VC = 10 V kisig = isig 1/ro + (α/re ) 1 1 1 + + re ro Rsig 1 mA Rout = ro + (RE rπ )(1 + gm ro ) At the emitter node we see that there are three parallel resistances to ground: re , ro , and Rsig . i = −isig 5 − 0.7 4.3 (1) 10 V = 1.6 μA 6.4 M I = A very small change indeed! Now ro re and for the case Rsig re , we obtain α/re =α 1/re For our case, β α= β +1 β 100 k=α= = = 0.99 β +1 101 k The output resistance Rout is given by Rout = ro + (Rsig rπ )(1 + gm ro ) where VA 50 V ro = = = 500 k IC 0.1 mA IC 0.1 mA = gm = = 4 mA/V VT 0.025 V gm ro = 4 × 500 = 2000 β 100 rπ = = 25 k = gm 4 7.56 Refer to Fig. 7.27. Rout = ro + (Re rπ )(1 + gm ro ) ro + (Re rπ )(gm ro ) Rout = 1 + gm (Re rπ ) ro =1+ gm rπ Re rπ + Re =1+ βRe (β/gm ) + Re For our case β = 100, gm = IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V, thus = VT 0.025 V 100 Re Rout =1+ ro 5 + Re where Re is in kilohms. (1) Chapter 7–21 (a) For Rout = 5 ro , Eq. (1) gives Re = 0.208 k = 208 (b) For Rout = 10 ro , Eq. (1) gives Re = 0.495 k 500 . (c) For Rout = 50 ro , Eq. (1) gives Re = 4.8 k. From Eq. (1) we see that the maximum value of Rout /ro is obtained with Re = ∞ and its value is 101, which is (β + 1). The minimum permitted output voltage is VG − Vt = 1 − 0.5 = 0.5 V or 2VOV . 7.59 Refer to Fig. 7.32 Ro = gm3 ro3 ro4 For identical transistors, Ro = (gm ro )ro 7.57 50 = gm2 ro2 = A02 = = 2VA VOV Thus, VA = 50 × VOV /2 = 25 × 0.2 = 5 V 5 = 5 × L ⇒ L = 1 μm 7.58 Refer to Fig. 7.33(a). 2ID 2I = VOV VOV 2I 0.25 ⇒ I = 0.25 mA 2= For identical transistors, Ro = (gm ro )ro = 2VA2 2VA VA = VOV I VOV I 2VA2 200 = 0.25 × 0.25 ⇒ VA = 2.5 V VA = VA L L= IRo = 2|VA |2 VOV Q.E.D. (a) I = 0.1 mA VA = VA L gm1 = 2|VA | |VA | × |VOV | I 2.5 VA = = 0.5 μm VA 5 To obtain W/L, we use 1 W 2 VOV ID = I = μn Cox 2 L W 1 × 0.252 250 = × 400 × 2 L W = 20 ⇒ L To obtain maximum negative signal swing at the output, we select VG so that the voltage at the drain of Q1 is the minimum permitted, which is equal to VOV (i.e., 0.25 V). Thus VG = 0.25 + VGS2 = 0.25 + VOV 2 + Vt = 0.25 + 0.25 + 0.5 = 1.0 V 2 × 42 = 160 0.2 Ro = 1.6 M 0.1 × Ro = To obtain the W/L values, 1 W |VOV |2 I = ID = μp Cox 2 L 3,4 1 W 100 = × 100 × × 0.22 2 L 3,4 W ⇒ = 50 L 3,4 (b) I = 0.5 mA 2 × 42 = 160 0.2 Ro = 320 k W 1 |VOV |2 I = μp Cox 2 L 3,4 W 1 500 = × 100 × |VOV |2 2 L 3,4 W ⇒ = 250 L 3,4 0.5Ro = 7.60 Refer to Fig. 7.32. Ro = (gm3 ro3 )ro4 For identical transistors, Ro = (gm ro )ro = 2|VA | |VA | × |VOV | I Thus, IRo = 2|VA |2 |VOV | Chapter 7–22 This table belongs to Problem 7.60. L = Lmin = 0.18 μm IRo = 8.1 V L = 2Lmin = 0.36 μm IRo = 32.4 V L = 3Lmin = 0.54 μm IRo = 72.9 V gm Ro Av 2WL gm Ro Av 2WL gm Ro Av o 2WL (mA/V) (k) (V/V) (μm2 ) (mA/V) (k) (V/V) (μm2 ) (mA/V) (k) (V/V) (μm2 ) I = 0.01 mA W/L = n 0.1 810 −40.5 0.065 n I = 0.1 mA W/L = 10 n 1.0 81 I = 1.0 mA W/L = 100 n 10.0 8.1 −40.5 0.1 −40.5 0.65n 6.5n |VA | = 0.1 7,290 −364.5 0.58n 1.0 324 −162 2.6n 1.0 729 −364.5 5.8n 10.0 32.4 −162 26n 10.0 72.9 −364.5 58n Rop = (gm ro )ro = (2 × 20) × 20 = 800 k Substituting |VA | 3,240 −162 0.26n Ro = Ron Rop = 400 k L 2|VA |2 2 L IRo = |VOV | Q.E.D. Av = −gm1 Ro = −2 × 400 = −800 V/V Now, for L = 0.18 μm, IRo = 2 × 52 × 0.182 = 8.1 V 0.2 L = 0.36 μm, IRo = 2 × 52 ×0.362 = 32.4 V 0.2 2 × 52 ×0.542 = 72.9 V 0.2 To fill out the table above, we use L = 0.54 μm, gm = IRo = 7.62 VDD 3.3 V VG4 Q4 VD4 2ID 2I 2I = = = 10I |VOV | |VOV | 0.2 Av = gm (Ro /2) VG3 Q3 (a) The price paid is the increase in circuit area. Ro (b) As I is increased, gm increases and hence the current-driving capability of the amplifier, and as we will see later, its bandwidth. (c) The circuit with the largest area (58n) as compared to the circuit with the smallest area (0.065n): Av is 364.5/40.5 = 9 times larger; gm is 100 times larger, but Ro is 11.1 times lower. I 100 A VSG4 = |Vtp | + |VOV | = 0.8 + 0.2 = 1 V Thus, VG4 = VDD − VSG4 = 3.3 − 1 = 2.3 V 7.61 Refer to Fig. 7.33. gm1 2ID1 2I 2 × 0.2 = = 2 mA/V = = VOV 1 VOV 0.2 Since all transistors are operating at the same ID and |VOV |, all have equal values of gm . Also because all have equal |VA | = 4 V, all ro ’s will be equal: To obtain the largest possible signal swing at the output, we maximize the allowable positive signal swing by setting VD4 at its highest possible value of VDD − |VOV | = 3.3 − 0.2 = 3.1 V. This will be obtained by selecting VGS as follows: VG3 = VD4 − VSG3 4 |VA | |VA | = = 20 k = ro = ID I 0.2 Since Ron = (gm ro )ro = (2 × 20) × 20 = 800 k VG3 = 3.1 − 1 = 2.1 V VSG3 = VSG4 = 1 V Chapter 7–23 the highest allowable voltage at the output will be vD3max = VG3 + |Vtp | = 2.1 + 0.8 = 2.9 V Since both Q3 and Q4 carry the same current I = 100 μA and are operated at the same overdrive voltage, |VOV | = 0.2 V, their W/L ratios will be the same and can be found from 1 W |VOV |2 ID = μp Cox 2 L 3,4 W 1 100 = × 60 × × 0.22 2 L 3,4 W ⇒ = 83.3 L 3,4 ⇒ W L = 10 1,2 For each of the PMOS transistors, 1 W |VOV |2 ID = μp Cox 2 L 3,4 1 W 125 = × 100 × × 0.252 2 L 3,4 W ⇒ = 40 L 3,4 7.64 ix Ro To obtain Ro , we first find gm and ro of both devices, gm3,4 = 2 × 0.1 2ID = = 1 mA/V |VOV | 0.2 ro3,4 = |VA | 5 = 50 k = ID 0.1 Q2 ix vx vy ro1 Ro = (gm3 ro3 )ro4 Q1 = 1 × 50 × 50 = 2.5 M 7.63 Refer to Fig. 7.33. Av = −gm1 Ro −280 = −1 × Ro ⇒ Ro = 280 k gm1 = 2ID 2I 1 = ⇒ I = gm1 VOV VOV VOV 2 1 × 1 × 0.25 = 0.125 mA 2 All four transistors are operated at the same value of ID and the same value of |VOV |. Also all have the same channel length and |VA |; thus all ro values are equal. Thus = Ron = Rop = 2Ro = 2 × 280 = 560 k While vx appears across Ro , vy appears across ro1 , Thus, vy ro1 = vx Ro ro1 = ro1 + ro2 + gm2 ro2 ro1 For gm2 ro2 1 and gm2 ro1 1, vy vx 1 gm2 ro2 560 = (gm ro )ro = 2|VA | |VA | |VOV | I 2|VA |2 = 0.25 × 0.125 ⇒ VA = 2.96 V 2.96 VA = 0.6 μm L= = VA 5 For each of the NMOS devices, 1 W V2 ID = μn Cox 2 L 1,2 OV 1 W 125 = × 400 × × 0.252 2 L 1,2 7.65 Refer to Fig. P7.65. (a) For the circuit in (a), 1 W 2 I = μn Cox VOVa 2 L For the circuit in (b), 1 W I = μn Cox V2 2 4L OVb Comparing Eqs. (1) and (2) we see that VOVb = 2VOVa Now, gm = 2ID VOV Q.E.D. (1) (2) Chapter 7–24 Thus for the circuit in (a), gm1 = gm2 = 2I VOVa and for the circuit in (b), gma = gmb = = 2I 2I I = = VOVb 2 VOVa VOVa 2 × 0.4 × ro1 = ro2 = Thus, 1 gma Q.E.D. 2 Since the channel length in (b) is four times that in (a), gmb = VAb = 4VAa 2μn Cox 5.4 × 0.2 = 1.55 mA/V 0.36 VA VL 5 × 0.36 = A = = 9 k ID ID 0.2 Ro = ro1 + ro2 + gm2 ro2 ro1 = 9 + 9 + 1.55 × 9 × 9 = 143.6 k Av = −gm1 (Ro RL ) and −100 = −1.55(Ro RL ) rob = 4roa ⇒ Ro RL = 64.5 k Thus 1 1 1 + = Ro RL 64.5 Ava = −gma roa W ID L 1 1 1 1 = − = RL 64.5 143.6 117 and Avb = −gmb rob ⇒ RL = 117 k 1 = − gma × 4 roa 2 = 2Av a Q.E.D. Rin2 = (b) For the cascode circuit in (c) to have the same minimum voltage requirement at the drain as that for circuit (b), which is equal to VOV b = 2VOV a , we must operate each of the two transistors in the cascode amplifier at VOV = VOV a . Thus each of the two transistors in the cascode circuit will have gm = gma . Also, each will have ro = roa . Thus = ro2 + RL 1 + gm2 ro2 9 + 143.6 = 10.2 k 1 + 1.55 × 9 Rd 1 = ro1 Rin2 = 9 10.2 = 4.8 k A1 = −gm1 Rd 1 = −1.55 × 4.8 = −7.41 V/V Avc = −gm Ro −gm [(gm ro )ro ] 7.67 Refer to Fig. P7.67. = −A2va Obviously, the cascode delivers a much greater gain than that achieved by quadrupling the channel length of the CS amplifier. 7.66 R2 (gm ro )ro R3 = R2 + ro gm ro2 + ro = gm ro gm ro vo Ro Q2 5.4/0.36 Rin2 RL i2 = i1 1 R3 ro = gm vi = gm v i R3 + ro ro + ro 2 i3 = i1 − i2 = Q1 5.4/0.36 1 gm v i 2 i4 = i3 = 1 gm v i 2 i5 = i4 = 1 gm v i 2 ro1 vi ro (b) i1 = gm vi I 0.2 mA VG2 (a) R1 = ro1 = ro i6 = 0 (because vsg4 = 0) i7 = i5 = 1 gm v i 2 Chapter 7–25 1 (c) v1 = −i2 ro = − (gm ro )vi 2 1 v2 = −i4 R2 = − gm (gm ro )ro vi 2 1 = − (gm ro )2 vi 2 1 1 v3 = −i5 R1 = − gm vi ro = − (gm ro )vi 2 2 (d) vi is a 5-mV peak sine wave (see Fig. 1). 7.68 VDD 1.8 V VG1 Q1 ro1 1.6 V 1 v̂ 1 = − × 20 × vi = −10 × 5 = −50 mV 2 Thus, v1 is a 50-mV peak sine wave that is 180◦ out of phase with vi . 1 v̂ 2 = − × 202 × 5 = −1 V 2 Thus, v2 is a 1-V peak sine wave, 180◦ out of phase relative to vi . Q2 VG2 (gm2ro2) ro1 1.4 V VG3 Q3 Ro = (gm3ro3) (gm2ro2) ro1 I 0.2 mA 1 v̂ 3 = − × 20 × 5 = −50 mV 2 Thus, v3 is a 50-mV peak sine wave, 180◦ out of phase relative to vi . We design for a minimum voltage of |VOV | across each of Q1 and Q2 . vi VG1 = VDD − VSG1 = VDD − |Vtp | − |VOV | = 1.8 − 0.4 − 0.2 = 1.2 V 5 mV 0 t VG2 = VS2 − VSG2 = 1.6 − 0.4 − 0.2 = 1.0 V v1 VG3 = VS3 − VSG3 50 mV = 1.4 − 0.4 − 0.2 = 0.8 V 0 t v2 –1 V All transistors carry the same ID = 0.2 mA and operate at the same value of |VOV | = 0.2 V. Thus, their W/L ratios will be equal, 0.2 = ⇒ 0 t 1 W × 0.1 × × 0.22 2 L W = 100 L Ro = (gm ro )2 ro where v3 –50 mV gm = 2 × 0.2 2ID = = 2 mA/V |VOV | 0.2 ro = |VA |L 6 × 0.4 = 12 k = ID 0.2 Ro = (2 × 12)2 × 12 = 6.91 M 0 t 7.69 Refer to Fig. P7.69. (a) Ro1 = ro Ro2 = ro Figure 1 Chapter 7–26 Ro5 = ro Ro = (gm3 ro3 )(ro4 rπ3 ) Ro4 = (gm ro )ro I = 0.2 mA I 0.2 gm3 = = 8 mA/V = VT 0.025 VA 5 ro3 = ro4 = = = 25 k I 0.2 β 50 = rπ 3 = = 6.25 k gm3 8 Ro3 = ro3 + (gm3 ro3 )(Ro1 Ro2 ) 1 = ro + gm ro × ro 2 1 1 ro (1 + gm ro ) (gm ro )ro 2 2 ro3 + Ro4 ro + gm ro ro Rin3 = 1 + gm3 ro3 gm ro = 1 + ro gm Ro = (8 × 25)(25 6.25) = 1 M ro (b) Ro = Ro3 Ro4 1 = (gm ro )ro (gm ro )ro 2 1 = (gm ro )ro 3 (c) When vo is short-circuited to ground, Rin2 becomes equal to 1/gm3 . This resistance will be much smaller than the two other resistances between the drain of Q1 and ground, namely, Ro1 = ro and Ro2 = ro . Thus the signal current in the drain of Q1 , gm1 vi will mostly flow into 1/gm3 , that is, into the source of Q3 and out of the drain of Q3 to ground. Thus, the output short-circuit current will be equal to gm1 vi ; thus the short-circuit transconductance Gm will be Gm = gm1 Q.E.D. vo = −gm1 Ro (d) vi 1 = −gm × (gm ro )ro 3 1 = − (gm ro )2 3 For gm = 2 mA/V and 7.71 When Eq. (7.88) is applied to the case of identical pnp transistors, it becomes Ro = (gm ro )(ro rπ ) Now, I |VA | ro = VT I gm ro = |VA |/VT β rπ = gm gm = Thus, = = = = A0 = 30 1 vo = − (30)2 = −300 V/V vi 3 |VA | Iro rπ VT ro + rπ |VA | |VA | rπ VT ro + rπ |VA | |VA | VT 1 + ro rπ |VA | |VA | 1 VT 1 + gm ro β |VA | 1 1 1 VT 1 + |VA | β VT |VA | (VT /|VA |) + (1/β) IRo = = For |VA | = 5 V and β = 50 we obtain 5 IRo = = 200 V (0.025/5) + (1/50) 7.70 VCC I (mA) VB4 Q4 VB3 Q3 Q.E.D. 0.1 0.5 1 Ro (k) 2000 400 200 7.72 The output resistance of the cascode amplifier (excluding the load) is Ro = gm ro (ro rπ ) Thus, Ro Av = −gm (Ro RL ) = −gm (Ro βro ) Chapter 7–27 For |VA | = 100 V, β = 50, and I = 0.2 mA we obtain I 0.2 gm = = = 8 mA/V VT 0.025 β 50 = 6.25 k rπ = = gm 8 100 |VA | = = 500 k I 0.2 Ro = 8 × 500 × (500 6.25) ro = = 24, 691 k Av = −8(24.7 25) × 103 = −99.4 × 103 −105 V/V (b) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P7.74(b). I 0.1 = 4 mA/V = VT 0.025 2ID2 2I 2 × 0.1 = 1 mA/V gm2 = = = VOV VOV 0.2 β 100 rπ1 = = = 25 k gm1 4 5 |VA | = ro1 = = 50 k I 0.1 |VA | 5 ro2 = = = 50 k I 0.1 Rin = rπ1 = 25 k gm1 = Ro = gm2 ro2 ro1 = 1 × 50 × 50 = 2.5 M 7.73 Refer to Fig. 7.38. When all transistors have equal β and ro , and, since they conduct equal currents, they have equal gm , then = −4 × 2.5 × 103 = −10, 000 V/V Ron = Rop = gm ro (ro rπ ) (c) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P7.74(c). Ro = Ron Rop = 1 (gm ro )(ro rπ ) 2 Av o = −gm1 Ro gm1 = gm2 = Av = −gm Ro 1 mA/V 1 = − (gm ro )gm (ro rπ ) 2 1 gm ro rπ = − (gm ro ) 2 rπ + ro 1 1 = − (gm ro ) 1 1 2 + gm ro gm rπ |VA | Substituting gm ro = and gm rπ = β, VT 1 |VA |/VT Av = − 2 (VT /|VA |) + (1/β) ro1 = ro2 = 2ID 2I 2 × 0.1 = = = |VOV | |VOV | 0.2 |VA | 5 |VA | = = 50 k = ID I 0.1 Rin = ∞ Ro = gm2 ro2 ro1 = 1 × 50 × 50 = 2.5 M Av o = −gm1 Ro = −1 × 2.5 × 183 = −2500 V/V (d) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P7.74(d). gm1 = 2I 2ID 2 × 0.1 = = = 1 mA/V |VOV | |VOV | 0.2 I 0.1 = gm2 = = 4 mA/V VT 0.025 5 |VA | = ro1 = = 50 k I 0.1 5 |VA | = = 50 k ro2 = I 0.1 β 100 rπ2 = = 25 k = gm2 4 Rin = ∞ gm2 Ro = (gm2 ro2 )(ro1 rπ2 ) For |VA | = 5 V and β = 50 we obtain 5/0.025 1 Av = − = −4000 V/V 2 (0.025/5) + (1/50) 7.74 (a) Refer to circuit in Fig. P7.74(a). I 0.1 = 4 mA/V = VT 0.025 = gm1 = 4 mA/V β 100 = 25 k = gm 4 |VA | 5 = = 50 k ro1 = ro2 = I 0.1 Rin = rπ 1 = 25 k rπ 1 = rπ 2 = Ro = gm2 ro2 (ro1 rπ 2 ) = (4 × 50)(50 25) = 3.33 M Av o = −gm Ro = −4 × 3.33 × 103 = −13,320 V/V gm1 = = 4 × 50(50 25) = 3.33 M Av o = −gm1 Ro = −1 × 3.33 × 106 = −3330 V/V Comment: The highest voltage gain (13,320 V/V) is obtained in circuit (a). However, the input resistance is only 25 k. Of the two circuits with infinite input resistance (c and d), the circuit in (d) has the higher voltage gain. Observe that combining MOSFETs with BJTs results in Chapter 7–28 circuits superior to those with exclusively MOSFETs or BJTs. The lowest voltage at the output while Q3 remains in saturation is VOmin = VG3 − Vt3 7.75 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P7.75(a). W gm1 = 2μn Cox ID L √ = 2 × 0.4 × 25 × 0.1 = 1.41 mA/V VA 1.8 ro1 = = = 18 k ID 0.1 I 0.1 = 4 mA/V gm2 = = VT 0.025 1.8 VA = = 18 k ro2 = I 0.1 β 125 rπ 2 = = 31.25 k = gm2 4 = 1.7 − 0.6 = 1.1 V 2ID2,3 2 × 0.2 gm2 = gm3 = = = 1.6 mA/V VOV 2,3 0.25 VA 10 = = 50 k ID 0.2 Ro = gm3 ro3 ro2 ro2 = ro3 = = 1.6 × 50 × 50 = 4 M 7.77 (gm3ro3) (gm2ro2)ro1 IREF Gm = gm1 = 1.41 mA/V IO Ro = gm2 ro2 (ro1 rπ 2 ) = 4 × 18 × (18 31.25) = 822.3 k Av o = −Gm Ro = −1.41 × 822.3 = −1159 V/V (b) Refer to circuit in Fig. P7.75(b). √ gm1 = gm2 = 2 × 0.4 × 25 × 0.1 = 1.41 mA/V 1.8 VA ro1 = ro2 = = = 18 k I 0.1 Gm = gm1 = 1.41 mA/V Q6 Q3 Q5 Q2 (gm2 ro2)ro1 ro1 Q4 Q1 Ro = gm2 ro2 ro1 = 1.41 × 18 × 18 = 457 k Av o = −Gm Ro = −1.41 × 457 = −644 V/V From the figure we see that We observe that the circuit with a cascode transistor provides higher gain. Ro = (gm3 ro3 )(gm2 ro2 )ro1 7.76 Refer to Fig. 7.39. 7.78 Refer to Eq. (7.95), (W/L)2 (W/L)1 40/1 = 200 μA = 20 4/1 1 W ID1 = μn Cox V2 2 L 1 OV 1 Ro = β3 ro3 /2 IO = IREF 1 4 2 20 = × 160 × × VOV 1 2 1 ⇒ VOV 1 = 0.25 V VG2 = VGS1 = Vt + VOV 1 = 0.6 + 0.25 = 0.85 V VOV 4 = VOV 1 where ro3 = 100 V VA = = 100 k I 1 mA Thus, 100 × 100 = 5 M 2 VO 10 V = IO = = 2 μA Ro 5 M Ro = 2 μA IO = 0.002 = IO 1 mA or 0.2% Thus, VGS4 = VGS1 = 0.85 V VG3 = 0.85 + 0.85 = 1.7 V 7.79 (a) IO1 = IO2 = 1 IREF 2 2 1+ 2 β Chapter 7–29 (b) 1.1 + 2.5 = 36 k 0.1 VOmax is limited by Q3 saturating. Thus R= IO1 IO2 IO3 VOmax = VE3 − VECsat IREF 0.7 mA Q3 Q5 Q4 1 2 = 1.8 − 0.3 = 1.5 V 4 7.81 Replacing each of the transistors in the Wilson mirror of Fig. 7.40 with its T model while neglecting ro results in the circuit shown below. Q1 ix Q1 2 aie3 (1 a) ie3 ie3 aie2 VEE vx The figure shows the required circuit. Observe that the output transistor is split into three transistors having base–emitter junctions with area ratio 1:2:4. Thus 0.1 0.1 IO1 = = = 0.0999 mA 2 2 1+ 2 1+ 2 β 50 1 Rin ie2 re2 ie1 re1 Note that the diode-connected transistor Q1 reduces to a resistance re1 . To determine Rin , we have applied a test voltage vx . In the following we analyze the circuit to find ix and hence Rin , as vx Rin ≡ ix 0.2 = 0.1998 mA 2 1+ 2 50 0.4 = = 0.3997 mA 2 1+ 2 50 IO2 = IO4 re3 Note that all three transistors are operating at equal emitter currents, approximately equal to IREF . Thus 7.80 re1 = re2 = re3 = 2.5 V VT IREF Analysis of the circuit proceeds as follows. Since re1 = re2 , we obtain 1.8 V Q2 ie2 = ie1 Q1 (1) Node equation at node 1: ie3 + αie2 = ie1 + ie2 Using Eq. (1) yields 1.1 V ie3 = (2 − α)ie1 Q3 (2) Node equation at node 2: R 0.1 mA ix = αie2 + (1 − α)ie3 IO VO Using Eqs. (1) and (2) yields ix = ie1 [α + (1 − α)(2 − α)] 2.5 V ix = ie1 [2 − 2α + α 2 ] (3) Chapter 7–30 Finally, vx can be expressed as the sum of the voltages across re3 and re1 , Thus vx = ie3 re + ie1 re The voltage vx can be expressed as the sum of the voltages across 1/gm3 and 1/gm1 : ix = i2 Using Eq. (2) yields vx = ie1 re (3 − α) (4) Substituting i3 = i2 and i1 = i2 , gm1 = gm3 = gm , and Dividing Eq. (4) by Eq. (3) yields Rin = For α vx 3−α = re ix 2 − 2α + α 2 vx = 2 i2 /gm But i2 = ix ; thus 1, Rin = 2re = 2 VT IREF vx = 2 ix /gm Q.E.D. and thus 2 Rin = gm Thus, for IREF = 0.2 mA, Rin = 250 7.82 Replacing each of the three transistors in the Wilson current mirror in Fig. 7.41(a) with its T model results in the circuit in the figure. i3 ix i3 i2 vx Q.E.D. 7.83 Refer to circuit in Fig. 7.41(a). (a) Each of the three transistors is operating at ID = IREF . Thus 1 W 2 VOV IREF = μn Cox 2 L 1 2 × 400 × 10 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.3 V 180 = 2 vx = (i3 /gm3 ) + (i1 /gm1 ) 1 gm3 1 i2 1 gm2 i1 1 gm1 VG3 = Vtn + VOV = 0.5 + 0.3 = 0.8 V (b) Q1 is operating at VDS = VGS = 0.8 V Q2 is operating at VDS = 2VGS = 1.6 V Thus, IREF − IO = VDS ro where Rin Here, we have applied a test voltage vx to determine Rin , vx Rin ≡ ix Since all three transistors are identical and are operating at the same ID , gm1 = gm2 = gm3 Now from the figure we see that i1 = i2 and i2 + i3 = i2 + i1 Thus i3 = i1 = i2 A node equation at node 2 gives ix + i3 = i2 + i3 VA 18 = 100 k = IREF 0.18 0.8 = 0.008 mA = 8 μA IREF − IO = 100 IO = 180 − 8 = 172 μA ro = (c) Refer to Fig. 7.41(c). Since Q1 and Q2 are now operating at equal VDS , we estimate IO = IREF = 180 μA. (d) The minimum allowable VO is the value at which Q3 leaves the saturation region: VOmin = VG3 − Vt = VGS3 + VGS1 − Vt = 0.8 + 0.8 − 0.5 = 1.1 V (e) Diode-connected transistor Q4 has an incremental resistance 1/gm4 . Reference to Fig. 7.41(b) indicates that the incremental resistance of Q4 would appear in series with the gate of Q3 and thus carries zero current. Thus including Q4 Chapter 7–31 has no effect on the value of Ro , which can be found from Eq. (7.96): Ro = gm3 ro3 ro2 where 2ID 2 × 0.18 = 1.2 mA/V = VOV 0.3 VA 18 ro2 = ro3 = = = 100 k IREF 0.18 Thus, Ro = 1.2 × 100 × 100 = 12 M (f) For VO = 1 V, we obtain VO 1V IO = = = 0.08 μA Ro 12 M IO = 0.04% IO gm3 = 7.85 Refer to Fig. 7.42. (a) To obtain a current transfer ratio of 0.8 (i.e., IO /IREF = 0.8 and IO = 80 μA), we write IREF IO RE = VT ln IO 100 0.08RE = 0.025 ln 80 ⇒ RE = 69.7 0.08 = 3.2 mA gm2 = 0.025 50 = 625 k ro2 = 0.08 rπ2 = ∞ (because β = ∞) Rout = RE + ro2 + gm2 ro2 RE = 0.069 + 625 + 3.2 × 625 × 0.0697 7.84 = 764.5 k IREF 200 A Rout IO 20 A Q1 VBE2 VBE1 (b) To obtain IO /IREF = 0.1, that is, IO = 10 μA, we write 100 0.01 RE = VT ln 10 Q2 RE (a) Assuming β is high so that we can neglect base currents, IREF IO RE = VT ln IO Substituting IO = 20 μA and IREF = 200 μA results in 200 0.02 RE = 0.025 ln 20 ⇒ RE = 2.88 k (b) Rout = (RE rπ 2 ) + ro2 + gm2 ro2 (RE rπ 2 ) where 0.02 = 0.8 mA/V 0.025 VA 50 = = = 2500 k IO 0.02 gm2 = ro2 rπ 2 = Relative to the value of ro2 , Rout = 1.22 ro2 β 200 = = 250 k gm 0.8 ⇒ RE = 5.76 k 0.01 = 0.4 mA/V gm2 = 0.025 50 = 5000 k ro2 = 0.01 rπ2 = ∞ Rout = RE + ro2 + gm2 ro2 RE = 5.76 + 5000 + 0.4 × 5000 × 5.76 = 16.5 M Compared to ro2 , 16.5 Rout = 3.3 = ro2 5 (c) To obtain IO /IREF = 0.01, that is, IO = 1 μA, we write 100 0.001 RE = 0.025 ln 1 ⇒ RE = 115 k 0.001 = 0.04 mA/V gm2 = 0.025 50 = 50 × 103 k ro2 = 0.001 Rout = (2.9 250)+2500+0.8×2500×(2.9 250) Rout = 115 + 50 × 103 + 0.04 × 50 × 103 × 115 = 8.2 M = 280 M A 5-V change in VO gives rise to Relative to the value of ro2 , IO = 5 = 0.7 μA 7.1 280 Rout = = 5.6 ro2 50 Chapter 7–32 7.86 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P7.86. Neglecting the base currents, we see that all three transistors are operating at IC = 10 μA, and thus 1 mA VBE1 = VBE2 = VBE3 = 0.7 − 0.025 ln 10 μA that we have set vi = 0 and applied a test voltage vx . We note that vgs = vbs = −vx and = 0.585 V ix = −gmb vbs + From the circuit we see that the voltage across R is VBE = 0.585 V, thus Thus, IO R = VBE 0.585 = 58.5 k R= 0.01 0.01 = 0.4 mA/V (b) gm3 = 0.025 40 = 4000 k ro3 = 0.01 β 100 = = 250 k rπ 3 = gm3 0.4 (1) ix = gmb vx + vx vx − gm vgs + ro1 ro3 vx vx + gm vx + ro1 ro3 from which we obtain vx 1 = ro1 ro3 Ro ≡ ix gm + gmb Q.E.D. Rout = (R rπ 3 ) + ro3 + gm3 ro3 (R rπ 3 ) 7.89 The dc level shift provided by a source follower is equal to its VGS . Thus, to obtain a dc level shift of 0.9 V, we write = (58.5 250) + 4000 + 0.4 × 4000 × (58.5 250) VGS = 0.9 V = Vt + VOV = 79.9 M ⇒ VOV = 0.9 − 0.6 = 0.3 V 7.87 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P7.87. Since Q1 and Q2 are matched and conducting equal currents I , their VGS values will be equal. Thus from the loop Q1 , Q6 , R, and Q2 , we see that IR = VEB6 I = VT ln IS Q.E.D. ro = G vgs ix S gmvgs ro1 VA VL 20 × 0.5 = 27.8 k = A = ID ID 0.36 To determine Av o , we note [refer to Fig. 7.45(b)] that the total effective resistance between the MOSFET source terminal and ground is 1 ro1 ro3 . Denoting this resistance R, we gmb have 1 R = ro ro gmb 7.88 ro3 2ID 2 × 0.36 = = 2.4 mA/V VOV 0.3 gmb = χgm = 0.2 × 2.4 = 0.48 mA/V ⇒ R = 3.3 k vgs vbs 1 20 × 0.2 × × 0.32 2 0.5 I = 0.36 mA = 360 μA = gm = Now to obtain I = 0.2 mA, we write 1 mA 0.2R = 0.7 − 0.025 ln 0.2 mA To obtain the required bias current, we use 1 W 2 VOV I = ID = μn Cox 2 L v x gmbvbs = 27.8 27.8 1 0.48 = 1.81 k Thus, the open-circuit voltage gain is B v x Ro ix The figure shows the equivalent circuit of the source follower prepared for finding Ro . Observe Av o = = R R+ 1 gm 1.81 1.81 + 1 2.4 = 0.81 V/V Chapter 7–33 Ro = R// 1 gm (b) Increasing the bias current by a factor of 10 (i.e., to 2 mA) results in = 1.81 k// 1 2.4 mA/V gm = 80 mA/V re = 0.0125 k = 0.339 k When a load resistance of 2 k is connected to the output, the total resistance between the output node and ground become R RL = 1.81 2 = 0.95 k. Thus, the voltage gain becomes Av = 0.95 0.95 + 1 2.4 rπ = 1.25 k ro = 25 k Rin2 = rπ2 = 1.25 k Rin = 101[0.0125 + (1.25 25)] = 121.5 k = 0.7 V/V Thus, Rin has been reduced by a factor of 10. 121.5 vb1 = vsig 121.5 + 500 7.90 = 0.2 V/V (considerably reduced) 5 V 200 A Rsig 500 k Q1 vo vsig Q2 200 A Rin Rin2 r2 (1.25 25) ve1 = vb1 (1.25 25) + 0.0125 = 0.99 V/V (unchanged) vo = −gm2 ro = −80 × 25 vb1 = −2000 V/V (unchanged) vo = 0.2 × 0.99 × −2000 = −396 V/V Gv = vsig which has been reduced by a factor of 3.5! All this reduction in gain is a result of the reduction in Rin . 7.91 From Fig. P7.91 we see that Each of Q1 and Q2 is operating at an IC approximately equal to 200 μA. Thus for both devices, gm = re 0.2 = 8 mA/V 0.025 1 = 0.125 k gm rπ = β 100 = = 12.5 k gm 8 ro = VA 50 = 250 k = IC 0.2 IE2 = 10 mA IE1 = IE2 β2 + 1 re2 = VT 25 mV = 2.5 = IE2 10 mA re1 = VT 25 mV = = 250 IE1 0.1 mA 10 = 0.1 mA 100 The Darlington follower circuit prepared for small-signal analysis is shown in the figure. (a) Rin2 = rπ 2 = 12.5 k Rin = (β1 + 1)[re1 + (rπ 2 ro1 )] Rsig 100 k = 101[0.125 + (12.5 250)] Q1 = 1.215 M Rin 1.215 vb1 = 0.71 V/V = = vsig Rin + Rsig 1.215 + 0.5 rπ 2 ro1 ve1 = = 0.99 V/V vb1 (rπ 2 ro1 ) + re1 vo = −gm2 ro2 = −8 × 250 = −2000 V/V vb1 vo = 0.71 × 0.99 × −2000 = −1405 V/V Gv = vsig Q2 vsig Rout RL 1 k Rin Chapter 7–34 Rin = (β + 1)[re1 + (β2 + 1)(re2 + RL )] (b) gm1 = = 101[0.25 + (101)(0.0025 + 1)] = 10.25 M Rout = re2 + re1 + Rsig /(β1 + 1) β2 + 1 100 × 103 101 = 2.5 + = 14.8 101 With RL removed, vo Gv o = =1 vsig 250 + vo RL = Gv o vsig RL + Rout =1× 1 = 0.985 1 + 0.0148 gm2 = IC2 1 mA = = 40 mA/V VT 0.025 rπ 2 = β 200 = 5 k = gm2 40 (c) Neglecting RG , we can write vb2 = vi rπ2 6.8 k (rπ2 6.8 k) + 1 gm1 = 0.65 V/V vo = −gm2 (3 1) vb2 With RL connected, Gv = 2ID1 2 × 0.1 = 0.632 mA/V = VOV 0.316 = −40 × 3 = −30 V/V 4 vo = 0.65 × −30 = −19.5 V/V vi (d) 7.92 RG 5 V Avvi ii vi RG 10 M 3 k Figure 2 0.7 VGS From Fig. 2 we can find ii as 0 VGS Q1 0.1 mA 0.7 V ii = Q2 0 0.7 0.1 6.8 mA 6.8 k = vi − Av vi RG vi + 19.4 vi RG Thus, Rin ≡ Figure 1 vi 10 M RG = = 487 k = ii 20.5 20.5 Thus the overall voltage gain becomes Rin vo = × Av vsig Rin + Rsig (a) From Fig. 1 we see that ID1 But ID1 = 0.1 mA/V vo 487 × −19.5 = vsig 487 + 500 1 W 2 μn Cox VOV 2 L = −9.6 V/V (e) The suggested configuration, shown partially in Fig. 3, will have 1 2 0.1 = × 2 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.316 V 10 M 10 M vi VGS = Vt + VOV = 1.316 V vo Thus, VC2 = VG2 = 0.7 + VGS = 2.016 V IC2 = 5 − 2.016 VCC − VC2 = 3 k 3 1 mA Figure 3 Chapter 7–35 no effect on the dc bias of each transistor. However, it will have a profound effect on Rin , as Rin now is 10 M, and 10 vo = × −19.5 = −18.6 V/V vsig 10 + 0.5 This is nearly double the value we had before! From the figure we can determine the overall voltage gain as Gv = = vo Total resistance in the drain = vsig Total resistance in the sources 1 RL = gm RL 1 1 2 + gm1 gm2 where 7.93 gm = gm1 = gm2 = 5 mA/V Gv = 1 × 5 × 10 = 25 V/V 2 RL 10 k 7.95 Refer to Fig. P7.95. All transistors are operating at IE = 0.5 mA. Thus, Rsig 10 k Q1 Q2 re = re1 v sig (a) Refer to Fig. P7.95(a). re2 α × Total resistance in collector vo =− vsig Total resistance in emitter = The figure shows the circuit prepared for signal analysis. Gv = = vo α × Total resistance in collectors = vsig Total resistance in emitters where 1 Gv = For α= 100 β = = 0.99 β +1 101 Gv = Rsig + re1 + re2 β +1 re1 = re2 = −α × 10 k 10 k + re β +1 −0.99 × 10 = −66.4 V/V 10 + 0.05 101 (b) Refer to Fig. P7.95(b). vsig vsig = ib1 = 10 + (β + 1)re1 10 + 101 × 0.05 αRL α VT 25 mV = = 50 IE 0.5 mA VT 25 mV = = 50 IE 0.5 mA 10 = 50.2 V/V 10 + 0.05 + 0.05 101 ic1 = βib1 = 100 vsig 10 + 101 × 0.05 ic2 = αic1 = 0.99 × 100 vsig 10 + 101 × 0.05 vo = −ic2 × 10 Gv ≡ 7.94 vo 10 × 0.99 × 100 =− = −65.8 V/V vsig 10 + 101 × 0.05 (c) Refer to Fig. P7.95(c). RL = Rsig Q1 vs Gv = 1 gm1 Q2 1 gm2 vo α × Total resistance in collector = vsig Total resistance in emitters 0.99 × 10 0.99 × 10 = 10 10 + 2 re + 2 × 0.05 β +1 101 = 49.7 V/V (d) Refer to Fig. P7.95(d). Rin (at the base of Q1 ) = (β1 + 1)[re1 + rπ2 ] Chapter 7–36 (f) where re1 = 50 vo ic2 rπ 2 = (β + 1)re2 = 101 × 50 = 5.05 k Thus, Q2 Rin = 101(0.05 + 5.05) = 515 k Rin 515 vb1 = 0.98 V/V = = vsig Rin + Rsig 515 + 10 rπ 2 5.05 vb2 = 0.98 V/V = = vb1 rπ 2 + re1 5.05 + 0.05 vo = −gm2 × 10 k vb2 Q1 vsig = −20 × 10 = −200 V/V vo = 0.98 × 0.98 × −200 = −194 V/V Gv = vsig ie1 = ie2 = (e) Refer to Fig. P7.95(e). vsig vsig = ib1 = 10 + (β + 1)re1 10 + 101 × 0.05 = ic1 = β1 ib1 = 100 vsig 10 + 101 × 0.05 ie2 = ic1 ic2 = αie2 = αic1 = vo = ic2 × 10 = 0.99 × 100 vsig 10 + 101 × 0.05 0.99 × 100 × 10 vsig 10 + 101 × 0.05 vsig 10 + re1 + re2 β1 + 1 vsig 10 + 0.05 + 0.05 101 ic2 = αie2 = 0.99 vsig 10 + 0.05 + 0.05 101 vo = ic2 × 10 k = 0.99 × 10 vsig 10 + 0.05 + 0.05 101 Thus, Thus, Gv = ie1 ie2 10 k vo 0.99 × 100 × 10 = 65.8 V/V = vsig 10 + 101 × 0.05 Gv = vo = 49.7 V/V vsig 10 k Exercise 8–1 VDD Ex: 8.1 Referring to Fig. 8.3, If RD is doubled to 5 k, RD 5 k I VD1 = VD2 = VDD − RD 2 0.4 mA = 1.5 − (5 k) = 0.5 V 2 VCMmax = Vt + VD = 0.5 + 0.5 = +1.0 V RD 5 k ID ID I 0.8 mA Since the currents ID1 , and ID2 are still 0.2 mA each, VSS VGS = 0.82 V So, VCMmin = VSS + VCS + VGS = −1.5 V + 0.4 V + 0.82 V = −0.28 V Thus, VOV So, the common-mode range is −0.28 V to +1.0 V = 2ID = W kn L 2 (0.4 mA) 0.2 mA/V2 (100) = 0.2 V Ex: 8.2 (a) The value of v id√that causes Q1 to conduct the entire current is 2 VOV √ → 2 × 0.316 = 0.45 V gm = 0.4 mA × 2 ID = = 4 mA/V VOV /2 0.2 V ro = VA 20 V = = 50 k ID 0.4 mA then, VD1 = VDD − I × RD Ad = gm (RD ro ) = 1.5 − 0.4 × 2.5 = 0.5 V Ad = (4 mA/V) (5 k 50 k) = 18.2 V/V VD2 = VDD = +1.5 V (b) For Q2 to conduct the entire current: √ v id = − 2 VOV = −0.45 V then, VD1 = VDD = +1.5 V VD2 = 1.5 − 0.4 × 2.5 = 0.5 V (c) Thus the differential output range is VD2 − VD1 :from 1.5 − 0.5 = + 1 V to 0.5 − 1.5 = −1 V Ex: 8.3 Refer to answer table for Exercise 8.3 where values were obtained in the following way: I W = VOV = I /k n W/L ⇒ 2 L k n VOV 2(I /2) I = VOV VOV √ v id /2 2 = 0.1 → v id = 2 VOV 0.1 VOV gm = Ex: 8.5 With I = 200 μA, for all transistors, 200 μA I = = 100 μA 2 2 L = 2(0.18 μm) = 0.36 μm ID = ro1 = ro2 = ro3 = ro4 = (10 V/ μm) (0.36 μm) = 36 k 0.1 mA 1 W 2 , VOV Since ID1 = ID2 = μn Cox 2 L W 2ID W = = 2 L 1 L 2 μn Cox VOV = 2(100 μA) = 12.5 400 μA/V2 (0.2 V)2 W W 2ID = = L 3 L 4 μp Cox |VOV |2 2(100 μA) = 50 100 μA/V2 (0.2)2 gm = I 0.8 mA = = 0.4 mA 2 2 1 W ID = k n (VOV )2 2 L Ex: 8.4 ID = VA L ID ID (100 μA) (2) = = 1 mA/V, VOV /2 0.2 V so Ad = gm1 (ro1 ro3 ) = 1(mA/V) (36 k 36 k) = 18 V/V Exercise 8–2 Ex: 8.6 L = 2 (0.18 μm) = 0.36 μm All ro = VA VCC Ex: 8.8 2.5 V ·L ID RC The drain current for all transistors is 200 μA I = 100 μA ID = = 2 2 (10 V/ μm) (0.36 μm) = 36 k ro = 0.1 mA Refering to Fig. 8.13(a), 1 W 2 for all NMOS VOV Since ID = μn Cox 2 L transistors, W W W W = = = L 1 L 2 L 3 L 4 2ID 2(100 μA) = = 12.5 2 μn Cox VOV 400 μA/V2 (0.2 V)2 W W W W = = = L 5 L 6 L 7 L 8 = = 2ID 2(100 μA) = = 50 2 μp Cox VOV 100 μA/V2 (0.2 V)2 For all transistors, gm = |ID | (0.1 mA) (2) = 1 mA/V = |VOV | /2 (0.2 V) From Fig. 8.13(b), Ron = (gm3 ro3 ) ro1 = (1 × 36) × 36 = 1.296 M Rop = (gm5 ro5 )ro7 = (1 × 36) × 36 = 1.296 M Ad = gm1 Ron Rop = (1 mA/V) (1.296 M 1.296 M) = 648 V/V IC1 IC2 RC 5 k I 0.4 mA 2.5 V VEE IC1 = IC2 IE1 = IE2 = I 0.4 mA = 2 2 = 0.2 mA VCM max VC + 0.4 V = VCC − IC RC + 0.4 V = 2.5 − 0.2 mA (5 k) + 0.4 V = +1.9 V VCM min = −VEE + VCS + VBE VCM min = −2.5 V + 0.3 V + 0.7 V = −1.5 V Input common-mode range is −1.5 V to +1.9 V Ex: 8.9 Substituting iE1 + iE2 = I in Eqn. (8.45) yields iE1 = I 1 + e(v B2 −v B1 )/VT I 1 + e(v B2 −v B1 )/VT 1 v B1 − v B2 = −VT ln −1 0.99 0.99 I = = −25ln (1/99) Ex: 8.7 = 25ln (99) = 115 mV Ex: 8.10 (a) The DC current in each transistor is 0.5 mA. Thus VBE for each will be 0.5 VBE = 0.7 + 0.025ln 1 = 0.683 V ⇒ v E = 5 − 0.683 = +4.317 V (b) gm = IC 0.5 mA = = 20 VT 0.025 V (c) iC1 = 0.5 + gm1 v BE1 = 0.5 + 20 × 0.005 sin (2π × 1000t) = 0.5 + 0.1 sin(2π × 1000t), mA Exercise 8–3 iC2 = 0.5 − 0.1 sin(2π × 1000t), mA (d) v C1 = (VCC − IC RC ) − 0.1 ×RC sin(2π × 1000t) = (15 − 0.5 × 10) − 0.1 × 10 sin(2π × 1000t) = 10 − 1 sin(2π × 1000t) , V v C2 = 10 + 1 sin(2π × 1000t) , V (e) v C2 − v C1 = 2 · sin(2π × 1000t) , V (f) Voltage gain ≡ v C2 − v C1 v B1 − v B2 2 V peak = 200 V/V = 0.01 V peak Ex: 8.13 If the output of a MOS differential amplifier is taken single-endedly, then 1 gm RD 2 (that is, half the gain obtained with the output taken differentially), and from Fig. 8.25(d) we have RD | Acm | 2RSS | Ad | = Thus, CMRR ≡ | Ad | = gm RSS | Acm | Q.E.D. Ex: 8.14 Ex: 8.11 The transconductance for each transistor is gm = 2μn Cox (W/L)ID ID = Thus, gm = VCC 0.8 mA I = = 0.4 mA 2 2 VB3 Q3 Q4 √ 2 × 0.2 × 100 × 0.4 = 4 mA/V vo1 vi1 The differential gain for matched v O2 − v O1 = gm RD RD values is Ad = v id = 86 dB Ex: 8.12 From Exercise 8.11, W/L = 100, μn Cox = 0.2 mA/V2 , 0.8 mA I = = 0.4 mA 2 2 W ID gm = 2μn Cox L ID = = 2 0.2 mA/V2 (100) (0.4 mA) gm = 4 mA/V Using Eq. (8.88) and the fact that RSS = 25 k, we obtain 2(4 mA/V) (25 k) (2 gm RSS ) = CMRR = gm 0.01 gm = 20, 000 CMRR (dB) = 20 log10 (20, 000) = 86 dB vo2 Q2 Q1 vi2 I 200 A If we ignore the 1% here, then we obtain Ad = gm RD = (4 mA/V) (5 k) = 20 V/V RD RD | Acm | = 2RSS RD 5 (0.01) = 0.001 V/V = 2 × 25 20 | Ad | = 20 log CMRR (dB) = 20 log | ACM | 0.001 VB4 Q5 VB5 VEE I = 200 μA Since β 1, I 200 μA = = 100 μA 2 2 IC 100 μA = 4 mA/V = gm = = VT 25 mV IC1 ≈ IC2 ≈ gm1 = gm2 RC1 = RC2 = RC = ro = = |VA | IC 10 V = 100 k 100 μA ro1 = ro2 = VA 10 = = 100 k I /2 0.1 re1 = re2 = re = VT 25 mV = = 0.25 k IE 0.1 mA RC ro 100 k 100 k = re 0.25 k = 200 V/V | Ad | = Rid = 2rπ , rπ = β 100 = 25 k = gm 4 mA/V Rid = 2(25 k) = 50 k Exercise 8–4 REE = 10 V VA = = 50 k I 200 μA = = RC RC 2REE RC Ex: 8.16 From Eq. (8.120), we get IS 2 RC 2 VOS = VT + RC IS 100 × 0.01 = 0.01 V/V 2 × 50 CMRR (dB) = 20 log10 = 86 dB Ad 200 = 20 log10 Acm 0.01 Using Eq. (8.96), we obtain RC βro · RC + 2REE 1+ ro 1+ Ricm = βREE 2 = 3.46 mV If the total load resistance is assumed to be mismatched by 1%, then we have | Acm | = 3 × 2 × 10−3 = 25 (0.02)2 + (0.1)2 = 2.55 mV 100 ∼ 100 = IB = = 0.5 μA 2(β + 1) 2 × 101 β IOS = IB β = 0.5 × 0.1 μA = 50 nA 100 100 × 100 = 100 × 50 × 100 + 2 × 50 1+ 100 Ricm 1.68 M 1+ 1 I = 0.4 mA 2 1 W V2 ID = μn Cox 2 L n OV Ex: 8.17 ID = 1 2 × 0.2 × 100 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V 0.4 = Ex: 8.15 From Exercise 8.4: VOV = 0.2 V Using Eq. (8.101) we obtain VOS due to RD /RD as: VOV RD · VOS = 2 RD 0.2 × 0.02 = 0.002 V i.e 2 mV 2 (W/L) , To obtain VOS due to W/L = gm1,2 = 2ID 2 × 0.4 = 4 mA/V = VOV 0.2 Gm = gm1,2 = 4 mA/V ro2 = VAn 20 = 50 k = ID 0.4 ro4 = |VAp | 20 = 50 k = ID 0.4 Ro = ro2 ro4 = 50 50 = 25 k Ad = Gm Ro = 4 × 25 = 100 V/V use Eq. (8.106), VOV (W/L) VOS = 2 W/L 0.2 × 0.02 = 0.002 ⇒ VOS = 2 = 16 mA/V ⇒ 2 mV ro2 = ro4 = The offset voltage arising from Vt is obtained from Eq. (8.109): Ro = ro2 ro4 = 250 250 = 125 k Ex: 8.18 Gm = gm1,2 VOS = Vt = 2 mV I /2 0.4 mA = VT 0.025 V 100 VA VA = = 250 k = IC I /2 0.4 Ad = Gm Ro = 16 × 125 = 2000 V/V β 160 =2× = 20 k gm1,2 16 Finally, from Eq. (8.110) the total input offset is Rid = 2rπ = 2 × VOS = 1/2 VOV RD 2 VOV (W/L) 2 2 + + (Vt ) 2 RD 2 W/L Ex: 8.19 I /2 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V = Gm = gm1 = gm2 VT 0.025 V = 2 × 10−3 2 + 2 × 10−3 2 + 2 × 10−3 2 ro4 = 100 V VA = = 200 k I /2 0.5 mA Exercise 8–5 Ro4 β4 ro4 = 50 × 200 = 10,000 k = 10 M Ro5 = 1 β5 ro5 2 (a) Using Eq. (8.170), we obtain I6 = where ro5 = Ex: 8.22 Refer to Fig. (8.40). VA = 200 k I /2 (W/L)6 (I /2) (W/L)4 ⇒ 100 = (W/L)6 × 50 100 Thus, thus, (W/L)6 = 200 1 Ro5 = × 100 × 200 = 10 M 2 Using Eq. (8.171), we get Ro = Ro4 Ro5 = 10 10 = 5 M I7 = Ad = Gm Ro = 20 mA/V × 5000 k = 105 V/V or 100 dB (W/L)7 I (W/L)5 ⇒ 100 = (W/L)7 × 100 200 thus, (W/L)7 = 200 Ex: 8.20 From Exercise 8.17, we get ID = 0.4 mA VOV = 0.2 V gm1,2 = 4 mA/V Gm = 4 mA/V Ad = 100 V/V Now, RSS = 25 k gm3 = = 1 W I = μp Cox V2 2 2 L 1 OV1 50 ⇒ VOV 1 = = 0.129 V 1 × 30 × 200 2 Similarly for Q2 , VOV 2 = 0.129 V 2μp Cox W L For Q6 , ID p √ 2 × 0.1 × 200 × 0.4 = 4 mA/V 1 1 = 0.005 V/V = | Acm | = 2gm3 RSS 2 × 4 × 25 CMRR = (b) For Q1 , 100 = ⇒ VOV 6 = 0.105 V (c) gm = 100 | Ad | = | Acm | 0.005 = 20,000 or 20 log 20,000 = 86 dB Ex: 8.21 From Exercise 8.18, we get 1 2 × 90 × 200VOV 6 2 2ID VOV ID Q1 Q2 Q6 VOV 50 μA 0.129 V 0.775 mA/V 50 μA 0.129 V 0.775 mA/V 100 μA 0.105 V 1.90 mA/V I = 0.8 mA, IC 0.4 mA, VA = 100 V (d) ro2 = 10/0.05 = 200 k gm1,2 = 16 mA/V, Gm = 16 mA/V ro4 = 10/0.05 = 200 k ro2 = ro4 = 250 k, Ad = 2000 V/V ro6 = 10/0.1 = 100 k Now, ro7 = 10/0.1 = 100 k REE = 100 V = 125 k 0.8 mA Using Eq. (8.165), | Acm | = ro4 250 = = 0.0125 V/V β3 REE 160 × 125 CMRR = 2000 | Ad | = = 160, 000 V/V | Acm | 0.0125 20 log CMRR = 104 dB gm (e) Eq. (8.168): A1 = −gm1 (ro2 ro4 ) = −0.775 (200 200) = −77.5 Eq. (8.169): A2 = −gm6 (ro6 ro7 ) = −95 V/V V V Exercise 8–6 Overall voltage gain is A1 × A2 = −77.5 × − 95 = 7363 V/V Ex: 8.23 Rid = 20.2 k Av o = 8513 V/V Ro = 152 With RS = 10 k and RL = 1 k, 1 20.2 × 8513 × Gv = 20.2 + 10 (1 + 0.152) = 4943 V/V Ex: 8.24 ie8 = β 8 + 1 = 101 ib8 ib7 R3 3 = 0.0126 = = ic5 R3 + Ri3 3 + 234.8 ic5 = β 5 = 100 ib5 R1 + R2 40 ib5 = = 0.888 = ic2 R1 + R2 + Ri2 40 + 5.05 ic2 = β 2 = 100 i1 Thus the overall current gain is ie8 = 101 × 0.0492 × 100 × 0.0126 × 100 i1 × 0.888 × 100 = 55,599 A/A and the overall voltage gain is R5 15.7 ib8 = 0.0492 = = ic7 R5 + Ri4 15.7 + 303.5 R6 ie8 vo = · v id Ri1 i1 ic7 = β 7 = 100 ib7 = 3 × 55599 = 8257 V/V 20.2 Chapter 8–1 8.1 Refer to Fig. 8.2. 1 W I = μn Cox V2 (a) 2 2 L 1,2 OV 0.08 = ⇒ VOV 1 2 × 0.4 × 10 × VOV 2 = 0.2 V ID1,2 = 1 W kp |VOV |2 2 L 1 × 4 × |VOV |2 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 0.35 V 0.25 = VSG = |Vtp | + |VOV | VGS = Vtn + VOV = 0.4 + 0.2 = 0.6 V = 0.8 + 0.35 = 1.15 V (b) VCM = 0 VS = 0 + VSG = +1.15 V VS = 0 − VGS = −0.6 V VD1 = VD2 = −VSS + ID RD I = 0.08 mA 2 = VDD − ID1,2 RD ID1 = ID2 = VD1 = VD2 = 1 − 0.08 × 5 = +0.6 V (c) VCM = +0.4 V VS = 0.4 − VGS = 0.4 − 0.6 = −0.2 V I = 0.08 mA 2 = VDD − ID1,2 RD ID1 = ID2 = VD1 = VD2 = 1 − 0.08 × 5 = +0.6 V Since VCM = 0.4 V and VD = 0.6 V, VGD = −0.2 V, which is less than Vtn (0.4 V), indicating that our implicit assumption of saturation-mode operation is justified. (d) VCM = −0.1 V VS = −0.1 − VGS = −0.1 − 0.6 = −0.7 V I = 0.08 mA 2 = VDD − ID1,2 RD ID1 = ID2 = VD1 = VD2 = 1 − 0.08 × 5 = +0.6 V (e) The highest value of VCM for which Q1 and Q2 remain in saturation is = −2.5 + 0.25 × 4 = −1.5 V Since for each of Q1 and Q2 , VSD = 1.15 − (−1.5) = 2.65 V which is greater than |VOV |, Q1 and Q2 are operating in saturation as implicitly assumed. (b) The highest value of VCM is limited by the need to keep a minimum of 0.4 V across the current source, thus VCM max = +2.5 − 0.4 − VSG = +2.5 − 0.4 − 1.15 = +0.95 V The lowest value of VCM is limited by the need to keep Q1 and Q2 in saturation, thus VCM min = VD1,2 − |Vtp | = −1.5 − 0.8 = −2.3 V Thus, −2.3 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.95 V 8.3 VDD 1 V VCM max = VD1,2 + Vtn = 0.6 + 0.4 = 1.0 V 5 k vD1 G1 VSmin = −VSS + VCS = −1 + 0.2 = −0.8 V VCM min = VSmin + VGS RD RD (f) To maintain the current-source operating properly, we need to keep a minimum voltage of 0.2 V across it, thus vid = −0.8 + 0.6 vGS1 iD1 iD2 Q1 Q2 vS = −0.2 V ID1 = ID2 1 = × 0.5 = 0.25 mA 2 G2 vGS2 I 0.16 mA VSS 1 V 8.2 Refer to Fig. P8.2. (a) For v G1 = v G2 = 0 V, 5 k vD2 (a) For iD1 = iD2 = 0.08 mA, v G1 = v G2 Chapter 8–2 Thus, 0.16 = v id = 0 V iD1 = iD2 0.08 = 1 W 2 = μn Cox VOV 2 L 1 2 × 0.4 × 10 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V v GS1 = v GS2 = 0.2 + 0.4 = 0.6 V v S = −0.6 V 1 × 0.4 × 10 (v id + 0.4 − 0.4)2 2 ⇒ v id = 0.283 V √ which is 2VOV , as derived in the text. v GS1 = 0.283 − (−0.4) = 0.683 V v D1 = VDD − iD1 RD = 1 − 0.16 × 5 = +0.2 V Note that since v G1 = v id = 0.283 V, Q1 is still operating in saturation, as implicitly assumed. v D1 = v D2 = VDD − iD1,2 RD v D2 = VDD − iD2 RD = 1 − 0.08 × 5 = 0.6 V =1−0×5=1V v D2 − v D1 = 0 V (b) For iD1 = 0.12 mA and iD2 = 0.04 mA, 1 W (v GS2 − Vtn )2 iD2 = μn Cox 2 L 0.04 = 1 × 0.4 × 10 × (v GS2 − 0.4)2 2 ⇒ v GS2 = 0.541 V Thus, v S = −0.541 V 1 W (v GS1 − Vtn )2 iD1 = μn Cox 2 L 0.12 = 1 × 0.4 × 10 (v id − v S − Vtn )2 2 1 = × 0.4 × 10 (v id + 0.541 − 0.4)2 2 v D2 − v D1 = 1 − 0.2 = 0.8 V (d) iD1 = 0.04 mA and iD2 = 0.12 mA. Since this split of the current I is the complement of that in case (b) above, the value of v id must be the negative of that found in (b). Thus, v id = −0.104 V v GS1 = 0.541 V v S = −0.645 V v GS2 = 0.645 V v D1 = VDD − iD1 RD = 1 − 0.04 × 5 = 0.8 V v D2 = 1 − 0.12 × 5 = 0.4 V v D2 − v D1 = −0.4 V ⇒ v id = 0.104 V (e) iD1 = 0 (Q1 just cuts off) and iD2 = 0.16 mA. This case is the complement of that in (c) above, thus v GS1 = 0.104 − (−0.541) = 0.645 V v GS1 = Vtn = 0.4 V v D1 = VDD − iD1 RD v GS2 = 0.683 V = 1 − 0.12 × 5 = 0.4 V v S = −0.683 V v D2 = VDD − iD2 RD = 1 − 0.04 × 5 = 0.8 V v id = −0.683 + 0.4 = −0.283 V √ which is − 2 VOV , as derived in the text. v D2 − v D1 = 0.8 − 0.4 = 0.4 V v D1 = VDD − iD1 RD = 1 − 0 × 5 = 1 V (c) iD1 = 0.16 mA and iD2 = 0 with Q2 just cutting off, thus v D2 = VDD − iD2 RD = 1 − 0.16 × 5 = 0.2 V v GS2 = Vtn = 0.4 V ⇒ v S2 = −0.4 V iD1 = 1 × 0.4 × 10 (v GS1 − Vtn )2 2 v D2 − v D1 = −0.8 V Summary A summary of the results is shown in the following table on the next page. Chapter 8–3 Case i D1 (mA) i D2 (mA) a 0.08 0.08 b 0.12 0.04 c 0.16 0 d 0.04 0.12 e 0 0.16 vid (V) vS (V) 0 −0.6 vD1 (V) vD2 (V) vD2 − vD1 (V) +0.6 +0.6 0 +0.104 −0.541 +0.4 +0.8 +0.4 +0.283 +0.2 +1.0 +0.8 −0.104 −0.645 +0.8 +0.4 −0.4 −0.283 −0.683 +1.0 +0.2 −0.8 −0.4 8.4 To obtain the complementary split in current, that is, iD1 = 0.07 mA and iD2 = 0.09 mA, VDD 1 V v id = −0.025 V RD RD 5 k vD1 G1 vid vGS1 5 k vD2 iD1 iD2 Q2 Q1 vS G2 vGS2 I 0.16 mA VSS 1 V 8.5 Refer to Fig. P8.2. To determine VOV , 1 × 4 × |VOV |2 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 0.354 V 0.25 = With v G2 = 0 and v G1 = v id , to steer the current from one side of the differential pair to the other, v id must be the ends of the range √ √ − 2 |VOV | ≤ v id ≤ 2 |VOV | that is, −0.5 V ≤ v id ≤ +0.5 V For iD1 = 0.09 mA and iD2 = 0.07 mA, 1 W (v GS2 − Vtn )2 iD2 = μn Cox 2 L 1 0.07 = × 0.4 × 10(v GS2 − 0.4)2 2 ⇒ v GS2 = 0.587 V and v S = −0.587 V 1 W iD1 = μn Cox (v GS1 − Vtn )2 2 L 1 0.09 = × 0.4 × 10 (v GS1 − 0.4)2 2 ⇒ v GS1 = 0.612 V v id = v S + v GS1 = −0.587 + 0.612 At v id = −0.5 V, Q2 just cuts off, thus v S = |Vtp | = 0.8 V and v SG1 = 0.8 − (−0.5) = 1.3 V At this value of v SG1 , 1 × 4 × (1.3 − 0.8)2 2 = 0.5 mA iD1 = which is the entire bias current. v D1 = −2.5 + 0.5 × 4 = −0.5 V Observe that since v G1 = v D1 , Q1 is still operating in saturation, as implicitly assumed. = 0.025 V v D2 = −2.5 V v D2 = VDD − iD2 RD At v id = +0.5 V, Q1 just cuts off, thus v SG1 = |Vtp | = 0.8 V and = 1 − 0.07 × 5 = 0.65 V v D1 = 1 − 0.09 × 5 = 0.55 V v D2 − v D1 = 0.65 − 0.55 = 0.10 V 0.10 v D2 − v D1 = = 4 V/V Voltage gain = v id 0.025 v S = +0.5 + 0.8 = +1.3 V and thus v SG2 = 1.3 V which results in Chapter 8–4 1 × 4 (1.3 − 0.8)2 2 = 0.5 mA The upper limit on VCM is determined by the need to keep Q1 and Q2 in saturation, thus which is the entire bias current. Here, = 0.1 + 0.4 = 0.5 V iD1 = v D2 = −2.5 + 0.5 × 4 = −0.5 V which verifies that Q2 is operating in saturation, as implicitly assumed. 8.6 Refer to the circuit in Fig. P8.6. For v G1 = v G2 = 0 V, ID1 = ID2 = 0.4 = 0.2 mA 2 To obtain VD1 = VD2 = +0.1 V VDD − ID1,2 RD = 0.1 0.9 − 0.2 RD = 0.1 Thus, −0.2 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.5 V 8.7 Refer to Eq. (8.23). For v id /2 2 ≤k VOV √ v id /2 ≤ k ⇒ VOV v id /2 2 v id /2 1− I = I VOV VOV √ √ Imax = I k 1 − k (1) Thus, ⇒ RD = 4 k For Q1 and Q2 , VICM max = VD1,2 + Vtn 1 W μn Cox V2 2 L 1,2 OV W 1 0.2 = × 0.4 × 0.152 2 L 1,2 W ⇒ = 44.4 L 1,2 ID1,2 = √ Imax = 2 k(1 − k) I /2 Q.E.D. (2) and the corresponding value of v id is found from Eq. (2) as √ v id max = 2 kVOV Q.E.D. (3) Equations (2) and (3) can be used to evaluate Imax v id max and for various values of k: I /2 VOV For Q3 , W 1 × 0.4 × × 0.152 2 L 3 W ⇒ = 88.8 L 3 0.4 = k v id max VOV Imax I /2 0.01 0.1 0.2 0.2 0.632 0.894 0.2 0.6 0.8 Since Q3 and Q4 form a current mirror with ID3 = 4ID4 , 1 W W = = 22.2 L 4 4 L 3 8.8 Switching occurs at √ v id = 2VOV VGS4 = VGS3 = Vtn + VOV = 0.4 + 0.15 Thus, = 0.55 V 0.9 − (−0.9) − 0.55 R= 0.1 = 12.5 k The lower limit on VCM is determined by the need to keep Q3 operating in saturation. For this to happen, the minimum value of VDS3 is VOV = 0.15 V. Thus, VICM min = −VSS + VOV 3 + VGS1,2 = −0.9 + 0.15 + 0.4 + 0.15 = −0.2 V 0.3 = √ 2VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.212 V Now, to obtain full current switching at v id = 0.5 V, VOV must be increased to VOV = 0.212 × 0.5 = 0.353 V 0.3 2 the current ID and Since ID is proportional to VOV hence the bias current I must be increased by the ratio (0.353/0.212)2 , then I must be 0.353 2 I = 200 × = 554.5 μA 0.212 Chapter 8–5 8.9 Refer to Fig. 8.5. gm = 1= 0.25 = 2(I /2) I = VOV VOV ⇒ 1 1 × 0.25 = × 0.4 × 2 2 8.12 Since the quiescent power dissipation is P = (VDD + VSS ) × I W L 0.252 W = 10 L 8.10 0.1 = 1 2 × 0.2 × 32VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.18 V gm = 2 × (0.2/2) = 1.11 mA/V 0.18 VA 10 = 100 k = ro = ID 0.1 Ad = gm (RD ro ) = 1.11 × (10 100) = 10.1 V/V 8.11 For v id = 0.1 V W = 40 L I 0.25 ⇒ I = 0.25 mA 1 I W 2 = μn Cox VOV 2 2 L ⇒ W 1 × 0.2 × × 0.252 2 L v id /2 VOV 2 = 0.04 v id /2 = 0.2 VOV 0.1/2 = 0.2 VOV then the maximum allowable I is 1 mW = 0.5 mA I= 2V We shall utilize this value. The value of VOV can be found from √ 2 VOV = 0.25 V 0.25 ⇒ VOV = √ = 0.18 V 2 The realized value of gm will be gm = 2 × (I /2) VOV 0.5 = 2.8 mA/V 0.18 To obtain a differential gain Ad of 10 V/V, = Ad = gm RD 10 = 2.8 × RD ⇒ RD = 3.6 k Finally, the required value of W/L can be determined from I W 2 1 ID = = μn Cox VOV 2 2 L 1 W 0.25 = × 0.4 × × 0.182 2 L W ⇒ = 38.6 L ⇒ VOV = 0.25 V gm = 2 × (I /2) VOV 8.13 To limit the power dissipation to 1 mW, P = (VDD + VSS )I I 2= 0.25 Thus, the maximum value we can use for I is ⇒ I = 0.5 mA I= Ad = 1V = 10 0.1 V gm RD = 10 10 = 5 k 2 I 1 W 2 = μn Cox VOV 2 2 L ⇒ RD = 1 mW = 0.5 mA 2V Using this value, we obtain I RD 2 0.2 = 1 − 0.25 × RD VD = VDD − ⇒ RD = 3.2 k Ad = gm RD 10 = gm × 3.2 Chapter 8–6 gm = 10 = 3.125 mA/V 3.2 8.15 Since both circuits use the same supply voltages and dissipate equal powers, then their currents must be equal, that is, 2 × (I /2) I = VOV VOV ID = I But gm = 3.125 = 0.5 VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.16 V To obtain W/L, we use 1 W 2 VOV ID = μn Cox 2 L W 1 × 0.162 0.25 = × 0.4 × 2 L W ⇒ = 48.8 50 L where ID is the bias current of the CS amplifier and I is the bias current of the differential pair. The gain of the CS amplifier is | A| = gm RD where gm = Thus, 2μn Cox | A| = W L 2μn Cox ID CS W L ID RD (1) CS The gain of the differential amplifier is 8.14 (a) Ad = gm RD Ad = gm RD 20 = gm × 47 where 20 = 0.426 mA/V ⇒ gm = 47 2ID 2(I /2) I = = (b) gm = VOV VOV VOV I 0.426 = 0.2 ⇒ I = 0.085 mA = 85 μA (c) Across each RD the dc voltage is 0.085 I RD = × 47 = 2 V 2 2 (d) The peak sine-wave signal across each gate source is 5 mV, thus at each drain the peak sine wave is Ad × 5 = 20 × 5 = 100 mV = 0.1 V (e) The minimum voltage at each drain will be v Dmin = VDD − RD ID − Vpeak = VDD − 2 − 0.1 gm = Thus, 2μn Cox Ad = 2μn Cox I 2 diff I RD 2 diff (2) If all transistors have the same channel length, each of the differential pair transistors must be twice as wide as the transistor in the CS amplifier. 8.16 For a CS amplifier biased at a current ID and utilizing a drain resistance RD , the voltage gain is |A| = gm RD v Dmin ≥ v Gmax − Vtn where where gm = v Gmax = VCM + Vpeak (input) Thus, Thus, W L Equating the gains in Eqs. (1) and (2) and substituting ID = I gives 1 W W = × L CS L diff 2 W W =2 ⇒ L diff L CS For the transistor to remain in saturation = 0.5 + 0.005 = 0.505 V W L |A| = 2μn Cox 2μn Cox W ID L W√ ID RD L (1) VDD ≥ 2.105 V For a differential pair biased with a current I and utilizing drain resistances RD , the differential gain is Thus, the lowest value of VDD is 2.21 V. Ad = gm RD VDD − 2.1 ≥ 0.505 − 0.5 Chapter 8–7 where W I 2μn Cox L 2 gm = Thus = Ad = 2μn Cox W √ I /2 RD L (2) Equating the gains from Eqs. (1) and (2), we get I = 2ID That is, the differential pair must be biased at a current twice that of the CS amplifier. Since both circuits use equal power supplies, the power dissipation of the differential pair will be twice that of the CS amplifier. μn (W/L)1,2 μp (W/L)3,4 (c) μn = 4μp and all channel lengths are equal, W1,2 Ad = 2 W3,4 For Ad = 10, W1,2 10 = 2 W3,4 ⇒ W1,2 = 25 W3,4 8.18 8.17 Q3 RD vod / 2 (vod / 2) vid 2 vid 2 Q1 Rs / 2 (a) The figure shows the differential half-circuit. Recalling that the incremental (small-signal) resistance of a diode-connected transistor is given 1 by ro , the equivalent load resistance of gm Q1 will be From symmetry, a virtual ground appears at the mid point of Rs . Thus, the differential half circuit will be as shown in the figure, and v od RD = Rs 1 v id + gm 2 1 ro3 RD = gm3 Ad ≡ and the differential gain of the amplifier in Fig. P8.17 will be v od 1 = gm1 ro3 ro1 Ad ≡ v id gm3 For Rs = 0, Since both sides of the amplifier are matched, this expression can be written in a more general way as 1 ro3,4 ro1,2 Ad = gm1,2 gm3,4 (b) Neglecting ro1,2 and ro3,4 (much larger that 1/gm3,4 ), gm1,2 Ad gm3,4 2μn Cox (W/L)1,2 (I /2) = 2μp Cox (W/L)3,4 (I /2) Ad = RD = gm RD , 1/gm as expected. To reduce the gain to half this value, we use 1 Rs = 2 gm ⇒ Rs = 2 gm 8.19 Refer to Fig. P8.19. (a) With v G1 = v G2 = 0, v GS1 = v GS2 = VOV 1,2 + Vtn Chapter 8–8 Thus 8.20 Refer to Fig. P8.20. VS1 = VS2 = −(VOV 1,2 + Vtn ) (a) With v G1 = v G2 = 0 V, (b) For the situation in (a), VDS of Q3 is zero, thus zero current flows in Q3 . Transistor Q3 will have an overdrive voltage of VS1 = VS2 = −VGS1,2 = −(Vt + VOV ) VOV 3 = VC − VS1,2 − Vtn = VC + (VOV 1,2 + Vtn ) − Vtn = VC + VOV 1,2 (c) With v G1 = v id /2 and v G2 = −v id /2 where v id is a small signal, a small signal will appear between drain and source of Q3 . Transistor Q3 will be operating in the triode region and its drain-source resistance rDS will be given by rDS = μn Cox 1 W VOV 3 L 3 Thus, Rs = μn Cox 1 W VOV 3 L 3 Now, W VOV 1,2 L 1,2 W gm3 = (μn Cox ) VOV 3 L 3 W W For = , L 3 L 1,2 W gm1,2 = μn Cox L VOV 1,2 gm1,2 = (μn Cox ) The current through Q3 and Q4 will be zero because the voltage across them (v DS3 + v DS4 ) is zero. Because the voltages at their gates are zero and at their sources are −(Vt + VOV ), each of Q3 and Q4 will be operating at an overdrive voltage equal to VOV . Thus each of Q3 and Q4 will have an rDS given by μn Cox Since (d) (i) Rs = 1 gm1,2 VOV 3 = VOV 1,2 rDS3,4 = 0.5 gm1,2 W L VOV 1 gm1,2 (W/L)1,2 (W/L)3,4 Rs = rDS3 + rDS4 then 2 (W/L)1,2 gm1,2 (W/L)3,4 Rs = (3) (b) With v G1 = v id /2 and v G2 = −v id /2 where v id is a small signal, Ad ≡ = v od v id 2 RD 1 1 + Rs + gm1 gm2 Using (3), we obtain Ad = 1 gm1,2 = RD 1 (W/L)1,2 + gm1,2 (W/L)3,4 gm1,2 RD (W/L)1,2 1+ (W/L)3,4 8.21 Refer to Fig. P8.21. The value of R is found as follows: But R= ⇒ VC = VOV 1,2 (2) 1,2 ⇒ VOV 3 = 2 VOV 1,2 VOV 3 = VC + VOV 1,2 (1) and since ⇒ VC = 0 (ii) Rs = 1 W VOV L 3,4 substituting from (2) into (1) gives But VOV 3 = VC + VOV 1,2 gm1,2 = μn Cox Thus, 1 1 VOV 1,2 = Rs = g m1,2 g m1,2 VOV 3 × VOV 3 VOV 1,2 rDS3,4 = = VG6 − VG7 IREF 0.8 − (−0.8) = 8 k 0.2 Chapter 8–9 Since I = IREF , Q3 and Q6 are matched and are operating at A summary of the results is provided in the table below. |VOV | = 1.5 − 0.8 − 0.5 = 0.2 V Thus, 1 W 0.2 = × 0.1 × × 0.22 2 L 6,3 W W ⇒ = = 100 L 3 L 6 Transistor W/L I D (mA) |V GS |(V) Each of Q4 and Q5 is conducting a dc current of (I /2) while Q7 is conducting a dc current IREF = I . Thus Q4 and Q5 are matched and their W/L ratios are equal while Q7 has twice the (W/L) ratio of Q4 and Q5 . Thus, I 1 W = μn Cox V2 2 2 L 4,5 OV 4,5 Q1 50 0.1 0.7 Q2 50 0.1 0.7 Q3 100 0.2 0.7 Q4 20 0.1 0.7 Q5 20 0.1 0.7 Q6 100 0.2 0.7 Q7 40 0.2 0.7 where VOV 4,5 = −0.8 − (−1.5) − 0.5 = 0.2 V thus, 1 W × 0.25 × × 0.04 2 L 4,5 W W ⇒ = = 20 L 4 L 5 0.1 = and W = 40 L 7 ro4 = ro5 = |VAp | 10 = = 100 k I /2 0.1 ro1 = ro2 = 10 VAn = = 100 k I /2 0.1 Ad = gm1,2 (ro1,2 ro4,5 ) 8.22 Refer to Fig. 8.13. All transistors have the same channel length and are carrying a dc current I /2. Thus all transistors |VA | have the same ro = . Also, all transistors are I /2 operating at the same |VOV | and have equal dc currents, thus all have the same 2(I /2) gm = = I /|VOV |. Thus all transistors have |VOV | equal intrinsic gain gm ro = 2|VA |/|VOV |. Now, the gain Ad is given by Ad = gm (Ron Rop ) = 1 gm Ron 2 = 1 1 gm (gm ro )ro = (gm ro )2 2 2 Thus, 50 = gm1,2 (100 100) ⇒ gm1,2 = 1 mA/V Ad = 1 2|VA | 2 2 VOV = 2(|VA |/|VOV |)2 But Q.E.D. gm1,2 2(I /2) = |VOV 1,2 | To obtain Ad = 500 V/V while operating all transistors at |VOV | = 0.2 V, we use 1= 0.2 |VOV 1,2 | 500 = 2 |VA |2 0.04 ⇒ |VOV 1,2 | = 0.2 V ⇒ |VA | = 3.16 V The (W/L) ratio for Q1 and Q2 can now be determined from 1 W 0.1 = × 0.1 × × 0.22 2 L 1,2 W W ⇒ = = 50 L 1 L 2 Since |VA | = 5 V/μm, the channel length L (for all transistors) must be 3.16 = 5 × L L = 0.632 μm To obtain the highest possible gm , we operate at the highest possible I consistent with limiting the Chapter 8–10 power dissipation (in equilibrium) to 0.5 mW. Thus, I= 0.5 mW = 0.28 mA (0.9 + 0.9)V = +0.52 V VC2 = VCC − IC2 × RC = 2.5 − 0 × 5 = 2.5 V 8.23 Refer to Fig. 8.15(a). The current I will split equally between Q1 and Q2 . Thus, Observe that Q1 is operating in the active mode, as implicitly assumed, and the current source has a voltage of 2.323 V across it, more than sufficient for its proper operation. IE1 = IE2 = 0.2 mA IC1 = IC2 = α × 0.2 = 0.99 × 0.2 = 0.198 mA 0.198 VBE1 = VBE2 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1 VCC 2.5 V RC 5 k RC 5 k VC1 VC2 = 0.660 V VE1 = VE2 = −1 − 0.66 = −1.66 V 0.5 V VC1 = VC2 = VCC − IC1.2 RC IC2 IC1 Q1 Q2 = 2.5 − 0.198 × 5 = +1.51 V VE 8.24 0.4 mA VCC 2.5 V IC1 IC2 RC 5 k RC 5 k VC1 VC2 0.5 V Q1 Q2 VEE 2.5 V (b) (b) With v B1 = −0.5 V, Q1 turns off and Q2 conducts all the bias current (0.4 mA) and thus exhibits a VBE of 0.677 V, thus VE = −0.677 V VE 0.4 mA VEE 2.5 V (a) (a) For v B1 = +0.5 V, Q1 conducts all the current I (0.4 mA) while Q2 cuts off. Thus Q1 will have a VBE obtained as follows: 0.99 × 0.4 VBE1 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1 which indicated that VBE1 = +0.177 V, which is too small to turn Q1 on. Also, note that the current source has a voltage of −0.677 + 2.5 = 1.823 V across it, more than sufficient for its proper operation. VC1 = VCC − IC1 RC = 2.5 − 0 × 5 = 2.5 V VC2 = 2.5 − 0.99 × 0.4 × 5 = +0.52 V VC1 = VCC − IC1 RC 8.25 Refer to Fig. 8.15(a) and assume the current source I is implemented with a single BJT that requires a minimum of 0.3 V for proper operation. Thus, the minimum voltage allowed at the emitters of Q1 and Q2 is −2.5 V + 0.3 V = −2.2 V. Now, since each of Q1 and Q2 is conducting a current of 0.2 mA, their VBE voltages will be equal: 0.99 × 0.2 VBE1,2 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1 = 2.5 − 0.99 × 0.4 × 5 = 0.660 V = 0.677 V Thus, VE = +0.5 − 0.677 = −0.177 V which indicates that VBE2 = +0.177 V, too small to turn Q2 on. Chapter 8–11 Thus, the minimum allowable VCM is VCM min = −2.2 + 0.660 = −1.54 V The upper limit on VCM is dictated by the need to keep Q1 and Q2 operating in the active mode, thus VCM max = 0.4 + VC1,2 = 0.4 + (2.5 − 0.99 × 0.2 × 5) = +1.91 V iC1 = 10.78 μA, v BE1 iC2 = 8.82 μA 10.78 × 10−3 = 0.69 + 0.025 ln 1 = 0.5767 V v BE2 8.82 × 10−3 = 0.69 + 0.025 ln 1 = 0.5717 V Thus, Thus, the input common-mode range is −1.54 V ≤ VICM ≤ 1.91 V v B1 = v BE1 − v BE2 = 0.5767 − 0.5717 = 0.005 V = 5 mV 8.26 (a) Refer to Fig. 8.15(a). I = 10 μA 2 IC1 = IC2 = α × 10 = 0.98 × 10 = 9.8 μA 9.8 × 10−3 VBE1 = VBE2 = 0.690 + 0.025 ln 1 IE1 = IE2 = = 0.574 V Thus, VE = −0.574 V VC1 = VC2 = VCC − IC RC = 1.2 − 9.8 × 10−3 × 82 0.4 V (b) Refer to Fig. 8.15(a). The maximum value of VCM is limited by the need to keep Q1 and Q2 in the active mode. This is achieved by keeping v CE1,2 ≥ 0.3 V. Since VC1,2 = 0.4 V, VEmax = 0.4 − 0.3 = 0.1 V and 8.27 Refer to Fig. 8.15(a) with VCC replaced by (VCC + v r ). I v C1 = (VCC + v r ) − α RC 2 I = (VCC − α RC ) + v r 2 I v C2 = (VCC + v r ) − α RC 2 I = (VCC − α RC ) + v r 2 v od ≡ v C2 − v C1 = 0 Thus, while v C1 and v C2 will include a ripple component v r , the difference output voltage v od will be ripple free. Thus, the differential amplifier rejects the undesirable supply ripple. 8.28 Refer to Fig. 8.14. I (a) VCM max = VCC − RC 2 (b) For VCC = 2 V and VCM max = 1 V, VCM max = VBE1,2 + VEmax 1 1 = 2 − (IRC ) 2 VCM max = 0.574 + 0.1 = 0.674 V ⇒ IRC = 2 V The minimum value of VCM is dictated by the need to keep the current source operating properly, i.e. to keep 0.3 V across it, thus (c) IB = I ≤ 2 × 101 × 2 = 404 μA VEmin = −1.2 + 0.3 = −0.9 V Select and I = 0.4 mA VCM min = VEmin + VBE1,2 then = −0.9 + 0.574 = −0.326 V RC = 2 = 5 k 0.4 8.29 iE1 iE1 − (I /2) = I I Thus, the input common-mode range is −0.326 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.674 V (c) Refer to Fig. 8.15(d). iE1 = 11 μA, iE2 = 9 μA = I /2 ≤ 2 μA β +1 iE1 − 0.5 I Chapter 8–12 This table belongs to Problem 8.29. v id (mV) 2 5 8 10 20 30 40 iE1 /v id (V−1 ) 9.99 9.97 9.92 9.87 9.50 8.95 8.30 I This table belongs to Problem 8.30. v id (mV) 2 v od (V) 0.2 0.498 0.987 1.457 1.90 2.311 2.685 3.022 3.320 v od Gain = v id 100 99.7 5 10 98.7 15 97.1 20 95.0 Using Eq. (8.48), we obtain 1 iE1 = − 0.5 I 1 + e−v id /VT Observe that for v id < 10 mV the proportional transconductance gain is nearly constant at about 10. The gain decreases as v id further increases, indicating nonlinear operation. This is especially pronounced for v id > 20 mV. 8.30 Refer to Fig. 8.14. v od = v C2 − v C1 = (VCC − iC2 RC ) − (VCC − iC1 RC ) 25 92.4 30 89.5 35 86.3 40 83.0 The figure shows v od versus v id and the gain versus v id . Observe that the transfer characteristic is nearly linear and the gain is nearly constant for v id ≤ 10 mV. As v id increases, the transfer characteristic bends and the gain is reduced. However, for v id even as large as 20 mV, the gain is only 5% below its ideal value of 100. 8.31 Require v od = 1 V when v id = 10 mV and I = 1 mA. Using Eq. (8.48), we obtain iE1 = 1 (mA) = 0.599 mA 1 + e−10/25 = RC (iC1 − iC2 ) iE2 = I − iE1 = 1 − 0.599 = 0.401 mA Using Eqs. (8.48) and (8.49) and assuming α 1, so that iC1 iE1 and iC2 iE2 , we get 1 1 − v od = IRC 1 + e−v id /VT 1 + ev id /VT 1 1 − =5 1 + e−v id /VT 1 + ev id /VT v od = v C2 − v C1 This relationship can be used to obtain the data in the table above. For v od = 1 V, we have = (VCC − iC2 RC ) − (VCC − iC1 RC ) = (iC1 − iC2 )RC (iE1 − iE2 )RC = 0.198RC 1 = 5.05 k 0.198 I VC1 = VC2 = VCC − RC 2 = 5 − 0.5 × 5.05 2.5 V RC = With a signal of 10 mV applied, the voltage at one collector rises to 3 V and at the other falls to 2 V. To ensure that the transistors remain in the active region, the maximum common-mode input voltage must be limited to (2 − 0.4) = +1.6 V. 8.32 (a) VBE = 0.69 + 0.025 ln = 0.632 V 0.1 1 Chapter 8–13 (b) Using Eq. (8.48), we obtain I iC1 = αiE1 1 + e−v id /VT ⇒ I = 2VT gm For v id = 20 mV, 8.35 v id = 10 mA/V iC1 200 μA = = 138 μA 1 + e−20/25 iC2 = 200 − 138 = 62 μA (c) For v id = 200 mV while iC1 = 138 μA and iC2 = 62 μA: Since iC1 and iC2 have not changed, v BE1 and v BE2 also would not change. Thus, v B1 − v B2 = v BE1 + iE1 Re − iE2 Re − v BE2 = (v BE1 − v BE2 ) + Re (iE1 − iE2 ) 200 = 20 + Re (iC1 − iC2 ) = 20 + Re (138 − 62) ⇒ Re = 180 mV = 2.37 k 76 μA (d) Without Re , v id = 20 mV → iC1 − iC2 = 76 μA 76 μA = 3.8 mA/V Gm = 20 mV With Re , v id = 200 mV → iC1 − iC2 = 76 μA 76 μA = 0.38 mA/V Gm = 200 mV Thus, the effective Gm has been reduced by a factor of 10, which is the same factor by which the allowable input signal has been increased while maintaining the same linearity. 8.33 gm = IC α × 0.2 = 8 mA/V VT 0.025 Rid = 2rπ = 2 β 160 = 40 k =2× gm 8 8.34 Rid = 2rπ = 20 k = 2 × 0.025 × 10 = 0.5 mA Input signal to half-circuit = 5 mV. For I = 200 μA, the bias current of the half-circuit is 100 μA and, 25 mV = 250 re = 0.1 mA 10 RC =− Gain of half-circuit = − re 0.25 = −40 V/V At each collector we expect a signal of 40 × 5 mV = 200 mV. Between the two collectors, the signal will be 400 mV. 25 mV = 100 0.25 mA The 0.1-V differential input signal appears across (2re + 2Re ), thus 8.36 (a) re = ie = 100 mV = 0.1 mA 200 + 2 × 400 v be = 0.1 × 100 = 10 mV (b) The total emitter current in one transistor is I + ie = 0.35 mA and in the other transistor 2 I − ie = 0.15 mA. 2 (c) At one collector the signal voltage is −αie RC −ie RC = −0.1 × 10 = −1 V and at the other collector the signal voltage is +1 V. (d) Voltage gain = 8.37 2V = 20 V/V 0.1 V VCC RC RC rπ = 10 k vod β = 10 k gm 100 = 10 gm Re Re ⇒ gm = 10 mA/V Ad = 100 = gm RC RC = 100 100 = 10 k = gm 10 gm = IC I /2 VT VT I VEE Chapter 8–14 v id = 100 mV appears across (2 re + 2 Re ). Thus the signal across (re + Re ) is 50 mV. Since the signal across re is 5 mV, it follows that the signal across Re must be 50 − 5 = 45 mV and thus Re = 9re We choose to operate at this value of I . Thus gm = IC α(0.2/2) 4 mA/V = VT 0.025 Ad = gm RC 60 = 4 × RC The input resistance Rid is Rid = (β + 1) (2re + 2Re ) = 2(100 + 1) (re + Re ) ⇒ RC = 15 k I VC1 = VC2 = VCC − RC 2 0.2 × 15 2 = 2 × 101 × (re + 9re ) = 2.5 − = 2 × 101 × 10re = +1 V To obtain Rid = 100 k, (b) Rid = 2rπ = 2 100 = 2 × 101 × 10 × re ⇒ re 50 = 60 × 10 = 600 mV = 0.6 V VT , IE 25 mV 50 = IE ⇒ IE = 0.5 mA I = 1 mA Re = 9re = 9 × 50 = 450 Gain = 100 = 50 k 4 (c) v od = Ad × v id Since re = =2× β gm α × 2RC 2re + 2Re RC re + Re Thus, there will be ±0.3 V signal swing at each collector. That is, the voltage at each collector will range between 0.7 V and +1.3 V. (d) To maintain the BJT in the active mode at all times, the maximum allowable VCM is limited to VCM max = 0.4 + v Cmin = 0.4 + 0.7 = 1.1 V 8.39 Ad = gm RC = IC RC VT (I /2) RC VT = IRC 2VT ⇒ RC = 10 k = 4 = 80 V/V 2 × 0.025 The determination of a suitable value of VCC requires information on the required input common-mode range (which is not specified). Suffice it to say that the dc voltage drop across RC is 5 V and that each collector swings ±1 V. A supply voltage VCC = 10 V will certainly be sufficient. I VC1 = VC2 = VCC − RC 2 But the gain required is Gain = 2V v od = = 20 V/V v id 0.1 V Thus, RC 20 = 0.05 + 0.45 =5−2=3V v C1 = 3 − 80 × 0.005 sin(ωt) = 3 − 0.4 sin(ωt) v C2 = 3 + 0.4 sin(ωt) 8.38 (a) The maximum allowable value of the bias current I is found as I= (VCC P 1 mW = = 0.2 mA + VEE ) 5V v C2 − v C1 = 0.8 sin(ωt) The waveforms are sketched in the figure on next page. Chapter 8–15 vˆid ⇒ VCM max = VCC + 0.4 − − 2 vˆid Ad VT + Q.E.D. 2 (b) VCC = 2.5 V, (4) vˆid = 10 mV, Ad = 50 V/V, VCM max = 2.5 + 0.4 − 0.005 − 50(25 + 5) × 10−3 1.4 V vˆod = Ad × vˆid = 50 × 10 = 500 mV = 0.5 V Using Eq. (2), we obtain IRC = 2Ad VT = 2 × 50 × 0.025 = 2.5 V To limit the power dissipation in the quiescent state to 1 mV, the bias current must be limited to I= Pmax 1 = = 0.2 mA VCC + VEE 5 Using this value for I , we get RC = 2.5 = 12.5 k 0.2 (c) To obtain VCM max = 1 V, we use Eq. (4) to determine the allowable value of Ad , 8.40 (a) Consider transistor Q1 , I vˆid v C1min = (VCC − RC ) − Ad 2 2 1 = 2.5 + 0.4 − 0.005 − Ad (25 + 5) × 10−3 (1) where Ad = gm RC = I /2 RC VT IRC 2VT Since vˆid v B1 = VCM max + 2 to keep Q1 in the active mode, v B1 ≤ 0.4 + v C1min Thus, VCM max + vˆid vˆid = 0.4 + VCC − Ad VT + 2 2 Thus, by reducing VCM max from 1.4 V to 1 V, we are able to increase the differential gain from 50 V/V to 63.2 V/V. 8.41 See figure on next page. The circuit together with its equivalent half-circuit are shown in the figure. Thus, IRC = Ad VT 2 Substituting from (2) into (1), we obtain vˆid v C1min = VCC − Ad VT + 2 ⇒ Ad = 63.2 V/V (2) Ad = gm1,2 (ro1,2 ro3,4 ) For (3) ro1,2 = ro3,4 = VA 2VA α(I /2) I IC1,2 I VT 2VT I 2VA 2VA Ad = 2VT I I gm1,2 = = VA VA I × = 2VT I 2VT = 20 = 400 V/V 2 × 0.025 Chapter 8–16 This figure belongs to Problem 8.41. VCC VBIAS Q3 Q3 Q4 vod Q2 Q1 vid VCM 2 vod /2 vid VCM 2 vid 2 Q1 Biased at I/2 Equivalent half-circuit I VEE 8.43 8.42 RC RC vod / 2 Q1 vid 2 1 R 2 id Biased at (I/2) RC RL Q2 Re Both circuits have the same differential half-circuit shown in the figure. Thus, for both Ad = vod αRC re + Re Rid = (β + 1)(2re + 2Re ) = 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) With v id = 0, the dc voltage appearing at the top end of the bias current source will be I RC (a) VCM − VBE − 2 (b) VCM − VBE Since circuit (b) results in a larger voltage across the current source and given that the minimum value of VCM is limited by the need to keep a certain specified minimum voltage across the current source, we see that circuit (b) will allow a larger negative VCM . Total resistance between collectors Total resistance in the emitter circuit (2RC RL ) =α 2re Ad = α 8.44 Refer to Fig. P8.42(a). I Re = 4VT 2 8VT ⇒ Re = I I RC = 60VT α 2 120VT αI Total resistance in collector circuit Ad = α Total resistance in emitter circuit 2RC RC =α Ad = α 2re + 2Re re + Re RC = (1) (2) Chapter 8–17 This figure belongs to Problem 8.45. VCC RC RC vod Rsig/2 Rsig/2 Q1 vsig 2 Q2 Re VCM vsig 2 VEE Substituting for RC from (2), for Re from (1), and for re = VT /(I /2), we obtain α(120VT /αI ) (2VT /I ) + (8VT /I ) Ad = = Rid v id = v sig Rid + Rsig Rsig = 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) (1) thus, (2) α × Total resistance between collectors v od = v id Total resistance in emitters (3) Gv ≡ β , α(β + 1) = β, we have β +1 2βRC Gv = 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) + Rsig α × Total resistance in collectors vo = vi Total resistance in emitters 0.99 × 25 2re + 2 × 0.25 where VT 25 mV = 250 = re = IE 0.1 mA v od 2α(β + 1)RC = v sig 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) + Rsig Since α = 2 RC 4RC = 6(re + Re ) 3 re + Re Thus the gain increases from approximately 1 2 RC /(re + Re ) to RC /(re + Re ). 2 3 = Using (2) and (3), we get Thus, (4) (6) 4βRC 2(2β + 1)(re + Re ) + 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) 8.46 Refer to Fig. P8.46. 2αRC 2re + 2Re αRC v od = v id re + Re (5) then the new value of Gv is obtained by replacing β by 2β in Eq. (4) and substituting for Rsig from (5): Gv = Rid = (β + 1)(2re + 2Re ) 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) v id = v sig 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) + Rsig 1 αRC 2βRC = 4(β + 1)(re + Re ) 2 re + Re If β is doubled to 2β while Rsig remains at its old value, we get where = Substituting for Rsig = Rid = 2(β + 1)(re + Re ) into Eq. (4) gives Gv = 120 = 12 V/V 2+8 8.45 Re I 0.99 × 25 vo 25 V/V = vi 2 × 0.25 + 2 × 0.25 Rin = (β + 1)(2re + 2Re ) If v id = 0.5 v sig , then from (1) we obtain = 2 × 101 × (0.25 + 0.25) Rid = Rsig = 101 k Chapter 8–18 8.47 Refer to Fig. P8.47. re = 8.49 gm = VT 25 mV = = 250 IE 0.1 mA = α × Total resistance in collectors vo = vi Total resistance in emitters = 2μn Cox W ID L √ 2 × 3 × 0.1 = 0.77 mA/V | Ad | = gm RD = 0.77 × 10 = 7.7 V/V RD RD | Acm | = 2RSS RD 0.99 × 25 k 2re + 500 = 0.99 × 25 k 25 V/V = 500 + 500 10 × 0.01 = 5 × 10−4 V/V 2 × 100 | Ad | = 1.54 × 104 or 83.8 dB | Acm | CMRR = Rin = (β + 1)(2re + 500 ) = 101 × (2 × 250 + 500 ) 8.50 Refer to Fig. P8.2. = 101 k ID = 0.25 mA = 8.48 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P8.48. As a differential amplifier, the voltage gain is found from α × Total resistance in collectors vo = vi Total resistance in emitters α × RC = 2re 1 W μp Cox |VOV |2 2 L 1 × 4 × |VOV |2 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 0.353 V 0.25 = gm = 2ID 2 × 0.25 = = 1.416 mA/V |VOV | 0.353 | Ad | = gm RD = 1.416 × 4 = 5.67 V/V RD RD | Acm | = 2RSS RD αRC = 2re (b) The circuit in Fig. P8.48 can be considered as the cascade connection of an emitter follower Q1 (biased at an emitter current I /2) and a common-gate amplifier Q2 (also biased at an emitter current of I /2). Referring to the figure below: = 4 × 0.02 2 × 30 = 1.33 × 10−3 V/V CMRR = 4252.5 or 72.6 dB 8.51 Refer to Fig. P8.51. (a) Assume v id = 0 and the two sides of the differential amplifier are matched. Thus, RC vo Q1 vi Q2 ID1 = ID2 = 0.5 mA 1 W 2 VOV ID1,2 = μn Cox 2 L 1 2 × 2.5 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.632 V 0.5 = re1 Rin2 re2 v e1,2 re2 1 = = vi re1 + re2 2 αRC vo = v e1,2 re2 VCM = VGS + 1 mA × RSS = Vt + VOV + 1 × RSS = 0.7 + 0.632 + 1 = 2.332 V 2ID 2 × 0.5 = 1.58 mA/V = VOV 0.632 Thus, (b) gm = 1 αRC αRC vo = × = vi 2 re2 2re Ad = gm RD which is identical to the expression found in (a) above. 8 = 1.38 × RD ⇒ RD = 5.06 k Chapter 8–19 (c) VD1 = VD2 = VDD − ID RD CMRR = = 5 − 0.5 × 5.06 = 2.47 V | Ad | = 2gm RSS | Acm | (W/L) W/L where (d) gm = 2ID 2(0.1/2) = 0.5 mA/V = VOV 0.2 For CMRR of 80 dB, the CMRR is 104 ; thus RD 104 = 2 × 0.5 × RSS /0.02 ΔVD1 ΔVCM Q1 1/gm 2RSS 2 k The figure shows the common-mode half-circuit, RD VD1 =− 1 VCM + 2 RSS gm 5.06 VD1 = −1.92 V/V =− 1 VCM +2 1.58 (e) For Q1 and Q2 to enter the triode region VCM + VCM = Vt + VD1 + VD1 Substituting VCM = 2.332, Vt = 0.7 V, VD1 = 2.47 V, and VD1 = −1.92VCM results in 2.332 + VCM = 0.7 + 2.47 − 1.92VCM ⇒ VCM = 0.287 V With this change, VCM = 2.619 V and VD1,2 = 1.919 V; thus VCM = Vt + VD1,2 . 8.52 The new deliberate mismatch RD /RD cancels the two existing mismatch terms in the expression for Acm given in the problem statement so as to reduce Acm to zero. Thus, RD RD × = −0.002 RD 2RSS RD 5 × = −0.002 2 × 25 RD RD = −0.02 or − 2% ⇒ RD (Note the sign of the change is usually determined experimentally.) 8.53 | Acm | = | Ad | = gm RD RD 2RSS (W/L) W/L RSS = 200 k For the current source transistor to have ro = 200 k, VA × L 0.1 mA 200 × 0.1 = 4 μm L= 5 200 = 8.54 It is required to raise the CMRR by 40 dB, that is, by a factor of 100. Thus, the cascoding of the bias current source must raise its output resistance RSS by a factor of 100. Thus the cascode transistor must have A0 = 100. Since A0 = gm ro = 2VA 2I VA = VOV I VOV 2VA 0.2 ⇒ VA = 10 V 100 = VA = VA × L 10 = 5 × L ⇒ L = 2 μm 8.55 Refer to Fig. P8.55, vo = (a) v id Total resistance across which v o appears α Total resistance in the emitter 2 k =α× re1 + re2 VT , where IE is IE the dc emitter current of each of Q1 and Q2 , we use To determine re1 = re2 = re = VE = VB − VBE = 0 − 0.7 = −0.7 V −0.7 − (−5) = 1 mA 4.3 IE = 0.5 mA 2IE = 25 mV = 50 0.5 mA 2 k =α× 20 V/V 0.1 k re1 = re2 = vo v id Chapter 8–20 (b) The common-mode half-circuit is shown in the figure, α × 2 k vo =− v icm (0.05 + 8.6) k −0.23 V/V vo = 0.23 V/V v icm (c) CMRR = 20 |v o /v id | = = 86.5 |v o /v icm | 0.23 or 38.7 dB (d) v o = −0.023 sin 2π × 60t + 0.2 sin 2π × 1000 t volts 8.56 RC 2RSS RC RC 10 × 0.02 = 0.001 V/V 200 To obtain Ricm , we use Eq. (8.96): | Acm | = Figure (a) shows the differential half-circuit. IE = 0.5 mA, | Acm | IC = αIE 0.5 mA IC 0.5 mA = 20 mA/V = gm = VT 0.025 V 25 mV = 50 0.5 mA VA 100 = 200 k = ro = IC 0.5 re = α × Total resistance in collectors Total resistance in emitters 10 k 10 k (50 + 150) Ad = Ricm βREE 1 + (RC /βro ) RC + 2REE 1+ ro where 2REE = 200 k, thus REE = 100 k and Ricm = 100 × 100 1 + (10/(100 × 200)) 10 + 200 1+ 200 = 4.88 M 8.57 (a) gm = IC 0.1 mA = 4 mA/V VT 0.025 V Ad = gm RC = 4 × 25 = 100 V/V = 5 = 25 V/V 0.2 We have neglected ro because its equivalent value at the output will be ro [1 + (Re /re )] = 200[1 + (150/50)] = 800 k which is much greater than the effective load resistance of 5 k. β 100 =2× = 50 k gm 4 RC RC (c) | Acm | = 2REE RC Rid = 2 × (β + 1)(50 + 150 ) = = 2 × 101 × 0.2 (k) = 40.4 k = 2.5 × 10−4 V/V (b) Rid = 2rπ = 2 25 × 0.01 2 × 500 Chapter 8–21 (d) CMRR = 100 | Ad | = 4 × 105 = | Acm | 2.5 × 10−4 or 112 dB VA 100 (e) ro = = 1000 k IC 0.1 Ricm βREE 1 + (RC /βro ) RC + 2REE 1+ ro 1 + (25/(100 × 1000)) = 100 × 500 25 + 1000 1+ 1000 25 M 20 VA = = 100 k I 0.2 For the transistors in the differential pair, we have 8.58 REE = ro = VA 20 = = 200 k I /2 0.1 Ricm βREE For RC Ricm βREE = 1+ 2REE ro REE = Ro | Wilson mirror 1 βro 2 where ro is that of the transistors in the Wilson mirror, then = 50 = 100 k 0.5 1 REE = × 100 × 100 = 5 M 2 5 | Acm | = × 0.1 2 × 5, 000 ro = = 5 × 10−5 V/V 50 CMRR = = 106 5 × 10−5 or 120 dB 1 + (RC /βro ) RC + 2REE 1+ ro ro , (c) If the bias current I is generated using a Wilson mirror, 50 × 100 = 2.5 M 2 × 100 1+ 200 8.60 See figure on next page. v be1 = 2.5 sin(ωt), mV and v be2 = −2.5 sin(ωt), mV I v C1 VCC − RC −gm RC ×2.5×10−3 sin(ωt) 2 where gm = I /2 I mA = VT 0.05 V Thus, 8.59 For the differential-pair transistors, we have IC 0.25 mA 0.25 = 10 mA/V 0.025 VA 50 ro = = 200 k = IC 0.25 gm = I I v C1 = 5− ×10− ×10×2.5×10−3 sin(ωt) 2 0.05 = 5 − 5I − 0.5I sin(ωt) Similarly, v C2 = 5 − 5I + 0.5I sin(ωt) (a) Ad = gm RC = 10 × 5 = 50 V/V To ensure operation in the active mode at all times with v CB = 0 V, we use where we have neglected the effect of ro since ro RC . v C1min = 0.005 (b) If the bias current is realized using a simple current source, 50 VA REE = ro | current source = = = 100 k I 0.5 RC RC | Acm | = 2REE RC 5 × 0.1 = 2 × 100 = 2.5 × 10−3 V/V | Ad | 50 CMRR = = = 2 × 104 | Acm | 2.5 × 10−3 or 86 dB 5 − 5.5I = 0.005 ⇒ I 0.9 mA With this value of bias current, we obtain 0.9 = 18 mA/V 0.05 Ad = gm RC = 18 × 10 = 180 V/V gm = At each collector there will be a sine wave of 180 × 2.5 = 450 mV = 0.45 V amplitude superimposed on the dc bias voltage of 5 − 0.45 × 10 = 0.5 V. Between the two collectors there will be a sine wave with 0.9 V peak amplitude. The second figure illustrates the waveforms obtained. Chapter 8–22 These figures belong to Problem 8.60. 8.61 If Q1 has twice the base-emitter junction 2 area of Q2 , the bias current I will split I in Q1 3 1 and I in Q2 . This is because with B1 and B2 3 grounded the two transistors will have equal VBE ’s. Thus their currents must be related by the ratio of their scale currents IS , which are proportional to the junction areas. RC iC1 RC iC2 vo2 vo1 vicm Q1 2 Q2 ie1 vicm ie2 ve vicm vicm REE REE With a common-mode input signal v icm applied, as shown in the figure, the current (v icm /REE ) will split between Q1 and Q2 in the same ratio as that of their base-emitter junction areas, thus ie1 = 2 v icm 3 REE and ie2 = 1 v icm 3 REE Thus, v o1 = −ic1 RC −ie1 RC = − 2 RC v icm 3 REE and v o2 = − 1 RC v icm 3 REE With the output taken differentially, we have v o2 − v o1 = Acm = 1 RC v icm 3 REE 1 RC 1 12 = × = 0.008 V/V 3 REE 3 500 8.62 If the output is taken single-endedly, then | Acm | = RC 2REE | Ad | = 1 gm RC 2 Chapter 8–23 CMRRs = | Acm | = gm REE | Ad | VOS = VOV 2 RD RD If the output is taken differentially, then RC RC | Acm | = 2REE RC Thus, | Ad | = gm RC (b) For each value of VOS we use Eq. (2) to determine I and then Eq. (1) to determine Ad . The results are as follows: CMRRd = 2gm REE / RC RC VOS = 1√ I /k n 2 RD RD (2) Thus, VOS (mV) 2 CMRRd = CMRRs RC /RC I (mA) 2 20 log = 34 dB RC /RC ⇒ 1 Ad = gm RD VOS 8.65 VOV = 2 ID I = = gm gm VOV RD = 2 RD 5 4 8 12 16 20 I /2 1 k (W/L) 2 n = I k n (W/L) 0.1 = 0.224 V 0.2 × 10 RD RD VOV = 0.04 ⇒ VOS = RD 2 RD = For I = 160 μA, we have √ gm = 4 × 0.16 = 0.8 mA/V Ad = 0.8 × 10 = 8 V/V = 0.16 = 0.2 V 0.8 0.2 × 0.02 = 2 mV VOS = 2 For I = 360 μA, we have √ gm = 4 × 0.36 = 1.2 mA/V VOV = 0.224 × 0.04 = 4.5 mV 2 (W/L) = 0.04 ⇒ VOS = (W/L) VOV 2 (W/L) (W/L) 0.224 × 0.04 = 4.5 mV 2 Vt = 5 mV ⇒ VOS = Vt = 5 mV = Worst-case VOS = 4.5 + 4.5 + 5 = 14 mV Ad = 1.2 × 10 = 12 V/V 0.36 = 0.3 V 1.2 0.3 × 0.02 = 3 mV VOS = 2 Thus by increasing the bias current, both the gain and the offset voltage increase, and by the same factor (1.5). VOV = √ √ 8.64 (a) gm = 2k n ID = k n I √ Ad = gm RD = k n I RD I /2 I VOV = = 1 kn kn 2 4 We observe that by accepting a larger offset we are able to obtain a higher gain. Observe that the gain realized is proportional to the offset voltage one is willing to accept. 8.63 gm = 2 k n (W/L)ID = k n (W/L)I VOV 3 0.04 0.16 0.36 0.64 1.00 Ad (V/V) RC = 0.04 = 4% RC 2 (1) If the three components are independent, √ VOS = 4.52 + 4.52 + 52 = 8.1 mV 8.66 The offset voltage due to Vt is VOS = ±5 mV The offset voltage due to RD is RD VOV 0.3 × 0.02 = 3 mV = VOS = 2 RD 2 The offset voltage due to (W/L) is VOV (W/L) 0.3 = × 0.02 = 3 mV VOS = 2 (W/L) 2 Chapter 8–24 VCC The worst-case offset voltage will be when all three components add up, VOS = 5 + 3 + 3 = 11 mV RC RC The major contribution to the total is the variability of Vt . (a1I/2) (a2I/2) VO Q1 To compensate for a total offset of 11 mV by appropriately varying RD , we need to change RD by RD obtained from RD VOV × 11 mV = 2 RD Q2 I 2 I 2 I RD 11 × 2 ⇒ = = 0.0733 RD 300 or 7.33% 8.67 VOS = VT RC RC and the collector voltages will be unequal, VC1 = VCC − α1 (I /2)RC = 25 × 0.1 = 2.5 mV 8.68 VOS = VT IS IS VC2 = VCC − α2 (I /2)RC Thus a differential output voltage VO develops: VO = VC2 − VC1 1 IRC (α1 − α2 ) 2 The input offset voltage VOS can be obtained by dividing VO by the differential gain Ad : = 25 × 0.1 = 2.5 mV 8.69 With both input terminals grounded, a mismatch RC between the two collector resistors gives rise to an output voltage I RC VO = α 2 = Ad = gm RC (1) I /2 IRC RC = VT 2VT Thus, VOS = VT (α1 − α2 ) With a resistance RE connected in the emitter of each transistor, the differential gain becomes Substituting, we obtain α × 2RC αRC | Ad | = = 2(re + RE ) RE + re α1 = (2) The input offset voltage VOS is obtained by dividing VO in (1) by | Ad | in (2), I RC VOS = (re + RE ) 2 RC Since re = VOS VT , I /2 1 RC = (VT + IRE ) 2 RC 8.70 See figure. The current I splits equally between the two emitters. However, the unequal β’s will mean unequal α’s. Thus, the two collector currents will be unequal, IC1 = α1 I /2 IC2 = α2 I /2 β1 β1 + 1 and β2 β2 + 1 β1 β2 = VT − β1 + 1 β2 + 1 α2 = VOS = VT β1 β2 + β1 − β1 β2 − β2 (β1 + 1)(β2 + 1) = VT β1 − β2 (β1 + 1)(β2 + 1) β1 − β2 β1 β2 1 1 = VT − β2 β1 VT Q.E.D. For β1 = 50 and β2 = 100, we have 1 1 − = −0.25 mV VOS = 25 100 50 Chapter 8–25 In terms of the emitter currents, this becomes I I − I RS 2 2 − re RS + 2 2 (β + 1) I I + RS I 2 2 re RS − = + 2 2 (β + 1) 8.71 For the MOS amplifier: RD VOV VOS = 2 RD 200 × 0.04 2 = 4 mV = For the BJT amplifier: RC VOS = VT RC I RS IRS and − from 2 (β + 1) 4(β + 1) each side, we obtain Subtracting = 25 × 0.04 = 1 mV If in the MOS amplifier the width of each device is increased by a factor of 4 while the bias current is kept constant, VOV will be reduced by a factor of 2. Thus VOS becomes VOS = 2 mV VCC RS 2 =− IRS Ir e I RS + + 4 (β + 1) 2 (β + 1) 2 Combining terms, we have IRS I RS = + Ire 2 (β + 1) (β + 1) RS I RS so that + re = I 2 (β + 1) (β + 1) 8.72 RS IRS I re I RS − − 4 (β + 1) 2 (β + 1) 2 I = RC VC Q1 RC RS RS 2 Q2 IB1 IB2 I I 2 2 I I RS · 2 (β + 1) I I 2 2 VC = IC RC . VC = 1 RS + re (β + 1) If I RS RC · 2 (β + 1) VC = Ad I RS · = 2 (β + 1) I RS RC · 2 (β + 1) 1 RS + re (β + 1) gm RC VOS = Assume the mismatch RS is split between the two base (source) resistances. The emitter currents will be different, as shown. 1 RS + re (β + 1) Now VOS can be obtained by dividing VC by Ad = gm RC , VEE Consider only the incremental currents involved. β ≈ 1, we have β +1 VOS = gm 1 RS + re (β + 1) 1 I RS · 2 gm RS + (β + 1) re gm Equating the voltage drop from each grounded input to the common emitters, we have I I RS + − re IB1 RS + 2 2 2 RS I I = IB2 RS − + + re 2 2 2 Since (β + 1) re = rπ and rπ gm = β, we have I · RS 2β VOS = Q.E.D. g m RS 1+ β I Subtracting out the re terms, we have 2 I RS − re IB1 RS + 2 2 RS I = IB2 RS − + re 2 2 8.73 Since the only difference between the two sides of the differential pair is the mismatch in VA , we can write VCE1 IC1 = IC 1 + VA1 Chapter 8–26 VCE2 IC2 = IC 1 + VA2 (b) If the area of Q1 and hence IS1 is 5% larger than nominal, then we have IC1 + IC2 = αI VCE2 VCE1 IC 2 + + = αI VA1 VA2 VCE1 VCE2 ⇒ IC = αI 2+ + VA1 VA2 IC1 αI = 2 For VCE1 VA1 IC1 αI 2 IC2 IS1 = 1.05IS and the area of Q2 and hence IS2 is 5% smaller than nominal, IS2 = 0.95IS VCE1 VA1 VCE1 VCE2 1+ + 2VA1 2VA2 1+ 1 and VCE2 VA2 Thus, IE1 = 0.5 × 1.05 = 0.525 mA IE2 = 0.5 × 0.95 = 0.475 mA 1 we have Assuming α 1, we obtain 1 VCE1 1 VCE2 1+ − 2 VA1 2 VA2 1 VCE2 αI 1 VCE1 1+ − 2 2 VA2 2 VA1 IC1 = 0.525 mA IC2 = 0.475 mA To reduce the resulting offset to zero, we adjust the potentiometer so that The voltage VO between the two collectors will be VC1 = VC2 VO = VC2 − VC1 ⇒ VCC − (RC1 + x)IC1 = VCC − (RC2 + 1 − x)IC2 = IC1 RC − IC2 RC αI VCE1 VCE2 RC × = − 2 VA1 VA2 IC1 (RC1 + x) = IC2 (RC2 + 1 − x) (1) I Since we still have IC1 IC2 = α , the 2 differential gain is still given by Ad = gm RC = IC RC αIRC = VT 2VT 0.525(5 + x) = 0.475(5 + 1 − x) ⇒ x = 0.225 (2) Dividing (1) by (2) gives VCE2 VCE1 VOS = VT − VA1 VA2 As a first-order approximation, we can assume 8.75 IBmax = IBmin = 400 2.5 μA 2 × 81 400 = 1 μA 2 × 201 IOSmax = 200 200 − 1.5 μA 81 201 VCE1 VCE2 = 10 V and substitute VA1 = 100 V and VA2 = 200 V to determine VOS as 10 10 VOS = 25 − 100 200 = 25 × 0.05 = 1.25 mV 8.76 A 2-mV input offset voltage corresponds to a difference RC between the two collector resistances, 2 = VT = 25 × 8.74 Refer to Fig. P8.74. (a) RC1 = 1.04 × 5 = 5.20 k RC2 = 0.96 × 5 = 4.80 k To equalize the total resistance in each collector, we adjust the potentiometer so that RC1 + x × 1 k = RC2 + (1 − x) × 1 k 5.2 + x = 4.8 + 1 − x ⇒ x = 0.3 k RC RC RC 20 ⇒ RC = 1.6 k Thus a 2-mV offset can be nulled out by adjusting one of the collector resistances by 1.6 k. If the adjustment mechanism raises one RC and lowers the other, then each need to be adjusted by only (1.6 k/2) = 0.8 k. If a potentiometer is used, the total resistance of the potentiometer must be at least 1.6 k. If specified to a single digit, we use 2 k. Chapter 8–27 The gain Ad is found as follows: 8.77 VCC a2I 3 RC VC1 VO RC Q1 VC2 where Q2 I 3 2I 3 2 α × Total resistance in collectors Total resistance in emitters α × 2RC = re1 + re2 Ad = aI 3 re1 = VT 3VT 1.5VT VT = = = IE1 2I /3 2I I re2 = VT 3VT VT = = IE2 I /3 I thus, I Ad = (a) 2αRC 2αIRC = 4.5 VT /I 4.5 VT (2) Substituting in Eq. (1) gives v id = 0.75 VT = 18.75 mV Now, using large signal analysis: RC v id = VB2 − VB1 = (VB2 − VE ) − (VB1 − VE ) RC Vod IC1 = IS1 e(VB1 −VE )/VT (3) (VB2 −VE )/VT (4) IC2 = IS2 e Q1 vid Q2 re1 where IS1 = 2 IS2 . To make IC1 = IC2 , re2 IS1 e(VB1 −VE )/VT = IS2 e(VB2 −VE )/VT e(VB2 −VB1 )/VT = 2 (b) From Fig. (a) we see that the transistor with twice the area (Q1 ) will carry twice the current in the other transistor (Q2 ). Thus 2I IE1 = , 3 α2I , IC1 = 3 Thus, IE2 I = 3 IC2 = Thus, v id = 17.3 mV which is reasonably close to the approximate value obtained using small-signal analysis. αI 2 8.78 Gm = 2 mA/V α2I RC VC1 = VCC − 3 αI VC2 = VCC − RC 3 and the dc offset voltage at the output will be With RL = ∞, Ad = Gm Ro and v o = Gm Ro v id VO = VC2 − VC1 With RL = 20 k, 1 VO = αIRC 3 To reduce this output voltage to zero, we apply a dc input voltage v id in the direction shown in Fig. (b). The voltage v id is required to produce v od in the direction shown which is opposite in direction to VO and of course |v od | = |VO |, thus 1 Ad v id = αIRC 3 VB2 − VB1 = VT ln 2 (1) v o = Gm Ro v id = Gm Ro RL RL + Ro 1 20 v id = Gm Ro v id 20 + Ro 2 Thus, Ro = 20 k Ad (with RL = ∞) = Gm Ro = 2 × 20 = 40 V/V Chapter 8–28 8.79 Gm = gm1,2 = 2(I /2) I I = = VOV VOV 0.25 VDD Ro = ro2 ro4 For Q3 ro2 = ro4 = |VA | = I /2 I /2 5 2 × 5 × 0.5 = I I 2.5 1 5 Ro = × = 2 I I Thus, = Q1 Q2 I 2.5 I × = 10 V/V Ad = Gm Ro = 0.25 I 8.80 Q4 |VA |L Q8 Q7 Q5 Q6 1 I W 2 = μn Cox VOV 2 2 L 1 2 × 0.2 × 50 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.14 V 0.1 = gm1,2 = 2 × (I /2) 2 × 0.1 = 1.4 mA/V = VOV 0.14 VSS |V | × L |VA | 5 × 0.5 = A = ro2 = ro4 = I /2 I /2 0.1 = 25 k ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V Ad = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) VGS = Vt + |VOV | = 1.4 × (25 25) = 0.5 + 0.2 = 0.7 V = 17.5 V/V For Q5 , Q6 , Q7 , and Q8 : ID = 0.2 mA 8.81 Ad = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) W ID gm1,2 = 2k n L √ √ = 4I = 2 I ro2 |VA | 2|VA | 2×5 10 = ro4 = = = = I /2 I I I √ 10 1 10 = √ Ad = 2 I × × 2 I I 10 20 = √ I ⇒ I = 0.25 mA 1 2 × 5 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.28 V 0.2 = VGS = 0.5 + 0.28 = 0.78 V From the figure we see that for each transistor to operate at VDS at least equal to VGS , the total power supply is given by VDD + VSS = VDS4 + VDS2 + VDS7 + VDS6 = VGS4 + VGS2 + VGS7 + VGS6 = 0.7 + 0.7 + 0.78 + 0.78 = 2.96 3.0 V 8.83 8.82 See figure. (a) See figure on next page. For Q1 , Q2 , Q3 and Q4 : 1 W I 2 = μn Cox VOV 2 2 L 0.1 = 1 2 × 5 × VOV 2 (b) Ad = gm1,2 (Ro4 Ro6 ) gm1,2 = 2(I /2) I = VOV VOV Ro6 = gm6 ro6 ro8 Chapter 8–29 Q7 Q8 Q5 Q6 For |VOV | = 0.2 V and |VA | = 10 V, we have 10 2 Ad = 2 = 5000 V/V 0.2 Ro6 Ro4 Q3 vo Q4 VBIAS Q1 Q2 I Since all transistors are operated at a bias current (I /2) and have the same overdrive voltage |VOV | and the same Early voltage, |VA |, all have the same gm = I /|VOV | and the same |VA | ro = = 2|VA |/I . Thus, I /2 Ro6 = gm ro2 Ro4 = gm4 ro4 ro2 = gm ro2 Ad = gm (gm ro2 gm ro2 ) 1 (gm ro )2 2 I 2|VA | 2|VA | gm ro = × = |VOV | I |VOV | 8.84 The currents i1 to i13 are shown on the circuit diagram. Observe that i11 = i7 = i3 (the current that enters a transistor exits at the other end!). Also observe that the mirror Q3 and Q4 is indeed functioning properly as the drain currents of Q3 1 and Q4 are equal (i12 = i2 = gm v id ). However, 4 the currents in their ro ’s are far from being equal! There are some inconsistencies that result from the approximations made to obtain the results shown in Fig. P8.84, namely, gm ro 1. Note for instance that although we find the current in ro of 1 Q2 to be gm v id , the voltages at the two ends of 2 1 ro are (gm ro )v id and v id /4; thus the current must 2 1 1 be v id gm ro − ro , which is approximately 2 4 1 gm v id . 2 The purpose of this problem is to show the huge imbalance that exists in this circuit. In fact, Q1 1 3 has |v gs | = v id while Q2 has |v gs | = v id . This 4 4 imbalance results from the fact that the current mirror is not a balanced load. Nevertheless, we know that this circuit provides a reasonably high common-mode rejection. = Ad = 2(|VA |/|VOV |) 2 Q.E.D. This figure belongs to Problem 8.84. 8.85 Gm = gm1,2 = ro2 = 2(I /2) 0.2 = 1 mA/V = VOV 1,2 0.2 20 VAn = = 200 k I /2 0.1 Chapter 8–30 ro4 = |VAp | 12 = = 120 k I /2 0.1 Thus, IO = ID4 − ID2 Ro = ro2 ro4 = 200 120 = 75 k = ID1 − ID2 Ad = Gm Ro = 1 × 75 = 75 V/V The gain is reduced by a factor of 2 with RL = Ro = 75 k. = I (W/L)A 2 (W/L)A The input offset voltage is VOS = 8.86 VDD IO Gm where Gm = gm1,2 = 2(I /2) I = VOV VOV Thus, Q3 Q4 IO Q1 Q2 I VSS VOS = (VOV /2) (W/L)A (W/L)A (b) ID1 = ID2 = I 2 Q.E.D. ID3 = ID1 If the (W/L) ratios of the mirror transistors have a mismatch (WL)M , the current transfer ratio of the mirror will have an error of [(W/L)M /(W/L)M ]. Thus (W/L)M ID4 = ID3 1 + (W/L)M At the output node, we have (a) Let W W 1 W = + L 1 L A 2 L A W W 1 W = − L 2 L A 2 L A Q1 and Q2 have equal values of VGS and thus of VOV , thus 1 W 1 W + V2 ID1 = k n 2 L A 2 L A OV 1 W 1 (W/L)A 2 = k n 1+ VOV 2 L A 2 (W/L)A Since, in the ideal case 1 I W ID1 = = k n V2 2 2 L A OV I 1 (W/L)A ID1 = 1+ 2 2 (W/L)A Similarly, we can show that 1 (W/L)A I 1− ID2 = 2 2 (W/L)A The current mirror causes ID4 = ID3 = ID1 IO = ID4 − ID2 (W/L)M = ID3 1 + − ID2 (W/L)M (W/L)M = ID1 1 + − ID2 (W/L)M = I (W/L)M 2 (W/L)M and the corresponding VOS will be IO IO = Gm I /VOV VOV (W/L)M = 2 (W/L)M VOS = Q.E.D. 0.2 × 0.02 = 2 mV 2 0.2 × 0.02 = 2 mV = 2 (c) VOS |Q1 ,Q2 mismatch = VOS |Q3 ,Q4 mismatch Worst-case VOS = 2 + 2 = 4 mV 8.87 IE1 = IE2 = 0.25 mA IC1 = IC2 0.25 mA gm1,2 = IC1,2 0.25 mA = = 10 mA/V VT 0.025 V Chapter 8–31 ro = |VA | 10 V = 40 k = IC 0.25 mA Rid = 2 rπ = 2 two input terminals and determine the output current i as follows: β 100 =2× = 20 k gm 10 i = IC2 − IC4 I I 1 −α 2 2 1 + (2/βp2 ) 1 I 1− =α 2 1 + (2/βp2 ) Ro = ro2 ro4 = 40 40 = 20 k =α Gm = gm1,2 = 10 mA/V Ad = Gm Ro = 10 × 20 = 200 V/V If RL = Rid = 20 k, then Gv = 200 × = 200 × RL RL + Ro −α 20 = 100 V/V 20 + 20 Dividing i by Gm = gm1,2 = VOS = − 8.88 Using Eq. (8.145), we obtain αI gives 2VT 2VT βp2 2VT βp For βp = 50, 2 × 25 βp VOS = − VOS = − −2 = − I I 2 = −α 2 2 2 βp βp 2 × 25 = −20 μV 502 ⇒ βp = 25 8.90 8.89 Q3 Q4 aI 2 (1 Q5 i 2 ) bP2 aI/2 aI/2 Q2 Q1 I/2 I/2 I The figure shows a BJT differential amplifier loaded in a base-current-compensated current mirror. To determine the systematic input offset voltage resulting from the error in the current-transfer ratio of the mirror, we ground the The figure shows a BJT differential amplifier loaded with a Wilson current mirror. To determine the systematic input offset voltage resulting from the error in the current-transfer ratio of the mirror, Chapter 8–32 we ground the two input terminals and determine the output current i as follows: i = α α I 1 I −α 2 2 1 + (2/βp2 ) I 2 αI = 2 2 βp2 βp input offset voltage VOS : αI /2 = provides the VT = +3.6 V (b) The dc bias voltage should be VO = v Omax − 1.5 = 4 − 1.5 = +2.5 V 2VT βp2 For βp = 50, VOS = − (a) VB7 = +5 − VEB6 − VEB7 = 5 − 0.7 − 0.7 v Omax = VB7 + 0.4 = +4 V Dividing i by Gm = gm1,2 VOS = − 8.92 Refer to Fig. P8.91. 2 × 25 = −20 μV 502 (c) For v O to swing negatively (i.e., below the dc bias value of 2.5 V) by 1.5 V, that is, to +1 V with Q4 remaining in saturation, VBIAS should be VBIAS = v Omin + 0.4 = 1.4 V 8.91 Refer to Fig. P8.91. Ad = Gm Ro (d) With VBIAS = 1.4 V, the bias voltage at the collectors of Q1 and Q2 is VC1,2 = VBIAS − VBE3,4 where Gm = gm1,2 I /2 VT = 1.4 − 0.7 = +0.7 V and The upper limit on VCM is 0.4 V above VC1,2 : Ro = Ro4 Ro7 VCM max = 0.7 + 0.4 = +1.1 V Here Ro4 is the output resistance of the cascode amplifier (looking into the collector of Q4 ), thus Ro4 = gm4 ro4 (ro2 rπ 4 ) Usually rπ 4 ro2 , Ro4 gm4 rπ 4 ro4 = β4 ro4 The resistance Ro7 is the output resistance of the Wilson mirror and is given by Ro7 = 1 β7 ro7 2 Thus Ro = (β4 ro4 ) 1 β7 ro7 2 Since all β and ro are equal, we obtain 1 βro Ro = (βro ) 2 1 βro 3 and 1 Q.E.D. Ad = βgm ro 3 For β = 100 and VA = 20 V, we have = gm ro = Ad = IC VA VA 20 = = = 800 VT IC VT 0.025 1 × 100 × 800 = 2.67 × 104 V/V 3 8.93 To maximize the positive output voltage swing, we select VBIAS as large as possible while maintaining the pnp current sources in saturation. For the latter to happen, we need a minimum of 0.3 V across each current source. Thus the maximum allowable voltage at the emitters of Q3 and Q4 is VCC − 0.3 = 5 − 0.3 = +4.7 V. Then, the maximum allowable value of VBIAS = 4.7 − 0.7 = +4 V. To keep Q4 in saturation, v Omax = VBIAS + 0.4 = 4.4 V If the dc voltage at the output is 0 V, then the maximum positive voltage swing is 4.4 V. In the negative direction, v Omin = −VEE + VBE7 + VBE5 − 0.4 = −5 + 0.7 + 0.7 − 0.4 = −4 V Thus, −4 V ≤ v O ≤ +4.4 V Gm = gm1,2 0.25 mA = 10 mA/V 0.025 V Ro4 = β4 ro4 = 50 × |VA | I /2 Chapter 8–33 100 V = 20 M 0.25 mA 1 100 1 Ro5 = β5 ro5 = × 100 × 2 2 0.25 = 20 M = 50 × Ro = Ro4 Ro5 = 20 M 20 M = 10 M Ad = Gm Ro = 10 × 10,000 = 105 V/V 8.94 The overdrive voltage, |VOV |, at which Q1 and Q2 are operating is found from 1 I = k p (W/L)|VOV |2 2 2 1 0.1 = × 6.4 × |VOV |2 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 0.18 V Gm = gm1,2 2(I /2) = |VOV | 0.2 = 1.13 mA/V = 0.18 |VAp | 10 = = 100 k ro2 = I /2 0.1 ro4 = |VAnpn | 30 = = 300 k I /2 0.1 Ro = ro2 ro4 = 100 k 300 k = 75 k But Ro = ro2 ro4 and ro2 = ro4 (Q2 and Q4 have the same ID = and the same VA ). Thus ro2 = ro4 = 100 k = |VA | = I 2 |VA | I /2 I × 100 k = 10 V 2 10 = |VA |L = 20 L ⇒ L = 0.5 μm (c) v Omin = VCM − Vtn = 0 − 0.5 = −0.5 V v Omax = VDD − |VOV | = 1 − 0.2 = 0.8 V Thus, −0.5 V ≤ v O ≤ 0.8 V |VA | 10 = = 50 k I 0.2 The CMRR can be obtained using Eq. (8.159): (d) RSS = CMRR = (gm ro )(gm RSS ) = (1 × 100)(1 × 50) = 5000 or 74 dB Ad = Gm Ro = 1.13 × 75 = 85 V/V 8.96 The CMRR is given by Eq. (8.158): 8.95 (a) For Q1 and Q2 , 1 W I = μn Cox V2 2 2 L 1,2 OV W 1 0.1 = × 0.4 × × 0.04 2 L 1,2 W W = = 12.5 ⇒ L 1 L 2 For Q3 and Q4 , 1 W I |VOV |2 = μn Cox 2 2 L 3,4 1 W 0.1 = × 0.1 × × 0.04 2 L 3,4 W W = = 50 ⇒ L 3 L 4 (b) Gm = gm1,2 1 mA/V Ad = Gm Ro 50 = 1 × Ro ⇒ Ro = 50 k 2 (I /2) I 0.2 = = = = VOV VOV 0.2 CMRR = [gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 )] [2 gm3 RSS ] (a) Current source is implemented with a simple current mirror: |VA | RSS = ro | QS = I 2(I /2) I = gm1,2 = gm3 = VOV VOV ro2 = ro4 = 2|VA | |VA | = I /2 I Thus, I 1 2|VA | |VA | I ×2× × × × VOV 2 I VOV I 2 VA =2 Q.E.D. VOV CMRR = (b) Current source is implemented with the modified Wilson mirror in Fig. P8.82: RSS = gm7 ro7 ro9 Transistor Q7 has the same k (W/L) as Q1 and Q2 , but Q7 carries a current I twice that of Q1 and Q2 . Thus √ √ VOV 7 = 2VOV 1,2 = 2VOV Chapter 8–34 and gm7 √ 2I 2I 2I = = √ = VOV 7 V 2VOV OV VA ro7 = ro9 = I Thus, √ 2 √ 2 2I VA 2VA RSS = = VOV I VOV I and √ 2 1 2|VA | I I 2VA × × ×2× × CMRR = VOV 2 I VOV VOV I √ VA 3 =2 2 Q.E.D. VOV For k (W/L) = 4 mA/V and I = 160 μA, 1+ 1 gm ro3 1 = 0.98 A/A 1+ 1 × 50 Am = 1 =1 Rom = ro4 = 50 k Ro2 = ro2 + 2RSS + 2gm2 ro2 RSS = 50 + 50 + 2 × 1 × 50 × 25 = 2600 k Acm = −(1 − Am )Gmcm (Rom Ro2 ) Acm = −(1 − 0.98) × 0.02 × (50 2600) = −0.0196 V/V CMRR = 2 25 Ad = 1274 = Acm 0.0196 or 62.1 dB 1 × 4 × |VOV |2 2 ⇒ |VOV | = 0.2 V Alternatively, using the approximate expression in Eq. (8.157), we obtain For |VA | = 5 V: Acm − 0.080 = For case (a), CMRR = 2 × 5 0.2 and 2 = 1250 or 62 dB CMRR = 25 = 1250 0.02 or 61.9 dB For case (b), √ CMRR = 2 2 1 1 = −0.02 V/V =− 2gm3 RSS 2 × 1 × 25 5 0.2 3 = 4.42 × 104 8.98 CMRR = or 93 dB Ad Acm CMRR = 60 dB or equivalently 1000. Thus, 8.97 Gm = gm1,2 ro2 2(I /2) 0.2 = 1 mA/V = = VOV 0.2 5 |VA | = ro4 = = = 50 k I /2 0.1 1000 = 50 | Acm | ⇒ | Acm | = 0.05 V/V But from Eq. (8.153), we obtain Ro = ro2 ro4 = 50 k 50 k | Acm | = (1 − Am )Gmcm (Rom Ro2 ) = 25 k Since Rom Ad = Gm Ro = 1 × 25 = 25 V/V | Acm | = (1 − Am ) 5 |VA | = = 25 k I 0.2 1 1 = 0.02 mA/V = = 2RSS 2 × 25 RSS = Gmcm Rim = Ro2 and Gmcm = 1/2RSS , we have Rom 2RSS 0.05 = (1 − Am ) × 20 2 × 20 ⇒ (1 − Am ) = 0.1 1 ro3 gm3 where gm3 = gm1 = gm2 = 1 mA/V 8.99 From Eq. (8.153), we have Acm = −(1 − Am )Gmcm (Rom Ro2 ) ro3 = ro2 = ro4 = 50 k where Rim = 1 k 50 k = 0.98 k Gmcm = 1 1 = = 0.011 mA/V 2RSS 2 × 45 Chapter 8–35 Using the fact that Ro2 Rom , we obtain IB = Acm −(1 − 0.98) × 0.011 × 45 The lower limit on VICM is determined by the lowest voltage allowed at the collector of Q5 while Q5 is in the active mode. This voltage is −5 + 0.3 = −4.7 V. Thus = −0.01 V/V CMRR = 0.125 mA I /2 = 1.25 μA β +1 100 30 Ad = 3000 = Acm 0.01 VICM min = −4.7 + VBE1,2 = −4.7 + 0.7 or 69.5 dB = −4 V 8.100 The upper limit on VICM is determined by the need to keep Q1 in the active mode. Thus VCC 5 V VICM max = VC1 + 0.4 = 4.3 + 0.4 = 4.7 V Q3 Q4 Thus the input common-mode range is vO Q2 Q1 −4 V ≤ VICM ≤ +4.7 V The common-mode gain can be found using Eq. (8.165): Acm = − R I I Q6 Q5 ro4 β3 REE Here, ro4 = |VA | 100 = = 800 k I /2 0.125 β3 = 100 REE = ro5 = 5 V Gm = gm1,2 I /2 VT I /2 5= VT Thus Acm = − 800 = −0.02 V/V 100 × 400 The CMRR can be found as CMRR = ⇒ I = 0.25 mA Utilizing two matched transistors, Q5 and Q6 , the value of R can be found from 0 − (−5) − 0.7 = 0.25 mA I= R ⇒ R = 17.2 k β 100 = 40 k =2× Rid = 2rπ = 2 gm 5 Ro = ro2 ro4 |VA | 100 = = 400 k I 0.25 | Ad | 2000 = = 100,000 | Acm | 0.02 or 100 dB 8.101 See figure on next page. From the solution to Problem 8.100, we know that I = 0.25 mA. For the Widlar current source, use R = 2 k. Thus IREF = 5 − 0.7 = 2.15 mA 2 Ro = 800 k 800 k = 400 k The value of RE can be found from IREF IRE = VBE6 − VBE5 = VT ln I 2.15 0.25 × RE = 0.025 ln 0.25 Ad = Gm Ro = 5 × 400 = 2000 V/V RE = 215 where |VA | 100 = = 800 k ro2 = ro4 = I /2 0.125 thus Chapter 8–36 5 V Ro = 200 k 200 k = 100 k Ad = Gm Ro = 8 × 100 = 800 V/V Rid = 2rπ = 2β/gm Q3 Q4 vO Q2 Q1 R 300 = 37.5 k 8 |VA | 40 = = 100 k REE = I 0.4 The common-mode gain can be found = I IREF using Eq. (8.165): ro4 Acm = − β3 REE =− Q6 Q5 RE 5 V 200 = −0.013 V/V 150 × 100 The CMRR can be obtained from 800 | Ad | = = 60,000 CMRR = | Acm | 0.013 or 96 dB Gv = The output resistance of the Widlar current source is given by Eq. (7.102). Thus = REE = [1 + gm5 (RE rπ 5 )]ro5 where gm5 I 0.25 mA = 10 mA/V = = VT 0.025 V rπ 5 = β 100 = 10 k = gm5 10 100 VA = = 400 k I 0.25 = [1 + 10(0.215 10)] × 400 Rid × Ad Rid + Rsig 37.5 × 800 = 444.4 V/V 37.5 + 30 8.103 Refer to Fig. P8.103. To determine the bias current I , which is the drain current of Q7 , we analyze the Wilson mirror circuit as follows: All four transistors, Q5 – Q8 , are conducting equal currents (I ) and have the same VGS , VGS = Vt + VOV ro5 = Thus REE IR = 15 − (−5) − 2 VGS = 1.24 M 144I = 20 − 2 Vt − 2 VOV Rid , Ro , Ad , IB , and the range of VICM will be the same as in Problem 8.100. The common-mode gain, however, will be lower: ro4 Acm = − β3 REE But =− 800 = 6.45 × 10−3 V/V 100 × 1240 and the CMRR will be 2000 | Ad | = 3.1 × 105 = CMRR = | Acm | 6.45 × 10−3 or 110 dB 8.102 Gm = gm1,2 I= 1 2 k (W/L)VOV 2 n 1 2 2 × 2 × VOV = VOV 2 Thus = 2 = 20 − 2 × 0.7 − 2VOV 144 VOV 2 144 VOV + 2VOV − 18.6 = 0 ⇒ VOV = 0.35 V and I /2 0.2 = 8 mA/V = VT 0.025 I = 0.352 = 0.12 mA (a) Rid = 2rπ = 2β/gm Ro = ro2 ro4 where |VA | 40 ro2 = ro4 = = = 200 k I /2 0.2 gm = gm1,2 I /2 0.06 = = 2.4 mA VT 0.025 Chapter 8–37 2 × 100 = 83.3 k 2.4 (b) Ad = gm1,2 Ro Rid = ro2 = ro4 = 60 |VA | = = 60 k I /2 1 Ro = 60 k 60 k = 30 k where Ad = 40 × 30 = 1200 V/V Ro = ro2 ro4 (c) Acm can be found using Eq. (8.165), ro4 Acm = − β3 REE But ro2 = ro4 = |VA | 60 = = 1 M I /2 0.06 Ro = 500 k where |VA | 60 = = 30 k I 2 60 = −0.02 V/V =− 100 × 30 REE = ro5 = Ad = 2.4 × 500 = 1200 V/V (c) Acm can be found from Eq. (8.165): ro4 Acm = − β3 REE Acm where REE is the output resistance of the Wilson mirror, or 95.6 dB REE = gm7 ro7 ro5 1200 | Ad | = = 60, 000 | Acm | 0.02 CMRR = 8.105 Refer to Fig. 8.40. where gm7 = 2I 2 × 0.12 = VOV 0.35 = 0.7 mA/V 60 |VA | = = 500 k ro7 = ro5 = I 0.12 REE = 0.7 × 5002 = 175 M Acm = − 1 = 5.7 × 10−5 V/V 100 × 175 1200 | Ad | = 21 × 106 = CMRR = | Acm | 5.7 × 10−5 or 146 dB 8.104 Refer to Fig. P8.104. To determine the bias current I , which is the current in the collector of Q5 , we first find the reference current through the 6.65-k resistor: 9 − (−5) − 0.7 = 2 mA IREF = 6.65 Assuming Q5 and Q6 are matched, we have I = 2 mA (a) gm1,2 I /2 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V Rid = 2rπ = 2β/gm1,2 2 × 100 = 5 k 40 (b) Ad = Gm Ro = W6 can be determined using Eq. (8.172): (W/L)7 (W/L)6 =2 (W/L)4 (W/L)5 (60/0.5) (W /0.5)6 =2 (10/0.5) (60/0.5) ⇒ W6 = 20 μm For all devices we can evaluate ID as follows: ID8 = IREF = 225 μA ID5 = IREF (W/L)5 = IREF = 225 μA (W/L)8 I = ID5 = 225 μA 1 ID5 = 112.5 μA 2 = ID1 = 112.5 μA ID1 = ID2 = ID3 = ID4 ID6 = ID7 = IREF = 225 μA With ID in each device known, we can use 1 W |VOVi |2 IDi = μCox 2 L i to determine |VOVi | and then |VGSi | = |VOVi | + |Vt | The values of gmi and roi can then be determined from 2IDi gmi = |VOVi | |VA | IDi where roi = Gm = gm1,2 = 40 mA/V A1 = −gm1 (ro2 ro4 ) Ro = ro2 ro4 = −0.9 × (80 80) = −36 V/V Chapter 8–38 The results for Problem 8.105 are summarized in the following table. Q1 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 112.5 112.5 112.5 112.5 225 225 225 225 |VOV | (V) 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 0.25 |VGS | (V) 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 gm (mA/V) 0.9 0.9 0.9 0.9 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.8 ro (k) 80 80 80 80 40 40 40 40 ID (μA) Q2 Q3 Q4 A2 = −gm6 (ro6 ro7 ) Thus = −1.8 × (40 40) = −36 V/V 200 = = −1.5 + 1 − 0.75 = −1.25 V 1 W μn Cox V2 2 L 5,7,8 OV W 1 = × 400 × × 0.04 2 L 5,7,8 W W W = = = 25 L 5 L 7 L 8 1 W |VOV |2 ID6 = 200 = μp Cox 2 L 6 W 1 200 = × 100 × × 0.04 2 L 6 W = 100 L 6 Thus The results are summarized in the following table: A0 = A1 A2 = −36 × −36 = 1296 V/V The upper limit of VICM is determined by the need to keep Q5 in saturation, thus VICM max = VDD − |VOV 5 | − |VSG1 | = 1.5 − 0.25 − 1 = +0.25 V The lower limit of VICM is determined by the need to keep Q1 and Q2 in saturation, thus VICM min = VG3 − |Vt | = −VSS + |VGS3 | − |Vt | −1.25 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.25 V The output voltage range is −VSS + VOV 6 ≤ v O ≤ VDD − |VOV 7 | Transistor Q1 W/L Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 12.5 12.5 50 50 25 100 25 25 that is, −1.25 V ≤ v O ≤ +1.25 V Ideally, the dc voltage at the output is zero. (b) The upper limit of VICM is determined by the need to keep Q1 and Q2 in saturation, thus 1 W μn Cox V2 2 L 1,2 OV W 1 100 = × 400 × × 0.04 2 L 1,2 W W = = 12.5 ⇒ L 1 L 2 1 W |VOV |2 ID3 = ID4 = 100 = μp Cox 2 L 3,4 1 W 100 = × 100 × × 0.04 2 L 3,4 W W = = 50 ⇒ L 3 L 4 8.106 (a) ID1 = ID2 = 100 = ID5 = ID7 = ID8 = 200 μA VICM max = VD1 + Vt = VDD − |VSG4 | + Vt = 0.9 − |Vt | − |VOV 4 | + Vt = 0.9 − 0.2 = +0.7 V The lower limit of VICM is determined by the need to keep Q5 in saturation, VICM min = −0.9 + |VOV 5 | + |VGS1 | = −0.9 + 0.2 + 0.2 + 0.4 = −0.1 V Thus −0.1 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.7 V (c) v Omax = VDD − |VOV 6 | = 0.9 − 0.2 = +0.7 V Chapter 8–39 v Omin = −VSS + |VOV 7 | = IREF = −0.9 + 0.2 = −0.7 V (48/0.8) (40/0.8) = 90 × 1.2 = 108 μA Thus −0.7 V ≤ v O ≤ +0.7 V Thus ID7 will exceed ID6 by 18 μA, which will result in a systematic offset voltage, (d) A1 = −gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) VO = 18 μA(ro6 ro7 ) where where 2 × 0.1 gm1,2 = = 1 mA/V 0.2 6 |VA | ro2 = ro4 = = = 60 k 0.1 mA 0.1 ro6 = 111 k and ro7 now becomes 10 = 92.6 k 0.108 A1 = −1 × (60 60) = −30 V/V ro7 = A2 = −gm6 (ro6 ro7 ) Thus where VO = 18 × 10−3 × (111 92.6) 2 × 0.2 = 2 mA/V 0.2 6 |VA | = = 30 k ro6 = ro7 = 0.2 0.2 = 909 mV gm6 = The corresponding input offset voltage will be VOS = A2 = −2 × (30 30) = −30 V/V A0 = A1 A2 = 30 × 30 = 900 V/V = 8.107 (a) Increasing (W/L)1 and (W/L)2 by a factor of 4 reduces |VOV 1,2 | by a factor of 2. Thus gm1,2 = 2ID /|VOV 1,2 | increase by a factor of 2. 909 = 0.82 mV 1109 8.109 (a) With the two input terminals connected to a dc voltage of VDD /2 = +0.6 V and for Q1 − Q4 to conduct a current of 200 μA, we have 1 W ID1,2 = k n V2 2 L 1,2 OV 1 W 200 = × 540 × × 0.152 2 L 1,2 W ⇒ = 32.9 L 1,2 (b) A1 is proportional to gm1,2 , thus A1 increases by a factor of 2 and the overall voltage gain increases by a factor of 2. (c) Since the input offset voltage is proportional to |VOV 1,2 |, it will decrease by a factor of 2. This, however, does not apply to VOS due to Vt . 8.108 If (W/L)7 becomes 48/0.8, ID7 will become ID7 = ID8 VO A0 (W/L)7 (W/L)8 This figure belongs to Problem 8.109. VDD 1.2 V Q3 Q4 Q6 Q1 Q2 vo IREF 200 A Q8 Q5 Q7 Chapter 8–40 1 W |VOV |2 kp 2 L 3,4 1 W 200 = × 100 × × 0.152 2 L 3,4 W ⇒ = 178 L 3,4 Thus ID3,4 = 0.65 V ≤ VICM ≤ 1.05 V Note that the input dc voltage in part (a) falls outside the allowable range of VICM ! Thus, part (a) should have specified a VICM greater than 0.65 V. The results of part (a), however, will not change. Transistor Q5 must carry a current of 400 μA, thus 1 W 400 = k n V2 2 L 5 OV W 1 = × 540 × × 0.152 2 L 5 W ⇒ = 65.8 L 5 (c) 0.15 V ≤ v O ≤ (1.2 − 0.15) that is, 0.15 V ≤ v O ≤ 1.05 V Similarly, Q7 is required to conduct a current of 400 μA, thus W W = = 65.8 L 7 L 5 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 |VA | 1.8 = = 9 k 0.2 mA 0.2 gm6 = 2 × 0.4 = 5.33 mA/V 0.15 ro6 = ro7 = 1.8 |VA | = = 4.5 k 0.4 mA 0.4 A2 = −gm6 (ro6 ro7 ) = −5.33(4.5 4.5) = 12 V/V A0 = A1 A2 = −12 × −12 = 144 V/V 8.110 Refer to Fig. P8.110. The results are summarized in the following table: Q3 ro2 = ro4 = = −12 V/V Finally, Q6 must conduct a current equal to that of Q7 , that is, 400 μA, thus 1 W 400 = × 100 × × 0.152 2 L 6 W ⇒ = 356 L 6 Q2 2 × 0.2 = 2.67 mA/V 0.15 A1 = −gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) = 2.67(9 9) Transistor Q8 conducts a current of 200 μA, thus W 1 W = = 32.9 L 8 2 L 5 Transistor Q1 (d) gm1,2 = (a) With the inputs grounded and the output at 0 V dc, we have Q8 IE1 = IE2 = 1 × 0.4 = 0.2 mA 2 ID (μA) 200 200 200 200 400 400 400 200 IE3 = IE4 0.2 mA W/L 32.9 32.9 178 178 65.8 356 65.8 32.9 IE5 0.5 mA IE6 = 1 mA (b) The upper limit on VICM is determined by the need to keep Q1 and Q2 in saturation, thus (b) The short-circuit transconductance of the first stage is VICM max = VD1,2 + |Vt | Gm = gm1,2 = = VDD − |Vt | − |VOV | + |Vt | = 1.2 − 0.15 = 1.05 V The lower limit on VICM is determined by the need to keep Q5 in saturation, thus VICM = |VOV 5 | + VGS1,2 = 0.15 + 0.15 + 0.35 = 0.65 V IC1,2 0.2 mA = 8 mA/V VT 0.025 V The voltage gain of the first stage can be obtained by multiplying Gm by the total resistance at the output node of the stage, i.e., the common collectors of Q2 and Q4 and the base of Q5 . Since ro2 = ro4 = ∞, the resistance at this node is equal to the input resistance of Q5 which is Rπ5 , rπ5 = β gm5 Chapter 8–41 where gm5 = IC5 0.5 = = 20 mA/V VT 0.025 ic3 5 k thus rπ 5 ib3 Q3 100 = = 5 k 20 v b5 = −Gm rπ 5 v id = −8 × 5 = −40 V/V The voltage gain of the second stage is A2 ≡ v c5 = −gm5 RC v b5 where RC5 is the total resistance in the collector of Q5 . Since ro5 = ∞, RC5 is simply the input resistance of the emitter follower Q6 , we have RC5 = Ri6 = (β + 1)(re6 + RL ) where re6 = VT 25 mV = 25 = IE6 1 mA Ri6 = (100 + 1)(0.025 + 1) = 103.5 k Q4 ic1 Thus the voltage gain of the first stage is given by A1 ≡ 5 k 25 ib1 vid 25 Q2 Q1 50 50 50 Rin Rin = (β + 1)(4 × 50 ) = 101 × 200 20 k ic1 = β1 = 100 ib1 ib3 (5 + 5) 10 = = = 0.5 ic1 (5 + 5) + Rin2 10 + 10 ic3 = β3 = 100 ib3 Thus Thus A2 = −20 × 103.5 = −2070 V/V ic3 ic3 ib3 ic1 = × × = 100 × 0.5 × 100 ib1 ib3 ic1 ib1 The gain of the third stage is given by = 5000 A/A A3 = vo RL 1 = 0.976 V/V = = v5 RL + re6 1 + 0.025 The overall voltage gain can now be obtained as A0 ≡ 50 vo = A1 A2 A3 v id = −40 × −2070 × 0.976 = 8.07 × 104 V/V 8.112 Refer to Fig. 8.41. From Example 8.7, we obtain IC1 = IC2 = 0.25 mA IC4 = IC5 = 1 mA IC7 = 1 mA 8.111 See figure. Rin2 = 2(β + 1)(25 + 25) = 2 × 101 × 50 10 k Effective load of first stage = Rin2 (5 + 5) = 10 10 = 5 k A1 = α Total resistance between collectors of Q1 and Q2 Total resistance in emitters of Q1 and Q2 5 k = 25 V/V 4 × 50 IC8 = 5 mA Thus re1 = re2 25 mV = 100 0.25 mA re4 = re5 = 25 mV = 25 1 mA With 100- resistance in the emitter of each of Q1 and Q2 , we have Rid = (β + 1)(2re1,2 + 2Re1,2 ) = 101 × (2 × 0.1 + 2 × 0.1) = 40.4 k Chapter 8–42 Thus, Rid increases by a factor of 2. With 25- resistance in the emitter of each of Q4 and Q5 , the input resistance of the second stage becomes Thus the gain of the third stage now becomes Ri2 = (β + 1)(2re4,5 + 2Re4,5 ) −130.5 V/V = 101 (2 × 0.025 + 2 × 0.025) and the overall voltage gain increases to = 10.1 k vo 130.5 = 1.73 × 105 V/V = 8513 × v id 6.42 Thus, Ri2 is increased by a factor of 2. The gain of the first stage will be v o1 = v id α × Total resistance between the collectors of Q1 and Q2 Total resistance in emitters of Q1 and Q2 40 k 10 k = 20 V/V 2 × 0.1 + 2 × 0.1 Thus the gain of the first stage decreases but only slightly. Of course, the two 100- resistances in the emitters reduce the gain but some of the reduction is mitigated by the increase in Ri2 , which increases the effective load resistance of the first stage. A3 = −α (b) The output resistance now becomes very large resistance Ro = 3 k re8 + β +1 3 k When the amplifier is loaded with RL = 100 , RL = RL + Ro 100 1.73 × 105 × 3000 + 100 Gv = 1.73 × 105 Gv = 5581 V/V If the original amplifier is loaded in RL = 100 , Gv = 8513 × The gain of the second stage will now be A2 = v o2 3 k Ri3 = −α v o1 2 × 0.025 + 2 × 0.025 From Example 8.8, Ri3 = 234.8 k, thus A2 − 3 234.8 = −29.6 V/V 0.1 which is about half the value without the two 25- emitter resistances. The gain of the third stage remains unchanged at −6.42 V/V, and the gain of the fourth stage remains unchanged at 1 V/V. Thus the overall voltage gain becomes 303.5 2.3 + 0.025 100 = 3378 V/V 152 + 100 Thus, although the output resistance of the original amplifier is much lower than that of the modified one, the overall voltage gain realized when the original amplifier is loaded in 100- resistance is much lower than that obtained with the modified design. Thus, replacing the 15.7-k resistance with a constant-current source is an excellent modification to make! 8.114 (a) vo = A1 A2 A3 A4 v id = 20 × −29.6 × −6.42 × 1 = 3800.6 V/V which is less than half the gain obtained without the emitter resistances. This is the price paid for doubling Rid . 8.113 Refer to Fig. 8.41. With R5 replaced with a 1-mA constant-current source with a high output resistance, the total resistance in the collector of Q7 now becomes the input resistance of Q8 , which is Ri4 = (β + 1)(re8 + R6 ) = 101 × (0.005 + 3) = 303.5 k Refer to Fig. (a) for the dc analysis. Replacing the 68 k-33 k divider network by its Thévenin Chapter 8–43 equivalent, we obtain VBB = −5 V + IE3 = 33 × 10 V 33 + 68 = 2.1 mA = −1.73 V VO = −5 + 2.1 × 2.4 = 0 V RBB = 68 k 33 k = 22.2 k (b) Rin = 68 k 33 k rπ1 Now, we can determine IE1 from IE1 = = 0.824 − 0.7 − (−5) 5.6 2.4 + 101 where VBB − (−5) − 0.7 RBB 4.7 + β +1 −1.73 + 5 − 0.7 = 0.52 mA 22.2 4.7 + 101 IC1 = α1 × 0.52 = 0.99 × 0.52 0.52 mA The collector current IC1 and the 8.2-k resistor it feeds can be replaced by a Thévenin equivalent as shown in Fig. (b). Thus rπ1 = β gm1 gm1 = IC1 0.52 = = 20.8 mA/V VT 0.025 rπ1 = 100 = 4.81 k 20.8 Rin = 68 k 33 4.81 4 k 5.6 k Rout = 2.4 k re3 + β +1 where 5V 0.74 V 8.2 k VT 25 mV = = 11.9 IE3 2.1 mA 5.6 = 2.4 0.0119 + 101 re3 = 3.3 k Rout IE2 = 65.5 (c) Refer to Fig. (d) Q2 IC2 (b) IE2 = 5 − 0.74 − 0.7 8.2 3.3 + 101 = 1.05 mA IC2 1.04 mA The collector current IC2 and the 5.6-k resistance it feeds can be replaced by a Thévenin equivalent as shown in Fig. (c). Thus ic1 = gm1 v i = 20.8v i Ri2 = rπ2 = β gm2 where gm2 = IC2 1.04 mA = 41.6 mA = VT 0.025 V rπ2 = 100 = 2.4 k 41.6 ib2 = gm1 v i 8.2 = 16.1v i 8.2 + 2.4 Chapter 8–44 ic2 = β2 ib2 = 100 × 16.1v i = 1610v i = Ri3 = (β + 1)(re3 + 2.4 k) = 101(0.0119 + 2.4) = 243.6 k gm2 gm1 1 1 gm1 ro1 1+ Since gm1 ro 1, gm2 1 1− Ais gm1 gm1 ro1 1 = Ais |ideal 1 − gm1 ro1 5.6 = 0.0225ic2 5.6 + 243.6 = 0.0225 × 1610v i = 36.18v i ib3 = ic2 × ie3 = (β + 1)ib3 = 101 × 36.18 = 3654v i v o = ie3 × 2.4 k where = 3654 × 2.4v i = 8770v i Ais |ideal = Thus vo = 8770 V/V vi Finally, from inspection, Ro = ro2 8.115 From the figure we observe that the controlled source gm1 v gs1 can be replaced by a resistance 1/gm1 , thus 1 v gs1 = ii ro1 gm1 Ri ≡ gm2 gm1 v gs1 1 = ro1 ii gm1 iosc = gm2 v gs2 = gm2 v gs1 = gm2 8.116 (a) Refer to Fig. P8.116. The current ID in each of the eight transistors can be found by inspection. Then, gm of each transistor can be determined as 2ID /|VOV | and ro as |VA |/ID . The results are given in the table below: (b) See figure on next page. Observe that at the output node the total signal current is 4id where 1 ro1 ii gm1 id = gm1,2 1 ro1 iosc gm1 Ais ≡ = gm2 1 ii + ro1 gm1 = v id 2 I v id 2|VOV | This figure belongs to Problem 8.115. d2, g1, g2 iosc ro1 ii vgs1 vgs2 gm1vgs1 gm2vgs2 ro2 Ri Ro This table belongs to Problem 8.116. Transistor Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 ID I 2 I 2 I 2 I 2 I 2 I I 2 I gm I |VOV | I |VOV | I |VOV | I |VOV | I |VOV | 2I |VOV | I |VOV | 2I |VOV | ro 2|VA | I 2|VA | I 2|VA | I 2|VA | I 2|VA | I |VA | I 2|VA | I |VA | I Chapter 8–45 This figure belongs to Problem 8.116, part (b). Q5 Q3 id Q4 id vid 2 Q1 id Q6 2id id Q2 vid 2 vo 4vid 2id 0V Q7 Q8 This figure belongs to Problem 8.116, part (c). Q5 Q3 Q6 Q4 io6 io5 ro6 vo ro8 ro5 Ro1 vicm 2RSS vicm 2RSS Ro2 1 ( gm7 // ro7 ( io8 Q7 Q8 and since the output resistance is Ro = ro6 ro8 = 1 |VA | 2 I then v o = 4 id Ro = 4 × I 1 |VA | × × v id 2|VOV | 2 I Thus Ad ≡ vo |VA | = v id |VOV | Q.E.D. (c) See figure. With v icm applied to both input terminals, we can replace each of Q1 and Q2 with an equivalent circuit composed of a controlled current, v icm /2RSS in parallel with a very large output resistance (Ro1 and Ro2 which are equal). The resistances Ro1 and Ro2 will be much larger than the input resistance of each of the mirrors Q3 − Q5 and Q4 − Q6 and thus we can neglect Ro1 and Ro2 altogether. The short-circuit output current of the Q4 − Q6 mirror will be gm6 1 v icm io6 = 1− gm4 gm4 ro4 2RSS v icm |VOV | = 1− 2|VA | RSS Chapter 8–46 and the output resistance will be ro6 . The short-circuit output current of the Q3 − Q5 mirror will be gm5 1 v icm io5 = 1− gm3 gm3 ro3 2RSS |VOV | v icm = 1− 2|VA | 2RSS and the output resistance will be ro5 . Since ro5 is much larger than the input resistance of the Q7 − Q8 mirror ( 1/gm7 ), most of io5 will flow into Q7 , resulting in an output short-circuit current io8 : gm8 1 1− io8 = io5 gm7 gm7 ro7 1 =2 1− io5 gm7 ro7 |VOV | v icm 1 = 1− 1− 2|VA | gm7 ro7 RSS and the output resistance is ro8 . Thus, at the output node we have a net current 1 |VOV | v icm io6 − io8 = 1 − 2|VA | gm7 ro7 RSS v icm 1 gm7 ro7 RSS This current flows into the output resistance (ro6 ro8 ) and thus produces an output voltage vo = ro6 ro8 1 v icm RSS gm7 ro7 ro6 ro8 1 RSS gm7 ro7 Ad = | |VA | I VA | VOV 1 |VA |/I 1 2 | Acm | = |VA |/I [I /|VOV | ] [2|VA |/I ] | Acm | = 1 1 |VOV | 1 × = 2 2 |VA | 4 CMRR = 4 VA VOV VOV VA 2 Q.E.D. (e) The upper limit on VICM is determined by Q1 and Q2 remaining in saturation, thus VICMmax = VDD − |VSG | + |Vt | = VDD − |VOV | The lower limit on VICM is determined by the need to keep the bias current source in saturation, i.e. maintaining a minimum voltage across it of |VOV |, thus VICMmin = −VSS + |VOV | + |VGS | = −VSS + 2|VOV | + |Vt | Thus −VSS + |Vt | + 2|VOV | ≤ VICM ≤ VDD − |VOV | and the common-mode gain becomes | Acm | = (d) RSS = Q.E.D. The output linear range is VDD − |VOV | ≤ v O ≤ −VSS + |VOV | Exercise 9–1 Ex: 9.1 AM = − =− RG gm (RD RL ) RG + Rsig 10 × 2(10 10) 10 + 0.1 = −9.9 V/V 1 fP 1 = 2πCC 1 (Rsig + RG ) = 1 2π × 1 × 10−6 (0.1 + 10) × 106 = 0.016 Hz fP 2 = gm + 1/RS 2π CS (2 + 0.1) × 10−3 = = 334.2 Hz 2π × 1 × 10−6 1 fP 3 = 2πCC 2 (RD + RL ) = 1 2π × 1 × 10−6 (10 + 10) × 103 = 8 Hz fZ = = 1 2π CS RS 1 2π × 1 × 10−6 × 10 × 103 fL = = 1 2π 1 2π 1 τC 1 + 1 τCE + 1 τC 2 1 1 1 + + × 103 7.44 0.071 13 = 2.28 kHz 1 fZ = 2πCE RE = 1 = 31.8 Hz 2π × 1 × 10−6 × 5 × 103 Since fZ is much lower than fL it will have a negligible effect on fL . Ex: 9.3 Cox = ox 3.45 × 10−11 F/m = tox 10 × 10−9 m = 3.45 × 10−3 F/m2 = 3.45 f F/μm2 Cov = WLov Cox = 10 × 0.05 × 3.45 = 1.72 f F Cgs = 2 WLCox + Cov 3 2 × 10 × 1 × 3.45 + 1.72 3 = 24.72 fF = = 15.9 Hz Cgd = Cov = 1.72 f F Since the highest-frequency pole is fP 2 = 334.2 and the next highest-frequency singularity is fZ at 15.9 Hz, the lower 3-dB frequency fL will be Csb 0 10 Csb = = = 6.1 f F VSB 1 1+ 1+ V0 0.6 fL fP 2 = 334.2 Hz Cdb 0 10 = = 4.1 f F Cdb = VDB 2+1 1+ 1+ V0 0.6 Ex: 9.2 Refer to Fig. 9.10. τC 1 = CC 1 [Rsig + (RB rπ )] = 1 × 10−6 [5 + (100 2.5)] × 103 = 7.44 ms RB Rsig τCE = CE RE re + β +1 β = gm rπ = 40 × 2.5 = 100 re 1/gm = 25 100 5 −6 × 103 5 0.025 + τCE = 1 × 10 101 τCE = 0.071 ms τC 2 = CC 2 (RC + RL ) = 1 × 10−6 (8 + 5) × 103 = 13 ms Ex: 9.4 gm = 2k n (W/L)ID = 2 × 0.16 × (10/1) × 0.1 = 0.566 mA/V gm fT = 2π(Cgs + Cgd ) = 0.566 × 10−3 2π(24.72 + 1.72) × 10−15 fT = 3.4 GHz Ex: 9.5 Cde = τF gm where τF = 20 ps gm = IC 1 mA = = 40 mA/V VT 0.025 V Exercise 9–2 Thus, fH = Cde = 20 × 10−12 × 40 × 10−3 = 0.8 pF 1 2πCin (Rsig RG ) 1 2π × 4.26 × 10−12 (0.01 4.7) × 106 Cje 2Cje 0 = = 2 × 20 = 40 f F = 3.7 MHz Cπ = Cde + Cje = 0.8 + 0.04 = 0.84 pF 1 × 106 = 20 ⇒ Cin = 1.625 pF = 0.33 = 12 f F 2 0.5 gm fT = 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) 1+ 40 × 10−3 = 7.47 GHz 2π(0.84 + 0.012) × 10−12 Ex: 9.6 | hfe | = 10 at f = 50 MHz Thus, fT = 10 × 50 = 500 MHz gm Cπ + Cμ = 2πfT = 40 × 10−3 2π × 500 × 106 = 12.7 pF Cπ = 12.7 − 2 = 10.7 pF Cin = Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm RL ) 1.625 = 1 + Cgd (1 + 7.14) ⇒ Cgd = 0.08 pF Ex: 9.10 To reduce the midband gain to half the value found, we reduce RL by the same factor, thus RL = 1.5 k But, RL = ro RC RL 1.5 = 100 8 RL ⇒ RL = 1.9 k Cin = Cπ + Cμ (1 + gm RL ) = 7 + 1(1 + 40 × 1.5) = 68 pF 10.7 = Cde + 2 fH = ⇒ Cde = 8.7 pF Since Cde is proportional to gm and hence IC , at IC = 0.1 mA, Cde = 0.87 pF and Cπ = 0.87 + 2 = 2.87 pF 4 × 10−3 = 130.7 MHz 2π(2.87 + 2) × 10−12 Ex: 9.8 AM = − =− RG gm RL RG + Rsig 4.7 × 7.14 = −7.12 V/V 4.7 + 0.01 1 2πCin (0.1 4.7) × 106 But, Ex: 9.7 Cπ = Cde + Cje fT = 1 2πCin (Rsig RG ) Cμ0 VCB m 1+ V0c Cμ = = Ex: 9.9 fH = = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 68 × 10−12 × 1.65 × 103 = 1.42 MHz Thus, by accepting a reduction in gain by a factor of 2, the bandwidth is increased by a factor of 1.42/0.754 = 1.9, approximately the same factor as the reduction in gain. Ex: 9.11 ft = | AM | fH 2 × 109 = 12.5 2π(CL + Cgd ) × 10 × 103 ⇒ CL + Cgd = 99.5 f F CL = 99.5 − 5 = 94.5 f F Exercise 9–3 1000 s 1+ 2π × 105 Ex: 9.12 T (s ) = ω 1+j ωP 1 |T | = 1+ |T | = 1+ 2= 1+ ωH ωP 1 ω ωP 1 AM ω 1+j ωP 2 1+ ω ωP 2 2 | AM | 2 ω ω 2 1+ ωP 1 k ωP 1 −4=0 The approximate value of ωH is obtained from Eq. (9.77), 1 1 + ωH 1 ωP2 1 4ωP2 1 1+ ωH k ωP 1 17 ωH 2 1 ωH 4 + 16 ωP 1 16 ωP 1 4 2 ωH ωH + 17 − 16 = 0 ωP 1 ωP 1 2 ⇒ ωH = 0.95ωP 1 The approximate value of ωH is found from Eq. (9.77): 1 1 ωH 1 + ωP2 1 16ωP2 1 For ωH = 0.99ωP 1, 0.992 2 = (1 + 0.992 ) 1 + k2 = 0.97ωP 1 ⇒ k = 9.88 Ex: 9.15 Cin = Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm RL ) Ex: 9.14 2 = 1 + For k = 1, ωH 2 2= 1+ ωP 1 = 1+ 2 =1+ ⇒ k = 2.78 ωH ωP 1 ωH ωP 1 For k = 4, the exact value of ωH is obtained from ωH 2 ωH 2 1+ 2= 1+ ωP 1 4ωP 1 For ωH = 0.9ωP 1, 0.81 2 = (1 + 0.81) 1 + 2 k +5 ⇒ ωH = 0.89ωP 1 | AM | 2 2 4 ⇒ ωH = 0.84ωP 1 GB = 1000 × 100 × 103 = 108 Hz Ex: 9.13 T ( j ω) = ωH ωP 1 2 ωH ωP 1 2 1+ 1+ ωH ωP 1 ωH k ωP 1 2 2 2 = 20 + 5(1 + 1.25 × 10) = 87.5 f F fH = = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 87.5 × 10−15 × 10 × 103 = 181.9 MHz This is greater than the value obtained in Example 9.8, fH = 135.5 MHz, by 34%. The value obtained in Example 9.8 is a better estimate of fH as it takes into account the effect of CL . ⇒ ωH = 0.64ωP 1 The approximate value using Eq. (9.77) is 2 ωP 1 ωH 1 = √ ωP2 1 2 Ex: 9.16 | AM | = gm RL = 1.25 × 10 = 12.5 V/V = 0.71ωP 1 GB = | AM | fH For k = 2, the exact value of ωH is obtained from ωH 2 ωH 2 1+ 2= 1+ ωP 1 2ωP 1 = 12.5 × 135.5 = 1.69 GHz =1+ 5 ωH 4 ωP 1 2 + 1 ωH 4 ωP 1 4 Ex: 9.17 | AM | = Rgs = 10 k 1 × 12.5 = 6.25 V/V 2 Exercise 9–4 (1 + gm RL ) + RL Rgd = Rsig = 10(1 + 6.25) + 5 = 77.5 k RCL = RL = 5 k τgs = Cgs Rgs = 20 × 10−15 × 10 × 103 = 200 ps τgd = Cgd Rgd = 5×10−15 ×77.5×103 = 387.5 ps τCL = CL RCL = 25 × 10−15 × 5 × 103 = 125 ps τH = τgs + τgd + τCL Ex: 9.19 (a) gm = 40 mA/V rπ = 200 = 5 k 40 ron = VAn 130 = = 130 k I 1 rop = |VAp | 50 = = 50 k I 1 RL = ron rop = 130 50 = 36.1 k AM = − = 200 + 387.5 + 125 = 712.5 ps =− 1 fH = 2πτH rπ gm RL rπ + rx + Rsig 5 × 40 × 36.1 5 + 0.2 + 36 = −175 V/V 1 = = 223.4 MHz 2π × 712.5 × 10−12 (b) Cin = Cπ + Cμ (1 + gm RL ) GB = 6.25 × 223.4 = 1.4 GHz = 16 + 0.3(1 + 40 × 36.1) Ex: 9.18 gm = 2μn Cox = 450 pF W ID L Rsig = rπ (rx + Rsig ) Since ID is increased by a factor of 4, gm doubles: = 5 (0.2 + 36) = 4.39 k gm = 2 × 1.25 = 2.5 mA/V fH = Since RL is ro /2, increasing ID by a factor of four results in ro and hence RL decreasing by a factor of 4, thus RL = 1 × 10 = 2.5 k 4 | AM | = gm RL = 2.5 × 2.5 = 6.25 V/V = 10 k Rgs = Rsig Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL = 10(1 + 6.25) + 2.5 = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 450 × 10−12 × 4.39 × 103 = 80.6 kHz (c) Rπ = Rsig = 4.39 k Rμ = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL = 4.39(1 + 40 × 36.1) + 36.1 = 6.38 M = 75 k RCL = RL = 36.1 k RCL = RL = 2.5 k τH = Cπ + Cμ Rμ + CL RCL τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = 16 × 4.39 + 0.3 × 6.38 × 103 + 5 × 36.1 = Cgs Rsig + Cgd Rgd + CL RCL = 70.2 + 1914 + 180.5 = 20 × 10−15 × 10 × 103 + 5 × 10−15 × 75 = 2164.7 ns × 103 + 25 × 10−15 × 2.5 × 103 = 200 + 375 + 62.5 = 637.5 ps fH = 1 = 250 MHz 2π × 637.5 × 10−12 GB = | AM | fH = 6.25 × 250 = 1.56 GHz fH = 1 2π × 2164.7 × 10−9 = 73.5 kHz gm (d) fZ = 2πCμ = 40 × 10−3 = 21.2 GHz 2π × 0.3 × 10−12 (e) GB = 175 × 73.5 = 12.9 MHz Exercise 9–5 Ex: 9.20 Rin = R L + ro 1 + gm ro 500 + 20 = = 20 k 1 + 25 Gv = RL 500 = 16.7 V/V = Rsig + Rin 10 + 20 τH = Cgs Rsig + Cgd × 21Rsig = Cgs Rsig + 0.25Cgs × 21Rsig = 6.25Cgs Rsig 1 2π × 6.25Cgs Rsig fH = Rgs = Rsig Rin = 10 20 = 6.7 k For the cascode amplifier, Rgd = RL Ro τH Rsig [Cgs 1 + Cgd 1 (1 + gm1 Rd 1 )] = 500 280 = 179.5 k where τH = Cgs Rgs + (Cgd + CL )Rgd Rd 1 = ro 1 Rin2 = ro = 20 × 10−15 × 6.7 × 103 + (5 + 25) × 10−15 × 179.5 × 103 = 134 + 5385 = 5519 ps 1 = 28.8 MHz fH = 2π × 5519 × 10−12 2 ro 2 gm = ro = 2 gm + ro gm ro 2ro 2ro = = 2 + gm ro 2 + 40 21 gm ro τH = Cgs Rsig 1 + 0.25 1 + 21 40 = Cgs Rsig 1 + 0.25 1 + 21 = Thus, while the midband gain has been increased substantially (by a factor of 9.7), the bandwidth has been substantially lowered (by a factor of 9.4). Thus, the high-frequency advantage of the CG amplifier is completely lost! = 1.73Cgs Rsig Ex: 9.21 (a) ACS = −gm (RL ro ) fH = 1 = −gm (ro ro ) = − gm ro 2 Thus, 1 = − × 40 = −20 V/V 2 Acascode = −gm (RL Ro ) ro + ro gm ro 1 2π × 1.73 Cgs Rsig 6.25 fH (cascode) = = 3.6 fH (CS) 1.73 (c) ft (cascode) = 2 × 3.6 = 7.2 ft (CS) = −gm (ro gm ro ro ) −gm ro = −40 V/V Thus, Acascode =2 ACS (b) For the CS amplifier, τH = Cgs Rgs + Cgd Rgd where Rgs = Rsig Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL Rsig (1 + gm RL ) 1 = Rsig 1 + gm ro 2 1 = Rsig 1 + × 40 = 21Rsig 2 Ex: 9.22 gm = 40 mA/V rπ = β 200 = 5 k = gm 40 Rin = rπ + rx = 5 + 0.2 = 5.2 k A0 = gm ro = 40 × 130 = 5200 V/V Ro 1 = ro 1 = 130 k Rin2 = re 2 = 25 ro 2 + RL ro 2 + RL /(β2 + 1) 130 + 50 50 130 + 201 = 35 Ro β2 ro 2 = 200 × 130 = 26 M Exercise 9–6 AM = − =− rπ gm (Ro RL ) rπ + rx + Rsig 5 40(26,000 50) 5 + 0.2 + 36 AM = −242 V/V = rπ 1 (rx 1 + Rsig ) Rsig = 5 (0.2 + 36) = 4.39 k Rπ 1 = Rsig = 4.39 k Rc 1 = ro 1 Rin2 Ex: 9.24 From Example 9.11, we get τH = b1 = 104 ps fH = = 1 2πτH 1 = 1.53 GHz 2π × 104 × 10−12 This is lower than the exact value found in Example 9.11 (i.e., 1.86 GHz) by about 18%, still not a bad estimate! = 130 k 35 35 Rμ1 = Rsig (1 + gm1 Rc 1 ) + Rc 1 = 4.39(1 + 40 × 0.035) + 0.035 = 10.6 k τH = Cπ 1 Rπ 1 + Cμ1 Rμ1 + Cπ 2 Rc 1 + (CL + Cμ2 )(RL Ro ) = 16 × 4.39 + 0.3 × 10.6 + 16 × 0.035 + (5 + 0.3)(50 26,000) Ex: 9.25 gm = 40 mA/V re = 25 rπ = = Rsig + rx = Rsig = 1 k Rsig RL = RL ro = 1 100 = 0.99 k fH = 1 = 470 kHz 2π × 338.5 × 10−9 RL + re + = To have fH equal to 1 MHz, 1 1 = = 159.2 ns τH = 2π fH 2π × 1 × 106 Thus, 159.2 = 70.24 + 3.18 + 0.56 + (CL + Cμ )(50 26000) ⇒ CL + Cμ = 1.71 pF Thus, CL must be reduced to 1.41 pF. Ex: 9.23 From Eq. (9.120), we obtain Rgs = Rsig Rsig + RL RL + = gm RL + 1 gm RL + 1 gm RL + 1 Rgd = Rsig RCL = RL gm RL + 1 = Rsig β +1 0.99 = 0.97 V/V 0.99 + 0.025 + (1/101) Cπ + Cμ = ft = | AM | fH = 242 × 470 = 113.8 MHz Thus, in comparison to the CE amplifier of Exercise 9.19, we see that | AM | has increased from 175 V/V to 242 V/V, fH has increased from 73.5 kHz to 470 kHz, and ft has increased from 12.9 MHz to 113.8 MHz. RL AM = = 70.24 + 3.18 + 0.56 + 264.5 = 338.5 ns β 100 = 2.5 k = gm 40 gm 2πfT 40 × 10−3 2π × 400 × 106 = 15.9 pF Cμ = 2 pF Cπ = 13.9 pF fZ = 1 1 = 2πCπ re 2π × 13.9 × 10−12 × 25 = 458 MHz b1 = Rsig R + C +C Rsig 1 + RL Cπ + Cμ 1 + L π L re rπ Rsig R 1+ L + re rπ 0.99 13.9 + 2 1 + × 1 + (13.9 + 0)0.99 0.025 = 1 0.99 + 1+ 0.025 2.5 = 2.66 × 10−9 s b2 = Cπ Cμ RL Rsig 13.9 × 2 × 0.99 × 1 = 0.99 1 Rsig RL 1+ + 1+ + 0.025 2.5 rπ re = 0.671 × 10−18 Exercise 9–7 ωP 1 and ωP 2 are the roots of the equation Ex: 9.28 Ad = gm1,2 (ro 2 ro 4 ) 1 + b1 s + b 2 s = 0 where Solving we obtain, 0.5 = 20 mA/V 0.025 100 = 200 k ro 2 = ro 4 = 0.5 Ad = 20(200 200) = 2000 V/V 2 gm1,2 = fP 1 = 67 MHz fP 2 = 563 MHz Since fP 1 fP 2, The dominant high-frequency pole is that introduced at the output node, fH fP 1 = 67 MHz Ex: 9.26 (a) ID 1,2 = 1 W μn Cox V2 2 L 1,2 OV 1 2 × 0.2 × 100VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V 0.4 = gm = 2ID 2 × 0.4 = = 4 mA/V VOV 0.2 (b) Ad = gm (RD ro ) where VA 20 = 50 k = ro = ID 0.4 Ad = 4(5 50) = 4 × 4.545 = 18.2 V/V (c) fH = = 2π(CL + Cgd 1 + Cdb )(RD ro ) 1 2π(100 + 10 + 10) × 10−15 × 4.545 × 103 = 292 MHz (d) τgs = Cgs Rsig = 50 × 10 = 500 ps τgd = Cgd Rgd = Cgd [Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL ] = 10[10(1 + 18.2) + 4.545] = 1965.5 ps τCL = (CL + Cdb )RL = 110 × 4.545 = 500 ps τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = 500 + 1965.5 + 500 = 2965.5 ps 1 fH = 2π × 2965.5 × 10−12 = 53.7 MHz Ex: 9.27 fZ = = fH = = 1 2πCL (ro 2 ro 4 ) 1 2π × 2 × 10−12 × 100 × 103 = 0.8 MHz Ex: 9.29 (a) AM = −gm RL where RL = RL ro = 20 20 = 10 k AM = −2 × 10 = −20 V/V τH = Cgs Rgs + Cgd Rgd + CL RL = Cgs Rsig + Cgd [Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL ] + CL RL = 20 × 20 + 5[20(1 + 20) + 10] + 5 × 10 = 400 + 2150 + 50 = 2600 ps fH = = 1 2πτH 1 2π × 2600 × 10−12 = 61.2 MHz GB = | AM | fH = 20 × 61.2 = 1.22 GHz (b) Gm = gm 2 = 0.67 mA/V = 1 + gm Rs 1+2 Ro ro (1 + gm Rs ) = 20 × 3 = 60 k 1 2π RSS CSS 1 2π × 75 × 103 × 0.4 × 10−12 = 5.3 MHz Thus, the 3-dB frequency of the CMRR is 5.3 MHz. RL = RL Ro = 20 60 = 15 k AM = −Gm RL = −0.67 × 15 = −10 V/V Rgd = Rsig (1 + Gm RL ) + RL = 20(1 + 10) + 15 = 235 k Exercise 9–8 RCL = RL = 15 k fP 2 = Rsig + Rs + Rsig Rs /(ro + RL ) ro 1 + gm Rs ro + RL Rgs = = 1 2πCμ RL 1 2π × 2 × 10−12 × 10 × 103 where = 8 MHz 2 = 1 k Rs = gm T (s ) = 20 × 1 20 + 1 + 20 + 20 Rgs = 20 1+2× 20 + 20 s 1+ ωP 1 |T ( j ω)| = 1+ τH = Cgs Rgs + Cgd Rgd + CL RCL = 20 × 10.75 + 5 × 235 + 5 × 15 = 215 + 1175 + 75 = 1465 ps 1 = 109 MHz 2π × 1465 × 10−12 GB = 10 × 109 = 1.1 GHz Ex: 9.30 Refer to Fig. 9.42(b). AM = 2rπ 1 × × gm RL 2rπ + Rsig 2 where gm = 20 mA/V 100 = 5 k rπ = 20 10 1 × × 20 × 10 = 50 V/V AM = 10 + 10 2 fP 1 = 2π = 1 Cπ + Cμ (2rπ Rsig ) 2 1 6 2π + 2 × 10−12 (10 10) × 103 2 = 6.4 MHz s ωP 2 1+ = 10.75 k fH = 50 ω ωP 1 50 2 1+ ω ωP 2 2 √ At ω = ωH , |T | = 50/ 2, thus 2= 1+ =1+ ωH ωP 1 ωH ωP 1 + fH2 + 1+ 2 ωH4 + ωH2 2 ωP 1ωP2 2 fH4 2 2 fP 1fP 2 2 ωH ωP 2 2 + 1 1 + 2 ωP2 1 ωP 2 1 fP21 + 1 fP22 ωH ωP 2 2 ωH ωP 1 2 ωH ωP 2 2 −1=0 −1=0 1 fH4 1 2 + f + −1=0 H 6.42 × 82 6.42 82 ⇒ fH = 4.6 MHz (Exact value) Using Eq. (9.164), an approximate value for fH can be obtained: 1 1 fH 1/ + 2 fP21 fP 2 = 1/ 1 1 + 2 = 5 MHz 6.42 8 Chapter 9–1 9.1 Refer to Fig. 9.3(b). Vg = Vsig RG RG + Rsig + gm Vg YS YS + gm 1 gm + sCS Is RS = 1 Vg gm + + sCS RS Is = 1 sCC1 where RG = RG1 RG2 = 2 M 1 M = 667 k and = gm Rsig = 200 k Vg RG = Vsig RG + Rsig Thus, s s+ 1 CC1 (RG + Rsig ) 1 2πCC1 (RG + Rsig ) gm + 1/RS 2πCS fP2 = fZ = Thus, fP1 = s + 1/CS RS gm + 1/RS s+ CS 1 2πCS RS where We required gm = 5 mA/V and RS = 1.8 k fP1 ≤ 10 Hz To make fP2 ≤ 100 Hz, gm + 1/RS ≤ 100 2πCS thus we select CC1 so that 1 ≤ 10 2πCC1 (RG + Rsig ) CC1 ≥ 5 × 10−3 + (1/1.8 × 103 ) = 8.8 μF 2π × 100 ⇒ CS ≥ 1 = 18.4 nF 2π × 10 × (667 + 200) × 103 Select CS = 10 μF. Thus, ⇒ CC1 = 20 nF 5 × 10−3 + (1/1.8 × 103 ) = 88.4 Hz 2π × 10 × 10−6 fP2 = 9.2 Refer to Fig. 9.3(b). and RD × RL Vo = −Id 1 RD + + RL sCC2 fZ = RD RL Vo =− Id RD + RL 9.4 Refer to Fig. 9.3. s s+ 1 CC2 (RD + RL ) 1 2πCC2 (RD + RL ) fP3 = 1 = 8.84 Hz 2π × 10 × 10−6 × 1.8 × 103 AM = − RG × gm (RD RL ) RG + Rsig where where RG = RG1 RG2 = 47 M 10 M RD = 10 k and RL = 10 k = 8.246 M To make fP3 ≤ 10 Hz, Rsig = 100 k, gm = 5 mA/V, RD = 4.7 k and RL = 10 k. 1 ≤ 10 2πCC2 (RD + RL ) ⇒ CC2 1 ≥ = 0.8 μF 2π × 10 × (10 + 10) × 103 Select, CC2 = 0.8 μF. Thus, AM = − = −15.8 V/V fP1 = 9.3 Refer to Fig. 9.3(b). Is = Vg 1 + ZS gm 8.426 × 5(4.7 10) 8.426 + 0.1 = 1 2πCC1 (RG + Rsig ) 1 2π × 0.01 × 10−6 (8.426 + 0.1) × 106 = 1.9 Hz Chapter 9–2 gm + 1/RS 2πCS fP2 = = 5 × 10−3 + 0.5 × 10−3 = 87.5 Hz 2π × 10 × 10−6 20 dB/decade 26 dB 20 log 20 26 dB 1 = 8 Hz 2π × 10 × 10−6 × 2 × 103 fP3 = = Gain, dB 1 2πCS RS fZ = = (e) The Bode plot for the gain is shown in Fig. 2. 6 dB 1 2πCC2 (RD + RL ) f 10 Hz f 100 Hz 1 = 10.8 Hz 2π × 1 × 10−6 (4.7 + 10) × 103 Since fP2 fP1 , fP3 , fZ , fL fP2 = 87.5 Hz Figure 2 Observe that the dc gain is 6 dB, i.e. 2 V/V. This makes perfect sense since from Fig. 1 we see that at dc, capacitor CS behaves as open circuit and the gain becomes DC gain = − 9.5 Vo f (log scale) 10 k RD = − 1 1 + RS + 4.5 gm 2 = −2 V/V Id I s RD 1 gm Is Vi RS 9.6 See figure on next page. Replacing the MOSFET with its T model results in the circuit shown in the figure. AM = − CS =− RG × gm (RD RL ) RG + Rsig 2 × 3(20 10) 2 + 0.5 = −16 V/V Figure 1 Replacing the MOSFET with its T model results in the circuit shown in Fig. 1. (a) AM ≡ Vo = −gm RD Vi −20 = −2 × RD ⇒ RD = 10 k (b) fP = 100 = gm + 1/RS 2πCS 2 × 10−3 + (1/4.5 × 103 ) 2πCS ⇒ CS = 3.53 μF (c) fZ = 1 = 2πCS RS To minimize the total capacitance we select CS so as to place fP2 (usually the highest-frequency low-frequency pole) at 100 Hz. Thus, gm 100 = 2πCS = 3 × 10−3 2πCS ⇒ CS = 4.8 μF Select CS = 5 μF. Of the two remaining poles, the one caused by CC2 has associated relatively low-valued resistances (RD and RL are much lower than RG ), thus to minimize the total capacitance we place fP3 at 10 Hz and fP1 at 1 Hz. Thus, 10 = 1 2πCC2 (RD + RL ) 1 2πCC2 (20 + 10) × 103 1 = 10 Hz 2π × 3.53 × 10−6 × 4.5 × 103 ≡ (d) Since fP fZ , ⇒ CC2 = 0.53 μF fL fP = 100 Hz Select CC2 = 1 μF. Chapter 9–3 This figure belongs to Problem 9.6. CC2 Vo Id Is Rsig Vsig 1= 0 CC1 Is 1 1= 2πCC1 (2 + 0.5) × 106 ⇒ CC1 = 63.7 nF Select CC1 = 100 nF = 0.1 μF. With the selected capacitor values, we obtain fP2 1 = 0.64 Hz 2π × 0.1 × 10−6 × 2.5 × 106 3 × 10−3 = = 95.5 Hz 2π × 5 × 10−6 fZ = 0 (dc) fP3 1 = = 5.3 Hz 2π × 1 × 10−6 (20 + 10) × 103 Since fP2 fP1 and fP3 , we have fL fP2 = 95.5 Hz 9.7 The amplifier in Fig. P9.7 will have the equivalent circuit in Fig. 9.9 except with RE = ∞ (i.e. omitted). Also, the equivalent circuits in Fig. 9.10 can be used to determine the three short-circuit time constants, again with RE = ∞. Since the amplifier is operating at IC IE = 100 μA = 0.1 mA and β = 100, 25 mV = 250 0.1 mA gm = 0.1 mA = 4 mA/V 0.025 V rπ = β 100 = = 25 k gm 4 RL 1/gm CS To make CE responsible for 80% of fL , we use 1 = 0.8 ωL = 0.8 × 2πfL τCE ⇒ τCE = Using the equivalent circuit in Fig. 9.10(b), we get RB Rsig τCE = CE re + β +1 1 2 ms 0.8 × 2π × 100 Thus, (200 20) × 103 = 2 × 10−3 CE 250 + 101 ⇒ CE = 4.65 μF Select, CE = 5 μF. Using the information in Fig. 9.10(a), we determine τC1 as τC1 = CC1 [(RB rπ ) + Rsig ] To make the contribution of CC1 to the determination of fL equal to 10%, we use 1 = 0.1ωL = 0.1 × 2πfL τC1 ⇒ τC1 = re = Io RG 1 2πCC1 (RG + Rsig ) fP1 = RD 1 = 15.92 ms 0.1 × 2π × 100 Thus, CC1 [(200 25) × 103 + 20 × 103 ] = 15.92 × 10−3 ⇒ CC1 = 0.38 μF Select CC1 = 0.5 μF. For CC2 we use the information in Fig. 9.10(c) to determine τC2 : τC2 = CC2 (RC + RL ) To make the contribution of CC2 to the determination of fL equal to 10%, we use 1 = 0.1ωL = 0.1 × 2πfL τC2 ⇒ τC2 = 1 = 15.92 ms 0.1 × 2π × 100 Chapter 9–4 Thus, −3 CC2 (20 + 10) × 10 = 15.92 × 10 3 ⇒ CC2 = 0.53 μF Although, to be conservative we should select CC2 = 1 μF; in this case we can select CC2 = 0.5 μF because the required value is very close to 0.5 μF and because we have selected CC1 and CE larger than the required values. The resulting fL will be 1 1 1 1 fL = + + 2π τCE τC1 τC2 (200 20) × 103 τCE = 5 × 10−6 × 250 + 101 = 2.15 ms τC1 = 0.5 × 10−6 [(200 25) × 103 + 20 × 103 ] = 21.1 ms τC2 = 0.5 × 10−6 (20 + 10) × 103 = 15 ms 3 10 103 103 1 fL = + + 2π 2.15 21.1 15 = 92.2 Hz which is lower (hence more conservative) than the required value of 100 Hz. Ctotal = 5 + 0.5 + 0.5 = 6.0 μF Using the method of short-circuit time constants and the information in Fig. 9.10, we obtain τC1 = CC1 [(RB rπ ) + Rsig ] = CC1 (Rin + Rsig ) = 1 × 10−6 (5.7 + 5) × 103 = 10.7 ms RB Rsig τCE = CE RE re + β +1 = 20× 10 −6 Rin = RB1 RB2 rπ where RB1 = 33 k, RB2 = 22 k IC 0.3 mA = 12 mA/V = VT 0.025 V gm = VT 25 mV re = = 83.3 = IE 0.3 mA rπ = β 120 = 10 k = gm 12 Thus, Rin = 33 22 10 = 5.7 k Rin AM = − gm (RC RL ) Rin + Rsig 3.9 × 10 (33 22 5) × 103 83.3 + 121 τC2 = CC2 (RC + RL ) = 1 × 10−6 (4.7 + 5.6) × 103 = 10 ms 1 1 1 1 fL + + 2π τC1 τCE τC2 1 1 1 1 = + + 2π 10.7 × 10−3 2.2 × 10−3 10.3 × 10−3 = 102.7 Hz 9.9 Refer to the data given in the statement for Problem 9.8. RB = RB1 RB2 = 33 k 22 k = 13.2 k IC IE 0.3 mA gm = IC 0.3 mA = = 12 mA/V VT 0.025 V re = VT 25 mV = 83.3 = IE 0.3 mA rπ = β 120 = 10 k = gm 12 From Fig. 9.10, we have τC1 = CC1 [(RB rπ ) + Rsig ] For CC1 to contribute 10% of fL , we use 1 = 0.1ωL = 0.1 × 2πfL τC1 = 0.1 × 2π × 50 ⇒ τC1 = 31.8 ms Thus, CC1 [(13.2 10) + 5] × 103 = 31.8 × 10−3 ⇒ CC1 = 3 μF where τC2 = CC2 (RC + RL ) Rsig = 5 k, RC = 4.7 k, and RL = 5.6 k For CC2 to contribute 10% of fL , we use Thus, 1 = 0.1ωL = 0.1 × 2πfL τC2 AM = − 5.7 × 12(4.7 5.6) 5.7 + 5 = −16.3 V/V = 2.2 ms 9.8 Refer to Fig. 9.9. In the midband, 3 = 0.1 × 2π × 50 ⇒ τC2 = 31.8 ms Chapter 9–5 and Thus, −3 CC2 (4.7 + 5.6) × 10 = 31.8 × 10 3 fL = fP = ⇒ CC2 = 3.09 μF 3 μF RB Rsig = CE RE re + β +1 | AM | = For CE to contribute 80% of fL , we use 1 τCE αRC re 1 1+ Re re Thus, including Re reduces the gain magnitude by Re the factor 1 + . re = 0.8ωL = 0.8 × 2πfL = 0.8 × 2π × 50 (c) From Eq. (3), we obtain ⇒ τCE = 3.98 ms fL = Thus, (13.2 5) × 1000 CE 3900 83.3 + 121 1 2πCE re 1 1+ Re re Thus, including Re reduces fL by the factor Re 1+ . This is the same factor by which the re magnitude of the gain is reduced. Thus, Re can be used to tradeoff gain for decreasing fL (that is, increasing the amplifier bandwidth). = 3.98 × 10−3 ⇒ CE = 36.2 μF (d) I = 0.25 mA, RC = 10 k, CE = 10 μF 9.10 Vo aIe Vsig (3) (b) From Eq. (2) we see that Finally, τCE 1 2πCE (re + Re ) Ie 25 mV VT = = 100 I 0.25 mA re = For Re = 0: RC | AM | = 1 = 159.2 Hz 2π × 10 × 10−6 × 100 fL = re αRC 10 k = 100 V/V re 100 To lower fL by a factor of 10, we use Re 1+ CE Re = 10 re ⇒ Re = 900 The gain now becomes Figure 1 | AM | = Replacing the BJT with its T model results in the circuit shown in Fig. 1. (a) Ie = See Fig. 2 for the Bode plot. Vsig re + Re + 1 sCE Gain (dB) Re 0 Vo = −αIe RC 40 dB Re 900 Thus, αRC Vo =− Vsig re + Re s 1 s+ CE (re + Re ) (1) αRC re + Re 20 dB 15.9 Hz 159 Hz From this expression we obtain AM = − 100 100 = = 10 V/V Re 10 1+ re (2) Figure 2 f (Hz) (log scale) Chapter 9–6 This figure belongs to Problem 9.11, part (a). CC Vo aIe Rsig RC RL Vsig V b Ie re CE Zin Figure 1 9.11 Replacing the BJT with its T model results in the equivalent circuit shown in Fig. 1 above. (a) At midband, CE and CC act as short circuits. Thus (e) To minimize the total capacitance we choose to make the pole caused by CE the dominant one and make its frequency equal to fL = 100 Hz, Rin = (β + 1)re (β + 1)re Vo =− gm (RC RL ) Vsig (β + 1)re + Rsig =− β(RC RL ) (β + 1)re + Rsig (b) Because the controlled current source αIe is ideal, it effectively separates the input circuit from the output circuit. The result is that the poles caused by CE and CC do not interact. The pole due to CE will have frequency ωPE : ωPE = 1 10, 000 25 + 101 2π × 100 = CE ⇒ CE = 12.83 μF Placing the pole due to CC at 10 Hz, we obtain 2π × 10 = 1 CC (10 + 10) × 103 ⇒ CC = 0.8 μF (f) A Bode plot for the gain magnitude is shown in Fig. 2. 1 Rsig CE re + β +1 and the pole due to CC will have a frequency ωPC ωPC = 1 CC (RC + RL ) (c) The overall voltage transfer function can be expressed as Vo s s = AM Vsig s + ωPE s + ωPC VT 25 mV = 25 (d) re = = IE 1 mA 100(10 k 10 k) AM = − 101 × 25 × 10−3 k + 10 k = −40 V/V Figure 2 The gain at fP2 (10 Hz) is 12 dB. Since the gain decreases by 40 dB/decade or equivalently 12 dB/octave, it reaches 0 dB (unity magnitude) at f = fPC /2 = 5 Hz. Chapter 9–7 9.12 Cox = = ox tox 3.45 × 10−11 F/m = 0.43 × 10−2 F/m2 8 × 10−9 m = 0.43 × 10−2 × 10−12 F/μm2 = 4.3 fF/μm2 2ID 2 × 0.2 = 1.33 mA/V = VOV 0.3 gm fT = 2π(Cgs + Cgd ) 9.13 gm = = 1.33 × 10−3 = 7.1 GHz 2π × (25 + 5) × 10−15 k n = μn Cox = 450 × 108 (μm2 /V·s) × 4.3 × 10−15 F/μm2 = 193.5 μA/V 1 W 2 ID = k n VOV (1 + λVDS ) 2 L 2 1 2 × 193.5 × 20 × VOV (1 + 0.05 × 1.5) 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.31 V 200 = 2ID 2 × 0.2 = 1.3 mA/V = VOV 0.31 γ χ= 2 2φf + VSB gm = 0.5 = √ = 0.19 2 0.65 + 1 gmb = χ gm = 0.25 mA/V ro = | VA | 1 1 = 100 k = = ID | λ|ID 0.05 × 0.2 Cgs = 2 WLCox + WLov Cox 3 2 × 20 × 1 × 4.3 + 20 × 0.05 × 4.3 3 = 57.3 + 4.3 = 61.6 fF = 9.14 fT = gm 2π(Cgs + Cgd ) For Cgs Cgd gm fT 2πCgs 2 WLCox + WLov Cox 3 If the overlap component is small, we get Cgs = 2 WLCox (2) 3 The transconductance gm can be expressed as W gm = μn Cox VOV (3) L Cgs Substituting from (2) and (3) into (1), we obtain W μn Cox VOV L fT = 2 2π × WLCox 3 3μn VOV = 4πL2 We note that for a given channel length, fT can be increased by operating the MOSFET at a higher VOV . For L = 0.5 μm and μn = 450 cm2 /V·s, Cgd = WLov Cox = 20 × 0.05 × 4.3 we have = 4.3 fF VOV = 0.2 V ⇒ fT = Csb0 Csb = | VSB | 1+ V0 = 20 1 1+ 0.7 = 12.8 fF Cdb0 Cdb = | VDB | 1+ V0 = 20 = 9.4 fF 2.5 1+ 0.7 gm fT = 2π(Cgs + Cgd ) = 1.3 × 10−3 = 3.1 GHz 2π(61.6 + 4.3) × 10−15 (1) 3 × 450 × 108 × 0.2 4π × 0.52 = 5.73 GHz VOV = 0.4 V ⇒ fT = 3 × 450 × 108 × 0.4 4π × 0.52 = 11.46 GHz 9.15 fT = gm 2π(Cgs + Cgd ) For Cgs Cgd gm fT 2πCgs (1) 2 WLCox + WLov Cox 3 If the overlap component (WLov Cox ) is small, we get Cgs = Cgs 2 WLCox 3 (2) Chapter 9–8 9.17 fT = The transconductance gm is given by W ID gm = 2μn Cox L (3) where IC 0.5 mA = = 20 mA/V VT 0.025 V gm = Substituting from (2) and (3) into (1), we get W ID 2μn Cox L fT = 2 2π × WLCox 3 1.5 μn ID = Q.E.D. πL 2Cox WL gm 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) Cπ = 8 pF Cμ = 1 pF Thus, We observe thatfor a given device, fT is proportional to ID ; thus to obtain faster operation the MOSFET is operated at a higher ID . Also,√we observe that fT is inversely proportional to L WL; thus faster operation is obtained from smaller devices. fT = 20 × 10−3 = 353.7 MHz 2π × (8 + 1) × 10−12 fβ = 353.7 fT = = 3.54 MHz β 100 9.18 See figure below. Cπ = Cde + Cje where Cde is proportional to IC . At IC = 0.5 mA, 8 = Cde + 2 ⇒ Cde = 6 pF 2VA 2VA L 9.16 A0 = = VOV VOV A0 = 2×5×L = 50L, V/V (L in μm) 0.2 fT 3μn VOV 3 × 400 × 108 × 0.2 = 2 4πL 4πL2 fT = 1.91 , GHz (L in μm) L2 1 At IC = 0.25 mA, Cde = × 6 = 3 pF, and 2 Cπ = 3 + 2 = 5 pF. Also, at IC = 0.25 mA, gm = 10 mA/V. Thus fT at IC = 0.25 mA is fT = 9.19 rx = 100 The expressions for A0 and fT can be used to obtain their values for different values of L. The results are given in the following table. L 10 × 10−3 = 265.3 MHz 2π(5 + 1) × 10−12 Lmin 2Lmin 3Lmin 4Lmin 5Lmin 0.13 μm 0.26 μm 0.39 μm 0.52 μm 0.65 μm gm = IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V rπ = β 100 = = 2.5 k gm 40 ro = VA 50 = 50 k = IC 1 A0 (V/V) 6.5 13 19.5 26 32.5 Cde = τF gm = 30 × 10−12 × 40 × 10−3 = 1.2 pF fT (GHz) 113 28.3 12.6 7.1 4.5 Cje0 = 20 pF This figure belongs to Problem 9.18. rx B Cm B' C Vp rp Cp gm Vp E ro Chapter 9–9 Cπ = Cde + 2Cje0 = 1.2 + 2 × 0.02 = 1.24 pF Cje0 VCB m 1+ V0c Cμ = Cμ = |hfe | 40 = 20 = 10.4 fF 2 0.5 1+ 0.75 gm fT = 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) = 9.21 For f fβ , fT f 2000 MHz f ⇒ f = 50 MHz fβ = 40 × 10−3 2π(1.24 + 0.01) × 10−12 fT 2000 MHz = 10 MHz = β0 200 9.22 rx = 5.1 GHz rp 9.20 For f fβ , |hfe | = B' B Cp fT f Cm C, E At f = 50 MHz and IC = 0.2 mA, Zin fT 50 ⇒ fT = 500 MHz |hfe | = 10 = With the emitter and the collector grounded, the equivalent circuit takes the form shown in the figure, and the input impedance becomes At f = 50 MHz and IC = 1.0 mA, fT 50 ⇒ fT = 600 MHz 1 1 + jω(Cπ + Cμ ) rπ rπ = rx + 1 + jω(Cπ + Cμ )rπ |hfe | = 12 = Zin = rx + Now, fT = gm 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) Since ωβ = where rπ ω 1+j ωβ ω 1−j ωβ = rx + rπ 2 ω 1+ ωβ Cπ = Cde + Cje Zin = rx + = τF gm + Cje Cμ = 0.1 pF At IC = 0.2 mA, gm = 500 × 106 = 0.2 = 8 mA/V, thus 0.025 8 × 10−3 2π(Cπ + 0.1) × 10−12 τF × 8 × 10−3 + Cje = 2.45 × 10−12 40 × 10−3 2π(Cπ + 0.1) × 10−12 ⇒ Cπ = 10.51 pF Solving (1) together with (2) yields τF = 252 ps Cje = 0.43 pF 1+ (1) 1 = 40 mA/V, thus At IC = 1 mA, gm = 0.025 τF × 40 × 10−3 + Cje = 10.51 × 10−12 rπ Re (Zin ) = rx + ⇒ Cπ = 2.45 pF 600 × 106 = 1 , then (Cπ + Cμ )rπ (2) ω ωβ 2 For the real part to be an estimate of rx accurate to within 10%, we require rπ 2 ≤ 0.1rx ω 1+ ωβ 1 rx 2 ≤ 0.1 rπ ω 1+ ωβ But rx ≤ rx rπ , thus ≤ 0.1, 10 rπ Chapter 9–10 1 ω ωβ 1+ 9.25 (a) Vo = −AVi 2 ≤ 0.1 × 0.1 If the current flowing through Rsig is denoted Ii , we obtain Ii sC(Vi − Vo ) = Yin = Vi Vi Vo = sC 1 − Vi = sC(1 + A) or, equivalently, 2 ω 1+ ≥ 100 ωβ ⇒ ω ≥ 10ωβ Thus, Cin = C(1 + A) 1/sCin Vi (s) = (b) 1 Vsig (s) Rsig + sCin 1 = 1 + sCin Rsig 9.23 To complete the table below we use the following relationships: re = VT 25 mV = IE IE (mA) gm = IC αIE IE IE (mA) = = VT VT VT 0.025 V A Vo (s) =− Vsig (s) 1 + sCin Rsig β0 , k gm (mA/V) gm fT = 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) rπ = fβ = (c) DC gain = 40 dB = 100 V/V, ⇒ A = 100 V/V 1 f3dB = 2πCin Rsig 1 2π(Cπ + Cμ )rπ 1 2πCin × 1 × 103 ⇒ Cin = 1591.5 pF Cin 1591.5 C= = = 15.8 pF A+1 101 (d) The Bode plot is shown in the figure below. 100 × 103 = fT fβ = β0 9.24 Cin = Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm RL ) = 1 + 0.1(1 + 39) = 5 pF fsdB = = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 5 × 10−12 Rsig For fsdB > 1 MHz, Rsig < 1 = 31.8 k 2π × 5 × 10−12 × 1 × 106 This table belongs to Problem 9.23. Transistor IE (mA) re () gm (mA/V) rπ (k) β0 fT (MHz) Cμ (pF) Cπ (pF) fβ (MHz) (a) 2 12.5 80 12.5 100 500 2 23.5 5 (b) 1 25 40 3.13 125 500 2 10.7 4 (c) 1 25 40 2.5 100 500 2 10.7 5 (d) 10 2.5 400 0.25 100 500 2 125.3 5 (e) 0.1 250 4 25 100 150 2 2.2 1.5 (f) 1 25 40 0.25 10 500 2 10.7 50 (g) 1.25 20 50 0.2 10 800 1 9 80 Chapter 9–11 From the figure we see that the gain reduces to unity two decades higher than f3dB , that is at 10 MHz. 9.26 Refer to Example 9.3. If the transistor is replaced with another whose W is half that of the original transistor, we obtain 1 W 2 = W1 2 Since 2 Cgs = WLCox + WLov Cox 3 then 1 Cgs2 = Cgs1 = 0.5 pF 2 Also, in comparison to fH 1 = 398 MHz 4.7 × gm2 RL2 4.7 + 0.1 | AM 2 | = 4.7 × 0.71 × 7.14 4.8 = 5 V/V = in comparison to | AM 1 | = 7 V/V. GB2 = 5 × 952 = 4.73 GHz in comparison to GB1 = 7 × 398 = 2.79 GHz. 9.27 fH = 1 2πCin Rsig For fH ≥ 6 MHz Cin ≤ 1 1 = 2πfH Rsig 2π × 6 × 106 × 1 × 103 Cgd = WLov Cox Cin ≤ 26.5 pF thus, But, 1 Cgd 1 = 0.2 pF 2 Cgd 2 = Since = 5 + (1 + gm RL ) × 1, pF = 6 + gm RL , pF W 2μn Cox ID L gm = Cin = Cgs + (1 + gm RL )Cgd For Cin ≤ 26.5 pF we have then gm RL ≤ 20.5 1 gm2 = √ gm1 = 0.71 mA/V 2 RL ≤ Since W 1 2 μn Cox VOV 2 L ID = then VOV 2 20.5 = 4.1 k 5 Corresponding to RL = 4.1 k, we have | AM | = gm RL = 20.5 V/V GB = | AM | fH = 20.5 × 6 = 123 MHz √ = 2VOV 1 If fH = 2 MHz, we obtain Finally, Cin = 26.5 × 3 = 79.5 pF ro2 = ro1 = 150 k gm RL = 79.5 − 6 = 73.5 Thus, Thus, RL2 = RL1 = 7.14 k | AM | = 73.5 V/V Thus, GB = 73.5 × 2 = 147 MHz Cin2 = Cgs2 + (gm2 RL2 + 1)Cgd 2 = 0.5 + (0.71 × 7.14 + 1) × 0.2 9.28 AM = − Rin gm RL Rin + Rsig = 1.71 pF where This should be compared to Cin1 = 4.26 pF. Thus, RL = RD RL ro fH 2 = = 1 2πCin2 (Rsig RG ) 1 2π × 1.71 × 10−12 (0.1 4.7) × 106 = 952 MHz = 8 k 10 k 50 k = 4.1 k AM = − 100 × 3 × 4.1 100 + 100 = −6.1 V/V Chapter 9–12 Cin = Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm RL ) (1) = 1 + 0.2(1 + 3 × 4.1) RL = RD RL ro (2) where Rsig = Rsig Rin = 100 k 100 k = 50 k fH = RG gm RL RG + Rsig where = 3.66 pF 1 fH = 2πCin Rsig 9.29 (a) AM = − 1 2π × 3.66 × 10−12 × 50 × 103 = 870 kHz To double fH by changing Rin , Eq. (2) indicates that Rsig must be halved: = 20 k 20 k 100 k = 9.1 k AM = − 2 M × 5 × 9.1 2 M + 0.5 M = −36.4 V/V (b) fH = 1 2πCin Rsig where Cin = Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm RL ) = 3 + 0.5(1 + 5 × 9.1) Rsig = 25 k = 26.25 pF which requires Rin to be changed to Rin2 , and 25 k = 100 Rin2 Rsig = Rsig RG ⇒ Rin2 = 33.3 k = 500 k 2000 k This change will cause | AM | to become | AM 2 | = 33.3 × 3 × 4.1 33.3 + 100 = 3.1 V/V which is about half the original value. To double fH by changing RL , Eq. (2) indicates that Cin must be halved: Cin2 = 1 × 3.66 = 1.83 pF 2 Using Eq. (1), we obtain 1.83 = 1 + 0.2(1 + gm RL2 ) ⇒ gm RL2 = 3.15 Thus, RL2 = 1.05 k and RL2 can be found from 1.05 = RL 8 k 50 k = 400 k Thus, fH = 1 2π × 26.25 × 10−12 × 400 × 103 = 15.2 kHz gm (c) fZ = 2πCgd = 5 × 10−3 2π × 0.5 × 10−12 = 1.6 GHz 9.30 gm = 2μn Cox (W/L)1 ID1 √ = 2 × 0.09 × 100 × 0.1 = 1.34 mA/V | VA1 | 12.8 = 128 k = ro1 = ID1 0.1 ro2 = | VA2 | 19.2 = = 192 k ID2 0.1 ⇒ RL = 1.24 k The total resistance at the output node, RL , is given by and the midband gain becomes RL = ro1 ro2 = 128 k 192 k | AM 2 | = 100 × 3.15 = 1.6 V/V 100 + 100 which is about a quarter of the original gain. Clearly, changing Rin is the preferred course of action! = 76.8 k AM = −gm1 RL = −1.34 × 76.8 = −103 V/V fH = 1 2πCin Rsig Chapter 9–13 where fH = Cin = Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm1 RL ) = 0.2 + 0.015(1 + 103) = 1.76 pF Thus, 1 2π × 1.76 × 10−12 × 200 × 103 = 452 kHz gm 1.34 × 10−3 = fZ = 2πCgd 2π × 0.015 × 10−12 fH = = 14.2 GHz 9.31 gm RL = 50 Cin = Cπ + Cμ (1 + gm RL ) = 10 + 1(1 + 50) fH = = 395 kHz 9.33 (a) AM = RB rπ − gm RL RB + Rsig rπ + rx + (Rsig RB ) For RB Rsig , rx AM − 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 61 × 10−12 × 5 × 103 = 522 kHz = Rsig , Rsig rπ , rπ gm RL = −βRL /Rsig Rsig Q.E.D. (b) Cin = Cπ + (gm RL + 1)Cμ For gm RL 1 and gm RL Cμ Cπ , Cin gm RL Cμ fH = = 61 pF 1 2π × 201.4 × 10−12 × 2 × 103 1 2πCin Rsig where Rsig = rπ [rx + (RB Rsig )] rπ Rsig rπ Thus, 9.32 AM = − RB rπ gm RL RB + Rsig rπ + rx + (Rsig RB ) fH 1 2πgm RL Cμ rπ fH = 1 2πCμ βRL where RL = ro RC RL = 100 k 10 k 10 k = 4.76 k (c) GB = | AM | fH =β and rπ = β/gm = 100/40 = 2.5 k AM = − 2.5 100 × 100 + 10 2.5 + 0.1 + (10 100) × 40 × 4.76 Q.E.D. RL 1 1 = Rsig 2πCμ βRL 2πCμ Rsig For Rsig = 25 k and Cμ = 1 pF, GB = 1 2π × 1 × 10−12 × 25 × 103 = −37 V/V 1 fH = 2πCin Rsig For IC = 1 mA and β = 100, where AM = −100 × = 201.4 pF and Rsig = rπ [rx + (RB Rsig )] fH = 25 = −100 V/V 25 6.37 MHz GB = = 63.7 kHz | AM | 100 V/V (ii) RL = 2.5 k: AM = −100 × = 2.5 [0.1 + (100 10)] = 2 k = 6.37 MHz (i) RL = 25 k: Cin = Cπ + Cμ (1 + gm RL ) = 10 + 1 × (1 + 40 × 4.76) Q.E.D. fH = 2.5 = −10 V/V 25 6.37 MHz GB = = 637 kHz | AM | 10 V/V Chapter 9–14 1.25 50 × × 170 50 + 5 1.25 + 0.05 + (50 5) = −33 V/V AM = − and 20 log| AM | = 30.4 dB This should be compared to the previous value of 39 V/V (32 dB). To determine fH , we first find Cin , Cin = Cπ + Cμ (1 + gm RL ) = 15 + 1(1 + 170) The Bode plots are shown in the figure. = 186 pF If the midband gain is unity, and the effective source resistance Rsig , fH = GB = 6.37 MHz This is obtained when RL is R 1 = 100 × L 25 ⇒ RL = 0.25 k = 250 Rsig = rπ [rx + (RB Rsig )] = 1.25 [0.05 + (50 5)] = 0.98 k Thus fH = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 186 × 10−12 × 0.98 × 103 = 873 kHz = 9.34 Refer to Example 9.4. Since IE is doubled to 2 mA, we have IC 2 mA = 80 mA/V gm = = VT 25 mV rπ = β 100 = 1.25 k = gm 80 mA/V ro = VA 100 V = 50 k = IC 2 mA Cπ + Cμ = gm 80 × 10−3 = = 16 pF ωT 2π × 800 × 106 Cμ = 1 pF Cπ = 15 pF This should be compared to the previous value of 754 kHz. The gain-bandwidth product becomes GB = | AM | fH = 33 × 873 = 28.8 MHz This should be compared to the previous value of 39 × 754 = 29.4 MHz. Thus, increasing the bias current by a factor of 2 results in an increase in fH by a factor of 1.16—that is, by about 16%. However, because of the attendant reduction in input resistance, the overall gain decreased by about the same factor and GB remained nearly constant. The price paid for the slight increase in fH is an increase in power dissipation by a factor of about two. rx = 50 Also, now 9.35 Rin = RB = 50 k = RC = 4 k The new value of AM is AM = − RB rπ (gm RL ) RB + Rsig rπ + rx + (RB Rsig ) where RL = ro RC RL = 50 4 5 = 2.13 k Thus, gm RL = 80 × 2.13 = 170 V/V and R 1−K 100 k = 1000 k = 1 M 1 − 0.9 9.36 Using Miller’s theorem, we obtain Z Z , Zout = Zin = 1 1−A 1− A For 1 Z= jωC 1 ⇒ Cin = C(1 − A) Zin = jωC(1 − A) 1 1 ⇒ Cout = C 1 − Zout = 1 A jωC 1 − A Chapter 9–15 (a) A = −1000 V/V, C = 1 pF The first figure below (left) shows that Cin = 1(1 + 1000) = 1001 pF 1 = 1.001 pF Cout = 1 1 + 1000 Vo = AVi (1) From Miller’s theorem, we have Rin = (b) A = −10 V/V, C = 10 pF Cin = 10(1 + 10) = 110 pF 1 = 11 pF Cout = 10 1 + 10 R2 R2 R2 = = Vo Vo 1+A 1+ 1− Vi −Vi (2) Using the voltage divider rule at the input, we get −Vi = Vsig (c) A = −1 V/V, C = 10 pF Cin = 10(1 + 1) = 20 pF Rin Rin + R1 ⇒ Vi = −Vsig Cout = 10(1 + 1) = 20 pF Rin Rin + R1 (3) For each value of A we use Eq. (2) to determine Rin , Eq. (3) to determine Vi (for Vsig = 1 V), Eq. (1) to determine Vo , and finally we calculate the value of Vo /Vsig . The results are given in the table below. (d) A = +1 V/V, C = 10 pF Cin = C(1 − 1) = 0 Cout = C(1 − 1) = 0 (e) A = +10 V/V, C = 10 pF Cin = 10(1 − 10) = −90 pF 1 = 9 pF Cout = 10 1 − 10 The −90 pF input capacitance can be used to cancel an equal (+90 pF) capacitance between the input node and ground. Vo (V) Vo /Vsig (V/V) A (V/V) Rin (k) Vi (V) 10 9.091 × 10−1 −0.476 −4.76 −4.76 100 9.901 × 10−2 −0.0901 −9.01 −9.01 1000 9.990 × 10−3 −9.89 × 10−3 −9.89 −9.89 10,000 9.999 × 10−4 −9.989 × 10−4 −9.99 −9.99 9.37 Ii R 10 k 2 R1 1 k Ii Vi Vsig Rin 9.38 0 (a) Refer to Fig. 1. A Vi − 2Vi Vi Vi − Vo = =− R R R Ii = Thus, Vo Vi Ii Rin ≡ Vi = −R Ii This figure belongs to Problem 9.38. Ii Rsig IL Vsig 0 ZL 2 Vo Vi Rin Figure 1 (ViVo)/R R Chapter 9–16 (b) Replacing the signal source with its equivalent Norton’s form results in the circuit in Fig. 2. Observe that Req = ∞ when Rsig = R. In this case, IL = Vsig Vsig = Rsig R (a) For the dc analysis, refer to the figure. VCC = IE RC + IB RB + VBE 1.5 = IE × 1 + ⇒ IE = IE × 47 + 0.7 β +1 1.5 − 0.7 = 0.546 mA 47 1+ 101 IC = αIE = 0.99 × 0.546 = 0.54 mA (b) gm = rπ = (c) IC 0.54 mA = = 21.6 mA/V VT 0.025 V β 200 = 4.63 k = gm 21.6 Vo = −gm (RC RL ) Vb = −21.6(1 1) = −10.8 V/V Figure 2 (c) If ZL = (d) Using Miller’s theorem, the component of Rin due to RB can be found as 1 , sC Rin1 = Vi = IL ZL RB 1 − (Vo /Vb ) 47 k = 4 k 1 − (−10.8) Vsig 1 × R sC 1 Vsig = sCR and = 2 Vsig Vo = 2Vi = sCR Thus, (e) Gv = = Rin = Rin1 rπ = 4 4.63 = 2.14 k Rin Vo × Rin + Rsig Vb 2.14 × −10.8 = −7.4 V/V 2.14 + 1 Vo Cμ (f) Cin = Cπ + 1 + Vb = 2 Vo = Vsig sCR which is the transfer function of an ideal noninverting integrator. where Cπ + Cμ = 9.39 gm 21.6 × 10−3 = 2πfT 2π × 600 × 106 Cπ + Cμ = 5.73 pF VCC 1.5 V Cπ = 5.73 − 0.8 = 4.93 pF Cin = 4.93 + (1 + 10.8) × 0.8 IE RC (g) Rsig = Rin Rsig RB IB IC = 2.14 k 1 k = 0.68 k fH = VBE = 14.37 pF IE = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 14.37 × 10−12 × 0.68 × 103 = 16.3 MHz Chapter 9–17 9.40 B Vp B C Cm rp Cp gm Vp re Cp E E Zi (s) Zi (s) From the figure we see that the controlled current-source gm Vπ appears across its control voltage Vπ , thus we can replace the current source with a resistance 1/gm . Now, the parallel equivalent of rπ and 1/gm is rπ rπ rπ (1/gm ) = re = = 1 gm rπ + 1 β +1 rπ + gm Thus, the equivalent circuit simplifies to that of re in parallel with Cπ , 1 Zi (s) = re = 1 + sCπ re 1 + sCπ re re Zi (jω) = 1 + jωCπ re Again, gm fT 1 4πCπ re It follows that in this case, f45◦ = 1 fT = 200 MHz 2 9.41 AM = −gm RL = −4 × 20 = −80 V/V 1 fsdB = fH = 2π(CL + Cgd )RL = 1 2π(2 + 0.1) × 10−12 × 20 × 103 Zi (jω) will have a 45◦ phase at = 3.8 MHz ω45 Cπ re = 1 fZ = ⇒ ω45 = 1 Cπ re Now, fT = gm 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) At high bias currents, Cπ Cμ and fT gm 2πCπ Since gm 1/re , we have fT 1 2πCπ re Thus, f45◦ fT = 400 MHz If the bias current is reduced to the value that results in Cπ Cμ , fT = gm gm = 2π × 2Cπ 4πCπ 1 , thus re gm 4 × 10−3 = = 6.4 GHz 2πCgd 2π × 0.1 × 10−12 ft = | AM | fH = 80 × 3.8 = 304 MHz 9.42 ft = CL + Cgd gm 2π(CL + Cgd ) gm = 2πft 2 × 10−3 = 0.159 pF 2π × 2 × 109 To reduce ft to 1 GHz, an additional capacitance of 0.159 pF must be connected to the output node. (Doubling the effective capacitance at the output node reduces ft by a factor of 2.) = 9.43 Refer to Fig. P9.43. To determine gm1 we use W gm1 = 2μn Cox ID1 L 1 100 × 0.1 = 2 × 0.090 × 1.6 = 1.06 mA/V Chapter 9–18 ro1 = VA1 12.8 = 128 k = ID1 0.1 | VA2 | 19.2 = = 192 k ro2 = ID2 0.1 RL = ro1 ro2 = 128 192 = 76.8 k AM = −gm1 RL = −1.06 × 76.8 = −81.4 V/V CL = Cdb1 + Cdb2 + Cgd 2 = 20 + 36 + 15 = 71 fF fH = fH = 1 2π(CL + Cgd 1 )RL 1 2π(71 + 15) × 10−15 × 76.8 × 103 Cin = 5.37 + (10.7 + 1) × 1 = 17.07 pF Rsig = rπ rx = 1.5 k 0.1 k = 0.094 k 1 fH = 2πCin Rsig = 1 2π × 17.07 × 10−12 × 0.094 × 103 = 99.2 MHz (b) If | AM | is reduced to 1, we obtain 1= 1.5 × gm RL 1.6 ⇒ gm RL = 1.07 = 24.1 MHz Cin = Cπ + (gm RL + 1)Cμ gm1 1.06 × 10−3 = fZ = 2πCgd 1 2π × 0.015 × 10−12 = 5.37 + (1.07 + 1) × 1 = 11.2 GHz = 7.44 pF fH = 9.44 The equivalent circuit is shown in the figure. IC 2 mA gm = = 80 mA/V = VT 0.025 V β 120 = = 1.5 k rπ = gm 80 (a) AM = − −10 = − rπ gm RL rπ + rx 1.5 × gm RL 1.5 + 0.1 ⇒ gm RL = 10.7 V/V RL = 0.133 k gm Cπ + Cμ = 2πfT = −3 80 × 10 = 6.37 pF 2π × 2 × 109 Cπ = 6.37 − 1 = 5.37 pF Cin = Cπ + (gm RL + 1)Cμ This figure belongs to Problem 9.44. 1 2π × 7.44 × 10−12 × 0.094 × 103 = 227.6 MHz 9.45 Figure 1 (next page) shows the amplifier high-frequency equivalent circuit. A node equation at the output provides 1 + sCL Vo + gm Vπ + sCμ (Vo − Vπ ) = 0 ro Replacing Vπ by Vi and collecting terms results in 1 + s(CL + Cμ ) = −Vi (gm − sCμ ) Vo ro ⇒ 1 − s(Cμ /gm ) Vo = −gm ro Vi 1 + s(CL + Cμ )ro Q.E.D. For IC = 200 μA = 0.2 mA and VA = 100 V, gm = IC 0.2 mA = 8 mA/V = VT 0.025 V ro = VA 100 = = 500 k IC 0.2 Chapter 9–19 This figure belongs to Problem 9.45. Cm Vi rp Vp Cp gmVp ro Vo CL Figure 1 DC gain = −gm ro = 8 × 500 = −4000 V/V f3dB = = 1 2π(CL + Cμ )ro 1 2π(1 + 0.2) × 10−12 × 500 × 103 Gain (dB) 50 40 20 dB/decade 30 = 265.3 kHz gm fZ = 2πCμ = The Bode plot is shown in the figure. 20 40 dB/decade 10 8 × 10−3 = 6.37 GHz 2π × 0.2 × 10−12 ft = | Adc | f3dB 0 2 10 20 200 f (MHz) 20 dB/decade 20 30 = 4000 × 265.3 = 1.06 GHz The Bode plot is shown in Figure 2. 9.47 (a) A(s) = 1000 1 1 + s/(2π × 105 ) (b) |A|, dB 60 3 dB 40 20 dB/decade 20 f 0 10 kHz 100 kHz 1 MHz 10 MHz 100 MHz Figure 2 0 5.7° 10 kHz 100 kHz 1 MHz 45° 9.46 AM = 40 dB ⇒ 100 V/V 90° 5.7° A(s) = 100 1 + s/(2π × 200 × 106 ) s s 1+ 1 + 2π × 2 × 106 2π × 20 × 106 Since fP1 fP2 fZ , we have f3dB fP1 = 2 MHz Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the Bode plot for the gain magnitude and phase. f Chapter 9–20 (c) GB = 1000 × 100 kHz = 100 MHz (d) The unity-gain frequency ft is ft = 100 MHz s 1+ 4 10 s s 1+ 3 1+ 5 10 10 9.49 A(s) = −10 3 (a) ωH 103 rad/s (e) (b) ωH = 1 1 1 + 10 106 10 − 2 108 = 1010 Hz If the frequency of the finite zero is lowered to 103 rad/s the zero will cancel the pole at 103 rad/s and the transfer function becomes 1 A(s) = −103 s 1+ 5 10 The 3-dB frequency now becomes ω3dB = 105 rad/s Figure 2 Figure 2 shows the magnitude response when a second pole at 1 MHz appears in the transfer function. The unity-gain frequency ft now is ft = 10 MHz 9.50 If at ω = 107 rad/s the excess phase due to the 3 coincident poles (at frequency ωP ) is 30◦ , then each pole is contributing 10◦ . Thus, 107 = 10◦ ωP tan−1 107 = 5.67 × 107 rad/s tan 10◦ ωP = which is different from the gain-bandwidth product, 9.51 τH = Cgs Rgs + Cgd Rgd + CL RCL GB = 100 MHz where 9.48 Using the dominant-pole approximation, ωH ωP1 1 1 1 + 2 2 ωP1 ωP2 ωP1 = ωP1 2 1+ ωP2 (a) For a difference of 10%, ωP1 = 0.9ωP1 ωP1 2 1+ ωP2 ⇒ ωP2 = 4.26 ωP1 (b) For a difference of 1%, ωP1 = 0.99ωP1 ωP1 2 1+ ωP2 ⇒ Rgs = Rsig = 10 k Cgd = 5 fF Using the root-sum-of-squares formula, we get ωH Cgs = 30 fF ωP2 = 49.3 ωP1 Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL = 10(1 + 2 × 20) + 20 = 430 k CL = 30 fF RCL = RL = 20 k Thus, τH = 30 × 10 + 5 × 430 + 30 × 20 = 3050 ps fH = = 1 2πτH 1 2π × 3050 × 10−12 = 52.2 MHz fZ = gm 2 × 10−3 = = 63.7 GHz 2πCgd 2π × 5 × 10−15 Chapter 9–21 9.52 AM = −gm RL Thus, = −4 × 20 = −80 V/V fP1 = Cin = Cgs + Cgd (gm RL + 1) 1 2πCeq1 Req1 = 10.1 pF 1 2π × 20 × 10−12 × 5 × 103 = 1.59 MHz Using the Miller approximation, we obtain At node 2: 1 fH 2πCin Rsig Req2 = Ro1 Rin2 = 2 k 10 k fP1 = = 2 + 0.1(80 + 1) = = 1.67 k 1 2π × 10.1 × 10−12 × 20 × 103 Ceq2 = Co1 + Cin2 = 788 kHz = 2 + 10 = 12 pF Using the open-circuit time constants, we get fP2 = τgs = Cgs Rgs = Cgs Rsig = 2 × 20 = 40 ns = Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL 1 2πCeq2 Req2 1 2π × 12 × 10−12 × 1.67 × 103 = 7.94 MHz = 20(1 + 80) + 20 = 1640 k τgd = Cgd Rgd = 0.1 × 1640 = 164 ns At node 3: τCL = CL RL Req3 = Ro2 RL = 2 k 1 k = 0.67 k = 2 × 20 = 40 ns Ceq3 = Co2 + CL = 2 + 7 = 9 pF τH = τgs + τgd + τCL (1) = 40 + 164 + 40 = 244 ns 1 fH = 2πτH = 1 = 652 kHz 2π × 244 × 10−9 The estimate obtained using the open-circuit time constants is more appropriate as it takes into account the effect of CL . We note from Eq. (1) that τCL is 16.4% of τH , thus CL has a significant effect on the determination of fH . 9.53 The figure shows the equivalent circuit of the two-stage amplifier where we have modeled each stage as a transconductance amplifier. At node 1: Req1 = Rsig Rin1 = 10 k 10 k = 5 k Ceq1 = Cin1 + Csig = 10 + 10 = 20 pF This figure belongs to Problem 9.53. fP3 = 1 2πCeq3 Req3 1 2π × 9 × 10−12 × 0.67 × 103 = 26.4 MHz fP3 = Thus, the three poles have frequencies 1.59 MHz, 7.94 MHz, and 26.4 MHz. Since the frequency of the second pole is more than two octaves higher than that of the first pole, the 3-dB frequency will be mostly determined by fP1 , f3dB fP1 = 1.59 MHz A slightly better estimate of f3dB can be determined using the root-sum-of-squares formula, 2 2 2 1 1 1 + + f3dB = 1/ fP1 fP2 fP3 1 1 1 = 1/ + + 1.592 7.942 26.42 = 1.56 MHz Chapter 9–22 9.54 τgs = Cgs Rgs = Cgs Rsig Thus, the original CL of 25 fF must be increased by = 5 × 10 = 50 ns 66.6 − 25 = 41.6 fF Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL = 10(1 + 5 × 10) + 10 = 520 k 9.56 We will assume that the value given in the problem statement is for Rsig (not Rsig ): τgd = Cgd Rgd = 1 × 520 = 520 ns Rsig = 5 k RCL = CL RL rπ = = 5 × 10 = 50 ns Rsig = rπ Rsig = 5 k 5 k τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = 50 + 520 + 50 = 620 ns 1 fH = 2πτH = β 100 = = 5 k gm 20 = 2.5 k (1) 1 = 257 kHz 2π × 620 × 10−9 τH = Cπ Rπ = Cπ Rsig = 10 × 2.5 = 25 ns τμ = Cμ Rμ = Cμ [Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL ] The interaction of Rsig with the input capacitance contributes all of τgs (50 ns) and a significant part of τgd , namely = 1 × [2.5(1 + 20 × 5) + 5] Cgd [Rsig (1 + gm RL )] = 1 × 10(1 + 50) = 510 ns τCL = CL RL Thus, the total contribution of Rsig is = 10 × 5 = 50 ns 50 + 510 = 560 ns 560 which is = 90.3% of τH . To double fH , we 620 must reduce τH to half of its value: τH = τπ + τμ + τCL τH = 1 × 620 = 310 ns 2 Now, τH = Rsig [Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm RL )] + Cgd RL + CL RL = 257.5 ns = 25 + 257.5 + 50 = 332.5 ns 1 1 = = 479 kHz fH = 2πτH 2π × 332.5 × 10−9 rπ gm RL AM = − rπ + Rsig 5 × 20 × 5 5+5 = −50 V/V =− 310 = Rsig [5 + 1(1 + 50)] + 1 × 10 + 5 × 10 ⇒ Rsig = 4.46 k 9.55 To lower fH from 135.5 MHz (see Example 9.8) to 100 MHz, τH must be increased to τH = 1 1 = 2πfH 2π × 100 × 106 9.57 Refer to Fig. 9.19(a). Since RB is not specified, we assume that its value is very large. rπ AM = − gm RL rπ + rx + Rsig where rπ = β 100 = 2.5 k = gm 40 = 1591.5 ps Thus, Now, AM = − τH = τgs + τgd + τCL 2.5 × 40 × 5 2.5 + 0.1 + 1 = −138.9 V/V 1591.5 = 200 + 725 + τCL Using the Miller approximation, we obtain ⇒ τCL = 666.5 Cin = Cπ + Cμ (1 + gm RL ) But, = 10 + 0.3(1 + 40 × 5) τCL = CL RL = 70.3 pF 665.5 = CL × 10 Rsig = rπ (rx + Rsig ) ⇒ CL = 66.6 fF = 2.5 (0.1 + 1) = 0.76 k Chapter 9–23 fH = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 = 2π × 70.3 × 10−12 × 0.76 × 103 = 2.98 MHz (c) CL = 50 pF τCL = CL RL = 50 × 7.5 = 375 ns τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = 20 + 246.5 + 375 τπ = Cπ Rπ = Cπ Rsig = 641.5 ns 1 fH = 2πτH = 10 × 0.76 = 7.6 ns = Using the open-circuit time constants, we get τμ = Cμ [Rsig (gm RL + 1) + RL ] = 0.3[0.76(40 × 5 + 1) + 5] = 47.3 ns τCL = CL RL = 3 × 5 = 15 ns τH = τπ + τμ + τCL = 7.6 + 47.3 + 15 = 69.9 ns 1 fH = 2πτH 1 = = 2.28 MHz 2π × 69.9 × 10−9 This is a more realistic estimate of fH as it takes into account the effect of CL . 9.58 RL = ro RL = 20 k 12 k = 7.5 k 1 = 248 kHz 2π × 641.5 × 10−9 Using the Miller approximation, since CL is not taken into account, then for all three cases we obtain Cin = Cgs + Cgd (gm RL + 1) = 0.2 + 0.2(1.5 × 7.5 + 1) = 2.65 pF fH = = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 2π × 2.65 × 10−12 × 100 × 103 = 600 kHz which is very close to the estimate obtained using the method of open-circuit time constants for the case CL = 0. However, as CL is increased, the estimate obtained using the Miller approximation becomes less and less realistic, which is due to the fact that it does not take CL into account. τgs = Cgs Rgs = Cgs Rsig = 0.2 × 100 = 20 ns 9.59 Refer to Fig. 9.26(c). = 0.2[100(1.5 × 7.5 + 1) + 7.5] Vo 1/gm = gm RL 1 Vsig + Rsig gm = 246.5 ns = τgd = Cgd [Rsig (gm RL + 1) + RL ] (a) CL = 0 1/5 × 5 × 10 1 +1 5 τCL = 0 = 8.3 V/V τH = τgs + τgd = 20 + 246.5 = 266.5 ns fP1 = fH = = 239 MHz = 20 + 246.5 + 75 = 341.5 ns fP2 = = 1 = 466 kHz 2π × 341.5 × 10−9 2π × 4 × 10−12 1 τH = τgs + τgd + τCL 1 2πτH 1 gm 1 fP1 = τCL = CL RL = 10 × 7.5 = 75 ns fH = 1 2πCgs Rsig 1 = 597 kHz 2π × 266.5 × 10−9 (b) CL = 10 pF = 1 5 × 103 1 2π(CL + Cgd )RL 1 2π(2 + 0.2) × 10−12 × 10 × 103 = 7.23 MHz Chapter 9–24 This figure belongs to Problem 9.60. Rsig E Vo C Vsig re RL Cp Vp (CLCm) gmVp B Since fP1 fP2 , fP2 will be dominant and τgs = Cgs (Rin Rsig ) fH fP2 = 7.23 MHz τgs = 0.2(1.32 50) = 0.26 ns 9.60 See figure above. Replacing the BJT with its high-frequency T model while neglecting ro and rx results in the equivalent circuit shown in the figure. (a) There are two separate poles, one at the input given by fP1 1 = 2πCπ (Rsig re ) 1 2π(CL + Cμ )RL = 100 7650 = 98.7 k τgd = (Cgd + CL + Cdb )Rgd = (0.015 + 0.03 + 0.02) × 98.7 = 6.42 ns and the other at the output, given by fP2 = Rgd = RL Ro τH = τgs + τgd = 0.26 + 6.42 = 6.68 ns Q.E.D. fH = (b) IC = 1 mA, gm = IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V re 1 = 25 gm fP1 1 = −12 2π × 10 × 10 (1 0.025) × 103 = 652.5 MHz fP2 = 1 2π(1 + 1) × 10−12 × 10 × 103 = 7.96 MHz Since fP2 fP1 , fP2 will be dominant and fH fP2 = 7.96 MHz 9.61 ro = VA 10 = = 100 k ID 0.1 Rsig = ro /2 = 50 k RL = ro = 100 k gm ro = 1.5 × 100 = 150 Rin = ro + RL 100 + 100 = 1.32 k = 1 + gm ro 1 + 150 = 1 2πτH 1 = 23.8 MHz 2π × 6.68 × 10−9 9.62 Refer to Example 9.9. To reduce fH to 200 MHz, τH must become τH = 1 1 = 2πfH 2π × 200 × 106 = 795.8 ps Since τgs remains constant at 26.6 ps, τCL must be increased to τCL = 795.8 − 26.6 = 769.2 ps But, τCL = (Cgd + CL )Rgd thus, 769.2 = (5 + CL ) × 18.7 ⇒ CL + 5 = 41.1 fF CL = 36.1 fF Ro = Rsig + ro + gm ro Rsig Thus, the amount of additional capacitance to be connected at the output is = 50 + 100 + 150 × 50 = 7650 k 36.1 − 25 = 11.1 fF Chapter 9–25 9.63 Ro = ro2 + ro1 + (gm2 ro2 )ro1 fH = = 2ro + gm ro2 1 2πτH 1 = 737 kHz 2π × 216 × 10−9 = 2 × 20 + 2 × 20 × 20 = 840 k = Av = −gm1 (Ro RL ) GB ≡ | AM | fH = 40 × 737 = 29.5 MHz = −2(840 1000) (b) AM = −gm1 (Ro RL ) = −913 V/V where Using Eq. (9.109), we obtain Ro = ro1 + ro2 + gm2 ro2 ro1 τH = Rsig [Cgs1 + Cgd 1 (1 + gm1 Rd 1 )] = 2ro + gm ro2 + Rd 1 (Cgd 1 + Cdb1 + Cgs2 ) = 2 × 20 + 4 × 20 × 20 = 1640 k + (RL Ro )(CL + Cgd 2 ) AM = −4(1640 20) = −79 V/V where Rin2 = Rd 1 = ro1 Rin2 Rin2 ro2 + RL = 1 + gm2 ro2 = ro2 + RL 1 + gm2 ro2 20 + 20 0.49 k 1 + 4 × 20 Rd 1 = ro1 Rin2 = 20 0.49 = 0.48 k 20 + 1000 = 24.9 k = 1 + 2 × 20 Using Eq. (9.109), we obtain Rd 1 = 20 24.9 = 11.1 k τH = Rsig [Cgs1 + Cgd 1 (1 + gm1 Rd 1 )] + Rd 1 (Cgd 1 + Cdb1 + Cgs2 ) Thus, + (RL Ro )(CL + Cgd 2 ) τH = 100[20 + 5(1 + 2 × 11.1)] + 11.1(5 + 5 + 20) = 20[2 + 0.2(1 + 4 × 0.48)] + 0.48(0.2 + 0.2 + 2) + (1000 840)(20 + 5) + (20 1640)(1 + 0.2) = 13587 + 333 + 11413 = 25, 333 ps = 25.33 ns fH = 1 = 6.28 MHz 2π × 25.33 × 10−9 9.64 (a) AM = −gm RL τH = 51.7 + 1.15 + 23.7 = 76.6 ns fH = 1 = 2.08 MHz 2π × 76.6 × 10−9 GB ≡ | AM | fH = 79 × 2.08 = 164 MHz Note the increase in bandwidth and in GB. where RL = RL ro = 20 20 = 10 k 9.65 20 log | AM | = 74 dB Thus, ⇒ | AM | = 5000 AM = −4 × 10 = −40 V/V Ro (gm ro )ro τgs = Cgs Rgs RL = Ro = Cgs Rsig = 2 × 20 = 40 ns | AM | = gm (RL Ro ) Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL 5000 = = 20(1 + 4 × 10) + 10 = 830 k τgd = Cgd Rgd = 0.2 × 830 = 166 ns τCL = CL RL = 1 × 10 = 10 ns τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = 40 + 166 + 10 = 216 ns 1 gm Ro 2 1 (gm ro )2 2 ⇒ gm ro = 100 = 2VA = 100 VOV ⇒ VOV = 2 × 10 = 0.2 V 100 Chapter 9–26 1 W 2 μn Cox VOV 2 L ID = Cgd = 5 fF and VA = 10 V in Eqs. (1)–(6), we obtain the following results in the table below. 1 × 0.2 × 50 × 0.22 2 = 0.2 mA gm ft = 2π(CL + Cgd ) = 9.67 (a) For the CS amplifier, | AM | = gm (ro ro ) = fH = where gm = 2ID 2 × 0.2 = 2 mA/V = VOV 0.2 = 2 × 10−3 2π(1 + 0.1) × 10−12 ft = 1 2πCin Rsig 1 1 2π Cgs + Cgd gm ro + 1 Rsig 2 (1) For the cascode amplifier, = 289.4 MHz f3dB 1 gm ro 2 | AM | = gm (Ro ro ) 289.4 ft = = 57.9 kHz = | AM | 5000 = gm [(gm ro )ro ro ] gm ro If the cascode transistor is removed, Thus, the gain increases by a factor of 2. AM = −gm (ro RL ) fH = −gm ro = −100 V/V 1 2πCin Rsig where 9.66 (a) From Fig. 9.29, we have gm ft = 2π(CL + Cgd ) √ 2μn Cox (W/L) = ID Q.E.D. 2π(CL + Cgd ) (b) gm = 2μn Cox (W/L) ID (2) Rd 1 = ro VOV = (3) = ro Cin = Cgs + Cgd (1 + gm Rd 1 ) Rd 1 = ro Rin2 ID 1 μn Cox (W/L) 2 VA ID (4) Ro = (gm ro )ro (5) ro = = ro (1) RL + ro gm ro ro + ro gm ro 2 2 gm gm 2 Cin = Cgs + Cgd 1 + gm × gm = Cgs + 3Cgd 1 2π(Cgs + 3Cgd )Rsig AM = −gm (Ro RL ) fH = = −gm (Ro Ro ) From (1) and (2), the ratio N of fH of the cascode amplifier to fH of the CS amplifier is 1 gm ro + 1 Cgs + Cgd 2 N= Cgs + 3Cgd 1 = − gm Ro 2 Substituting (6) μn Cox = 0.4 mA/V2 , W/L = 20, CL = 20 fF, (2) This table belongs to Problem 9.66, part (b). ID (mA) ft (GHz) VOV (V) gm (mA/V) ro (k) Ro (M) AM (V/V) fH (MHz) 0.1 8 0.16 1.26 100 12.6 −7938 1 0.2 11.5 0.22 1.80 50 4.5 −4050 2.8 0.5 18 0.35 2.83 20 1.13 −1600 11.3 Chapter 9–27 Thus, Ro = β2 ro2 = 100 × 100 = 10,000 k 1 Cgs + (gm ro )Cgd 2 N Cgs + 3Cgd τH = Cπ1 Rπ1 + Cμ1 Rμ1 + (Ccs1 + Cπ2 )Rc1 Q.E.D. 1 gm ro 2 ⇒ gm ro = 100 (b) 50 = 1 Cgs + × 100 × 0.1Cgs 2 N= Cgs + 3 × 0.1Cgs 1+5 = = 4.6 1 + 0.3 (c) gm ro = 100 = 2VA VOV 2 × 10 VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.2 V 1 W 2 VOV ID = μn Cox 2 L 1 × 0.4 × 10 × 0.22 2 = 0.08 mA = 80 μA = 9.68 Refer to Fig. 9.30. gm = IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V β 100 = = 2.5 k rπ = gm 40 rπ gm (βro RL ) AM = − rπ + rx + Rsig =− 2.5 40(100 × 100 2) 2.5 + 0.05 + 5 + (CL + Ccs2 + Cμ2 )(RL Ro ) = 10 × 1.67 + 2 × 3.4 + (0 + 10) × 0.0255 + (0 + 0 + 2)(2 10,000) = 16.7 + 6.8 + 0.255 + 4 = 27.8 ns fH = 1 1 = 2πτH 2π × 27.8 × 10−9 = 5.7 MHz 9.69 (a) Gain from base to collector of Q1 = −1. Thus, Cin = Cπ1 + Cμ1 (1 + 1) = Cπ1 + 2Cμ1 fP1 = = 1 2πRsig Cin 1 2πRsig (Cπ1 + 2Cμ ) Q.E.D. At the output node, the total capacitance is (CL + Cc2 + Cμ2 ) and since ro is large, Ro will be very large, thus the total resistance will be RL . Thus the pole introduced at the output node will have a frequency fP2 , fP2 = 1 2π(CL + Cc2 + Cμ2 )RL Q.E.D. (b) I = 1 mA 1 mA = 40 mA/V 0.025 V β 100 = 2.5 k = rπ = gm 40 gm = −26.5 (V/V) (i) Rsig = 1 k Rsig = rπ (rx + Rsig ) Rsig = rπ Rsig = 2.5 1 = 0.71 k = 2.5 (0.05 + 5) = 1.67 k fP1 = Rπ 1 = Rsig = 1.67 k ro2 + RL Rc1 = ro1 re2 ro2 + RL /(β2 + 1) ⎤ ⎡ 100 + 2 ⎥ ⎢ = 100 ⎣0.025 2 ⎦ 100 + 101 = 25.5 Rμ1 = Rsig (1 + gm1 Rc1 ) + Rc1 1 2π × 0.71 × 103 (10 + 2 × 2) × 10−12 = 16 MHz fP2 = 1 2π(0 + 0 + 2) × 10−12 × 2 × 103 40 MHz fH = 1 =1 1 1 + 2 fp12 fp2 1 1 + 2 = 14.9 MHz 2 16 40 = 1.67(1 + 40 × 0.0255) + 0.0255 (ii) Rsig = 10 k = 3.4 k Rsig = rπ Rsig = 2.5 10 = 2 k Chapter 9–28 fP1 = 1 2π × 2 × 103 (10 + 4) × 10−12 To determine Cπ , we use gm 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) = 5.7 MHz fT = fP2 = 40 MHz 1 1 + 2 = 5.6 MHz fH = 1 5.72 40 1 × 109 = τH = 0.54 × 12.5 + 0.1 × 639.8 + 0.54 × 12.3 IC = 0.1 mA 0.1 mA = 4 mA/V gm = 0.025 V β 100 = 25 k = rπ = gm 4 + 0.1 × VA 100 V = = 1000 k ID 0.1 mA 1 = 0.25 k re gm rπ gm (βro RL ) AM = − rπ + rx + Rsig rπ gm (βro βro ) =− rπ + rπ Obviously the last term, which is due to the pole at the output node, is dominant. The frequency of the output pole is fP = 1 = 31.8 kHz 2π × 5000 × 10−9 fH fP = 31.8 MHz Because the other poles are at much higher frequencies, an estimate of the unity-gain frequency can be found as 1 = − βgm ro 4 1 = − × 100 × 4 × 1000 4 = −100,000 V/V ft = | AM | fP = 105 × 31.8 × 103 = 3.18 GHz Rsig = rπ Rsig = rπ rπ = 1 rπ = 12.5 k 2 ⎞ ⎜ ro + RL ⎟ ⎟ Rc1 = ro re ⎜ ⎝ RL ⎠ ro + β +1 ⎞ ⎛ ro + βro ⎟ ⎟ ⎠ β ro ro + β +1 1000 0.25 × 1 × 100 × 1000 2 = 6.8 + 64 + 6.6 + 5000 ns ro = ⎜ = 1000 0.25⎜ ⎝ ⇒ Cπ + Cμ = 0.64 pF Cπ = 0.64 − 0.1 = 0.54 pF 9.70 Refer to Fig. 9.30. Rπ 1 = Rsig = 12.5 k ⎛ 4 × 10−3 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) β +1 2 = 1000 12.5 = 12.3 k This estimate of ft is not very good (too high!). The other three poles have frequencies much lower than 3.18 GHz and will cause the gain to decrease faster, reaching the 0 dB value at a frequency lower than 3.18 GHz. Also note that fT of the BJTs is 1 GHz and the models we use for the BJT do not hold at frequencies approaching fT . 9.71 AM = Ro = βro = 100 × 1000 = 100 M RL = RL ro 1 gm 1 gmb = 2 20 = 1.82 k AM = 1.82 1.82 + Ro = ro fZ = τH = Cπ 1 Rπ 1 + Cμ1 Rμ1 + (Ccs1 + Cπ 2 )Rc1 + (CL + Cc2 + Cμ2 )(RL Ro ) RL + where Rμ1 = Rsig (1 + gm1 Rc1 ) + Rc1 = 12.5(1 + 4 × 12.3) + 12.3 = 639.8 k RL = 1 5 = 0.91 V/V 1 1 = 20 0.2 k = 200 gm 5 gm 2πCgs 5 × 10−3 = 398 MHz 2π × 2 × 10−12 Chapter 9–29 Next, we evaluate b1 and b2 : Cgs Cgs + CL Rsig + R b1 = Cgd + gm RL + 1 gm RL + 1 L = 0.1 + 2+1 2 20 + × 1.82 5 × 1.82 + 1 5 × 1.82 + 1 (Cgs + Cgd )CL + Cgs Cgd Rsig RL b2 = gm RL + 1 (2 + 0.1) × 1 + 2 × 0.1 × 20 × 1.82 5 × 1.82 + 1 = 8.3 × 10−18 √ √ b2 8.3 Q= = = 0.44 b1 6.5 Thus, the poles are real and their frequencies can be obtained by finding the roots of the polynomial (1 + b1 s + b2 s2 ) −9 −18 2 = 1 + 6.5 × 10 s + 8.3 × 10 1 fH = 2πRsig Cgd + Cgs gm RL + 1 s which are Q.E.D. For the given numerical values, fH = = 5.96 + 0.54 = 6.50 × 10−9 s = and 1 2π × 100 × 103 10 + 2 × 10−12 5 × (2 20) + 1 = 156 kHz (Note: An error was made in the first printing of the book and the values of Cgs and Cgd were exchanged. The above value of fH corresponds to the numbers in the first printing.) For Cgs = 10 pF and Cgd = 2 pF, fH = 1 10 × 10−12 2+ 5 × (2 20) + 1 2π × 100 × 103 = 532 kHz ωP1 = 0.21 × 109 rad/s and ωP2 = 0.57 × 109 rad/s 9.73 Refer to Fig. 9.31(c). Replacing Cgs with an input capacitance between G and ground, we get Thus, Ceq = Cgs (1 − K) ωP1 = 33.4 MHz fP1 = 2π ωP2 fP2 = = 90.7 MHz 2π Since the two poles are relatively close to each other, an estimate of fH can be obtained using 1 1 + 2 fH = 1 2 fP1 fP2 = 31.6 MHz where K= gm RL 1 + gm RL then Ceq = Cgs /(1 + gm RL ) and the total input capacitance becomes Cin = Cgd + Ceq = Cgd + 9.72 fH fP1 where b1 = Cgd + 1 2πb1 Cgs Cgs + CL Rsig + R gm RL + 1 gm RL + 1 L For CL = 0, b1 = Cgd Rsig + = Cgd The frequency of the input pole is fP1 = 1 2πRsig Cgd + Cgs 1 + gm RL fH fP1 Cgs (Rsig + RL ) gm RL + 1 For Rsig RL , Cgs Rsig gm RL + 1 Cgs + Rsig gm RL + 1 b1 Cgd Rsig + Cgs 1 + gm RL 9.74 With gmb = 0 and ro large, we obtain RL RL and AM = gm RL gm RL + 1 Chapter 9–30 For AM = 0.9, 0.9 = gm RL gm RL + 1 ⇒ gm RL = 9 √ Now, for a maximally-flat response, Q = 1/ 2. Using the expression for Q in Eq. (9.129), we get Q= √ gm RL + 1 [(Cgs + Cgd )CL + Cgs Cgd ]Rsig RL √ √ 1 3 RL √ = RL 2 10 1 + 100 ⇒ Vo (s) dc gain = ω0 Vi (s) 2 + ω02 s +s Q = = s2 + s 2 × 2π × 106 + (2π × 106 )2 0.8 s2 + s 8.886 × 106 s + 39.48 × 1012 RL 100 2 RL −4 +1=0 100 9.76 Refer to Fig. 9.33. IC = 1 mA gm = 40 mA/V, rπ = RL = 27 k and RL = 373 k The second answer is not very practical as it implies the transistor is operating at gm = 9/373 = 0.024 mA/V, a very small transconductance!. We will pursue only the first answer. Thus, RL = 27 k VA 20 = 20 k = IC 1 gm fT = 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) ro = 2 × 109 = f3dB = f0 = ω3dB = = 1 √ 2π b2 gm RL + 1 Rsig RL [(Cgs + Cgd )CL + Cgs Cgd ] 9+1 100 × 27[(10 + 1) × 10 + 10 × 1] × 106 × 10−24 = 5.55 Mrad/s f3dB = 884 kHz 40 × 10−3 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) ⇒ Cπ + Cμ = 3.2 pF Cπ = 3.2 − 0.1 = 3.1 pF RL = RL ro = 1 20 = 0.95 k Rsig = Rsig + rx = 1 + 0.1 = 1.1 k RL AM = RL + re + gm = 0.33 mA/V and the 3-dB frequency is found using Eq. (9.127): re = 25 100 = 2.5 k 40 This equation results in two solutions, 0.8 √ [Cgs + Cgd (gm RL + 1)]Rsig + (Cgs + CL )RL √ √ 1 9 + 1 [(10 + 1)10 + 10 × 1] × 100 × RL √ = [10 + 1(9 + 1)] × 100 + (10 + 10)RL 2 Thus, the transfer function will be AM = Rsig β +1 0.95 0.95 + 0.025 + 1.1 101 = 0.96 V/V fZ = = 1 2πCπ re 1 2π × 3.1 × 10−12 × 25 2 GHz b1 = Rsig R Cπ + Cμ 1 + L Rsig + Cμ + CL 1 + RL re rπ 1 Q= √ 2 Rsig R 1+ L + rπ re 0.95 3.1 + 0.1 1 + × 1.1 + (3.1 + 0) × 0.95 0.025 = 0.95 1.1 1+ + 0.025 2.5 ω0 = ω3dB = 2π × 106 rad/s = 0.27 × 10−9 9.75 For a maximally flat response we have Chapter 9–31 b2 = [(Cπ + Cμ )CL + Cπ Cμ ]RL Rsig Rsig R 1+ L + re rπ (0 + 3.1 × 0.1) × 0.95 × 1.1 = 1.1 0.95 + 1+ 0.025 2.5 = 8.2 × 10−21 √ √ b2 8.2 × 10−21 Q= = = 0.335 b1 0.27 × 10−9 Thus, the poles are real and their frequencies can be found as the roots of the polynomial (1 + b1 s + b2 se ) = 1 + 0.27 × 10−9 s + 8.2 × 10−21 s2 s s = 1+ 1+ ωP1 ωP2 (c) Rsig small and the frequency response is determined by the output pole: fP2 = = 1 2π(CL + Cgd + Cdb )(RD ro ) 1 2π(100 + 5 + 5) × 10−15 × 9.1 × 103 = 159 MHz fH 159 MHz (d) Rsig = 40 k τgs = Cgs Rgs = Cgs Rsig = 40 × 10−15 × 40 × 103 ⇒ ωP1 = 4.25 × 109 rad/s = 1.6 ns ωP2 = 28.6 × 109 rad/s Rgd = Rsig (gm RL + 1) + RL Thus, = 40(1.6 × 9.1 + 1) + 9.1 fP1 = 676 MHz fP2 = 4.6 GHz Thus, 9.77 I = 0.4 mA 1 W 2 VOV (a) ID = μn Cox 2 L 1 2 × 0.4 × 16VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.25 V gm = τgd = Cgd Rgd = 5 × 631.5 = 3.16 ns τCL = (CL + Cdb )RL f3dB fP1 = 676 MHz 0.2 = = 631.5 k 2ID 2 × 0.2 = VOV 0.25 = (100 + 5) × 9.1 = 955.5 ps = 0.96 ns τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = 1.6 + 3.16 + 0.96 = 5.72 ns fH = = 1 2πτH 1 2π × 5.72 × 10−9 = 27.8 MHz = 1.6 mA/V (b) ro = VA 20 = ID 0.2 = 100 k RD ro = 10 100 = 9.1 k Ad = gm (RD ro ) = 1.6 × 9.1 = 14.5 V/V 9.78 The common-mode gain will have a zero at fZ = = 1 2πRSS CSS 1 2π × 100 × 103 × 1 × 10−12 = 1.59 MHz Thus, the CMRR will have two poles, one at fZ , i.e. at 1.59 MHz, and the other at the dominant Chapter 9–32 pole of Ad , 20 MHz. Thus, the 3-dB frequency of CMRR will be approximately equal to fZ , Since CSS is proportional to W , its value will be quadrupled: f3dB = 1.59 MHz CSS = 400 fF The output resistance RSS will remain unchanged. Thus, fZ will decrease by a factor of 4 to become 9.79 At low frequencies, fZ = 1 MHz Ad = 100 V/V Acm = 0.1 V/V 9.81 gm = Ad = 1000 or 60 dB Acm IC 0.25 mA = 10 mA/V = VT 0.025 V rπ = β 100 = 10 k = gm 10 The first pole of CMRR is coincident with the zero of the common-mode gain, fT = gm 2π(Cπ + Cμ ) fP1 = 1 MHz Cπ + Cμ = The second pole is coincident with the dominant pole of the differential gain, = fP2 = 10 MHz = 3.2 pF A sketch for the Bode plot for the gain magnitude is shown in the figure. Cπ = 3.2 − 0.5 = 2.7 pF CMRR = gm 2πfT 10 × 10−3 2π × 500 × 106 (a) CMRR (dB) RC 60 20 dB/decade Vo /2 Rsig Vid 2 40 40 dB/decade 20 0 0.1 9.80 RSS = 1 fP1 10 fP2 100 1000 f, MHz 40 VA = I 0.1 = 400 k CSS = 100 fF fZ = = 1 2πCSS RSS 1 = 4 MHz 2π × 100 × 10−15 × 400 × 103 If VOV of the current source is reduced by a factor of 2 while I remains unchanged, (W/L) must be increased by a factor of 4. Assume L remains unchanged, W must be increased by a factor of 4. The figure on the next page shows the differential half-circuit and its high-frequency equivalent circuit. (b) Ad ≡ =− Vo rπ =− gm RC Vid rπ + rx + Rsig 10 × 10 × 10 10 + 0.1 + 10 = −49.8 V/V (c) Cin = Cπ + Cμ (1 + gm RC ) = 2.7 + 0.5(1 + 10 × 10) = 53.2 pF fH = 1 2πCin Rsig Chapter 9–33 This figure belongs to Problem 9.81. Rsig Cm rx Vo/2 Vid 2 Vp rp Cp RC gmVp where Rsig = rπ (Rsig + rx ) = 10 10.1 5 k fH = 1 = 598 kHz 2π × 53.2 × 10−12 × 5 × 103 GB = | Ad | fH = 49.8 × 598 = 29.8 MHz 9.82 gm1,2 = 2ID1,2 I = VOV 1,2 VOV 1,2 0.2 mA = = 1 mA/V 0.2 V 2| VA | | VA | = I /2 I I 2| VA | 2| VA | Ad = | VOV | I I ro2 = ro4 = Ad = | VA | | VOV | fP1 = 1 2πCL Ro where Ro = ro2 ro4 = fP1 = I 2πCL | VA | Ad = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) fP2 = gm3 2πCm = 1(100 100) = 50 V/V where ro2 = ro4 = | VA | 10 V = = 100 k ID 0.1 mA | VA | I fP1 1 = 2πCL Ro gm3 = I 2ID = | VOV | | VOV | = 1 2πCL (ro2 ro4 ) Cm = CL 4 = 1 2π × 0.2 × 10−12 (100 100) × 103 fP2 = 4I 2πCL | VOV | 1 = 15.9 MHz 2π × 0.2 × 50 × 10−9 gm3 fP2 = 2πCm = where gm3 2ID I = = = 1 mA/V | VOV | | VOV | fP2 = fZ = −3 1 × 10 = 1.59 GHz 2π × 0.1 × 10−12 2gm3 = 2fP2 = 2 × 1.59 = 3.18 GHz 2πCm 9.83 Ad = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) gm1,2 = 2ID I = | VOV | | VOV | fZ = (1) (2) 2gm3 8I = 2fP2 = 2πCm 2πCL | VOV | (3) Dividing (2) by (1), we obtain | VA | fP2 = 4 Ad =4 fP1 | VOV | Q.E.D. Since fP2 = 4 Ad fP1 , the unity-gain frequency ft is equal to GB, thus ft = Ad fP1 = I | VA | | VOV | 2πCL | VA | ft = = I /| VOV | 2πCL gm 2πCL Q.E.D. Chapter 9–34 the short-circuit at the output causes Cμ2 to appear in parallel with Cπ1 and Cπ2 . Thus, For the numerical values given, we have 20 = 100 V/V 0.2 I 0.2 = 1 mA/V = gm = VOV 0.2 Ad = fP1 = = Vπ = Ii (s) I 2πCL | VA | 1 1 + re1 rπ2 1 (1) + s(Cπ1 + Cπ2 + Cμ2 ) At the output node we have −3 0.2 × 10 2π × 100 × 10−15 × 20 Io (s) = gm2 Vπ − sCμ2 Vπ (2) Combining Eqs. (1) and (2) gives = 15.9 MHz gm2 − sCμ2 Io (s) = 1 1 Ii (s) + + s(Cπ1 + Cπ2 + Cμ2 ) re1 rπ2 ft = 15.9 × 100 = 1.59 GHz fP2 = 4Ad fP1 = 4 × 100 × 15.9 Since the two transistors are operating at approximately equal dc bias currents, their small-signal parameters will be equal, thus = 6.37 GHz fZ = 2fP2 = 12.7 GHz A sketch of the Bode plot for | Ad | is shown in the figure. gm − sCμ Io (s) = 1 1 Ii (s) 1+ + s(2Cπ + Cμ ) re β +1 = 1 − s(Cμ /gm ) gm re 1 1 1+ 1 + s (2Cπ + Cμ )re / 1 + β +1 β +1 = 1 − s(Cμ /gm ) 1 1 1+ 1 + s (2Cπ + Cμ )re / 1 + β +1 β +1 = 1 − s(Cμ /gm ) 1 1 1 + 2/β 1 + s (2Cπ + Cμ )re / 1 + β +1 α Thus we see that the low-frequency transmission is 9.84 See figure below. The mirror high-frequency equivalent circuit is shown in the figure. Note that we have neglected rx and ro . The model of the diode-connected transistor Q1 reduces to re1 in parallel with Cπ1 . Io (0) = Ii 1+ 2 β as expected. The pole is at fP , fP To obtain the current-transfer function Io (s)/Ii (s), we first determine Vπ in terms of Ii . Observe that 1 1 1 2π (2Cπ + Cμ )re / 1 + β This figure belongs to Problem 9.84. Cm2 C1, B1, B2 Ii (s) Vp re1 sCm2Vp Cp1 Cp2 rp2 gm2Vp Io (s) Chapter 9–35 (b) Rs = 100 and the zero is at gm fZ = 2πCμ Gm = For the numerical values given, AM = −3.33 × 5 = −16.7 V/V IC 1 mA = = 40 mA/V gm = VT 0.025 V Rgd = 100(1 + 3.33 × 5) + 5 = 1771.7 k 100 + 0.1 = 66.7 k Rgs = 1 + 5 × 0.1 re 25 Cπ + Cμ = = gm 2πfT τH = 10 × 66.7 + 2 × 1771.7 = 4.21 ns 40 × 10−3 2π × 500 × 1006 fH = = 12.7 pF (c) Rs = 200 1 fP = 2π[(2 × 10.7 + 2) × 10−12 × 25/1.01] Gm = 1.01 × 1012 2π × 23.4 × 25 5 = 2.5 mA/V 1 + 5 × 0.2 AM = −2.5 × 5 = −12.5 V/V Rgd = 100(1 + 2.5 × 5) + 5 = 1355 k = 274.8 MHz gm fZ = 2πCμ = 1 = 37.8 MHz 2π × 4.21 × 10−9 GB = 631 MHz Cπ = 12.7 − 2 = 10.7 pF = 5 = 3.33 mA/V 1 + 5 × 0.1 Rgs = 100 + 0.2 = 50.1 k 1 + 5 × 0.2 τH = 10 × 50.1 + 2 × 1355 ns 40 × 10−3 = 3.18 GHz 2π × 2 × 10−12 fH = 9.85 Refer to Eqs. (9.146)–(9.153). For our case, gm (1) Gm = 1 + gm Rs 1 = 49.6 MHz 2π × 3.21 × 10−9 GB = 49.6 × 12.5 = 620 MHz A summary of the results is provided in the following table: Ro = very large Rs = 0 Rs = 100 Rs = 200 RL = RL Ro = RL Am = −Gm RL = −gm RL 1 + gm Rs Rgd = Rsig (1 + Gm RL ) + RL Rgs = Rsig + Rs 1 + gm Rs τH = Cgs Rgs + Cgd Rgd fH = 1 2πτH (2) (3) | AM | (V/V) 25 16.7 12.5 fH | (MHz) 26.6 37.8 49.6 GB (MHz) 641 631 620 (4) Observe that increasing Rs trades off gain for bandwidth while GB remains approximately constant. For the numerical values given: (a) Rs = 0 9.86 (a) GB = | AM | fH Gm = gm = 5 mA/V = 1 2πCgd Rsig Rgd = 100(1 + 5 × 5) + 5 = 2605 k = 1 2π × 0.2 × 10−12 × 100 × 103 τH = 10 × 100 + 2 × 2605 = 6.21 ns = 7.96 MHz 1 = 26.6 MHz fH = 2π × 6.21 × 10−9 (b) | AM | = 20 V/V GB = 26.6 × 25 = 641 MHz fH = AM = −gm RL = −5 × 5 = −25 V/V 7.96 = 398 kHz 20 Chapter 9–36 (c) A0 = gm ro RL = RL Ro = 40 120 = 30 k 100 = 5 × ro AM = −Gm RL ⇒ ro = 20 k = −1.67 × 30 = −50 V/V gm 5 = Gm = 1 + gm Rs 1 + gm Rs Rgd = Rsig (1 + Gm RL ) + RL Ro = ro (1 + gm Rs ) = 20(1 + gm Rs ) = 20(1 + 1.67 × 30) + 30 RL = RL Ro = 20 20(1 + gm Rs ) = 1050 k AM = −Gm RL τgd = Cgd Rgd = 0.1 × 1050 = 105 ns 5 20 = [20 20(1 + gm Rs )] 1 + gm Rs τCL = CL RCL 4(1 + gm Rs ) = 20 × 20(1 + gm Rs ) 20 + 20(1 + gm Rs ) ⇒ 1 + gm Rs = 4 3 = 0.6 k = 600 ⇒ Rs = gm 9.87 (a) AM = −gm RL = CL RL = 1 × 30 = 30 ns Rsig + Rs + Rsig Rs /(ro + RL ) ro 1 + gm Rs ro + RL Rgs = = where 20 + 0.4 + 20 × 0.4/(40 + 40) 40 1 + 5 × 0.4 40 + 40 RL = RL ro = 10.25 k = 40 40 = 20 k τgs = Cgs Rgs = 2 × 10.25 = 20.5 ns AM = −5 × 20 = −100 V/V τH = τgs + τgd + τCL τgs = Cgs Rgs = Cgs Rsig = 20.5 + 105 + 30 = 155.5 ns = 2 × 20 = 40 ns Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL = 20(1 + 5 × 20) + 20 = 2040 k τgd = Cgd Rgd = 0.1 × 2040 1 2πτH fH = = 1 = 1.02 MHz 2π × 155.5 × 10−9 GB = 51.2 MHz = 204 ns τCL = CL RL = 1 × 20 = 20 ns τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = 40 + 204 + 20 = 264 ns fH = 1 = 603 kHz 2π × 264 × 10−9 9.88 Gm = RL = RL Ro = ro ro (1 + gm Rs ) = ro ro (1 + k) ro × ro (1 + k) ro + ro (1 + k) GB = 100 × 603 = 60.3 MHz = (b) With Rs = 400 , gm Gm = 1 + gm Rs = ro 5 = 1.67 mA/V = 1 + 5 × 0.4 Ro = ro (1 + gm Rs ) = 40(1 + 5 × 0.4) = 120 k gm gm = 1 + gm Rs 1+k 1+k 2+k AM = −Gm RL = − gm ro 2+k Thus, AM = −A0 2+k Q.E.D. Chapter 9–37 Rgs = Rsig + Rs + Rsig Rs /(ro + RL ) ro 1 + gm Rs ro + RL The results we obtain appear in the following table. k Rsig + Rs + Rsig Rs /2ro = 1 1 + gm Rs 2 | AM |, V/V τH ns fH (MHz) GB (MHz) 0 100 264 0.603 60.3 1 66.7 191.3 0.832 55.6 2 50 155 1.03 51.5 3 40 133.2 1.19 47.6 4 33.3 118.7 1.34 44.6 5 28.6 108.3 1.47 42.0 6 25 100.5 1.58 39.5 7 22.2 94.4 1.69 37.5 8 20 89.6 1.78 35.6 9 18.2 85.7 1.86 33.9 Utilizing the expressions for RL and Gm RL derived earlier, we obtain A0 1+k Rgd = Rsig 1 + + ro 2+k 2+k 10 16.7 82.3 1.93 32.2 11 15.4 79.6 2.00 30.8 12 14.3 77.2 2.06 29.5 τgd = Cgs Rgd = A0 1+k + Cgd ro Cgd Rsig 1 + 2+k 2+k 13 13.3 75.1 2.12 28.2 14 12.5 73.3 2.17 27.1 15 11.8 71.6 2.22 26.2 For Rsig Rs , Rsig (1 + Rs /2ro ) Rgs 1 + (k/2) For ro Rs , Rgs Rsig 1 + (k/2) τgs = Cgs Rgs = Cgs Rsig 1 + (k/2) Rgd = Rsig (1 + Gm RL ) + RL τCL = CL RL = CL ro To obtain fH = 2 MHz, we see from the table that 1+k 2+k k = 11 Thus, Thus, 1 + gm Rs = 11 τH = τgs + τgd + τCL Cgs Rsig A0 + Cgd Rsig 1 + 1 + (k/2) 2+k 1+k 1+k + CL ro +Cgd ro 2+k 2+k Cgs Rsig A0 = + Cgd Rsig 1 + 2+k 1 + (k/2) 1+k +(CL + Cgd )ro Q.E.D. 2+k = 10 = 5 k 2 The gain achieved is ⇒ Rs = | AM | = 15.4 V/V 9.90 (a) Refer to Fig. P9.90(a). Since the total resistance at the drain is ro , we have AM = −gm ro Q.E.D. τgs = Cgs Rgs = Cgs Rsig Rgd = Rsig (1 + gm RL ) + RL 9.89 Substituting the given numerical values in the expressions for AM and τH given in the statement for Problem 9.88 and noting that A0 = gm ro = 5 × 40 = 200, we obtain fH = 1 2πτH and GB = | AM |fH = Rsig (1 + gm ro ) + ro τgd = Cgd Rgd = Cgd [Rsig (1 + gm ro ) + ro ] τCL = CL RL = CL ro Thus, τH = τgs + τgd + τCL = Cgs Rsig + Cgd [Rsig (1 + gm ro ) + ro ] + CL ro Q.E.D. Chapter 9–38 This figure belongs to Problem 9.90, part (b). Rsig Vg1 1 gm1 Vsig Q1 Vo ro1 ro2 Q2 Vg2 Figure 1 Cgd 1 : Capacitor Cgd 1 is between G1 and ground and thus sees the resistance Rsig , For the given numerical values, AM = −1 × 20 = −20 V/V τH = 20 × 20 + 5[20(1 + 1 × 20) + 20] + 10 × 20 Rgd 1 = Rsig = 400 + 2200 + 200 = 2800 ps = 2.8 ns 1 1 = fH = 2πτH 2π × 2.8 × 10−9 = 56.8 MHz τgd 1 = Cgd 1 Rsig Cgs1 : To find the resistance Rgs1 seen by capacitor Cgs1 , we replace Q1 with its hybrid-π equivalent circuit with Vsig set to zero, Cgd 1 = 0, and Cgs1 replaced by a test voltage Vx . The resulting equivalent circuit is shown in Fig. 3. GB = 20 × 56.8 = 1.14 GHz (b) From Fig. 1 we see that Vg1 =1 Vsig Rsig D1 Vg1 G1 Ix Vg2 ro1 = 1 Vg1 + ro1 gm1 Vx Vo = −gm2 ro2 Vg2 S1 Thus, AM = 1 × ro1 × −gm2 ro2 1 + ro1 gm1 ro1 =− (gm2 ro2 ) 1/gm1 + ro1 Ix Analysis of the circuit in Fig. 3 proceeds as follows: Q.E.D. Vg1 = Ix Rsig Vs1 = Vg1 − Vx = Ix Rsig − Vx Node equation at S1 , Ix = gm1 Vx − Vs1 ro1 Ix Rsig − Vx ro1 Rsig 1 Ix 1 + = Vx gm1 + ro1 ro1 Cgd1 = gm1 Vx − Q1 Cgs1 Cgd2 G2 Cgs2 Q2 CL Thus, Rgs1 ≡ Rsig + ro1 Vx = 1 + gm1 ro1 Ix τgs1 = Cgs1 Rgs1 Figure 2 Vs1 Figure 3 Next we evaluate the open-circuit time constants. Refer to Fig. 2. Rsig G 1 ro1 gm1Vx = Cgs1 Rsig + ro1 1 + gm1 ro1 Chapter 9–39 Cgs2 : Capacitor Cgs2 sees the resistance between G2 and ground, which is the output resistance of source follower Q1 , Rgs2 = 1 ro1 gm1 Thus, τgs2 = Cgs2 1 ro1 gm1 Cgd 2 : Transistor Q2 operates as a CS amplifier with an equivalent signal-source resistance equal to the output resistance of the source follower Q2 , 1 that is, ro1 and with a gain from gate to gm1 drain of gm2 ro2 . Thus, the formula for Rgd in a CS amplifier can be adapted as follows: 1 Rgd 2 = ro1 (1 + gm2 ro2 ) + ro2 gm1 and thus, τgd 2 = Cgd 2 1 ro1 (1 + gm2 ro2 ) + ro2 gm1 CL : Capacitor CL sees the resistance between D2 , and ground which is ro2 , τCL = CL ro2 Summing τgd 1 , τgs1 , τgs2 , τgd 2 and τCL gives τH in the problem statement. Q.E.D. GB = 19 × 286 = 5.43 GHz Thus, while the dc gain remained approximately the same both fH and GB increased by a factor of about 5! 9.91 At an emitter bias current of 0.1 mA, Q1 and Q2 have gm = 4 mA/V re = 250 rπ = β 100 = 25 k = gm 4 VA 100 = 1000 k = IC 0.1 gm Cπ + Cμ = 2πfT ro = = 4 × 10−3 = 3.2 pF 2π × 200 × 106 Cμ = 0.2 pF Cπ = 3 pF To determine Rin and the voltage gain AM , refer to the circuit in Fig. 9.40(a). Here, however, RL is ro2 . Rin2 = rπ2 = 25 k For the given numerical values: Rin = (β1 + 1)[re1 + (ro1 Rin2 )] 20 AM = − (1 × 20) 1 + 20 = 101[0.25 + (1000 25)] = −19 V/V τgd 1 = Cgd 1 Rsig = 5 × 20 = 100 ps τgs1 = Cgs1 Rsig + ro1 1 + gm ro1 20 + 20 = 38 ps 1 + 1 × 20 1 = Cgs2 ro1 gm1 2.5 M Vb1 Rin 2.5 M = 1 V/V = Vsig Rin + Rsig 2.5 M + 10 k (Rin2 ro1 ) Vb2 = Vb1 (Rin2 ro1 ) + re1 25 1000 = 0.99 1 V/V (25 1000) + 0.25 = 20 = τgs2 Vo = −gm2 ro2 = −4 × 1000 = −4000 V/V Vb2 = 20 × (1 20) = 19 ps 1 τgd 2 = Cgd 2 ro1 (1 + gm ro2 ) + ro2 gm1 = 5[(1 20)(1 + 20) + 20] = 200 ps τCL = CL ro2 = 10 × 20 = 200 ps τH = 100 + 38 + 19 + 200 + 200 = 557 ps fH = 1 2πτH 1 = 2π × 557 × 10−12 = 286 MHz Thus, AM = Vo = −4000 V/V Vsig To determine fH we use the method of open-circuit time constants. Figure 9.40(b) shows the circuit with Vsig = 0 and the four capacitances indicated. Again, recall that here RL = ro2 . Also, in our present circuit there is a capacitance CL at the output. Capacitance Cμ1 sees a resistance Rμ1 , Rμ1 = Rsig Rin = 10 k 2.5 M 10 k Chapter 9–40 To find the resistance Rπ 1 we refer to the circuit in Fig. 9.40(c) where Rin2 is considered to include ro2 , Rin2 = 25 k 1000 k = 24.4 k We use the formula for Rπ 1 given in Example 9.13: Rπ 1 = Rsig + Rin2 Rsig Rin2 1+ + rπ 1 re1 10 + 24.4 = 347 10 24.4 + 1+ 25 0.25 Capacitance Cπ 2 sees a resistance Rπ 2 : Rπ 1 = Rπ 2 = Rin2 Rout1 Rsig = rπ 2 ro1 re1 + β1 + 1 10 = 25 1000 0.25 + 101 = 344 The high-frequency analysis can be performed in an analogous manner to that used in the text for the bipolar circuit. Refer to Fig. 9.42(b) and adapt the circuit for the MOS case. Thus, fP1 = 2πRsig = 1 Cgs + Cgd 2 1 4 2π × 100 × 103 + 0.5 × 10−12 2 = 637 kHz and fP2 = 1 2πRD Cμ 1 2π × 50 × 103 × 0.5 × 10−12 = 6.37 MHz = Since fP2 10fP1 , the pole at fP1 will dominate and fH fP1 = 637 kHz Capacitance Cμ2 sees a resistance Rμ2 : Rμ2 = (1 + gm2 ro2 )(Rin2 Rout1 ) + ro2 = 2376 k 9.93 Using an approach analogous to that utilized for the BJT circuit (Fig. 9.42), we see that there is a pole at the input with frequency fP1 : We can determine τH from fP1 = = (1 + 4 × 1000) × 0.344 + 1000 2πRsig τH = Cμ1 Rμ1 + Cπ 1 Rπ 1 + Cμ2 Rμ2 + Cπ 2 Rπ 2 + CL ro = 0.2 × 10 + 3 × 0.347 + 0.2 × 2376 + 3 × 0.344 + 1 × 1000 τH = 2 + 1 + 475.2 + 1 + 1000 = 1479.2 ns Observe that there are two dominant capacitances: the most significant is CL and the second most significant is Cμ2 . fH = = 1 2πτH 1 = 107.6 kHz 2π × 1479.2 × 10−9 2ID 2(I /2) = 9.92 gm = VOV VOV = I 0.2 mA = = 1 mA/V VOV 0.2 V RD Vo = Vsig 2/gm = 1 1 gm RD = × 1 × 50 = 25 V/V 2 2 1 Cgs + Cgd 2 fP1 = 2π × 20 × 103 1 2 + 0.1 × 10−12 2 = 7.2 MHz, and a pole at the output with frequency fP2 , fP2 = = 1 2π(Cgd + CL )RL 1 2π × (0.1 + 1) × 10−12 × 20 × 103 = 7.2 MHz Thus, fP1 = fP2 = 7.2 MHz The midband gain AM is obtained as AM = RL 1 = gm RL 2/gm 2 1 × 5 × 20 = 50 V/V 2 Thus, the amplifier transfer function is = Vo (s) = Vsig (s) 50 1+ s 2π × 7.2 × 106 2 Chapter 9–41 Vo = Vsig 1+ 50 ω 2π × 7.2 × 106 2 Vo = (gm ro )2 = 10,000 V/V Vsig (b) τgs1 = Cgs Rsig Vo 50 = √ , thus Vi 2 2 √ ω3dB 2=1+ 2π × 7.2 × 106 √ f3dB = 2 − 1 × 7.2 MHz = 20 × 10 = 200 ps = 4.6 MHz At the drain of Q1 we have (Cdb1 + Cgs2 ) and the resistance seen is ro : At ω = ω3dB , 9.94 gm = Rgd 1 = Rsig (1 + gm1 ro1 ) + ro1 = 10(1 + 100) + 100 = 1110 k τgd 1 = Cgd 1 Rgd 1 = 5 × 1110 = 5550 ps IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V VT 0.025 V re 25 rπ = τd 1 = (Cdb1 + Cgs2 )ro = (5 + 20) × 100 = 2500 ps Rgd 2 = ro1 (1 + gm2 ro2 ) + ro2 β 120 = 3 k = gm 40 = 100(1 + 100) + 100 = 1110 k Rin = 2rπ = 6 k τgd 2 = Cgd 2 Rgd 2 = 5 × 1110 = 5550 ps Vo Rin αRL = Vsig Rin + Rsig 2re τd 2 = Cdb2 ro2 = 5 × 100 = 500 ps 10 6 × = 66.7 V/V 6 + 12 2 × 0.025 gm Cπ + Cμ = 2πfT 40 × 10−3 = = 12.7 pF 2π × 500 × 106 Cμ = 0.5 pF 2πRsig 2π × 12 × 103 = 14,300 ps = 14.3 ns = 1 Cπ + Cμ 2 = = 200 + 5550 + 2500 + 5550 + 500 fH = Cπ = 12.2 pF fP1 = τH = τgs1 + τgd 1 + τd 1 + τgd 2 + τd 2 1 2πτH 1 = 11.1 MHz 2π × 14.3 × 10−9 9.96 (a) 1 12.2 + 0.5 × 10−12 2 5 V 52 1 mA 3 3 k = 2 MHz fP2 = = 1 2πRL Cμ RG 10 M 0 1 2π × 10 × 103 × 0.5 × 10−12 2 V = 31.8 MHz Thus, fP1 is the dominant pole and fH fP1 = 2 MHz VG1 2 V VGS 1.3 V 0.7 V 1 mA Q1 0.1 mA 0 Q2 9.95 (a) For each of Q1 and Q2 , gm = 2 × 0.1 2ID = = 1 mA/V | VOV | 0.2 ro = | VA | 10 = = 100 k ID 0.1 gm ro = 100 0.1 mA 6.8 k Figure 1 Chapter 9–42 Thus, The dc analysis is shown in Fig. 1. It is based on VS1 = VBE2 = 0.7 V. Neglecting IB2 , we obtain 0.7 V ID1 = 0.1 mA Q.E.D. 6.8 k 1 2 ID1 = k n (W/L)VOV 2 1 2 0.1 = × 2 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV 0.3 V Vo = 0.66 × −30 Vi −20 V/V Using Miller’s theorem, the input resistance Rin is found as RG 10 M Rin = = Vo 1 − (−20) 1− Vi VGS = Vt + VOV = 1 + 0.3 = 1.3 V = 476 k Rin Vi = Vsig Rin + Rsig VG1 = 0.7 + 1.3 = 2 V VC1 = VG1 = 2 V 5−2 IC2 = = 1 mA Q.E.D. 3 2ID1 2 × 0.1 = = 0.67 mA/V (b) gm1 = VOV 0.3 Cgs = Cgd = 1 pF = 476 = 0.83 V/V 476 + 100 Vo = 0.83 × 20 = 16.5 V/V Vsig (c) The pole due to C1 has a frequency f1 : IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V = VT 0.025 V β 200 rπ 2 = = = 5 k gm2 40 gm2 Cπ 2 + Cμ2 = 2πfT 2 gm2 = f1 = = 1 2πC1 (Rsig + Rin ) 1 2π × 0.1 × 10−6 (100 + 476) × 103 = 2.8 Hz 40 × 10−3 = = 10.6 pF 2π × 600 × 106 Cμ2 = 0.8 pF The pole due to C2 has a frequency f2 : f2 = Cπ 2 = 9.8 pF 1 2πC2 (3 + 1) × 103 1 = 40 Hz 2π × 1 × 10−6 × 4 × 103 Since f2 f1 , the lower 3-dB frequency fL will be = (c) Q1 acts as a source follower, thus 6.8 k rπ 2 Vb2 = 1 Vi + (6.8 k rπ 2 ) gm1 (6.8 5) = 0.66 V/V = 1.5 + (6.8 5) Neglecting RG , we obtain Vo = −gm2 (3 k 1 k) Vb2 = −40(3 1) = −30 V/V fL f2 = 40 Hz (d) τgd 1 = Cgd 1 (Rin Rsig ) = 1 × 10−12 (476 100) × 103 = 82.6 ns To determine the resistance Rgs seen by Cgs , refer to Fig. 2. This figure belongs to Problem 9.96, part (d). Rsig Rsig 100 k ⬅ Ix Vx gmVx Cgs Ix Rs 6.8 k // rp2 Figure 2 Rs Chapter 9–43 Since CL = 0, we can obtain a good estimate of fH using the Miller approximation: We can show that Rsig + Rs Vx = Rgs ≡ Ix 1 + gm1 Rs Cin = Cπ + Cμ (gm RL + 1) where = 6 + 2(20 × 10 + 1) Rs = 6.8 k rπ 2 = 408 pF = 6.8 5 = 2.88 k 1 2πRsig Cin 100 + 2.88 = 35.1 k Rgs = 1 + 0.67 × 2.88 fH = τgs = Cgs Rgs = 1 × 10−12 × 35.1 × 103 = 35.1 ns = τπ 2 = Cπ 2 (rπ 1 6.8 k) = 39 kHz −12 = 9.8 × 10 × 2.88 × 10 1 2π × 10 × 103 × 408 × 10−12 3 = 28.2 ns 1 6.8 k [1 + gm2 (3 1)] + (3 1) Rμ2 = gm1 3 + 0.75 = (1.5 6.8) 1 + 40 × 4 (b) This is a cascode amplifier. Refer to Fig. 9.30 for the analysis equations. AM = − − rπ gm (βro RL ) rπ + Rsig rπ gm RL rπ + Rsig = 38.8 k = −66.7 V(V) (same as the CE in (a)) τμ2 = Cμ2 Rμ2 = 0.8 × 38.8 = 31.1 ns Rsig = rπ Rsig = 5 10 = 3.33 k τH = τgd + τgs + τπ 2 + τμ2 Rπ1 = Rsig = 82.6 + 35.1 + 38.8 + 31.1 τπ1 = Cπ1 Rπ1 = 6 × 3.33 = 20 ns = 187.6 ns 1 fH = 2πτH Rc1 = re2 = 50 = Rμ1 = Rsig (1 + gm1 Rc1 ) + Rc1 1 = 848 kHz 2π × 187.6 × 10−9 9.97 All transistors are operating at IE = 0.5 mA. Thus, gm 20 mA/V re 50 β 100 = 5 k = rπ = gm 20 ro = very high (neglect) rx = very small (neglect) Cπ + Cμ = gm 20 × 10−3 = 2πfT 2π × 400 × 106 = 8 pF Cμ = 2 pF = 3.33(1 + 40 × 0.05) + 0.05 = 3.33(1 + 2) + 0.05 = 10.05 k τμ1 = Cμ1 Rμ1 = 2 × 10.05 = 20.1 ns τc1 = Cπ2 Rc1 = 6 × 0.05 = 0.3 ns τμ2 = Cμ2 RL = 2 × 10 = 20 ns τH = 20 + 20.1 + 0.3 + 20 = 60.4 ns fH = 1 1 = 2πτH 2π × 60.4 × 10−9 = 2.6 MHz (c) This is a CC-CB cascade similar to the circuit analyzed in Fig. 9.42. There are two poles: one at the input, 1 fP1 = 2π(Rsig 2rπ ) Cπ = 6 pF (a) CE amplifier rπ gm RL AM = − rπ + Rsig =− 5 × 20 × 10 = −66.7 V/V 5 + 10 fP1 = = Cπ + Cμ 2 1 2π(10 10) × 103 (3 + 2) × 10−12 1 2π × 5 × 5 × 10−9 = 6.4 MHz Chapter 9–44 and one at the output, fP2 = = 1 2πRL Cμ 1 2π × 10 × 103 × 2 × 10−12 = 8 MHz Since the two poles are relatively close to each other, we use the root-sum-of-the-squares formula to obtain an estimate for fH : 1 1 fH = 1/ 2 + 2 fP1 fP2 1 1 = 1/ + 2 = 5 MHz 8 6.42 AM = RL Rsig 2re + β +1 10 50 V/V 10 2 × 0.05 + 101 (d) This is a CC-CE cascade similar to the circuit analyzed in Example 9.13. = Rin = (β1 + 1)(re1 + rπ 2 ) τπ 1 = Cπ1 Rπ1 = 6 × 0.15 = 0.9 ns Rπ2 = Rin2 Rout1 Rsig + re1 = rπ2 β1 + 1 10 + 0.05 = 0.15 k =5 101 τπ 2 = Cπ2 Rπ2 = 6 × 0.15 = 0.9 ns Rμ2 = (1 + gm2 RL )(Rin2 Rout1 ) + RL 10 = (1 + 20 × 10) 5 + 0.05 + 10 101 = 39.1 k τμ2 = Cμ2 Rμ2 = 2 × 39.1 = 78.2 ns τH = 19.6 + 0.9 + 0.9 + 78.2 = 99.6 ns fH = 1 = 1.6 MHz 2π × 99.6 × 10−9 (e) This is a folded cascode amplifier. The analysis is identified to that for (b) above. AM = −66.7 V/V = 101(0.05 + 5) = 510 k fH = 2.6 MHz Rin 510 Vb1 = = Vsig Rin + Rsig 510 + 10 (f) This is a CE-CB cascade. The analysis is identical to that for case (c) above. = 0.98 V/V rπ 2 5 Vb2 = = = 0.99 V/V Vb1 rπ 2 + re1 5 + 0.05 AM = 50 V/V fH = 5 MHz Vo = −gm2 RL = −20 × 10 = −200 V/V Vb2 AM = Vo = −0.98 × 0.99 × 200 = −194 V/V Vsig Rμ1 = Rsig Rin Summary of Results Case Configuration AM (V/V) fH (MHz) = 10 510 = 9.81 k a CE −66.7 0.039 τμ1 = Cμ1 Rμ1 = 2 × 9.81 = 19.6 ns b Cascode −66.7 2.6 c CC-CB 50 5 d CC-CE −194 1.6 e Folded Cascode −66.7 2.6 f CC-CB 50 5 Rπ 1 = Rsig + Rin2 = Rsig Rin2 1+ + rπ 1 re1 10 + 5 = 0.15 k 5 10 + 1+ 5 0.05 Exercise 10–1 10 Vo = 4 = 0.001 V A 10 Ex: 10.1 (c) A = 100 V/V and Af = 10 V/V Vi = Since A is not much greater than Af , we shall use the exact expression to determine β and hence R2 /R1 , (f) A ⇒ 0.8 × 104 V/V Af = A 1 + Aβ 100 10 = 1 + 100β ⇒ β = 0.09 V/V Af = 0.8 × 104 1 + 0.8 × 104 × 9 × 10−4 = 975.6 V/V 975.6 − 1000 × 100 1000 = −2.44% or a reduction of 2.44%. which is a change of Now, R1 = 0.09 R1 + R2 1 R2 = − 1 = 10.11 R1 0.09 (d) Aβ = 100 × 0.09 = 9 1 + Aβ = 10 ⇒ 20 dB (e) Vo = Af Vs = 10 × 1 = 10 V Vf = βVo = 0.09 × 10 = 0.9 V 10 Vo = = 0.1 V A 100 (f) A → 80 V/V Vi = 80 = 9.756 Af = 1 + 80 × 0.09 9.756 − 10 × 100 = −2.44% or a a change of 10 reduction of 2.44%. Ex. 10.2 (c) A = 104 V/V and Af = 103 V/V A Af = 1 + Aβ 104 103 = 1 + 104 β ⇒ β = 9 × 10−4 V/V R1 = 9 × 10−4 R1 + R2 R2 1 = − 1 = 1110.1 R1 9 × 10−4 (d) Aβ = 104 × 9 × 10−4 = 9 1 + Aβ = 10 ⇒ 20 dB (e) Vs = 0.01 V Vo = Af Vs = 103 × 0.01 = 10 V Vf = βVo = 9 × 10−4 × 10 = 0.009 V Ex. 10.3 To constrain the corresponding change in Af to 0.1%, we need an amount-of-feedback of at least 10% = 100 1 + Aβ = 0.1% Thus the largest obtainable closed-loop gain will be 1000 A = = 10 V/V Af = 1 + Aβ 100 Each amplifier in the cascade will have a nominal gain of 10 V/V and a maximum variability of 0.1%; thus the overall voltage gain will be (10)3 = 1000 V/V and the maximum variability will be 0.3%. Ex. 10.4 β = R1 1 = 0.1 = R1 + R2 1+9 Aβ = 104 × 0.1 = 1000 1 + Aβ = 1001 Af = A 1 + Aβ Af = 104 = 9.99 V/V 1 + 104 × 0.1 fHf = fH (1 + Aβ) = 100 × 1001 = 100.1 kHz Ex. 10.5 Signal at output = Vs =1× 100 1 × 100 =1× 1V 1 + 1 × 100 × 1 101 Interference at output = Vn =1× A1 A2 1 + A1 A2 β A1 1 + A1 A2 β 1 0.01 V 1 + 1 × 100 × 1 Thus S/I at the output becomes 1/0.01 = 100 or 40 dB Since S/I at the input is 1/1=1 or 0 dB, the improvement is 40 dB. Exercise 10–2 Ex. 10.6 (a) Refer to Fig. 10.8(c). R1 R1 + R2 β= A 36.36 = = 4.4 V/V 1 + Aβ 1 + 36.36 × 0.2 Af = If Aβ were 1, then (b) 1 1 = = 5 V/V β 0.2 Af Ex. 10.7 From the solution of Example 10.4, Aβ = 6 RD 1 + Aβ = 7 Vd fHf = (1 + Aβ)fH R2 Q V t Vr =7×1 = 7 kHz R1 Ex. 10.8 Refer to Fig. E10.8. The 1-mA bias current will split equally between the emitters of Q1 and Q2 , thus Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the circuit prepared for determining the loop gain Aβ. Observe that we have eliminated the input signal Vs , and opened the loop at the gate of Q where the input impedance is infinite obviating the need for a termination resistance at the right-hand side of the break. Now we need to analyze the circuit to determine Vr Aβ ≡ − Vt First, we write for the gain of the CS amplifier Q, Vd = −gm [RD (R1 + R2 )] Vt (1) then we use the voltage-divider rule to find Vr , R1 Vr = Vd R1 + R2 Combining Eqs. (1) and (2) gives Aβ ≡ − Thus, R1 Vr = gm [RD (R1 + R2 )] Vt R1 + R2 IE1 = IE2 = 0.5 mA Transistor Q3 will be operating at an emitter current IE3 = 5 mA determined by the 5-mA current source. Since the dc component of Vs = 0, the negative feedback will force the dc voltage at the output to be approximately zero. See Fig. 1 on next page. The β circuit is shown in Fig. 1 together with the determination of β and of the loading effects of the β circuit on the A circuit, β= R1 1 = 0.1 V/V = R1 + R2 1+9 R11 = R1 R2 = 1 9 = 0.9 k (2) R22 = R1 + R2 = 1 + 9 = 10 k The A circuit is shown in Fig. 2. See figure on next page. re1 = re2 = which can be simplified to Aβ = gm RD R1 RD + R1 + R2 re3 = (c) A = Aβ β ie = = gm RD (R1 + R2 ) RD + R1 + R2 20 R1 = = 0.2 V/V (d) β = R1 + R2 20 + 80 10 × 20 = 7.27 Aβ = 4 10 + 20 + 80 A= 7.27 = 36.36 V/V 0.2 ie = VT 25 mV = 50 = IE1,2 0.5 mA VT 25 mV =5 = IE3 5 mA Vi re1 + re2 + Rs + R11 β +1 Vi 0.05 + 0.05 + 10 + 0.9 101 ⇒ ie = 4.81Vi Rb3 = (β + 1)[re3 + (R22 RL )] = 101[0.005 + (10 2)] = 168.84 k (1) Exercise 10–3 These figures belong to Exercise 10.8. R2 R2 1 2 R1 Vf 1 Vo 2 R1 b 0 R2 1 Vf R1 Vo R1 R2 2 R1 R2 1 2 R1 R22 R1 R2 R11 R1 R2 Figure 1 RC 20 k Q3 aie Rs 10 k Q1 Vi ib3 ie3 Q2 Vo Rb3 ie R22 R11 RL 2 k Ro Ri Figure 2 Vo = 85 V/V Vi ib3 = αie RC RC + Rb3 A≡ = 0.99 ie 20 20 + 168.84 β = 0.1 V/V ⇒ ib3 = 0.105ie Aβ = 8.5 (2) Vo = ie3 (R22 RL ) 85 = 8.95 V/V 9.5 From the A circuit, we have Af = = (β + 1)ib3 (R22 RL ) = ib3 × 101(10 2) ⇒ Vo = 168.33ib3 Combining (1)–(3), we obtain 1 + Aβ = 9.5 Ri = Rs + R11 + (β + 1)(re1 + re2 ) (3) = 10 + 0.9 + 101 × 0.1 = 21 k Exercise 10–4 Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) = 21 × 9.5 = 199.5 k RD Rin = Rif − Rs = 199.5 − 10 = 189.5 k From the A circuit, we have RC Ro = RL R22 re5 + β +1 20 = 2 10 0.005 + 101 Vo R22 Q = 181 Rof R11 Ro = 1 + Aβ Vi 181 = 19.1 9.5 Rof = RL Rout = Ri Figure 2 19.1 = 2 k Rout R1 β= R1 + R2 A Af = 1 + Aβ ⇒ Rout = 19.2 Ex. 10.9 Figure 1 shows the β circuit together with the determination of β, R11 and R22 . β= From A circuit, we have Ri = R1 R1 + R2 1 gm Ro = RD R22 R11 = R1 R2 Rin = Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) R22 = R1 + R2 1 (1 + Aβ) gm Rin = Figure 2 shows the A circuit. We can write Vo = gm (RD R22 )Vi Rout = Rof = Thus, A≡ Rout = Vo = gm [RD (R1 + R2 )] Vi Ro 1 + Aβ RD (R1 + R2 ) 1 + Aβ This figure belongs to Exercise 10.9. R2 R2 1 2 R1 Vf 1 Vo 2 R1 b 0 R2 1 R1 Vf R1 Vo R1 R2 2 1 R2 R1 2 R22 R1 R2 R11 R1 R2 Figure 1 Ro Exercise 10–5 Comparison with the results of Exercise 10.6 shows that the expressions for A and β are identical. However, Rin and Rout cannot be determined using the method of Exercise 10.6. Using Eq. (10.36), we obtain Af = Ex. 10.10 From the solution to Example 10.6, we have Aβ = 653.6 1 + Aβ = 654.6 A decrease in the op amp gain by 10% results in a decrease in A by 10% and a corresponding decrease in Af by A1 gm2 1 + A1 gm2 RF 200 × 2 = 4.94 mA/V 1 + 200 × 2 × 0.2 From Eq. (10.32), we have Ri = Rs + Rid + RF Rid + RF = 100 + 0.2 = 100.2 k From Eq. (10.35), we get Aβ A1 gm2 RF = 200 × 2 × 0.2 = 80 10% 10% = = 0.015% 1 + Aβ 654.6 1 + Aβ = 81 A more exact solution (not using differential) is as follows: = 81 × 100.2 8.1 M The open-loop gain A becomes From Eq. (10.33), we have A = 0.9 × 653.6 = 588.24 mA/V Ro = ro2 + RL + RF β = RF = 1 k ro2 + RF Af = 588.24 1 + 588.24 × 1 = 0.9983 mA/V Change in Af = 0.9983 − 0.9985 = −0.0002 −0.0002 × 100 Percentage change in Af = 0.9983 = −0.02% Rif = (1 + Aβ)Ri = 20 + 0.2 = 20.2 k Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) = 20.2 × 81 = 1.64 M If gm2 drops by 50%, A drops by 50% to A = A1 gm2 = 200 × 1 = 200 mA/V and Af becomes Af = 200 = 4.878 mA/V 1 + 200 × 0.2 Thus, Ex. 10.11 For a nominal closed-loop transconductance of 2 mA/V, we have 1 = 0.5 k RF = β = 2 mA/V From the solution to Example 10.6, we obtain gm (RF Rid ro2 ) μ A= RF 1 + gm (RF Rid ro2 ) A= 1000 2(0.5 100 20) 0.5 1 + 2(0.5 100 20) A = 985.2 mA/V Io 985.2 = = 1.996 mA/V Af ≡ Vs 1 + 985.2 × 0.5 Ex. 10.12 Af 5 mA/V β 1 = 0.2 k = 200 Af RF = 200 Af = 4.94 − 4.878 = −0.062 Af 0.062 × 100 = −1.25% × 100 = − Af 4.94 Ex. 10.13 See figure on next page. Figure 1 shows the circuit for determining the loop gain. The figure also shows the analysis. We start by finding the current in the drain of Q2 as gm2 Vg2 (this excludes the current in ro2 ). Since ro2 RL + RF , most of gm2 Vg2 will flow through RL and RF (Rid + Rs ). Since RF Rid + Rs , the voltage across RF will be approximately −gm2 Vg2 RF . This voltage is amplified by A1 which provides at its output Vr = −A1 gm2 RF Vg2 Thus, we find Aβ as Aβ ≡ − Vr = A1 gm2 RF Vg2 Exercise 10–6 This figure belongs to Exercise 10.13. Rs G2 A1 Vr Rid Vg2 ro2 RL RF Q2 gm2Vg2 0 Rid Rs RF gm2Vg2 RL gm2Vg2 RF RF Figure 1 Rout = Rof − RL Ex. 10.14 From Eq. (10.34), we obtain Aβ = (A1 gm2 RF ) Rid Rid + Rs + RF ro2 ro2 + RL + RF Rout ro2 (1 + A1 gm2 RF ) Ri = Rs + Rid + RF Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) = Rs + Rid + RF + (A1 gm2 RF )Rid Rin = Rif − Rs Rin = Rid + RF + (Agm2 RF )Rid ro2 ro2 + RL + RF ro2 ro2 + RL + RF For RF Rid and ro2 RL + RF , we have Af ≡ when the loop gain is large, we use β Ex. 10.15 From Eq. (10.34), we obtain Rid Rid + Rs + RF ro2 ro2 + RL + RF RE2 RE2 + RF + RE1 For RE1 = RE2 = 100 , Q.E.D. 1 = 10 Af But, 10 = (A1 gm2 RF ) Q.E.D. Io 100 mA/V Vs β = RE1 × Rin Rid + Agm2 RF Rid ro2 Ex. 10.16 To obtain = Ri + AβRi Aβ = For RF ro2 and Rid Rs + RF , we have From Eq. (10.32), we obtain = Rid (1 + Agm2 RF ) Rid = ro2 + RF + (A1 gm2 RF ) Rid + Rs + RF From Eq. (10.33), we get 100 × 100 200 + RF ⇒ RF = 800 −Io RC1 Vo = Vs Vs = −Af RC1 = −100 × 0.6 = −60 V/V Ro = ro2 + RL + RF Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) = Ro + AβRo = ro2 +RL +RF +(A1 gm2 RF ) Rid ro2 Rid + Rs + RF Ex. 10.17 See figure on next page. Figure 1 shows the circuit prepared for the determination of the loop gain, Aβ ≡ − Vr Vt Exercise 10–7 This figure belongs to Exercise 10.17. RC3 RC2 RC1 Ic1 rp2 Q1 re1 Vr Q3 Ic2 Q2 Vt Ib3 Ri3 Ie3 Ie1 RF If RE2 RE1 Figure 1 We shall trace the signal around the loop as follows: Ic2 = gm2 Vt (1) RC2 Ib3 = Ic2 RC2 + Ri3 (2) where Ri3 = (β + 1) re3 + [RE2 (RF + (RE1 re1 ))] (3) Ie3 = (β + 1)Ib3 (4) Ie3 = 101Ib3 (11) If = 0.13Ie3 (12) Ie1 = 0.706If (13) Ic1 = 0.99Ie1 (14) Vr = −1.957Ic1 (15) Combining (9)–(15), we obtain If = Ie3 RE2 RE2 + RF + (RE1 re1 ) (5) Ie1 = If RE1 RE1 + re1 (6) Ic1 = αIe1 (7) Vr = −Ic1 (RC1 rπ 2 ) (8) Aβ = − Ex. 10.18 RF ro Rs Combining (1)–(7) gives Vr in terms of Vt and hence Aβ ≡ −Vr /Vt . We shall do this numerically using the values in Example 10.8: Vr = 249.3 Vt V Vr t Rid gm2 = 40 mA/V, RC2 = 5 k, β = 100, Rid mV t RL Figure 1 re3 = 6.25 , RE1 = RE2 = 100 , RF = 640 , Figure 1 shows the circuit prepared for determining the loop gain re1 = 41.7 , α1 = 0.99, RC1 = 9 k, and rπ 2 = 2.5 k Ri3 = 101 0.00625 + [0.1 (0.64 + (0.1 0.0417))] Aβ ≡ − Using the voltage-divider rule, we can write by inspection = 9.42 k Ic2 = 40Vt Ib3 = 0.347Ic2 Vr Vt (9) Vr = (10) −μVt RL [RF + (Rs Rid )] (Rs Rid ) ro + RL [RF + (Rs Rid )] RF + (Rs Rid ) Exercise 10–8 Vr = RL (Rs Rid ) −μVt ro [RL + RF + (Rs Rid )] + RL [RF + (Rs Rid )] Thus, Aβ = − Q.E.D. Using the numerical values in Example 10.9, we get 104 × 1 × 1 Aβ = 0.1(1 + 10 + 1) + 1(10 + 1) RF 1 + gm (ro RF ) (d) Rout = Rof = = Ex. 10.19 See figure on next page. Figure 1(a) shows the feedback amplifier circuit. The β circuit is shown in Fig. 1(b), and the determination of β is shown in Fig. 1(c), 1 RF Q.E.D. Ro 1 + Aβ ro RF 1 + gm (Rs RF )(ro RF )/RF 1 1 1 gm (Rs RF ) = + + Rout ro RF RF ⇒ Rout = ro = 819.7 RF 1 + gm (Rs RF ) (e) A = −5(1 10)(20 10) A = −30.3 k β=− 1 1 = −0.1 mA/V =− RF 10 1 + Aβ = 4.03 Af = 1 = −RF β (b) The determination of R11 and R22 is illustrated in Figs. 1(d) and (e), respectively: 30.3 A =− = −7.52 k 1 + Aβ 4.03 (Compare to the ideal value of −10 k). Ri = Rs RF = 1 10 = 909 R11 = R22 = RF Ro = ro RF = 20 10 = 6.67 k Finally, the A circuit is shown in Fig. 1(f). We can write by inspection 909 Ri = = 226 1 + Aβ 4.03 1 1 − = 291 Rin = 1 Rif Rs Ri = Rs R11 = Rs RF Ro = ro R22 = ro RF Vgs = Ii Ri Ex. 10.20 From Eq. (10.54), we obtain Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ A = −μ Af = gm (Rs RF )(ro RF ) 1 + gm (Rs RF )(ro RF )/RF (c) Rif = Ri 1 + Aβ Rs RF Rif = 1 + gm (Rs RF )(ro RF )/RF 1 1 gm (ro RF ) 1 = + + Rif Rs RF RF Ro 6.67 = = 1.66 k 1 + Aβ 4.03 Rout = Rof = 1.66 k Thus, Vo = −gm (Rs RF )(ro RF ) A≡ Ii − Rif = Rof = Vo = −gm Vgs (ro R22 ) Af = Q.E.D. Aβ = 3.03 (a) For large loop gain, we have Af 1 1 = [1 + gm (ro RF )] Rin RF ⇒ Rin = Vr = Vt μRL (Rid Rs ) ro [RL + RF + (Rid Rs )] + RL [RF + (Rid Rs )] β=− thus, Q.E.D. R1 R2 ro2 Ri R1 R2 1/gm + (R1 R2 ro2 ) For μ = 100, R1 = 10 k, R2 = 90 k, gm = 5 mA/V, ro2 = 20 k, we have Ri = Rs Rid (R1 + R2 ) = ∞ ∞ 100 = 100 k A = −100 10 90 20 100 10 90 0.2 + (10 90 20) = −1076.4 A/A 10 R1 = −0.1 A/A =− R1 + R2 10 + 90 But, β=− 1 1 1 = + Rif Rs Rin Af = − 1076.4 = −9.91 A/A 1 + 107.64 Exercise 10–9 This figure belongs to Exercise 10.19. RF Vo Is Vgs Rs gmVgs ro Rif Rout Rof Rin (a) If RF 1 RF 1 2 Vo 2 b (b) 1 If RF Vo (c) RF RF 1 1 2 R11 RF 2 R22 RF (e) (d) Vo Ii Rs R11 Vgs R22 gmVgs ro Ro Ri (f) Figure 1 Rif = Ri 100 k = = 920 1 + Aβ 108.64 Rin = Rif = 920 Rout = Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) Ro = ro2 + (R1 R2 ) + gm ro2 (R1 R2 ) = 929 k Rout = 929 × 108.64 = 101 M Substituting R2 = 0 and Rs = Rid = ∞ in Eq. (10.50), we obtain Ri = R1 and in Eq. (10.55), we obtain Ro = ro2 and in Eq. (10.53), we obtain A = −μ Ex. 10.21 With R2 = 0, Eq. (10.48) gives β = −1 Af = −1 A/A R1 = −μgm R1 1/gm Now, Af = A 1 + Aβ Exercise 10–10 Af = − μgm R1 1 + μgm R1 1 + A0 β = 1 + 105 × 0.01 = 1001 Rin = Rif = Ri /(1 + Aβ) = R1 1 + μgm R1 Rin 1/μgm Rout = Rof = (1 + Aβ)Ro = (1 + μgm R1 )ro2 β1 and then the pole will be shifted to a frequency Ex. 10.22 Total phase shift will be 180◦ at the frequency ω180 at which the phase shift of each amplifier stage is 60◦ . Thus, ◦ = 60 ◦ ω180 = tan 60 × 10 √ = 3 × 104 rad/s 4 At ω180 , we have | A| = If β is changed to a value that results in a nominal closed-loop gain of 1, then we obtain 1 + A0 β = 1 + 105 × 1 105 μ(gm ro2 )R1 fPf = fP (1 + A0 β) = 100 × 1001 = 100.1 kHz For μgm R1 1, we have ω180 tan−1 4 10 The pole will be shifted to a frequency 10 √ 1+3 3 = 125 Thus, the loop gain magnitude will be fPf = 105 × 100 = 10 MHz Ex. 10.24 From Eq. (10.68), we see that the poles coincide when (ωP1 + ωP2 )2 = 4(1 + A0 β)ωP1 ωP2 (104 + 106 )2 = 4(1 + 100β) × 104 × 106 ⇒ 1 + 100β = 25.5 ⇒ β = 0.245 The corresponding value of Q = 0.5. This can also be verified by substituting in Eq. (10.70). A maximally √ flat response is obtained when Q = 1/ 2. Substituting in Eq. (10.70), we obtain (1 + 100β) × 104 × 106 104 + 106 | Aβ| = 125β 1 √ = 2 For stable operation, we require ⇒ β = 0.5 125βcr < 1 In this case, the low-frequency closed-loop gain is 1 ⇒ βcr = = 0.008 125 Af (0) = β ≥ βcr will result in oscillations. Correspondingly, the minimum closed-loop gain for stable operation will be = Af = = 103 1 + 103 βcr 1000 103 = = 111.1 1 + 1000 × 0.008 9 Ex. 10.23 The feedback shifts the pole by a factor equal to the amount of feedback: A0 1 + A0 β 100 = 1.96 V/V 1 + 100 × 0.5 Ex. 10.25 The closed-loop poles are the roots of the characteristic equation 1 + A(s)β = 0 ⎛ ⎞3 ⎜ 1+⎝ ⎟ s ⎠β = 0 1+ 4 10 10 Exercise 10–11 To simplify matters, we normalize s by the factor 104 , thus obtaining the normalized complex-frequency variable S = s/104 , and the characteristic equation becomes (S + 1)3 + 103 β = 0 (1) From Fig. 1, we can easily obtain the loop gain as Aβ = A(s) × 0.01 = 105 1+ × 0.01 s 2π × 10 1000 s 1+ 2π × 10 This equation has three roots, a real one and a pair that can be complex conjugate. The real pole can be found from = (S + 1)3 = −103 β From this single-pole response (low-pass STC response) we can find the unity-gain frequency by inspection as ⇒ S = −1 − 10β 1/3 = − 1 + 10β 1/3 (2) f1 = fP × 1000 Dividing the characteristic polynomial in (1) by S + 1 + 10β 1/3 gives a quadratic whose two roots are the remaining poles of the feedback amplifier. After some straightforward but somewhat tedious algebra, we obtain The phase angle at f1 will be −90◦ and thus the phase margin is 90◦ . S 2 + 10β 1/3 − 2 S + 1 + 100β 2/3 − 10β 1/3 Ex. 10.27 From Eq. (10.82), we obtain =0 (3) The pair of poles can now be obtained as √ S = −1 + 5β 1/3 ± j5 3 β 1/3 = 104 Hz | Af (jω1 )| = 1/|1 + e−jθ | 1/β = 1/|1 + cos θ − j sin θ| (4) (a) For PM = 30◦ , θ = 180 − 30 = 150◦ , thus Equations (1) and (3) describe the three poles shown in Fig. E10.25. | Af (jω1 )| = 1/|1 + cos 150◦ − j sin 150◦ | 1/β From Eq. (2) we see that the pair of complex poles lie on the jω axis for the value of β that makes the coefficient of S equal to zero, thus = 1.93 βcr = 2 10 3 (b) For PM = 60◦ , θ = 180 − 60 = 120◦ , thus | Af (jω1 )| = 1/|1 + cos 120◦ − j sin 120◦ | 1/β = 0.008 Note that this is the same value found in the solution of Exercise 10.22. =1 (c) For PM = 90◦ , θ = 180 − 90 = 90◦ , thus | Af (jω1 )| = 1/|1 + cos 90◦ − j sin 90◦ | 1/β Ex. 10.26 99R √ = 1/ 2 = 0.707 R Figure 1 A (s) Ex. 10.28 See figure on next page. To obtain guaranteed stable performance, the maximum rate of closure must not exceed 20 dB/decade. Thus we utilize the graphical construction in Fig. 1 to obtain the Exercise 10–12 This figure belongs to Exercise 10.28. dB “rate of closure” 20 dB/decade |A| 20 dB/decade 100 40 dB/decade 80 de eca B/d d 0 60 2 40 20 102 101 1 20 log b 100 forntiat e e fr dif or 101 vdifferentiator 10 2 10 3 10 4 10 5 10 6 f (Hz) 1 τ Figure 1 maximum value of the differentiator frequency as 1 Hz. Thus, Ex. 10.30 The frequency of the first pole must be lowered from 1 MHz to a new frequency 1 ≤ 2π × 1 Hz τ 1 s = 159 ms τ≥ 2π 10 MHz = 1000 Hz 104 that is, by a factor of 1000. Thus, the capacitance at the controlling node must be increased by a factor of 1000. Ex. 10.29 To obtain stable performance for closed-loop gains as low as 20 dB (which is 80 dB below A0 , or equivalently 104 below A0 ), we must place the new dominant pole at 1 MHz/104 = 100 Hz. fD = Chapter 10–1 10.1 Af = 200 = R2 = 10 A 1 + Aβ = 290 k 104 1 + 104 β (c) (i) A = 1000(1 − 0.2) = 800 V/V ⇒ β = 4.9 × 10−3 3 If A changes to 10 , then we get Af = 1+ 103 1 −1 0.033 800 1 + 800 × 0.099 = 9.975 V/V 1000 × 4.9 × 10−3 Thus, Af changes by 1000 = 169.5 = 5.9 Percentage change in Af = Af = 9.975 − 10 × 100 = −0.25% 10 (ii) A = 200(1 − 0.2) = 160 V/V = 169.5 − 200 × 100 200 = −15.3% Af = 160 = 9.877 V/V 1 + 160 × 0.095 Thus, Af changes by 10.2 (a) Because of the infinite input resistance of the op amp, the fraction of the output voltage Vo that is fed back and subtracted from Vs is determined by the voltage divider (R1 , R2 ), thus R1 β= R1 + R2 (b) (i) A = 1000 V/V A Af = 1 + Aβ 10 = 1000 1 + 1000β ⇒ β = 0.099 V/V R1 = 0.099 R1 + R2 1 R2 = R1 0.099 1 −1 R2 = R1 0.099 1 − 1 = 91 k = 10 0.099 1+ (ii) A = 200 V/V 200 10 = 1 + 200β ⇒ β = 0.095 V/V 1 −1 R2 = R1 0.095 1 − 1 = 95.3 k = 10 0.095 (iii) A = 15 V/V 10 = 15 1 + 15β ⇒ β = 0.033 V/V 9.877 − 10 × 100 = −1.23% 10 (iii) A = 15(1 − 0.2) = 12 V/V = Af = 12 = 8.574 1 + 12 × 0.033 Thus, Af changes by 8.575 − 10 × 100 = −14.3% 10 We conclude that as A becomes smaller and hence the amount of feedback (1 + Aβ) is lower, the desensitivity of the feedback amplifier to changes in A decreases. In other words, the negative feedback becomes less effective as (1 + Aβ) decreases. = 10.3 The direct connection of the output terminal to the inverting input terminal results in Vf = Vo and thus β=1 If A = 1000, then the closed-loop gain will be Af = = A 1 + Aβ 1000 = 0.999 V/V 1 + 1000 × 1 Amount of feedback = 1 + Aβ = 1 + 1000 × 1 = 1001 or 60 dB For Vs = 1 V, we obtain Vo = Af Vs = 0.999 × 1 = 0.999 V Vi = Vs − Vo = 1 − 0.999 = 0.001 V Chapter 10–2 If A becomes 1000(1 − 0.1) = 900 V/V, then we get 900 = 0.99889 Af = 1 + 900 × 1 Thus, Af changes by = 0.99889 − 0.999 × 100 = −0.011% 0.999 10.4 A = Vo 5V = = 500 V/V Vi 10 mV Vf = Vs − Vi = 1 − 0.01 = 0.99 V β= Vf 0.99 = 0.198 V/V = Vo 5 Ahigh = 1500 If we apply negative feedback with a feedback factor β, then Af , nominal = 1000 1 + 1000β Af , low = 500 1 + 500β Af , high = 1500 1 + 1500β It is required that Af , low ≥ 0.99Af , nominal and Af , high ≤ 1.01Af , nominal 10.5 (a) Af = A 1 + Aβ Ideally, Af = 1 β 1 A Af ideal − Af = − β 1 + Aβ 1 1 + Aβ − Aβ = = (1 + Aβ)β (1 + Aβ)β Expressed as a percentage of the ideal gain 1/β, we have 1 Difference = × 100% Ideal 1 + Aβ For Aβ 1, 100 Difference % Ideal Aβ (b) For Af to be within: (i) 0.1% of ideal value, then 100 ≤ 0.1 Aβ (1) (2) If we satisfy condition (1) with equality, we can determine the required value of β. We must then clock that condition (2) is satisfied. Thus, 500 1000 = 0.99 × 1 + 500β 1 + 1000β ⇒ β = 0.098 For this value of β, we obtain Af , nominal = 1000 1 + 1000 × 0.098 = 10.101 Af , low = 500 = 10 1 + 500 × 0.098 Af , high = 1500 = 10.135 1 + 1500 × 0.098 Thus, the low value of the closed-loop gain is 0.101 below nominal or −1%, and the high value is 0.034 above nominal or 0.34%. Thus, our amplifier meets specification and the nominal value of closed-loop gain is 10.1. This is the highest possible closed-loop gain that can be obtained while meeting specification. ⇒ Aβ ≥ 1000 Now, if three closed-loop amplifiers are placed in cascade, the overall gain obtained will be (ii) 1% of ideal value, then Nominal Gain = (10.1)3 = 1030 100 ≤1 Aβ Lowest Gain = 103 = 1000 ⇒ Aβ ≥ 100 Highest Gain = (10.135)3 = 1041 (iii) 5% of ideal value, then Thus, the lowest gain will be approximately 3% below nominal, and the highest gain will be 1% above nominal. 100 ≤5 Aβ ⇒ Aβ ≥ 20 10.6 Anominal = 1000 Alow = 500 5V = 2500 V/V 2 mV 5V = 50 V/V Af = 100 mV 10.7 A = Chapter 10–3 Amount of feedback ≡ 1 + Aβ = we get 2500 A = 50 = Af 50 A=μ or 34 dB =μ Rid /(R1 + Rid ) (R1 + R2 ) R1 Rid /(R1 + Rid ) + R2 =μ Rid (R1 + R2 ) R1 Rid + R2 Rid + R1 R2 Aβ = 49 β= 49 = 0.0196 V/V 2500 R1 + R2 R1 Rid (R1 Rid ) + R2 R1 Thus, 10.8 A=μ X Rid Vs X' V1 mV1 Vo R2 Rid Rid + (R1 R2 ) Q.E.D. 10.9 From Eq. (10.10), we have dAf /Af 1 = dA/A 1 + Aβ Since −40 dB is 0.01, we have 0.01 = R1 1 1 + Aβ ⇒ Aβ = 99 For dAf /Af 1 = dA/A 5 Figure 1 Rid Vr Vt Rid V1 mV1 R2 R1 we have 1 + Aβ = 5 ⇒ Aβ = 4 10.10 Af = 10 V/V 1 + Aβ = Figure 2 Figure 1 shows the given circuit with the op amp replaced with its equivalent circuit model. To determine the loop gain Aβ, we short circuit Vs and break the loop at the input terminals of the op amp. To keep the circuit unchanged, we must place a resistance equal to Rid at the left-hand side of the break. This is shown in Fig. 2, where a test signal Vt is applied at the right-hand side of the break. To determine the returned voltage Vr , we use the voltage-divider rule as follows: R1 Rid Vr = −μV1 (R1 Rid ) + R2 Substituting V1 = Vt and rearranging, we obtain Aβ ≡ − R1 Rid Vr =μ Vt (R1 Rid ) + R2 ±10% = 100 ±0.1% A 100 ⇒ A = 1000 V/V 100 − 1 = 0.099 V/V β= 1000 10 = 10.11 For A = 1000 V/V, we have Af = 10 = 1000 1 + Aβ ⇒ Densensitivity factor ≡ 1 + Aβ = 100 Aβ = 99 99 = 0.099 V/V 1000 For A = 500 V/V, we have β= Af = 10 = 500 1 + Aβ Since ⇒ Densensitivity factor ≡ 1 + Aβ = 50 R1 β= R1 + R2 β= 49 = 0.098 V/V 500 Chapter 10–4 If the A = 1000 amplifiers have a gain uncertainty of ±10%, the gain uncertainty of the closed-loop amplifiers will be = ±10% = ±0.1% 100 Gain uncertainty of A = 500 amplifiers 50 ⇒ Gain uncertainty = ±5% 2μ 1 + 2μβ 105 = 12μ 1 + 12μβ (1) (2) Dividing Eq. (2) by Eq. (1) yields 1.105 = 6(1 + 2μβ) 1 + 12μβ 3.885 = 9.33 × 10−3 V/V 416.6 (6) Dividing (6) by (5) yields 1.105 = 6(1 + 2μβ) 1 + 12μβ ⇒ μβ = 3.885 which is identical to the first case considered, and μ= 9.5(1 + 2 × 3.885) = 41.66 V/V 1 + 12μβ which is a factor of 10 lower than the value required when the gain required was 100. The feedback factor β is 3.885 = 9.33 × 10−2 V/V 41.66 (b) Finally, for the case Af = 10 ± 0.5% we can write by analogy Substituting in Eq. (1) yields β= 12μ 1 + 12μβ (5) which is a factor of 10 higher than the case with Af = 10. ⇒ μβ = 3.885 95(1 + 2 × 3.885) = 416.6 V/V 2 2μ 1 + 2μβ 10.5 = β= 1.105 + 1.105 × 12μβ = 6 + 12μβ μ= (a) For ±5% maximum variability, Eqs. (1) and (2) become 9.5 = 10.12 Let the gain of the ideal (nonvarying) driver amplifier be denoted μ. Then, the open-loop gain A will vary from 2μ to 12μ. Correspondingly, the closed-loop gain will vary from 95 V/V to 105 V/V. Substituting these quantities into the closed-loop gain expression, we obtain 95 = 49.92 = 9.95 × 10−3 V/V 5016.8 Repeating for Af = 10 V/V (a factor of 10 lower than the original case): β= If we require a gain uncertainty of ±0.1% using the A = 500 amplifiers, then ±0.1% = which is more than a factor of 10 higher than the gain required in the less constrained case. The value of β required is μβ = 49.92 μ = 501.68 V/V β = 9.95 × 10−2 V/V If Af is to be held to within ±0.5%, Eqs. (1) and (2) are modified to 99.5 = 2μ 1 + 2μβ 100.5 = 12μ 1 + 12μβ Dividing (4) by (3) yields 6(1 + 2μβ) 1.01 = 1 + 12μβ ⇒ μβ = 49.92 Substituting into (3) provides μ= 99.5(1 + 2 × 49.92) 2 = 5016.8 V/V (3) (4) 10.13 If the nominal open-loop gain is A, then we require that as A drops to (A/2) the closed-loop gain drops from 10 to a minimum of 9.8. Substituting these values in the expression for the closed-loop gain, we obtain 10 = A 1 + Aβ A/2 1 1 + Aβ 2 Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2) yields 1 2 1 + Aβ 2 1.02 = 1 + Aβ 9.8 = (1) (2) Chapter 10–5 1.02 = =1+ 2 + Aβ 1 + Aβ 1 1 + Aβ Af , low = 700 = 9.957 V/V 1 + 700 × 0.099 and a high value of Af , high = 1300 = 10.023 V/V 1 + 1300 × 0.099 1 = 50 0.02 Substituting in Eq. (1) gives Thus, the cascade of two stages will have a range of A = 10 × 50 = 500 V/V Lowest gain = 9.9572 = 99.14 V/V and Highest gain = 10.0232 = 100.46 V/V 50 − 1 = 0.098 V/V 500 If β is accurate to within ±1%, to ensure that the minimum closed-loop gain realized is 9.8 V/V, we have A/2 9.8 = 1 1 + A × 0.098 × 1.01 2 ⇒ A = 653.4 V/V which is −0.86% to +0.46% of the nominal 100 V/V gain, well within the required ±1%. ⇒ 1 + Aβ = β= 10.15 Af = 10.14 If we use one stage, the amount of feedback required is 1 + Aβ = 1000 A = 10 = Af 100 A 1 + Aβ (1) 0.1A 1 + 0.1Aβ (2) 100 = 99 = A 1 + Aβ Dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2) gives 1.01 = 10(1 + 0.1Aβ) 1 + Aβ 10 + Aβ 1 + Aβ Thus the closed-loop amplifier will have a variability of = ±30% = ±3% 10 which does not meet specifications. Next, we try using two stages. For a nominal gain of 100, each stage will be required to have a nominal gain of 10. Thus, for each stage the amount of feedback required will be =1+ 1000 = 100 10 Thus, the closed-loop gain of each stage will have a variability of Substituting (1 + Aβ) = 900 into Eq. (1) yields Variability of Af = 1 + Aβ = ±30% = ±0.3% 100 and the cascade of two stages will thus show a variability of ±0.6%, well within the required ±1%. Thus two stages will suffice. = We next investigate the design in more detail. Each stage will have a nominal gain of 10 and thus 1000 = 100 10 ⇒ Aβ = 99 1 + Aβ = ⇒ β = 0.099 Since A ranges from 700 V/V to 1300 V/V, the gain of each stage will range from ⇒ 9 1 + Aβ 9 = 0.01 1 + Aβ 1 + Aβ = 900 Aβ = 899 A = 100 × 900 = 90, 000 V/V The value of β is β= 899 = 9.989 × 10−3 V/V 90, 000 If A were increased tenfold, i.e, A = 900, 000, we obtain 900, 000 = 100.1 V/V Af = 1 + 8990 If A becomes infinite, we get Af = A 1 + Aβ 1 1 = 1 β +β A 1 = 100.11 V/V = 9.989 × 10−3 = Chapter 10–6 10.16 A = AM s s + ωL A 1 + Aβ Af = C= = AM s/(s + ωL ) 1 + AM βs/(s + ωL ) = AM s s + ωL + sAM β = AM s s(1 + AM β) + ωL AM s = 1 + AM β s + ωL /(1 + AM β) Thus, AM 1 + AM β ωL = 1 + AM β AMf = ωLf 10.19 Let’s first try N = 2. The closed-loop gain of each stage must be √ Af = 1000 = 31.6 V/V Thus, the amount-of-feedback in each stage must be 1 + Aβ = A 1000 = 31.6 = Af 31.6 f3dB |stage = (1 + Aβ)fH 1000 = 100 10 Thus, fH f = (1 + AM β)fH = 100 × 10 = 1000 kHz = 1 MHz fL fLf = 1 + AM β = 1 4 μF 2π × 5000 × 8 The 3-dB frequency of each stage is Thus, both the midband gain and the 3-dB frequency are lowered by the amount of feedback, (1 + AM β). 10.17 1 + AM β = and the coupling capacitor C will have a value of 100 = 1 Hz 100 = 31.6 × 20 = 632 kHz Thus, the 3-dB frequency of the cascade amplifier is f3dB |cascade = 632 21/2 − 1 = 406.8 kHz which is less than the required 1 MHz. Next, we try N = 3. The closed-loop gain of each stage is Af = (1000)1/3 = 10 V/V and thus each stage will have an amount-of-feedback 1 + Aβ = 1000 = 100 10 which results in a stage 3-dB frequency of 10.18 To capacitively couple the output signal to an 8- loudspeaker and obtain fL = 100 Hz, we need a coupling capacitor C, C= 1 2πfL × 8 f3dB |stage = (1 + Aβ)fH = 100 × 20 = 2000 kHz = 2 MHz 1 = 198.9 μF 200 μF 2π × 100 × 8 If closed-loop gain AM f of 10 V/V is obtained from an amplifier whose open-loop gain AM = 1000 V/V, then The 3-dB frequency of the cascade amplifier will be f3dB |cascade = 2 21/3 − 1 1000 = 100 1 + AM β = 10 and 100 fL = = 1 Hz fLf = 100 100 If the required fLf is 50 Hz, then which exceeds the required value of 1 MHz. Thus, we need three identical stages, each with a closed-loop gain of 10 V/V, an amount-of-feedback of 100, and a loop gain fL = 50 × (1 + AM β) Thus, = 50 × 100 = 5000 Hz, β = 0.099 V/V = = 1.02 MHz Aβ = 99 Chapter 10–7 A1 A2 1 + A1 A2 β 10.20 Af = 100 = 10A2 1 + A1 A2 β 0.9A2 900 ⇒ A2 = 10, 000 V/V 10 = (1) β= (1 + A1 A2 β) × 8 = 40 kHz ⇒ 1 + A1 A2 β = 5 899 = 0.0999 V/V 0.9 × 10, 000 10.22 V Substituting in (1) gives A2 = 100 × 5 = 50 V/V 10 1 + 10 × 50 × β = 5 vS ve ⇒ β = 0.008 V/V fLf = = m 100 vO vI 80 1 + A1 A2 β 80 = 16 Hz 5 10.21 Vo ripple = Vn V Figure 1 A1 1 + A1 A2 β vO To reduce Vo ripple to 100 mV, 0.1 = 1 × 0.9 1 + A1 A2 β Slope 0.99 V/V ⇒ 1 + A1 A2 β = 9 Af = A1 A2 1 + A1 A2 β 10 = 0.9A2 9 0 0.01 = 1 × 0.9 1 + A1 A2 β ⇒ 1 + A1 A2 β = 90 Af = A1 A2 1 + A1 A2 β 10 = 0.9A2 90 A2 = 1000 V/V β= Slope 0.99 V/V 8 = 0.089 V/V 0.9 × 100 To reduce Vo ripple to 10 mV, 89 = 0.099 V/V 0.9 × 1000 To reduce Vo ripple to 1 mV, 0.001 = 1 × 0.9 1 + A1 A2 β ⇒ 1 + A1 A2 β = 900 vS 7 mV ⇒ A2 = 100 V/V β= 7 mV Figure 2 Refer to Fig. 1. For v I = +0.7 V, we have v O = 0 and +0.7 vI = = +7 mV ve = μ 100 Similarly, for v I = −0.7 V, we obtain v O = 0 and ve = vI −0.7 = = −7 mV μ 100 Thus, the limits of the deadband are now ±7 mV. Outside the deadband, the gain of the feedback amplifier, that is, v O /v S , can be determined by noting that the open-loop gain A ≡ v O /v e = 100 V/V and the feedback factor β = 1, thus Af ≡ vO A = vS 1 + Aβ 100 = 0.99 V/V 1 + 100 × 1 The transfer characteristic is depicted in Fig. 2. = Chapter 10–8 This figure belongs to Problem 10.23. 10.23 The closed-loop gain for the first (high-gain) segment is Af 1 = 1000 1 + 1000β v S = 0.9 + (1) and that for the second segment is Af 2 = 100 1 + 100β We require Af 1 = 1.1 Af 2 Thus, dividing Eq. (1) by Eq. (2) yields 1.1 = 10 1 + 100β 1 + 1000β 1.1 + 1100β = 10 + 1000β ⇒ β = 0.089 Af 1 = 1000 = 11.1 V/V 1 + 1000 × 0.089 Af 2 = 100 = 10.1 V/V 1 + 100 × 0.089 The first segment ends at |v O | = 10 mV × 1000 = 10 V. This corresponds to vS = 10 V 10 = 0.9 V = Af 1 11.1 The second segment ends at |v O | = 10 + 0.05 × 100 = 15 V. This corresponds to (2) 15 − 10 Af 2 5 = 1.4 V 10.1 Thus, the transfer characteristic of the feedback amplifier can be described as follows: = 0.9 + For |v S | ≤ 0.9 V, v O /v S = 11.1 V/V For 0.9 V ≤ |v S | ≤ 1.4 V, v O /v S = 10.1 V/V For |v S | ≥ 1.4 V, v O = ±15 V The transfer characteristic is shown in the above figure. 10.24 Because the op amp has an infinite input resistance and a zero output resistance, this circuit is a direct implementation of the ideal feedback structure and thus A = 1000 V/V and β= R1 R1 + R2 The ideal closed-loop gain is Af = 1 R2 =1+ β R1 Thus, R2 10 ⇒ R2 = 90 k 10 = 1 + Chapter 10–9 β= 10 = 0.1 V/V 10 + 90 Aβ = 1000 × 0.1 = 100 Af = = A 1 + Aβ 1000 = 9.9 V/V 1 + 100 = A 1 + A × 0.1 ⇒ A = 1010 V/V Thus μ must be increased by the factor 1010 = 2.343 to become 431.1 μ = 2343 V/V To obtain Af that is exactly 10, we use 10 = 1000 1 + Aβ ⇒ Aβ = 99 10.26 Refer to Fig. 10.10. (a) β = β = 0.099 0.099 = R1 R1 + R2 0.099 = 10 10 + R2 ⇒ R2 = 91 k R1 R1 + R2 R2 1 Af ideal = = 1 + β R1 5=1+ R2 1 ⇒ R2 = 4 k (b) From Example 10.2, we have 10.25 Refer to Fig. 10.11. (a) The ideal closed-loop gain is given by Af = 1 R1 + R2 R2 = =1+ β R1 R1 R2 10 10 = 1 + Aβ = (gm1 RD1 )(gm2 RD2 ) R1 1 RD2 + R2 + R1 gm1 ⇒ R2 = 90 k = (4 × 10)(4 × 10) (b) From Example 10.3, we obtain = 22.54 RL [R2 + R1 (Rid + Rs )] RL [R2 + R1 (Rid + Rs )] + ro A= R1 (Rid + Rs ) Rid × [R1 (Rid + Rs )] + R2 Rid + Rs Af = Aβ = μ × 10 [90 + 10 (100 + 100)] 10 [90 + 10 (100 + 100)] + 1 Aβ = 1000 × 100 10 (100 + 100) × [10 (100 + 100)] + 90 100 + 100 = 1000 × 0.9009 × 0.0957 × 0.5 = 43.11 43.11 Aβ = = 431.1 V/V A= β 0.1 A 431.1 = = 9.77 V/V Af = 1 + Aβ 1 + 43.11 (c) To obtain Af = 9.9 V/V, we use 9.9 = A 1 + Aβ 1 × 1 + gm1 R1 = 1 1 × 1 + 4 × 1 10 + 4 + (1 0.25) Aβ 22.54 = = 112.7 V/V β 0.2 A 1 + Aβ 112.7 = 4.79 V/V 1 + 22.54 10.27 (a) The feedback network consists of the voltage divider (R1 R2 ), thus β= R1 R1 + R2 If the loop gain is large, the closed-loop gain approaches the ideal value Af = R2 1 =1+ β R1 =1+ 10 = 11 V/V 1 Chapter 10–10 results in the circuit in Fig. 3 which we can use to determine the loop gain Aβ as follows: (b) 0.1 mA 8.4 V 0.1 mA Q1 Q2 0.003 mA 0.7 V R2 0 0.3 mA 7.7 V 10 k 0.7 mA Rs 100 k 1 mA R1 1 k Figure 3 Figure 1 Vt re1 + Rs Ie1 = (1) Ic1 = α1 Ie1 (2) The dc analysis is shown in Fig. 1 from which we see that Ve2 = −(β2 + 1)Ic1 RL [R2 + (R1 Rib )] IE1 0.1 mA Vr = Ve2 IE2 0.3 mA Combining (1) to (4), we can determine Aβ as VE2 = +7.7 V Aβ ≡ − (c) Setting Vs = 0 and eliminating dc sources, the feedback amplifier circuit simplifies to that shown in Fig. 2. = α1 × R1 Rib (R1 Rib ) + R2 Vr Vt (β2 + 1) RL [R2 + (R1 Rib )] re1 + Rs R1 Rib (R1 Rib ) + R2 Substituting α1 (β2 + 1) = α(β + 1) = β = 100 Q2 B1 Q1 re1 = R2 VT 25 mV = 250 = IE1 0.1 mA Rs = 100 RL = 1 k Rs R1 RL Rib Figure 2 R1 = 1 k R2 = 10 k Rib = 101(0.25 + 0.1) = 35.35 k we obtain Now, breaking the feedback loop at the base of Q1 while terminating the right-hand side of the circuit (behind the break) in the resistance Rib , Rib = (β1 + 1)(re1 + Rs ) 100 1 [10 + (1 35.35)] Aβ = 0.25 + 0.1 × = 23.2 1 35.35 (1 35.35) + 10 (3) (4) Chapter 10–11 (d) A = 23.2 Aβ = = 255.2 V/V β (1/11) RF + RS1 A 1 + Aβ Af = RS2 If = Id 3 Id 1 = If 255.2 = 10.5 V/V = 1 + 23.2 1 gm1 (3) + RS2 RS1 (4) 1 gm1 RS1 + Vr = Id 1 RD1 10.28 (a) The feedback network consists of the voltage divider (RF , RS1 ). Thus, β= RS1 RS1 + RF Substituting the numerical values in (1)–(5), we obtain Vd 2 = −4 × 10Vt = −40Vt and the ideal value of the closed-loop gain is Af = (5) Id 3 = RF 1 =1+ β RS1 (6) Vd 2 1 1 + 0.1 0.9 + 0.1 4 4 Id 3 = 2.935Vd 2 RF 0.1 ⇒ RF = 0.9 k 10 = 1 + (7) If = Id 3 0.1 0.9 + 0.1 (b) 1 4 + 0.1 If = 0.0933Id 3 Id 1 = If RD2 RD1 Vd2 Id1 Vr Vt Q3 Id3 0.1 + 1 4 = 0.286If (9) (10) Combining (6)–(10) gives Vr = −31.33Vt RF 1/gm1 ⇒ Aβ = 31.33 If RS1 RS2 A= Af = Figure 1 = Figure 1 shows the circuit for determining the loop gain. Observe that we have broken the loop at the gate of Q2 where the input resistance is infinite, obviating the need for adding a termination resistance. Also, observe that as usual we have set Vs = 0. To determine the loop gain Aβ ≡ − Vd 2 = −gm2 RD2 Vt 1 1 + RS2 RF + RS1 gm3 gm1 A 1 + Aβ Thus, Af is 0.3 V/V lower than the ideal value of 10 V/V, a difference of −3%. The circuit could be adjusted to make Af exactly 10 by changing β through varying RF . Specifically, 313.3 1 + 313.3β ⇒ β = 0.0968 (1) Vd 2 Aβ 31.33 = = 313.3 V/V β 0.1 313.3 = 9.7 V/V 1 + 31.33 10 = Vr Vt we write the following equations: Id 3 = 0.1 Vr = 10Id 1 Q2 Q1 Id1 Id3 (8) (2) But, β= RS1 RS1 + RF Chapter 10–12 0.0968 = 0.1 0.1 + RF Ie3 = (β3 + 1)Ib2 (3) RE RE + re1 (4) ⇒ RF = 933 Ie1 = Ie3 (an increase of 33 ). Vr = −α1 Ie1 (RC1 rπ2 ) Substituting 10.29 (a) The feedback circuit consists of the voltage divider (RF , RE ). Thus, β= (5) α1 = 0.99 RE RE + RF RC1 = 2 k and, gm2 = RF 1 Af ideal = = 1 + β RE IC2 2 mA = 80 mA/V = VT 0.025 V rπ 2 = β2 100 = 1.25 k = gm2 80 Thus, RE = 0.05 k RF 25 = 1 + 0.05 re1 = ⇒ RF = 1.2 k β3 = 100 (b) Figure 1 below shows the feedback amplifier circuit prepared for determining the loop gain Aβ. Observe that we have eliminated all dc sources, set Vs = 0, and broken the loop at the base of Q2 . We have terminated the broken loop in a resistance rπ 2 . To determine the loop gain Aβ ≡ RC2 = 1 k RF = 1.2 k we obtain Ic2 = 80Vt Vr Vt Ib3 = Ic2 we write the following equations: Ic2 = gm2 Vt Ib3 = Ic2 VT 25 mV = 25 = 0.025 k IE1 1 mA (1) RC2 RC2 + (β3 + 1) [RF + (RE re1 )] (2) (6) 1 1 + 101[1.2 + (0.05 0.025)] = 8.072 × 10−3 Ic2 (7) Ie3 = 101Ib3 (8) This figure belongs to Problem 10.29, part (b). RC2 Ib3 RC1 Ic1 Q1 Vr rp2 Vt Ie1 re1 RE RF Ie3 Figure 1 Q2 Ic2 Q3 Ie3 Chapter 10–13 Ie1 = Ie3 50 = 0.667Ie3 50 + 25 (9) A = 47.62 V/V Vr = −0.99(2 1.25)Ie1 Vr = −0.7615Ie1 (10) Combining (6)–(10) results in A 1 + Aβ ⇒ R2 = 179 k R1 = 821 k 10.30 All MOSFETs are operating at ID = 100 μA = 0.1 mA and |VOV | = 0.2 V, thus 2 × 0.1 = 1 mA/V = 0.2 10.31 Ri = 2 k Ro = 2 k A = 1000 V/V β = 0.1 V/V All devices have ro = 47.62 1 + 47.62β R2 = 0.179 R1 + R2 828.2 = 24.3 V/V 1 + 33.13 gm1,2 A 1 + Aβ ⇒ β = 0.179 V/V Aβ 33.13 A= = = 828.2 V/V β 1/25 = (b) Af = 5= Aβ = 33.13 Af = Thus, |VA | 10 = = 100 k ID 0.1 Loop Gain ≡ Aβ = 1000 × 0.1 = 100 1 + Aβ = 101 (a) Af = Q3 Q4 Vo = Rs Q1 Q2 R1 Vt Vr A 1 + Aβ 1000 = 9.9 V/V 101 Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) = 2 × 101 = 202 k R2 Rof = = Figure 1 Ro 1 + Aβ 2 = 19.8 101 Figure 1 shows the circuit prepared for determining the loop gain Aβ. Vo = −gm1,2 [ro2 ro4 (R1 + R2 )]Vt Vr = R2 Vo = β Vo R1 + R2 Thus, Aβ ≡ − (1) 10.32 Since the output voltage is sampled, the resistance-with-feedback is lower. The reduction is by the factor (1 + Aβ), thus 1 + Aβ = 200 Aβ = 199 Vr = gm1,2 [ro2 ro4 (R1 + R2 )]β Vt Rof = Ro 200 = 1(100 100 1000)β ⇒ Ro = 200 × 100 = 20, 000 = 47.62β = 20 k Chapter 10–14 10.33 A = 1000 V/V Rin = Rif − Rs 667 M Ri = 1 k Ro = ro RL = 1 2 = 0.67 k Rif = 10 k Rof = Thus, the connection at the input is a series one, and Rof = Rout RL 1 + Aβ = Af = = 10 = 10 1 0.67 k Ro = = 0.11 1 + Aβ 6061.6 Rout 0.11 10.35 Refer to the solution to Problem 10.27. A 1 + Aβ (a) β = 1000 = 100 V/V 10 To implement a unity-gain voltage follower, we use β = 1. Thus the amount of feedback is 1 + Aβ = 1 + 1000 = 1001 Af = R1 R1 + R2 1 R2 =1+ β R1 =1+ 10 = 11 V/V 1 (b) From the solution to Problem 10.27, we have and the input resistance becomes IE1 0.1 mA Rif = (1 + Aβ)Ri IE2 0.3 mA = 1001 × 1 = 1001 k = 1.001 M VE2 = +7.7 V 10.34 (a) β = 1 Af ideal = 1 V/V (b) Substituting R1 = ∞ and R2 = 0 in the expression for A in Example 10.4, we obtain A=μ RL Rid RL + ro Rid + Rs Aβ = A × 1 = A (c) A = 104 × 100 2 × 2 + 1 100 + 10 = 6060.6 V/V Aβ = 6060.6 Af = = A 1 + Aβ 6060.6 = 0.9998 V/V 1 + 6060.6 From Example 10.4 with R1 = ∞ and RL = 0, we have Ri = Rs + Rid = 10 + 100 = 110 k Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) = 110 × 6061.6 = 667 M Figure 1 Chapter 10–15 (c) The A circuit is shown in Fig. 1. Ie1 = Vi 37.9 = Rout 1000 ⇒ Rout = 39.4 Vo = Ie2 [RL (R1 + R2 )] = (β2 + 1)α1 Vi RL (R1 + R2 ) R1 R2 Rs + re1 + β1 + 1 Since β1 = β2 = β and α = Vo =β Vi A≡ β , we have β +1 RL (R1 + R2 ) R1 R2 Rs + re1 + β1 + 1 Substituting β = 100, RL = 1 k, R1 = 1 k, R2 = 10 k, Rs = 0.1 k, and re1 = 0.25 k gives A = 100 1 11 0.1 + 0.25 + 1 10 101 = 255.3 V/V Ri = Rs + re1 + R1 R2 β1 + 1 = 0.1 + 0.25 + 1 10 = 0.359 k 101 Ro = RL (R1 + R2 ) = 1 11 = 0.917 k (d) β = = (e) R1 R1 + R2 1 1 = 1 + 10 11 Vo A = Af = Vs 1 + Aβ 1 + Aβ = 1 + Af = 255.3 = 24.21 11 255.3 = 10.5 V/V 24.21 Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) = 0.359 × 24.21 = 8.69 k 0.917 k Ro = = 37.9 1 + Aβ 24.21 Rof = Rout RL R1 R2 β1 + 1 Rs + re1 + Rof = The value of Af (10.5 V/V) is 0.5 less than the ideal value of 11, which is 4.5%. 10.36 (a) Let Vs increase by a small increment. Since Q1 is operating in effect as a CS amplifier, a negative incremental voltage will appear at its drain. Transistor Q2 is also operating as a CS amplifier; thus a positive incremental voltage will appear at its drain. Transistor Q3 is operating as a source follower; thus the signal at its source (which is the output voltage) will follow that at its gate and thus will be positive. The end result is that we are feeding back through the voltage divider (R2 , R1 ) a positive incremental signal that will appear across R1 and thus at the source of the Q1 . This signal, being of the same polarity as the originally assumed change in the signal at the gate of Q1 (Vs ), will subtract from the original change, causing a smaller signal to appear across the gate-source terminals of Q1 . Hence, the feedback is negative. (b) β = R1 R1 + R2 Thus, β= 2 = 0.1 V/V 2 + 18 If the loop gain is large, the closed-loop gain approaches the ideal value 1 R2 Af ideal = = 1 + β R1 Thus, 18 = 10 V/V Af ideal = 1 + 2 (c) VG1 = 0.9 V VS1 = VG1 − VGS1 = VG1 − Vt1 − VOV 1 = 0.9 − 0.5 − 0.2 = 0.2 V VG2 = VDD − VSG2 Rin = Rif − Rs = VDD − |Vt2 | − |VOV 2 | = 8.69 − 0.1 = 8.59 k = 1.80 − 0.5 − 0.2 = 1.1 V Chapter 10–16 Thus, current source I1 will have 0.7-V drop across it, more than sufficient for its proper operation. Since VS1 = 0.2 V the dc current through R1 will be IR1 VS1 0.2 V = 0.1 mA = = R1 2 k Now, a node equation at S1 reveals that because ID1 = 0.1 mA and IR1 = 0.1 mA, the dc current in R2 will be zero. Thus, it will have a zero voltage drop across it and Figure 1 shows the A circuit as well as the β circuit and how the loading-effect resistances R11 and R22 are determined. To determine A, let’s first determine the small-signal parameters of all transistors as well as ro of each of the three current sources. gm1 = 2ID1 2 × 0.1 = = 1 mA/V VOV 1 0.2 ro1 = |VA | 10 = 100 k = ID1 0.1 VS3 = VS1 = 0.2 V Thus, current source I3 will have across it, the minimum voltage required to keep it operating properly. Finally, rocs1 = |VA | 10 = = 100 k I1 0.1 gm2 = 2ID2 2 × 0.1 = 1 mA/V = VOV 2 0.2 ro2 = |VA | 10 = = 100 k ID2 0.1 VG3 = VS3 + VGS3 = VS3 + Vt3 + VOV 3 = 0.2 + 0.5 + 0.2 = 0.9 V Thus, current source I2 will have across it a voltage more than sufficient to keep it operating properly. (d) rocs2 = |VA | 10 = = 100 k I2 0.1 gm3 = 2ID3 2 × 0.1 = = 1 mA/V VOV 3 0.2 ro3 = |VA | 10 = = 100 k ID3 0.1 rocs3 = |VA | 10 = 100 k = I3 0.1 Refer to the A circuit. Transistor Q1 is a CS amplifier with a resistance R11 in its source: Rs = R11 = R1 R2 = 2 18 = 1.8 k Transistor Q1 will have an effective transconductance: Gm1 = gm1 2 = 0.43 mA/V = 1 + gm Rs 1 + 2 × 1.8 The output resistance of Q1 will be Ro1 = (1 + gm1 Rs )ro1 = (1 + 2 × 1.8) × 100 = 460 k The total resistance at the drain of Q1 is Rd 1 = rocs1 Ro1 Figure 1 = 100 460 = 82.1 k Chapter 10–17 Thus, the voltage gain of the first stage is A1 = −Gm1 Rd 1 = −0.43 × 82.1 = −35.3 V/V Rof = 935 = 5.6 166 Note: This problem, though long, is extremely valuable as it exercises the student’s knowledge in many aspects of amplifier design. The gain of the second stage is A2 = −gm2 (rocs2 ro2 ) = −1(100 100) = −50 V/V To determine the gain of the third stage, we first determine the total resistance between the source of Q3 and ground: Rs3 = rocs3 ro3 (R1 + R2 ) Rs3 = 100 100 20 = 14.3 k (b) Figure 1 on the next page shows the circuit prepared for dc analysis. We see that Thus, A3 = = 10.37 (a) Refer to Fig. P10.37. Assume that for some reason v S increases. This will increase the differential input signal (v S − v O ) applied to the differential amplifier. The drain current of Q1 will increase, and this increase will be mirrored in the drain current of Q4 . The increase in iD4 will cause the voltage at the gate of Q5 to rise. Since Q5 is operating as a source follower, the voltage at its source, v O , will follow and increase. This will cause the differential input signal (v S − v O ) to decrease, thus counteracting the originally assumed change. Thus, the feedback is negative. Rs3 Rs3 + 1 gm3 14.3 = 0.935 V/V 1 14.3 + 1 ID1 = ID2 = 100 μA ID3 = 100 μA ID4 = 300 μA ID5 = 0.8 mA The overall voltage gain A can now be found as A = A1 A2 A3 = −35.3 × −50 × 0.935 = 1650 V/V For Q1 and Q2 , use 1 W 2 ID = μn Cox VOV 2 L 1 20 2 × 120 × VOV 1,2 2 1 (e) We already found β in (b) as 100 = β = 0.1 V/V ⇒ VOV 1,2 = 0.29 V (f) 1 + Aβ = 1 + 1650 × 0.1 = 166 For Q3 , use Af = A 1650 = = 9.94 V/V 1 + Aβ 166 which is lower by 0.06 or 0.6% than the ideal value obtained in (b). (g) Rof = Ro 1 + Aβ 1 W μp Cox |VOV 3 |2 2 L 100 = 1 40 × 60 × |VOV 3 |2 1 2 ⇒ |VOV 3 | = 0.29 V To obtain Ro refer to the output part of the A circuit. Ro = (R1 + R2 ) rocs3 ro3 ID = 1 gm3 Since VSG4 = VSG3 , we have |VOV 4 | = |VOV 3 | = 0.29 V Finally for Q5 , use 1 20 2 × 120 × × VOV 5 2 1 = 20 100 100 1 800 = = 935 ⇒ VOV 5 = 0.82 V Chapter 10–18 This figure belongs to Problem 10.37, part (b). 2.5 V Q3 (40/1) Q4 (120/1) Q5 (20/1) 300 A Q1 (20/1) VO Q2 (20/1) 0.8 mA 200 A Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 10.37, part (d). Q3 Q4 3Id1 Q5 Vd4 Id1 Vo Q1 Q2 Vi 0 Id1, 2 1 2 1 2 R11 0 R22 Figure 2 If perfect matching pertains, then VD4 = VD3 = VDD − VSG3 = 2.5 − |Vt | − |VOV 3 | = 2.5 − 0.7 − 0.29 = 1.51 V which is approximately zero, as stated in the Problem statement. (c) gm1 = gm2 = gm3 = = 2 × 0.1 = 0.7 mA/V 0.29 VO = VD4 − VGS5 = VD4 − Vt − VOV 5 = 1.51 − 0.7 − 0.82 = −0.01 V 2ID |VOV | gm4 = 2 × 0.3 2 mA/V 0.29 gm5 = 2 × 0.8 2 mA/V 0.82 Chapter 10–19 ro1 = ro2 = ro3 = = |VA | |V | × L = A ID ID 24 × 1 = 240 k 0.1 (e) Af = = A 1 + Aβ 82.6 = 0.988 V/V 1 + 82.6 Ro 492 = = 5.9 1 + Aβ 1 + 82.6 ro4 = 24 = 80 k 0.3 Rof = ro5 = 24 = 30 k 0.8 Rout = Rof = 5.9 (d) Figure 2 on the previous page shows the A circuit. Observe that since the β network is simply a wire connecting the output node to the gate of Q2 , we have R11 = 0 and R22 = ∞. To determine A, we write Id 1,2 (f) To obtain a closed-loop gain of 5 V/V, we connect a voltage divider in the feedback loop, as shown in Fig. 3. Q5 Vi 1 = = gm1,2 Vi 2/gm1,2 2 Since W L 4 will be W =3 L , the drain current of Q4 3 R1 Id 4 = 3Id 1 3 = gm1,2 Vi 2 The voltage at the drain of Q4 will be Vd 4 = Id 4 ro4 = 3 gm1,2 ro4 Vi 2 Figure 3 β= R1 R1 + R2 Af = A 1 + Aβ Finally, Vo is related to Vd 4 as Vo = Vd 4 5= ro5 ro5 + 1 gm5 Selecting R1 = 1 M, we obtain 3 Vo = gm1,2 ro4 Vi 2 ro5 1 ro5 + gm5 Substituting numerical values, we obtain A= 30 3 × 0.7 × 80 × 2 30 + 0.5 = 82.6 V/V The output resistance Ro is Ro = ro5 1 gm5 = 30 0.5 = 0.492 k = 492 82.6 1 + 82.6β ⇒ β = 0.188 Thus, A≡ R2 Q2 0.188 = 1 1 + R2 ⇒ R2 = 4.319 M Note that by selecting large values for R1 and R2 , we have ensured that their loading effect on the A circuit would be negligible. The output resistance will be Rout = 5 × 5.9 = 29.5 . 10.38 (a) Refer to Fig. P10.30. Let Vs increase by a positive increment. This will cause the drain current of Q1 to increase. The increase in Id 1 will be fed to the Q3 − Q4 mirror, which will provide a corresponding increase in the drain current of Q4 . The latter current will cause the voltage at the output node to rise. A fraction of the increase in Vo is applied through the divider (R1 , R2 ) to the Chapter 10–20 This figure belongs to Problem 10.38, part (c). Q3 Q4 Vo R1 Rs Q1 Vi Q2 R22 R2 R2 R1 R11 0 R1 1 R2 Ro 2 R1 1 R2 2 R11 R22 Figure 1 gate of Q2 . The increase in the voltage of the gate of Q2 will subtract from the initially assumed increase of the voltage of the gate of Q1 , resulting in a smaller increase in the differential voltage applied to the (Q1 , Q2 ) pair. Thus, the feedback counter acts the originally assumed change, verifying that it is negative. ro2 = ro4 = |VA | 10 = 100 k = ID3,4 0.1 R22 = R1 + R2 = 1 M A = 1(100 100 1000) = 47.62 V/V (b) The negative feedback will cause the dc voltage at the gate of Q2 to be approximately equal to the dc voltage at the gate of Q1 , that is, zero. Now, with VG2 0, the dc current in R2 will be zero and similarly the dc current in R1 will be zero, resulting in VO = 0 V dc. This is identical to the value found in the solution to Problem 10.30. (d) A Vo = Af = Vs 1 + Aβ (c) Figure 1 shows the A circuit. It also shows how the loading effect of the β network on the A circuit, namely R11 and R22 , are found. The gain of the A circuit can be written by inspection as 5= 47.62 1 + 47.62β A = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 R22 ) ⇒ β = 0.179 Thus, where gm1,2 = = 2ID1,2 VOV 1,2 2 × 0.1 = 1 mA/V 0.2 R2 = 0.179 R1 + R2 R2 = 0.179 M = 179 k Chapter 10–21 R1 = 1000 − 179 = 821 k Using β = 0.179, we obtain Again, these values are identical to those found in Problem 10.30. Af = which is identical to the value found in (f) above. (e) Refer to Fig. 1 on the preceding page. Ro = R22 ro2 ro4 10.39 All transistors have L = 1 μm, thus all have |VA | = |VA | × L = 10 × 1 = 10 V. Also, all have |Vt | = 0.75 V. = 1000 100 100 = 47.62 k Rout = Rof = = Ro 1 + Aβ (a) Figure 1 shows the circuit prepared for dc design. We have also indicated some of the current and voltage values. We now find the (W/L) ratios utilizing 1 W 2 VOV ID = μn Cox 2 L 47.62 1 + 47.62 × 0.179 = 5 k for the NMOS transistors, and 1 W |VOV |2 ID = μp Cox 2 L This value cannot be found using the loop-gain analysis method of Problem 10.30. (f) With RL = 10 k, for the PMOS devices. Vo RL =5× Vs RL + Rout 5× 8.26 = 3.33 V/V 1 + 8.26 × 0.179 For Q6 , 1 × 100 × 2 W ⇒ = 16 L 6 10 = 3.33 V/V 10 + 5 50 = (g) As an alternative to (f), we shall redo the analysis of the A circuit in (c) above with RL = 10 k included: W L × 0.252 6 For Q7 , A = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 R22 RL ) 100 μA (W/L)7 = =2 (W/L)6 50 μA = 1(100 100 1000 10) ⇒ (W/L)7 = 2 × 16 = 32 = 8.26 V/V This figure belongs to Problem 10.39, part (a). VDD 2.5 V 1.5 V Q3 Q4 50 A 80 k 2.5(1.5) 80 50 A Q6 1.5 V 50 A Q1 Q2 50 A 50 A 100 A Q7 1.5 V VSS 2.5 V Figure 1 Q5 250 A VO 0 V 250 A Q8 Chapter 10–22 For Q8 , (c) gm1,2 = (W/L)8 250 μA =5 = (W/L)6 50 μA W ⇒ = 5 × 16 = 80 L 8 = 1 × 100 × 2 50 = ⇒ W L = 1 W L W L 1 × 50 × 2 ⇒ W L = 3 × 0.252 1,2 W L = 16 × 0.252 3,4 = 32 4 VOV 5 = 1.5 − 0.75 = 0.75 V 1 W 250 = × 100 × × 0.752 2 L 5 ⇒ |VA | = ID 10 = 100 k 0.01 ro5 = ro8 = VGS5 = 1.5 V W L ro7 = 2 Finally, since VG3 = VD4 = VD3 = 1.5 V and we require VO = 0 V, we have 10 = 200 k 0.05 W L 2 × 0.25 2ID = = 0.67 mA/V |VOV 5 | 0.75 (d) ro1 = ro2 = ro3 = ro4 = ro6 = For Q3 and Q4 , 50 = 2 × 0.05 = 0.5 mA/V 0.2 gm5 = For Q1 and Q2 , 2ID1,2 VOV 1,2 10 = 40 k 0.25 (e) Figure 2 on the next page shows the A circuit, the β circuit, and how the loading effects of the β circuit on the A circuit, namely R11 and R22 , are determined. Vg5 = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) Vi = 0.5(200 200) = 50 V/V Vo = Vg5 Rs Rs + 1 gm5 where Rs = ro8 ro5 (R1 + R2 ) RL = 8.9 5 (b) The maximum value of VICM is limited by Q1 leaving the saturation region, = 40 40 100 100 = 14.3 k Thus, VICM max = VD1 + Vt Vo 14.3 = 0.905 V/V = Vg5 14.3 + (1/0.67) = 1.5 + 0.75 = 2.25 V A= The minimum value of VICM is limited by the need to keep Q7 in saturation. This is achieved by keeping VD7 at a minimum voltage of Vg5 Vo Vo = × Vi Vi Vg5 = 50 × 0.905 = 45.3 V/V Af = 10 = −2.5 + |VOV 7 | = −2.5 + 0.25 = −2.25 V A 1 + Aβ 45.3 1 + 45.3β Thus, 10 = VICM min = −2.25 + VGS1 ⇒ β = 0.078 = −2.25 + 1 = −1.25 V R2 = 0.078 R1 + R2 Thus, R2 = 7.8 k −1.25 V ≤ VICM ≤ +2.25 V R1 = 100 − 7.8 = 92.2 k Chapter 10–23 This figure belongs to Problem 10.39, part (e). Q3 Q4 Vg5 Q1 Vi Q5 Vo Q2 R1 R2 ro8 R1 RL R2 R11 A Circuit R2 1 R22 0 R1 R1 1 2 b Circuit R2 b R1R2 R2 Ro 2 1 R1 R2 2 R11 R2 R1 R22 R1R2 Figure 2 (f) Refer to Fig. 2. Ro = RL (R1 + R2 ) ro8 ro5 = Rs 1 gm5 1 = 14.3 (1/0.67) gm5 = 1.36 k Rof = = Ro 1 + Aβ 1.36 k 300 1 + 45.3 × 0.078 originally assumed increase at the negative input terminal, verifying that the feedback is negative. 1 (b) Af ideal = β where β= R1 R1 + R2 Thus, to obtain an ideal closed-loop gain of 5 V/V we need β = 0.2: 0.2 = 20 20 + R2 Rout RL = Rof ⇒ R2 = 80 k ⇒ Rout 300 (c) Figure 1 on the next page shows the smallsignal equivalent circuit of the feedback amplifier. 10.40 (a) Refer to Fig. P10.40. If Vs increases, the output of A1 will decrease and this will cause the output of A2 to increase. This, in turn, causes the output of A3 , which is Vo , to increase. A portion of the positive increment in Vo is fed back to the positive input terminal of A1 through the voltage divider (R2 , R1 ), The increased voltage at the positive input terminal of A1 counteracts the (d) Figure 2 on the next page shows the A circuit and the β circuit together with the determination of its loading effects, R11 , and R22 . We can write 82 V1 = −0.766 V/V =− Vi 82 + 9 + 16 V2 = 20V1 × 5 = 12.195V1 3.2 + 5 V3 = −20V2 (20 20) = −200V2 Chapter 10–24 This figure belongs to Problem 10.40, part (c). Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 10.40, part (d). Figure 2 Vo = V3 1 100 = 0.497V3 (1 100) + 1 (g) From the A circuit, Thus, A≡ Vo = 0.497 × −200 × 12.195 × −0.766 Vi = 928.5 V/V (e) β = 20 = 0.2 V/V 20 + 80 1 + Aβ = 1 + 928.5 × 0.2 = 186.7 (f) Af ≡ = which is nearly equal to the ideal value of 5 V/V. Vo A = Vs 1 + Aβ 928.5 = 4.97 V/V 186.7 Ri = 9 + 82 + 16 = 107 k Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) = 107 × 186.7 = 19.98 M Rin = Rif − Rs 19.98 M (h) From the A circuit, Ro = RL R22 1 k = 1 100 1 = 497.5 Rof = Ro 497.5 = = 2.66 1 + Aβ 186.7 Chapter 10–25 Rout RL = Rof R11 = RE RF = 50 1200 = 48 Rout 1000 = 2.66 gm2 = IC2 IE2 2 mA = 80 mA/V = VT VT 0.025 mA rπ2 = 100 β2 = = 1.25 k 80 80 Rout 2.66 (i) fHf = fH (1 + Aβ) α1 = 0.99 1 = 100 × 186.7 Vc1 RC1 1.25 = −10 = − Vi 0.025 + 0.048 = 18.67 kHz (j) If A1 drops to half its nominal value, A will drop to half its nominal value: 1 A = × 928.5 = 464.25 2 and Af becomes Af = 464.25 = 4.947 V/V 1 + 464.25 × 0.2 Thus, the percentage change in Af is = 4.947 − 4.97 = −0.47% 4.97 10.41 (a) Figure 1 on the next page shows the A circuit and the circuit for determining β as well as the determination of the loading effects of the β circuit. (b) If Aβ is large, then Af ≡ ⇒ RC1 = 1.75 k Next consider the second stage composed of the CE transistor Q2 . The load resistance of the second stage is composed of RC2 in parallel with the input resistance of emitter-follower Q3 . The latter resistance is given by Ri3 = (β3 + 1)(re3 + R22 ) where re3 = R22 = RF + RE = 1.2 + 0.05 = 1.25 k Thus, Ri3 = 101 × 1.25 = 126.3 k A2 ≡ Vc2 = −gm2 (RC2 Ri3 ) Vb2 −50 = −80(RC2 126.3) Vo 1 Vs β ⇒ RC2 = 628 Since (e) A = A1 A2 A3 RE β= RF + RE where we have A3 = Af = VT 25 mV =5 = IE3 5 mA RF + RE RE (c) 25 = 1 + Q.E.D. RF 50 ⇒ RF = 1.2 k (d) Refer to the A circuit in Fig. 1. The voltage gain of Q1 is given by Vc1 RC1 rπ 2 = −α1 Vi re1 + R11 R22 1.25 = = 0.996 V/V R22 + re3 1.25 + 0.005 A ≡ −10 × −50 × 0.996 = 498 V/V Af ≡ Vo = Vs 498 1 + 498 × 50 1250 = 23.8 V/V (f) Refer to the A circuit in Fig. 1. Ri = (β1 + 1)(re1 + R11 ) where Ri = 101(0.025 + 0.048) VT 25 mV re1 = = = 25 IE1 1 mA = 7.37 k Chapter 10–26 This figure belongs to Problem 10.41, part (a). RF Vf 1 RF 2 Vo RE RE 1 2 b Circuit RE b RF RE R11 RE // RF 0 RF RE 1 2 R22 RE RF RC2 RC1 Q3 Q2 Vo Vi Q1 R22 Ri R11 Ro A Circuit Figure 1 Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) Rout = Rof = where 1 + Aβ = 1 + = 498 = 20.92 25 Rif = 7.37 × 20.92 = 154 k RC2 Ro = R22 re3 + β3 + 1 = 1.25 0.005 + = 11.1 0.628 101 Ro 1 + Aβ 11.1 = 0.53 20.92 10.42 To obtain Af ≡ RF = β = Io 10 mA/V, we select Vs 1 = 100 Af From Example 10.6, we obtain A= ≡ gm (RF Rid ro2 ) μ RF 1 + gm (RF Rid ro2 ) 2(0.1 100 20) 1000 0.1 k 1 + 2(0.1 100 20) Chapter 10–27 = 10, 000 × 0.1658 First, we express Id 2 in terms of Vt : = 1.658 A/V Id 2 = −gm2 Vt Af = A 1 + Aβ (1) Then we determine Id 1 : Id 1 = Id 2 1658 = = 9.94 mA/V 1 + 1658 × 0.1 RM RM + RF + (2) 1 gm1 The returned voltage Vr can now be obtained as Vr = Id 1 RD 10.43 (a) (3) Combining Eqs. (1)–(3), we find Vr /Vt : IF RF Vr =− Vt RM gm2 RD RM RM + RF + Io 1 gm1 Thus, Aβ = Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the β network with the input port short-circuited. Thus, β≡ If RM =− Io RM + RF gm2 RD RM RM + RF + Dividing the expression for Aβ by RM β=− yields RM + RF A=− RF 1 Af ideal = = − 1 + β RM gm2 RD 1 + 1/[gm1 (RM + RF )] (c) A = − (b) Figure 2 below shows the circuit for determining the loop gain Aβ, 1 gm1 4 × 10 1 + 1/[4 × 1] = −32 A/A Af = −5 = − 32 1 − 32 × β β = −0.169 A/A RD Vr Q2 Vt Id2 Id1 Q1 RL RF Aβ = − Vr Vt RM = −0.169 RM + RF RM = 0.169 × 1 = 0.169 k = 169 10.44 (a) Refer to Fig. P10.44(b). Id1 RM Figure 2 − β≡ If 1 =− Vo RF 1 Af ideal = = −RF β For Af ideal = −1 k, we have RF = 1 k Q.E.D. Chapter 10–28 Ro1 = 100 k (b) β = 200 RF ro Vr Rid Vt V1 R11 = 10 k Rid mV1 Rs = 10 k RL = 10 k To determine A, Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the circuit for determining the loop gain Aβ: Vr Aβ ≡ − Vt Io Vi A≡ we write V1 = Vi Writing Vr in terms of V1 = Vt yields Vr = −μVt R22 = 200 = Vi Rid Rid + RF + ro Ri1 Ri1 + Rs + R11 1 10 = Vi 10 + 10 + 10 3 Io = Gm V1 Thus, Aβ ≡ − Vr Rid =μ Vt Rid + RF + ro (c) Aβ = 1000 100 100 + 1 + 1 = 980.4 980.4 980.4 A= = β −1/RF = −980.4 k = 0.6 × 980.4 = −0.999 k 1 + 980.4 Ro1 Ro1 + RL + R22 100 Vi 100 + 10 + 0.2 = 0.544 Vi 1 Io = 0.544 × Vi = 0.1815 Vi 3 A = 0.1815 A/V = Io A = Vs 1 + Aβ 0.1815 0.1815 = = 4.88 mA/V 1 + 0.1815 × 200 1 + 36.2 Rif = Ri (1 + Aβ) Ri is obtained from the A circuit as 10.45 Ri = Rs + Ri1 + R11 = 10 + 10 + 10 = 30 k Thus, Rif = 30 × 37.2 = 1.116 M Figure 1 (2) Combining (1) and (2), we obtain Af = A Af = 1 + Aβ =− Q.E.D. (1) Rin = Rif − Rs Figure 1 shows the A circuit where = 1.116 − 0.010 = 1.006 M Ri1 = 10 k 1 M Chapter 10–29 Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) where RE2 = 100 , R22 (from β circuit) = 740 , re3 = 5 , RC2 = 5 k, β3 = 100; where Ro is obtained from the A circuit as thus, Ro = RL + Ro1 + R22 Ro = 100 740 5 + = 10 + 100 + 0.2 = 110.2 k 5000 101 = 33.7 Rof = 110.2 × 37.2 = 4.1 M Ro 1 + Aβ Rof = Rout = Rof − RL = 4.1 − 0.01 = 4.09 M = 10.46 (a) 33.7 = 0.14 1 + 246.3 RF 640 10.47 (a) RE1 1 2 RF 100 Vf Figure 1 RS1 RS2 Io Figure 1 shows the β circuit from which we obtain β= = Figure 1 RE1 RE1 + RF Figure 1 shows the β network. The value of β can be obtained from 100 = 0.135 V/V 100 + 640 Vf Io (b) For Aβ 1, β≡ Ve3 1 = Af ideal = = 7.4 V/V Vs β = (c) If Aβ 1, then RS1 RS2 RS2 + RF + RS1 Af RC2 RC3 600 5 k 1 1 1 RF = + + β RS1 RS2 RS1 RS2 For Af 100 mA/V, 100 = Q3 (1) 1 RF 1 + + 0.1 0.1 0.1 × 0.1 ⇒ RF = 0.8 k Vo Q2 RE2 100 R22 (b) Figure 2 on the next page shows the A circuit and the determination of the loading effects of the β circuit, namely R11 and R22 , R11 = RS1 (RF + RS2 ) Ro Figure 2 = 100 (800 + 100) = 80 R22 = RS2 (RF + RS1 ) = 80 The value of A is determined as follows: Figure 2 shows the portion of the A circuit relevant for calculating Ro : Ro = RE2 R22 re3 + RC2 β3 + 1 RD1 Vd 1 =− Vi (1/gm1 ) + R11 =− 10 = −30.3 V/V (1/4) + 0.08 Chapter 10–30 This figure belongs to Problem 10.47, part (b). Figure 2 Vd 2 = −gm2 RD2 = −4 × 10 = −40 V/V Vd 1 1 Io = Vd 2 1/gm5 + R22 = 1 3 mA/V 0.25 + 0.08 (d) From the A circuit in Fig. 2, we have Ro = ro3 + R22 + gm3 ro3 R22 = 20 + 0.08 + 4 × 20 × 0.08 = 26.48 k Rout = Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) Thus, Io = 3 × −40 × −30.3 = 3636 mA/V A= Vi = 26.48 × 37.36 = 989.3 k (e) (c) β = 0.01 k RF RF 1 + Aβ = 1 + 3636 × 0.01 = 37.36 Af = 1 RS1 2 Io 3636 = 97.3 mA/V = Vi 37.36 1 RS1 R11 Difference from design value 0 97.3 − 100 × 100 = 100 = −2.7% To make Af exactly 100 mA/V, we can increase RF (see Eq. (1) to appreciate why we need to increase RF ). 1 RF RS1 2 R22 Figure 3 Chapter 10–31 Figure 3 on the preceding page shows the β circuit for the case the output is Vo . β= Af = = RS1 RS1 + RF A 1 + Aβ 306.9 = 8.74 V/V 35.1 (f) From the A circuit in Figure 4, we have 1 100 = = 100 + 800 9 Ro = R22 Also shown is how R11 and R22 are determined in this case: Ro = 900 250 = 195.7 R11 = RS1 RF = 100 800 = 88.9 Rout2 = Rof = R22 = RF + RS1 = 800 + 100 = 900 = RD1 RD2 Vd2 1 gm3 Ro 1 + Aβ 195.7 = 5.6 35.1 10.48 (a) Q3 Vd1 Vo Q1 Vi R22 R11 Figure 1 Ro Figure 4 Figure 4 shows the A circuit for this case. To determine A, we write Vd 1 RD1 =− Vi 1/gm1 + R11 Vd 1 10 = −29.5 V/V =− Vi 0.25 + 0.0889 Vd 2 = −gm2 RD2 = −4 × 10 = −40 V/V Vd 1 Vo = Vd 2 R22 R22 + 1 gm5 = 88.9 = 0.26 V/V 88.9 + 250 Thus, A≡ Vo = 0.26 × −40 × −29.5 = 306.9 V/V Vi 1 + Aβ = 1 + 306.9 × 1 = 35.1 9 which is a little lower than the value (37.36) found when we analyzed the amplifier as a transconductance amplifier. Figure 2 Figure 1 shows the small-signal equivalent circuit of the feedback amplifier. Observe that the resistance RF senses the output current Io and provides a voltage Io RF that is subtracted from Vs . Thus the feedback network is composed of the resistance RF , as shown in Fig. 2. Because the feedback is of the series-series type, the loading resistances R11 and R22 are determined as indicated in Fig. 2, R11 = RF R22 = RF Chapter 10–32 (b) The β circuit is shown in Fig. 2 and = β = RF gm 1 + gm RF + RF ro From the A circuit in Fig. 3, we have Figure 3 shows the A circuit. Ro = ro + RF (c) Rof = (1 + Aβ)Ro gm ro RF = 1+ (ro + RF ) ro + RF Io Vgs V i gmVgs ro = ro + RF + gm ro RF Ro R11 Io which is a familiar relationship! RF 10.49 (a) The β circuit is shown in Fig. 1: β = RF Figure 3 For Aβ 1, Af ≡ Io /Vs approaches the ideal value 1 1 Af ideal = = β RF To determine A = Io /Vi , we write Vgs = Vi Io = gm Vgs ro ro + RF To obtain Af 5 mA/V, we use RF = Io ro A≡ = gm Vi ro + RF (b) Determining the loading effects of the β network is illustrated in Fig. 1: gm ro RF 1 + Aβ = 1 + ro + RF R11 = R22 = RF Io A = Af = Vs 1 + Aβ = 1 = 0.2 k = 200 5 Figure 2 (next page) shows the A circuit. An expression for A ≡ Io /Vi can be derived as follows: gm ro /(ro + RF ) 1 + gm ro RF /(ro + RF ) V1 = Vi (1) This figure belongs to Problem 10.49, part (a). 0 1 RF 2 1 V1 RF b 0 1 RF 2 V1 RF Io 0 2 1 R11 RF RF 2 R22 RF Figure 1 Io Chapter 10–33 This figure belongs to Problem 10.49, part (b). Io Vi V1 Vgs mV1 ro gmVgs Ro R11 RF R22 RF Io Figure 2 Vgs = μV1 − Io RF (2) ro ro + RF (3) Io = gm Vgs Rof = 20 + 0.2 + 1001 × 2 × 20 × 0.2 = 20 + 0.2 + 8008 = 8028.2 k 8 M Combining Eqs. (1)–(3) yields A≡ μgm ro Io = Vi ro + RF + gm ro RF For μ = 1000 V/V, gm = 2 mA/V, ro = 20 k, and RF = 0.2 k, we have A= 1000 × 2 × 20 20 + 0.2 + 2 × 20 × 0.2 = 1418.4 mA/V (c) Aβ = μgm ro RF ro + RF + gm ro RF Aβ = 283.7 10.50 Figure 1 on the next page shows the equivalent circuit with Vs = 0 and a voltage Vx applied to the collector for the purpose of determining the output resistance Ro , Ro ≡ Vx Ix Some of the analysis is displayed on the circuit diagram. Since the current entering the emitter node is equal to Ix , we can write for the emitter voltage Ve = Ix [Re (rπ + Rb )] 1 + Aβ = 284.7 Io A (d) Af ≡ = Vs 1 + Aβ 1418.4 = 4.982 mA/V = 284.7 which is very close to the ideal value of 5 mA/V. (1) The base current can be obtained using the current-divider rule applied to Re and (rπ + Rb ) as Ib = −Ix Re Re + rπ + Rb (2) The voltage from collector to ground is equal to Vx and can be expressed as the sum of the voltage drop across ro and Ve , (e) From the A circuit in Fig. 2, we have Vx = (Ix − βIb )ro + Ve Ro = ro + RF + gm ro RF Substituting for Ve from (1) and for Ib from (2), we obtain Vx Ro = = ro + [Re (rπ + Rb )] Ix 1 + Aβ = 1 + μgm ro RF ro + RF + gm ro RF Rof = (1 + Aβ)Ro = ro + RF + gm ro RF + μgm ro RF = ro + RF + (μ + 1)gm ro RF μgm ro RF Ro = 20 + 0.2 + 2 × 20 × 0.2 = 28.2 k + Re βro Re + rπ + Rb = ro + [Re (rπ + Rb )] 1 + ro β rπ + Rb Since β = gm rπ , we obtain Ro = ro + [Re (rπ + Rb )] 1 + gm ro rπ rπ + Rb Q.E.D. Chapter 10–34 This figure belongs to Problem 10.50. Ib B C Ix (Ix 2 bIb) rp bIb ro Ve Rb E V x Ix Re Figure 1 For Rb = 0, 10.51 Ro = ro + (Re rπ )(1 + gm ro ) Ix The maximum value of Ro will be obtained when Re rπ . If Re approaches infinity (zero signal current in the emitter), Ro approaches the theoretical maximum: (Ix 2 bIb) Ib rp bIb Romax = ro + rπ (1 + gm ro ) = ro + rπ + βro ro Ix (3) V x 0 βro E B Ix C Ix ( b1)Ix rp bIx Ix ro Rout V x Vx Ix Figure 1 E Figure 2 The situation that pertains in the circuit when Re = ∞ is illustrated in Fig. 2. Observe that since the signal current in the emitter is zero, the base current will be equal to the collector current (Ix ) and in the direction indicated. The controlled-source current will be βIx , and this current adds to Ix to provide a current (β + 1)Ix in the output resistance ro . A loop equation takes the form Vx = (β + 1)Ix ro + Ix rπ and thus Vx = rπ + (β + 1)ro Ro ≡ Ix which is identical to the result in Eq. (3). Figure 1 shows the situation that pertains in the transistor when μ is so large that Vb 0 and Ie 0. Observe that Ib = −Ix Writing a loop equation for the C-E-B, we obtain Vx = (Ix − βIb )ro − Ib rπ Substituting Ib = −Ix , we obtain Rout = Vx = rπ + (β + 1)ro Ix or if β is denoted hfe , Rout = rπ + (hfe + 1)ro Q.E.D. Thus, for large amounts of feedback, Rout is limited to this value, which is approximately hfe ro independent of the amount of feedback. This phenomenon does not occur in MOSFET circuits where hfe = ∞. Chapter 10–35 10.52 R2 V1 1 R3 R1 2 Io 0 R2 1 0 R1 2 R3 R2 R1 2 1 R3 R11 R22 Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the feedback network fed with a current Io to determine β: β≡ Vf R1 R3 = Io R1 + R2 + R3 Io 1 Vs β Vg (1/gm ) + R22 Thus, A≡ Thus, Af = Vg = μVi Io = For Aβ 1, Af = The A circuit is shown in Fig. 2. We can write 1 R2 1 + + R3 R1 R3 R1 Io μ = Vi (1/gm ) + R22 Since β = 0.01, we have For R1 = R3 = 0.1 k and Af = 100 mA/V, Aβ = R2 + 10 0.01 ⇒ R2 = 0.8 k 100 = 10 + = To obtain the loading effects of the feedback network, refer to Fig. 1. 0.01μ 1/gm + R22 0.01μ = 9.17 × 10−3 μ 1 + 0.09 For a 60-dB amount of feedback, 1 + Aβ = 1000 R11 = R3 (R2 + R1 ) = 100 (800 + 100) = 90 Aβ = 999 R22 = R1 (R2 + R3 ) 9.17 × 10−3 μ = 999 = 100 (800 + 100) = 90 ⇒ μ = 1.09 × 105 V/V Rout = Rof = (1 + Aβ)Ro = 1000Ro where Ro can be obtained from the A circuit as Vi m R11 Vg Io Ro Ro = ro + R22 + gm ro R22 = 50 + 0.09 + 1 × 50 × 0.09 R22 = 54.6 k Thus, Figure 2 Rout = 1000 × 54.6 = 54.6 M (1) (2) Chapter 10–36 10.53 (a) Since Vs has a zero dc component, the gate of Q1 is at zero dc voltage. The negative feedback will force the gate of Q2 to be approximately at the same dc voltage as that at the gate of Q1 , thus (c) From the β circuit in Fig. 1 and noting that the feedback topology in series-series, the loading effects of the feedback network are VO = 0 Figure 2 shows the A circuit. We can write VD1 = 1.2 − VSG3 Vg5 = −gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) Vi R11 = R22 = RF = 10 k = 1.2 − |Vt | − |VOV 3 | Vg5 (1/gm5 ) + R22 = 1.2 − 0.4 − 0.2 = +0.6 V Io = VD2 = VO + VGS5 Thus, = 0 + Vt + VOV 5 A≡ = 0.6 V Io gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) = Vi (1/gm5 ) + R22 gm1,2 = (b) Vf 1 RF 2 = Io 2ID1,2 VOV 1,2 2 × 0.1 = 1 mA/V 0.2 ro2 = ro4 = Vf b RF Io = Figure 1 20 = 200 k 0.1 gm5 = The feedback network is shown in Fig. 1, from which we find A= β = RF = 10 k |VA | ID2,4 2ID5 2 × 0.8 = = 8 mA/V VOV 5 0.2 1 × (200 200) 0.125 + 10 = 9.88 mA/V For Aβ 1, Af 1 1 = β RF Io A = Af = Vs 1 + Aβ Af = 1 = 0.1 mA/V 10 k = 9.88 = 0.099 mA/V 1 + 9.88 × 10 This figure belongs to Problem 10.53, part (b). Q3 Vg5 10 k Vi Io Q4 Q1 Ro Q5 Q2 R22 RF 10 k R11 RF 10 k Figure 2 (1) Chapter 10–37 (d) From the A circuit, we have Combining (1) and (2) yields Ro = ro5 + R22 + gm5 ro5 R22 Aβ = − where ro5 = Q.E.D. |VA | 20 = 25 k = ID5 0.8 Ro = 25 + 10 + 8 × 25 × 10 = 2035 k 10.55 μ = 103 V/V, Rid = ∞, ro = 100 , RF = 10 k, and Rs = RL = 1 k. From Example 10.9 Eqs. (10.37) and (10.41), Rout = Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) = 2.035 × (1 + 9.88 × 10) = 203 M β=− (e) Vo = Io RF 1 1 = −0.1 mA/V =− RF 10 k A = −μRi = Af Vs RF Vo = Af RF = 0.099 × 10 = 0.99 V/V Vs Rout Vr RF ro5 = gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) Vt (RF ro5 ) + (1/gm5 ) (RF RL ) ro + (RF RL ) where Ri = Rid RF Rs Output resistance at source of Q5 = 1 + Aβ Ri = ∞ 10 1 = 0.909 k 1/gm5 1 + Aβ A = −103 × 0.909 × = 125 = 1.25 1 + 9.88 × 10 = −818.9 k Af = 10.54 Q3 Q4 Vg5 Rs Q1 Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ =− 818.9 1 − 818.9 × −0.1 =− 818.9 = −9.88 k 1 + 81.89 Rif = Ri /(1 + Aβ) Q5 Q2 = Vr Vt (10 1) 0.1 + (10 1) 0.909 k = 11 1 + 81.89 Rif = Rin Rs = Rin 1 k RF Rin = 1 1 = 1 1 1 1 − − Rif 1000 11 1000 = 11.1 Figure 1 From Eq. (10.42), we have Ro = ro RF RL Figure 1 shows the circuit prepared for determining the loop gain Aβ: = 0.1 10 1 = 90.1 Vr Aβ ≡ − Vt Rof = First we write for the gain of differential amplifier Vg5 = −gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) Vt (1) Next we write for the source follower, RF ro5 Vr = Vg5 (RF ro5 ) + (1/gm5 ) = Ro 1 + Aβ 90.1 = 1.1 1 + 81.89 Rof = Rout RL = Rout /1 k (2) ⇒ Rout 1.1 Chapter 10–38 Comparison to the values in Example 10.9: μ = 104 V/V μ = 103 Af −9.99 k −9.88 k Rin 1.11 11.1 Rout 0.11 1.1 β=− Aβ = 3.23 Af = =− 10.56 RF g Vr Rs Vt 1 = −0.1 mA/V RF gmVgs Vgs ro Vgs Vt Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ 32.3 = −7.63 k 1 + 3.23 Compare these results to those found in Exercise 10.19: A = −32.3 k (−30.3 k), β = −0.1 mA/V (−0.1 mA/V), Aβ = −3.23 (−3.03), and Af = −7.63 k (−7.52 k). The slight differences are due to the approximation used in the systematic analysis method. 10.57 (a) Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the circuit prepared for the determination of the loop gain Aβ: Aβ = − Vr Vt An expression for Vr can be written by inspection as Rs Vr = −gm Vt [ro (Rs + RF )] Rs + RF Thus, Aβ = gm [ro (Rs + RF )] If Rs Rs + RF (1) Figure 1 RF 1 2 Vo Figure 2 The feedback network (β circuit) is shown in Fig. 2 fed with Vo at port 2 and with port 1 short-circuited to determine β: If 1 =− β≡ Vo RF (2) Figure 1 illustrates the dc analysis. We can express the dc collector voltage VC in two alternative ways: IC VC = +15 − RC IC + + 0.07 β and VC = 0.7 + Rf IC + 0.07 β Equations (1) and (2) can how be used to determine A: Equating these two expressions yields A = −gm [ro (Rs + RF )](Rs RF ) 15 − 5.6(IC + 0.01IC + 0.07) Using the numerical values given in Exercise 10.19(e), we obtain = 0.7 + 56(0.01IC + 0.07) A = −5[20 (1 + 10)](1 10) ⇒ IC = 1.6 mA = −32.3 k VC 5.5 V Chapter 10–39 This figure belongs to Problem 10.57, part (b). Figure 2 The below two figures belong to Problem 10.57, part (c). Figure 3 Figure 4 (b) Figure 2 above shows the small-signal equivalent circuit of the amplifier where Also, observe that 1.6 mA = 64 mA/V 0.025 V β 100 = = 1.56 k rπ = gm 64 β=− gm = (c) Figure 3 above shows the A circuit. It includes the loading effects of the feedback network: R11 = R22 = Rf 1 Rf From the A circuit in Fig. 4, we have Ri = Rs Rf rπ (1) Vπ = Ii Ri (2) Vo = −gm Vπ (RC Rf ) (3) Chapter 10–40 Combining (1), (2) and (3) gives A≡ 10.58 Vo = −gm (Rs Rf rπ )(RC Rf ) Ii VDD Ri = 10 k 56 k 1.56 k I = 1.32 k A = −64 × 1.32 × (5.6 56) = −429 k Q2 1.4 V 0.7 V 0.7 V Q1 From the A circuit, we have I Ro = RC Rf = 5.6 k 56 k = 5.1 k (d) β = − Aβ = (e) Af = Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ 429 = −49.5 k 8.67 Ri Rif = 1 + Aβ = 0 Figure 1 429 = 7.67 56 1 + Aβ = 8.67 =− RF 1 1 =− Rf 56 k 1.32 k = 152 8.67 Rif = Rs Rin 152 = 10 k Rin Rin = 155 Rout = Rof Ro = 1 + Aβ 5.1 k = = 588 8.67 Af Vo Vo 49.5 (f) = −4.95 V/V = = =− Vs Is Rs Rs 10 (a) See Figure 1. VG1 = VGS1 = Vt + VOV = 0.5 + 0.2 = +0.7 V (because the dc voltage across RF is zero) VO = VG1 VO = +0.7 V VD1 = VO + VGS2 = 0.7 + 0.5 + 0.2 = +1.4 V (b) gm1,2 = ro1,2 = 2I 2 × 0.4 = 4 mA/V = VOV 0.2 16 V VA = = 40 k I 0.4 mA (c) Figure 2 on the next page shows the β circuit and the determination of its loading effects, R11 = R22 = RF Refer to Fig. P10.57 and assume the gain of the BJT to be infinite so that the signal voltage at its base is zero (virtual ground). In this case, we have Figure 2 shows also the A circuit. We can write Rf 56 Vo =− =− = −5.6 V/V Vs Rs 10 where Thus, the actual gain magnitude ( 5 V/V) is only about 12% below the ideal value; not bad for a single transistor inverting op amp! Vg1 = Ii Ri (1) Ri = R11 = RF (2) Vd 1 = −gm1 ro1 Vg1 (3) Chapter 10–41 This figure belongs to Problem 10.58, part (c). RF RF 1 2 RF 1 2 1 2 R11 RF R22 RF Vd1 Q2 Vg1 Vo Q1 R22 RF R11 RF Ii Ro Ri Figure 2 Vo = Vd 1 R22 ro2 (4) 1 (R22 ro2 ) + gm2 =− Combining Eqs. (1)–(4) results in A≡ (e) Af ≡ RF ro2 Vo = −gm1 ro1 RF Ii (RF ro2 ) + 1/gm2 (d) Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ gm1 ro1 RF (RF ro2 ) (RF ro2 ) + 1/gm2 + (gm1 ro1 )(RF ro2 ) (f) Ri = RF Rin = Rif = Ri /(1 + Aβ) = RF If RF 1 + gm1 ro1 Rout = Rof = Ro /(1 + Aβ) V b o If 1 RF Vo where from the A circuit we have Ro = RF ro2 Figure 3 1 RF Aβ = gm1 ro1 RF ro2 (RF ro2 ) + 1/gm2 1 + Aβ = 1 + gm1 ro1 RF ro2 (RF ro2 ) + 1/gm2 1 gm2 1 Rout = RF ro2 gm2 1 + gm1 ro1 From Fig. 3 we see that β=− RF ro2 (RF ro2 ) + 1/gm2 RF ro2 (RF ro2 ) + 1/gm2 (g) A = −4 × 40 × 10 10 40 (10 40) + 0.25 = −1551.5 k β=− 1 1 = −0.1 mA/V =− RF 10 k Chapter 10–42 Aβ = 155.15 (b) Refer to the solution to Example 10.9. 1 + Aβ = 156.15 1551.5 = −9.94 k Af = − 156.15 Ri = RF = 10 k Rin = Rif = 10, 000 RF = = 64 1 + Aβ 156.15 1 Ro = RF ro2 gm2 Ro = 10 40 0.25 = 242 Rout = Rof = Ro 1 + Aβ 242 = 1.55 = 156.15 β=− 1 1 = −0.05 mA/V =− RF 20 k Using Eq. (10.39), we obtain Ri = Rid RF Rs = 100 20 2 = 1.786 k Using Eq. (10.41) with RL = ∞, we get A≡ Vo 20 = −103 × 1.786 × Ii 20 + 2 = −1623.6 k Af ≡ Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ where 1 + Aβ = 1 + 1623.6 × 0.05 10.59 (a) = 82.18 Af = Vo 1623.6 =− Is 82.18 = −19.76 k Af Vo Vo 19.76 = = =− Vs Is Rs Rs 2 = −9.88 V/V Rif = = Ri 1 + Aβ 1.786 = 21.7 82.18 Rif = Rs Rin Refer to the feedback network shown in Fig. 10.24(b) and to the determination of β illustrated in Fig. 10.24(c). Thus, β=− 1 RF 21.7 = 2000 Rin Rin 21.7 Rout = Rof = Ro 1 + Aβ If Aβ 1, then we have where from Eq. (10.42) with RL = ∞ we get Vo 1 = −RF Af = Is β Ro = ro RF = 2 20 = 1.818 k and the voltage gain realized will be Rout = Rof = 1.818 = 22.1 82.18 Vo RF Vo = − Vs Is Rs Rs (c) fHf = fH (1 + Aβ) If Rs = 2 k, to obtain Vo /Vs −10 V/V, we required = 1 × 82.18 RF = 10 × Rs = 20 k = 82.18 kHz Chapter 10–43 This figure belongs to Problem 10.60. RF G Vgs/Rs Vgs Rs Is (Vo – Vgs)/RF Vo Vo/ro ro gmVgs Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 10.61, part (a). 5 V RC 10 k 0.356 mA 10 1.44 V 0.7 V 50.356 Q1 0.35 mA Q2 0.0058 mA 0.0035 mA 0.577 ~ 0.58 mA VO 0.7 0.035 0.735 V 0.0035 RE 10 k RF 10 k 5 V 0.735(5) 0.5735 mA 10 Figure 1 10.60 Figure 1 shows the small-signal-equivalent circuit of the feedback amplifier of Fig. E10.19. Analysis to determine Vo /Is proceeds as follows: Substituting for Vgs from (1) into (2), we obtain Is + Vo gm − Writing a node equation at the output node provides gm − 1 RF (1) (ro RF ) Vgs Vo − Vgs + =0 Rs RF Is − Vgs Vo + =0 (Rs RF ) RF (ro RF )(Rs RF ) Vo RF For the feedback analysis to be reasonably accurate, we use gm Writing a node equation at node G provides Is − + Vo Is 1 gm − (ro RF )(Rs RF ) RF = 1 1 + gm − (ro RF )(Rs RF )/RF RF 1 1 + r RF ⇒ Vgs = −Vo o 1 gm − RF 1 1 =0⇒ Vo − Vgs Vo gm Vgs + + =0 ro RF ⇒ Vgs = −Vo 1 RF 1 RF 10.61 (a) Figure 1 (see figure above) shows the dc analysis. We assumed IC1 = 0.35 mA and found that IC2 = 0.58 mA, thus verifying the given values. The dc voltage at the output is (2) VO = +0.735 V Chapter 10–44 The collector voltage of Q1 is given by (b) Vc1 = −gm1 Vb1 RC (β2 + 1)[re2 + (RE RF )] where re2 = VT 25 mV = = 43.1 IE2 0.58 mA Vc1 = −14Vb1 10 101[0.0431 + (10 10)] = −137.3Vb1 (2) The gain of the emitter-follower Q2 is given by Vo RE RF = Vc1 (RE RF ) + re2 Figure 2 = Figure 2 shows the β circuit and the determination of its loading effects on the A circuit: 5 = 0.99 V/V 5 + 0.0431 Combining (1)–(3) gives R11 = R22 = RF = 10 k A≡ Vo = −0.99 × 137.3 × 4.17 Ii = −567.6 k (c) The value of β can be obtained from the β circuit as shown in Fig. 4: Figure 4 Figure 3 β=− 1 1 = −0.1 mA/V =− RF 10 k Figure 3 shows the A circuit. The input resistance is given by Aβ = −567.6 × −0.1 Ri = RF = RF rπ 1 = 56.76 where 1 + Aβ = 57.76 gm1 IC1 0.35 = 14 mA/V = = VT 0.025 rπ 1 = (d) Af ≡ β 100 = 7.14 k = gm1 14 Af = − Thus, Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ 567.6 = −9.83 k 57.76 Rin = Rif = Ri = 10 k 7.14 k = 4.17 k Ri 1 + Aβ The input voltage Vb1 is given by Vb1 = Ii Ri = 4.17Ii (1) = 4.17 k = 72.2 57.76 (3) Chapter 10–45 This figure belongs to Problem 10.62. If RF 1 RF Vo 2 b If 1 RF Vo 1 RF 2 1 R11 RF 2 R22 RF Figure 1 Figure 2 shows the A circuit. For the CG amplifier Q1 , we can write From the A circuit, we have RC Ro = RF RE re2 + β2 + 1 Ri = RF 10 = 10 10 0.0431 + 101 = 138.2 Ro Rout = Rof = 1 + Aβ 138.2 = = 2.4 57.76 10.62 Figure 1 shows the feedback network with a voltage Vo applied to port 2 to determine β: If 1 =− β≡ Vo RF For Aβ 1, we have 1 Vo ≡ Af = −RF Is β Vo Thus, for −10 k, we select Is RF = 10 k The loading of the feedback network on the A circuit can be determined as shown in Fig. 1: 1 gm1 Vsg = Ii Ri (2) Vd 1 = gm1 Vsg RD1 (3) Combining (1)–(3) yields 1 Ii Vd 1 = (gm1 RD1 ) RF gm1 Vo = −gm2 (RD2 RF ) Vd 1 Substituting gm1 = gm2 = 4 mA/V, RD1 = RD2 = 10 k, and RF = 10 k gives Aβ = RD2 Vo Vd1 Q2 195 = 19.5 10 1 + Aβ = 20.5 Af ≡ R22 RF Q1 =− Vo A = Is 1 + Aβ 195 = −9.52 k 20.5 Rin = Rif = R11 RF Ii Ro Ri 1 + Aβ From Eq. (1), we obtain Ri = 10 0.25 = 244 Ri Figure 2 (5) Combining (4) and (5), we obtain the open-loop gain A: 1 Vo = −(gm1 RD1 ) RF A≡ gm2 (RD2 RF ) Is gm1 A = −195 k RD1 (4) For the CS stage Q2 , we can write A = −(4 × 10) × (10 0.25) × 4 × (10 10) R11 = R22 = RF (1) Rin = 244 = 11.9 20.5 Chapter 10–46 Now consider the amplifier stage shown in Fig. P10.63(b). First, we determine the dc bias point as follows: From the A circuit, Ro = RD2 RF = 10 10 = 5 k Rout = Rof = Ro = 1 + Aβ IE = 5000 = 244 20.5 IC = 1.11 × 0.99 = 1.1 mA 10.63 (a) Converting the signal source to its Norton’s form, we obtain the circuit shown in Fig. 1(a). This is a shunt–shunt feedback amplifier with the feedback network consisting of the resistor Rf . To determine β, we use the arrangement shown in Fig. 1(b), IC 1.1 = 44 mA/V = VT 0.025 rπ = β 100 = = 2.27 k gm 44 Rout = 7.5 k Av o = −gm × 7.5 k = −44 × 7.5 = −330 V/V Now, for Aβ 1, the closed-loop gain becomes Figure 2(a) (next page) shows the equivalent circuit of the amplifier stage. Figure 2(b) shows the A circuit of the feedback amplifier made up of the cascade of three stage. Observe that we have included Rs and RL as well as R11 and R22 . The overall gain A ≡ Vo /Is cam be obtained as follows: Vo 1 = −Rf Is β The voltage gain Vo is obtained as Vs Af Vo Vo = = Vs Is Rs Rs Ri = Rs RF 1.65 k Thus, = 10 1000 1.65 = 1.414 k Rf Vo − Vs Rs V1 = Ii Ri = 1.414Ii Q.E.D. (b) To obtain a closed-loop voltage gain of approximately −100 V/V, we use −100 = − gm = Rin = 10 15 2.27 = 1.65 k 1 β=− Rf Af ≡ 10 − 0.7 10 + 15 = 1.11 mA 10 15 4.7 + 101 15 × Rf Rs For Rs = 10 k, we obtain Rf = 1 M V2 = −330V1 × 1.65 = −59.5V1 1.65 + 7.5 (2) V3 = −330V2 × 1.65 = −59.5V2 1.65 + 7.5 (3) Vo = −330V3 × 1 1000 (1 1000) + 7.5 = −38.8V3 This figure belongs to Problem 10.63, part (a). Figure 1 (1) (4) Chapter 10–47 This figure belongs to Problem 10.63, part (b). 7.5 k V1 330V 1 1.65 k (a) 7.5 k Ii Rs V1 RF 1.65 k Ri 7.5 k V2 330V1 7.5 k 1.65 k V3 330V2 1.65 k RF RL 330V3 10 k 1 M 1 M 1 k Ro (b) Figure 2 Combining (1)–(4) gives A≡ Vo = −1.94 × 105 k Ii Since 1 1 =− β=− Rf 1 M we have Ro = 1 1000 7.5 = 881.6 Rof = Ro 1 + Aβ 881.6 = 4.5 195 Rof = Rout RL = ⇒ Rout = 4.5 Aβ = 194 and 10.64 (a) 1 + Aβ = 195 VDD 3.3 V Thus, Af ≡ I1 Vo 1.94 × 105 =− Is 195 Q2 Q1 = −995 k and the voltage gain realized is Af −99.5 Vo = −99.5 V/V = = Vs Rs 10 Rif = Ri 1 + Aβ 1414 = 7.3 195 Rif = Rs Rin = Rin 7.3 From the A circuit, we have Ro = RL RF 7.5 k VG R1 0 VG R1 ID2 1 mA R2 VO 10 A RL 0.99 mA Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the circuit for the purpose of performing a dc design. ID1 = 100 μA ⇒ I1 = 100 μA 1 W V2 ID1 = μn Cox 2 L 1 OV 1 Chapter 10–48 1 × 200 × 2 W ⇒ = 25 L 1 W L 100 = × 0.22 1 Q2 Q1 VG1 = Vtn + VOV 1 R2 Vo = 0.6 + 0.2 = 0.8 V Since IR2,R1 = 10 μA, we have Is 0.8 V R1 = = 80 k 0.01 mA IRL = ID2 − IR2,R1 Vs Rs Rs Rif R1 RL Rin = 1 − 0.01 = 0.99 mA Rout Figure 3 VO = 0.99 × 2 = 1.98 V 1 W V2 ID2 = μn Cox 2 L 2 OV 2 W 1 1 = × 0.2 × × 0.22 2 L 2 W ⇒ = 250 L 2 Af Vo Vo = = Vs Is Rs Rs Thus, −6 = − 118 Rs ⇒ Rs = 19.7 k VO − VG 0.01 mA 1.98 − 0.8 = 118 k = 0.01 VGS2 = Vtn + VOV 2 = 0.8 V R2 = (d) VD1 = VG2 = 1.98 + 0.8 = 2.78 V Q2 (b) The β circuit consists of resistance R2 . The value of β can be determined as shown in Fig. 2. Vo Q1 Ii If Rof Rs R1 R11 R2 R22 R2 RL R2 1 2 Ri V o Ro Figure 4 Figure 2 The A circuit is shown in Fig. 4. β≡ If 1 1 =− =− Vo R2 118 k Ri = Rs R1 R2 = 19.7 80 118 = 13.92 k = −8.47 × 10−3 mA/V Vgs1 = Ii Ri = 13.92Ii Thus, 1 Af ideal ≡ = −118 k β Vd 1 = −gm1 Vgs1 ro1 (c) Converting the signal source to its Norton’s form, the feedback amplifier takes the form shown in Fig. 3. where gm1 = 2ID1 2 × 0.1 = = 1 mA/V VOV 1 0.2 ro1 = VA 20 = 200 k = ID1 0.1 (1) Chapter 10–49 10.65 Thus, Vd 1 = −200Vgs1 (2) Vo RL R2 ro2 = Vd 1 (RL R2 ro2 ) + 1/gm2 RD where gm2 Vo 2ID2 2×1 = = = 10 mA/V VOV 2 0.2 ro2 = Q1 Ro VA 20 = 20 k = ID2 1 Thus, Vo (2 118 20) = 0.947 V/V = Vd 1 (2 118 20) + 0.1 Ii (3) Ri Combining (1)–(3), we obtain A= Figure 1 Vo = −13.92 × 200 × 0.947 Ii = −2636.7 k 1 Ro = RL R2 ro2 gm2 = 2 118 20 0.1 The A circuit is shown in Fig. 1. Ri = 1 1 = = 0.2 k gm1 5 A≡ Vo = RD = 10 k Ii Ro = RD = 10 k = 94.7 (e) Af = Vo A = Vs 1 + Aβ =− C1 If 2636.7 =− 1 + (2636.7/118) Vo Qf C2 2636.7 = −113 k 23.34 Af Vo 113 = −5.73 V/V = =− Vs Rs 19.7 (f) Rif = 13.92 Ri = = 0.596 k 1 + Aβ 23.34 Rif = Rs Rin 0.596 = 19.7 Rin ⇒ Rin = 615 Rof = Ro 94.7 = = 4.06 1 + Aβ 23.34 Rof = Rout RL 4.06 = Rout 2000 ⇒ Rout = 4.1 Figure 2 The β circuit is shown in Fig. 2. β≡ If C1 0.9 ×2 = gmf = C1 + C2 0.9 + 0.1 Vo = 1.8 mA/V Vo A = Af ≡ Vs 1 + Aβ = 10 = 0.53 k 1 + 10 × 1.8 Rin = Rif = Ri 200 = = 10.5 1 + Aβ 19 Rout = Rof = Ro 10 k = = 526 1 + Aβ 19 Chapter 10–50 These figures belong to Problem 10.66, part (a). RF 1 RM 0 RF 2 1 RM RF 2 1 RM R11 RF RM 2 R22 RM // RF Figure 1 RD Vgs2 gm1Vsg1 Q1 Io gm2Vgs2 RL Vsg1 Ii Q2 R11 R22 Ri Ro Figure 2 10.66 (a) Figure 1 shows the β network as well as the determination of its loading effects on the A circuit: The β circuit prepared for the determination of β is shown in Fig. 3. β≡ R11 = RF + RM R22 = RM RF Figure 2 shows the A circuit. Some of the analysis is shown on the diagram. 1 gm1 If RM =− Io RM + RF (c) From (5)–(6), we obtain 1 RM R11 (gm1 RD )gm2 Aβ = RM + RF gm1 (1) (d) gm1 = gm2 = 5 mA/V, RD = 20 k Vsg1 = Ii Ri (2) RM = 10 k, and RF = 90 k, thus Vgs2 = gm1 Vsg1 RD (3) R11 = RF + RM = 90 + 10 = 100 k Io = −gm2 Vgs2 (4) R22 = RM RF = 10 90 = 9 k Ri = R11 Combining (1)–(4) gives 1 Io = − R11 (gm1 RD )gm2 A≡ Ii gm1 A = −(100 0.2) × (5 × 20) × 5 = −99.8 A/A (5) (b) β=− 10 = −0.1 A/A 10 + 90 Aβ = 9.98 If RF 1 1 + Aβ = 10.98 RM Figure 3 2 (6) Io Af ≡ Io A 99.8 = =− = −9.1 A/A Is 1 + Aβ 10.98 Rin = Rif = Ri 1 + Aβ Chapter 10–51 where Combining Eqs. (1) and (2), we obtain Ri = 100 k 0.2 k 0.2 k Aβ ≡ − Rin = 200 = 18.2 10.98 Vr ro2 R1 =μ 1 Vt ro2 + R1 + (ro2 R1 ) gm For (e) Breaking the output loop of the A circuit between XX , we find μ = 1000 V/V, R1 = 10 k, Ro = R22 + RL + ro2 gm = 5 mA/V, and ro2 = 20 k = (RM RF ) + RL + ro2 we obtain = (10 90) + 1 + 20 Aβ = 1000 × = 30 k = 970.9 Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) = 30 × 10.98 which is slightly lower than the value found in Example 10.10 (1076.4), the difference being about −10%. This is a result of the assumptions and approximations made in the general feedback analysis method. = 329.4 k Rout = Rof − RL = 328.4 k 20 10 0.2 + (20 10) 20 + 10 From Example 10.10 (or directly from the β circuit) we have 10.67 β = −0.1 A/A Io Thus, A = −9709 m Vr ro2 Vt Af = − Io R2 0 Figure 1 10.68 Refer to Fig. 10.27(c), which shows the determination of β, Figure 1 shows the shunt-series feedback amplifier circuit of Fig. 10.27(a) prepared for determining the loop gain, β= If R1 =− Io R1 + R2 Vr Vt Ri = Rs Rid (R1 + R2 ) Vt 1 + (ro2 R1 ) gm ro2 ro2 + R1 (1) For our case here, Rs = Rid = ∞, thus Ri = R1 + R2 For Rin = Rif = 1 k, we have Rif = The voltage Vr can be obtained as Vr = Io R1 × −μ = −μR1 Io (1) Refer to Fig. 10.27(e), which shows the A circuit. The input resistance Ri is given by observe that here Rs = Rid = ∞. Thus Io can be obtained as Io = 9709 = −9.99 A/A 971.9 which is identical to the value obtained in Example 10.10. Thus while Aβ and A differ slightly for the earlier results, Af is identical; an illustration of the power of negative feedback! Io R1 Aβ ≡ − and (2) Ri 1 + Aβ ⇒ Ri = Rif (1 + Aβ) Chapter 10–52 Figure 1 shows the dc analysis. It starts by noting that ID1 = 0.2 mA. Thus VOV 1 = 0.2 V and Thus R1 + R2 = 1 k × (1 + Aβ) Since 1 + Aβ is 40 dB, that is, VG1 = VGS1 = Vt + VOV 1 = 0.5 + 0.2 1 + Aβ = 100 = 0.7 V we have R1 + R2 = 1 × 100 = 100 k (2) Now, Af = A 1 + Aβ −100 = VS2 = +0.7 V A 100 and ⇒ A = −104 A/A 99 Aβ = = −0.0099 β= A −104 Using Eqs. (1) and (2), we obtain −0.0099 = − IR1 = 0.7 V = 0.2 mA 3.5 k Thus, Q2 is operating at R1 R1 + R2 ID = 0.2 mA ⇒ R1 = 0.0099 × 100 = 0.99 k (b) gm1 = gm2 = R2 = 100 − 0.99 = 99.01 k Now, using Eq. (10.53), (page 859), we obtain ro2 Ri A = −μ 1/gm + (R1 R2 ro2 ) ro2 + (R1 R2 ) = 100 20 0.2 + (0.99 99.01 20) 20 + (0.99 99.01) μ = 119 V/V Q.E.D. 2ID VOV 2 × 0.2 = 2 mA/V 0.2 ro1 = ro2 = −104 = −μ Since the dc current through R2 is zero, the dc voltage drop across it will be zero, thus 10 = 50 k 0.2 (c) R2 R2 From Example 10.10, we have 0 Ro = ro2 + (R1 R2 ) + gm2 ro2 (R1 R2 ) Ro = 20 + (0.99 99.01)(1 + 5 × 20) R1 1 1 2 R1 2 = 119 k R11 R1R2 Rout = Rof = Ro (1+Aβ) = 119×100 = 11.9 M R2 10.69 (a) 1 R1 2 0.2 mA R22 R1 R2 Q2 0.7 V Q1 0.2 mA R2 Figure 2 0.7 V 14 k 0 0.2 mA R1 3.5 k Figure 2 shows the β circuit and the determination of its loading effects, R11 and R22 , R11 = R1 + R2 = 3.5 + 14 = 17.5 k Figure 1 R22 = R1 R2 = 3.5 14 = 2.8 k Chapter 10–53 (e) Aβ = −525.8 × −0.2 Io Vd1 Q2 Vgs1 Ro ro2 = 105.16 1 + Aβ = 106.16 Q1 Ii Af = − R22 R11 Io 525.8 = −4.95 A/A 106.16 (f) Rin = Rif = Figure 3 = Ri 1 + Aβ 17.5 k = 164.8 106.16 Figure 3 shows the A circuit. To obtain A = Io /Ii , we write Rout = Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) Vgs1 = Ii R11 (1) = 332.8 × 106.16 = 35.3 M Vd 1 = −gm1 ro1 Vgs1 (2) ro2 Vd 1 1 ro2 + R22 + (ro2 R22 ) gm2 Io = (3) Combining (1)–(3) yields A= R11 ro2 Io (gm1 ro1 ) =− 1 Ii ro2 + R22 + (ro2 R22 ) gm2 A=− 17.5 50 × 2 × 50 × 0.5 + (50 2.8) 50 + 2.8 A = −525.8 A/A Ri = R11 = 17.5 k 10.70 (a) If μ is a very large, a virtual ground will appear at the input terminal. Thus the input resistance Rin = V− /Ii = 0. Since no current flows in Rs , or into the amplifier input terminal, all the current Is will flow in the transistor source terminal and hence into the drain, thus Io = Is and Io =1 Is (b) This is a shunt-series feedback amplifier in which the feedback circuit consists of a wire, as shown on the next page in Fig. 1. As indicated, Ro = ro2 + R22 + gm2 ro2 R22 = 50 + 2.8 + 2 × 50 × 2.8 R11 = ∞ = 332.8 k R22 = 0 (d) If The A circuit is shown in Fig. 2 (next page) for which we can write R2 R1 1 2 Io Vid = −Ii (Rs Rid ) −Ii Rs Figure 4 Figure 4 shows the determination of the value of β: β≡ If R1 =− Io R1 + R2 β=− (since Rid is very large) Vgs = μVid (2) Io = gm2 Vgs (3) Combining (1)–(3), we obtain Thus, 3.5 = −0.2 A/A 3.5 + 14 (1) A≡ Io = −μgm2 Rs Ii Chapter 10–54 These figures belong to Problem 10.70, part (b). 1 2 1 2 1 R22 0 2 R11 Figure 1 Io G Vid Rid mVid 0 Vgs gm2Vgs ro2 Ro S Ii Rs short because R22 0 Ri Figure 2 Ri = Rs Af 1 Ro = ro2 Ri 1 + Aβ (e) Rif = (c) = If Rs μgm2 Rs Rif = Rin Rs 1 2 Io 1 1 1 = + Rif R in Rs 1 1 1 + μgm2 = + Rs R in Rs Figure 3 ⇒ Rin = From Fig. 3 we find β≡ If = −1 Io (d) Aβ = μgm2 Rs 1 μgm2 Rout = Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) = ro2 (1 + μgm2 Rs ) (f) A Af = 1 + Aβ Io μgm2 Rs =− 1 + μgm2 Rs Note that the negative sign is due to our assumption that Is flows into the input node (see Fig. 2 for the way Ii is applied). If instead Is is flowing out of the input node, as indicated in Fig. P10.70, then Af ≡ gm1Vi Rout m ro1 Io μgm2 Rs = Is 1 + μgm2 Rs If μ is large so that μgm2 Rs 1, Figure 4 Q2 Chapter 10–55 The circuit of the cascode amplifier in Fig. P10.70 with VG replaced by signal ground, and Q1 replaced by its equivalent circuit at the drain (Fig. 4, previous page) looks identical to that of Fig. 10.70(a). Thus we can write thus Vx = Ix ro1 − μgm1 ro1 Vx ⇒ Rin ≡ Vx ro1 = Ix 1 + μgm1 ro1 Since μgm1 ro1 1, we have Io gm1 v i 1 μgm1 Rout = ro2 (1 + μgm2 ro1 ) = ro2 + μ(gm2 ro2 )ro1 Rin μ(gm2 ro2 )ro1 (d) Since the drain of Q2 is outside the feedback loop, we have Compared to the case of a regular cascode, we see that while Io gm1 Vi as in the regular cascode, utilizing the "super" CG transistor results in increasing the output resistance by the additional factor μ! 10.71 (a) Refer to Fig. P10.71. Let Is increase. This will cause the voltage at the input node, which is the voltage at the positive input of the amplifier μ, to increase. The amplifier output voltage will correspondingly increase. Thus, Vgs of Q1 increases and Io1 increases. This counteracts the originally assumed change of increased current into the input node. Thus, the feedback is negative. (b) The negative feedback will cause the dc voltage at the positive input terminal of the amplifier to be equal to VBIAS . Thus, the voltage at the drain of Q1 will be equal to VBIAS . For Q1 to operate in the active mode, the minimum voltage at the drain must be equal to VOV which is 0.2 V. Thus the minimum value of VBIAS must be 0.2 V. Rout = ro2 10.72 15 V 10 mA 200 A VO 10 V Q2 100 A 0.7 V RL 500 100 A Q1 10.07 mA 0.7 V 70 A 0 Rf 10 k 70 A 1.4 V 10 mA Rs 10 k RE 140 Figure 1 The dc analysis is shown in Fig. 1, from which we see that (c) IC1 = 0.1 mA IC2 = 10 mA Thus, gm1 = 4 mA/V rπ1 = 25 k Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the circuit for determining Rin , Rin ≡ Vx Ix A node equation at D1 gives Vx = (Ix − gm1 Vgs )ro1 gm2 = 400 mA/V The β circuit (Fig. 2, next page), also shows the determination of its loading effects and of β. R11 = Rf + RE = 10.14 k R22 = Rf RE = 10 0.14 = 0.138 k β=− 0.14 RE =− = 0.0138 A/A Rf + RE 10 + 0.14 The A circuit is shown in Fig. 3. ⇒ Vx = Ix ro1 − gm1 Vgs ro1 Ri = Rs R11 rπ1 But, = 10 10.14 25 Vgs = μVx , = 4.19 k Chapter 10–56 These figures belong to Problem 10.72. RE 1 0 Rf Rf 1 2 b Circuit If RE 2 RE 2 R11 Rf RE Rf 1 RE 2 Rf 1 R22 RE Rf b Io RE If Rf RE Io Figure 2 RL 500 gm1Vp1 b2 gm1Vp1 Io Q2 Ii Rs R11 Q1 R22 Vp1 Ri Vp1 IiRi Figure 3 Vπ 1 = Ii Ri Io = −β2 gm1 Vπ 1 Io ⇒A= = −β2 gm1 Ri Ii Vo −Io RL 0.5 = = 69.5 × = 3.47 V/V Vs −Is Rs 10 Rif = Ri 1 + Aβ 4190 = 173.6 24.13 A = −100 × 4 × 4.19 = −1676 A/A = Aβ = −1676 × −0.0138 = 23.13 Rif = Rs Rin 1 + Aβ = 24.13 173.6 = 10, 000 Rin Af = Io A = Is 1 + Aβ ⇒ Rin = 176.7 where 10.73 See figures on the next two pages. Vs Is = Rs (a) Refer to Fig. 1. Af = − 1676 = −69.5 A/A 24.13 (b) Refer to Fig. 2. (c) Routz = ro2 ro4 Chapter 10–57 These figures belong to Problem 10.73, part (a). Q1 Vx Q2 Vx /R QN x Vx /R 0 m 0 Vy Vx QP Vx /R y Vx Vx R R Iz 0 z 0 Q3 Vx positive Figure 1 Q4 Vx R Chapter 10–58 These figures belong to Problem 10.73, part (b). Q1 0 QN Vy 0 0 y x 0 Q2 m 0 z Iy Vy 0 Iy QP Iz Iy Iy Rin 0 Iy Q3 Q4 Iy positive Q1 Q2 Iy QN x 0 m Vy 0 Iy 0 Vy 0 Iy QP z y Iy Iz Iy 0 0 Q3 Q4 Iy negative Figure 2 Chapter 10–59 10.74 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P10.74. Observe that the feedback signal is capacitively coupled and so are the signal source and RL ; thus, these do not enter into the dc bias calculations and the feedback does not affect the bias. The dc emitter current in Q1 can be determined from Is = Vs Rs RB = RB1 RB2 = 13 k (c) See figure on the next page. The determination of the loading effects of the β circuit on the A circuit is shown in Fig. 2: 15 − 0.7 100 + 15 = 0.865 mA IE1 = 100 15 0.870 + 101 IC1 = 0.99 × 0.865 = 0.86 mA 12 × R11 = Rf + RE2 = 10 + 3.4 = 13.4 k R22 = RE2 Rf = 3.4 10 = 2.54 k The A circuit is shown in Fig. 3 on the next page. Next consider Q2 and let its emitter current be IE2 . The base current of Q2 will be IE2 /(β + 1) 0.01 IE2 . The current through RC1 will be (IC1 + IB2 ) = (0.86 + 0.01 IE2 ). We can thus write the following equation: Analysis of the A circuit to determine A ≡ Io /Is proceeds as follows: 12 = (0.86 + 0.01 IE2 ) × 10 + 0.7 + 3.4 × IE2 Vπ1 = Ii Ri Ri = Rs R11 RB rπ1 = 10 13.4 13 2.91 = 1.68 k 2.7 12 − 8.6 − 0.7 ⇒ IE2 = = = 0.77 mA 3.4 + 0.1 3.5 IC2 = 0.76 mA (1) Ib2 = −gm1 Vπ1 RC1 RC1 + rπ2 + (β + 1)R22 (2) Io = Ie2 = (β + 1)Ib2 The small-signal parameters of Q1 and Q2 can now be obtained as 0.86 gm1 = = 34.4 mA/V 0.025 100 rπ 1 = = 2.91 k 34.4 0.76 gm2 = = 30.4 mA/V 0.025 100 rπ 2 = = 3.3 k 30.4 (b) The equivalent circuit of the feedback amplifier is shown in Fig. 1, where (3) Combining Eqs. (1)–(3) results in A≡ = Io (β + 1)Ri gm1 RC1 =− Ii RC1 + rπ2 + (β + 1)R22 101 × 1.68 × 34.4 × 10 10 + 3.3 + 101 × 2.54 = −216.3 A/A Breaking the emitter loop of Q2 at XX gives Ro = R22 + = 2.54 + Rs = 10 k rπ2 + RC1 β +1 3.3 + 10 = 2.67 k 101 This figure belongs to Problem 10.74, part (b). Ic2 Is Rs RB rp1 RC1 Vp1 gm1Vp1 rp2 Vp2 gm2Vp2 Io Rout Rif Rin Rf Rof RE2 Figure 1 Iout RL RC2 Chapter 10–60 These figures belong to Problem 10.74, part (c). Rf Rf 1 RE2 2 1 0 Rf 1 RE2 2 RE2 2 b Circuit R22 RE2 Rf R11 Rf RE2 Figure 2 Figure 3 (d) Iout = IC2 If Rf RE2 1 Iout Iout Io RC2 = ×α Iin Is Is RC2 + RL 2 Figure 4 β≡ RC2 RC2 = αIo RC2 + RL RC2 + RL Io ⇒ Iout 8 = −3.87 × 0.99 × 0.99 × Iin 8+1 = −3.41 A/A If RE2 =− Io RE2 + Rf = −0.254 A/A Rout RC1 Q2 (e) Aβ = −216.3 × −0.254 = 54.88 1 + Aβ = 55.88 Af = Io 216.3 = −3.87 A/A =− Is 55.88 Rif = 1.68 k Ri = = 30.1 1 + Aβ 55.88 Rof Rof = Ro (1 + Aβ) = 2.67 × 55.88 Figure 5 = 149.2 k (f) Rif = Rs Rin 30.1 = 10 k Rin To determine Rout , consider the circuit in Fig. 5. Using the formula given at the end of Example 10.8, adapted to our case here, we get Rin = 30.2 Rout = ro2 + [Rof Rs Is Iin = Is Rs + Rin (rπ2 + RC1 )] 1 + gm2 ro2 rπ2 rπ2 + RC1 Chapter 10–61 At ω = ω180 , the magnitude of A becomes where | A(jω180 )| = 75 V = 98.7 k 0.76 mA ro2 = 105 2 2 20, 000 2 1 + 20, 000 1+ 100 20, 000 Rout = 98.7 + [149.2 (3.3 + 10)] 1 + 30.3 × 98.7 × 3.3 3.3 + 10 | A(jω180 )|βcr = 1 Check: βcr = Maximum possible Rout βro 10 M Af = 10.75 A(s) = φ = −tan−1 105 2 s s 1+ 1+ 100 20, 000 = ω ω − 2 tan−1 100 20, 000 180◦ = tan−1 105 1 + 105 × 4 × 10−3 105 250 V/V 1 + 400 10.76 A(s) = ω180 ω180 + 2 tan−1 100 20, 000 105 2 s s 1+ 1+ 100 20, 000 105 2 ω ω 1+j 1+j 100 20, 000 ω ω − 2 tan−1 (1) φ(ω) = −tan−1 100 20, 000 A(jω) = Since ω180 will be much greater than 100 rad/s, we can assume that at ω180 , tan−1 (ω180/100 ) is approximately 90◦ , thus ω180 = 90◦ 20, 000 ⇒ tan−1 1 = 4 × 10−3 V/V 250 Correspondingly, So, our result is reasonable. 2 tan−1 105 = 250 V/V 200 × 2 | A(jω180 )| = = 98.7 + 12.21 × 743 = 9.17 M | A(jω)| = ω180 = 45◦ 20, 000 ⇒ ω180 = 20, 000 rad/s 105 2 (2) ω 2 ω 1+ 1+ 100 20, 000 Using Eqs. (1) and (2), we can obtain the data required to construct Nyquist plots for the two cases: β = 1 and β = 10−3 . The results are given in the following table. which is indeed much greater than 100 rad/s, justifying our original assumption. This table belongs to Problem 10.76. ω −2 tan−1 100 −tan−1 ω rad/s 0 0 −45 10 ω 20, 000 0 ◦ 2 φ | A| | Aβ| β=1 0 105 105 ◦ −45.6 ◦ ◦ −0.6 ◦ ◦ 0.7 × 10 5 10 −84.3 −5.7 −90 104 −89.4◦ −53.1◦ −142.5◦ 3 2 × 10 4 ∞ ◦ −89.7 ◦ −90 ◦ −90 ◦ −180 −180 ◦ −270 4 ◦ | Aβ| β = 10−3 100 0.7 × 10 5 70 10 4 10 10 800 800 0.8 250 250 0.25 0 0 0 Chapter 10–62 This figure belongs to Problem 10.76. Im b1 v 2 10 250 v 10 4 800 4 1 v0 Ab 105 w 45.6º v 102 0.7 v 10 3 10 4 Re 105 Not to scale Im b 103 v 2 10 4 0.25 1 v 104 0.8 v 103 10 w –45.6° v0 100 Re v 102 70 Not to scale Figure 1 Using these data, we obtain the two Nyquist plots shown in Fig. 1. We observe that the amplifier with β = 1 will be unstable and that with β = 10−3 will be stable. At this frequency, | A| = √ 104 √ 1 + 10.952 1 + 1.0952 = 413.6 For stable operation, | A|βcr < 1 10.77 A(s) = 104 s s 2 1+ 4 1+ 5 10 10 104 ω ω 2 1+j 4 1+j 5 10 10 ω ω −1 φ = −tan−1 − 2 tan 104 105 ω180 ω180 − 2 tan−1 −180 = −tan−1 4 10 105 A(jω) = By trial and error we find ω180 = 1.095 × 105 rad/s βcr < 2.42 × 10−3 Thus, oscillation will commence for β ≥ 2.42 × 10−3 104 k s 3 1+ 3 10 104 k A(jω)β(jω) = ω 3 1+j 3 10 104 k | A(jω)β(jω)| = 3/2 ω2 1+ 6 10 10.78 A(s)β(s) = Chapter 10–63 ω 103 ω180 −180◦ = −3 tan−1 3 10 φ(ω) = −3 tan−1 10.81 Af (0) = 10 = ⇒ ω180 = 103 tan 60 = 1732 rad/s 104 k | A(jω180 )β(jω180 )| = 1+ 17322 106 3/2 = 0.125 × 104 k A0 1 + A0 β 1000 1 + 1000β ⇒ β = 0.099 To obtain a maximally flat response, Q = 0.707 Using Eq. (10.70), we obtain 100 × 1 × fP2 0.707 = 1 + fP2 For stable operation, | A(jω180 )β(jω180 )| < 1 ⇒ 0.125 × 104 k < 1 1 100 fP2 = 2 (1 + fP2 )2 −4 k < 8 × 10 2 fP2 + 2 fP2 + 1 = 200fP2 10.79 Af (0) = A0 1 + A0 β 2 fP2 − 198 fP2 + 1 = 0 fP2 198 kHz where A0 = 1 MHz = 105 V/V 10 Hz (the other solution is a very low frequency which obviously does not make physical sense). Thus, 105 10 V/V Af (0) = 1 + 105 × 0.1 f3dB = 10(1 + A0 β) = 10(1 + 10 × 0.1) 10 Hz 5 5 Unity-gain frequency of closed-loop amplifier = Af (0) × f3dB = 10 × 105 = 106 Hz = 1 MHz Thus, the pole shifts by a factor equal to the amount-of-feedback, (1 + A0 β). 10.80 A0 = 10 V/V fP = 100 Hz fHf = fP (1 + A0 β) = 10 kHz 10 × 103 = 100 ⇒ 1 + A0 β = 100 99 ⇒ β = 4 = 0.0099 V/V 10 A0 Af (0) = 1 + A0 β 104 = 100 V/V = 100 Af (0) Af (s) = s 1+ ωHf Af (s) = 100 1 + s/2π × 104 The 3-dB frequency of the closed-loop amplifier is f0 , which can be obtained from Eq. (10.68) and the graphical construction of Fig. 10.32: f0 1 = (fP1 + fP2 ) 2Q 2 1 f0 = √ (1 + 198) = 140.7 kHz 2 10.82 (a) The closed-loop poles become coincident when Q = 0.5. Using Eq. (10.70), we obtain √ (1 + A0 β)ωP1 ωP2 Q= ωP1 + ωP2 √ (1 + A0 β)ωP1 ωP2 0.5 = ωP1 + ωP2 ⇒ 1 + A0 β = 0.52 (ωP1 + ωP2 )2 ωP1 ωP2 = 0.52 × (2π)2 (104 + 105 )2 (2π)2 × 104 × 105 = 0.52 × 112 = 3.025 10 β = 2.025 × 10−4 ωc = = 1 (ωP1 + ωP2 ) 2 1 × 2π(fP1 + fP2 ) 2 fc = 1 × (104 + 105 ) = 5.5 × 104 Hz 2 Chapter 10–64 (b) Af (0) = = A0 1 + A0 β 10.83 Af = 10 104 = 3306 V/V 1 + 2.205 × 10−4 × 104 Af (s) = A(s) 1 + A(s)β s 1+ ωP1 s 1+ ωP1 = 1+ s ωP2 A0 1+ s ωP2 + A0 β A0 1 1 s2 (1 + A0 β) + s + + ωP1 ωP2 ωP1 ωP2 Af (jω) = (1 + A0 β) + j Af (jωc ) = A0 ω ω ω ω + − ωP1 ωP2 ωP1 ωP2 104 3.025 + j(5.5 + 0.55) − 5.5 × 0.55 104 Af (jωc ) = j 6.05 | Af |(jωc ) = K2 1+ A0 Af (s) = Let each stage in the cascade have a dc gain K and a 3-dB frequency fP , thus A(s) = where A(s) = Maximally flat response with fsdB = f0 = 1 kHz. 104 = 1653 V/V 6.05 s ωP 2 Using the expression for Q in Eq. (10.70), we get √ (1 + A0 β)ωP1 ωP2 Q= ωP1 + ωP2 √ and substituting Q = 1/ 2, ωP1 = ωP2 = ωP , and A0 = K 2 , we obtain 1 + K 2β 1 √ = 2 2 1 + K 2β = 2 and K 2β = 1 Now, Af 0 = A0 1 + A0 β 10 = K2 1 + K 2β (c) Q = 0.5. K2 2 (d) If β = 2.025 × 10−3 V/V. Using Eq. (10.68), we obtain = 1 s = − × 2π(104 + 105 ) 2 ⇒ K 2 = 20 ⇒ K = 1 ± × 2 2π (104 + 105 )2 − 4(1 + 104 × 2.025 × 10−3 ) × 104 × 105 s = −5.5 × 104 2π ±0.5 121 × 108 − 4 × 21.25 × 109 √ = −5.5 × 104 ± 0.5 × 104 121 − 40 × 21.25 = −5.5 × 104 ± j0.5 × 104 × 27 = (−5.5 ± j13.25) × 104 Hz Using Eq. (10.70), we obtain (1 + 104 × 2.025 × 10−3 )104 × 105 Q= 104 + 105 = 1.325 β= √ 20 = 4.47 V/V 1 = 0.05 V/V 20 Using Eq. (10.68), we obtain ω0 1 = (ωP1 + ωP2 ) Q 2 1 f0 √ = × 2 fP 2 1/ 2 √ √ ⇒ fP = 2f0 = 2 × 1 = 1.414 kHz Af (s) = Af (s) = 10ω02 ω0 s2 + s + ω02 Q 10(2π × 103 )2 2π × 103 s2 + s + (2π × 103 )2 √ 1/ 2 Chapter 10–65 Im 10.84 Let each stage have the transfer function T (s) = 3 Normalized s-plane K 1+ s ωP K 60° where ωP = 2π × 100 × 103 rad/s ⎞3 ⎛ ⎜ A(s) = ⎝ K 1+ (1K) 1 ⎟ s ⎠ ωP S s vP 3 K 2 0 Re K 2 3 β=1 Thus the characteristic equation is given by 1 + A(s)β = 0 1+ K3 s 1+ ωP Figure 1 lines with 60◦ angles to the horizontal. These two poles reach the jω axis (which is the boundary for stable operation) at K = 2 at which point √ S2,3 = ±j 3 3 = 0 s = S, where S is a ωP normalized frequency variable, thus To simplify matters, let (1 + S)3 + K 3 = 0 (1) This equation has three roots, which are the poles of the feedback amplifier. One of the roots will be real and the other two can be complex conjugate depending on the value of K. The real pole can be directly obtained from Eq. (1) as Thus the minimum value of K from which oscillations occur is K = 2. Oscillations will be at √ ω = 3 × 2π fP or f = √ 3 × 100 kHz = 173.2 kHz (1 + S1 )3 = −K 3 10.85 (1 + S1 ) = −K S1 = −(1 + K) (2) Now we need to obtain the two other poles. The characteristic equation in (1) can be written as S 3 + 3 S 2 + 3 S + (1 + K 3 ) = 0 (3) Equivalently it can be written as (S + 1 + K)(S 2 + aS + b) = 0 (4) Equating the coefficients of corresponding terms in (3) and (4), we can find a and b and thus obtain the quadratic factor S 2 + (2 − K)S + (1 − K + K 2 ) = 0 (5) This equation can now be easily solved to obtain the pair of complex conjugate poles as √ K 3 S2,3 = −1 + ± j K 2 2 Figure 1 shows the root locus of the three poles in the normalized s plane (normalized relative to ωP = 2π × 105 ). Observe that as K increases the real pole S1 moves outwardly on the negative real axis. The pair of conjugate poles move on straight A(s) = 1+ s 2π × 10 105 1+ s 2π × 103 β = 0.01 Aβ(jω) = ω 1+j 2π × 10 1000 1+j | Aβ| = 1+ ω 2π × 10 ω 2π × 103 1000 2 1+ ω 2π × 103 (1) 2 (2) Figure 1 (next page) sketches the Bode plot for | Aβ|. The unity-gain frequency will occur on the −40 dB/decade line. The value of f1 can be obtained from the Bode plot as follows: The −40 dB/decade line represents gain drop proportional to 103 /f 2 . For a drop by only 20 dB (a factor of 10) the change in frequency is 1 103 = 10 f12 √ f1 = 10 × 103 Hz = 3.16 × 103 Hz Chapter 10–66 40 20 dB/decade 20 0 1 b 0.001 10 102 103 f1 f (Hz) 40 dB/decade Figure 2 Figure 1 10.86 A0 = 105 with a single pole at fP = 10 Hz For a unity-gain buffer, β = 1, thus However, the Bode plot results are usually approximate. If we require a more exact value for f1 we need to iterate a couple of times using the exact equation in (2). The result is f1 = 3.085 × 103 Hz The phase angle can now be obtained using (1) as follows: ω1 ω1 φ = −tan−1 − tan−1 2π × 10 2π × 103 = −tan−1 A0 β = 105 and fP = 10 Hz Since the loop gain rolls off at a uniform slope of −20 dB/decade, it will reach the 0 dB line (| Aβ| = 1) five decades beyond 10 Hz. Thus the unity-gain frequency will be f1 = 105 × 10 = 106 Hz = 1 MHz The phase shift will be that resulting from a single pole, −90◦ , resulting in a phase margin: Phase margin = 180◦ − 90◦ = 90◦ f1 f1 − tan−1 3 10 10 = −tan−1 (3.085 × 102 ) − tan−1 (3.085) 10.87 Using Eq. (10.82), we obtain = −89.81◦ − 72.03◦ = −161.84 | Af (jω1 )| = Thus, where Phase margin = 180◦ − 161.84 = 18.15◦ θ = 180◦ − φ To obtain a phase margin of 45◦ : The phase shift due to the first pole will be 90◦ . Thus, the phase shift due to the second pole must be −45◦ , thus ◦ −45 = −tan −1 f1 103 f1 103 rad/s. Since f1 is two decades above fP we need A0 β to be 100. Thus, β will now be β = 100/105 = 10−3 Figure 2 shows a sketch of the Bode plot for | Aβ| in this case. 1/β |1 + e−jθ | φ ≡ Phase margin Peaking, P ≡ | Af (jω)| 1/β Thus, P = 1/|1 + e−jθ | = 1/|1 + cos θ − j sin θ| = 1/ (1 + cos θ)2 + sin2 θ √ = 1/ 2 + 2 cos θ = 1/ 2 + 2 cos(180◦ − φ) P = 1/ 2(1 − cos φ) 1 ⇒ φ = cos−1 1 − 2P 2 Chapter 10–67 At this frequency, | A| is 70 dB. The β horizontal straight line drawn at 70-dB level gives 1 20 log = 70 dB β We use this equation to obtain the following results: P φ 1.05 56.9◦ ⇒ β = 3.16 × 10−4 1.10 54.1◦ Correspondingly, ◦ 0.1 dB ≡ 1.0115 59.2 1.0 dB ≡ 1.122 52.9◦ 3 dB ≡ 1.414 41.4◦ Af = 104 = 2.4 × 103 V/V 1 + 104 × 3.16 × 10−4 or 67.6 dB 10.89 Figure 1, on the next page, is a replica of Fig. 10.37 except here we locate on the phase plot the points at which the phase margin is 90◦ and 135◦ , respectively. Drawing a vertical line from each of those points and locating the intersection with the | A| line enables us to determine the maximum β 10.88 Figure 1 below shows magnitude and phase Bode plots for the amplifier specified in this problem. From the phase plot we find that θ = −135◦ (which corresponds to a phase margin of 45◦ ) occurs at f = 3.16 × 105 Hz This figure belongs to Problem 10.88. 80 20 dB/decade 20 log(1/b) 70 dB 20 log 70 40 dB/decade 60 50 40 60 dB/decade 30 20 10 0 ° 0 105 3.16 105 106 fP1 fP2 fP3 104 Pole fP1 Pole fP2 Pole fP3 105 3.16 105 106 104 45° 90° 135° 180° Total phase 225° 270° Figure 1 107 f, Hz 107 f, Hz Chapter 10–68 This figure belongs to Problem 10.89. dB 20 dB/decade 100 90 20 log X1 20 log 1/b 85 dB (stable) 80 45º PM 25 dB gain margin 70 60 20 log 1/b for zero margins 50 40 90º PM (a) 40 dB/decade X2 (b) 20 log 1/b 50 dB (unstable) 30 60 dB/decade 20 f180º 10 0 10 102 10 102 103 w 0 45º 90º 104 105 106 f180º 107 108 f (Hz) 104 105 106 107 108 f(Hz) 90º PM 135º 108º 72º phase margin 180º 225º 45º phase margin 270º Figure 1 that can be used in each case. Thus, for PM = 90◦ : 1 20 log = 90 dB β ⇒ β = 3.16 × 10−5 10.90 Figure 1 below shows the Bode plot for the amplifier gain and for a differentiator. Observe that following the rate-of-closure rule the intersection of the two graphs is arranged so that the maximum difference in slopes is 20 dB/decade. and the corresponding closed-loop gain is Af = A0 105 = 1 + A0 β 1 + 105 × 3.16 × 10−5 dB = 2.4 × 104 V/Vor 87.6 dB and for PM = 45◦ , we have 1 20 log = 80 dB β ⇒ β = 10−4 V/V = 9.09 × 103 V/V or 79.2 dB 40 dB/ decade 20 dB/decade 40 Bode plot for differentiator 20 and the corresponding closed-loop gain is A0 105 = Af = 1 + A0 β 1 + 105 × 10−4 20 dB/decade 60 0.001 0.01 0 0.1 1 1 2pCR Figure 1 10 100 f (MHz) Chapter 10–69 Thus, to guarantee stability, 10.94 The fourth, dominant pole must be at 1 ≤ 0.001 MHz or 1 kHz 2πCR 1 = 0.159 ms ⇒ CR ≥ 2π × 103 fD = = fP1 A0 106 = 10 Hz 105 R 1 M 10.91 The new pole must be placed at 1 MHz = 100 Hz 104 In this way the modified open-loop gain will decrease at the uniform rate of −20 dB/decade, thus reaching 0 dB in four decades, that is at 1 MHz where the original pole exists. At 1 MHz, the slope changes to −40 dB/decade, but our amplifier will be guaranteed to be stable with a closed-loop gain at low as unity. C fD = 10.92 We must move the 1 MHz pole to a new location, 20 MHz = 2 kHz 104 This reduction in frequency by a factor of 1 MHz = 500 will require that the total 2 kHz capacitance at the controlling node must become 500 times what it originally was. fD = 1 M Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1. fD = 1 2πRC 10 = 1 2π × 1 × 106 × C ⇒ C = 15.9 nF 10.95 fP1 = 105 = 20 log 1 = 60 dB β A horizontal line at the 60-dB level will intersect the vertical line at fP2 = 106 Hz at a point Z1 . Drawing a line with a slope of −20 dB/decade from Z1 will intersect the 100-dB horizontal line at a frequency two decade lower than fP2 , thus the frequency to which the 1st pole must be moved is fD = 106 fP2 = = 10 kHz 100 100 (b) For β = 0.1, 20 log 1 = 20 dB β Following a process similar to that for (a) above, the first pole must be lowered to fD = 106 = 100 kHz 104 1 2π × 150 × 10−12 × R1 ⇒ R1 = 10.61 k fP2 = 1 2πC2 R2 106 = 1 2π × 5 × 10−12 × R2 10.93 Refer to Fig. 10.38. (a) For β = 0.001, 1 2πC1 R1 ⇒ R2 = 31.83 k First, we determine an approximate value of fP2 from Eq. (10.94) fP2 = gm Cf 2π[C1 C2 + Cf (C1 + C2 )] Assume that Cf C2 , then fP2 = gm 2π(C1 + C2 ) 40 × 10−3 2π(150 + 5) × 10−12 = 41.1 MHz which is much greater than fP3 . Thus, we use fP3 to determine the new location of fP1 , 2 × 106 = 200 Hz 104 Using Eq. (10.93), we obtain fP1 = fP1 = 1 2πgm R2 Cf R1 Chapter 10–70 200 = A(s)β(s) = − ⇒ Cf = 58.9 pF = A(s) Since Cf is indeed much greater than C2 , the pole at the output will have the frequency already calculated: A(s)β(s) = 1 2π × 40 × 10−3 × 31.83 × 103 × Cf × 10.61 × 103 fP2 41.1 MHz 1/sC R + 1/sC 105 1 s 1 + sCR 1+ 10 CR = 0.01 × 10−6 × 100 × 103 = 10−3 s 10.96 A(s)β(s) = Rs 100 k A (s) Vt Vr Vt (a) Bode plots for the magnitude and phase of Aβ are shown in Fig. 2. From the magnitude plot we find the frequency f1 at which | Aβ| = 1 is R 100 k Vr 105 s s 1+ 3 1+ 10 10 f1 = 3.16 × 104 Hz C 0.01 F (b) From the phase plot we see that the phase at f1 is 180◦ and thus the phase margin is zero. A more exact value for the phase margin can be obtained as follows: Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 10.96, part (a). 100 20 dB/decade 80 40 dB/decade 60 40 f1 3.16 20 0 1 10 fP1 100 1000 fP2 10,000 f (Hz) 100,000 0º 45º f (Hz) Phase of fP1 90º 135º 104 Hz Total phase 180º Figure 2 Phase of fP2 Chapter 10–71 θ (f1 ) = −tan−1 3.16 × 104 3.16 × 104 − tan−1 10 103 s = (−0.505 ± j31.62) × 103 rad/s The poles and zero are shown in Fig. 3. = −89.98 − 88.19 = −178.2 Thus the phase margin is 1.8◦ . (c) Af (s) = A(s) 1 + A(s)β(s) 105 / 1 + = 1+ s 10 105 s s 1+ 3 1+ 10 10 s 105 1 + 3 10 = s s 105 + 1 + 1+ 3 10 10 s 1+ 3 10 = 1 + 10−5 (1 + 0.101s + 0.0001s2 ) At s = 0, Figure 3 The pair of complex-conjugate poles have ω0 31.62 krad/s Q = 31.3 Thus, the response is very peaky, as shown in Fig. 4. Af 1 Af 1000 The transmission zero is 1000 2 1.01 krad/s sZ = −103 rad/s The poles are the roots of 10−9 s2 + 1.01 × 10−6 s + 1 = 0 which are 1 0 v0 31.62 krad/s Figure 4 v krad/s Exercise 11–1 Ex: 11.1 To allow for v O to reach −VCC + VCEsat = −15 + 0.2 = −14.8 V, with Q1 just cutting off (i.e. iE1 = 0), vo RL 1 = = = 0.995 V/V vi RL + re1 1 + 0.0052 At v O = 0 V, 14.8 14.8 V = 14.8 mA = I= RL 1 k iE1 = 14.8 mA The value of R can now be found from VCC − VD VR = I= R R 15 − 0.7 14.8 = R 14.3 = 0.97 k ⇒R= 14.8 The resulting output signal swing will be −14.8 V to +14.8 V. The minimum current in Q1 = 0. The maximum current in Q1 = 14.8 + 14.8 = 29.6 mA re1 = 25 mV = 1.7 14.8 mA RL 1 vo = = 0.998 V/V = vi RL + re1 1 + 0.0017 At v O = +10 V, iE1 = 24.8 mA re1 = 25 mV = 1.0 24.8 mA RL 1 vo = = = 0.999 V/V vi RL + re1 1 + 0.001 Ex: 11.2 At v O = −10 V, we have Ex: 11.3 −10 = −10 mA 1 iE1 = I + iL = 14.8 − 10 = 4.8 mA 4.8 v BE1 = 0.6 + 0.025 ln 1 a. PL = iL = = 0.64 V v I = v O + v BE1 = −10 + 0.64 = −9.36 V At v O = 0 V, we have iL = 0 mA iE1 = I = 14.8 mA 14.8 v BE1 = 0.6 + 0.025 ln 1 = 0.67 V v I = v O + v BE1 = 0 + 0.67 = 0.67 V 10 = 10 mA 1 iE1 = I + iL = 14.8 + 10 = 24.8 mA 24.8 v BE1 = 0.6 + 0.025 ln 1 RL = √ 2 8/ 2 100 =2W Efficiency η = = PL × 100 PS 0.32 × 100 2 = 16% Ex: 11.4 (a) PL = = 1 Vˆo2 2 RL 1 (4.5)2 = 2.53 W 2 4 (b) PS+ = PS− = VCC × =6× 1 Vˆo π RL 1 4.5 × = 2.15 W π 4 (c) η = 2.53 PL × 100 × 100 = PS 2 × 2.15 = 59% (d) Peak input currents = 1 Vˆo β + 1 RL v I = v O + v BE1 1 4.5 × 51 4 = 22.1 mA = 10 + 0.68 = 10.68 V (e) Using Eq. (11.22), we obtain = 0.68 V At v O = −10 V, we have iE1 = 4.8 mA re1 = 25 mV = 5.2 4.8 mA = 0.32 W PS = 2VCC × I = 2 × 10 × 100 × 10−3 At v O = 10 V iL = √ 2 V̂o / 2 = PDN max = PDPmax = = 2 VCC π 2 RL 62 = 0.91 W π2 × 4 Exercise 11–2 VT 25 = 0.25 = iN + iP 100.04 + 0.04 Ex: 11.5 (a) The quiescent power dissipated in each transistor = IQ × VCC Rout = Total power dissipated in the two transistors RL vo = 1 vi RL + Rout = 2IQ × VCC = 60 mW 1 − 0.94 × 100 = 6% 1 For IQ = 10 mA, change is 1.2% (b) IQ is increased to 10 mA For IQ = 2 mA, change is 6% At v O = 0, we have iN = iP = 10 mA (c) The quiesent power dissipated in each transistor = IQ × VCC = 2 × 2 × 10−3 × 15 From Eq. (11.31), we obtain Rout VT 25 = 1.25 = = iP + iN 10 + 10 RL 100 vo = = vi RL + Rout 100 + 1.25 vo = 0.988 at v O = 0 V vi At v O = 10 V, we have 10 V = 0.1 A = 100 mA 100 Use Eq. (11.27) to calculate iN : iL = iN2 − iN iL − IQ2 = 0 % Change = Total power dissipated = 2 × 10 × 10−3 × 15 = 300 mW Ex: 11.6 From Example 11.4, we have VCC = 15 V, RL = 100 QN and QP matched and IS = 10−13 A and β = 50, IBias = 3 mA 10 = 0.1 A 100 As a first approximation, iN 0.1 A, For v O = 10 V, we have iL = 0.1 A 2 mA 50 + 1 iN2 − 100 iN − 102 = 0 iP = 0, iBN ⇒ iN = 101.0 mA iD = IBias − iBN = 3 − 2 = 1 mA ⎛ ⎞ Using Eq. (11.26), we obtain iP = IQ2 iN Rout = 1 mA VT 25 0.2451 = iN + iP 101.0 + 1 RL 100 vo = = 1 vi RL + Rout 100 + 0.2451 −3 ⎜ 10 ⎟ (1) VBB = 2VT ln⎝ ⎠ 1 −13 × 10 3 1 1 This is because biasing diodes have area of 3 3 the output devices. ⫹VCC 1 − 0.988 × 100 = 1.2% 1 In Example 11.3, IQ = 2 mA, and for v O = 0 % change = Rout IBias VT 25 = 6.25 = = iN + iP 2+2 QN RL 100 vo = 0.94 = = vi RL + Rout 100 + 6.25 iD iN v O = 10 V 10 V = 100 mA iL = 100 Again calculate iN (for IQ = 2 mA) using Eq. (11.27) (iN = 100.04 mA): iP = IQ2 IN = vO iP vI Qp 22 = 0.04 mA 100.04 ⫺VCC iL RL Exercise 11–3 But VBB = VBEN + VBEP iN i N − iL = VT ln + VT ln IS IS iN (iN − iL ) = V T ln IS2 Expressing currents in mA, we have iP (iP − 100) = 81 iP2 − 100 iP − 81 = 0 (2) ⇒ iP = 100.8 mA iN = iP + iL = 0.8 mA Equating Eqs. 1 and 2, we obtain ⎛ ⎞ −3 iN (iN − iL ) ⎜ 10 ⎟ 2VT ln⎝ ⎠ = VT ln 1 IS2 × 10−13 3 ⎛ ⎞2 Ex: 11.7 IC = gm × 2 mV/◦ C × 5 ◦ C, mA where gm is in mA / mV 10 mA = 0.4 mA/mV 25 mV Thus, IC = 0.4 × 2 × 5 = 4 mA gm = −3 iN (iN − 0.1) ⎜ 10 ⎟ ⎝1 ⎠ = −13 2 10 × 10−13 3 iN (iN − 0.1) = 9 × 10−6 If iN is in mA, then Ex: 11.8 Refer to Fig. 11.15. iN (iN − 100) = 9 iN2 − 100 iN − 9 = 0 (a) To obtain a terminal voltage of 1.2 V, and since β 1 is very large, it follows that VR1 = VR2 = 0.6 V. ⇒ iN = 100.1 mA Thus IC1 = 1 mA iP = iN − iL = 0.1 mA For v O = −10 V and iL = IR = −10 = −0.1 A 100 Thus, I = IC1 + IR = 1.5 mA = −100 mA: As a first approximation assume iP ∼ = 100 mA, iN 0. Since iN = 0, current through diodes = 3 mA ⎛ ⎞ −3 ⎜ 3 × 10 ⎟ ∴ VBB = 2VT ln⎝ ⎠ 1 × 10−13 3 iN iP + VT ln But VBB = VT ln −13 −13 10 10 i P + iL iP + VT ln = V T ln −13 10 10−13 Here iL = −0.1 A Equating Eqs. (3) and (4), we obtain ⎛ ⎞ −3 ⎜ 3 × 10 ⎟ 2VT ln⎝ ⎠= 1 × 10−13 3 iP − 0.1 iP ln + V VT ln T 10−13 10−13 ⎛ ⎞2 −3 iP (iP − 0.1) ⎜ 3 × 10 ⎟ ⎝1 ⎠ = −13 2 10 × 10−13 3 iP (iP − 0.1) = 81 × 10−6 1.2 V 1.2 = 0.5 mA = R1 + R2 2.4 (b) For VBB = +50 mV: VBB = 1.25 V IR = VBE = (3) 1.25 = 0.52 mA 2.4 1.25 = 0.625 V 2 IC1 = 1 × eVBE /VT = e0.025/0.025 = 2.72 mA I = 2.72 + 0.52 = 3.24 mA For VBB = +100 mV, we have (4) VBB = 1.3 V, VBE = IR = 1.3 = 0.54 mA 2.4 1.3 = 0.65 V 2 IC1 = 1 × eVBE /VT = 1 × e0.05/0.025 = 7.39 mA I = 7.39 + 0.54 = 7.93 mA For VBB = +200 mV: VBB = 1.4 V, IR = 1.4 = 0.58 mA 2.4 VBE = 0.7 V IC1 = 1 × e0.1/0.025 = 54.60 mA I = 54.60 + 0.58 = 55.18 mA Exercise 11–4 At this current, |VBE | is given by 2.86 × 10−3 |VBE | = 0.025 ln 0.63 V −14 3.3 × 10 For VBB = −50 mV: VBB = 1.15 V, IR = 1.15 = 0.48 mA 2.4 1.15 2 = 0.575 Thus VE1 = 0.63 V and I1 = 2.87 mA IC1 = 1 × e−0.025/0.025 = 0.37 mA iC1 = iC2 = iC3 = iC4 2.87 mA I = 0.48 + 0.37 = 0.85 mA (b) For v I = +10 V: For VBB = −100 mV: To start the iterations, let VBE1 0.7 V VBE = No more iterations are required and VBB = 1.1 V IR = Thus, 1.1 = 0.46 mA 2.4 VE1 = 10.7 V VBE = 0.55 V and IC1 = 1 × e−0.05/0.025 = 0.13 mA I1 = I = 0.46 + 0.13 = 0.59 mA 15 − 10.7 = 0.86 mA 5 For VBB = −200 mV: VBB = 1.0 V IR = ⫹15 V 1 = 0.417 mA 2.4 VBE = 0.5 V IC1 = 1 × e 5 k⍀ I1 −0.1/0.025 = 0.018 mA Q3 I = 0.43 mA Q1 Ex: 11.9 (a) From symmetry we see that all transistors will conduct equal currents and have equal VBE ’s. Thus, ⫹10 V vO Q2 vO = 0 V Q4 ⫹15 V I2 I1 5 k⍀ 5 k⍀ VE1 ⫺15 V Q3 Q1 Neglecting IB3 , we obtain vO 0V Q2 Q4 5 k⍀ IC1 IE1 I1 = 0.86 mA But at this current IC1 |VBE1 | = VT ln IS 0.86 × 10−3 = 0.025 ln 3.3 × 10−14 = 0.6 V ⫺15 V Thus, VE1 = +10.6 V and I1 = 0.88 mA. No further iterations are required and IC1 0.88 mA. If VBE 0.7 V, then To find IC2 , we use an identical procedure: 15 − 0.7 = 2.86 mA VE1 = 0.7 V and I1 = 5 If we neglect IB3 , then VBE2 0.7 V IC1 2.86 mA I2 = VE2 = 10 − 0.7 = +9.3 V 9.3 − (−15) = 4.86 mA 5 Exercise 11–5 VBE2 = 0.025 ln 4.86 × 10−3 3.3 × 10−14 I1 = 15 − 10.6 = 0.88 mA 5 = 0.643 V IE1 = I1 − IB3 = 0.88 − 0.5 = 0.38 mA VE2 = 10 − .643 = +9.357 IC1 0.38 mA I2 = 4.87 mA |VBE1 | = 0.025 ln IC2 4.87 mA 0.38 × 10−3 3.3 × 10−14 = 0.58 V Finally, VE1 = 10.58 V IC3 = IC4 = 3.3 × 10−14 eVBE /VT I1 = where VE1 − VE2 = 0.62 V 2 Thus, IC3 = IC4 = 1.95 mA VBE = 15 − 10.58 = 0.88 mA 5 Thus, IC1 0.38 mA Now for Q2 we have The symmetry of the circuit enables us to find the values for v I = −10 V as follows: IC1 = 4.87 mA IC2 = 0.88 mA VBE2 = 0.643 V VE2 = 10 − 0.643 = 9.357 I2 = 4.87 mA IC3 = IC4 = 1.95 mA IB4 0 For v I = +10 V, we have v O = VE1 − VBE3 IC2 4.87 mA (as in (b)) = 10.6 − 0.62 = +9.98 V Assuming that IC3 100 mA, we have 100 × 10−3 VBE3 = 0.025 ln 3.3 × 10−14 For v I = −10 V, we have v O = VE1 − VBE3 = −9.357 − 0.62 = −9.98 V (c) For v I = +10 V, we have = 0.72 V v O 10 V IL 100 mA Thus, v O = VE1 − VBE3 IC3 100 mA = 10.58 − 0.72 = +9.86 V IB3 = 100 0.5 mA 201 |VBE4 | = v O − VE2 9.86 − 9.36 = 0.5 V Thus, IC4 = 3.3 × 10−14 e0.5/0.025 5 k⍀ I1 0.02 mA Q3 Q1 From symmetry we find the values for the case IB3 v I = −10 V as: vI IL Q2 vO 100 k⍀ IC1 = 4.87 mA, IC2 = 0.38 mA IC3 = 0.02 mA, IC4 = 100 mA v O = −9.86 V. Q4 I2 5 k⍀ Ex: 11.10 For Q1 : iC1 = ISP ev EB /VT Assuming that |VBE1 | has not changed much from 0.6 V, then iC = ISP ev EB /VT βN + 1 VE1 10.6 V iC β N ISP ev EB /VT Exercise 11–6 Thus, effective scale current = β N ISP (b) Effective current gain ≡ iC = βPβN iB = 20 × 50 = 1000 100 × 10−3 = 50 × 10−14 ev EB /0.025 v EB = 0.025 ln 2 × 1011 = 0.651 V Ex: 11.11 See Figure 11.21 When VBE5 = 150 × 10−3 × RE1 , then ICS = IBias = 2 mA VBE5 = VT ln = 25 × 10−3 IC5 IS 2 × 10−3 ln 10−14 = 0.651 V 1 W kn (VGS − Vtn )2 2 L 1 1 W 0.2 = × 0.250 (0.2)2 2 L 1 W ⇒ = 40 L 1 1 W Q2 : IBias = k P (VGS − |Vt |)2 2 L 2 1 W 0.2 = × 0.100 × × (0.2)2 2 L 2 W ⇒ = 100 L 2 1 W QN : IQ = k n (VGS − Vt )2 2 L N 1 W 1 = × 0.250 × 0.22 2 L n W ⇒ = 200 L n 1 W QP : IQ = k p (VGS − |Vt |)2 2 L p W 1 1 = × 0.100 × × 0.22 2 L p W = 500 L p Q1 : IBias = Now VGG = VGS1 + VGS2 = (Vov1 + Vt ) + (Vov2 + |Vt |) = (0.2 + 0.5) + (0.2 + 0.5) = 1.4 V 150 × 10−3 RE1 = 0.651 RE1 = 4.34 If peak output current = 100 mA VBE5 = RE1 × 100 mA = 4.34 × 100 × 10−3 Ex: 11.13 IN = iLmax = 10 mA W 1 V2 ∴ 10 = k n 2 L n OV 1 2 × 0.250 × 200 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.63 V 10 = = 0.434 V iC5 = IS eVBE5 /VT −3 = 10−14 e0.434/25×10 Using equation 11.46, we obtain 0.35 μA v Omax = VDD − VOV |Bias − Vtn − VOVN = 2.5 − 0.2 − 0.5 − 0.63 Ex: 11.12 Using Eq. (11.43), we obtain IQ = IBias 1 = 0.2 (W/L)n (W/L)1 (W/L)n (W/L)P (W/L)n =5 (W/L)1 = 1.17 V Ex: 11.14 New values of W/L are 2000 W = = 1000 L P 2 W 800 = 400 = L N 2 Exercise 11–7 1 W V2 kp 2 L P OV Gain error 0.14 VOV =− =− 4μI Q RL 4 × 10 × 1 × 10−3 × 100 Ex: 11.16 From Fig. 11.31 we see that for Pdissipation to be less than 2.9 W, a maximum supply voltage of 20V is called for. The 20-V-supply curve intersects the 3% distoration line at a point for which the output power is 4.2 W. Since √ 2 Vˆo / 2 PL = RL √ we have Vˆo = 4.2 × 2 × 8 = 8.2 V = −0.035 or 16.4 V peak-to-peak IQ = 1 2 × 0.1 × 10−3 × 1000 × VOV 2 = 0.14 V 1 × 10−3 = ⇒ VOV Gain error = −0.035 × 100 = −3.5% gmn = gmp = 2IQ 2 × 1 × 10−3 = VOV 0.14 Ex: 11.17 Voltage gain = 2 K where K = = 14.14 mA/V Rout = R2 R4 =1+ = 1.5 R3 R1 Thus, Av = 3 V/V 1 μ gmp + gmn Input resistance = R3 = 10 k 1 = 10 × (14.14 + 14.14) × 10−3 Peak-to-Peak v o = 3 × 20 = 60 V 3.5 Peak load current = 2v i vo Ex: 11.15 Total current into node B = + R3 R2 Thus vo vo 2v i + R=− R3 R2 A R 1 2R + = − vi ⇒ vo A R2 R3 PL = √ 2 30/ 2 8 30 V = 3.75 A 8 = 56.25 W Ex: 11.18 See Fig. 1. 2R − vo R3 = 1 R vi + A R2 = −2R2 /R3 1 + (R2 /AR) Q.E.D. Q4 B vi vo R3 ⫹ R2 Q6 For AR ⫺A vi R3 ⫺ vo vo A R2 , we have 2R2 vo − vi R3 Figure 1 continued Exercise 11–8 Ex: 11.19 fs = 10 × highest frequency in audio signal = 10 × 20 = 200 kHz Since fs is a decade higher than fP , the gain will have fallen by 40 dB. Thus the PWM component at fs will be attenuated by 40 dB. Ex: 11.20 Maximum peak amplitude = VDD √ (VDD / 2)2 Maximum power delivered to RL = RL = 2 VDD 2RL For VDD = 35 V and RL = 8 : Peak amplitude = 35 V Maximum power = 352 = 76.6 W 2×8 Power delivered by power supplies = 76.6 PL = = 85.1 W η 0.9 Ex: 11.21 TJ − TA = θ JA PD 200 − 25 = θ JA × 50 175 = 3.5◦ C/W 50 But, θ JA = θ JC + θ CS + θ SA θ JA = 3.5 = 1.4 + 0.6 + θ SA ⇒ θ SA = 1.5◦ C/W TJ − TC = θ JC × PD TC = TJ − uJC × PD = 200 − 1.4 × 50 Figure 1 = 130◦ C Chapter 11–1 0 − (−VCC ) − VD R 10 − 0.7 = = 9.3 mA 1 Upper limit on v O = VCC − VCEsat 11.1 I = I= 1 W μn Cox (VGS − Vt )2 2 L But VGS = 2.5 − IR = 2.5 − I = 10 − 0.3 = 9.7 V Thus Corresponding input = 9.7 + 0.7 = 10.4 V I= Lower limit on v O = −IRL = −9.3 × 1 = −9.3 V Corresponding input = −9.3 + 0.7 = −8.6 V If the EBJ area of Q3 is twice as large as that of Q2 , then = W 1 μn Cox (2.5 − I − Vt )2 2 L 1 × 20(2.5 − I − 0.5)2 2 I = 10(2 − I )2 ⇒ I 2 − 4.1I + 4 = 0 I = 1.6 mA and VGS = 0.9 V 1 × 9.3 = 4.65 mA 2 There will be no change in v Omax and in the corresponding value of v I . However, v Omin will now become The upper limit on v O is determined by Q1 leaving the saturation region (and entering the triode region). This occurs when v I exceeds VDD by Vt volts: v Omin = −IRL v I max = 2.5 + 0.5 = 3 V I= = −4.65 × 1 = −4.65 V and the corresponding value of v I will be To obtain the corresponding value of v O , we must find the corresponding value of VGS1 , as follows: v I = −4.65 + 0.7 = −3.95 V v O = v I − VGS1 If the EBJ area of Q3 is made half as big as that of Q2 , then iL = I = 4 × 9.3 = 18.6 mA iL = 3 − VGS1 There will be no change in v Omax and in the corresponding value of v I . However, v Omin will now become iD1 = iL + I = 3 − VGS1 + 1.6 = 4.6 − VGS1 v Omin = −VCC + VCEsat But, = −10 + 0.3 = −9.7 V and the corresponding value of v I will be v I = −9.7 + 0.7 = −9 V 11.2 First we determine the bias current I as follows: vO v I − VGS1 v I − VGS1 = = RL RL 1 iD1 = 1 W μn Cox (VGS1 − Vt )2 2 L 4.6 − VGS1 = 1 × 20(VGS1 − 0.5)2 2 2 ⇒ VGS1 − 0.9VGS1 − 0.21 = 0 VGS1 = 1.09 V v Omax = v I max − VGS1 = 3 − 1.09 = +1.91 V The lower limit of v O is determined either by Q1 cutting off, v O = −IRL = −1.6 × 1 = −1.6 V or by Q2 leaving saturation, v O = −VDD + VOV 2 where VOV 2 = VGS2 − Vt = 0.9 − 0.5 = 0.4 V Thus, v O = −2.5 + 0.4 = −2.1 V Chapter 11–2 We observe that Q1 will cut off before Q2 leaves saturation, thus v Omin = −1.6 V Since we are provided with four devices, we can minimize the total supply current by paralleling two devices to form Q2 as shown below. and the corresponding value of v I will be 5 V v I min = v Omin + Vt = −1.6 + 0.5 = −1.1 V vI 11.3 Refer to Fig. 11.2. For a load resistance of 100 and v O ranging between –5 V and +5 V, the maximum current through Q1 is 5 = I + 50, mA and the minimum current 0.1 5 is I − = I − 50, mA. 0.1 For a current ratio of 15, we have I+ I + 50 = 15 I − 50 vO R I RL Q2A Q3 Q2B 5 V ⇒ I = 57.1 mA 9.3 V = 163 R= 57.1 mA The incremental voltage gain is Av = Q1 I rather 2 than 2I which is the value obtained in the circuit of Fig. 11.2. Then the supply current is 4.5 mA. The value of R is found from 4.3 V R= = 2.87 k 1.5 mA In a practical design we would select a standard value for R that results in I somewhat larger than 3 mA. Say, R = 2.7 k. In this case I = 3.2 mA. The resulting supply current will be 3 × RL RL + re1 For RL = 100 ; At v O = +5 V, iE1 = 57.1 + 50 = 107.1 mA 25 = 0.233 107.1 100 = 0.998 V/V Av = 100 + 0.233 re1 = Power from negative supply = 3 × 1.6 × 5 = 24 mW. At v O = 0 V, iE1 = 57.1 mA 25 = 0.438 57.1 100 = 0.996 V/V Av = 100.438 At v O = −5 V, iE1 = 57.1 − 50 = 7.1 mA re1 = 11.5 Refer to Figs. 11.2 and 11.4. For v O being a square wave of ±VCC levels: 25 = 3.52 7.1 100 = 0.966 V/V Av = 103.52 Thus the incremental gain changes by 0.998 − 0.966 = 0.032 or about 3% over the range of v O . re1 = 11.4 Refer to Fig. 11.2. With VCC = +5 V, the upper limit on v o is 4.7 V, which is greater than the required value of +3 V. To obtain a lower limit of −3 V, we select I so that IRL = 3 ⇒ I = 3 mA PD1 |average = 0. For the corresponding sine wave 1 curve [Fig. 11.4], we have PD1 |avg = VCC I . 2 Chapter 11–3 For v O being a square wave of ±VCC /2 levels: 1 V̂ V̂ = = 0.25 4 V̂ V̂ or 25% 11.8 Refer to Figs. 11.6 and 11.7. A 10% loss in peak amplitude is obtained when the amplitude of the input signal is 5 V. 11.9 vO 0.7 vO vI vO = iC1 1 v CE1 = VCC − VCC sin θ 2 1 1 PD1 = VCC − VCC sin θ I + I sin θ 2 2 1 = VCC I − VCC I sin2 θ 4 1 1 = VCC I − VCC I × (1 − cos 2θ ) 4 2 1 7 = VCC I + VCC I cos 2θ 8 8 7 PD1 |average = VCC I 8 vO 100 For a sine-wave output of VCC /2 peak amplitude: 1 VCC sin θ 2 1 VCC 1 =I+ 2 sin θ = I + I sin θ RL 2 QN PD1 |average = 0.75VCC I QP RL With v I sufficiently positive so that QN is conducting, the situation shown obtains. Then, (v I − v O ) × 100 = v O + 0.7 1 (v I − 0.007) 1.01 This relationship applies for v I ≥ 0.007. Similarly, for v I sufficiently negative so that QP conducts, the voltage at the output of the amplifier becomes v O − 0.7, thus ⇒ vO = (v I − v O ) × 100 = v O − 0.7 1 (v I + 0.007) 1.01 This relationship applies for v I ≤ −0.007. ⇒ vO = 11.6 In all cases, the average voltage across Q2 is equal to VCC . Thus, since Q2 conducts a constant current I, its average power dissipation is VCC I. 11.7 The minimum required value of VCC is VCC = V̂ and the minimum required value of I is I= V̂ RL From Eq. (11.10), V̂o 1 V̂o η= 4 IRL VCC The result is the transfer characteristic Chapter 11–4 Without the feedback arrangement, the deadband becomes ±700 mV and the slope change a little (to nearly +1 V/V). 11.10 iD = 4 mA and RL = Devices have |Vt | = 0.5 V W = 2 mA/V2 L For RL = ∞, the current is normally zero, so μC ox VGS = Vt ∴ v O = v I − VGS1 = 5 − 0.5 = 4.5 V The peak output voltage will be 4.5 V 0.5 ⇒ θ = 5.74◦ sin θ = 5 Crossover interval = 4θ = 22.968 22.96 × 100 = 360 = 6.4% 2.5 V = 625 4 mA 11.11 For VCC = 10 V and RL = 8 , the maximum sine-wave output power occurs when 2 1 VCC V̂o = VCC and is PLmax = 2 RL 1 100 = 6.25 W = × 2 8 Correspondingly, PS+ = PS− = 1 V̂o VCC π RL 10 1 × × 10 = 3.98 W π 8 for a total supply power of = PS = 2 × 3.98 = 7.96 W The power conversion efficiency η is η= PL 6.25 × 100 = 78.5% × 100 = PS 7.96 For V̂o = 5 V, PL = 1 V̂o2 1 25 = 1.56 W = × 2 RL 2 8 PS+ = PS− = 1 V̂o VCC π RL 5 1 × × 10 = 2 W π 8 PS = 4 W 1.56 × 100 = 39% η= 4 Thus, the efficiency reduces to half its maximum value. = For υI = 5 V, υO = 2.5 V: ∴ VGS = 5 − 2.5 = 2.5 V iD = = 1 W μC ox (VGS − Vt )2 2 L 1 × 2 × (2.5 − 0.5)2 2 11.12 PL = 50 = 1 V̂o2 2 RL 1 V̂o2 2 8 ⇒ V̂o = 28.3 V Chapter 11–5 VCC = 28.3 + 4 = 32.3 → 33 V Peak current from each supply = Pdissipation/device = 28.3 V̂o = RL 8 = 3.54 A PS+ = PS− = 1 × 3.54 × 33 = 37.2 W π 11−η PL = 0.772PL 2 η 1 = 0.772PL ⇒ PL = 1.3 W = 1 52 2 RL ⇒ RL = 9.62 (i.e., ≥ 9.62 ) Thus, PS = 2 × 37.2 = 74.4 W η= 50 PL = 67.2% = PS 74.4 Using Eq. (11.22), we obtain PDN max = PDPmax = 2 VCC 332 = 13.8 W = 2 2 π RL π ×8 11.14 PL = PS+ = PS− PS = 11.13 VCC = 10 V For maximum η, V̂o = VCC = 10 V The output voltage that results in maximum device dissipation is given by Eq. (11.20), V̂o = 2 VCC π 2 × 10 = 6.37 V π If operation is always at full output voltage, η = 78.5% and thus = Pdissipation = (1 − η) PS 1 − 0.785 PL = PL = 0.274PL = (1 − η) η 0.785 1 × 0.274PL = 0.137PL 2 For a rated device dissipation of 2 W, and using a factor of 2 safety margin, η= V̂o2 RL 1 V̂o = VSS 2 RL V̂o VSS RL PL Vˆ2 /RL V̂o = o = PS VSS V̂o VSS RL ηmax = 1(100%) , obtained for V̂o = VSS PLmax = 2 VSS RL Pdissipation = PS − PL = V̂o V̂ 2 VSS − o RL RL ∂Pdissipation ∂ V̂o = = 0 for V̂o = VSS 2V̂o − RL RL VSS 2 Correspondingly, η = Pdissipation/device = Pdissipation/device = 1 W = 0.137PL ⇒ PL = 7.3 W 1 100 7.3 = × 2 RL ⇒ RL = 6.85 (i.e. RL ≥ 6.85 ) The corresponding output power (i.e., greatest possible output power) is 7.3 W. 1 VSS /2 = or 50% VSS 2 11.15 VBB = 2VT ln(IQ /IS ) = 2 × 0.025 ln(10−3 /10−14 ) = 1.266 V At v I = 0, iN = iP = IQ = 1 mA, we have 25 mV = 25 1 mA reP = 12.5 reN = reP = Rout = reN Av = vo RL 100 = = vi RL + Rout 100 + 12.5 = 0.889 V/V 1 If operation is allowed at V̂o = VCC = 5 V, 2 At v O = 10 V, we have π V̂o (Eq. 11.15) η= 4 VCC iL = = 1 π × = 0.393 4 2 10 = 0.1 A = 100 mA 100 To obtain iN , we use Eq. (11.27): iN2 − iL iN − IQ2 = 0 Chapter 11–6 iN2 − 100 iN − 1 = 0 11.17 Av = ⇒ iN = 100.01 mA Now Av ≥ 0.97 for RL ≥ 100 iP = iN − iL = 0.01 mA Rout VT = iP + iN 25 mV = 0.25 100 mA RL 100 = = 0.998 V/V RL + Rout 100 + 0.25 Av = ∴ 0.97 = 100 100 + Rout ⇒ Rout 3 Rout = 3 = 11.16 At iL = 0, we have iN = iP = IQ and Rout = VBB Thus, 100 12.5 100 + IQ (1) reN = ip iN iL − = βN + 1 βP + 1 β +1 where β N = β P = β = 49 0 Using values of v I from the table, one can evaluate Rin as vI Rin = iI Thus, Rout = 1.24 V iI = For iL = 50 mA, we have 50 mA and iP 25 × 10−3 VT = = 4.17 mA 6 6 4.17 = 2VBE = 2 0.7 + VT ln 100 11.18 The current iI can be obtained as where IQ is in mA. iN VT 2IQ IQ = 1 VT 2 IQ RL vo = = vi RL + Rout RL re VI and Rout = = RL + Rout 2 2IQ VT 25 mV = 0.5 = iN 50 mA 100 vo = 0.995 V/V = vi 100 + 0.5 Using the resistance reflection rule To limit the variation to 5%, we use v o = 0.995 − 0.05 = 0.945 V/V v i iL =0 Rin (β + 1)RL = 50 × 100 = 5000 For large input signal, the two values of Rin are somewhat the same. For the small values of v I , the calculated value in the table is larger. Substituting this value in Eq. (1) yields IQ = 2.15 mA This table belongs to Problem 11.18. vO (V) +10.0 +5.0 +1.0 +0.5 +0.2 +0.1 0 –0.1 –0.2 –0.5 –1.0 –5.0 –10.0 iL iN (mA) (mA) 100 100.04 50 50.08 10 10.39 5 5.70 2 3.24 1 2.56 0 2 –1 1.56 –2 1.24 –5 0.70 –10 0.39 –50 0.08 –100 0.04 iP (mA) 0.04 0.08 0.39 0.70 1.24 1.56 2 2.56 3.24 5.70 10.39 50.08 100.04 v BEN (V) 0.691 0.673 0.634 0.619 0.605 0.599 0.593 0.587 0.581 0.567 0.552 0.513 0.495 v EBP (V) 0.495 0.513 0.552 0.567 0.581 0.587 0.593 0.599 0.605 0.619 0.634 0.673 0.691 vi v O /v I (V) (V/V) 10.1 0.99 5.08 0.98 1.041 0.96 0.526 0.95 0.212 0.94 0.106 0.94 0 – –0.106 0.94 –0.212 0.94 –0.526 0.95 –1.041 0.96 –5.08 0.98 –10.1 0.99 Rout v o /v i () (V/V) 0.25 1.00 0.50 1.00 2.32 0.98 4.03 0.96 5.58 0.95 6.07 0.94 6.25 0.94 6.07 0.94 5.58 0.95 4.03 0.96 2.32 0.98 0.50 1.00 0.25 1.00 iI (mA) 2 1 0.2 0.1 0.04 0.02 0 –0.02 –0.04 –0.1 –0.2 –1 –2 Rin () 5050 5080 5205 5260 5300 5300 5300 5300 5260 5205 5080 5050 Chapter 11–7 RL vo = and vi RL + Rout 11.19 Largest possible positive output from 6 to 10, i.e., 4 V VT VT = at v O = 0 iP + iN IQ + IQ v o =1− v 1 v O =0 Rout = (a) RL =1− =1− RL + Rout VT /2IQ RL + VT /2IQ = RL VT RL + 2IQ = VT /2IQ VT = 2RL IQ + VT RL + VT /2IQ If 2IQ RL VT , then we have VT 2IQ RL Q.E.D. (b) Quiescent power dissipation = 2VCC IQ = PD × Quiescent power dissipation = VCC VT × 2VCC IQ = VT × 2IQ RL RL VCC ∴ PD = VT RL (c) VCC 10 = 25 × 10−3 × (d) PD = VT RL 100 = 2.5 mW PD = Largest negative output from 6 to 0, i.e., 6 V 11.21 Rout = re /2 = 8 ⇒ re = 16 IQ = VT 25 = 1.56 mA = re 16 Thus, n = 1.56 = 7.8 0.2 11.22 IQ IBIAS = 1 mA, neglecting the base current of QN . More precisely, IQ = IBIAS − ⇒ IQ = IQ β +1 IBIAS 1 1+ β +1 0.98 × 1 = 0.98 mA The largest positive output is obtained when all of IBIAS flows into the base of QN , resulting in v O = β N + 1 IBIAS RL = 51 × 1 × 100 = 5.1 V The largest possible negative output voltage is limited by the saturation of QP to −10 + VECsat = −10 V To achieve a maximum positive output of 10 V without changing IBIAS , β N must be 2.5 × 10−3 10 = β N + 1 × 1 × 10−3 × 100 0.05 0.02 0.01 PD (mW) IQ (mA) 50 125 250 2.5 6.25 12.5 ⇒ β N = 99 Alternatively, if β N is held at 50, IBIAS must be increased so that 10 = 51 × IBIAS × 10−3 × 100 ⇒ IBIAS = 1.96 mA 11.20 IQ = 1 mA For output of –1 V, we have 1 = −10 mA iL = − 100 Using Eq. (11.27), we obtain iN2 − iL iN − IQ2 = 0 iN2 + 10iN − 1 = 0 iN = 0.1mA iP = 10.1mA 10.1 = 0.06 V 1 and the input step must be –1.06 V. Thus v EBP increases by VT ln for which IBIAS = 1.92 mA IQ = 1 1+ β +1 11.23 Figure 1(a) shows the small-signal equivalent circuit of the class AB circuit in Fig. 11.14. Here, each of QN and QP has been replaced with its hybrid-π model, and the small resistances of the diodes have been neglected. As well, we have not included ro of each of QN and QP . The circuit in Fig. 1(a) can be simplified to that in Fig. 1(b) where rπ = rπN rπP (1) gm = gmN + gmP (2) Chapter 11–8 This figure belongs to Problem 11.23. vp vi gmNvp rpN E vp gmPvp rpP vo RL E (a) ii vp /rp vi vp rp rpN // rpP gmvp gm gmN gmP E vo ( 1 gm rp )v p RL (b) Figure 1 Since gm 1 , then from (2) we obtain re Equations (5) and (6) can be used to obtain the incremental (or small-signal) gain, 1 gm + RL vo rπ = 1 vi gm + RL + 1 rπ 1 1 1 = + re reN reP or, equivalently, re = reN reP (3) We observe that the circuit in Fig. 1(b) is the equivalent circuit of an emitter follower with the small-signal parameters rπ , gm , and re given in Eqs. (1), (2), and (3). Furthermore, its β is given by β = gm rπ = (gmN + gmP )(rπ N rπ P ) (4) For the circuit in Fig. 1(b), we can write vi = vπ + vo 1 v o = gm + v π RL rπ (5) (6) But, gm + 1 1 = rπ re Thus, vo RL /re = vi RL /re + 1 vo RL = = vi RL + re RL RL + (reN reP ) ⇒ Q.E.D. The input resistance is found as follows: vi vi Rin = = ii v π /rπ (7) Chapter 11–9 Substituting for v i from (5) together with utilizing (7) gives 1 v π 1 + gm + RL rπ Rin = v π /rπ = rπ + (gm rπ + 1)RL At 77.9◦ C: 25 VT = (273 + 77.9) = 29.9 mV 293 IQ = 3.78 × 10−11 × (1.14)57.9 e(0.6/0.0299) = 37.6 mA etc., etc. = rπ + (β + 1)RL = (β + 1)(RL + re ) 11.26 (a) VBE = 0.7 V at 1 mA β[RL + (reN reP )] Q.E.D. (8) At 0.5 mA, VBE = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 11.24 Refer to Fig. P11.24. Neglecting the small resistances of D1 and D2 , we can write for the voltage gain of the CE amplifier transistor Q3 , v c3 = −gm3 Rin (1) vi where Rin is the input resistance of the class AB circuit, given in the statement of Problem 11.23 as β[RL + (reN reP )] Rin (2) where β = (gmN + gmP )(rπ N rπ P ) (3) The voltage gain of the class AB circuit is given in the statement of Problem 11.23 as RL vo = (4) v c3 RL + (reN reP ) Now, we can combine (1), (2), and (4) to obtain the voltage gain of the circuit in Fig. P11.24 as RL vo = −gm3 β[RL + (reN reP )] vi RL + (reN reP ) vo = −gm3 βRL ⇒ vi where β is given by Eq. (3). 0.5 = 0.683 V 1 0.683 = 1.365 k 0.5 and R2 = 1.365 k Thus, R1 = VBB = 2VBE = 1.365 V (b) For Ibias = 2 mA, IC increases to nearly 1.5 mA for which 1.5 = 0.710 V VBE = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1 0.710 = 0.52 mA is very nearly Note that IR = 1.365 equal to the assumed value of 0.50 mA, thus no further iterations are required. VBB = 2VBE = 1.420 V (c) For Ibias = 10 mA, assume that IR remains constant at 0.5 mA, thus IC1 = 9.5 mA and VBE = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 9.5 = 0.756 V 1 at which 0.755 = 0.554 mA IR = 1.365 Thus, IC1 = 10 − 0.554 = 9.45 mA 9.45 = 0.756 V 1 = 2 × 0.756 = 1.512 V 11.25 At 20◦ C, IQ = 1mA = IS e(0.6/0.025) and VBE = 0.7 + 0.025 ln ⇒ IS (at 20◦ C) = 3.78 × 10−11 mA Thus, VBB ◦ −11 At 70 C, IS = 3.78 × 10 (1.14) 50 = 2.64 × 10−8 mA At 70◦ C, VT = 25 273 + 70 = 29.3 mV 273 + 20 Thus, IQ (at 70◦ C) = 2.64 × 10−8 e0.6/0.0293 = 20.7 mA Additional current = 20.7 − 1 = 19.7 mA Additional power = 2 × 20×19.7 =788 mW Additional temperature rise = 10 × 0.788 = 7.9◦ C, (d) Now for β = 100, 0.756 = 0.554 mA 1.365 9.45 = 0.648 mA IR2 = 0.554 + 101 IC = 10 − 0.648 = 9.352 mA IR1 = Thus, VBE = 0.7 + 0.025 ln VBB = 0.756 + IR2 R2 = 0.756 + 0.648 × 1.365 = 1.641 V 9.352 = 0.756 V 1 Chapter 11–10 This figure belongs to Problem 11.27. ix X R2 X R2 Q ⇒ vx R1 R1 vp /(R1 // rp ) vp rp gmvp X X Figure 1 11.27 Figure 1 shows the VBE multiplier together with its small-signal equivalent circuit prepared for determining the incremental terminal resistance r, vx r≡ ix Now, vπ (1) ix = gm v π + R1 rπ vπ R2 (2) vx = vπ + R1 rπ Dividing (2) by (1) gives 1 + R2 /(R1 rπ ) r= 1 gm + R1 rπ R2 + (R1 rπ ) = 1 + gm (R1 rπ ) For R1 = R2 = 1.2 k, IC = 1 mA, and β = 100, we have At v I = 0 V, we have gm = 40 mA/V 100 = 2.5 k rπ = 40 Thus, 1.2 + (1.2 2.5) = 60.2 r= 1 + 40(1.2 2.5) At v I = 0 V, we have II = 0 2.87 200 II = IB2 − IB1 = 0 IB1 = IB2 = At v I = +10 V, we have 0.88 mA = 4.4 μA 200 4.87 mA = 24.4 μA IB2 = 200 II = IB2 − IB1 = 20 μA IB1 = At v I = −10 V, we have 4.87 mA = 24.4 μA 200 0.88 IB2 = mA = 4.4 μA 200 II = IB2 − IB1 = −20 μA IB1 = (b) For RL = 100 : At v I = +10 V, we have 0.38 = 1.9 μA 200 4.87 = 24.4 μA IB2 = 200 II = IB2 − IB1 = 22.5 μA IB1 = 11.28 (a) For RL = ∞: At v I = –10 V, we have II = −22.5 μA IB1 Q1 11.29 Circuit operating near v I = 0 and is fed with a signal source having zero resistance. The resistance looking as shown by the arrow X is II = R1 re1 vI Q2 IB2 This resistance is reflected from base to the emitter of Q3 as(R1 re1 ) /(β3 + 1). The resistance seen by arrow Y , from the upper half of the circuit = R3 + re3 + (R1 re1 ) /(β3 + 1) Chapter 11–11 A similar resistance is seen by the arrow Z and both of these resistances (seen by arrows Y and arrow Z) are in parallel, therefore Rout = 1 R3 + re3 + (R1 re1 ) / β 3 + 1 2 More precisely, IE3 + IE1 = 1 mA β +1 thus, 1 +1 =1 IQ (β + 1) ⇒ IQ 0.99 mA Input bias current is zero because IB1 = IB2 . (b) From the equivalent half circuit, we have 2Rin = β 1 + 1 re1 + β 3 + 1 (re3 + 2RL ) re1 = re3 = VT 25 = 25 = IE 1 2Rin = (100 + 1)[25 + (100 + 1)(25 + 2 × 100)] ⇒ Rin = 1.15 M Q3 vi Q1 2Rout vo 2RL 200 2Rin 11.30 Av = VCC = 1 mA Q3 IB1 iI 200 200 + 25 + 2Rout = re3 + VCC vO VCC re1 β3 + 1 25 101 0.89 V/V Q1 vI vo 2RL = vi 2RL + re3 + re1 β +1 25 101 = 12.6 = 25 + Rout RL 100 Q2 IB2 Q4 At v I = 5 V, we have 1 mA VE1 = +5.7 V VCC IR1 = (a) v I = 0 and transistors have β = 100. vO = 0 V IQ = IE3 = IE4 = IE1 = IE2 11.31 See figure on the next page. 1 mA VCC − VE1 10 − 5.7 4.3 = = R1 R1 R1 To allow for IB3 = 10 mA if needed while reducing IE1 by no more than half, then IR1 must be 2 × 10 = 20 mA. Thus, R1 = VR1 4.3 = = 0.215 k = 215 IR1 20 Chapter 11–12 25 mV = 1.25 20 mA 1 215 1.25 = 0.75 + 0.625 + 2 51 re1 = Rout Rout = 0.7 Next, consider the situation when v I = +1 V and RL = 2 Let v O 1 V, then 1V = 0.5 A = 500 mA 2 Now if we assume that iE4 0, then iL = iE3 = iL = 500 mA VBE3 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 500 30 Similarly, = 0.770 V 500 10 mA iB3 = 51 Assuming that VEB1 0.7 V, then R2 = 0.215 k = 215 v E1 = 1 + 0.7 = 1.7 V Next, we determine the values of R3 and R4 : At v I = 0, assume VEB1 = 0.7. Then iR1 = VE1 = 0.7 V iE1 10 − 1.7 = 38.6 mA 0.215 = iR1 − iB2 = 38.6 − 10 = 28.6 mA VEB1 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 10 − 0.7 = 43.3 mA IR1 = 0.215 43.3 VEB1 = 0.7 + 0.025 × ln 10 = 0.726 V = 0.737 V iL = VE1 = 1.726 V VE1 = 0.737 V Meanwhile Q3 will be conducting IQ = 40 mA. Since IS3 = 3IS1 then Q3 has VBE = 0.7 V at IC = 30 mA. At 40 mA, 40 VBE3 = 0.7 + 0.025 × ln 30 = 0.707 V For v O = 0, VE1 − VBE3 − IE3 R3 = 0 0.737 − 0.707 − 40R3 = 0 ⇒ R3 = 0.75 Similarly, R4 = 0.75 1 R1 re1 R3 + re3 + Rout = 2 β3 + 1 where re3 = 25 mV = 0.625 40 mA 28.6 10 = VE1 − VBE3 R3 + RL 1.726 − 0.770 0.75 + 2 = 0.348 A v O = iL RL = 0.348 × 2 = 0.695 V Let’s check that iE4 is zero. The voltage at the base of Q4 is VB4 = 1 − VBE2 1 − 0.74 = 0.26 V The voltage across R4 and VEB4 is = v O − 0.26 = 0.695 − 0.26 = 0.435 V which is sufficiently small to keep Q4 cutoff, verifying our assumption that iE4 0. Let’s now do more iterations to refine our estimate of v O : iL = 0.35 A Chapter 11–13 0.35 7 mA 51 10 − 1 − 0.726 − 7 = 31.5 mA iE1 = 0.215 31.5 VEB1 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 10 (a) For the composite transistor, we have iB3 = β= Refer to the diagram. IB = = 0.729 V IC = VE1 = 1 + 0.729 = 1.729 V iE3 = iL = 350 mA VBE3 350 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 30 = 1 IE β1 + 1 β2 + 1 β1 β2 IE + IE β1 + 1 β2 + 1 β2 + 1 β1 + β2 β1 + 1 β1 + 1 β2 + 1 · IE For the composite transistor, β is given by = 0.761 V VE1 − VBE3 iL = R3 + R2 = IC IB β1 + β2 β1 + 1 × IE β1 + 1 β2 + 1 IC = β= 1 IB · IE β1 + 1 β2 + 1 1.729 − 0.761 = 0.352 A 0.75 + 2 = β1 + β2 β1 + 1 v O = iL RL β 1 β 2 since β 1 = 0.352 × 2 = 0.704 V 1 and β 2 1 (b) Refer to the diagram. Operating current of Q2 11.32 = IC2 = C where β = β 1 β 2 IC b1 b11 • IC since β 2 IE b2 b21 b21 Q1 B β +1 β2 β2 IE = × IC β2 + 1 β2 + 1 β IB Q2 IE IE b21 E C 1 and β Operating current of Q1 • IE = IC1 = = β1 IE β1 + 1 β2 + 1 β1 β +1 IC · β β1 + 1 β2 + 1 IC since β β2 1, β 2 B IB IE and β 1 1. (c) Again refer to the diagram and part (b). IC2 IC1 + VT In VBE = VBE2 + VBE1 = VT In IS IS From part (b), IC2 IC 1 IC and IC1 IC β2 IC 1 IC ∴ VBE = VT ln + VT ln IS β 2 IS IC IC 1 + VT ln + VT ln = VT ln IS IS β2 IC − VT ln β 2 VBE = 2VT ln IS (d) rπeq = β 1 + 1 re1 + β 2 + 1 re2 E Here, re2 = VT IE2 VT IC2 VT IC Chapter 11–14 re1 = VT IE2 VT IC1 VT = β 2 re2 IC /β 2 From Figure 1 we can write = 2 β 1 + 1 β 2 re2 ⇒ IC2 = ∼ = 2β 1 β 2 re2 = 2β 1 β 2 VT IC = (e) To find gmeq , apply a signal v be and find the corresponding current ic : v be + β 2 + 1 re2 re1 + β 2 + 1 re2 v bc = · v be RC (v Rv ) i RB o vo B ic/b 1, v bc gmeq (b) β2 · v be β 2 r e2 + β 2 + 1 re2 v bc 1.64 IC2 = = 0.0164 mA β 100 1 β 2 r e2 + β 2 + 1 re2 ∵ gm re ic 5 − 1.4 RB RC + 2 β 3.6 = 1.64 mA 2000 2+ 10, 000 IC1 ic = ic1 + ic2 = gm1v be1 + gm2v be2 re1 = gm1v be re1 + β 2 + 1 re2 +gm2 IC2 RB + 1.4 β2 5 = IC2 RC + β 1 + 1 [β 2 re2 + β 2 re2 ] rπ eq vi 1 β2 + v be 2β 2 re2 2β 2 re2 ic Q1 β2 + 1 2β 2 re2 ic/b re1 vb2 1 2re2 Rin Rb1 ic 1 = = v be 2re2 Q2 (b1)re2 Figure 2 1 IC 2 VT v b2 = v i 11.33 (a) (β + 1)re2 (β + 1)re2 + re1 where 5 V RC 1.4 V IC2 VT 25 mV = 15.2 = IC2 1.64 mA re1 = VT IE1 VT 25 mV = 1.52 = IC1 0.0164 mA v b2 = v i 101 × 15.2 = 0.5v i 101 × 15.2 + 1520 ic = gm2 v b2 IC2 b = gm2 × 0.5v i IC2 Q1 where gm2 = IC2 /b 0.7 V VT IE2 2 k RB 2 M IC2 /b2 re2 = Q2 IC2 1.64 = 65.6 mA/V = VT 0.025 ic = 65.6 × 0.5v i = 32.8v i Writing a node equation at the output provides Figure 1 vo − vi ic vo + ic + + =0 RC β RB Chapter 11–15 Substituting ic = 32.8v i , we obtain 1 1 1 1 32.8 − + = −v i 1 + vo RC RB β RB 1 1 1+ 32.8 − vo β RB =− Av ≡ 1 1 vi + RC RB 0.978 VC = −0.7 − 100 0.0214 + 1010 = −2.94 V (b) Small-signal parameters: gm1 = 9.7 × 10−6 = 0.388 mA/V 25 × 10−3 1.01 × 32.8 − (1/2000) =− 1 1 + 2 2000 = −66.2 V/V rπ 1 = β1 = 25.77 k gm1 ro1 = |VA | 100 = = 10.31 M IC1 9.7 μA (c) Rb1 = (β + 1)[re1 + (β + 1)re2 ] gm2 = 0.97 × 10−3 = 38.8 mA/V 25 × 10−3 = 318.7 k rπ 2 = β2 = 2.58 k gm2 The component of Rin arising from RB can be found as vi Ri2 = (v i − v o )/RB ro2 = |VA | /IC2 = 103.1 k = 101[1.52 + 101 × 0.0152] Node equation at b2 : v b2 v π2 gm1v π1 + + =0 ro1 rπ2 RB 2000 = 29.8 k = 1 − (v o /v i ) 1 − (−66.2) = But v b2 = v o + v p2 , then v o + v π2 v π2 + =0 ro1 rπ2 1 1 vo ⇒ v π2 + + gm1v π1 =− rπ2 ro1 ro1 Thus gm1v π1 + Rin = Rib Ri2 = 318.7 29.8 = 27.2 k 11.34 (a) DC Analysis: or, v π2 10 V vo + gm1v π1 ro1 =− 1 1 + rπ2 ro1 Node equation at output: 10.7 RB 500 500 k 0.0214 mA 0.7 V vo v o − v π1 1 + = gm2 v π2 + v π2 ro2 Rf rπ2 1 = gm2 + v π2 rπ2 1 vo gm2 + + gm1v π1 rπ2 ro1 =− 1 1 + rπ2 ro1 Q1 IE2 1010 IE2 101 Rf 100 k Q2 IE2 ( 0.0214 + IE2 1010 ( IE2 + IE2 1010 = 0.978 mA 1 mA = 0.0214 + ⇒ IE2 IC2 = 0.99 × 0.978 = 0.97 mA IC1 = 0.978 = 9.7 μA 101 VC 1 mA Substituting v π1 = v i and collecting terms, we obtain ⎤ ⎡ 1 gm2 + ⎥ ⎢ 1 1 rπ2 ⎥ v o⎢ ⎣ ro2 + Rf + 1 ⎦ 1 ro1 + rπ2 ro1 ⎡ ⎤ 1 gm1 gm2 + ⎢ 1⎥ rπ2 = −v i⎢ − ⎥ ⎣ 1 1 Rf ⎦ + rπ2 ro2 Chapter 11–16 This figure belongs to Exercise 11.34, part (b). Rf rp2 c1 , b2 b1 vi RB rp1 gm1vp1 1 gm1 gm2 + 1 rπ 2 − 1 1 Rf + vo rπ 2 ro2 =− 1 vi gm2 + 1 1 rπ 2 + + 1 1 ro2 Rf ro1 + rπ 2 ro1 Since rπ 2 vo vi vp2 ro1 gm2vp2 vp1 = 500 25.77 vo vi 100 1 + 1320 11.35 First consider the situation in the quiescent state and find VBB . IQ2 = IQ4 = 2 mA ro1 , we have VBE2 = VBE4 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln IBias Substituting β 2 = β N and noting that β N obtain 1 vo −gm1 1 1 1 1 vi + + β N ro2 ro1 Rf Q1 B Q2 R2 Q5 1, we vI B ⎥ vo ⎦ 1− vi Rf RL Q3 Q4 Q.E.D. vi − vo vi Rf ⎤ ⎡ ⎢ = 500 25.77 ⎣ vO R1 VCC (c) vo = −0.388 10.31 × 103 100 (103.1 100) vi Rin = RB rπ 1 VCC gm1 β 2 + 1 − 1 1 1 β +1 + + ro2 Rf ro1 2 = −1320 V/V 2 10 = 0.660 V gm1 β 2 + 1 , we have = −gm1 ro1 β N ro2 Rf c2 = 75.5 1 gm1 (gm2 rπ 2 + 1) − Rf − 1 1 1 + + (gm2 rπ 2 + 1) ro2 Rf ro1 1 Rf ro2 = 500 25.77 0.0757 1 gm1 β 2 + 1 − Rf = − 1 1 1 β +1 + + ro2 Rf ro1 2 Since vo e2 For Q1 and Q3 , we have 2 2 IC = = = 0.02 mA β 100 VBE1 0.02 = |VBE3 | = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1 = 0.602 V 0.02 0.02 mA = = 0.2 μA IB1 = β 100 Chapter 11–17 IBias = 100 × Base current in B1 Now find v I for v O = –10 V and RL =1 k. = 100 × 0.2 = 20 μA −10 = −10 mA 1 k Assume that current through Q2 is almost zero. 1 × 20 μA = 2 μA 10 and IC5 = 20 − 2 = 18 μA 18 μ VBE5 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1m iL = IR1,R2 = ∴ IC4 0.600 V VBB = VBE1 + VBE2 + |VBE3 | = 0.602 + 0.660 + 0.602 = 1.864 V 1.864 = 932 k R1 + R2 = 2 μA R1 = 0.600 = 300 k 2 μA R2 = 932 − 300 = 632 k Now find v I for v O = 10 V and RL = 1 k. Q2 is conducting most of the current and Q4 conducting a negligible current. 10 V = 10 mA 1 k ∴ The current through each of Q1 and Q2 10 =5 increases by a factor of 2 Thus VBE2 = 0.66 + 0.025ln5 = 0.700 V ∴ I C2 IL = VBE1 = 0.602 + 0.025ln5 = 0.642 V and IB1 = 5 × 0.2 μA = 1 μA ∴ The current through the multiplier is IBias − 1 = 20 − 1 = 19 μA. Assuming most of the decrease occurs in IC5 , we obtain 10 mA The current through Q4 increases by a factor of 5 (relative to the quiescent value). ∴ The current through Q3 must also increase by the same factor. Thus |VBE3 | = 0.602 + 0.025 ln5 = 0.642 V |VBE3 | has increased by 0.642 − 0.602 = 0.04 V. Since Q1 and Q2 are almost cut off, all of the IBias now flows through the VBE multiplier. That is an increase of 0.2 μ. Assuming that most of the increase occurs in IC5 , VBE5 becomes 18.2 μA VBE5 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 0.600 V 1 mA The voltage VBE5 remains almost constant, and the voltage across the multiplier will remain almost constant. Thus the increase in |VEB3 | will result in an equal decrease in |VBE1 | + |VBE2 |, i.e. VBE1 + VBE2 = 0.660 + 0.602 − 0.04 The current through each of Q1 and Q2 decreases by the same factor, let it be m; then 0.025 ln m + 0.025 ln m = −0.04 V ⇒ m = 0.45 Thus IC2 = 0.45 × 2 = 0.9 mA Now do iteration IC4 = 10.9 ∴ I C5 = 18 − 1 = 17 μA 17 μA = 0.598 V VBE5 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1 μA 10.9 = 5.45 2 ∴ |VBE3 | = 0.602 + 0.025 ln 5.45 ∴ VBB1 , the voltage across the multiplier is = 0.644 932 = 1.858 V 300 It follows that VEB3 becomes v I = v O + |VEB3 | VBB = 0.598 × VEB3 = 1.858 – 0.700 – 0.642 = 0.516 V i.e. VEB3 has decreased by 0.600 – 0.516 = 0.084 V Correspondinly, IC3 will decrease by a factor of e −0.084 0.025 = 0.035. ∴ I C4 becomes 0.035 × 2 = 0.07 mA This value is close to zero, no iteration required. ∴ v I = 10 + 0.7 + 0.642 − 1.858 v I = 9.484 V IC4 has increased by a factor of vI ∼ = − 10.644 V 11.36 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P11.36. While D1 is conducting, the voltage at the emitter of Q3 is (VCC1 − VD ). For Q3 to turn on, the voltage at its base must be at least equal to VCC1 = 35 V. This will occur when v I reaches the value v I = VCC1 − VZ1 − VBB = 35 − 3.3 − 1.2 = 30.5 V This is the positive threshold at which Q3 is turned on. Chapter 11–18 (b) The power dissipated in the circuit is given by Eq. (11.19): PD = VBE = 6.5 × 75 = 487.5 mV 2 V̂o 1 V̂o2 VCC − π RL 2 RL IC5 = 10−14 × e487.5/25 = 2.9 μA For 95% of the time, V̂o = 30 V, VCC = 35 V, 1 2 1 PD = × 30 × 35 − × 302 RL π 2 = 11.38 Refer to Fig. P11.38. 2 × 10−3 = 10−14 eVEB5 /VT 218.5 RL VEB5 = 0.025 ln(2 × 1011 ) = 0.650 V 0.650 V = 6.5 R= 100 mA For a normal peak output current of 75 mA, we have For 5% of the time, V̂o = 65 V, VCC = 70 V, 1 2 1 PD = × 65 × 70 − × 652 RL π 2 = 784.1 RL VEB5 = 6.5 × 75 = 487.5 mV Thus, the total power dissipation is IC5 = 10−14 × e487.5/25 218.5 784.1 PD = × 0.95 + × 0.05 RL RL = 246.8 RL = 2.9 μA (1) This should be compared to the power dissipation of a class AB output stage operated from ±70 V. Here, PD (for 95% of the time) 1 2 1 2 = × 30 × 70 − × 30 RL π 2 = 886.9 RL VZ = 6.8 + (125 − 25) × 2 = 7.0 V Similarly, for Q2 to conduct 200 μA, we need VBE2 = 0.517 V Now, the voltage across R1 and R2 is V(R1 +R2 ) = VZ − VBE1 784.1 RL 881.8 RL At 125◦ C, we have = 0.517 V = 7 − 0.517 = 6.483 V 886.9 784.1 Total dissipation = × 0.95 + × 0.05 RL RL = 11.39 Refer to Fig. 11.22. Since IC2 = 200 μA, then 200 − 2 mV × 100 VBE1 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 100 PD (for 5% of the time) 1 2 1 = × 65 × 70 − × 652 RL π 2 = From a normal peak output current of 75 mA, we get (2) The results in (1) and (2) indicate that using the Class G circuit in Fig. P11.36 results in a reduction in PD by a factor of 3.6! The voltage across R2 is equal to VBE1 , thus 0.517 = 2.59 k 0.2 mA The voltage across R1 is given by 6.487 − 0.517 = 5.966 V. Thus, R2 = 5.966 V = 29.8 k 0.2 mA Now, at 25◦ C, we have R1 = 11.37 Refer to Exercise 11.11 and Fig. 11.21. VZ = 6.8 V 2 × 10−3 = 10−14 eVBE /VT Assume VBE1 = 0.7 V, then ⇒ VBE = 0.650 V V(R1 +R2 ) = 6.8 − 0.7 = 6.1 V RE1 = 0.650 V = 6.5 100 mA I(R1 +R2 ) = 6.1 = 0.188 μA 2.59 + 29.8 Chapter 11–19 11.41 Thus 188 = 0.716 V VBE1 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 100 V(R1 +R2 ) = 6.8 − 0.716 = 6.084 VBE2 = 6.084 × VDD R2 R1 + R2 IBias 2.59 = 0.486 V 2.59 + 29.8 = 6.084 × Thus, Q1 QN IC2 = 100 e(486−700)/25 = 0.019 μA vO 11.40 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. 11.23. Rout = Ron Rop Q2 where Ron = 1 ron gmn 1/gmn Rop = 1 rop gmp 1/gmp Rout = Ron Rop vI VSS (a) Equation (11.43) 1 gmn + gmp Q.E.D. IQ = IBias For matched devices, we have 1 = 0.1 gmn = gmp = gm Rout = 1 2gm Q.E.D. (b) Rout = 20 1 = 20 2gm ⇒ gm = 1 A/V = 25 mA/V 40 But, gm = k (W/L)VOV 25 = 200VOV ⇒ VOV = 25 = 0.125 V 200 VGG = 2VGS = 2(|Vt | + |VOV |) = 2(0.5 + 0.125) = 2 × 0.625 = 1.25 V 1 W 2 VOV IQ = k 2 L = RL 1 1 gmn gmp Thus, Rout QP 1 × 200 × 0.1252 = 1.56 mA 2 (W/L)n (W/L)1 (W/L)n (W/L)1 (W/L)n = 10 (W/L)1 1 W kn V2 2 L 1 OV W 1 0.1 = × 0.250 × × (0.15)2 2 L 1 W ⇒ = 35.6 L 1 W 1 × (0.15)2 Q2 : 0.1 = × 0.100 × 2 L 2 W ⇒ = 88.9 L 2 W 1 × (0.15)2 QN : 1 = × 0.250 × 2 L N W ⇒ = 356 L N W 1 QP : 1 = × 0.100 × × (0.15)2 2 L P W = 889 L P Q1 : IBias = Chapter 11–20 (b) From the circuit we get v I = v O − VSGP Substituting for Rout above, we obtain for Since v O = 0, we have vo = vi v I = −VSGP RL 1 2g m RL + VSGP = |VOV | + |Vt | Q.E.D. (b) Voltage gain = 0.98 = = 0.15 + 0.45 = 0.6 V ∴ v I = −VSGP = −0.6 V 0.98 = (c) Using Eq. (11.46), we obtain 1000 + RL + 1 2g m 1 2g m ⇒ gm = 24.5 mA/V To find VGSN , use the equations For Q1 , we have IBias = ID . VGSN = Vt + 0.47 = 0.45 + 0.47 RL 1000 v Omax = VDD − VOV |Bias − VGSN 1 W iDN max = k n (VGSN − Vt )2 2 L 1 10 = × 0.250 × 356 (VGSN − Vt )2 2 ⇒ VGSN − Vt = 0.47 V vo vi ∴ 0.2 = 1 k1V 2 2 OV 1 2 × 20 × VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.14 V 0.2 = 0.92 V For QN , we have ∴ v Omax = 2.5 − 0.2 − 0.92 = 1.38 V gm = k n VOV 24.5 = k n × 0.14 11.42 k n = 173 mA/V2 n= VDD kn 173 = k1 20 = 8.66 IBias and IQ = nIbias = 8.66 × 0.2 Q1 = 1.73 mA QN vO Q2 QP RL 11.43 Refer to Fig. 11.24. Consider the situation when QN is conducting the maximum current of 20 mA, 20 = 1 2 k nv 2 OVN 1 × 200v 2OVN 2 ⇒ v OVN = 0.45 V = vI VSS Thus, v Omin = −VSS + v OVN (a) under quiescent condition Voltage gain = RL vo = vi RL + Rout As shown in problem 11.40, for matched transistors we have 1 Rout = 2gm = −2.5 + 0.45 = −2.05 V Because QN and QP are matched, a similar situation pertains when QP is supplying maximum current, and v Omax = +2.05 V Thus, the output voltage swing realized is ±2.05 V. Chapter 11–21 11.44 From Eq. (11.57), we obtain Substituting this into Eq. (2) gives Rout = 1/μ(gmp + gmn ) iDN = IQ (1 + 1)2 = 4IQ where Since iL = −iDN , we have gmp = gmn Rout = 2IQ 2×2 = = 20 mA/V = |VOV | 0.2 v O = iL RL = −4IQ RL 1 1 = k = 5 5(20 + 20) 200 Similarly, Eq. (2) shows that QN turns off and iDN = 0 when μ 11.45 (a) From Eq. (11.68), we obtain | Gain error | = 1 2μgm RL (1) From Eq. (11.57), we get Rout = (2) Combining (1) and (2) yields Q.E.D. (b) For RL = 100 and | Gain error | = 3%, Rout = 0.03 × 100 = 3 But, Rout = 3= 1 2μgm 1 2 × 5 × gm ⇒ gm = 1 = 33.3 mA/V 30 Using gm = substituting this into Eq. (1) gives iDP = IQ (1 + 1)2 = 4IQ v O = iL RL = 4IQ RL 1 2μgm Rout | Gain error | = RL vO − vI = −1 VOV Since in this case iL = iDP , then 1 μ(gmn + gmp ) For gmn = gmp = gm , we have Rout = Q.E.D. 2IQ VOV we obtain 2 × 2.5 33.3 = VOV 5 ⇒ VOV = = 0.15 V 33.3 11.46 iDP and iDN are given by Eqs. (11.61) and (11.62) as vO − vI 2 iDP = IQ 1 − μ (1) VOV vO − vI 2 iDN = IQ 1 + μ (2) VOV Equation (1) shows that QP turns off and iDP = 0 when vO − vI =1 μ VOV Q.E.D. Thus, one of the two transistors turns off when | iL | reaches 4IQ . 1 W 2 k V 2 L OV W 1 1.5 = × 0.1 (0.15)2 2 L P W ⇒ = 1333.3 L P W (W/L)P = L N k n /k p W 1333.3 = 533.3 = L N 2.5 11.47 (a) IQ = (b) gm = 2IQ 2 × 1.5 = 20 mA/V = VOV 0.15 Rout = 1 (where gmn = gmp = gm ) 2μgm 2.5 = 1 2μ × 20 × 10−3 ⇒ μ = 10 V/V (c) Gain error = − =− 1 2μgm RL 1 = −0.05 2 × 10 × 20 × 10−3 × 50 or − 5% (d) In the quiescent state the dc voltage at the output of each amplifier must be of the value that causes the current in QN and QP to be IQ . Thus, for the QP amplifier the output voltage is VDD − VSG = VDD − |Vtp | − |VOV | = 2.5 − 0.5 − 0.15 = 1.85 V Chapter 11–22 11.48 (a) From the circuit in Fig. P11.48 we see that R3 R1 VB1 − VB4 = 1 + VBE6 + 1 + VBE5 R4 R2 Similarly, the voltage at the output of the QN amplifier must be −VSS + VGS = −2.5 + 0.5 + 0.15 = −1.85 V and (e) QP will be supplying all the load current when QN cuts off. From Eq. (11.62) we see that QN cuts off when μ VGG = (VB1 − VB4 ) − (VBE1 + VBE2 + VEB3 + VEB4 ) Thus vO − vI = −1 VOV R3 R1 VGG = 1 + VBE6 + 1 + VBE5 R4 R2 Substituting this in Eq. (11.61), we find the current iDP to be − 4VBE iDP = IQ (1 + 1) = 4IQ Q.E.D. (1) 2 where VBE denotes the magnitude of the base-emitter voltage of each of Q1 − Q4 . Since in this situation iL = iDP (b) From the circuit diagram we see that as the output transistors heat up, Q6 also heats up. Thus in Eq. (1) only VBE6 changes with the temperature of the output stage, thus VGG changes with temperature according to R3 ∂VBE6 ∂VGG = 1+ Q.E.D. (2) ∂T R4 ∂T then iL = 4IQ and v O = 4IQ RL = 4 × 1.5 × 10−3 × 50 = 0.3 V (c) To stabilize the operation of QN and QP as temperature changes, we arrange that Similarly, when v O = −0.3 V, QP will cut off and all the current (4IQ = 6 mA) will be supplied by QN . ∂VGG ∂(VtN + |VtP |) = ∂T ∂T (f) The situation at v O = v Omax is illustrated in Fig. 1. Analysis of this circuit provides 1 W iDP = × k n [2.5 − (v Omax − 0.5) − 0.5]2 2 L n = −3 − 3 = −6 mV/◦ C From Eq. (2), we obtain R3 ∂VBE6 ∂VGG = 1+ ∂T R4 ∂T R3 × −2 = 1+ R4 R3 mV/◦ C = −2 1 + R4 1 v Omax = × 0.25 × 533.3(2.5 − v Omax )2 RL 2 ⇒ v Omax = 1.77 V Similarly, v Omin = −1.77 V This figure belongs to Problem 11.47, part (f). VDD 2.5 V vOmax Vt m Vt vImax QP vOVmax iDP 0 A the edge of triode region iLmax vOmax RL 50 Figure 1 (3) (4) Chapter 11–23 From Eqs. (3) and (4), we obtain 1+ ⇒ R3 =3 R4 R3 =2 R4 (d) IDN = IDP = 100 mA W 1 V2 100 = μn Cox 2 L N OVN 1 2 × 2 × 103 × VOVN 2 ⇒ VOVN = 0.316 V 100 = = R2 3R2 VS + 2 − VEB R1 R1 2 R2 2 VS , select = 3 R1 3 For VO R2 = 100 2R1 = = 33.3 k 3 3 To keep the gain unchanged, we must change R3 so that 2R2 = 50 R3 R3 = Similarly, 4 2 × (100/3) = = 1.33 k 50 3 |VOVP | = 0.316 V 11.50 Refer to Fig. 11.29 with VS = 22 V. Thus, VB1 0 VE1 0.7 V VE3 1.4 V VGSN = |VGSP | = 0.316 + 3 = 3.316 V and VGG = 2 × 3.316 = 6.632 V To establish a quiescent current of 20 mA in the driver stage, we use VC10 = 22 − 0.7 = 21.3 V IE3 = 21.3 − 1.4 50 6.632 VGG = = 0.3316 k R= 20 20 332 IE1 = IB3 = VB1 − VB4 = VGG + 4VBE IB1 = = 6.632 + 4 × 0.7 = 9.432 V Thus, R1 R3 VBE6 + 1 + VBE5 = 9.432 V 1+ R4 R2 R1 × 0.7 = 9.432 (1 + 2) × 0.7 + 1 + R2 R1 = 9.47 ⇒ R2 11.49 Refer to the circuit of Fig. 11.29. Resistors R2 and R3 control the gain, 2R2 Av = − R3 0.4 mA 0.4 IE3 = = 19 μA βP + 1 21 19 IE1 = = 0.9 μA βP + 1 21 VB1 = IB1 × R4 = 0.9 × 10−3 × 150 = 0.136 V We can use this value to obtain IE1 : VE1 = 0.836 V VE3 = 1.536 V IE3 = 21.3 − 1.536 50 (almost no change) IE1 19 μA IE4 = IE3 = 0.4 mA IE2 = IE1 = 19 μA IE5 IC3 = 0.4 × 20 = 0.38 mA 21 Resistor R3 controls the gain alone. Resistor R2 affects both the gain and the dc output level. To see the later point, equate I3 and I4 from Eqs. (11.69) and (11.70) to obtain IE6 = IE5 = 0.38 mA VO − 2VEB VS − 3VEB = R1 R2 = VE3 + IR2 R2 R2 3R2 ⇒ VO = 2VEB + VS − VEB R1 R1 0.4 mA IR1 = IR2 0.4 mA VO = VE4 + IR2 R2 = 1.536 + 0.4 × 25 = 11.54 V Chapter 11–24 Consider next the effect of finite transistor β. For the case in Fig. 1, we have vI iE1 = R β vI iC1 = α1 iE1 = β +1 R 1 iC4 = iC1 2 1+ β Thus, β β vI iO = β +1 β +2 R 100 100 v I × × = 101 102 R vI 0.97 R 11.51 Refer to Fig. 11.31. To limit PD to 2 W, we need to limit the supply voltage to VS = 16 V The VS = 16 V graph intersects the THD = 3% line at PL = 2.7 W, which is the maximum possible load power. Thus, √ (V̂o / 2)2 = 2.7 RL V̂o = √ 2.7 × 8 × 2 = 6.57 V which means that an approximately 13-V peak-to-peak sinusoid is needed. 11.52 Figure 1 shows the currents in the circuit for the case where v I is positive and assuming an op amp with very high gain (hence the 0 V between its two input terminals) and all β’s are very high. The result is that iO = 11.53 Refer to Fig. 11.32. Gain = 2K = 8 K =4 R4 =K =4 R3 ⇒ R4 = 40 k R2 =4 1+ R1 R2 =3 R1 ⇒ R2 = 30 k vI R If v I is negative, the current through R reverses direction and is thus supplied by Q2 and then mirrored to the output by the mirror Q5 − Q6 , resulting in iO = v I /R but reversed in direction. This figure belongs to Problem 11.52. VCC Q3 5 Q4 vI /R Q1 1 0V vI /R 0 4 Q2 vI vI /R 0 vI 3 vI R R vI / R Q6 Q5 2 0 VCC Figure 1 6 iO vI / R 7 Chapter 11–25 2 (b) Power loss = 4fs CVDD 11.54 The analysis is shown in Fig. 1 (below), from which the gain is found as PL PL + Ploss vO R2 + R3 =1+ vI R1 η= The largest sinusoid that can be provided across RL will have a peak amplitude of 2 × 13 = 26 V. To ensure that the signals v O1 and v O2 are complementary, then = 2 VDD /2R 2 2 (VDD /2R) + 4fs CVDD = 1 1 + 8fs CR 1+ For fs = 250 kHz,C = 1000 pf and R = 16 R2 R3 = R1 R1 η= Selecting R1 = 1 k, we obtain 1 + R2 = R3 1 1 + 8 × 250 × 103 × 1000 × 10−12 × 16 = 97% (1) and to obtain a gain of 8 V/V we write 1+ R2 + R3 =8 R1 1 + R2 + R3 = 8 11.58 (2) Solving (1) and (2) simultaneously gives 2(1 + R2 ) = 8 ⇒ R2 = 3 k R3 = 4 k 11.55 See figure on the next page. 11.56 Average = +10 × 0.65 − 10 × 0.35 = +3 V If duty cycle changed to 0.35, the average becomes = +10 × 0.35 − 10 × 0.65 = −3 V Figure 1 11.57 (a) Maximum peak voltage across R = VDD (a) Figure 1 shows the SOA boundaries. Maximum power supplied to load √ (VDD / 2)2 V2 = = DD R 2R (b) For the CS configuration in Fig. P11.58, VDS = VDD − RID This figure belongs to Problem 11.54. Figure 1 (1) Chapter 11–26 This figure belongs to Problem 11.55. We see that maximum VDS occurs when ID = 0 and the resulting maximum VDS is VDSmax = VDD Writing (1) in the alternative form VDD − VDS R shows that maximum ID is obtained when VDS = 0 and the resulting maximum ID is ID = (2) VDD R The power dissipation in the transistor is given by IDmax = (c) For VDD = 40 V, v DSmax = 40 V. Now, since VDS and ID are related by the linear relationship in (1) or (2), the straight line representing this relationship on the iD − v DS plane must pass by the point v DS = 40 V and iD = 0. Now we are searching for the straight line with maximum slope that clears the hyperbola and intersects the vertical axis at 5 A or less. For this case, this straight line is the one joining the points (40, 0) and (0, 5). It is a tangent to the hyperbola at VDD v DS = = 20 V, which is the point of 2 maximum power dissipation. For this straight line = (VDD − RID )ID 40 V =8 5A IDmax = 5 A PD will be maximum when PDmax = PD = VDS ID ∂PD =0 ∂ID 2 VDD 402 = = 50 W 4R 4×8 (d) For VDD = 30 V: Following a process similar to that in (c), we find that is, VDD − 2RID = 0 ⇒ RID = R= VDD 2 30 V =6 5A IDmax = 5 A R= 302 = 37.5 W 4×6 or PDmax = VDD 2 The corresponding PDmax is The locus of the operating point is shown in Fig. 1. VDS = PDmax = VDS ID = VDD VDD 2 2R = 2 VDD 4R (e) For VDD = 15 V, we have 15 V =3 5A IDmax = 5 A R= PDmax = 152 = 18.75 W 4×3 Chapter 11–27 The locus of the operating point is shown in Fig. 1. 11.62 θ JC = TJ − TC 180◦ − 30◦ = 3◦ C/W = PD 50 TJ − TS = θ JS PD 11.59 Power rating = ICav 130 − 30 = 40 W 2.5 40 = 2.0 A ≤ 20 11.60 (a) θ JA = TJ max − TA0 PD0 100 − 25 = 37.5◦ C/W 2 (b) At TA = 50◦ C, we have = PDmax TJ max − TA = θ JA 100 − 50 = 1.33 W = 37.5 (c) TJ = 25◦ + 37.5 × 1 = 62.5◦ C 180◦ − TS = (θ JC + θ CS )PD ⇒ TS = 180 − (3 + 0.6) × 30 = 72◦ TS − TA = θ SA PD 72 − 27 = θ SA × 30 ⇒ θ SA = 1.5◦ C/W Required heat-sink length = 6◦ C/W/cm 1.5◦ C/W = 4 cm 11.63 TC − TA = θ CA PD = (θ CS + θ SA ) PD ⇒ PD = TC − TA 97 − 25 = 120 W = θ CS + θ SA 0.5 + 0.1 11.61 TJ ≤ 50 + 3 × 20 = 110◦ C TJ − TC = θ JC PD VBE = 800 − 2 × (110 − 25) = 630 mV 150 − 97 = θ JC × 120 = 0.63 V ⇒ θ JC = 0.44◦ C/W Exercise 12–1 Ex: 12.1 Using Eq. (12.2), we obtain A = gm1 (ro2 ro4 )gm6 (ro6 ro7 ) VICM min = −VSS + Vtn + VOV 3 − |Vtp | β=1 = −1.65 + 0.5 + 0.3 − 0.5 Thus, = −1.35 V Rout = Using Eq. (12.3), we get VICM max = VDD − |VOV 3 | − |Vtp | − |VOV 1 | = 1.65 − 0.3 − 0.5 − 0.3 = +0.55 V Usually, A1 Thus, Rout Thus, ro6 ro7 1 + gm1 (ro2 ro4 )gm6 (ro6 ro7 ) 1 gm6 [gm1 (ro2 ro4 )] −1.35 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.55 V Using Eq. (12.5), we obtain −VSS + VOV 6 ≤ v O ≤ VDD − |VOV 7 | Thus −1.65 + 0.5 ≤ v O ≤ 1.65 − 0.5 ⇒ −1.15 V ≤ v O ≤ +1.15 V Ex: 12.4 Using Eq. (12.36), we get ft = Gm1 2πCC ⇒ CC = = Gm1 2πft 0.3 × 10−3 2π × 10 × 106 = 4.8 pF Ex: 12.2 For all devices, we have From Eq. (12.31), we have |VA | = 20 V fZ = Using Eq. (12.13), we get 2 1 1 + A1 = − |VOV 1 | |VA2 | VA4 2 2 = −100 V/V =− 0.2 20 Using Eq. (12.20), we obtain 1 2 1 + A2 = − |VOV 6 | VA6 |VA7 | 2 2 = −40 V/V =− 0.5 20 A = A1 A2 = −100 × −40 = 4000 V/V 20 |VA | = = 40 k ro6 = ro7 = 0.5 mA 0.5 Ro = ro6 ro7 = 40 40 = 20 k = Rout = Rof Ro = 1 + Aβ where Ro = ro6 ro7 0.6 × 10−3 2π × 4.8 × 10−12 20 MHz From Eq. (12.35), we have fP2 = = Gm2 2πC2 0.6 × 10−3 = 48 MHz 2π × 2 × 10−12 Thus, ft is lower than fZ and fP2 . Ex: 12.5 (a) Using Eq. (12.36), we have ft = Gm1 2πCC ⇒ CC = = Ex: 12.3 The feedback is of the voltage sampling type (i.e., the connection at the output is a shunt one), thus Gm2 2πCC Gm1 2πft 1 × 10−3 2π × 100 × 106 = 1.6 pF A0 = Gm1 (ro2 ro4 )Gm2 (ro6 ro7 ) = 1(100 100) × 2(40 40) = 50 × 2 × 20 = 2000 V/V f3dB = ft 100 × 106 = = 50 kHz A0 2000 Exercise 12–2 gm13 = gm8 = 0.6 mA/V (b) From Eq. (12.34), we have R= gm12 = 1 1 = = 500 Gm2 2 × 10−3 = (c) From Eq. (12.35), we have fP2 = φP2 = −tan−1 Now, 2 RB = √ 2μn Cox (W/L)12 IREF ft fP2 = 100 318 = −tan−1 2μn Cox × 4(W/L)13 IREF = 2gm13 = 1.2 mA/V Gm2 2πC2 2 × 10−3 = 318 MHz 2π × 1 × 10−12 = 2μn Cox (W/L)12 IREF √ 2 ( 4 − 1) −3 1.2 × 10 = 1.67 k = −17.4◦ From Example 8.6, we have PM = 90 − 17.4 = 72.6◦ VDD = VSS = 2.5 V IREF = 90 μA Ex: 12.6 Using Eq. (12.47), we obtain Vtn = 0.7 V SR = VOV 1 ωt |Vtp | = 0.8 V = 0.2 × 2π × 100 × 106 |VOV 8 | = 0.3 V = 126 V/μs IREF RB = 0.09 × 1.67 Using Eq. (12.45), = 150 mV SR = Since I CC gm13 = −12 ⇒ I = 126 × 10 × 1.6 × 10 6 = 200 μA 0.6 = 2IREF VOV 13 2 × 0.09 VOV 13 ⇒ VOV 13 = 0.3 V Ex: 12.7 2 RB = √ 2μn Cox (W/L)12 IREF = √ 2 2 × 90 × 10−6 × 80 × 10 × 10−6 = 5.27 k Using Eq. (12.61), we obtain (W/L)12 2 −1 gm12 = RB (W/L)13 80 2 −1 = 5.27 20 = 0.379 mA/V Ex: 12.8 From Example 8.6, Q8 has W L = 8 40 0.8 gm8 = 0.6 mA/V VGS13 = 0.3 + 0.7 = 1 V (W/L)12 −1 (W/L)13 VG13 = −VSS + VGS13 80 −1 20 = −2.5 + 1 = −1.5 V VGS11 = VGS13 = 1 V VG11 = VG13 + VGS11 = −1.5 + 1 = −0.5 V VSG8 = |Vtp | + |VOV 8 | = 0.8 + 0.3 = 1.1 V VG8 = VDD − VSG8 = 2.5 − 1.1 = +1.4 V Ex: 12.9 Total bias current = 300 μA = 2IB ⇒ IB = 150 μA IB = ID1 + ID3 150 = ID1 + 0.25ID1 ⇒ ID1 = 120 μA (W/L)12 −1 (W/L)13 Exercise 12–3 I = ID1 + ID2 Ro4 = (gm4 ro4 )(ro2 ro10 ) = 120 + 120 = 240 μA = (0.3 × 666.7)(166.7 133.3) ID3,4 = 0.25ID1,2 = 0.25 × 120 = 30 μA = 14.8 M 2ID6 2 × 0.03 = 0.3 mA/V = gm6 = VOV 0.2 Ex: 12.10 Using Eq. (12.64), we get ro6 = ro8 = VICM max = VDD − |VOV 9 | + Vtn Ro6 = gm6 ro6 ro8 = 1.65 − 0.3 + 0.5 = +1.85 V = 0.3 × 666.7 × 666.7 = 133.3 M Using Eq. (12.65), we obtain Ro = Ro4 Ro6 VICM min = −VSS + VOV 11 + VOV 1 + Vtn = 14.8 133.3 = 13.3 M VICM min = −1.65 + 0.3 + 0.3 + 0.5 Av = Gm Ro = 1.2 × 13.3 × 103 = 16,000 V/V = −0.55 V |VA | 20 = 666.7 k = ID6,8 0.03 Thus, Ex: 12.12 (a) The NMOS input stage operates over the following input common-mode range: −0.55 V ≤ VICM ≤ +1.85 V −VSS + 2VOV + Vtn ≤ VICM ≤ VDD − |VOV | + Vtn Using Eq. (12.68), we get that is, VOmax = VDD − |VOV 10 | − |VOV 4 | = 1.65 − 0.3 − 0.3 = +1.05 V Using Eq. (12.69), we obtain VOmin = −VSS + VOV 7 + VOV 5 + Vtn = −1.65 + 0.3 + 0.3 + 0.5 = −0.55 V Thus, −0.55 V ≤ v O ≤ +1.05 V Ex: 12.11 Gm = gm1 = gm2 2(I /2) I Gm = = VOV 1 VOV 1 0.24 = 1.2 mA/V 0.2 20 |VA | = = 166.7 k ro2 = I /2 0.12 = ro4 = 20 |VA | |VA | = = I ID4 0.150 − 0.120 IB − 2 20 = 666.7 k 0.03 |VA | ro10 = IB = 20 = = 133.3 k 0.15 2ID4 2 × 0.03 = = 0.3 mA/V gm4 = |VOV | 0.2 (−2.5 + 0.6 + 0.7) ≤ VICM ≤ (2.5 − 0.3 + 0.7) −1.2 V ≤ VICM ≤ +2.9 V (b) The PMOS input stage operates over the following input common-mode range: −VSS +VOV −|Vtp | ≤ VICM ≤ VDD −2|VOV |−|Vtp | that is, (−2.5 + 0.3 − 0.7) ≤ VICM ≤ (2.5 − 0.6 − 0.7) −2.9 V ≤ VICM ≤ +1.2 V (c) The overlap range is −1.2 V ≤ VICM ≤ +1.2 V (d) The input common-mode range is −2.9 V ≤ VICM ≤ +2.9 V Ex: 12.13 Denote the (W/L) of the transistors in the wide-swing mirror by (W/L)M . Transistor Q4 has 1 (W/L)5 = (W/L)M 4 IREF = 1 W μn Cox 2 L 2 VOV 5 5 = 1 W μn Cox 2 L 1 2 × VOV 5 4 M = 1 W μn Cox 2 L M Thus, VOV 5 = VOV 2 (VOV 5 /2)2 Exercise 12–4 where VOV is the overdrive voltage for each of the mirror transistors. Thus, V5 = Vtn + 2VOV which is the value of VBIAS needed in the circuit of Fig. 12.13(b). Ex: 12.14 At IC = 0.1 mA, VBE = 25 ln Thus, IC10 = 9.5 μA 2 resulting in I= IC1 = IC2 = IC3 = IC4 = 9.5 μA Ex: 12.17 Figure 1 on next page shows the determination of the loop gain of the feedback circuit that stabilizes the bias currents of the first stage of the 741 op amp. Note that since IC10 is assumed to be constant, we have shown its incremental value at node X to be zero. Observe that this circuit shows only incremental quantities. The analysis shown provides the returned current signal as −3 0.1 × 10 10−14 = 575.6 V IC 0.1 mA = 4 mA/V = gm = VT 0.025 V re 1 = 250 gm rπ = β 200 = 50 k = gm 4 Ir = −It ro = VA 125 V = = 1.25 M IC 0.1 mA For βP 1, we have Ex: 12.15 VT ln βP 1+ 2 βP Ir −βP It IREF = IC10 R4 IC10 and the loop gain Aβ is 730 25 ln = 5IC10 IC10 (1) where IC10 is in μA, and both sides of Eq. (1) are in mV. Using iteration: IC LHS of Eq. (1) RHS of Eq. (1) (μA) (mV) (mV) 100 49.5 500 50 67 250 20 89.9 100 19 91.2 95 18 92.6 90 Aβ ≡ − Ir = βP It Ex: 12.18 VBE6 = VT ln 9.5 × 10−6 = 517 mV 10−14 = VBE6 + IR2 = 25 ln VR3 = 517 + 9.5 × 10−6 × 1 = 526.5 mV IC7 IE7 = VR3 R3 526.5 = 10.5 μA 50 Ex: 12.19 IB = Thus, = 1 2 Ex: 12.16 Refer to Fig. 12.15. At node X, = I I βN + 1 βN IC10 2I + 2 βP 1+ βP ⎡ 2 ⎢ βP + 1 + βP = 2I⎢ ⎣ 2 βP 1 + βP 2I 2I 2I βP + 1 βP + 2 1 (IB1 + IB2 ) 2 I I + βN + 1 βN + 1 IC10 19 μA IC10 = IC6 IS 9.5 = 47.5 nA 200 IOS = 0.1 × IB = 4.75 nA = ⎤ ⎥ ⎥ ⎦ Ex: 12.20 VC1 = VCC − VEB8 = 15 − 0.6 = 14.4 V Q1 and Q2 saturate when VICM exceeds VC1 by 0.3 V. Thus, VICM max = +14.7 V Exercise 12–5 This figure belongs to Exercise 12.17. Figure 1 VC5 −VEE + VBE5 + VBE7 Ex: 12.21 IC13B = 0.75IC12 = −15 + 0.6 + 0.6 = −13.8 V = 0.75 × 0.73 = 0.55 mA Q3 (and Q4 ) saturate when = 550 μA VB3 = VC5 − 0.3 IC17 = IC13B = 550 μA = −13.8 − 0.3 = −14.1 V But, VB3 = VICM − VBE1 − VEB3 = VICM − 1.2 V Thus, VICM min = VB3 + 1.2 V = −14.1 + 1.2 = −12.9 V Thus, −12.9 V ≤ VICM ≤ +14.7 V VBE17 = VT ln = 25 ln IC17 IS 550 × 10−6 10−14 = 618 mV VR9 = VBE17 + IE17 R8 618 + 550 × 0.1 = 673 mV IR9 = 673 = 13.46 μA 50 Exercise 12–6 550 = 2.74 μA 201 = IR9 + IB17 = 16.30 μA |VAp | 50 V = = 5.26 M I 9.5 μA IB17 = Ex: 12.25 ro4 = IE16 gm4 = 0.38 mA/V 200 × 16.3 = 16.2 μA IC16 = 201 16.2 = 0.08 μA IB16 = 200 Ex: 12.22 The two diode-connected transistors will carry a bias current of 0.25IREF = 180 μA. Since the output transistors have three times the values of IS as that of the diode-connected transistors, the bias current in the output transistors will be = 3 × 180 = 540 μA Ex: 12.23 re = VT 25 mV = 2.63 k IE 9.5 μA 1 = 0.38 mA/V re gm1 1 gm1 = 0.19 mA/V 2 Rid = (βN + 1) × 4re Gm1 = = 201 × 4 × 2.63 = 2.1 M re2 = 2.63 k rπ4 = βP 50 = 131.6 k = gm4 0.38 Ro4 = ro4 [1 + gm4 (re2 rπ4 )] = 5.26[1 + 0.38(2.63 131.6)] = 10.4 M (The answer in the book was obtained by neglecting rπ4 .) ro6 = 125 V VAn = = 13.16 M I 9.5 μA gm6 = 0.38 mA/V R6 = 1 k 200 = 526.3 k 0.38 Ro6 = ro6 [1 + gm6 (R2 rπ6 )] rπ6 = = 13.16[1 + 0.38(1 526.3)] = 18.2 M Ro1 = Ro9 Ro6 = 10.4 18.2 = 6.62 M Ex: 12.24 refer to Fig. 12.19. Ex: 12.26 | Av o | = Gm1 Ro1 (a) v b6 = ie6 (re6 + R2 ) Using Gm1 given in the answer to Exercise 12.23, = ie (re6 + R2 ) Gm1 = 0.19 mA/V re6 = VT 25 mV = 2.63 k IE6 9.5 μA v b6 = ie (2.63 + 1) = 3.63 k × ie (b) ie7 = iR3 + ib5 + ib6 v b6 2αie = + R3 βN 3.63 2 ie + ie 50 201 = 0.08ie and Ro1 given in the answer to Exercise 12.25, Ro1 = 6.7 M we obtain | Av o | = Gm1 Ro1 = 0.19 × 6.7 = 1273 V/V = (c) ib7 = 0.08 ie7 = ie = 0.0004ie βN + 1 201 (d) v b7 = ie7 re7 + v b6 v b7 = 0.08 × 2.63ie + 3.63ie = 3.84 k × ie v b7 (e) Rin = 3.84 k αie Ex: 12.27 Refer to Fig. 12.22, which shows the current mirror with an imbalance between R1 = R and R2 = R + R. Observe that the imbalance causes an error in the mirror transfer ratio of I m = I I is given by Eq. (12.94). Thus, where I R m = R + R + re Exercise 12–7 where re = re5 = re6 , m = R R + re5 R+ R = 0.02 and re5 = 2.63 k, R For R = 1 k, m = Q.E.D. 0.02 = 5.5 × 10−3 1 + 0.02 + 2.63 Ex: 12.28 |VAp | 50 V Ro9 = ro9 = = = 2.63 M IC9 19 μA Ex: 12.31 Using Eq. (12.104), we get α ic17 = v b17 re17 + R8 = 1 200 v b17 = 6.85v b17 201 0.0455 + 0.1 Using Eq. (12.106), we obtain Ri17 = 201(0.0455 + 0.1) = 29.25 k Using Eq. (12.105), we get v b17 = v i2 50 29.25 = 0.92v i2 (50 29.25) + 1.54 Ro10 = ro10 [1 + gm10 (R4 rπ 10 )] Combining Eqs. (1) and (2), we obtain where ic17 = 6.32v b17 ro10 VAn 125 V = = = 6.58 M IC10 19 μA gm10 = IC10 19 μA = = 0.76 mA/V VT 0.025 V R4 = 5 k rπ 10 = βN 200 = 263.2 k = gm10 0.76 Ro10 = 6.58[1 + 0.76(5 263.2)] (1) (2) Thus, Gm2 = 6.32 mA/V This value is somewhat lower than the value generally published for Gm2 , namely Gm2 = 6.5 mA/V To conform with published literature, we shall use the latter value in future calculations. = 31.1 M Ro = Ro9 Ro10 Ex: 12.32 Ro13B = ro13B = = 2.63 31.1 = 2.43 M = Ex: 12.29 Using Eq. (12.100), we obtain m Gmcm = 2Ro = −3 5.5 × 10 = 1.13 × 10−6 mA/V 2 × 2.43 × 106 CMRR = 0.19 Gm1 = = 1.68 × 105 Gmcm 1.13 × 10−6 or 104.5 dB Without common-mode feedback, the CMRR is reduced by a factor equal to βP . Equivalently, CMRR = 104.5 − 20 log βP = 104.5 − 20 log 50 |VAp | IC13B 50 = 90.9 k 0.55 Ro17 = ro17 [1 + gm17 (R8 rπ17 )] where ro17 = 125 = 227.3 k 0.55 gm17 = 0.55 = 22 mA/V 0.025 R8 = 0.1 k rπ17 = 200 = 9.09 k 22 Ro17 = 227.3[1 + 22(0.1 9.09)] = 722 k Ro2 = Ro13B Ro17 = 70.5 dB = 90.9 722 81 k Ex: 12.30 re16 re17 = VT 25 mV = = 1.54 k IE16 16.2 mA VT 25 mV = 45.5 IE17 0.55 mA Ex: 12.33 Open-circuit voltage gain = −Gm2 Ro2 = −6.5 × 81 = −526.5 V/V Using Eq. (12.103), we obtain Ri2 = Ex: 12.34 re23 = (200 + 1) {1.54 + [50 (200 + 1)(0.0455 + 0.1)]} 4 M VT IE23 25 mV = 138.9 0.18 mA Exercise 12–8 Ro23 = = Ro2 + re23 β23 + 1 i= vt + gm18 × 0.917v t (40 30.3) + 1.56 = 6.11 × 10−3 v t vt rAA ≡ 163 i 81 + 0.139 50 + 1 = 1.73 k VT re20 = IE20 Ex: 12.36 For v O = 10 sinωt 25 mV = =5 5 mA Ro23 Rout = re20 + β20 + 1 dv O = ω × 10 cosωt dt dv O = ωM × 10 = 2πfM × 10 SR = dt 1730 = 39 =5+ 50 + 1 fM = max Total output resistance = Rout + R7 = 39 + 27 = 66 Ex: 12.37 IS2 = 2IS1 Using Eq. (12.127), we obtain Ex: 12.35 i I= A ⫺ ⫹ vp ⫺ R10 40 k⍀ gm18vp vi i Figure 1 shows the equivalent circuit model of the circuit in Fig. E12.35. Note that the diode-connected transistors Q19 is replaced with re19 , VT IE19 25 mA = 1.56 k 16 μA Transistor Q18 is replaced with its hybrid-π model, gm18 = IC18 0.165 mA = VT 0.025 V = 6.6 mA/V βN 200 = 30.3 k = rπ 18 = gm18 6.6 Now, vπ = vt R3 = R4 = rp18 A' 0.025 ln2 R2 ⇒ R2 = 1.73 k vt ⫹ rAA' VT IS2 ln R2 IS1 0.01 = re19 re19 = 0.63 × 106 SR = = 10 kHz 20π 20π R10 rπ (R10 rπ ) + re19 40 30.3 = vt = 0.917v t (40 30.3) + 1.56 0.2 V = 20 k 0.01 mA Ex: 12.38 To obtain I8 = 10 μA, transistor Q8 must have the same (ratio = 1) emitter area as Q3 , and R8 = R3 = 20 k To obtain I9 = 20 μA, Q9 must have an EBJ area twice (ratio = 2) that of Q3 and 1 R3 = 10 k 2 To obtain I10 = 5 μA, Q10 must have an EBJ area half (ratio = 0.5) that of Q3 and R9 = R10 = 2R3 = 40 k Ex: 12.39 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 12.42. (a) Current gain from v IP to output = (β1 + 1)(β2 + 1)βP β1 β2 βP = βN βP2 Current gain from v IN to output = (β3 + 1)βN β3 βN = βN2 (b) For iL = +10 mA, current needed at v IP input = 10 10 = = 2.5 μA 40 × 102 βN βP2 Exercise 12–9 For iL = −10 mA, where IREF is in μA. Thus, current needed at v IN input = 10 10 = 2 40 βN2 = 6.25 μA For iL = −10 mA, then iP = 10 + iN Ex: 12.40 IQ = 0.4 mA, I = 10 μA, ISN IS7 = 10, =2 IS10 IS11 Using Eq. (12.136), we obtain 0.4 × 103 = 2 IREF = 10 μA 2 IREF 10 × 10 × 2 Using Eq. (12.137), we get iN (10 + iN ) = 0.2 iN + 10 + iN ⇒ iN2 − 9.6iN + 2 = 0 ⇒ iN = 0.2 mA iP = 10.2 mA Chapter 12–1 12.1 Using Eq. (12.2), we get VICM min = −VSS + Vtn + VOV 3 − |Vtp | = −1 + 0.4 + 0.2 − 0.4 = −0.8 V Using Eq. (12.3), we obtain VICM max = VDD − |VOV 5 | − |Vtp | − |VOV 1 | = 1 − 0.2 − 0.4 − 0.2 = +0.2 V Thus, −0.8 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.2 V 12.3 For the op amp to not have a systematic offset voltage, the condition in Eq. (12.1) must be satisfied, that is, (W/L)6 (W/L)7 =2 (W/L)4 (W/L)5 45/0.3 W /0.3 =2 6/0.3 30/0.3 ⇒ W = 18 μm Refer to Fig. 12.1: ID8 = IREF = 40 μA Using Eq. (12.5), we get −VSS + VOV 6 ≤ v O ≤ VDD − |VOV 7 | Thus, I = ID5 = IREF ID7 = IREF −0.8 V ≤ v O ≤ +0.8 V 30 W5 = 200 μA = 40 × W8 6 45 W7 = 40 × = 300 μA W8 6 ID6 = 300 μA I = 100 μA 2 The overdrive voltage at which each transistor is operating is determined from ID1 = ID2 = ID3 = ID4 = 12.2 For NMOS devices, we have VA = 25 × 0.3 = 7.5 V For PMOS devices, |VA | = 20 × 0.3 = 6 V Using Eq. (12.13), 2 1 1 + A1 = − |VOV 1 | |VA2 | VA4 1 1 2 + =− 0.15 6 7.5 = −44.4 V/V Using Eq. (12.20), we obtain 2 1 1 + A2 = − VOV 6 VA6 |VA7 | 1 1 2 + =− 0.2 7.5 6 1 W 2 μCox VOV 2 L Then VGS is found from ID = |VGS | = |Vt | + |VOV | The transconductance at which each transistor is operating is obtained from gm = 2ID VOV The output resistance of each transistor is found from |VA | ro = ID A1 = −gm1,2 (ro2 ro4 ) = −1.33(150 150) = −100 V/V = −33.3 V/V A2 = −gm6 (ro6 ro7 ) A = A1 A2 = 1478.5 V/V = −3.16(50 50) = −79 V/V 7.5 = 25 k ro6 = 0.3 6 = 20 k ro7 = 0.3 Ro = ro6 ro7 = 11.1 k A = A1 A2 = 7900 V/V For a unity-gain voltage amplifier using this op amp, we have Rout = Rof = Ro 1 + Aβ 11.1 k = 1 + 1481.5 × 1 = 7.5 Using Eq. (12.2), we obtain VICM min = −VSS + Vtn + VOV 3 − |Vtp | VICM min = −1 + 0.45 + 0.19 − 0.45 = −0.81 V Using Eq. (12.3), we get VICM max = VDD − |VOV 5 | − |Vtp | − |VOV 1 | = 1 − 0.24 − 0.45 − 0.15 = +0.16 V Chapter 12–2 The results are summarized in the following table: Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 I D (μA) 100 100 100 100 200 300 300 40 |VOV | (V) 0.15 0.15 0.19 0.19 0.24 0.19 0.24 0.24 |VGS | (V) 0.6 0.6 0.64 0.64 0.69 0.64 0.69 0.69 g m (mA/V) 1.33 1.33 1.05 1.05 1.67 3.16 ro (k) 150 150 150 150 75 50 2.5 0.33 50 375 Thus, Thus, −0.8 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.16 V CMRR = Using Eq. (12.5), we obtain −VSS + VOV 6 ≤ v O ≤ VDD − |VOV 7 | Thus, −1 + 0.19 ≤ v O ≤ 1 − 0.24 −0.81 V ≤ v O ≤ 0.76 V 12.4 For all transistors, we have |VA | = 20 × 0.3 = 6 V Using Eq. (12.13), we get 2 2 6 =− A1 = − |VOV | |VA | |VOV | Using Eq. (12.20), we obtain 2 6 2 =− A2 = − |VOV | |VA | |VOV | 36 A = A1 A2 = |VOV |2 1600 = 36 |VOV |2 I 1 2|VA | I |VA | × × ×2× × |VOV | 2 I |VOV | I |VA |2 |VOV |2 For CMRR = 72 dB = 4000, we have =2 |VA |2 0.152 ⇒ |VA | = 6.7 V 4000 = 2 × Since |VA | = |VA |L, we have 6.7 = 15L ⇒ L = 0.45 μm 2 VA 2 = 6.7 = 2000 V/V Av̂ = VOV 0.15 12.6 From Eq. (12.36), we obtain Gm1 ft = 2πCC Thus, Gm1 0.8 × 10−3 = = 1.06 pF 2πft 2π × 120 × 106 From Eq. (12.35), we get Gm2 fP2 = 2πC2 CC = CMRR = [gm1 (ro2 ro4 )] [2gm3 RSS ] 2.4 × 10−3 = 318.3 MHz 2π × 1.2 × 10−12 From Eq. (12.31), we get Gm2 fZ = 2πCC where = ⇒ |VOV | = 0.15 V 12.5 From Eq. (12.24), we have gm1 = ro2 I |VOV | 2|VA | = ro4 = |VA |/(I /2) = I gm3 = I |VOV | RSS = ro5 = |VA | I = 2.4 × 10−3 = 360 MHz 2π × 1.06 × 10−12 12.7 (a) A = Gm1 R1 Gm2 R2 = 1 × 100 × 2 × 50 = 10, 000 V/V (b) Without CC connected: 1 1 = ωP1 = C1 R1 0.1 × 10−12 × 100 × 103 = 108 rad/s Chapter 12–3 This figure belongs to Problem 12.7, part (b). , dB 20 dB/decade 80 20 dB/decade 60 40 dB/decade 40 20 vt v (rad/s) 0 105 104 vP1 (with CC) 106 107 vP2 108 vP1 without CC 109 1010 vZ vP2 with CC Figure 1 ωP2 = 1 1 = C2 R2 2 × 10−12 × 50 × 103 = 107 rad/s Figure 1 shows a Bode plot for the gain magnitude. (c) With CC connected: = 100 × ωP2 2 × 10−3 = = 109 rad/s 2 × 10−12 ×4× 10−12 1 × 2 × 10−3 × 50 × 103 105 rad/s = 25,000 rad/s = 4 Using Eq. (12.31), we get ωZ = Using Eq. (12.35), we obtain Gm2 = C2 103 = Gm2 CC 2 × 10−3 109 rad/s = 5 × 108 rad/s = 4 × 10−12 2 The Bode plot for the gain magnitude with CC connected is shown in Fig. 1. For ωt two octaves below ωP2 , we have ωt = 109 rad/s 4 12.8 Gm1 = 0.3 mA/V Gm2 = 0.6 mA/V Using Eq. (12.36), we get ro2 = ro4 = 222 k Gm2 ωt = CC ro6 = ro7 = 111 k Thus, 1 × 10−3 109 = 4 CC ⇒ CC = 4 pF Now using Eq. (12.34), we obtain ωP1 = 1 R1 CC Gm2 R2 C2 = 1 pF (a) A = Gm1 (ro2 ro4 )Gm2 (ro6 ro7 ) = 0.3(222 222) × 0.6(111 111) = 33.3 × 33.3 = 1109 V/V (b) fP2 = = Gm2 2πC2 0.6 × 10−3 = 95.5 MHz 2π × 1 × 10−12 Chapter 12–4 1 1 = = 1.67 k Gm2 0.6 × 10−3 ft −1 (d) Phase margin = 180 − 90 − tan fP2 ft 80◦ = 90 − tan−1 fP2 (c) R = ft = fP2 tan10◦ = 95.5 × 0.176 = 16.8 MHz Using Eq. (12.36), we obtain CC = Gm1 0.3 × 10−3 = = 2.84 pF 2πft 2π × 16.8 × 106 The dominant pole will be at a frequency 16.8 × 106 ft = DC Gain 1109 fP1 = = 15.1 kHz (e) Since ft = Gm1 2πCC to double ft , CC must be reduced by a factor of 2, CC = 2.84 = 1.42 pF 2 At the new ft = 2 × 16.8 = 33.6 MHz, we have ft fP2 33.6 = −tan−1 = −19.4◦ 95.5 φP2 = −tan−1 To reduce this phase lag to −10◦ , we need to change R so that the zero moves to the negative real axis and introduces a phase lead of 9.4◦ . Thus, −1 ft tan fZ ◦ = 9.4 33.6 ft fZ = = = 203 MHz tan 9.4 0.166 fZ = 1 1 2πCC R − Gm2 ⇒R− 1 1 = Gm2 2π × 203 × 106 × 1.42 × 10−12 = 552 Gm1 2πft CC = = 1 × 10−3 = 1.59 pF 2π × 100 × 106 (b) fP2 = = Gm2 2πC2 2 × 10−3 = 318 MHz 2π × 1 × 10−12 Gm2 2 × 10−3 = 2πCC 2π × 1 × 1.59 × 10−12 fZ = = 200 MHz To obtain fP1 , we need to know the dc gain of the op amp, A0 , then fP1 = ft A0 The value of A0 is not specified in the problem statement! ft −1 (c) φP2 = −tan fP2 100 = −17.5◦ = −tan−1 318 ft φZ = −tan−1 fZ −1 100 = −26.6◦ φZ = −tan 200 φtotal = 90◦ + 17.5 + 26.6 = 134◦ Phase margin = 180 − 134 = 46◦ (d) From Eq. (12.44), for fZ = ∞ we select R= 1 1 = = 0.5 k = 500 Gm2 2 Phase margin = 180◦ − (90◦ + 17.5◦ ) = 72.5◦ (e) To obtain a phase margin of 85◦ , we need the left-half plane zero to provide at ft a phase angle of 85◦ − 72.5◦ = 12.5◦ . Thus, ft 12.5◦ = tan−1 fZ ft 100 = = 451 MHz tan 12.5◦ tan 12.5◦ R = 1670 + 552 = 2222 fZ = = 2.22 k From Eq. (12.44), we have −fZ = 12.9 (a) Using Eq. (12.36), we get Gm1 ft = 2πCC 2πCC ⇒ R = 722 1 1 −R Gm2 Chapter 12–5 12.10 Using Eq. (12.46), we obtain SR = 2πft VOV 1,2 C2 = 5 × 10−3 = 1.51 pF 2π × 529 × 106 This is the maximum value that C2 can have; if C2 is larger, then fP2 will be lower; and the phase it introduces at ft will increase, causing the phase margin to drop below 70◦ . = 2π × 100 × 106 × 0.2 = 125.6 V/μs Using Eq. (12.45), SR = 12.12 C2 = 0.7 pF. I CC I 100 × 10−6 ⇒ CC = = SR 125.6 × 106 = 0.8 pF For a phase margin of 72◦ , the phase due to fP2 at ft must be 18◦ ; thus, ft = tan 18◦ fP2 ⇒ fP2 = 12.11 Gm1 = 1 mA, Gm2 = 5 mA/V But (a) Using Eq. (12.36), we obtain fP2 = ft = Gm1 2πCC ⇒ CC = Gm1 1 × 10−3 = 2πft 2π × 80 × 106 = 2π × 307.8 × 106 × 0.7 × 10−12 = 1.35 mA/V Thus, (b) Phase margin = ft ft ◦ −1 90 − tan − tan−1 fP2 fZ where gm6 = 1.35 mA/V For the transmission zero to be at ∞, R= Gm2 2πC2 1 1 = = 739 Gm2 1.35 × 10−3 SR = 2πft |VOV 1,2 | and fZ = Gm2 2πC2 ⇒ Gm2 = 2πfP2 C2 = 2 pF fP2 = = 2π × 100 × 106 × 0.15 Gm2 2πCC = 94.2 V/μs For a PM of 70◦ , we have ft ft + tan−1 = 20◦ tan−1 fP2 fZ SR = I CC ⇒ CC = But, fZ = and tan−1 100 = 307.8 MHz tan 18◦ 5 × 10−3 = 398 MHz 2π × 2 × 10−12 ft fZ = tan−1 80 398 = 11.4◦ Thus, ft = 20 − 11.4◦ = 8.6◦ tan−1 fP2 ft = tan 8.6◦ fP2 ⇒ fP2 = 80 = 529 MHz tan 8.6◦ Gm2 = 529 × 106 2πC2 100 × 10−6 I = = 1.06 pF SR 94.2 × 106 12.13 SR = 60 V/μs, ft = 60 MHz (a) Using Eq. (12.46), we obtain SR = 2πft |VOV 1 | ⇒ |VOV 1 | = 60 × 106 = 0.16 V 2π × 60 × 106 (b) Using Eq. (12.45), we get SR = I CC ⇒ CC = 120 × 10−6 I = = 2 pF SR 60 × 106 (c) For Q1 and Q2 , we have 1 W |VOV 1,2 |2 ID1,2 = μp Cox 2 L 1,2 Chapter 12–6 W 1 × 0.162 × 60 × 2 L 1,2 W W ⇒ = = 78.1 L 1 L 2 60 = 2ID6 |VOV | ro6 = |VA | ID6 Thus, PSRR− = 12.14 Gm1 = 0.8 mA/V, Gm2 = 2 mA/V 1 2|VA | I 2ID6 |VA | × × × × |VOV | 2 I |VOV | ID6 VA 2 = 2 VOV (a) Using Eq. (12.36), we obtain gm1 ft = 2πCC ⇒ CC = gm6 = Q.E.D. (b) A PSRR− of 72 dB means Gm1 0.8 × 10−3 = = 1.27 pF 2πft 2π × 100 × 106 (b) Phase margin = ft ◦ −1 −1 ft − tan 90 − tan fP2 fZ ft ft − tan−1 60◦ = 90 − tan−1 fP2 fZ PSRR− = 4000 Thus, |VA |2 0.152 ⇒ |VA | = 6.71 V 4000 = 2 Now, |VA | = |VA |L Thus, ft ft + tan−1 = 30◦ tan−1 fP2 fZ 6.71 = 15L ⇒ L = 0.45 μm where Gm2 2πC2 fP2 = fZ = 2πCC = 1 1 −R Gm2 1 2π × 1.27 × 10−12 (0.5 − 0.5) × 103 Thus, ft = 30◦ tan−1 fP2 ft = 173.2 MHz tan 30 We now can obtain C2 from fP2 = 2 × 10−3 173.2 × 106 = 2πC2 ⇒ C2 = 2 × 10−3 = 1.84 pF 2π × 173.2 × 106 12.15 (a) From Eq. (12.54), we have PSRR− = gm1 (ro2 ro4 )gm6 ro6 where I I 2 = = |VOV | |VOV | 2× gm1 ro2 = ro4 = 12.16 For Q8 and Q9 , we have 1 W |VOV 8,9 |2 IREF = μp Cox 2 L 8,9 |VA | 2|VA | = I /2 I 60 1 × 60 × × |VOV 8,9 |2 2 0.5 ⇒ |VOV 8,9 | = 0.25 V 225 = =∞ gm8 = gm9 = 2ID 2 × 0.225 = |VOV | 0.25 = 1.8 mA/V For Q10 , Q11 and Q12 , we have gm = gm8 = 1.8 mA/V 2IREF = 1.8 VOV ⇒ VOV = 0.25 V and W 1 × 180 × × 0.252 2 L W W W ⇒ = = = 40 L 10 L 11 L 12 225 = Using Eq. (12.61), we obtain 2 (W/L)12 −1 RB = gm12 (W/L)13 √ 2 4−1 1.8 × 10−3 = 1.11 k = Chapter 12–7 Voltage drop across RB = IREF × 1.11 VICM max = VDD − |VOV 9 | + Vtn = 0.225 × 1.11 = 0.25 V W The ratios of Q10 , Q11 and Q12 are given L above. For Q13 , we have W W =4 L 13 L 12 W ⇒ = 160 L 13 = 1 − 0.15 + 0.4 = +1.25 V VICM min = −VSS + |VOV 11 | + VOV 1 + Vtn = −1 + 0.15 + 0.15 + 0.4 = −0.3 V Thus, −0.3 V ≤ VICM ≤ +1.25 V v Omax = VBIAS1 + |Vtp | = 0.3 + 0.4 = +0.7 V DC voltage at gate of Q12 v Omin = −VSS + VOV 7 + Vtn + VOV 5 = −VSS + IREF RB + Vtn + VOV 12 = −1 + 0.15 + 0.4 + 0.15 = −0.3 V = −1.5 + 0.25 + 0.5 + 0.25 = −0.5 V Thus, DC Voltage at gate of Q10 −0.3 V ≤ v O ≤ +0.7 V = VG12 + Vtn + VOV 11 I = 0.2 mA 2 W 1 × 0.04 0.2 = × 0.4 × 2 L 1,2 W W = = 25 ⇒ L 1 L 2 = −0.5 + 0.5 + 0.25 = +0.25 V 12.19 ID1 = ID2 = DC Voltage at gate of Q8 = VDD − |Vtp | − |VOV 8 | = 1.5 − 0.5 − 0.25 = +0.75 V 12.17 2IB × 2 = 1 mW IB = I = 250 − 200 = 50 μA 2 W 1 × 0.04 50 = × 100 × 2 L 3,4 W W = = 25 ⇒ L 3 L 4 ID3 = ID4 = IB − 10−3 = 0.25 mA = 250 μA 4 ID1 = 4ID3 ID1 + ID3 = IB 5ID3 = 250 μA ID5 = ID6 = ID7 = ID8 = 50 μA W 1 × 0.04 50 = × 400 × 2 L 5−8 W W W W ⇒ = = = L 5 L 6 L 7 L 8 ID3 = 50 μA, ID4 = 50 μA ID1 = 200 μA, ID2 = 200 μA I = 400 μA 12.18 VBIAS1 = VDD − |VOV 9 | − |VOV 3 | − |Vtp | = 6.25 = 1 − 0.15 − 0.15 − 0.4 = +0.3 V VBIAS3 = −VSS + VOV 11 + Vtn ID9 = ID10 = IB = 250 μA W 1 × 0.04 250 = × 100 × 2 L 9,10 W W = = 125 ⇒ L 9 L 10 = −1 + 0.15 + 0.4 = −0.45 V ID11 = I = 400 μA VBIAS2 = VDD − |VOV 9 | − |Vtp | = 1 − 0.15 − 0.4 = +0.45 V This table belongs to Problem 12.19. Transistor Q1 W/L 25 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9 Q10 Q11 25 25 25 6.25 6.25 6.25 6.25 125 125 50 Chapter 12–8 1 × 400 × 2 W ⇒ = 50 L 11 400 = W L 11 10 × 106 = Summary: See table on previous page. 12.20 Gm = gm1 = gm2 = = 2(I /2) VOV IB 10 × 10−12 ⇒ IB = 10−4 A = 0.1 mA = 100 μA I I = 3 IB − 2 2 I (1 + 3) = 3IB = 300 2 I 0.4 = 2 mA/V = VOV 0.2 I = 0.25 − 0.2 = 0.05 mA 2 2 × 0.05 2ID4 = = 0.5 mA/V = |VOV | 0.2 ID4 = IB − gm4 IB CL 12.21 SR = × 0.04 I = 150 μA Now, ft = Gm 2πCL ro4 = |VA | 10 = 200 k = ID4 0.05 where ro2 = |VA | 10 |VA | = = 50 k = ID2 I /2 0.2 Gm = gm1,2 = ro10 = |VA | |VA | 10 = 40 k = = ID10 IB 0.25 Ro4 = (gm4 ro4 ) (ro2 ro10 ) = 2(I /2) I = VOV 1,2 VOV 1,2 0.15 mA = 1 mA/V 0.15 V Thus, = 0.5 × 200 (50 40) ft = = 2.22 M 1 × 10−3 2π × 10−12 ID6 = 50 μA = 0.05 mA = 15.92 MHz 2 × 0.05 = 0.5 mA/V 0.2 |VA | 10 = = 200 k ro6 = ID6 0.05 Phase due to the two nondominant poles at ft 15.92 = −2 tan−1 = −35.3◦ 50 gm6 = ro8 = Thus, |VA | 10 = 200 k = ID8 0.05 Phase margin = 90 − 35.3 = 54.7◦ Ro6 = gm6 ro6 ro8 To increase the phase margin to 75◦ , the phase due to the two nondominant poles must be reduced to 90 − 75 = 15◦ , i.e. each should contribute 7.5◦ , thus we must reduce ft to the value obtained as follows: ft tan−1 = 7.5◦ 50 MHz = 0.5 × 200 × 200 = 20 M Ro = Ro4 Ro6 = 2.22 20 = 2 M Av = Gm Ro = 2 × 2000 = 4000 V/V ft = 50 × tan 7.5◦ = 6.58 MHz For the closed-loop amplifier: This is achieved by increasing CL , A = Av = 4000 β= C = 0.1 C + 9C 6.58 × 106 = A 4000 Vo = Af = = Vi 1 + Aβ 1 + 4000 × 0.1 4000 = 9.975 V/V 401 Ro 2 M = Rout = Rof = 1 + Aβ 401 = ⇒ CL = 1 × 10−3 2πCL 10−3 = 24.2 pF 2π × 7.92 × 106 The new value of slew-rate will be 5 k SR = 0.1 × 10−3 IB = = 4.13 V/μs CL 24.2 × 10−12 Chapter 12–9 Ro = Ro4 Ro6 4 |VA |2 |VA |2 = 3 |VOV |I |VOV |I 12.22 Refer to Fig. 12.9. When Vid is sufficiently large to cause Q1 to cut off and Q2 to conduct all of I , Q3 will carry a current IB . However, Q4 will carry (IB − I ). The current IB in Q3 will be mirrored in the drain of Q6 . Thus, at the output node the current available to charge CL will be = IO = IB − (IB − I ) = I The voltage gain can now be found as and the slew rate becomes A = Gm Ro = gm1,2 Ro I SR = CL = |VA |2 I |VOV | |VOV |I = |VA |2 |VOV |2 12.23 A = 80 dB ≡ 104 V/V ft = 20 MHz, CL = 10 pF IB = I |VA | = 12 V Refer to Figs. 12.9 and 12.10. For I = IB , the dc operating currents of the 11 transistors are as follows: Q1 − Q8 : I 2 |VA |2 |VOV |I V A 2 10,000 = VOV ⇒ |VA | = 100 |VOV | 12 = 0.12 V 100 To obtain ft = 20 MHz, we use gm1,2 20 × 106 = 2π × 10 × 10−12 ⇒ |VOV | = Q9 , Q10 , and Q11 : I gm1,2 = 2π × 10 × 10−12 × 20 × 106 Thus, for Q1 − Q8 , we have = 1.257 × 10−3 A/V gm = I |VOV | Thus, 2|VA | I ⇒ I = 1.257 × 0.12 × 10−3 I = 1.257 × 10−3 |VOV | and ro = while, for Q9 − Q11 , ro = |VA | I I = VOV Ro4 = (gm4 ro4 ) (ro2 ro10 ) 2|VA | 2|VA | |VA | I × = |VOV | I I I = 2 |VA | 2|VA | × |VOV | 3 I = 4|VA |2 3|VOV |I Ro6 = gm6 ro6 ro8 = 2|VA | 2|VA | I |VOV | I I 4|VA |2 = |VOV |I IB = I = 150 μA SR = Now, Gm = gm1,2 = 0.15 mA = 150 μA 150 × 10−6 IB = CL 10 × 10−12 = 15 V/μs For Q1 and Q2 , we have 1 I W = 75 μA = k n V2 2 2 L 1,2 OV W 1 75 = × 400 × × 0.122 2 L 1,2 W W ⇒ = = 26 L 1 L 2 ID = For Q3 and Q4 , we have ID = IB − I = 150 − 75 = 75 μA 2 Thus, 75 = 1 400 × × 2 2.5 W L × 0.122 3,4 Chapter 12–10 Summary (Approximate Values): Transistor Q1 W/L ⇒ W L 26 = 3 W L Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q10 Q11 26 65 65 26 26 26 26 130 130 52 Q9 = 65.1 4 For Q5 , Q6 , Q7 , and Q8 , we have Thus, −1.3 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.25 V (c) The overlap range is ID = IB = 75 μA 1 W × 400 × × 0.122 2 L 5−8 W W W W ⇒ = = = = 26 L 5 L 6 L 7 L 8 75 = −0.25 V ≤ VICM ≤ +0.25 V (d) −1.3 V ≤ VICM ≤ +1.3 V For Q9 and Q10 , we have 12.25 First we determine VOV : ID = IB = 150 μA 90 = 1 400 W × × × 0.122 2 2.5 L 9,10 W W ⇒ = = 130.2 L 9 L 10 150 = 1 2 × 400 × 20 VOV 2 ⇒ VOV = 0.15 V VBIAS = Vt + 2VOV = 0.45 + 2 × 0.15 = 0.75 V For Q11 , we have ID = I = 150 μA 1 × 400 × 2 W ⇒ = 52 L 11 150 = W L × 0.122 11 See table above for a summary. 12.24 (a) Refer to Fig. 12.12. For the NMOS input stage Figure 1 VICM max = VDD − |VOV | + Vtn = 1 − 0.15 + 0.45 = +1.3 V VICM min = −VSS + VOV + VOV + Vtn = −1 + 0.15 + 0.15 + 0.45 Figure 1 shows the voltages at the various nodes in the mirror circuit. The minimum voltage allowable at the output terminal is = −0.25 V v Omin = VBIAS − Vtn Thus, = 0.75 − 0.45 = 0.3 V −0.25 V ≤ VICM ≤ +1.3 V which is 2VOV . (b) For the PMOS input stage The output resistance is VICM max = VDD − |VOV | − |Vtp | Ro = 1 − 0.15 − 0.15 − 0.45 V where = +0.25 V ro1 = ro3 = gm3 ro3 ro1 VICM min = −VSS + VOV − |Vtp | VA 10 = 111.1 k = ID 0.09 2ID 2 × 0.09 = 1.2 mA/V = VOV 0.15 = −1 + 0.15 − 0.45 gm3 = = −1.3 V Ro = 1.2 × 111.1 × 111.1 = 14.8 M Chapter 12–11 12.26 Since Q3 is operating in the common-gate configuration and since the resistance in its drain is low, the input resistance at its source is 1/gm3 . This resistance appears in parallel with ro1 which is much larger. Thus, the total resistance at this node is 1/gm3 and since the total capacitance is CP , the pole introduced will have a frequency 1 gm3 = 2πCP /gm3 2πCP fP Q.E.D. VBE2 = VT ln I1 IS2 VBE3 = VT ln I3 IS3 VBE4 = VT ln I3 IS4 I1 IS1 VBE3 + VBE4 = VBE1 + VBE2 Now, ft = 12.28 VBE1 = VT ln gm1 2πCL where gm1 = gm3 because all transistors are operating at the same values of ID and |VOV |. For a phase margin of 80◦ the phase at ft introduced by the pole at fP must be only 10◦ , ft = 10◦ tan−1 fP VT ln I3 I3 I1 I1 + VT ln = VT ln + VT ln IS3 IS4 IS1 IS2 VT ln I32 I2 = VT ln 1 IS3 IS4 IS1 IS2 ⇒ I32 I2 = 1 IS3 IS4 IS1 IS2 ⇒ I3 = I1 IS3 IS4 IS1 IS2 Q.E.D. √ 150 = I1 3 × 3 = 3I1 ft ft = tan 10◦ 0.176 gm1 gm3 = 2πCP 2πCL × 0.176 fP = ⇒ I1 = 50 μA ⇒ CP = 0.176CL 12.29 For the A and B devices, we have This is the largest value that CP can have. VEB = VT ln 0.73 × 10−3 10−14 = 625 mV 12.27 For each transistor we use IC VBE = VT ln IS IC = 25 ln 10−14 For the A device, we have gmA = ICA 0.25 × 0.73 = = 7.3 mA/V VT 0.025 reA 1 = 137 gmA gm = IC IC = VT 0.025 V rπA = β 50 = 6.85 k = gmA 7.3 re 1 gm roA = |VA | 50 = 278 k = ICA 0.18 rπ = β/gm = 200/gm For the B device, we have ro = VA /IC = 125/IC We obtain the following results: Q1 Q2 Q5 Q6 Q16 Q17 9.5 9.5 9.5 9.5 16.2 550 517 517 517 517 530 618 gm (mA/V) 0.38 0.38 0.38 0.38 0.65 22 IC (μA) VBE (mV) gmB = ICB 0.75 × 0.73 = = 21.9 mA/V VT 0.025 reB 1 = 46 gmB rπB = β 50 = = 2.28 k gmB 21.9 roB = |VA | 50 = 90.9 k = ICB 0.55 re (k) 2.63 2.63 2.63 2.63 1.54 0.045 12.30 VSG1 = |Vtp | + |VOV 1 | rπ (k) 526 526 526 526 308 VGS2 = Vtn + VOV 2 ro (M) 13.2 13.2 13.2 13.2 7.72 0.227 9.1 VGS3 = Vtn + VOV 3 Chapter 12–12 VSG4 = |Vtp | + |VOV 4 | = 25 ln But, VBEO = VT ln VSG1 + VGS2 = VGS3 + VSG4 ⇒ |VOV 1 | + VOV 2 = VOV 3 + |VOV 4 | = 25 ln Since |VOV 1 | = 2I1 /k2 VOV 3 = 2I3 /k3 |VOV 4 | = then IO IS 10 × 10−6 10−14 = 603 mV = 518 mV 2I1 /k1 VOV 2 = 0.3 × 10−3 10−14 VBER − VBEO = 603 − 518 = 85 mV R= 85 mV = 8.5 k 10 μA 2I3 /k4 1 1 √ +√ k1 k2 ⎡ 1 √ + ⎢ k1 ⇒ I3 = I1 ⎢ ⎣ 1 √ + k3 = 2I1 2I3 1 1 √ +√ k3 k4 ⎤2 1 √ k2 ⎥ ⎥ 1 ⎦ √ k4 12.33 Refer to Fig. 12.15. (a) A node equation at X yields 2I 2I + = IC10 1 + 2/βP βP For k1 = k2 and k3 = k4 = 16 k1 , we have √ 2 2/ k1 = 16 I1 I3 = I1 √ 2/ k3 2 βP + 1 + βP = IC10 2I 2 βP 1 + βP IC10 βP (βP + 2) I= 2 βP2 + βP + 2 For I3 = 1.6 mA, we have For βP = 50, we have I1 = 0.1 mA I= IC10 × 1.019 2 For βP = 20, we have 12.31 Differential input breakdown voltage I= = 0.6 + 0.6 + 50 + 7 IC10 × 1.043 2 = 58.2 V Thus, I increases by where we have assumed that a forward conducting transistor exhibits |VBE | = 0.6 V. (b) IC10 × 0.024, which is 2.4%. 2 12.32 IREF IO QO QR R Figure 1 Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1, IREF = 0.3 mA, IO = 10 μA VBER = VT ln IREF IS Figure 1 shows the suggested alternative design. As shown, here I 1 βP IC10 2 Chapter 12–13 For βP = 50, we have Thus, I = 25IC10 2nI = IC10 For βP = 20, we have For I = 10 μA and IC10 = 40 μA, we have I = 10IC10 n=2 Thus, I changes by −15IC10 , which is −60% change! This is a result of the absence of the desensitivity effect of negative feedback. 12.36 Figure 1 shows the circuit when R3 is adjusted so that IC5 = IC6 = IC7 . Denoting the new value of these three currents I1 , we obtain the various currents indicated in Fig. 1. Now, at the input node X, we have 1 I1 1 + = 9.5 μA βN 12.34 Refer to Fig. 12.15. For IS9 = 2IS8 , the collector current of Q9 will be IC9 = 4I 1+ 2 βP ⇒ I1 = If βP is large, a node equation at X yields 4I 9.5 = 9.45 μA 1 + (1/200) At this collector current, we have IC10 9.45 × 10−6 = 516.7 μA 10−14 The voltage drop across R3 becomes 1 R1 VR3 = VBE5 + I1 1 + βN VBE = 25 ln 1 19 = 4.75 μA ⇒ I = IC10 = 4 4 To establish IC1 = IC2 = 9.5 μA, we need to redesign the Widlar source to provide IC10 = 38 μA. From Eq. (12.86), we obtain = 516.7 + 9.5 × 1 IREF = IC10 R4 VT ln IC10 = 526.2 mV 730 = 38R4 38 ⇒ R4 = 1.94 k The value of R3 can now be found as 12.35 Refer to Fig. 12.15. For βP large, a node equation at X yields = 56 k IC9 12.37 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 12.16. The current in Q5 remains equal to 25 × ln VR3 526.2 = R3 = 1 1 I1 1 − 9.45 1 − βN 200 IC10 If the ratio of the area of Q9 to that of Q8 is n, then I = 9.5 μA IC9 = n × 2I This figure belongs to Problem 12.36. 9.5 A I1 I1/BN Q7 X I1 ( 1 I1 1 bN Q5 ) R1 1 k I1/BN ( I1 1– 1 bN ( I1 1 I1/BN ) Y 1 bN ) I1 Q6 ( I1 1 R3 VEE Figure 1 1 bN R2 1 k ) Chapter 12–14 The voltage between the base of Q5 and −VEE is = VBE5 + IR1 9.5 × 10−6 = 25 ln + 9.5 × 1 10−14 = 517 + 9.5 = 526.5 mV With R2 shorted, this voltage appears across the BE junction of Q6 . Thus, IC6 = IS eVBE6 /VT = 10−14 e526.5/25 12.40 VC1 = VCC − VEB8 = 5 − 0.6 = 4.4 V Q1 and Q2 saturate when VICM exceeds VC1 by 0.4 V. Thus, VICM max = +4.8 V VC5 −VEE + VBE5 + VBE7 = −5 + 0.6 + 0.6 = −3.8 V Q3 and Q4 saturate when VB3 = VC5 − 0.4 = −4.2 V = 14 μA But, 12.38 2I = 19 μA VB3 = VICM − VBE1 − VEB3 Assuming = VICM − 1.2 IC1 = IC2 = I = 9.5 μA Thus, then IB1 = 9.5 = 63.3 nA 150 IB2 = 9.5 = 43.2 nA 220 1 IB = (IB1 + IB2 ) = 53.3 nA 2 VICM min = VB3 + 1.2 = −4.2 + 1.2 = −3.0 V Thus, −3 V ≤ VICM ≤ +4.8 V IOS = |IB1 − IB2 | = 20.1 nA 12.41 IC18 + IC19 = 0.25 × 0.73 = 180 μA 12.39 Refer to Fig. 12.14 and to Exercise 12.21. From the answers to Exercise 12.21, we find that Require VBE17 = 618 mV IC18 = IC19 = 90 μA IE17 IC17 = 550 μA IB17 = 550 = 2.75 μA 200 Voltage across R9 = VBE17 + IE17 R8 = 618 + 550 × 0.1 VR9 R9 For IC16 = 9.5 μA, we have IE16 90 × 10−6 10−14 = 573 mV Current through R10 = IC19 + IB19 − IB18 IC19 = 90 μA = 673 mV IE16 = IB17 + VBE18 = 25 ln 9.5 = 9.55 μA = 9.5 + 200 Thus, 673 (mV) 9.55 = 2.75 + R9 (k) ⇒ R9 = 98.9 k R10 = 573 = 6.4 k 90 VBB = VBE18 + VBE19 = 2 × 0.573 = 1.146 V Since VBB appears across the series combination of Q14 and Q20 , we can write VBB = VT ln IC14 IC20 + VT ln IS14 IS20 Chapter 12–15 Substituting VBB = 1.146 V, IS14 = IS20 = 3 × 10−14 , we obtain for the equal currents IC14 and IC20 1.146 = 2 × 0.025 ln IC14 3 × 10−14 Ix R2 Vx ⇒ IC14 = IC20 = 270 μA B rp R1 Vp C gmVp 12.42 E I 180 A R2 90.55 A R1 90 A 0.45 A VBB 1.118 V 90 A Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1. 180 = 90 μA = 2 90 IB = = 0.45 μA 201 IC = = βN IE βN + 1 200 × 90 = 89.55 μA 201 VBE = VT ln = 25 ln Figure 2 89.55 A 180 A IE = IR1 r Vx Ix IC IS 89.55 × 10−6 10−14 = 573 mV To determine the incremental resistance between the two terminals of the VBE multiplier, we replace the transistor with its hybrid-π model, as shown in Fig. 2. Here gm = IC 89.55 μA = 3.6 mA/V = VT 25 mV rπ = β 200 = = 55.6 k gm 3.6 R1 rπ = 6.37 55.6 = 5.7 k Vπ = Vx R1 rπ (R1 rπ ) + R2 = Vx 5.7 = 0.49 Vx 5.7 + 6.03 Ix = Vx + gm × 0.49 Vx 5.7 + 6.03 = Vx (0.085 + 1.764) r≡ 1 Vx = 0.541 k = Ix 0.085 + 1.764 = 541 12.43 Refer to Fig. 12.14 and Table 12.1. The current ICC drawn from VCC can be found as follows: ICC = IE12 + IE13 + IC14 + IE9 + IE8 + IC7 + IC16 573 mV R1 = = 6.37 k 90 μA Assuming βP and βN IR2 = IR1 + IB = 90 + 0.45 = 90.45 μA ICC = 730 + 730 + 154 + 19 + 19 + 10.5 VR2 = VBB − VR1 = 1.118 − 0.573 = 0.545 V 545 mV R2 = = 6.03 k 90.45 μA 1, + 16.2 = 1678.7 μA = 1.68 mA PD = ICC (VCC + VEE ) = 1.68(15 + 15) = 50.4 mW Chapter 12–16 To find Ro4 , refer to the circuit in Fig. 2. 12.44 Ro4 = ro4 [1 + gm4 (2 re rπ4 ] where 50 V = 5.26 M 9.5 μA ro4 = gm4 = 0.38 mA/V 50 = 131.6 k 0.38 Ro4 = 5.26[1 + 0.38(5.26 131.6)] rπ4 = = 15.4 M Ro1 = Ro4 Ro6 = 15.4 18.2 = 8.33 M Open-circuit voltage gain = Gm1 Ro1 = 0.13 × 8.33 × 103 = 1083 V/V Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the input stage with the two extra diode-connected transistors Q1a and Q2a . Since these devices are simply in series with Q1 − Q4 , they will have the same dc bias current, namely 9.5 μA. Thus, each of Q1a and Q2a will have an incremental resistance equal to re of each of Q1 to Q4 , re = Comparison Original Design Modified Design Rid (k) 2.1 3.2 Gm1 (mA/V) 0.19 0.13 Ro4 (M) 10.5 15.4 Ro1 (M) 6.7 8.3 |Av o | (V/V) 1273 1083 25 mV = 2.63 k 9.5 μA The input differential resistance Rid now becomes Rid = (βN + 1) × 6re = 201 × 6 × 2.63 = 3.2 M The effective transconductance of the input stage, Gm1 , now becomes Gm1 ≡ 2αie v id Thus the input resistance increases but the gain decreases: The additional diodes introduce negative feedback in the input stage; same effect as adding a resistance in the emitter of a common-emitter amplifier. 12.45 From Fig. 12.20(b) and Eq. (12.91), we get Ro6 = ro6 [1 + gm6 (R2 rπ6 )] = 2αie 1 = gm1 6ie re 3 = 1 9.5 μA = 0.13 mA/V 3 25 mV where 125 V = 13.6 M 9.5 μA ro6 = 9.5 μA = 0.38 mA/V 25 mV 200 = 526.3 k rπ6 = 0.38 1 + 0.38(R2 526.3) Ro6 (modified) = Ro6 (original) 1 + 0.38(1 526.3) gm6 = 2 1 + 0.38 R2 1 + 0.38 ⇒ R2 = 4.63 k Figure 2 Thus, R2 must be increased by a factor of 4.63. Chapter 12–17 Substituting for Gm1 by 12.46 Refer to Fig. 12.19. (a) v b6 = ie6 (re6 + R2 ) 1 1 I gm1 = 2 2 VT Gm1 = = ie (re6 + R2 ) where we obtain 25 mV = 2.63 k re6 = 9.5 μA I v b6 = ie (2.63 + 2) = 4.63 k × ie = v b6 2αie + R3 β re = 2 4.63 ie + ie 50 201 = 0.1ie ie7 0.1 (c) ib7 = = ie = 0.0005ie βN + 1 201 25 mV = 2.63 k and R = 1 k 9.5 μA 3 1 + (2.63/1) R = R 2 × 25 1 − (3/50) R = 0.23 R = 0.1 × 2.38ie + 4.63ie = 4.89ie or 23% v b7 (e) Rin ≡ αie For VOS = −3 mV, we have 4.9 k 12.47 Output current of first stage = (1 − 0.8)I = 0.2I 0.2I Gm1 R = −0.205 or − 20.5% R (c) The maximum offset voltage than can be trimmed this way corresponds to R2 completely shorted, that is, R = −R, thus −1 = where 1 1 I gm1 = 2 2 VT VOS 1 + 2.63 VOS 2VT 1− 2VT ⇒ VOS = − Thus, VOS = 0.2I 0.5I /VT 2VT = −19 mV 2.63 12.49 = 0.4 × VT = 10 mV 12.48 Refer to Fig. 12.22 which shows the situation when R1 = R and R2 = R + R. The result of this mismatch is an output current I given by Eq. (12.94): I =I R+ R R + re (1) If we have an input offset voltage VOS , this offset results in an output current I given by I = Gm1 VOS (2) The offset can be nulled by introducing a mismatch R that results in an equal magnitude and opposite polarity output current. The required R can be found by equating (1) and (2), thus I R+ Q.E.D. then (d) v b7 = ie7 re7 + v b6 Gm1 = VOS R 1 + re /R = R 2VT 1 − VOS /2VT (b) For VOS = 3 mV and recalling that = VOS = R+ ⇒ (b) ie7 = iR3 + ib5 + ib6 R 1 I = VOS R + re 2 VT R = Gm1 VOS R + re Figure 1 Chapter 12–18 Figure 1 (see preceding page) shows the analysis when the β of Q4 is reduced to 10. The output current of the mirror is I = 0.691 μA which corresponds to an input offset voltage of VOS = Thus, io of the mirror becomes io = 2.38αie with the result that the gain of the 741 increases 2.38 = 1.19. by a factor of 2 I 1 , where Gm1 = gm1 = 0.19 mA/V Gm1 2 (c) If both R1 and R2 are shorted, the gain remains unchanged. 0.691 = 3.6 mV 0.19 12.52 Please note that an error occurred in the first printing of the text: Q9 is biased at 19 μA. With a resistance R in the emitter of Q9 , Ro9 becomes Thus, VOS = 12.50 From Eq. (12.102) we have CMRR = gm1 (Ro9 Ro10 )/m Ro9 = ro9 [1 + gm9 (R rπ9 )] where where gm1 = 0.38 mA/V Ro9 = 2.63 M Ro10 = 31.1 M m = 1 − 0.995 = 0.005 Thus, CMRR = 0.38(2.63 31.3) × 103 /0.005 = 1.84 × 105 or 105.3 dB ro9 = |VAp | 50 V = 2.63 M = IC9 19 μA gm9 = IC9 19 μA = = 0.76 mA/V VT 0.025 V rπ9 = βP 50 = 65.8 k = gm9 0.76 Thus, to obtain Ro9 = Ro10 = 31.1 M, we use 31.1 = 2.63[1 + 0.76(R 65.8)] ⇒ R = 18.2 k Thus, Ro to the left of node Y becomes 12.51 Refer to Fig. 12.19. (a) If R1 is short-circuited, the incremental transfer ratio of the mirror can be found as follows: Ro = 31.1 M 31.1 M = 15.55 M 12.53 ie5 re5 = ie6 (re6 + R2 ) Thus, ie6 re5 2.63 ic6 = = = ic5 ie5 re5 + R2 2.63 + 1 = 0.72 Thus, the output current of the mirror becomes io = 1.72αie rather than 2αie . Thus, the gain of the 741 will be 1.72 = 0.86. reduced by a factor of 2 (b) If R2 is short-circuited, then ie5 (re5 + R1 ) = ie6 re6 ⇒ ic6 ie6 re5 + R1 = = ic5 ie5 re6 = 2.63 + 1 = 1.38 2.63 Figure 1 Chapter 12–19 Figure 1 (see previous page) shows the input stage with the approach suggested for determining Gmcm . Here Rf = Ro (1 + Aβ) = Ro (1 + βP ) βP Ro = IC13B R13B IC13A = 550 × 366 = 1.12 k 180 IE13B R13B IE12 A node equation at the common bases of the Q3 and Q4 yields R12 = v icm 2i = βP Rf = IC13B R13B IC12 = 550 × 366 = 275 730 ⇒i= βP v icm 2Rf βP v icm 2βP Ro v icm = 2Ro = 12.55 Using Eq. (12.110), we obtain v Omax = VCC − |VCEsat | − VBE14 = 5 − 0.2 − 0.6 = +4.2 V Thus, io = m i = m v icm 2Ro and Gmcm Using Eq. (12.111), we get v Omin = −VEE + |VCEsat | + VEB23 + VBE20 = −5 + 0.2 + 0.6 + 0.6 = −3.6 V io m ≡ = v icm 2Ro which is the same result [Eq. (12.100)] obtained by the alternative approach of Example 12.5. 12.54 Refer to the results of Exercise 12.32. We need to raise ro13B from 90.9 k to 722 k by inserting a resistance R13B in the emitter of Q13B . Since Ro13B = ro13B [1 + gm13B (R13B rπ 13B ] Thus, −3.6 V ≤ v O ≤ +4.2 V 12.56 Refer to Fig. P12.56. Rout = re14 + where re14 = 25 mV =5 5 mA where rAA = 163 ro13B = 90.9 k re23 = gm13B = rπ 13B = 0.55 mA = 22 mA/V 0.025 V βP gm13B = 50 = 2.27 k 22 Thus, rAA + re23 + [Ro2 /(βP + 1)] β14 + 1 25 mV = 139 0.18 mA Ro2 = 81 k βP = 50 β14 = 200 Thus 722 = 90.9[1 + 22(R13B 2.27)] ⇒ R13B = 366 Rout = 5 + 163 + 139 + (81000/51) 201 = 14.4 The resistors in the emitters of Q13A and Q12 must be of values that will result in IE13B R13B = IE12 R12 = IE13A R13A Thus, R13A = IE13B R13B IE13A 12.57 Refer to Fig. 12.25 and Example 12.6 with Q23 having its emitter and base shorted together. In such a situation the input resistance of the output stage becomes Rin3 = (β20 RL ) (ro13A + rAA ) (1) Chapter 12–20 IE14 21.85 = 108.7 μA = βN + 1 201 where we have assumed the situation with v O negative and Q20 supplying the load current. IB14 = In Eq. (1), Iteration #2: β20 = 50 IC15 = 180 − IB14 = 180 − 108.7 = 71.3 μA RL = 2 k VBE15 = 25 ln ro13A = |VAp | 50 = = 280 k IC13A 0.18 and rAA is the incremental resistance of the Q18 − Q19 bias network; very small ( 160 ). Thus, IE14 = 567.2 = 21 mA 27 IB14 = 21 mA = 104.5 μA 201 Iteration #3: (50 × 2) 280 Rin3 71.3 × 10−6 = 567.2 mV 10−14 = 74 k IC15 = 180 − 104.5 = 75.5 μA The gain of the second stage becomes VBE15 = 25 ln A2 = v i3 Rin3 = −Gm2 Ro2 v i2 Rin3 + Ro2 = −6.5 × 81 × IE14 = 74 74 + 81 75.5 × 10−6 = 568.6 10−14 568.6 = 21.06 mA 27 which is very close to the value found in Iteration #2; thus, no further iterations are necessary and = −215.4 V/V IE14 Compare to the value with Q23 included (−515 V/V). 21 mA 12.59 Refer to Fig. 12.14. 12.58 Maximum current available from input stage = 19 μA Q13A IC22 = 19 μA 180 A IB14 VBE22 = 25 ln Q14 IC15 Q15 0 = 534 mV IE14 VBE24 = 534 mV IE14 IC24 = 19 μA R6 27 IR11 = out Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1. Iteration #1: IC15 = 180 μA VBE15 IE14 180 × 10−6 = 25 ln = 590 mV 10−14 VBE15 590 mV = 21.85 mA = = R6 27 19 × 10−6 10−14 534 mV = 10.7 μA 50 k IC21 = IC24 + IR11 = 19 + 10.7 = 29.7 μA VEB21 = 25 ln 29.7 × 10−6 10−14 = 545.3 mV IR7 = 545.3 = 20.2 mA 27 This is the maximum current that the 741 can sink. To reduce this current limit to 10 mA, we need to double the value of R7 . Chapter 12–21 12.60 The factor 0.97 is simply = 12.64 RL RL + Rout Thus, for RL = ∞, A0 = 243, 147/0.97 = 250, 667 V/V This is the open-circuit voltage gain. The output resistance is found from 2 = 0.97 2 + Rout ⇒ Rout = 62 Figure 1 The gain with RL = 500 is A0 = 250, 667 × 500 500 + 62 = 223, 013 V/V For a phase margin of 85◦ with a closed loop gain of 100, the phase at f1 due to the pole at 5 MHz must be at most 5◦ ; thus, 12.61 If the phase margin is 80◦ , the phase due to the second pole fP2 at the unity gain frequency ft must be 10◦ . Thus, tan−1 ft = 10◦ fP2 tan−1 Since ft = 1 MHz, 1 MHz = 5.67 MHz tan 10◦ fP2 = 12.62 The phase introduced at ft = 1 MHz by each of the coincident second and third poles must be 5◦ . Thus, fP2 = fP3 can be obtained from ft = 5◦ fP2 tan−1 ⇒ fP2 = fP3 1 MHz = = 11.4 MHz tan 5◦ ⇒ f1 = 5 × tan 5◦ = 437 kHz Thus, the new dominant pole must be at fD , fD × A0 = 437 100 fD × 243, 147 = 437 100 ⇒ fD = 180 Hz To find the required value of CC , we use Eq. (12.116) to determine Cin : Cin = CC (1 + |A2 |) = CC × 516 Then, fD = 12.63 fP = ft 5 MHz = = 5 Hz A0 106 1 2πCin Rt where Rt = 2.5 M But, fP = f1 = 5◦ 5 MHz 1 2πCR where 180 = 1 2π × 516CC × 2.5 × 106 ⇒ CC = 0.7 pF C = (1 + |A|)CC = (1 + 1000) × 50 = 50.05 nF 1 5= 2π × 50.05 × 10−9 × R ⇒ R = 636 k 12.65 DC gain A0 = Gm1 R = 2 × 10−3 × 2 × 107 = 4 × 104 V/V 20 log A0 = 92 dB Chapter 12–22 1 2πCC R fP = = 1 2π × 100 × 10−12 × 2 × 107 = 79.6 Hz 106 = 159.2 kHz 2π fM = 80 Hz If the topology is similar to that of the 741, then we can use Eq. (12.126), SR = 4VT ωt ft = A0 fP = 4 × 104 × 80 ⇒ ωt = = 3.2 MHz , dB SR 10 × 106 = 4VT 4 × 25 × 10−3 = 108 rad/s ft = 100 92 80 60 20 dB/decade 108 = 15.9 MHz 2π 40 12.67 Including a resistance RE in the emitter of each of Q3 and Q4 cause Gm1 to become 20 Gm1 = 0 3.2 106 f (Hz) ft 80 fP Figure 1 Figure 1 shows a sketch of the Bode plot for the magnitude of the open-loop gain of the op amp. SR = I CC 1 2re + RE where re is the emitter resistance of each of Q1 − Q4 , re = VT I Thus, But, Gm1 = 2 4re + 2RE Gm1 = I = 2VT I 2VT + IRE (1) The slew rate is still given by (12.125), Thus, SR = I = 2VT Gm1 and 2I CC (2) Also, the model in Fig. 12.30 still applies; thus, SR = 2VT Gm1 CC = 2 × 25 × 10−3 × ωt = 2 × 10−3 100 × 10−12 = 1 V/μs 12.66 For a sine-wave output, we have Gm1 CC Equations (1)–(3) can be combined to obtain SR = 2I 2Gm1 (2VT + IRE ) = CC CC = 2ωt (2VT + IRE ) v O = V̂o sin ωt = 4(VT + IRE /2)ωt d vO = ωV̂o cos ωt dt d v O = ωV̂o dt Since for the 741 max 10 × 10 = ωM × 10 6 ωM = 106 rad/s (3) Q.E.D. SR = 4VT ωt to double SR while keeping ωt unchanged, we select 1 IRE = VT 2 Chapter 12–23 fP = 8.2 Hz If we also keep I unchanged, then RE = 2 × 25 × 10−3 2VT = I 9.5 × 10−6 This is a result of CC in Eq. (12.116) being is halved and thus fP in Eq. (12.118) is doubled. = 5.26 k 12.68 (a) Refer to Fig. P12.68. From Eq. (1), the new value of Gm1 is Gm1 = = IC1 = IC2 = IC3 = IC4 = 0.05 mA I 2VT + IRE IC5 = 1 mA IC7 = IC6 = IC5 = 1 mA I I = 2VT + 2VT 4VT (b) For Q1 and Q2 , we have = 0.095 mA/V 0.05 mA = 2 mA/V 0.025 V β 100 = 50 k = rπ = gm 2 gm = which is half the original value. From Eq. (3), we see that CC will have to be one half the original value, thus CC = 15 pF Rid = 2rπ = 100 k This result could have been obtained also from SR = I /CC ; doubling SR with I unchanged requires halving CC . Now, with Gm1 half the original value, the dc gain also will be half the original value, (c) Figure 1 shows the small-signal analysis where vi ie = 2re1,2 v o = (β + 2)βαie RL 1 A0 = × 243, 147 = 121, 573 V/V 2 Av = vo (β + 2)βαRL = vi 2re1,2 Av 1 2 RL β 2 re1,2 or 101.7 dB Finally, since fP = where ft A0 re1,2 = halving A0 with ft unchanged means fP is doubled, 25 mV = 0.5 k 0.05 mA This figure belongs to Problem 12.68, part (c). vid Q7 ie Q1 (b1) baie Q2 baie aie 2aie aie aie aie Q5 aie Q3 Q4 Figure 1 (b2) baie baie Q6 RL vo Chapter 12–24 Av = 1 5 1002 × = 5 × 104 V/V 2 0.5 12.70 For I5 = 10 μA = I , then Q5 emitter area =1 Q1 emitter area or 94 dB (d) C For I6 = 40 μA = 4I , then Q6 emitter area =4 Q1 emitter area 0V A2 2aie gm1,2vi If we connect a resistance R6 in the emitter of Q6 , then I6 changes to a new value determined as follows: VBE6 + I6 R6 = VBE1 I6 R6 = VBE1 − VBE6 Figure 2 Replacing the second stage with an amplifier having a large negative gain, we obtain the equivalent circuit shown in Fig. 2. From this equivalent circuit we see that the gain is approximately given by A(s) = gm1,2 sC Thus, the unity gain frequency ωt is given by ωt = gm1,2 C ωt gm1,2 = ωP = A0 A0 C gm1,2 fP = 2πA0 C For fP = 100 Hz and substituting gm1,2 = 2 mA/V and A0 = 5 × 104 , we find 2 × 10−3 2π × 100 × 5 × 104 = 63.7 pF 12.69 I = 5 μA Using Eq. (12.127), we obtain IS2 VT ln I= R2 IS1 0.025 ln 4 R2 ⇒ R2 = 6.93 k R3 = R4 = But I6 is to be equal to I , thus IR6 = VT ln R6 = IS6 IS1 VT ln 4 I ⇒ R6 = 0.025 ln 4 = 3.47 k 0.01 Ro5 = ro5 = VAn 30 V = = 3 M I5 10 μA Ro6 = ro6 + (R6 rπ6 )(1 + gm6 ro6 ) where ro6 = 30 V = 3 M 10 μA gm6 = 10 μA = 0.4 mA/V 0.025 V rπ6 = βN 40 = 100 k = gm6 0.4 Ro6 = 3 + (3.47 100) × 10−3 (1 + 1200) Ro6 = 3 + 4 = 7 M IS2 =4 IS1 5 × 10−3 = I I6 − VT ln IS1 IS6 If the VBIAS1 line has a low incremental resistance to ground, then and the 3-dB frequency ωP is C= = VT ln 0.15 V = 30 k 0.005 mA Thus, increasing the BEJ area by a factor of 4 and adding a resistance R6 to restore the current to the desired value of 10 μA increases the output resistance by a factor of about 2.5! 12.71 (a) The bias current I of the differential pair is given by Eq. (12.127), VT IS5 I= ln (1) R5 IS1 Chapter 12–25 (b) The voltage gain of the differential pair is given by VCC 3 V Ad = gm RC where gm is the transconduuctance of each of the two transistors in the differential pair, gm = Q3 Q4 vo I /2 I = VT 2VT Q1 Q2 Thus, Ad = IRC 2VT (3) Substituting for I from Eq. (1) into Eq. (3), we obtain Ad = 1 RC IS5 ln 2 R5 IS2 which indicates that Ad will be independent of temperature! Q5 VBIAS 0.7 V Figure 1 (4) Figure 1 shows the complementary circuit to that in Fig. 12.33(a). Here, IS5 (b) I = 20 μA, Ad = 10 V/V, =4 IS1 0.8 V ≤ VICM ≤ 2.9 V Using Eq. (1), we obtain 12.73 Refer to Fig. 12.35(b). 20 × 10−3 = 0.025 ln 4 R5 ⇒ R5 = 1.73 k Using Eq. (4), we get 10 = 1 RC ln 4 2 1.73 ⇒ RC = 25 k VICM max = VCC − 0.1 − 0.7 = 3 − 0.8 = +2.2 V VICM min = = 1 IRC − 0.6 2 1 × 0.02 × 25 − 0.6 2 = −0.35 V Thus, −0.35 V ≤ VICM ≤ +2.2 V Av = gm RC 12.72 (a) Refer to Fig. 12.35(a). where VICM min = VC1 − 0.6 gm = = 0.7 − 0.6 = 0.1 V Av = 0.4 × 25 = 10 V/V IC 10 × 10−6 = = 0.4 mA/V VT 25 × 10−3 VICM max = VCC − 0.1 − 0.7 = 3 − 0.8 = 2.2 V 12.74 gm = I /2 20 μA = 0.8 mA/V = VT 25 mV For Ad = 10 V/V, we have Thus, 10 = gm RC 0.1 V ≤ VICM ≤ 2.2 V ⇒ RC = 12.5 k Chapter 12–26 I RC = 20 × 10−3 × 12.5 = 0.25 V 2 VICM min = 0.8 V I VICM max = VCC − RC + 0.6 2 = 3 − 0.25 + 0.6 = 3.35 V Thus, 0.8 V ≤ VICM ≤ 3.35 V Rid = 2rπ = 2 =2 βN gm 40 = 100 k 0.8 To increase Rid by a factor of 4, gm and hence I must be reduced by a factor of 4, thus IC6 becomes IC6 = 10 μA To keep the gain and the permissable range of VICM unchanged, RC must be increased by a factor of 4, thus RC becomes RC = 50 k βP gm1 where IC1 4 × 10−6 = = 0.16 mA/V VT 25 × 10−3 gm1 = Gm1 ≡ io αie7 = Vid /2 Vid /2 = 0.876gm1 = 0.137 mA/V The total resistance between the output node and ground for the circuit in Fig. 12.38(a) is R = Ro9 Ro7 (RL /2) The resistances Ro9 is the output resistance of Q9 , which has an emitter-degeneration resistance R9 . Thus, where ro9 = |VAp | 20 V = 2.5 M = IC9 8 μA gm9 = IC9 8 μA = 0.32 mA/V = VT 25 mV rπ9 = βP 10 = = 31.25 k gm9 0.32 Thus, Ro9 = 12.5 + (33 31.25) Thus, 2 × 10 = 125 k 0.16 Rid = The short-circuit transconductance Gm1 can be found from Fig. 12.38(b): Gm1 = io v id /2 At node X we have four resistances to ground: ro1 = Thus, Ro9 = ro9 + (R9 rπ9 )(1 + gm9 ro9 ) 12.75 Refer to Fig. 12.38, which shows the differential half-circuit of the differential amplifier of Fig. 12.37. Rid = 2rπ 1 = 2 Obviously, ro1 and ro7 are much larger than re7 and R7 . Then, the portion of gm1 (v id /2) that flows into the emitter proper of Q7 can be found from Vid R7 ie7 gm1 2 R7 + re7 22 Vid = gm1 2 22 + 3.125 Vid = 0.876gm1 2 |VAp | 20 V = = 5 M IC1 4 μA × 10−3 (1 + 0.32 × 2.5 × 103 ) = 15.3 M The resistance Ro7 is the output resistance of Q7 , which has an emitter-degeneration resistance (R7 ro1 ) R7 . Thus, Ro7 = ro7 + (R7 rπ7 )(1 + gm7 ro7 ) where ro7 = |VAn | 30 V = = 3.75 M IC7 8 μA gm7 = IC7 8 μA = 0.32 mA/V = VT 25 mV rπ7 = βN 40 = 125 k = gm7 0.32 R7 = 22 k ro7 = |VAn | 30 V = = 3.75 M IC7 8 μA re7 1 VT 25 mV = = = 3.125 k gm7 IC7 8 μA Chapter 12–27 Thus, ie7 Ro7 = 3.75 + (22 125) × 10−3 (1 + 0.32 × 3.75 × 103 ) = = 26.2 M RL 1.5 = = 0.75 M 2 2 gm1 v id 2 R7 R7 + re7 0.067 I v id VT 2 0.067 + 0.0125 v id I = 0.84 VT 2 R = 15.3 26.2 0.75 = 0.696 M The output short-circuit current io will be I v id io ie7 = 0.84 VT 2 Finally, we can find the voltage gain as Thus, The load resistance R can now be found as Av = v od /2 = Gm1 R v id /2 = 0.137 × 0.696 × 103 = 95.4 V/V Gm1 = 0.84 I VT 33.6I To obtain the output resistance R, R = Ro9 Ro7 12.76 IC1 = I IC7 = IC9 = 2I From Fig. 12.37 we see that the current through R7 is approximately (IC1 + IC7 ), that is, 3I . Thus, we determine Ro9 as follows: Ro9 = ro9 + (R9 rπ9 )(1 + gm9 ro9 ) where 0.2 R7 = 3I ro9 = |VAp | 10 20 = = IC9 2I I Since Q3 and Q4 are cut off, the current through R9 is equal to IE9 or approximately IC9 , thus gm9 = IC9 2I = 80I = VT 0.025 R9 = 0.3 2I To determine the short-circuit transconductance Gm1 , refer to Fig. 12.38(b). gm9 ro9 = 800 rπ9 = Thus, gm1 = IC1 I = VT VT Ro9 = Gm1 = io v id /2 = At node X we have four resistances in parallel, namely, ro1 , R7 , ro7 , and re7 : ro1 |VAp | 20 = = IC1 I βP 10 0.125 = = gm9 80I I 10 + I 0.15 0.125 I I × 801 64.6 I We next determine Ro7 as follows: Ro7 = ro7 + (R7 rπ7 )(1 + gm7 ro7 ) where R7 = 0.067 0.2 = 3I I ro7 = 15 I ro7 = VAn 30 15 = = IC7 2I I R7 = 0.067 I re7 VT 0.025 0.0125 = = IC7 2I I gm7 = Thus, ro1 and ro7 are much greater than re7 and R7 , v id and the portion of gm1 that flows into the 2 emitter proper of Q7 is given by IC7 2I = VT VT gm7 ro7 = 1200 rπ7 = βN 40 0.5 = = gm7 2I /VT I Chapter 12–28 Thus, Ro7 = = 15 + I 0.067 0.5 I I IE8 = × 1201 86 I IE7 = The corresponding change in the collector voltages of Q7 and Q8 will be v O2 = We now can determine the output resistance R as VB re7 + R7 v O1 = − IC7 Ro Now, 36.9 64.6 86 = R = Ro9 Ro7 = I I I IE7 IC7 The open-circuit voltage gain can be obtained as and Av o = Gm1 R 36.9 I = 0.84 VT I Ro = Ro7 Ro9 thus v O1 = − = 1240 V/V VB (Ro7 Ro9 ) re7 + R7 With a load resistance RL , we have This is the returned voltage, thus RL Av = Av o RL + R Aβ ≡ − = 1240 RL 36.9 RL + I = 1240 IRL IRL + 36.9 For RL = 1 M and I in μA, we have I Av = 1240 I + 36.9 From this equation we can obtain I= v O1 VCM Ro7 Ro9 re7 + R7 = Q.E.D. (b) From Example 12.8, we have Ro7 = 23 M, Ro9 = 12.9 M, re7 VT 25 mV = = 2.5 k, IC7 10μA R7 = 20 k thus 36.9 1240 −1 Av Aβ = (23 12.9) × 103 2.5 + 20 Thus, for Av = 150 V/V, the required value of I is = 367.3 36.9 = 5.1 μA I= 1240 −1 150 For a change I = 0.3 μA, the corresponding change in VCM without feedback is and for Av = 300 V/V, we require I= 36.9 = 11.8 μA 1240 −1 300 VCM = 12.77 (a) Refer to Fig. 12.39. Break the loop at the input of the CMF circuit and apply a common-mode input signal VCM . The CMF circuit will respond by causing a change VB in its output voltage that can be found from its transfer characteristic as I (Ro7 Ro9 ) Aβ Substituting for Aβ from Eq. (1), we obtain VCM = I (re7 + R7 ) = 0.3 × 10−6 (2.5 + 20) = 6.75 mV VCM Now, a change Q8 results in I (Ro7 Ro9 ) The negative feedback reduces this change by the amount of negative feedback 1 + Aβ Aβ, thus the actual VCM becomes VCM VB = (1) VB in the base voltage of Q7 and which is identical to the value found in Example 12.8. Chapter 12–29 12.78 (a) v O can range to within 0.1 V (the saturation voltage) of ground and VCC , thus But, i5 = i4 and R5 = R4 0.1 V ≤ v O ≤ 2.9 V thus (b) For iL = 0, the output resistance is v B6 = v BE5 + i4 R4 Ro = roN roP Using Eq. (2), we obtain where roN v B6 = v BE5 + v EBP − v EB4 VAn 30 V = = 50 k = IQ 0.6 mA roP = = (v BE5 − v EB4 ) + v EBP IS4 iP = VT ln + VT ln IS5 ISP IS4 iP = VT ln IS5 ISP |VAp | 20 V = 33.3 k = IQ 0.6 mA Thus, Ro = 50 33.3 = 20 k (c) Rout = Rof = = 20 k 1 + 105 Now, using the given relationship Ro 1 + Aβ ISN ISP = IS4 IS5 0.2 in Eq. (3), we get iP v B6 = VT ln ISN (d) For iL = 12 mA, we have IQ iN = = 0.3 mA 2 Using Eqs. (1) and (4), we obtain iP v B6 − v B7 = VT ln iN iP = 12 + 0.3 = 12.3 mA roN = roP 30 V = 100 k 0.3 mA This is the differential voltage input for the differential amplifier Q6 − Q7 . Thus, 20 V = 1.63 k = 12.3 Ro = 100 1.63 = 1.6 k (e) For iL = −12 mA, we have iC6 = I 1 + e(v B6 −v B7 )/VT = I iP = 0.3 mA iN = 12.3 mA roN = 30 V = 2.44 k = 12.3 mA roP = v EBP − v EB4 R4 v B6 = v BE5 + i5 R5 iP iN iN I i P + iN iC7 = Ro = 2.44 66.7 = 2.4 k i4 = 1+ Q.E.D. Similarly, 20 V = 66.7 k 0.3 mA 12.79 Refer to Fig. 12.43. iN v B7 = v BEN = VT ln ISN (3) = = I 1+ e(v B7 −v B6 )/VT I 1+ iN iP iP I i P + iN Q.E.D. (1) (2) 12.80 v E = v EB7 + v BEN Since Q7 conducts a current iC7 given by Eq. (12.131), (4) Chapter 12–30 iC7 = I iP iP + iN and QN conducts a current iN , then I iP iN 1 v E = VT ln + VT ln iP + iN IS7 ISN iP iN I Q.E.D. = VT ln iP + iN ISN IS7 ISN =8 IS10 IS7 =4 IS11 Using Eq. (12.136), we have 2 I 600 = 2 REF × 8 × 4 12 ⇒ IREF = 10.6 μA 12.81 IQ = 0.6 mA = 600 μA I = 12 μA The minimum current in each transistor is about 0.3 mA. Exercise 13–1 Ex: 13.1 A = −20 log|T | [dB] From Fig.1 we see that the real pole is at |T | = A s = −1 1 0.99 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.5 0.1 0 0 0.1 1 2 3 6 20 ∞ Ex: 13.2 Amax = 20 log1.05 − 20 log 0.95 0.9 dB 1 = 40 dB Amin = 20 log 0.01 and thus gives rise to a factor (s + 1) in the denominator. The pair of complex conjugate poles are at −cos 60◦ ± j sin 60◦ √ = −0.5 ± j 3/2 Ex: 13.3 T (s) = k (s + j2) (s − j2) 1 1 3 3 s+ +j s+ −j 2 2 2 2 2 s +4 =k 1 3 s2 + s + + 4 4 2 s +4 =k 2 s +s+1 4 T (0) = k = 1 1 1 k= 4 1 s2 + 4 ∴ T (s) = 4 s2 + s + 1 The corresponding quadratic in the denominator will be √ √ 3 3 = s + 0.5 + j s + 0.5 − j 2 2 s s2 + 4 × T (s) = a3 (s + 0.1 + j0.8) (s + 0.1 − j0.8) |T (jω)| = √ 1 (s + 0.1 + j1.2) (s + 0.1 − j1.2) s s2 + 4 = a3 2 s + 0.2s + 0.65 s2 + 0.2s + 1.45 = = s2 + s + 1 Since the filter is of the all-pole type, the transfer function will be T (s) = k 1 (s + 1)(s2 + s + 1) Since the dc gain is unity, k = 1 and T (s) = Ex: 13.4 = 1 1+ ω2 (1 − ω2 )2 + ω2 1 (1 + ω2 )(1 − ω2 )2 + ω2 (1 + ω2 ) 1 (1 − ω4 )(1 − ω2 ) + ω2 + ω4 = √ Ex: 13.5 1 (s + 1)(s2 + s + 1) jv = √ 1 1 − ω4 − ω2 + ω6 + ω2 + ω4 1 Q.E.D. 1 + ω6 √ |T (jω)| = 1/ 2 at ω = ω3dB , thus 1 30° 1+ ⫺1 0 30° s 6 ω3dB 1 = √ 2 ⇒ ω3dB = 1 rad/s At ω = 3 rad/s, we have |T | = √ 1 1+ 36 1 = √ 730 √ A = −20 log |T | = −20 log(1/ 730) Figure 1 = 10 log(730) = 28.6 dB Exercise 13–2 Ex: 13.6 = 10 Amax 10 Ex: 13.8 1 10 10 − 1 = 0.5088 −1= 1 |T (jω)| = 1 + 2 2N ω ωp A(ωs ) = −20 log|T (jωs )| 2N 2 ωs = 10 log 1 + ωp Thus, 10 log 1 + 0.50882 × 1.52N ≥ 30 N = 11: LHS = 32.87 dB ∴ Use N = 11 and obtain Amin = 32.87 dB 1 + 0.36542 = 0.54 dB Ex: 13.7 The real pole is at s = –1 The complex conjugate poles are at s = − cos 60◦ ± j sin 60◦ 3 = −0.5 ± j 2 π , k = 0, 1, 2 2 (2k + 1) π ∴ ω̂ = ωp cos , k = 0, 1, 2 10 π = 0.95ωp ω̂1 = ωp cos 10 ω̂ ωp 1 (s + 1) s2 + s + 1 DC gain = 1 = (2k + 1) ω̂2 = ωp cos 3 π 10 = 0.59ωp ω̂3 = ωp cos 5 π 10 =0 5 cos−1 s 30⬚ 1 3 3 s + 0.5 − j (s + 1) s + 0.5 + j 2 2 = for ω < ωp . ω̌ ωp ∴ ω̌ = ωp cos T (s) = ω ωP Valleys are obtained when ω̌ =1 cos2 N cos−1 ωp jw 60⬚ 1 1 + 2 cos2 N cos−1 5 cos−1 For Amin to be exactly 30 dB, we need 10 log 1 + 2 × 1.522 = 30 1/3 wp ( e1 ) ⫽1 Peaks are obtained when ω̂ =0 cos2 N cos−1 ωp ω̂ cos2 5 cos−1 =0 ωp N = 10: LHS = 29.35 dB ⇒ 0.3654 ⇒ Amax = 20 log |T (jω)| = = kπ, k = 0, 1, 2 kπ , k = 0, 1, 2 5 ω̌1 = ωp cos 0 = ωp π = 0.81ωp 5 2π ω̌3 = ωp cos = 0.31ωp 5 ω̌2 = ωp cos Ex: 13.9 Amax 10 0.5 − 1 = 10 10 − 1 = 0.3493 ωs A(ωs ) = 10 log 1 + 2 cosh2 N cosh−1 ωp 2 −1 2 = 10 log 1 + 0.3493 cosh 7 cosh 2 = 10 = 64.9 dB Exercise 13–3 For Amax = 1 dB, = 100.1 − 1 = 0.5088 A (ωs ) = 10 log 1 + 0.50882 cosh2 7 cosh−1 2 = 68.2 dB This is an increase of 3.3 dB Ex: 13.10 = 10 1 10 Ex: 13.12 Refer to Fig. 13.14. 1 = 103 rad/s CR For R arbitrarily selected to be 10 k, ω0 = C= 1 = 0.1 μF 103 × 104 The two resistors labeled R1 can also be selected to be a convenient value, say 10 k each. − 1 = 0.5088 (a) For the Chebyshev filter: Ex: 13.13 T (s) = A (ωs ) = 10 log 1 + 0.50882 cosh2 N cosh−1 1.5 √ For maximally flat response, Q = 1/ 2, thus ≥ 50 dB T (s) = N = 7.4 ∴ choose N = 8 (b) For a Butterworth filter = 2N ωs ωp A(ωs ) = 10 log 1 + 2 ω02 (ω02 − ω2 ) √ + j 2 ωω0 ω02 |T (jω)| = = 55 − 50 = 5 dB ω2 √ 0 s2 + s 2 ω0 + ω02 T (jω) = Excess attenuation = 10 log 1 + 0.50882 cosh2 8 cosh−1 1.5 − 50 = 0.5088 ω02 ω0 + ω02 s2 + s Q (ω02 − ω2 )2 + 2ω2 ω02 ω02 ω04 + ω4 1 = ω ω0 1+ 4 ˙ 2 (1.5)2N ≥ 50 = 10 log 1 + 0.5088 At ω = ω0 , N = 15.9 ∴ choose N = 16 1 1 |T (jω0 )| = √ = √ 1+1 2 Excess attenuation = ˙ 2 (1.5)32 − 50 = 0.5 dB 10 log 1 + 0.5088 which is 3 dB below the value at ω = 0 (0 dB). Q.E.D. ω0 Q Ex: 13.14 T (s) = ω0 s2 + s + ω02 Q sK Ex: 13.11 R2 R1 C ⫺ ⫹ Vi Vo where K is the center-frequency gain. For ω0 = 105 rad/s and 3-dB bandwidth = 103 rad/s, we have ω0 3-dB BW = Q 103 = 104 = 1 , R1 = 10 k CR 1 C = 0.01 μF 105 Q ⇒ Q = 100 Also, for a center-frequency gain of 10, we have K = 10 −R2 H.F. gain = = −10 R1 Thus, R2 = 100 k T (s) = s2 104 s + 103 s + 1010 Exercise 13–4 Ex: 13.15 (a) T (s) = a2 ω02 |T (jω)| = |a2 | s2 + ω02 ω0 s2 + s + ω02 Q −ω 1+ Q= ω2 ω02 Q2 ω2 ω02 Q2 (ω02 − ω2 )2 (1) a2 v1 v0 v2 √ ω0 BWa 103/10 − 1 ω0 Q.E.D. ⇒ BWa = Q 2 (ω02 − ω2 )2 + = |a2 | (b) For A = 3 dB we have v Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1 and note that at any value of |T | there are two frequencies, ω1 and ω2 , with this gain value. From Eq. (1) we obtain Ex: 13.16 From Fig. 13.16(e) we have ωn 2 1 ω0 (1 − 2Q2 ) − 1 ωmax = 1 ωn 2 + −1 ω0 2Q2 1.2 2 1 −1 1− 1 2 × 100 = 1 1.2 2 + −1 1 2 × 100 = 0.986 rad/s 2 |a2 | |ωn2 − ωmax | Tmax = 2 )2 + (ω02 − ωmax DC gain = |a2 | ω1 ω22 − ω1 ω02 = ω2 ω02 − ω12 ω2 Thus, ω1 ω2 (ω1 + ω2 ) = (ω1 + ω2 )ω02 Tmax = ⇒ ω1 ω2 = 2 ωmax ωn2 =1 ω02 1 = 0.694 1.44 ⇒ |a2 | = 0.694 |1.44 − 0.972| (1 − Q.E.D. Now if ω1 and ω2 differ by BWa , 2 where ω2 ω2 ω12 ω02 = 2 22 0 2 2 2 2 2 2 Q (ω0 − ω1 ) Q (ω2 − ω0 ) ω1 ω2 ⇒ 2 = 2 ω0 − ω12 ω2 − ω02 ω02 ω0 Q 0.972)2 = 3.17 1 + × 0.972 100 HF transmission = |a2 | = 0.694 ω2 − ω1 = BWa and if the attenuation over this band of frequencies is to be greater than A dB, then by using Eq. (1) we have ω2 ω2 10 log10 1 + 2 0 21 2 2 ≥ A (ω0 − ω1 ) Q ω1 ω0 ≥ 10A/10 − 1 (ω02 − ω12 )Q ω1 ω0 1 ≥ Q (ω1 ω2 − ω12 ) ω0 1 ≥ Q ω2 − ω1 1 ω0 ≥ Q BWa Q≤ 10A/10 − 1 √ BWa 10A/10 − 1 1 ⇒Q= √ 2 ω0 = 2π × 100 × 103 Arbitrarily selecting R = 1 k, we get 1 Q = ω0 CR ⇒ C = √ 2 × 2π 105 × 103 = 1125 pF L 10A/10 − 1 10A/10 − 1 ω0 Ex: 13.17 Maximally flat ⫹ Vi ⫺ ⫹ C R Vo ⫺ Exercise 13–5 Also Q = R ω0 L R ∴L= = ω0 Q The circuit consists of 3 sections in cascade: 103 1 2π105 × √ 2 (a) First-order section: = 2.25 mH R2 Ex: 13.18 ⫹ Vi C R1 L ⫺ ⫹ ⫹ R C ⫺ Vo ⫺ T (s) = From Exercise 13.15 above, 3-dB bandwidth = ω0 /Q −0.2895ωp s + 0.2895ωp 2π10 = 2π60/Q ⇒ Q = 6 where the numerator coefficient is set so that the dc gain = −1. Q = ω0 CR Let R1 = 10 k 6 = 2π60 × C × 104 ⇒ C = 1.6 μF dc gain = R2 /R1 = 1 = R2 = 10 k R Q= ω0 L ω0 = 0.2895ωp R 104 L= = = 4.42 H ω0 Q 2π60 × 6 Ex: 13.19 f0 = 10 kHz, f3dB = 500 Hz f 104 Q= = 20 = f3dB 500 1 = 0.2895ωp CR2 ⇒C= (b) Second-order section with transfer function: T (s) = Using the data at the top of Table 13.1, we get C4 = C6 = 1.2 nF R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = 1 ω0 C 1 = 5.5 nF 0.2895 × 2π104 × 104 s2 0.4293ω2P + s0.4684ωp + 0.4293ω2P where the numerator coefficient is selected to yield a dc gain of unity. 1 = 13.26 k 2π104 × 1.2 × 10−9 20 R6 = Q/ω0 C = = 265 k 4 2π10 × 1.2 × 10−9 Now using the data in Table 13.1 for the bandpass case, we obtain = K = center-frequency gain = 10 Referring to Fig. 13.21(c), we have 1 + r2 /r1 = 10 Selecting r1 = 10 k, we obtain r2 = 90 k. Ex: 13.20 From Eq. (13.25), we have ωp = 2π104 and T (s) = ωp 5 × 8.1408 s + 0.2895ωp 1 × s2 + s0.4684ωp + 0.4293ωp 2 1 s2 + s0.1789ωp + 0.9883ωp 2 Select R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = 10 k ⇒C= √ 1 0.4293 × 2π104 × 104 = 2.43 nF C4 = C6 = C = 2.43 nF √ 0.4293ωp Q = 14 k = 1.4 ⇒ R6 = Q= 0.4684ωp ω0 C (c) Second-order section with transfer function: T (s) = 0.9883ω2 p s2 + s0.1789ωp + 0.9883ω2 p Exercise 13–6 The circuit is similar to that in (b) above but with R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = 10 k 1 C4 = C6 = ω0 × 104 1 = √ 0.9883 × 2π104 × 104 = 1.6 nF √ 0.9883 Q= = 5.56 0.1789 Thus R6 = Q/ω0 C = 55.6 k given C = l nF, RL = 10 k, then R= 1 1 = = 31.83 k ω0 C 2π5 × 103 × 10−9 R1 = 10 k ⇒ Rf = 10 k R2 = 10 k ⇒ R3 = R2 (2Q − 1) = 10 (10 − 1) = 90 k Placing the three sections in cascade, i.e. connecting the output of the first-order section to the input of the second-order section in (b) and the output of of section (b) to the input of (c) results in the overall transfer function in Eq. (13.25) except for an inversion. Ex: 13.21 Refer to the KHN circuit in Fig. 13.24. Choosing C = l nF, we obtain 1 1 R= = = 15.9 k 4 ω0 C 2π10 × 10−9 Using Eq. (13.62) and selecting R1 = 10 k, we get Rf = R1 = 10 k Using Eq. (13.63) and setting R2 = 10 k, we obtain R3 = R2 (2Q − 1) = 10 (2 × 2 − 1) = 30 k 1 = 1.5 V/V High-frequency gain = K = 2 − Q The transfer function to the output of the first integrator is Vhp Vbp 1 sK/ (CR) × =− = ω0 Vi sCR Vi 2 + ω20 s +s Q Thus the center-frequency gain is given by K Q = KQ = 1.5 × 2 = 3 V/V CR ω0 RH 2 8 ω = ω2n ⇒ RH = 10 RL 0 5 DC gain = K RF = R1 Rf ⫺ ⫹ C R R2 C R ⫺ ⫹ ⫺ ⫹ CR = ⫺ ⫹ RF =3 RL 3 × 10 = 16.7 k 2 − 1/5 1 1 ⇒C= = 1.59 nF ω0 2π104 × 104 Rd = QR = 20 × 10 = 200 k Center frequency gain = KQ = 1 ∴K = 1 1 = Q 20 Rg = R/K = 20R = 200 k Ex: 13.24 Refer to Fig. 13.26 and Table 13.2 (AP entry). C = 10 nF 1 1 = 10 k = 4 R= ω0 C 10 × 10 × 10−9 QR = 5 × 10 = 50 k C1 = C × flat gain = 10 × 1 = 10 nF R1 = ∞ R = R/1 = 10 k gain r = 10 k 5 × 10 Qr = = 50 k R3 = gain 1 CR = RF RH = 25.6 k Ex: 13.25 From Eq. (13.76) we have RL R3 1 RF = 2− RL Q 2 Ex: 13.23 Refer to Fig. 13.25 (b) R2 = Ex: 13.22 Vi Vo (RF /RH ) s2 + (RF /RL ) ω2 0 = −K Vi s2 + sω0 /Q + ω20 2×1 2Q = = 2 × 10−4 s ω0 104 For C = C1 = C2 = l nF Vo 2 × 10−4 = 200 k 10−9 Thus R3 = 200 k R= Exercise 13–7 Ex: 13.28 From Eq. (13.75) we have m = 4Q2 = 4 ⫺ ⫹ ⫹ 200 R = = 50 k m 4 ⫺ 0 Ex: 13.26 The transfer function of the feedback network is given in Fig. 13.28(a). The poles are the roots of the denominator polynomial, 1 1 1 1 s +s + + =0 + C1 R3 C2 R3 C1 R4 C1 C2 R3 R4 sC3Vo 2 1 + −9 5 10 × 5 × 104 × 2 × 10 R1 + Figure 1 =0 10−18 1010 s2 + s 3 × 104 + 108 = 0 s= C3 ⫺ 1 C4 Vi R4 = 5 × 104 , 10 X sC3Vo For C1 = C2 = 10−9 F, R3 = 2 × 105 , −9 R2 Vo 2 s2 + s Vo ⫹ Thus, R4 = −3 × 104 ± 9 × 108 − 4 × 108 2 = −0.382 × 104 and −2.618 × 104 rad/s Figure 1 shows the circuit of Fig. 13.34(c) with partial analysis to determine the transfer function. The voltage at node X can be written as Vx = Vo + sC3 Vo R2 = (1 + sC3 R2 )Vo (1) Now a node equation at X takes the form Ex: 13.27 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 13.30(a), where the transfer function is given on page 1126 as −s(α/C1 R4 ) T (s) = 1 1 1 1 s2 + s + + C1 C2 R3 C1 C2 R3 R4 Now, using the component value obtained in Exercise 13.25, namely C1 = C2 = 1 nF R3 = 200 k R4 = 50 k the center-frequency gain is given by (note that Q = 1) R3 C1 |T (jωa )| = α 1+ R4 C2 1=α× 4 = 2α 1+1 Vi − Vx = sC3 Vo + sC4 (Vx − Vo ) R1 Substituting for Vx from Eq. (1) gives Vi − Vo (sC3 R2 + 1) = sC3 R1 Vo + sC4 R1 (sC3 R2 Vo ) Vi = Vo [s2 C3 C4 R1 R2 + sC3 (R1 + R2 ) + 1] ⇒ Vo = Vi 1 s2 + s C4 1/C3 C4 R1 R2 1 1 1 + + R1 R2 C3 C4 R1 R2 Thus, ω0 = 1/ C3 C4 R1 R2 and Q= √ C3 C4 R1 R2 C4 1 1 + R1 R2 −1 which are identical to Eqs. (13.77) and (13.78), respectively. Q.E.D. ⇒ α = 0.5 From Eq. (2) we see that Thus, Vo (0) = 1 Vi 50 R4 = = 100 k α 0.5 (2) Q.E.D. and Ex: 13.29 The design equations are Eqs. (13.79) and (13.80). Thus, 50 R4 = = 100 k 1−α 0.5 R1 = R2 = R = 10 k Exercise 13–8 and Using Eq. (13.99), we obtain C4 = C Gm = ω0 C = 2π × 20 × 106 × 2 × 10−12 C3 = C/4Q2 = C 4× 1 2 = 0.5C where 1 2× √ 2Q 2 = CR = ω0 2π × 4 × 103 √ 2 ⇒C= = 5.63 nF 2π × 4 × 103 × 10 × 103 = 0.251 mA/V Thus, Gm1 = Gm2 = 0.251 mA/V Gm3 = 0.251 Gm = √ = 0.355 mA/V Q 1/ 2 Gm4 = Gm | Gain | = Gm = 0.251 mA/V Thus, Ex: 13.32 From Eq. (13.109) C4 = 5.63 nF C3 = C4 = ω0 Tc C C3 = 2.81 nF = 2π 104 × Ex: 13.30 Refer to the results in Example 13.3 = 6.283 pF (a) R3 /R3 = +2% From Eq. (13.112) ωo = −1/2 ⇒ SR3 Q SR3 = ωO 1 = − × 2 = −1% ωO 2 1 1 ⇒ Q/Q = × 2 = 1% 2 2 (b) R4 /R4 = 2% SRω4o = − Q SR4 = − C5 = 1 × 20 200 × 103 6.283 C4 = = 0.314 pF Q 20 From Eq. (13.113) Centre-frequency gain = 1 ωO = −1% ⇒ 2 ωO C6 = C5 = 0.314 pF 1 Q 1 ⇒ = − × 2 = −1% 2 Q 2 Ex: 13.33 Rp = ω0 LQ0 (c) Combining the results in (a) & (b), we get ωO = −1 − 1 = −2% ωO Q = 1 − 1 = 0% Q (d) Using the results in (c) for both resistors being 2% high, we have = 2π106 × 3.18 × 10−6 × 150 = 3 k R = RL ro Rin ) /ω0 L 103 103 = 35 2π × 455 × 103 × 5 × 10−6 = BW = f0 /Q = 455/35 = 13 kHz C1 + Cin = −1 1 = − (−2) + (−2) − 2 2 2 = Q Q C1 Q C2 = SC1 + SC2 +0 Q C C2 Rp = 2 k ⇒ RL = 15 k Ex: 13.34 Q = (R1 ωO ωo C1 ωo C2 = SC1 + SC2 −2 ωO C1 C2 = 2 − 2 = 0% C6 =1 C5 1 ω20 L 1 2π × 455 × 103 2 × 5 × 10−6 = 24.47 nF C1 = 24.47 − 0.2 = 24.27 nF = 0 (−2) + (0) (−2) + 0 = 0% Ex: 13.35 To just meet specifications, Ex: 13.31 f0 = f3dB = 20 MHz √ Q = 1/ 2 Q= DC gain = 1 ∴ R1 455 f0 = = 45.5 BW 10 n2 Rin = 45.5 ω0 L Exercise 13–9 R1 n2 Rin = 45.5 × 2π × 455 × 103 × 5 × 10−6 = 650 n2 Rin = 1.86 k 1.86 = 1.36 n= 1 C1 + Cin 1 = 2 = 24.47 nF 2 n ω0 L Ex: 13.36 200 = (f0 /Q) 21/2 − 1 Eq. (13.123) f0 = 310.8 kHz Q C= 1 1 = 2 ω20 L 2π × 10.7 × 106 × 3 × 10−6 = 73.75 pF C1 = 24.36 nF 1 ωO = Q CR At resonance, the voltage developed across R1 is I R1 n2 Rin = IR. Thus, Vbe = IR/n & Ic = gm Vbe = gm IR/n, R= 40 × 0.65 A Ic = gm R/n = = 19.1 I 1.36 A 73.7 × 10 = 6.94 k −12 1 × 2π × 310.8 × 103 Chapter 13–1 13.1 T (s) = |T (jω)| = ω0 ω0 , T (jω) = s + ω0 jω + ω0 ω0 ω20 + ω2 φ (ω) ≡ tan−1 = −tan −1 1 = 1+ Im (T (jω)) Re (T (jω)) ω ω0 2 Peak amplitude of output sinusoid = 0.707 V Phase of output relative to that of input = −45◦ . (c) f = 100 kHz ω = 2π × 105 rad/s √ |T | = 1/ 1 + 100 0.1 V/V φ = −tan−1 (10) = −84.3◦ (ω/ωO ) Peak amplitude of output sinusoid = 0.1 V G = 20 log10 |T (jω)| Phase of output relative to that of input = −84.3◦ . A = −20 log10 |T (jω)| (d) f = 1 MHz ω = 2π × 106 rad/s |T | = 1/ 1 + 104 = 0.01 V/V ω |T (jω)| [V/V] G [dB] 0 1 0 0 0 0.5ω0 0.8944 –0.97 0.97 –26.57 Peak amplitude of output sinusoid = 0.01 V ω0 0.7071 –3.01 3.01 –45.0 2ω0 0.4472 –6.99 6.99 –63.43 Phase of output relative to that of input = −89.4◦ . 5ω0 0.1961 –14.1 14.1 –78.69 10ω0 0.0995 –20.0 20.0 –84.29 100ω0 0.010 –40.0 40.0 –89.43 A φ [dB] [degrees] φ = −tan−1 (100) = −89.4◦ 13.3 T (s) = = 1 (s + 1) s2 + s + 1 1 s3 + 2s2 + 2s + 1 T (jω) = j 2ω − ω3 + 1 − 2ω2 13.2 T (s) = T (jω) = 2π × 104 s + 2π × 104 |T (jω)| = 2π × 104 2π × 104 + jω 1 1 + j[ω/2π × 104 ] 1+ |T (jω)| = 1 2 + 1 − 2ω2 1 2 −2 = 4ω2 − 4ω4 + ω6 + 1 − 4ω2 + 4ω4 = 1 + ω6 = ω 2π × 104 −1 2ω − ω3 −1 2 φ(ω) = −tan (ω/2π × 10 ) 4 (a) f = 1 kHz ω = 2π × 103 rad/s √ |T | = 1/ 1 + 0.01 0.995 V/V φ = −tan−1 (0.1) = −5.7◦ Peak amplitude of output sinusoid = 0.995 V Phase of output relative to that of input = −5.7◦ . = √ − − 1 2 1 2 1 Q.E.D. 1 + ω6 For phase angle: Im (T (jω)) φ(ω) = tan−1 Re (T (jω)) 2ω − ω3 = − tan−1 1 − 2ω2 For ω = 0.1 rad/s: |T (jω)| = 1 + 0.16 −1/2 1 ◦ φ (ω) = −11.5 = −0.20 rad For ω = 1 rad/s: ω = 2π × 104 rad/s √ |T | = 1/ 2 = 0.707 V/V √ −1/2 |T (jω)| = 1 + 16 = 1/ 2 = 0.707 1 = −135◦ = −2.356 rad φ = −tan−1 −1 φ = −tan−1 (1) = −45◦ Note: G = –3 dB (b) f = 10 kHz Chapter 13–2 For ω = 10 rad/s: 13.6 6 −1/2 |T (jω)| = 1 + 10 = 0.001 3 −1 2 (10) − 10 φ = −tan 1 − 2 102 −980 = −tan−1 −199 980 = − 180◦ + tan−1 199 = −258.5◦ = −4.512 rad Figure 1 Now consider an input of A sin ωt to T(s). The output is then given by A |T (jω)| sin (ωt + φ (ω)) Refer to Fig. 1. Using this result, the output to each of the following inputs will be: T (s) = 2π × 104 s + 2π × 104 T (jω) = INPUT OUTPUT 10 sin(0.1t) 10 sin(0.1t –0.2) 10 sin(1t) 7.07 sin(t − 2.356) 10 sin(10t) 0.01 sin(10t − 4.512) 1 ω 2π × 104 f 2 |T | = 1 1+ 104 1+j At f = fp = 5 kHz, we have 2 5 × 103 1+ = 0.894 |T | = 1 104 13.4 Refer to Fig. 13.3. Thus, Amax = 20 log 1.05 = 0.42 dB 1 Amin = 20 log 0.0005 Amax = −20 log 0.894 = 0.97 dB = 66 dB Selectivity factor ≡ = fs fp 5 = 1.25 4 At f = fs = 10 fp = 50 kHz, we have 2 50 × 103 1+ = 0.196 |T | = 1 104 1 Amin = 20 log = 14.15 dB 0.196 13.7 See Fig. 1. 13.5 At ω = 0, we have 20 log |T | = 0 dB ⇒ |T | = 1 V/V At ω = ωp , we have 20 log|T | = −Amax = −0.2 dB ⇒ |T | = 0.977 V/V At ω = ωs , we have 20 log|T | = −Amin = −60 dB ⇒ |T | = 0.001 V/V Figure 1 Chapter 13–3 This pole pair gives rise to a factor 13.8 See Fig. 1. = (s + 0.809 × 104 + j 0.588 × 104 )(s + 0.809 × 104 − j0.588 × 104 ) = (s2 + 1.618 × 104 s + 108 ) Thus the denominator polynomial of T (s) is D(s) = (s + 104 )(s + 0.618 × 104 s + 108 )(s2 + 1.618 × 104 s + 108 ) (a) The filter is a low-pass of the all-pole type, T (s) = Figure 1 k (s + 104 )(s2 + 0.618 × 104 s + 108 ) × (s2 + 1.618 × 104 s + 108 ) Since the dc gain is unity, we have k = 1020 13.9 Thus, T (s) = 1020 (s + 10 )(s + 0.618 × 104 s + 108 ) × (s2 + 1.618 × 104 s + 108 ) 4 2 (b) The filter is a high pass, T (s) = ks5 (s + 104 )(s2 + 0.618 × 104 s + 108 ) × (s2 + 1.618 × 104 s + 108 ) Since the high-frequency (s → ∞) gain is unity, k must be unity, thus T (s) = s5 (s + 10 )(s + 0.618 × 104 s + 108 ) × (s2 + 1.618 × 104 s + 108 ) 13.10 T (s) = Figure 1 s = −104 sin 18◦ ± j104 cos 18◦ = −0.309 × 104 ± j0.951 × 104 This pole pair gives rise to a factor = (s + 0.309 × 104 + j 0.951 × 104 )(s + 0.309 × 104 − j0.951 × 104 ) = s2 + 0.618 × 104 s + 108 The pair of complex conjugate poles p2 and are at ◦ ◦ s = −10 sin 54 ± j10 cos 54 4 4 = −0.809 × 104 ± j0.588 × 104 p2∗ 2 k(s2 + 4) (s + 0.25 + j)(s + 0.25 − j) k(s2 + 4) + 0.5s + 1.0625 4k =1 T (0) = 1.0625 1.0625 = 0.2656 ⇒k= 4 0.2656(s2 + 4) T (s) = 2 s + 0.5s + 1.0625 T (∞) = 0.2656 = Figure 1 shows the location of the five poles in the s plane. The real-axis pole at s = −104 gives rise to a factor (s + 104 ). The pair of conjugate poles p1 and p1∗ are at 4 s2 13.11 T (s) = k(s2 + 4) (s + 1)(s + 0.5 − j 0.8) × (s + 0.5 − j 0.8) = k(s2 + 4) (s + 1)(s2 + s + 0.89) 4k =1 0.89 0.89 = 0.2225 ⇒k= 4 T (0) = Chapter 13–4 I6 = I3 + I5 = (s + 1)Vo + s(s2 + s + 1)Vo Thus, T (s) = 0.2225(s2 + 4) (s + 1)(s + s + 0.89) Vi = V4 + I6 × 1 = (s2 + s + 1)Vo + (s3 + s2 + 2s + 1)Vo 13.12 T (s) = = (s3 + s2 + 2s + 1)Vo s6 s(s2 + 106 )(s2 + 9 × 106 ) + b5 s5 + b4 s4 + b3 s2 + b1 s + b0 = (s3 + 2s2 + 3s + 2)Vo Vo (s) 1 = 3 Vi (s) s + 2s2 + 3s + 2 Note that we started with the numerator factors (which represent the given transmission zeros). We used the fact that there is one transmission zero at s = ∞ to write the denominator sixth-order polynomial. Thus, N =6 A sketch of the magnitude response, |T |, is given in Fig. 1. All the transmission zeros are at s = ∞. To find the poles, we have to factor the third-order denominator polynomial. Toward this end, we find by inspection that one of the zeros of the denominator polynomial is at s = −1. Thus, the polynomial will have a factor (s + 1) and can be written as s3 + 2s2 + 3s + 2 = (s + 1)(s2 + as + b) where by equating corresponding terms on both sides we find that |T| b=2 a+1=2⇒a =1 Thus, s3 + 2s2 + 3s + 2 = (s + 1)(s2 + s + 2) and the poles are at 0 1 v, krad/s 2 3 Figure 1 s = −1 and at the roots of s2 + s + 2 = 0 13.13 which are 1 I6 I5 1F Vi 1H V4 I2 1F √ 1−8 s= 2 √ = −0.5 ± j 7/2 −1 ± I3 I1 Vo 1 = −0.5 ± j1.323 Figure 1 13.14 Amax = 0.5 dB, Amin ≥ 20 dB, Refer to Fig. 1. Vo = Vo I1 = 1 I2 = sCVo = s × 1 × Vo = sVo Using Eq. (13.14), we obtain = 10Amax /10 − 1 = 100.05 − 1 = 0.3493 I3 = I1 + I2 = (s + 1)Vo Using Eq. (13.15), we have V4 = Vo + sLI3 A(ωs ) = 10 log[1 + 2 (ωs /ωp )2N ] = Vo + s × 1(s + 1)Vo = 10 log[1 + 0.34932 × 1.72N ] = (s2 + s + 1)Vo For N = 5, A(ωs ) = 14.08 dB I5 = s × 1 × V4 For N = 6, A(ωs ) = 18.58 dB = s(s + s + 1)Vo For N = 7, A(ωs ) = 23.15 dB 2 ωs = 1.7 ωp Chapter 13–5 Thus, to meet the As ≥ 20 dB specification, we use For the case N = 7, A = 10 log(1 + 1.814 ) = 35.7 dB N =7 in which case the actual minimum stopband attenuation realized is 13.17 Amax = 0.5 dB, N = 5, ωp = 103 rad/s Amin = 23.15 dB Using Eq. (13.14), we obtain = 10Amax /10 − 1 = 100.05 − 1 If Amin is to be exactly 20 dB, we can use Eq. (13.15) to obtain the new value of as follows: = 0.3493 20 = 10 log[1 + 2 × 1.714 ] 100 − 1 = 0.2425 = 1.714 Now, using Eq. (13.13) we can determine the value to which Amax can be reduced as Amax = 20 log 1 + 2 Amax = 20 log 1 + 0.24252 = 0.25 dB 13.15 Using Eq. (13.15), we have A(ωs ) = 10 log[1 + 2 (ωs /ωp )2N ] For large A(ωs ), we can neglect the unity term in this expression to obtain A(ωs ) 10 log [ 2 (ωs /ωp )2N ] Substituting A(ωs ) ≥ Amin we obtain The natural modes can be determined by reference to Fig. 13.10(a): 1/N 1 ω0 = ωp 1/5 1 3 ω0 = 10 × 0.3493 = 1.234 × 103 rad/s π π ± jcos p1 , p1∗ = ω0 sin 10 10 = ω0 (−0.309 ± j0.951) = 1.234 × 103 (0.309 ± j0.951) 3π 3π ± jcos p2 , p2∗ = ω0 −sin 10 10 = 1.234 × 103 (−0.809 ± j0.588) p3 = −ω0 = −1.234 × 103 13.18 20 log + 20N log(ωs /ωp ) ≥ Amin ⇒N ≥ Amin − 20 log 20 log(ωs /ωp ) Q.E.D. 13.16 For an N th-order Butterworth filter, we have from Eq. (13.11) 1 |T (jω)| = 1 + 2 ω ωp 2N At the 3-dB frequency ω3 dB we have: 1/2N ω3 dB 2N 1 = 1 ⇒ ω3 dB = 2 ωp . Thus, ωp 2 from Eq. (13.15) the attenuation at ω = 1.8ω3 dB is: 1.8ω3 dB 2N 2 A = 10 log 1 + ωp = 10 log 1 + 2 1 1.8 2 = 10 log(1 + 1.82N ) 1/2N 2N Figure 1 Chapter 13–6 (a) See previous page: Fig. 1(a). 13.20 (b) See previous page: Fig. 1(b). 13.19 fp = 10 kHz, Amax = 3 dB, fs = 20 kHz, Amin = 20 dB Using Eq. (13.14), we obtain = 10Amax /10 − 1 = 103/10 − 1 = 1 Using Eq. (13.15), we have A(ωs ) = 10 log[1 + 2 (ωs /ωp )2N ] Thus, Figure 1 Amin ≥ 10 log[1 + 2 (ωs /ωp )2N ] 20 ≥ 10 log (1 + 22N ) For N = 3, 10 log(1 + 26 ) = 18.1 dB For N = 4, From Fig. 1 we see that at the stopband edge, ωs , the Chebyshev filter provides A(dB) greater attentuation than the Butterworth filter of the same order and having the same Amax . 10 log(1 + 28 ) = 24.1 dB 13.21 N = 7, ωp = 1 rad/s, Amax = 0.5 dB Thus, N =4 The poles can be determined by reference to Fig. 13.10(a): 1/4 1 ω0 = ωp = ωp = 2π × 104 rad/s 1 π π ± jcos p1 , p1∗ = ω0 −sin 8 8 = 2π × 104 (−0.383 ± j0.924) 3π 3π ± jcos p2 , p2∗ = ω0 −sin 8 8 = 2π × 104 (−0.924 ± j0.383) Thus, T (s) = (s2 + 0.765ω0 s + ω04 2 ω0 )(s2 + 1.848ω0 s + ω02 ) where ω0 = 2π × 104 and where we have assumed the dc gain to be unity. Using Eq. (13.11), we obtain |T (jω)| = 1+ 1 ω ωp 8 At f = 30 kHz = 3 fp , the attenuation is A = −20 log|T | = 10 log(1 + 38 ) = 38.2 dB Using Eq. (13.21), we obtain = 10Amax /10 − 1 = 10 0.05 − 1 = 0.3439 From Eq. (13.18), we have |T (jω)| = 1 1+ 2 cos2 [N cos−1 (ω/ωp )] 1 = 1 + 2 cos2 (7 cos−1 ω) (1) |T (jω)| will be equal to unity at the values of ω that make cos(7 cos−1 ω) = 0 (2) Since the cosine function is 0 for angles that are odd multiples of π/2, the solutions to Eq. (2) are π 7 cos−1 ωk = (2k + 1) 2 where k = 0, 1, 2, .... Thus, (2k + 1)π 14 We now can compute the values of ωk as π = 0.975 rad/s ω1 = cos 14 3π = 0.782 rad/s ω2 = cos 14 ωk = cos Chapter 13–7 5π = 0.434 rad/s 14 7π = 0 rad/s ω4 = cos 14 Next, we determine the passband frequencies at which maximum deviation from 0 dB occurs. From Eq. (1) we see that these are the values of ω that make ω3 = cos −1 cos (7 cos ω) = 1 2 (3) Since the magnitude of the cosine function is unity for angles that are multiples of π, the solutions to Eq. (3) are given by Finally, we note that since this is a 7th-order all-pole filter, for s → ∞, T will be proportional to 1/s7 ; that is, |T | will be proportional to 1/ω7 , thus the asymptotic response will be 7 × 6 = 42 dB/octave. 13.22 Amax = 1 dB ⇒ = 101/10 − 1 = 0.5088 fp = 3.4 kHz, fs = 4 kHz ⇒ fs = 1.176 fp Amin = 35 dB 7 cos−1 ωm = mπ (a) To obtain the required order N , we use Eq. (13.22), or A(ωs ) = 10 log[1 + 2 cosh2 (N cosh−1 (ωs /ωp )] mπ ωm = cos 7 where Thus, 10 log[1 + 0.50882 cosh2 (N cosh−1 1.176)] ≥ 35 m = 0, 1, 2, .... We attempt various values for N as follows: We now can compute the values of ωm as N A(ωs ) 8 28.8 dB 9 33.9 dB ω0 = cos0 = 1 rad/s π ω1 = cos = 0.901 rad/s 7 2π = 0.623 rad/s ω2 = cos 7 3π = 0.223 rad/s ω3 = cos 7 10 39.0 dB Use N = 10. Excess attenuation = 39 − 35 = 4 dB (b) The poles can be determined using Eq. (13.23), namely 2k − 1 π 1 1 sinh sinh−1 pk /ωp = −sin N 2 N 2k − 1 π 1 1 +j cos cosh sinh−1 N 2 N |T |, dB 0.434 0.782 0.975 0 0.5 0.223 0.623 0.900 k = 1, 2, ..., N 64.9 0 1 2 v, rad/s Figure 1 Figure 1 shows a sketch of |T | for this 7th-order Chebyshev filter, with the passband maxima and minima identified. Note that the frequencies of the maxima and minima do not depend on the value of Amax . First we determine 1 1 sinh−1 sinh N 1 1 sinh−1 = 0.1433 = sinh 10 0.5088 and 1 −1 1 sinh = 1.0102 cosh N Thus, = 64.9 dB π π + j1.0102 cos p1 /ωp = −0.1433 sin 20 20 = −0.0224 + j0.9978 3π 3π + j1.0102 cos p2 /ωp = −0.1433 sin 20 20 This point also is indicated on the sketch in Fig. 1. = −0.0651 + j0.9001 To determine the attenuation at the stopband frequency ω = 2 rad/s, we utilize the expression in Eq. (13.22), thus A(2) = 10 log[1 + 0.34932 cosh2 (7 cosh−1 2)] Chapter 13–8 5π 5π + j1.0102 cos p3 /ωp = −0.1433 sin 20 20 = −0.1013 + j0.7143 7π 7π p4 /ωp = −0.1433 sin + j1.0102 cos 20 20 = −0.1277 + j0.4586 9π 9π p5 /ωp = −0.1433 sin + j1.0102 cos 20 20 = −0.1415 + j0.1580 p6 = p5∗ , p7 = p4∗ , p8 = p3∗ , p9 = p2∗ , p10 = p1∗ Each pair of complex conjugate poles, pk , pk∗ = ωp (−k ± j k ) gives rise to a quadratic factor in the denominator of T (s) given by = 3.84 × 10−3 × (2π × 3.4 × 103 )10 = 7.60 × 1040 13.23 Refer to Fig. 13.13 (row a). Input resistance = R1 Thus, to obtain an input resistance of 12 k, we select R1 = 12 k |DC gain| = 10 = R2 R1 ⇒ R2 = 10 R1 = 120 k CR2 = ⇒C= 1 1 = ω0 2π × 5 × 103 1 = 265 pF 2π × 5 × 103 × 120 × 103 s2 + sωp (2k ) + ωp2 (k2 + 2k ) 13.24 Refer to Fig. 13.13 (row b). where H.F. Input resistance = R1 ωp = 2π × 3.4 × 10 rad/s Thus, Thus, we obtain for the five pole pairs: R1 = 120 k p1 , p1∗ : (s2 + s 0.0448ωp + 0.9961ωp2 ) CR1 = 3 p2 , p2∗ : (s2 + s 0.1302ωp + 0.8144ωp2 ) p3 , p3∗ : (s2 + s 0.2026ωp + 0.5205ωp2 ) ⇒C= 1 1 = ω0 2π × 200 1 2π × 200 × 120 × 103 = 6.63 nF p4 , p4∗ : (s2 + s 0.2554ωp + 0.2266ωp2 ) High-frequency gain = − p5 , p5∗ : (s2 + s 0.2830ωp + 0.0450ωp2 ) ⇒ R2 = R1 = 120 k R2 = −1 R1 The transfer function T (s) can now be written as T (s) = B Product of five quadratic terms The value of B determines the required dc gain, specifically DC gain = B ωp10 × 0.9961 × 0.8144 × 0.5205 × 0.2266 × 0.0450 = B 4.31 × 10−3 ωp10 1 1 For DC gain = √ = √ 1 + 2 1 + 0.50882 = 0.891 we select B = 4.31 × 10−3 × ωp10 × 0.891 13.25 Refer to the op-amp-RC circuit in Fig. 13.13 (row c). Assuming an ideal op amp, we have Z2 (s) Vo =− T (s) = Vi Z1 (s) Since both Z1 and Z2 have a parallel structure, it is far more convenient to work in terms of Y1 (s) and Y2 (s), thus T (s) = − Y1 (s) Y2 (s) 1 + s C1 R1 =− 1 + s C2 R2 C1 =− C2 1 C1 R1 1 s+ C2 R2 s+ Chapter 13–9 Figure 1 shows a sketch of the magnitude of the transfer function. Note that the magnitude of the high-frequency gain is C1 /C2 = 100 or 40 dB. Thus, ωZ = 1 C1 R1 ωP = 1 C2 R2 DC gain = T (0) = − R2 R1 HF gain = T (∞) = − C1 C2 13.26 We use the op-amp-RC circuit of Fig. 13.13(c). Low-frequency input resistance = R1 Figure 1 Thus, R1 = 10 k DC gain = − 13.27 Figure 1 (below) shows the bandpass filter realized as the cascade of a first-order low-pass filter and a first-order high-pass filter. The component values are determined as follows: R2 = −1 R1 ⇒ R2 = R1 = 10 k 1 ωZ = 2π 2πC1 R1 fZ = 100 = To make Rin as large as possible while satisfying the constraint that no resistance is larger than 100 k, we select 1 2πC1 × 10 × 103 ⇒ C1 = fP = f0 = 1 = 0.16 μF 2π × 106 R1 = 100 k The low-frequency gain of the low-pass circuit is (−R2 /R1 ). With R1 = 100 k, the maximum gain obtained is unity and is achieved by selecting 1 2πC2 R2 10 × 103 = C2 = Rin = R1 1 2πC2 × 10 × 103 R2 = 100 k This implies that the required gain of 12 dB or 4 V/V must be all realized in the high-pass circuit. 1 = 1.6 nF 2π × 108 This figure belongs to Problem 13.27. R2 R4 Vi R1 C1 V1 Vi 0 dB R3 V1 20 dB/decade C2 Vo Vo V1 12 dB Vo 20 dB/decade Vi 12 dB 20 dB/decade 50 kHz f 50 Hz Figure 1 20 dB/ decade f 50 Hz 50 kHz f Chapter 13–10 The upper 3-dB frequency of the bandpass filter is the 3-dB frequency of the low-pass circuit, that is, 1 50 × 10 = 2πC1 R2 3 ⇒ C1 = 1 2π × 50 × 103 × 100 × 103 Thus, Vo sCR − 1 =− Vi sCR + 1 or s − ω0 s − 1/CR Vo =− =− T (s) = Vi s + 1/CR s + ω0 = 31.8 pF where Next, we consider the high-pass circuit. The high-frequency (f 50 Hz) gain of this circuit is (−R4 /R3 ). To obtain a gain of −4 V/V, we select ω0 = R4 = 100 k 100 = 25 k 4 The lower 3-dB frequency of the bandpass filter (50 Hz) is the 3-dB frequency of the high-pass circuit, thus R3 = 1 2πC2 R3 50 = ⇒ C2 = 1 2π × 50 × 25 × 103 = 0.127 μF R1 R1 R V I V C Vi T (jω) = − = ω0 − jω ω0 + jω 1 − j(ω/ω0 ) 1 + j(ω/ω0 ) 1 + (ω/ω0 )2 =1 |T (jω)| = 1 + (ω/ω0 )2 ω φ(ω) = −2 tan−1 ω0 1 ω = tan − φ(ω) ⇒ ω0 2 = Vo R= The results obtained are as follows: = Vi ω/ω0 0.268 0.577 1 1.732 3.732 ω0 (krad/s) 18.66 8.66 5 2.89 1.34 20 34.60 74.63 R (k) 1 sCR + 1 1 sCR + 1 Vi 1 Vi − V− = 1− I= R1 R1 sCR + 1 Vi sCR R1 sCR + 1 Vo = V− − IR1 = 5.36 11.55 1/sC R + (1/sC) 13.29 I V− = V+ = Vi = −30◦ −60◦ −90◦ −120◦ −150◦ φ Figure 1 V+ = Vi (1) 1 108 = ω0 × 10 × 10−9 ω0 Refer to Fig. 1. jω − ω0 jω + ω0 Thus, for a given phase shift φ, we can use Eq. (1) to determine (ω/ω0 ). For ω = 5 × 103 rad/s, we can then determine the required value of ω0 . Finally, for C = 10 nF, the required value for R can be found from 13.28 I 1 CR Vi sRCVi − sCR + 1 sCR + 1 I Vi R1 R1 C V V R Vo Figure 1 Chapter 13–11 Im Figure 1 (see previous page) shows the circuit of Fig. 13.14 with R and C interchanged. To determine the transfer function T (s) = Vo (s)/Vi (s), we analyze the circuit as follows: jv f fN R V+ = Vi 1 R+ sC s = Vi 1 s+ CR V− = V+ = Vi Vi R1 s s+ 1 CR ⎛ A graphical construction showing φN and φD and their difference φ is depicted in Fig. 2 above. ⎞ Observe that the difference, φ, is a positive angle whose value ranges from 180◦ (at ω = 0) to 0◦ (at ω = ∞). The two end points should also be obvious from T ( jω) which is −1 at ω = 0 and +1 at ω = 0. ⎟ 1 ⎠ s+ CR s 1/CR 1 s+ CR Vo = V− − IR1 ⎡ 13.30 Figure 1 shows a circuit composed of the cascade connection of two all-pass circuits of the type shown in Fig. 13.14. We require that each circuit provide −120◦ phase shift at ω = 2π × 60 rad/s. From the data in Fig. 13.14(a), ⎤ 1/CR ⎥ ⎢ = Vi ⎣ − 1 1 ⎦ s+ s+ CR CR s φ(ω) = −2 tan−1 (ωCR) Thus, T (s) = s − (1/CR) Vo (s) = Vi (s) s + (1/CR) Thus, −120◦ = −2 tan−1 (ωCR) s − ω0 = s + ω0 ωCR = tan 60◦ where 2π × 60 × 1 × 10−6 × R = ω0 = 1/CR T (jω) = Re v0 0 Figure 2 Vi ⎜ Vi − V− = I= ⎝1 − R1 R1 = fD v0 −ω0 + jω ω0 + jω R= √ 3 2 √ 3 = 2.3 k 2π × 60 × 10−6 × 2 φ(ω) = φN (ω) − φD (ω) The value of R1 can be selected arbitrarily, say where φN is the phase angle of the numerator and φD is the phase angle of the denominator. R1 = 10 k This figure belongs to Problem 13.30. R1 R1 R1 R1 V1 R C R V2 Figure 1 C V3 Chapter 13–12 (a) Butterworth filter: 13.31 Refer to Fig. 13.16(a). For a second-order Butterworth, we have √ Q = 1/ 2 = 0.707 and ω0 = ωp = 1 rad/s. The dc gain is unity. Thus, ω02 ω0 + ω02 s2 + s Q T (s) = 1 √ + 2s + 1 1 |T (jω)| = √ 1 + ω2N Thus, T (s) = 108 = 2 s + 5000 s + 108 1 ωmax = ω0 1 − 2Q2 = 10 4 |T (j2)| = √ 1 1− = 9354 rad/s 2×4 (b) Chebyshev filter: =1 |Tmax | = Q 1− 1 4Q2 = 2 1− 1 16 1 1 + 24 √ Amin = A(ωs ) = 20 log10 17 = 12.3 dB Since the dc gain is unity, we have |ao /ω02 | s2 For a second-order Chebyshev filter, the poles are given by Eq. (13.23), which for N = 2, ωp = 1, and = 1 yields π 1 sinh sinh−1 1 p1 , p1∗ = −sin 4 2 π 1 cosh sinh−1 1 ±j cos 4 2 = 2.066 13.32 There are many possibilities, but only two are optimal. The first is the Butterworth filter which exhibits maximum flatness of |T | at ω = 0. The second is the Chebyshev for which |T | exhibits equiripple response in the passband. = −0.3218 ± j0.7769 Thus, for this pair of complex-conjugate poles, we have ω0 = 2 × 0.3218 = 0.6436 Q See Figure 1 below. Figure 1(a) shows the second-order Butterworth filter that just meets the given passband specifications. Figure 1(b) shows the second-order Chebyshev filter that just meets the given passband specifications. Note that no stopband specifications were given (otherwise the problem would be overspecified); we are simply asked to calculate the attenuation at ωs = 2ωp = 2 rad/s. and ω02 = 0.32182 + 0.77692 = 0.7071 Thus, K s2 + 0.6436 s + 0.7071 From Fig. 1(b) we see that the dc gain is 1/ 1 + 2 = 0.7071 T (s) = For both filters, since Amax = 3 dB, we have Thus, K = 0.7071 × 0.707 = 0.5 =1 This figure belongs to Problem 13.32. Figure 1 Chapter 13–13 and 0.5 s2 + 0.6436 s + 0.7071 At s = j2, we have T (s) = 0.5 |T (j2)| = (0.7071 − 4)2 + (0.6436 × 2)2 = 0.1414 Amin = A(2) = −20 log 0.1414 = 17.0 dB 13.33 Refer to Fig. 13.16(b). For a maximally flat response, we have √ Q = 1/ 2 and −ω0 1 Poles are at ± jω0 1 − 2Q 4Q2 π 1 3 4 = − × 10 ± j2π × 10 1 − 2 4 × 202 π = × 103 [−1 ± j40 × 0.9997] 2 = 1.57 × 103 (−1 ± j39.988) Zeros are at s = 0 and s = ∞. 13.35 (a) A second-order bandpass filter with a center-frequency gain of unity (arbitrary) has the transfer function T (s) = s(ω0 /Q) s2 + s(ω0 /Q) + ω02 ω3dB = ω0 Thus, Thus, ωω0 /Q |T (jω)| = (ω02 − ω2 ) + (ωω0 /Q)2 (ω2 − ω2 )2 = 1/ 1 + Q2 0 2 2 ω ω0 ω0 = 1 rad/s If the high-frequency gain is unity, then we have a2 = 1 (1) and s2 √ s2 + 2 s + 1 The two zeros are at s = 0. The poles are complex conjugate and given by ω0 1 ± jω0 s=− 1− 2Q 4Q2 T (s) = ⎞ !⎛ ! ! 1 ⎟ 1 ⎜ ±j ! =− "⎝1 − 1 1⎠ 2× √ 4× 2 2 1 1 = −√ ± j√ 2 2 = −0.707 ± j0.707 13.34 f0 = 10 kHz ⇒ ω0 = 2π × 104 rad/s f0 BW = = 500 Hz ⇒ Q = 20 Q Center-frequency gain = 10 Thus, ω0 s 10 Q T (s) = ω0 s2 + s + ω02 Q = π × 104 s s2 + sπ × 103 + (2π × 104 )2 |T| v1 v0 v2 v Figure 1 From Fig. 1 we see that at each |T | (below the peak value) there are two frequencies ω1 < ω0 and ω2 > ω0 with the same |T |. The relationship between ω1 and ω2 can be determined by considering the second term in the denominator of Eq. (1), as follows: ω02 − ω12 ω2 − ω02 = 2 ω1 ω0 ω2 ω0 Cross multiplying and collecting terms results in ω1 ω2 = ω02 Q.E.D. (b) Since the two edges of the passband must be geometrically symmetric around ω0 , we have √ ω0 = ωP1 ωP2 = 8100 × 10,000 = 9000 rad/s Chapter 13–14 This figure belongs to Problem 13.35, part (b). | T|, dB 0 3 22.1 3,000 fs1 27,000 f, Hz fs2 8,100 9,000 10,000 fp1 f0 fp2 Figure 2 13.37 Since near the poles, |T | exhibits a peak, and near the zeros it exhibits a dip, the results shown in Fig. 1 are obtained. The Q factor can now be found from ω0 3-dB BW = Q 10,000 − 8100 = 9000 Q 9000 = 4.74 1900 The geometric symmetry of |T | enables us to find ωs2 from ⇒Q= ωs1 ωs2 = ω02 13.38 Refer to Fig. 13.17(c). Using the voltage divider rule, we obtain (9000) = 27,000 rad/s 3000 Using Eq. (1), we obtain (ω2 − ω2 )2 Amin = A(ωs1 ) = 10 log 1 + Q2 0 2 2s1 ωs1 ω0 (90002 − 30002 )2 = 10 log 1 + 4.742 30002 × 90002 ⇒ ωs2 = Figure 1 2 Vo ZRC = Vi ZRC + sL = 1 1 + sLYRC = 1 1 + sL sC + = 22.1 dB T (s) = Figure 2 shows a sketch of |T |. 13.36 An increase in Qp increases the magnitude of the peak. On the other hand, an increase in Qz increases the magnitude of the dip. Thus, the results shown in Fig. 1 are obtained. Vo (s) = Vi (s) 1 R 1 s2 LC + s L +1 R 1/LC 1 1 + s2 + s CR LC Thus, = 1 ω0 = √ [which is Eq. (13.34)] LC 1 ω0 ⇒ Q = ω0 CR = CR Q Qp > Qz [which is Eq. (13.35)] Qp < Qz 13.39 Q = ω0 CR v Figure 1 5 = 105 × C × 10 × 103 ⇒ C = 5 nF Q.E.D. Chapter 13–15 Vo sL2 L2 = = Vi s(L1 + L2 ) L1 + L2 1 ω0 = √ LC (c) ⇒ L = 1/ω02 C L2 Vo (0) = Vi L1 + L2 1 = 20 mH 1010 × 5 × 10−9 L= 13.40 (a) If L became 1.01L, we obtain 1 1 0.995 ω0 = √ √ √ 1.01LC 1.005 LC LC L2 Vo (∞) = Vi L1 + L2 No transmission zeros. sL2 Vo = (d) Vi s(L1 + L2 ) + R Thus, ω0 decreases by 0.5%. Vo (0) = 0 Vi (b) If C increases by 1%, similar analysis as in (a) results in ω0 decreasing by 0.5%. L2 Vo (∞) = Vi L1 + L2 (c) ω0 is independent of the value of R ⇒ no change. There is a transmission zero at 0 (dc) due to L2 . 13.42 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 13.18(b). 13.41 (a) As ω reaches 0 (dc), we get Q = ω0 CR Vo = Vi 1 √ = 106 × 1 × 10−9 × R 2 1/sC2 C1 = 1 1 C1 + C2 + sC1 sC2 C1 Vo = Vi C1 + C2 ω02 LC = 1 1012 × L × 1 × 10−9 = 1 As ω reaches ∞, ⇒ L = 1 mH Vo C1 = Vi C1 + C2 No transmission zero are introduced. (b) Vo = Vi ZR,C2 ZR,C2 + 1 1 1+ YR,C2 sC1 = 1 1 1 + sC2 1+ sC1 R C2 1+ C1 1 = Vo (0) = 0 Vi C2 1+ C1 ZLR + 1 sC 1 1 1+ YLR sC 1 = 1 1 1 + 1+ sC R sL = 1 + sC1 R 1 ZLR = s = C1 1 s 1+ + C2 C1 R Vo (∞) = Vi 13.43 Refer to Fig. 13.18(c). Using the voltage divider rule, we obtain Vo = Vi 1 sC1 = = ⇒ R = 707 = C1 C1 + C2 There is a transmission zero at s = 0, due to C1 . 1 1 1 + 1+ sCR s2 LC s2 1 1 s2 + s + CR LC 13.44 Using superposition, we find the resulting T (s) in each of the three cases and then sum the results. Thus (see Figure 1 on the next page): (a) When x is lifted off ground and connected to Vx , the circuit becomes as shown in Fig. 1(a), and the transfer function becomes that of a low-pass Chapter 13–16 This figure belongs to Problem 13.44. L C Vx C R Vo1 Vy L (a) R Vo2 Vz (b) Figure 1 √ filter with ω0 = 1/ LC, Q = ω0 CR, and dc gain of unity, thus Vo1 ω02 = ω0 Vx + ω02 s2 + s Q R (1) L C Vo3 (c) 13.46 (a) Figure 1 on the next page shows the analysis. It is based on assuming ideal op amps that exhibit virtual short circuits between their input terminals, and draw zero currents into their input terminals. Observe that: (b) With y lifted off ground and connected to Vy , the resulting circuit [shown in Fig. √ 1(b)], is that of a high-pass filter with ω0 = 1/ LC, Q = ω0 CR, and a high-frequency gain of unity, thus (1) The circuit is fed at port-1 with a voltage V1 . The virtual short circuit between the input terminals of each of A2 and A1 cause the voltage at port-2 to be Vo2 s2 = ω 0 Vy + ω02 s2 + s Q V2 = V1 (2) (c) With z lifted off ground and connected to Vz , the resulting circuit shown in√Fig. 1(c) is that of a bandpass filter with ω0 = 1/ LC, Q = ω0 CR, and a center-frequency gain of unity, thus ω0 s Vo3 Q = (3) ω Vc 0 s2 + s + ω02 Q Now summing (1), (2), and (3) gives ω0 s2 Vy + s Vz + ω02 Vx Q Vo = ω0 s2 + s + ω02 Q 13.45 L = C4 R1 R3 R5 /R2 Selecting R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = R = 10 k, we have L = C4 R 2 = C4 × 108 Thus, C4 = L × 10−8 (a) For L = 15 H, we have C4 = 15 × 10−8 F = 0.15 μF (b) For L = 1.5 H, we have C4 = 0.015 μF = 15 nF (c) For L = 0.15 H, we have C4 = 1.5 nF (1) (2) With port-2 terminated in an impedance Z5 , the current that flows out of port-2 is I2 = V2 Z5 (3) Following the analysis indicated, we find the input current into port-1 as I1 = Z2 Z4 Z1 Z3 Z5 This current could have been written as Z2 Z4 I2 I1 = V1 Z1 Z3 (2) (4) Equations (1) and (2) describe the operation of the circuit: It propagates the voltage applied to port-1, V1 , and to port-2, V2 = V1 ; and whatever current is drawn out of port-2 is multiplied by the function (Z2 Z4 /Z1 Z3 ) and appears at port-1. (5) The result of the two actions in (4) is that the input impedance looking into port-1 becomes V1 V2 = I1 I2 (Z2 Z4 /Z1 Z3 ) V2 Z1 Z3 = Z2 Z4 I2 or Z1 Z3 Z5 Z11 = Z2 Z4 Z11 ≡ (b) If port-1 is terminated in an impedance Z6 , the input impedance looking into port-2 can be obtained by invoking the symmetry of the circuit, thus Z2 Z4 Z22 = Z6 Z1 Z3 Chapter 13–17 This figure belongs to Problem 13.46. I1 V1 1 Z2Z4 Z1Z3Z5 I1 Z1 V1 0 V1V1 V1 Z2 Z3 0 Z4 V1 Z2Z4 Z1Z3Z5 V1 A1 Z2Z4 Z3Z4 V1 (Z4/Z3Z5) V1 V1 V1/Z5 ( ) Z4 Z3Z5 V1V1 V1/Z5 2 V1/Z5 Z5 Z4 Z5 A2 Zin V1 I1 ( ZZ ZZ ) Z 1 3 5 2 4 Figure 1 Fig. 13.22(a) converts a resistance R5 into an inductance L = C4 R1 R3 R5 /R2 . Other conversion functions are possible and the circuit is known as a Generalized Impedance Converter or GIC. Thus, the circuit behaves as an impedance transformer with the transformation ratio from Z1 Z3 port-2 to port-1 being and from port-1 to Z2 Z4 Z2 Z4 port-2 being . Z1 Z3 13.47 Figure 1 below shows the suggested circuit together with the analysis. The input impedance looking into port-2 is Since Z1 , Z2 , Z3 , and Z4 can be arbitrary functions of s, the transformation ratio can be an arbitrary function of s. Thus the circuit can be used as an impedance converter. For instance, the particular selection of impedances in Fig. 13.20(a) results in the transformation ratio from port-2 to port-1 being (sC4 R1 R3 /R2 ). As a result, the circuit in Z22 (s) ≡ V2 R2 = 2 I2 s C4 C6 R1 R3 For s = jω we have Z22 (jω) = − R2 ω2 C4 C6 R1 R2 This figure belongs to Problem 13.47. A1 V2 1 0 R1 ( sC RR V ) sC6V2 6 1 2 2 C6 sC6V2 0 R2 R3 sC6R1V2 R2 I2 V2 2 ( s C CRR R V ) 2 ) s2C4C6R1R3 R2 0 C4 V2 0 ( 4 6 1 3 V 2 2 2 A2 Z22 Figure 1 Chapter 13–18 which is a negative resistance whose magnitude depends on frequency ω; thus it is called a Frequency Dependent Negative Resistance or FDNR. can be realized by the circuit in Fig. 13.13(a) with R1 = R2 = 100 k (arbitrary but convenient value). 1 ω0 CR1 = 13.48 Refer to Fig. 13.22(e) and the LPN entry in Table 13.1. ⇒C= Select The second-order transfer function C4 = C = 10 nF T2 (s) = Thus, R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = = 1 ω0 C R6 = Q × 1.59 = 15.9 k 2 2 ω0 10 C61 = C = 10 = 6.94 nF ωn 12 C62 = C − 6.94 = 3.06 nF 106 103 s2 + s + 106 1.618 C4 = C6 = C = 10 nF (practical value) R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = = 1 ω0 C 1 = 100 k 103 × 10 × 10−9 R6 = Q/ω0 C = Q × 100 = 161.8 k K =1 K =1 The second-order transfer function 13.49 For a fifth-order Butterworth filter with Amax = 3 dB, and thus = 1, and ωp = 103 rad/s, the poles can be determined using the graphical construct of Fig. 13.10(a), thus The pole pair p1 , p1∗ has ω0 = 103 rad/s and π ω0 = 103 sin = 103 × 0.309 2Q 10 1 = 1.618 2 × 0.309 p2∗ T3 (s) = 106 103 + 106 s2 + s 0.618 can be realized using the circuit in Fig. 13.22(a) with C4 = C6 = C = 10 nF (practical value) R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = R6 = Q The pole pair p2 , has ω0 = 10 rad/s and ω0 3π = 103 sin = 103 × 0.809 2Q 10 ⇒Q= 1 = 0.01 μF = 10 nF × 100 × 103 can be realized by the circuit in Fig. 13.22(a) with 1 = 1.59 k 2π × 10 × 103 × 10 × 10−9 ⇒Q= 103 3 1 = 0.618 2 × 0.809 1 ω0 C = 0.618 × 100 = 61.8 k K =1 The complete filter circuit is obtained as the cascade connection of the three filter sections, as shown in Fig. 1 on the next page. The real-axis pole p3 is at a 13.50 f0 = 2 kHz s = −10 rad/s Selecting, 3 1 = 100 k ω0 C Thus, the transfer function T (s) is C4 = C6 = C = 1.0 nF, we obtain 103 T (s) = × s + 103 R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = 106 × 103 + 106 s2 + s 1.618 1 2π × 2 × 103 × 10 × 10−9 106 103 s2 + s + 106 0.618 = The first-order factor, R6 = T1 (s) = 103 s + 103 1 ω0 C = 79.6 k Q = 2 × 7.96 = 159.2 k ω0 C r1 = r2 = 10 k (arbitrary) Chapter 13–19 This figure belongs to Problem 13.49. 100 k 10 nF 100 k Vi 100 k 1 161.8 k 10 nF 100 k 100 k 10 nF 100 k Vo 1 61.8 k 100 k 10 nF 100 k 100 k 10 nF 100 k Figure 1 13.51 Refer to Fig. 13.22(f) and to the HPN entry in Table 13.1. T (s) = K s2 + (R2 /C4 C6 R1 R3 R51 ) 1 R2 1 1 s2 + s + + C6 R6 C4 C6 R1 R3 R51 R52 R2 = C4 C6 R1 R3 R51 R2 1 1 ω02 = + C4 C6 R1 R3 R51 R52 ωn2 Thus, ω02 R51 = ωn2 R5 where R5 = R51 R52 Thus, ω02 R51 = R5 ωn2 2 ωn R52 = R5 / 1 − ω0 Choosing C4 = C5 = C (practical value) and R1 = R2 = R3 = R4 = R, we get R 1 ω02 = 2 3 = 2 2 C R C R ⇒ R = 1/ω0 C 1 1 ω0 = = Q C6 R6 CR6 Q ⇒ R6 = ω0 C Finally, K = High-frequency gain Chapter 13–20 then 13.52 (a) T (s) = 0.4508(s2 + 1.6996) (s + 0.7294)(s2 + s0.2786 + 1.0504) R= = 9.76 k 2 ω0 C61 = C ωn Replacing s by s/105 , we obtain T (s) = 2 s + 1.6996 0.4508 1010 s2 s s + 0.7294 + 0.2786 + 1.0504 105 1010 105 = 1 × 10−9 C62 = 1 − 0.618 = 0.382 nF = 382 pF √ 1.0504 = 3.679 Q= 0.2786 (b) First-order section: 0.7294 × 105 s + 0.7294 × 105 R6 = where the dc gain is made unity. This function can be realized using the circuit of Fig. 13.13(a) with Q = 3.679 × 9.76 = 35.9 k ω0 C Finally, K = DC gain = 1 C = 1 nF (arbitrary but convenient value) R2 = 1.0504 × 1010 = 0.618 nF 1.6996 × 1010 = 618 pF 0.4508 × 105 (s2 + 1.6996 × 1010 ) = (s + 0.7294 × 105 ) × (s2 + s0.2786 × 105 + 1.0504 × 1010 ) T1 (s) = 1 1 = √ ω0 C 1.0504 × 105 × 1 × 10−9 The complete circuit is shown in Fig. 1 below. 1 1 = ω0 C 0.7294 × 105 × 1 × 10−9 = 13.71 k 13.53 Bandpass with f0 = 2 kHz, 3-dB bandwidth of 50 Hz, thus For dc gain of unity, we have R1 = R2 = 13.71 k Q= Second-order LPN section: f0 2 kHz = = 40 BW 50 Hz Refer to the circuit in Fig. 13.24(a). Using 0.618(s2 + 1.6996 × 105 ) T2 (s) = 2 s + s0.2786 × 105 + 1.0504 × 1010 C = 10 nF Selecting, we obtain then C4 = C61 + C62 = C = 1 nF R= and 1 1 = 3 ω0 C 2π × 2 × 10 × 10 × 10−9 = 7.96 k R1 = R2 = R3 = R5 = R This figure belongs to Problem 13.52, part (b). Figure 1 Chapter 13–21 Select then R1 = 10 k Rf = R1 = 10k then Selecting Rf = R1 = 10 k R2 = 10 k Select then R2 = 1 k R3 = R2 (2Q − 1) = 70 k then Selecting R3 = (2Q − 1)R2 = (80 − 1) × 1 = 79 k RL = RH = 10 k 1 1 =2− = 1.975 K =2− Q 40 then Center-frequency gain = KQ = 1.975 × 40 = 79 RB = QRH = 4 × 10 = 40 k Now, 1 1 = 2 − = 1.75 Q 4 13.54 (a) Refer to the circuits in Fig. 13.24 and the transfer function in Eq. (13.66), that is, K =2− T (s) = (RF /RH )s2 − s(RF /RB )ω0 + (RF /RL )ω02 −K ω0 + ω02 s2 + s Q Flat gain = −10 = −K = −K RF RH ⇒ RF = s2 − s(RH /RB )ω0 + (RH /RL )ω02 ω0 + ω02 s2 + s Q T (s) = (RF /RH )s2 − s(RF /RB )ω0 + (RF /RL )ω02 −K s2 + s(ω0 /Q) + ω02 s2 − s(ω0 /Q) + ω02 T (s) = −Flat gain × 2 s + s(ω0 /Q) + ω02 (2) That is, Flat gain = −K T (s) = −G Q.E.D. RF RH Q.E.D. RH 2 ω RL 0 2 RH ω0 ⇒ = RL ωn Selecting where C = 1 nF K =2− 1 1 = 10 k = 5 ω0 C 10 × 1 × 10−9 Selecting R1 = 10 k (3) ωn2 = G=K then (2) where G is the high-frequency gain, then by equating the coefficients of the corresponding numerator terms, we obtain (b) ω0 = 105 rad/s, Q = 4 and flat gain = 10, thus R= s2 + ωn2 ω0 s2 + s + ω02 Q RB = ∞ RB RL = RH = Q (1) For this to be the transfer function of a notch filter, that is, (1) and 1 RH = RB Q 10RH 10 × 10 = = 57.1 k K 1.75 13.55 Consider Fig. 13.24 and Eq. (13.66), that is, For this to be an all-pass function, that is, then RH =1 RL RF RH (4) RF RH 1 Q thus 1 RF G = 2− Q RH ⇒ RF G = RH 2 − (1/Q) (5) Chapter 13–22 Equations (3), (4), and (5) are the design equations for the resistors associated with the summer. Observe that the value of one of the three resistors, RL , RH , and RF can be arbitrarily selected. 13.57 Using Eq. (13.68) with R1 = ∞, we have 1 r 1 s2 − s + C1 Vo R3 C1 R CC1 RR2 =− 1 1 Vi C s2 + s + QCR C 2 R2 13.56 Refer to Fig. 13.26 and Table 13.2. Using Thus, ωz = 1/ CC1 RR2 1 R3 C1 R Qz = √ CC1 RR2 r C1 R R3 = C R2 r C = 10 nF, then R= 1 1 = 5 ω0 C 10 × 10 × 10−9 = 1 k (1) (2) Rd = QR = 10 × 1 = 10 k From Eqs. (1) and (2) we see that trimming ωz and Qz can proceed in the following sequence: Select (a) Trim R2 to adjust ωz . This will affect Qz . r = 20 k (b) Trim R3 to adjust Qz . This will not affect ωz R1 = R3 = ∞ 13.58 If the dc gain is unity, then 1 = HF gain × ⇒ HF gain = T (s) = ωn2 ω02 0.4508(s2 + 1.6996) (s + 0.7294)(s2 + s0.2786 + 1.0504) (a) Replacing s by s/105 , we obtain 105 1.3 × 105 T (s) = 2 0.4508 × 105 (s2 + 1.6996 × 1010 ) (s + 0.7294 × 105 )(s2 + s 0.2786 × 105 + 1.0504 × 1010 ) = 0.5917 (b) First-order section: C1 = C × high-frequency gain T1 (s) = = 10 × 0.5917 = 5.92 nF which is made to have a dc gain of unity, as required. This function can be realized by the circuit in Fig. 13.13(a). Selecting (ω0 /ωn )2 R2 = R = 1 k HF gain 0.7294 × 105 s + 0.7294 × 105 C = 1 nF (arbitrary but convenient) This figure belongs to Problem 13.58, part (b). 9.76 k 13.71 k 35.9 k 1 nF 1 nF 10 k 13.71 k Vi 1 nF 618 pF 9.76 k Vo 9.76 k Figure 1 10 k Chapter 13–23 we have Thus, 1 R2 = ω0 C R3 = 14.14 k R4 = 7.07 k 1 = 0.7294 × 105 × 1 × 10−9 = 13.71 k 13.60 Refer to Fig. 13.28(a). For a dc gain of unity, we have 1 2 + 2 2 CR C R t(s) = 1 3 2 + s +s CR C 2 R2 s2 + s(2/τ ) + (1/τ 2 ) = 2 s + s(3/τ ) + (1/τ 2 ) s2 + s R1 = R2 = 13.71 k Second-order LPN section: T2 (s) = s2 0.618(s2 + 1.6996 × 1010 ) + s0.2786 × 105 + 1.0504 × 1010 where the dc gain is unity. Refer to Fig. 13.26 and Eq. (13.68). Selecting C = 1 nF ω0 = then R= If the network is placed in the negative-feedback path of an ideal infinite-gain op amp, as in Fig. 13.24, the poles will be given by the roots of the numerator polynomial, thus 1 τ and 1 1 = √ ω0 C 1.0504 × 105 × 1 × 10−9 1/τ = 0.5 2/τ Thus, the poles will be coincident at Q= = 9.76 k √ 1.0504 Rd = QR = × 9.76 = 35.9 k 0.2786 Select s = −ω0 = −1/τ 13.61 r = 10 k Now, sC3Vo C1 = C × high-frequency gain = 1 × 0.618 = 0.618 nF = 618 pF R2 R1 = ∞ C4 0 R3 = ∞ (ω0 /ωn )2 HF Gain 1 1.0504 × = 9.76 × 1.6996 0.618 = 9.76 k R2 = R Vi sC4(ViVx) X C3 R1 VoVx R1 sC3Vo 0V Vo Figure 1 The complete circuit is shown in Fig. 1. 13.59 Refer to Fig. 13.29 and Eqs. (13.75) and (13.76): C1 = C2 = C = 1 nF R3 = R and R4 = R/4Q2 = R 4× √ 2Q 2/ 2 CR = = ω0 105 √ 2 ⇒R= 5 = 14.14 k 10 × 1 × 10−9 1 2 The circuit is shown in Fig. 1. The voltage at node X can be found as Vx = 0 − sC3 Vo R2 = −sC3 R2 Vo = R 2 (1) A node equation at X can be written as sC3 Vo + sC4 (Vi − Vx ) + Vo − Vx =0 R1 Substituting for Vx from Eq. (1), we obtain (2) Vo 1 sC3 Vo +sC4 Vi − (−sC3 R2 Vo ) sC4 + + =0 R1 R1 Chapter 13–24 1 R2 + = −sC4 Vi Vo sC3 +s2 C3 C4 R2 +sC3 R1 R1 Vo = Vi = −sC4 R2 1 s2 C3 C4 R2 + sC3 1 + + R1 R1 1 s2 + s C4 where ω0 = 2π × 10 × 103 f0 10 = =5 BW 2 Thus, Q= −s/C3 R2 1 1 1 + + R1 R2 C3 C4 R1 R2 CR = For R1 = R2 = R, C4 = C, and C3 = C/36, we obtain −s(36/CR) Vo = 36 2 Vi + s2 + s CR C 2 R2 This is a bandpass function with 6 ω0 = CR 6/CR =3 Q= 2/CR 2×5 2π × 104 Selecting C = 10 nF we obtain 10 = 15.92 k 2π × 104 × 10 × 10−9 R= Thus, C1 = C2 = 10 nF R3 = 15.92 k R4 = and R 15.92 = 159.2 = 4Q2 100 Center-frequency gain = −18 Center-frequency gain = − 13.62 =− 1 R3 1 = − × 100 = −50 V/V 2 R4 2 13.63 R3 C2 1/C1 R4 1 1 1 + C1 C2 R3 C1 R4 Vi Vo Figure 1 The circuit is shown in Fig. 1. The transfer function can be obtained using the equation on page 1126 with α = 1, thus Vo = Vi −s/C1 R4 1 1 1 1 s2 + s + + C1 C2 R3 C1 C2 R3 R4 Figure 1 The circuit is shown in Fig. 1. The voltage at node X is given by R3 = R 1 Vo − βVi sC R Vo 1 − = βVi 1 + sCR sCR R4 = R/4Q2 Writing a node equation at X gives Using the design equations (13.75) and (13.76), we obtain CR = 2Q ω0 Vx = βVi − Vi − Vx Vo − βVi + + sC(Vo − Vx ) = 0 R R/4Q2 (1) Chapter 13–25 Substituting for Vx from Eq. (1) and collecting terms gives The analysis is shown in Fig. 1, below, left. The voltage at node X is given by Vi = Vx Vo 1 R3 sC2 1 = Vo 1 + sC2 R3 4Q2 2 1 2 s +s 1 + 2Q 1 − + 2 2 CR β C R β 2 2 4Q s2 + s + CR C 2 R2 We observe that, as expected, 2 2Q CR (a) To obtain an all-pass function, we set 2 1 2 1 + 2Q2 1 − =− CR β CR ω0 = ⇒ A node equation at X provides Vo − Vx Vo + sC1 (Vi − Vx ) = R4 R3 1 1 1 Vo − + sCVi − Vx + sC1 = 0 R4 R3 R4 Vo = Vi s2 + s 1 R3 s2 1 1 1 + + C1 C2 C1 C2 R3 R4 This is a high-pass function with a high-frequency gain of unity. To obtain a maximally flat response with ω3dB = 104 rad/s and using But, R2 R1 + R2 C1 = C2 = C = 10 nF Thus, then R2 = Q2 R1 ω0 = ω3dB = 104 rad/s 1 1 1 + Q = √ = ω0 R3 C1 C2 2 2 1 √ = 104 R3 10 × 10−9 2 (b) To obtain a notch function, we set 1 2 1 + 2Q2 1 − =0 CR β ⇒ (1) Substituting for Vx from Eq. (1) and collecting terms, we obtain 1 1 =1+ 2 β Q β= Vx = Vo + 1 1 =1+ β 2Q2 1 2 ⇒ R3 = √ × −8 × 10−4 = 14.14 k 2 10 1 ω02 = C1 C2 R3 R4 1 108 = −8 10 × 10−8 × 14.4 × 103 × R4 100 k = 7.07 k ⇒ R4 = 14.14 or, equivalently, R2 = 2Q2 R1 13.64 13.65 Vo Vo R3 C2 X Vo C1 Vo R3 R3 R4 (VoVx)/R4 sC1(ViVx) Vi Figure 1 Figure 1 Chapter 13–26 Figure 1 (see previous page) shows a graphical construct to determine the poles of the fifth order Butterworth filter. The pair of complex conjugate poles p1 and p1∗ have a frequency The second second-order section also can be realized using the circuit in Fig. 13.34(c). Here, ω01 = ω3dB = 2π × 104 rad/s C4 = C and a Q factor C3 = Q1 = R1 = R2 = R = 10 k 1 = 1.618 2 sin 18◦ C 4Q2 where Q = Q2 = 0.618. Thus The pair of complex conjugate poles p2 and p2∗ have ω02 = ω3dB = 2π × 104 rad/s and a Q factor, C3 = C = 0.655C 4 × 0.6182 CR = 2Q 2 × 0.618 = ω0 2π × 104 2 × 0.618 = 1.97 nF 2π × 104 × 104 1 = 0.618 2 sin 54◦ The real-axis pole p3 is at C3 = 1.29 nF s = −ω0 = −2π × 10 rad/s C4 = 1.97 nF The first second-order section can be realized using the circuit in Fig. 13.34(c). The design equations are (13.77)–(13.80). The first-order section can be realized using the circuit in Fig. 13.13(a) with ⇒C= Q2 = 4 R1 = R2 = R = 10 k R1 = R2 = R = 10 k C4 = C C= C3 = C/4Q2 = Here, Q = Q1 = 1.618, thus C3 = C = 0.095C 4 × 1.6182 CR = 2 × 1.618 2Q = ω0 2π × 104 ⇒C= 1 ω0 R 1 = 1.59 nF 2π × 104 × 104 The complete circuit is shown in Fig. 2 below. 13.66 Refer to Fig. 13.31 and let the network n have a transfer function ω0 s Va Q = ω0 Vb 2 + ω02 s +s Q 2 × 1.618 = 5.15 nF 2π × 104 × 10 × 103 C3 = 0.492 nF = 492 pF C4 = 5.15 nF This figure belongs to Problem 13.65. Figure 2 Chapter 13–27 which is a bandpass with a unity center-frequency gain. The complementary network in (b) will have a transfer function Va Va =1− Vc Vb ω0 s Q =1− ω0 2 + ω02 s +s Q = s2 + ω02 ω0 + ω02 s2 + s Q which is a notch function. ∂ω0 ω0 =− ∂C 2C ∂ω0 =0 ∂R ∴ S ωL 0 = ∂ω0 L = −1/2 ∂L ω0 S ωC0 = ∂ω0 C = −1/2 × ∂C ω0 S ωR 0 = ∂ω0 R =0 ∂R ω0 For Q we have √ R C −1 −Q ∂Q = √ = ∂L 2 2L L L √ 1 R ∂Q Q 1R C = √ = √ = ∂C 2 LC 2C L 2C ∂Q R = C/L = C/L = Q/R ∂R R Q SL = − Q Figure 1 SC = As an example, consider the RLC bandpass circuit shown in Fig. 1(a). It has the transfer function SR = 1 CR 1 1 s2 + s + CR LC Interchanging the input terminal with ground, we obtain the circuit shown in Fig. 1(b). Vo T1 (s) = = Vi Q Q L 1 × =− 2L Q 2 Q C 1 × = 2C Q 2 Q R · =1 R Q s Straightforward analysis shows that this circuit has the transfer function 1 s2 + LC T2 (s) = 1 1 + s2 + s CR LC which is a notch function. Observe that T2 (s) = 1 − T1 (s) that is, the circuits in (a) and (b) are complementary. 13.67 For the circuit in Fig. 13.18(b) we have 1/LC T (s) = 2 s + s/RC + 1/LC 1 C Q=R ω0 = √ L LC For ω0 we have ∂ω0 ∂(LC)−1/2 1 ω0 = = − L−3/2 C −1/2 = ∂L ∂L 2 2L 13.68 (a) y = uv Sxy = =v = ∂(uv) x ∂x uv ∂u x ∂v x +u ∂x uv ∂x uv ∂u x ∂v x + ∂x u ∂x v = Sxu + Sxv (b) y = u/v Sxy = ∂(u/v) x ∂y x = ∂x y ∂x u/v = 1 ∂u xv u ∂v xv − 2 v ∂x u v ∂x u = ∂u x ∂v x − ∂x u ∂x v = Sxu − Sxv (c) y = ku Sxy = = ∂u x ∂y x =k ∂x y ∂x ku ∂u x ∂x u = Sxu Chapter 13–28 ∂ω0 −1 = √ ∂C3 2C3 C3 C4 R1 R2 −ω0 = 2C3 (d) y = un Sxy = ∂y x ∂x y ∂u x ∂x un ∂u x =n ∂n u = nun−1 SCω30 = Clearly, SCω30 = SCω40 = SRω10 = SRω20 = − = nSxu ∂Q = ∂C3 (e) y = f1 (u), u = f2 (x) Sxy = ∂y x ∂x y = ∂f1 (u) ∂u x u ∂u ∂x f1 (u) u ∂f2 (x) x ∂f1 (u) u = ∂u f1 (u) ∂x u ∂f2 (x) x ∂f1 (u) u = ∂u f1 (u) ∂x f2 (x) = Q Similarly, Q SR2 = 0 −ω0 C4 1 × =− 2C4 ω0 2 Similarly, SCω60 = SRω10 = SRω30 = SRω5o = − 1 2 ωO 1 ∂ω0 = ⇒ SRω2o = ∂R2 2R2 2 Now for Q: Q ∂Q R6 ∂Q Q = +1 = ⇒ SR6 = R6 ∂R6 Q ∂R6 Q 1 ∂Q Q Q = ⇒ SC6 = SR2 = + ∂C6 2C6 2 13.71 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 13.35(f). Vi Io = gm1,2 2 Thus, Gm = gm1,2 = 2k n ID1,2 = 2k n (I /2) = k nI Thus, 13.70 Using Eqs. (13.78) and (13.79), we have Gm = 1 C3 C4 R1 R2 1 1 1 1 + C4 R1 R2 1 gm1,2 2 But, Q 1 ∂Q Q Q =− ⇒ SC4 = SR1 ,R2 ,R3 = − ∂C4 2C4 2 C3 C4 R1 R2 1 2 If R1 = R2 ⇒ SR1 = 0. −ω0 ∂ω0 = ∂C4 2C4 √ −1 1 1 1 C3 C4 R1 R2 + C4 R1 R2 ∂Q Q 1 Q = ⇒ SC4 = + ∂C4 2C4 2 √ √ 1/ R1 − R1 /R 2 Q ∂Q = √ · ∂R1 2 1 R1 R1 √ + R2 R1 R2 /R 1 − R1 /R 2 Q = · 2 R2 R1 R1 + R1 R2 1 R2 /R 1 − R1 /R 2 Q ∴ SR1 = 2 R2 /R 1 + R1 /R 2 13.69 From Table 13.1 we have 1 ω0 = C4 C6 R1 R3 R5 /R 2 C6 R2 Q = R6 C4 R1 R3 R5 Q= √ 1 2 −Q 2C3 Q = Suy Sxu ω0 = √ 2C3 ∴ SC3 = − = Suf1 Sxf2 ∴ S ωC40 = ∂ω0 C3 1 =− ∂C3 ωO 2 1 k nI 2 For Gm = 0.25 mA/V and k n = 0.5 mA/V2 , we have 1√ 0.25 = 0.5I 2 ⇒ I = 0.5 mA Chapter 13–29 √ Since Gm is proportional to I , tuning Gm in the range ±5% requires tuning I in the range 0.952 Inominal to 1.052 Inominal , which is approximately ±10% of the nominal value. 13.72 R = 1 Gm Thus, 10 × 106 = Gm 2π × 5 × 10−12 ⇒ Gm = 0.314 mA/V 13.75 Both Ro and Co will appear in parallel with C, thus 1 1 = 3 = 10−3 A/V = 1 mA/V R 10 Since the output terminal is connected back to the input, the output resistance appears in effect in parallel with the resistance 1/Gm , thus the actual resistance realized is 1 Ro = 1 100 = 0.99 k Gm ⇒ Gm = Vo = Gm Vi 1 1 + s(C + Co ) Ro The transfer function realized will be Vo Gm = 1 V1 + s(C + Co ) Ro The integrator time constant is τ = (C + Co )/Gm C Co = 1+ Gm C Co The quantity 1 + represents the error C factor. For the error to be less than 1%, we must have Co ≤ 0.01 C ⇒ C ≥ 100Co 13.73 Thus, the smallest value of C is 100Co . Frequency of the low-frequency pole Figure 1 The circuit is shown in Fig. 1, for which we can write 1 (Gm1 V1 − Gm2 V2 + Gm3 V3 ) Vo = Gm4 = Gm2 Gm3 Gm1 V1 − V2 + V3 Gm4 Gm4 Gm4 To obtain = 1 (C + Co )Ro 1 CRo If this frequency is to be at least two decades Gm , then lower than the unity gain frequency C 1 Gm ≤ 0.01 CRo C 100 Ro Vo = V1 − 2V2 + 3V3 ⇒ Gm ≥ we select Thus, the smallest value of Gm must be 100/Ro . Gm1 = Gm4 13.76 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 13.36(c) and its transfer function in Eq. (13.91), namely Gm2 = 2 Gm4 Gm3 = 3 Gm4 Vo Gm1 =− Vi sC + Gm2 13.74 For the integrator in Fig. 13.36(b), we have Gm Vo = V1 sC Unity-gain frequency = Gm 2πC Gm2 2πC Gm2 20 × 106 = 2π × 2 × 10−12 Pole frequency = ⇒ Gm2 = 0.251 mA/V Chapter 13–30 |DC gain| = 10 = Gm1 Gm2 Thus, Zin ≡ Gm1 Gm2 V1 C =s I1 Gm1 Gm2 which is that of an inductance L, ⇒ Gm1 = 2.51 mA/V L= 13.77 C Gm1 Gm2 Q.E.D. (b) To obtain an LCR resonator, we connected a capacitor C from node 1 to ground and a resistance R realized by the transconductor Gm3 , as shown in Fig. 1 below. (c) A fourth transconductor Gm4 is used to feed a current Gm4 Vi to node 1, as shown in Fig. 1. The resulting circuit is identical to that in Fig. 13.37(b) except here C1 = C2 = C. (d) With analogy to the identical circuit in Fig. 13.37(b), V1 /Vi will be a second-order bandpass filter with a transfer function given by Eq. (13.93), and V2 /Vi will be a second-order low-pass filter with a transfer function given by Eq. (13.94). Thus, Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the circuit. A node equation at X yields sC1 (Vi − Vo ) = Gm1 Vi + Gm2 Vo + sCVo V1 =− Vi (sC1 Vi − Gm1 )Vi = Vo (Gm2 + sC + sC1 ) ⇒ Vo Gm1 − sC1 =− Vi Gm2 + s(C + C1 ) s(Gm4 /C) Gm3 Gm1 Gm2 s2 + s + C1 C2 and, V2 =− Vi 13.78 (a) Refer to the circuit in Fig. P13.78. The output current of the Gm2 transconductor is Gm2 V1 . Thus, Gm2 V1 sC This is the input voltage to the negative transconductor Gm1 . Thus the output current of Gm1 , which is equal to I1 , will be V2 = Gm2 Gm4 /C 2 Gm1 Gm2 Gm2 s2 + s + C C2 13.79 Using Eqs. (13.95) and (13.96), we have Gm1 Gm2 (1) ω0 = C1 C2 √ Gm1 Gm2 C1 (2) Q= Gm3 C2 I1 = Gm1 V2 Gm1 Gm2 = V1 sC This figure belongs to Problem 13.78, part (b). Gm3 Gm1 1 Vi Gm4 C V Gm2 C V2 Figure 1 Chapter 13–31 Selecting Gm1 = Gm2 = Gm3 = Gm , we obtain Gm ω0 = √ C1 C2 C1 Q= C2 Gm4 = (3) = Gm |Gain| Q 0.785 × 5 = 0.785 mA/V 5 (4) Selecting C2 = C, then from Eq. (4) we have 13.81 The resulting circuit is shown in Fig. 1. For V2 we can write C1 = Q2 C V2 = and from Eq. (3) we have 1 (Gm2 V1 − Gm5 Vi ) sC2 (1) A node equation at X can be written as Gm = ω0 QC Gm1 V2 + sC3 (V1 − Vi ) + Gm4 Vi + Gm3 V1 + sC1 V1 13.80 f0 = 25 MHz, Q = 5, =0 Center-frequency gain = 5 Substituting for V2 from Eq. (1) into Eq. (2) and collecting terms results in the transfer function The design equations are given by (13.99), (13.100), and (13.101). Thus (2) V1 = Vi Gm = ω0 C s2 where C = C1 = C2 = 5 pF Gm = 2π × 25 × 106 × 5 × 10−12 = 0.785 mA/V 13.82 Req = Thus, −s Tc 1 1 = = C1 fc C1 200 × 103 C1 For C1 = 1 pF, Gm2 = Gm = 0.785 mA/V Gm3 = Gm1 Gm5 Gm4 + C1 + C3 (C1 + C3 )C2 Gm3 Gm1 Gm2 2 s +s + C1 + C3 (C1 + C3 )C2 C3 C1 + C3 0.785 Gm = = 0.157 mA/V Q 5 Req = 1 = 5 M 200 × 103 × 1 × 10−12 This figure belongs to Problem 13.81. Gm1V2 X Gm1 C3 Gm2Vi Gm2 C2 V1 C1 Gm3V1 sC3 (V1 Vi) Gm4 Gm3 Gm4Vi Vi Gm5Vi Gm5 Figure 1 V2 Chapter 13–32 13.84 ω0 = ω3dB = 103 rad/s √ Q = 1/ 2 and DC gain = 1 For C1 = 5 pF, Req = 1 = 1 M 200 × 103 × 5 × 10−12 fc = 100 kHz, C1 = C2 = C = 5 pF For C1 = 10 pF, Req = From Eqs. (13.109) and (13.110), 1 = 500 k 200 × 103 × 10 × 10−12 C3 = C4 = ω0 Tc C 1 × 5 × 10−12 100 × 103 13.83 Change transferred ⇒ Q = CV = 103 × = 10−12 (1) = 0.05 pF = 1 pC From Eq. (13.112), For f0 = 100 kHz, average current is given by IAV C5 = Q = = 1 pC × 100 × 103 T The dc gain of the low-pass circuit is = 0.1 μA DC gain = For each clock cycle, the output will change by the same amount as the change in voltage across C2 . ∴ V = Q/C2 = C6 = C4 = 0.05 pF 1 pC = 0.1 V 10 pF 13.85 Refer Fig. 1 below and Fig. 2 on next page. For the BJT we have 10 V = 100 cycles 0.1 V slope = C6 C4 For DC gain = 1, For V = 0.1 V for each Clock cycle, the amplifier will saturate in = 0.05 C4 = √ = 0.071 pF Q 1/ 2 10V V = t (100 cycles) 1/100 × 103 = 104 V/s gm = IC 1 mA = 40 mA/V VT 0.025 V rπ = β 200 = = 5 k gm 40 Cπ = 10 pF This figure belongs to Problem 13.85, part (a). RL 5 k Vo Rs 10 k Vs L 0.5 H Vbe C 200 pF 1 mA Zin Figure 1 Chapter 13–33 Miller capacitance = Cμ (1 + gm RL ) = 0.5(1 + 40 × 5) = 100.5 pF Total capacitance = C + Cπ + CMiller = 200 + 10 + 100.5 = 310.5 pF Thus, the additional parallel resistance required, Ra , can be determined from Ra Rp = R Ra 15.71 = 5.23 ⇒ Ra = 7.84 k 13.87 f0 = = Zin rp Cp Cm(1gmRL) Q= 1 ω0 = √ LCtotal = √ √ 2π 36 × 10−6 × 103 × 10−12 = 838.8 kHz Equivalent parallel resistance = 32 × 1 = 9 k Figure 2 1 0.5 × 10−6 × 310.5 × 10−12 1 √ 2π LC 1 = 80.3 Mrad/s Total effective parallel resistance = 10 k 5 k = 3.33 k Rp ω0 L 9 × 103 2π × 838.8 × 103 × 36 × 10−6 = 47.4 = 13.88 3.33 × 103 R = = 83 Q= ω0 L 80.3 × 106 × 0.5 × 10−6 80.3 × 106 ω0 = = 967 kHz Q 83 rπ Vbe (ω0 ) = Vs rπ + Rs Im sCm(VpVo) 3-dB BW = rp Yin Vp 1 = −40 × 5 × Vs 3 = −66.7Vs # # # Vo (ω0 ) # # # # V (ω ) # = 66.7 V/V s 0 13.86 Rp = ω0 LQ = 2π × 106 × 10 × 10−6 × 250 = 15.71 k 1 C= 2 ω0 L = 1 = 2.53 nF 6 2 (2π × 10 ) × 10 × 10−6 For a 3-dB bandwidth of 12 kHz, we have Q= 1 × 106 = 83.3 12 × 103 which requires a parallel resistance of R = ω0 LQ = 2π × 106 × 10 × 10−6 × 83.3 = 5.23 k Cp L Vo gmVp Vo (ω0 ) = −gm RL Vbe Cm Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1. A node equation at the output node yields sCμ (Vπ − Vo ) = gm Vπ + Vo sL sCμ − gm 1 + sCμ sL Now, we can find Iμ as ⇒ Vo = Vπ Iμ = sCμ (Vπ − Vo ) = sCμ Vπ − sCμ Vo Thus, sCμ − gm Iμ = sCμ − sCμ 1 Vπ + sCμ sL ⎡ 1 ⎤ + sCμ − sCμ + gm ⎢ ⎥ = sCμ⎣ sL ⎦ 1 + sCμ sL 1 + gm = sCμ sL 1 + sCμ sL Chapter 13–34 ω02 − ω2 . For ωω0 ω = ω0 + δω where (δω/ω0 ) 1, δω ω = ω0 1 + ω0 2δω ω2 ω02 1 + ω0 For s = jω, we obtain Iμ = jωCμ Vπ = jωCμ Now, consider the quantity 1 jωL 1 jωCμ + jωL gm + 1 + jωLgm 1 − ω2 LCμ since ωCμ 1 ωL Thus, ω02 − ω2 ω2 − ω2 (1 + 2δω/ω0 ) = 0 2 0 ωω0 ω0 (1 + δω/ω0 ) ⇒ ω2 LCμ 1 Thus, Iμ jωCμ (1 + jωLgm ) Vπ = = jωCμ − ω2 LCμ gm Substituting in Eq. (1), we obtain Returning to Fig. 1, we can write Yin = −2δω/ω0 2δω − δω ω0 1+ ω0 1 Iμ + jωCμ + rπ Vπ |T (jω)| = 1 + jωCπ + jωCμ − ω2 Cμ Lgm rπ 1 = − ω2 Cμ Lgm + jω(Cπ + Cμ ) rπ = Q.E.D. 1 |T (jω)|N = √ |T (jω0 )|N 2 K = |T (jω0 )| Thus, |T (jω0 )| 2 2 ω − ω2 1 + Q2 0 ωω0 |T (jω0 )|N [1 + 4Q2 (δω/ω0 )2 ]N /2 The 3-dB bandwidth is the value of (2δω) at which where |T (jω)| = (b) For N syncronously tuned sections connected in cascade, we obtain |T (jω)|N = ω0 sK Q 13.89 (a) T (s) = ω 0 + ω02 s2 + s Q |T (jω0 )| 2 δω 1 + 4Q2 ω0 (1) Denoting, 2δω = B, we obtain √ [1 + Q2 (B/ω0 )2 ]N /2 = 2 ω0 B= 21/N − 1 Q.E.D. Q Exercise 14–1 Ex: 14.1 Pole frequency f0 = 1 kHz Center-frequency gain = = Ex: 14.3 The square wave at the output of the op amp will have amplitude V = 2 V. Now if the bandpass circuit is of high selectivity, the signal across the tank circuit√will be that whose frequency is ω0 = 1/ LC, which is the fundamental frequency in the Fourier series of the square wave at the output. The fundamental frequency at the output will have a peak amplitude of 4V /π = 8/π = 2.55 V. Now, since the center-frequency gain of the bandpass circuit is unity, the voltage across the tank circuit will have a peak amplitude of 2.55 V. 1 Amplifier gain 1 V/V 2 Ex: 14.2 r2 r1 ⫺ Vo Vo K K sCVo /K C Vo ⫹ R Vo /sKL L Ex: 14.4 L+ = V Vo sC ⫹ 1 K sL r2 K ⫽ 1 ⫹ r1 I⫽ ( ) Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the circuit with some of the analysis already indicated. Writing a loop equation gives Vo Vo = IR + K 1 Vo Vo R sC + + = K sL K 3 3 + 0.7 1 + 9 9 R4 + VD 1 + R5 = 15 = 5 + 0.93 = 15.93 V R3 R3 − VD 1 + L− = − V R2 R2 3 3 = −15 × − 0.7 1 + 9 9 Limiter gain = (1) −Rf −60 = R1 30 = −2 V/V Thus limiting occurs at r2 K =1+ r1 ±5.93 2 = ± 2.97 V Multiplying Eq. (1) by (sK/CR) and dividing by Vo and rearranging gives 1 1 (1 − K) + =0 CR LC r2 gives Substituting K = 1 + r1 s2 + s 1 r2 1 + =0 CR r1 LC For s = jω, we have 1 1 r2 2 =0 − jω −ω + LC LC r1 Re[D(jω)] = −ω2 + Im[D(jω)] = − = −5.93 V/V where s2 − s R4 R5 1 LC ω r2 CR r1 For sustained oscillation, both the real part and the imaginary part must be zero at the frequency of oscillation, thus 1 1 Re = 0 ⇒ ω02 = √ ⇒ ω0 = √ LC LC r2 Im = 0 ⇒ = 0 ⇒ r2 = 0 r1 Slope in the limiting regions = −Rf R4 60 3 = −0.095 V/V =− R1 30 ZP R2 Ex: 14.5 (a) L (s) = 1 + R1 ZP + ZS R2 1 = 1+ R1 1 + ZS YP ⎛ ⎞ ⎟ 1 20.3 ⎜ ⎜ ⎟ = 1+ ⎠ 1 1 10 ⎝ 1+ R+ + sC sC R = 3.03 3 + sCR + 1 sCR where R = 10 k and C = 16 nF Thus, L (s) = 3.03 3 + s16 × 10−5 + 1 s × 16 × 10−5 Exercise 14–2 Ex: 14.7 Figure 1 shows the circuit together with the analysis details. The current I can be found as Vo 1 1 Vo I= 1+ 2+ + Rf sCR sCRRf sCR The closed-loop poles are found by setting L (s) = 1; that is, they are the values of s, satisfying 3 + s × 16 × 10−5 + 1 = 3.03 s × 16 × 10−5 Finally, Vx can be found from 1 1 I Vo 2 + − Vx = − sCRf sCR sC 1 1 Vo 1 Vo 2 + 1+ − =− sCRf sCR sCRf sCR 1 Vo 2+ − 2 2 s C RRf sCR 5 ⇒s= 10 (0.015 ± j) 16 (b) The frequency of oscillation is 105 /16 rad/s or approximately 1 kHz. (c) Refer to Fig. 14.6. At the positive peak V̂o , the voltage at node b will be one diode drop (0.7 V) above the voltage V1 which is about 1/3 of Vo ; thus Vb = 0.7 + V̂O /3. Now if we neglect the current through D2 in comparison with the currents through R5 and R6 , we find that − Vo =− Vx V̂o − Vb ∼ Vb − (−15) = R5 R6 Vo = Vx Vb + 15 V̂o − Vb = 1 3 4 V̂o = Vb + 5 3 4 + s3CR + 1 sCR ω2 C 2 RRf 1 4 + j 3ωCR − ωCR Ex: 14.8 From the loop-gain expression +5 Vo = Vx ω2 C 2 RRf 4 + j 3ωCR − ⇒ V̂o = 10.68 V 1 ωCR we see that the phase will be zero at From symmetry, we see that the negative peak is equal to the positive peak. Thus the output peak-to-peak voltage is 21.36 V. 1 ω0 CR 1 ⇒ ω0 = √ 3CR At this frequency, we have 3ω0 CR = Ex: 14.6 (a) For oscillations to start, we need R2 /R1 = 2; thus the potentiometer should be set so that its resistance to ground is 20 k. (b) f0 = s2 C 2 RRf For s = jω, Thus, 4 V̂o 0.7 + V̂o = 3 3 3 4 1 Vx = + 2 2 + 3 3 2 Vo sCRf s C RRf s C R Rf ω2 C 2 RRf Vo = 0 Vi 4 1 Rf = 12 R 1 1 = 2πRC 2π10 × 103 × 16 × 10−9 = 1 kHz This figure belongs to Exercise 14.7. [⫺ sCR1 V ⫺ sC1 VR (1⫹ sCR1 ) ] o f o f ⫺ I C Vo /Rf Vo sCRf Vo /Rf C Vx C R 0 ⫺ 0 ⫹ R Vo sCRRf Vo sCRRf (2⫹ sCR1 ) Vo 1⫹ 1 sCR Rf ( Figure 1 Rf ) Vo Exercise 14–3 Thus the minimum value that Rf must have for oscillations to start is Equating the real part to zero gives Rf = 12R ω02 = Using the values in Fig. 14.9, we obtain Equating the imaginary part to zero and using Eq. (1) gives 1 1 = 3.608 krad/s ω0 = √ −9 × 10 × 103 16 × 10 3 3.608 × 103 ω0 = = 574.3 Hz f0 = 2π 2π Rf ≥ 12 × 10 = 120 k 1 1 ⇒ CR = CR 2π103 For C = 16 nF, we have R = 10 k. Ex: 14.9 ω0 = ∴ the output is twice as large as the voltage across the resonator, and the peak-to-peak amplitude is 4(2 × 1.4) 4V = = 3.6 V π π Ex: 14.10 For the Hartley oscillator of Fig. 14.13(b), let the emitter be grounded and assume that the total effective resistance between collector and emitter is R. Replacing the BJT with its equivalent circuit but neglecting rπ , Cπ and Cμ and assuming that ro is absorbed into R, we obtain the circuit shown in Fig. 1. 1 (L1 + L2 )C 1 R = 1 (L1 + L2 )C L2 CR gm + gm R = 1 + gm R = L1 L2 L1 L2 which is the condition for sustained oscillations. To ensure that oscillation will start, we need gm R > L1 L2 Q.E.D. Ex: 14.11 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 14.14(a). R = Rcoil ro RL = Q 100 × 103 2 × 103 ω0 C1 = 100 105 2 × 103 106 × 0.01 × 10−6 = 104 105 2 × 103 = 1.64 × 103 = 1.64 k gm = IC 1 mA = = 40 mA/V VT 0.025 V For sustained oscillations, we have gm R = Figure 1 A node equation at C gives 1 1 1 Vπ + + gm Vπ + Vπ 1 + 2 =0 sL2 R sL1 s L2 C 1 1 1 1 1 + + gm + + 2 + s L1 L2 R s L2 CR 1 =0 s3 L1 L2 C 1 1 1 1 + s2 + + s3 gm + +s R L1 L2 L2 CR 1 =0 L1 L2 C 1 1 + + jω −ω2 gm + L2 CR R 1 1 1 + =0 − ω2 L1 L2 C L1 L2 (1) C2 C1 ⇒ C2 = 0.01 × 40 × 1.64 = 0.66 μF ω02 L C1 C2 =1 C1 + C2 1012 × L × 0.01 × 0.66 × 10−6 = 1 0.01 + 0.66 ⇒ L = 101.5 μH To allow oscillations to grow in amplitude, we need gm R > C2 C1 which can be achieved by using a somewhat smaller C2 than the value found above. Exercise 14–4 1 Ex: 14.12 ω0 = 10 Grad/s = 10 × 109 = √ LC 10 10 1 = √ 10 × 10−9 × C Ex: 14.16 vI (t) 10 1ms 5 ⇒ C = 1 pF t Rp = ω0 LQ = 1010 × 10 × 10−9 × 10 = 1000 –10 = 1 k gm |min –5 vO (t) 1 1 = = (Rp ro ) (1 10) × 103 10 = 1.1 mA/V t –10 Ex: 14.13 From Eq. (14.26), we have fs = Time delay = 1 1 = √ 2π LCs 2π 0.52 × 0.012 × 10−12 = 2.015 MHz Ex: 14.17 From Eq. (14.27), we have fp = 2π L = vO 1 Cs Cp Cs + Cp ωo L ∼ ωs L = r r vI 3 Ex: 14.18 |VT | = 50 × 10−3 = 10 Ex: 14.14 VTH = |VTL | = β|L| R1 × 13 R1 + R2 100 = 50 mV 2 R1 R2 10 R2 = R1 0.05 R2 = 200R1 For R1 = 1 k, we have R2 = 200 k. R2 = 1.6 R1 Ex: 14.19 100 R1 = = 0.091 V/V β= R1 + R2 100 + 1000 R2 = 16 k Ex: 14.15 VTH = VTL = vO A comparator with a threshold of 3 V and output levels of ±12 V. ∼ = 55,000 5= ⫹ –12 2π × 2.015 × 106 × 0.52 120 5= ⫺ vI 1 = 2.018 MHz = 3V 12 0.012 × 4 × 10−12 2π 0.52 × 0.012 + 4 Q= 1 ms = 0.125 ms 8 R1 |L| R2 R1 × 10 R2 R2 = 2R1 Possible choice: R1 = 10 k, R2 = 20 k T = 2τ ln 1+β 1−β = 2 × 0.01 × 10−6 × 106 × ln = 0.00365 s 1 = 274 Hz f0 = T 1.091 1 − 0.091 Exercise 14–5 Ex: 14.20 f = 1 = T R2 ⫹ vO ⫺ C⫽ 0.1 μF 500 12.7 ln 11.3 f |25◦ C = 10 k⍀ 500 Hz 12 + VD ln 12 − VD = 4281 Hz At 0◦ C, VD = 0.7 + 0.05 = 0.75 V R 10 k⍀ f |0◦ C = 500 = 3,995 Hz 12.75 ln 11.25 At 50◦ C, VD = 0.7 − 0.05 = 0.65 V T1 = T2 = T /2 f |50◦ C = vO (V) 12 500 = 4,611 Hz 12.65 ln 11.35 At 100◦ C, VD = 0.7 − 0.15 = 0.55 V T/2 T f |100◦ C = t –12 500 = 5,451 Hz. 12.55 ln 11.45 Ex: 14.21 To obtain a triangular waveform with 10-V peak-to-peak amplitude, we should have v⫹ VD VTH = −VTL = 5 V But VTL = −L+ × T/2 T t R1 R2 Thus, −5 = −10 × 10 R2 ⇒ R2 = 20 k –VD For 1-kHz frequency, T = 1 ms. Thus, v⫺ VD T /2 = 0.5 × 10−3 = CR 0 = 0.01 × 10−6 × R × 10/10 t ⇒ R = 50 k T/2 ⫺VD T1 VTH − VTL L+ Ex: 14.22 Using Eq. (14.38), we obtain 12.7 100 × 10−6 = 0.1 × 10−6 × R3 ln 10.8 T2 R3 = 6171 During T1 , we have v − (t) = 12 − (12 + VD ) e−t/τ Ex: 14.23 T = 1.1CR ⇒ R = T /1.1C = 9.1 k v − = VD at t = T /2 VD = 12 − (12 + VD ) e−T /2τ 12 + VD T = 2τ ln 12 − VD = 2 × 0.1 × 10−6 × 10 × 103 × ln Ex: 14.24 T = 0.69C(RA + 2RB ) 12 + VD 12 − VD 1 = 0.69 × 103 × 10−12 (RA + 2RB ) 100 × 103 ⇒ RA + 2RB = 1 = 14.49 k 0.69 × 10−4 (1) Exercise 14–6 At v = 3 V, the circuit provides Using Eq. (14.47), we obtain 0.75 = RA + RB RA + 2RB i= RA + RB = 0.75 × 14.49 = 10.88 k (2) (1) − (2) ⇒ RB = 3.61 k 3 = 0.6 mA, while ideally 5 i = 0.1 × 9 = 0.9 mA. Thus the error is −0.3 mA. * At v = 5 V, the circuit provides Now, substituting into (2), we get i= RA = 7.27 k Use 7.2 k and 3.6 k, standard 5% resistors. 5 5−3 + = 2.6 mA, while ideally 5 1.25 i = 0.1 × 25 = 2.5 mA. Thus the error is +0.1 mA. * At v = 7 V, the circuit provides Ex: 14.25 i= i ⫹ R2 R3 i = 0.1 × 49 = 4.9 mA. Thus the error is –0.3 mA. * At v = 10 V, the circuit provides, R1 v 7 7−3 + = 4.6 mA, while ideally 5 1.25 3V 7V i= ⫺ 10 10 − 3 10 − 7 + + = 10 mA, 6 1.25 1.25 while ideally i = 10 mA. Thus the error is 0 A. i = 0.1v 2 At v = 2 V, we obtain i = 0.4 mA. Thus, R1 = 2 = 5 k. 0.4 For 3 V ≤ V ≤ 7 V, we have i= v v −3 + R1 R2 To obtain a perfect match at V = 4 V ( i.e., to obtain i = 1.6 mA), we need 1.6 = 4 4−3 + 5 R2 Ex: 14.26 VCC R2 = 1.25 k For v ≥ 7V , we have i= RC v v −3 v −7 + + R1 R2 R3 To obtain a perfect match at v = 8V , we must select R3 so that i = 6.4 mA: 6.4 = 8 8 − 3 8.7 + + 5 1.25 R3 ⇒ R3 = 1.25 k RC ⫺ vO ⫹ Q1 vI Q2 ⫹ 2·42 VT ⫺ I R ⫺VEE I Exercise 14–7 Ie1 = I + (2.42 VT ) /R 2.42 VT =I 1+ IR 2.42 VT =I 1+ 2.5 V T 2.42 =I 1+ 2.5 2.42 Ic1 ∼ = I 1+ 2.5 2.42 Ic2 ∼ = I 1− 2.5 v O = (VCC − Ic2 RC ) − (VCC − Ic1 RC ) = (Ic1 − Ic2 ) RC = IRC × 2 × 2.42 2.5 = 0.25 × 10 × 2 × 2.42 = 4.84 V 2.5 Chapter 14–1 14.1 Since the second-order bandpass filter will exhibit zero phase at ω = ω0 , the circuit if it oscillates will do so at Thus, the poles will be in the left half of the s-plane at a radial frequency ω0 and a horizontal distance from the jω axis of ω = ω0 σ =− For the circuit to oscillate, the magnitude of the gain at ω = ω0 must be at least unity, thus (a) For the poles to be on the jω axis, we need AK ≥ 1 σ =0 For sustained oscillations, we have ⇒ AK = 1 AK = 1 14.2 (a) The bandpass function can be written as ω0 Ks Q T (s) = ω 0 + ω02 s2 + s Q ωω0 j K Q T (jω) = ωω0 (ω02 − ω2 ) + j Q Thus, φ(ω) = 90◦ − tan−1 dφ = dω 1+ × =− 1 Q2 ωω0 /Q ω02 − ω2 1 ωω0 ω02 − ω2 2 × which is achieved by making AK = 2 14.4 1 Q (ω02 − ω2 )ω0 − ωω0 (−2ω) (ω02 − ω2 )2 dφ 2Q (ω = ω0 ) = − dω ω0 (b) For a change in phase φ, the corresponding change in ω0 will be =− (b) For the poles in the right half of the s-plane at ω0 , we a horizontal distance from the jω axis of 2Q have ω0 σ =+ 2Q (ω0 /Q)(ω02 + ω2 ) 1 (ω02 − ω2 )2 + 2 ω2 ω02 Q ω0 = ω0 (1 − AK) 2Q φ d φ/d ω φ 2Q/ω0 ω0 φ ⇒ =− ω0 2Q Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the resulting circuit. Here Rp can be found from Rp = ω0 LQ where 1 1 ω0 = √ = √ 1 × 10−6 × 100 × 10−12 LC = 108 rad/s Thus, Rp = 108 × 1 × 10−6 × 50 = 5 k The total parallel resistance can now be found as 14.3 The characteristic equation is obtained as follows: 1 − L(s) = 0 ω0 Ks Q =0 1−A ω0 2 + ω02 s +s Q ω0 ⇒ s2 + s (1 − AK) + ω02 = 0 Q R = Ri Ro Rp = 5 5 5 = 1.67 k The circuit will oscillate when the loop gain is unity, that is, Gm R = 1 ⇒ Gm = 1 = 0.6 mA/V R Chapter 14–2 and the frequency of oscillation will be f0 = 10 ω0 = = 15.92 MHz 2π 2π 8 14.5 (a) A change of +1% in the value of L causes a change of −0.5% in the value of ω0 . (b) A change of +1% in the value C causes a change of −0.5% in the value of ω0 . (c) Since ω0 does not depend on the value of R, there will be no change in ω0 as R changes by +1%. 14.6 For the circuit to oscillate, two conditions must be satisfied: (1) The total phase shift around the loop should be 0 or 360◦ , and (2) The loop gain must be at least unity. Here we have three amplifier stages (Fig. P14.6). Thus the phase angle of each amplifier at the oscillation frequency ω0 , must be 120◦ . Now, for each amplifier stage we have Vo = −gm Vi 1 1 + sC R gm R Vo =− Vi 1 + sCR At s = jω0 , we have gm R Vo (jω0 ) = − Vi 1 + jω0 CR =− = gm R(1 − jω0 CR) 1 + (ω0 CR)2 gm R (−1 + jω0 CR) 1 + (ω0 CR)2 For the phase angle to be 120◦ , we need 14.7 For oscillations to begin, the total phase shift around the loop at ω0 must be 0 or 360◦ . Since the phase shift of the frequency-selective network is 180◦ , the amplifier must have a phase shift of 180◦ . Also, the loop gain at ω0 must be at least unity. Since the frequency-selective network has 12-dB attenuation, the amplifier gain must be at least 12 dB or 4 V/V. 14.8 Refer to Fig. 14.4(e). L+ = −L− = 3 V R4 R3 = = 0.05 R1 R1 Now, L+ = V R4 R4 + 0.7 1 + R5 R5 thus, R4 R4 3 = 5 + 0.7 1 + R5 R5 ⇒ R4 2.3 = R5 5.7 R3 2.3 = R2 5.7 (3) Selecting R1 = 100 k, Eq. (1) gives R3 = R4 = 5 k Then using Eqs. (2) and (3), we obtain R2 = R5 = 5 × 5.7 = 12.4 k 2.3 14.9 Refer to Fig. 1 on the next page. By connecting VB and RB , we are injecting a current into the virtual ground node of VB /RB . To neutralize this current, v I has to be at a negative value that pulls an equal current through R1 . Thus, the comparator threshold shifts from v I = 0 to v I = −VB R1 RB To obtain a −2-V threshold with VB = 5 V, we have R1 −2 = −5 RB = 0.5gm R ⇒ For a loop gain of unity, we have For a comparator input resistance of 100 k, we have (0.5gm R) = 1 gm R = 2 gm |min 2 = R (2) Similarly, from the equation for L− we obtain tan 60 = ω0 CR √ 3 ⇒ ω0 = CR Vo gm R (jω0 ) = gm R = √ V 1+3 i 1 + (ω0 CR)2 3 (1) R1 2 = RB 5 R1 = 100 k Using Eq. (1), we obtain RB = 250 k (1) Chapter 14–3 This figure belongs to Problem 14.9. Slope 5 V R1 RB VB 5 V with VB , RB without VB , RB R3 vO VB/RB vO L 3 V R2 vI R4 R1 R1 VB RB R4 2 V R4 5 V 0 vI L 3 V Slope R2 R1 Figure 1 To obtain a slope of 0.05 in the limiting regions, we use R3 R4 = = 0.05 R1 R1 = s/CR s2 + s(3/CR) + 1 (CR)2 which is a bandpass function with a center frequency ω0 given by thus, 1 CR R3 = R4 = 5 k ω0 = To obtain L+ = −L− = 3 V, we use Eqs. (14.8) and (14.9) with VD = 0, thus and a pole-Q of 1 3 Q= R3 R4 3 = = R2 R5 5 and a center-frequency gain of 5×5 = 8.33 k ⇒ R2 = R5 = 3 Gain = For standard 5% resistors, use: R1 = 100 k, RB = 240 k, R3 = R4 = 5.1 k, R2 = R4 = 8.2 k. 1 3 14.11 The characteristic equation can be written using the expression for the loop gain in Eq. (14.10) as follows: 14.10 Refer to Fig. 14.5. 1 − L(s) = 0 Zp Va = Vb Zp + Zs 1− = 1 1 + Zs Yp = 1 1 1 1+ R+ + sC sC R = 1 + R2 /R1 3 + sCR + 1 sCR R2 1 −1− =0 sCR R1 R2 1 =0 CR + s2 + s 2 − R1 (CR)2 3 + sCR + Thus the poles have 1 1 + 1 + 1 + sCR + 1 sCR =0 ω0 = 1 CR Chapter 14–4 To obtain an 8-V peak-to-peak output, we use R5 R5 15 + 1+ × 0.7 R6 R6 V̂o = 4 = 2 1 R5 − 3 3 R6 and Q= 1 2− R2 R1 The poles will be on the jω axis for R2 /R1 = 2 and will be in the right half of the s-plane for R2 /R1 > 2. Q.E.D. ⇒ R5 = 0.115 R6 Since R5 = 1 k, then 14.12 If the closed-loop amplifier in Fig. 14.5 exhibits a phase shift of −3◦ for ω around ω0 , then the loop-gain expression in Eq. (14.11) becomes L(jω) = −jφ (1 + R2 /R1 )e 3 + j(ωCR − 1/ωCR) If R3 and R6 are open circuited, substituting R6 = ∞ in Eq. (1) yields 3π = π/60 180 V̂o = 1.5VD = 1.05 V This result can be obtained directly from the circuit: If R3 and R6 are open circuited, the positive peak of the output will be the voltage at which D2 conducts. At this point, v O = V̂o and 1 2 v 1 = V̂o , thus the voltage across VD is V̂o or, 3 3 equivalently, Oscillation will occur at the frequency ω0 for which the phase angle of L(jω) is 0◦ : 1 −1 1 −φ = tan ω0 CR − 3 ω0 CR ω0 CR − ⇒ ω02 1 = −3 tan 3◦ = −0.157 ω0 CR V̂o = 1.5VD 0.157 1 ω0 − + =0 CR (CR)2 ⇒ ω0 = and R3 = 8.66 k where φ= R6 = 8.66 k A similar situation occurs at the negative peak at which diode D1 conducts and the voltage across it 2 will be V̂o , etc. 3 0.925 CR 14.13 Refer to Fig. 14.6. Assume that R3 = R6 and R4 = R5 and consider the magnitude of the positive peak. When v O = V̂o , D2 just conducts and clamps node b to a voltage V̂o Vb = V1 + VD + VD . Neglecting the current 3 through D2 , we can write 14.14 R2 R1 sCV1 0 V1 Vˆo − Vb Vb − (−15) = R5 R6 V1 sCV1R Substituting V1 (1 sCR) R Figure 1 1 V̂o + VD 3 we obtain R5 R5 15 + 1+ VD R6 R6 V̂o = 2 1 R5 − 3 3 R6 C R C R5 R5 V̂o = 1 + Vb + 15 R6 R6 Vo I R sCV1 Thus, Vb = V1 (1) Figure 1 shows the circuit and some of the analysis for the purpose of determining the transfer function of the RC circuit. The current I is given by I= V1 (1 + sCR) + sCV1 R Chapter 14–5 For Vo we now can write Vo = V1 (1 + sCR) + I sC V1 (1 + sCR) + V1 sCR V1 s/CR ⇒ = 1 3 Vo + s2 + s CR (CR)2 = V1 (1 + sCR) + The loop gain L(s) can now be found as R2 CR s 1+ R1 L(s) = 1 3 + s2 + s CR (CR)2 R2 jω 1 + CR R1 L(jω) = 1 3ω − ω2 + j (CR)2 CR 2 ⇒ ω01 + 0.3 1 ω01 − =0 CR (CR)2 ⇒ ω01 = 0.86 CR That is, the frequency of oscillation is reduced by 14% to f01 = 0.86f0 = 8.6 kHz To restore operation to f0 = 10 kHz, we modify the shunt resistor R to Rx , as indicated in Fig. 1. C Rx Va C Vo Figure 1 Zero phase shift will occur at ω = ω0 : 1 CR At ω = ω0 , we have R2 1 1+ |L(jω)| = 3 R1 R ω0 = For oscillations to begin, we need R2 1 1+ ≥1 3 R1 R2 ≥2 R1 ⇒ CR = 0.159 × 10−4 s For R = 10 k, we have 0.159 × 10−4 = 1.59 nF 10 × 103 Now, refer to Eq. (14.11). If the closed-loop ◦ amplifier hasan excess phase lag of 5.7 , then the R2 −j5.7◦ gain will be 1 + . Oscillations will e R1 occur at the frequency ω01 at which the phase angle of the denominator is −5.7◦ , that is, 1 1 = −5.7◦ tan−1 ω01 CR − 3 ω01 CR ω01 CR − = = 14.15 First we design the circuit to operate at 10 kHz. 1 ω0 = CR 1 2π × 10 × 103 = CR C= We now require the feedback RC circuit to have a phase shift of −(−5.7◦ ) = +5.7◦ at f = 10 kHz. The transfer function of the RC circuit can be found as follows: Zp Va = Vo Zp + Zs 1 = 3 tan(−5.7◦ ) = −0.3 ω01 CR 1 1 + Zs Yp 1 1+ R+ sC = R 2+ Rx 1 1 + sC Rx 1 + sCR + 1 sCRx For s = jω, we have Va = Vo 2+ R Rx 1 + j ωCR − 1 ωCRx Va must be +5.7◦ Vo or equivalently, the phase angle of the denominator must be −5.7◦ . Thus, At ω = ω0 , the phase angle of 1 ω0 CRx tan−1 = −5.7◦ R 2+ Rx 1 R ω0 CR − = 2+ tan(−5.7◦ ) ω0 CRx Rx R = 2+ × −0.0998 Rx ω0 CR − Chapter 14–6 Now, ω0 CR = 1, thus R R 1− = −0.0998 2 + Rx Rx inverting input terminal will be (V̂o /3). Some of the analysis is shown in the figure. We complete the analysis as follows: R R (1 − 0.0998) ⇒ = 1.33 Rx Rx ⇒ Rx = 0.75 R = 7.5 k 5 V̂o − V̂o − 0.65 50 6 I1 = = 10V̂o − V̂o − 6.5 0.1 6 At ω = ω0 and for Rx = 7.5 k Va 1 (ω0 ) = 10 10 Vo 2+ +j 1− 7.5 7.5 5 V̂o − V̂o 5 6 = 0.1V̂o − V̂o I2 = 10 60 1 + 2 × 0.0998 = I1 + I2 = 1 3.33 − j0.33 Va 1 1 (ω0 ) = = V 3.35 o (3.33)2 + (0.33)2 = V̂o 30 Thus, 5 V̂o 50 + 0.1 − − 6.5 = V̂o 10 − 6 60 30 Thus the magnitude of the gain of the amplifier must be 3.35 V/V. Thus, R2 /R1 must be changed to ⇒ V̂o = 3.94 V Thus the peak-to-peak of the output sinusoid will be 2 × 3.94 = 7.88 V. R2 = 2.35 R1 14.17 Refer to Fig. 1, below. 14.16 I1 = Vo V 5 15 o Vo 30 3 6 0.1 k I1 10 k Vo 30 0 10 k I3 = I1 + I2 = Vo /3 V o 30 10 (1) I2 = sCV1 I2 Vo /3 Rf V1 R R ⇒ V1 = − Vo Rf Vo = −Rf I1 = − 0.65 V 15 k V1 R Vo I3 = Figure 1 V1 + sCV1 R V1 (1 + sCR) R V2 = V1 + I3 R = V1 (2 + sCR) The circuit in Fig. 1 depicts the situation when v O = V̂o . We made use of the fact that for sustained oscillations the closed-loop gain of the amplifier must be 3. Thus the voltage at the I4 = sCV2 = sCV1 (2 + sCR) I5 = I3 + I4 = V1 (1 + sCR) + sCV1 (2 + sCR) R This figure belongs to Problem 14.17. Rf I1 X I7 Vx R V3 I5 R V2 I3 R V1 I1 R I6 I4 I2 C C C Figure 1 Vo Chapter 14–7 V3 = V2 + I5 R C= = V1 (2 + sCR) + V1 (1 + sCR) + sCRV1 (2 + sCR) Rf = 56 × 10 = 560 k = V1 (3 + s4CR + s2 C 2 R2 ) I6 = sCV3 14.18 Figure 1 shows the circuit with the additional resistance R included. The loop has been broken at the output of the op amp. The analysis will determine Vo /Vx and equate it to unity, which is the condition for sustained oscillations. = sCV1 (3 + s4CR + s2 C 2 R2 ) I7 = I5 + I6 V1 (1 + sCR) + sCV1 (5 + s5CR + s2 C 2 R2 ) R Vx = V3 + I7 R = To begin, observe that the voltage V1 is related to Vo by = V1 (3 + s4CR + s C R ) 2 2 2 Rf Vo =− V1 R +V1 (1 + sCR) + V1 (s5CR + s2 5C 2 R2 + s3 C 3 R3 ) = V1 (4 + s 10CR + s 6C R + s C R ) 2 2 2 3 √ 10 = 3.36 nF 2π × 15 × 103 × 10 × 103 3 3 (1) Also, the current I1 is given by Substituting for V1 from Eq. (1) and equating Vx with Vo , we obtain V1 (2) R We now proceed to determine the various currents and voltages of the RC network as follows: I1 = Rf = 4 + s 10CR + s2 6 C 2 R2 + s3 C 3 R3 R For s = jω − V2 = V1 + Rf = (4 − 6 ω2 C 2 R2 ) + jω (10CR − ω2 C 3 R3 ) − R Equating the imaginary part on the RHS to zero, we obtain for the frequency of oscillation ω0 √ 10 ω0 = CR Equating the real parts on both sides gives the condition for sustained oscillations as Rf 10 = 6 2 2 C 2 R2 − 4 = 56 R C R That is, 1 I1 sC 1 V1 1 = V1 1 + sC R sCR V2 V1 1 = 1+ I2 = R R sCR V1 1 V1 + 1+ I3 = I1 + I2 = R R sCR 1 V1 2+ = R sCR = V1 + V3 = V2 + Rf = 56R I3 sC V1 1 + 2+ = V1 sCR sCR 1 3 + = V1 1 + sCR s2 C 2 R2 V1 V3 3 1 = 1+ + 2 2 2 I4 = R R sCR s C R 1 1+ sCR Numerical values: f0 = 15 kHz R = 10 k √ 10 CR = 2π × 15 × 103 This figure belongs to Problem 14.18. Rf V1 C Vx V3 I3 C C V2 R I5 I1 R R I4 I2 Figure 1 Vo Chapter 14–8 I5 = I3 + I4 1 V1 V1 3 1 2+ = + 1+ + 2 2 2 R sCR R sCR s C R 4 1 V1 3+ + = R sCR s2 C 2 R2 I5 Vx = V3 + sC 3 1 + 2 2 2 = V1 1 + sCR s C R 4 1 V1 3+ + 2 2 2 + sCR sCR s C R 5 1 6 + 2 2 2 + 3 3 3 = V1 1 + sCR s C R sC R 14.19 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 14.10 with the limiter eliminated and with the loop broken at X to determine the loop gain L(s) = Vo2 Vx To determine L(s), we note that it is the product of the transfer functions of the inverting integrator formed around op amp 1: 1 Vo1 =− Vx sCR (1) and the noninverting integrator formed around op amp 2. To obtain the transfer function of the latter, refer to Fig. 1. Now, by replacing V1 by the value from Eq. (1), we obtain 1 6 R 5 Vx = −Vo 1+ + 2 2 2 + 3 3 3 Rf sCR s C R sC R For sustained oscillations Vo = Vx , thus − Rf 6 5 1 =1+ + + 3 3 3 R sCR s2 C 2 R2 sC R For s = jω, we have Figure 1 Rf 6 5 1 =1+ − 2 2 2 − 3 3 3 − R jωCR ω C R jω C R 5 6 1 = 1− 2 2 2 −j − ω C R ωCR ω3 C 3 R3 Thus, oscillation will occur at the frequency that renders the imaginary part of the RHS zero: 1 6 = 3 3 3 : ω0 CR ω0 C R Rf 5 =1− = −29 R 1/6 Thus, which is the minimum required value for Rf to obtain sustained oscillations. Numerical values: 1 √ 2π 6 × 16 × 10−9 × 10 × 103 Rf = 290 k Vo2 = Vo1 1 1 R sCR + − 2 Rf 2R , we obtain 1+ 1 (2) 2 Using Eqs. (1) and (2), we obtain the loop gain as sCR − L(s) = − Rf = 29R = 406 Hz Vo2 = Vo1 Substituting for Rf = At this frequency, the real part of the RHS must be equal to (−Rf /R): f0 = 1 Vo1 − Vo2 Vo2 Vo2 2 + = sC 2R 2Rf 2 ⇒ 1 ⇒ ω0 = √ 6CR − Writing a node equation at the positive input terminal of op amp 2, we obtain 1 sCR 1 2 The characteristic equation can now be written as sCR − 1 − L(s) = 0 1 sCR 1 =0 2 +1=0 sCR sCR − 2 1+ sCR − Chapter 14–9 s2 − s 1 1 + 2 2 =0 CR 2 C R Thus, the poles are s= 1 2CR 2 ± 1 2 1 C 2 R2 2 2 − 4 C 2 R2 For 4, we have 1 ±j s CR 4 R= Thus, relative to the fundamental, we have: (a) The second harmonic = 0. (b) The third harmonic from which it is obvious that the poles are in the right half of the s-plane. Q.E.D. 14.20 ω0 = For the nth harmonic, we have ω = nω0 , where n = 3, 5, 7, ...... Since n is large and Q = 20 is large, we obtain 1 |T (jω)| 1/Q n − n = 1/3 1 20 3 − 3 = 6.25 × 10−3 (c) The fifth harmonic 1 CR 1 2π × 10 × 103 × 1.6 × 10−9 = 9.95 k The square wave v 2 will have a peak-to-peak amplitude 1/5 1 20 5 − 5 = 2.08 × 10−3 (d) The rms of harmonics to the tenth: = 1.04 × 10−3 The component at the fundamental frequency ω0 will have a peak-to-peak amplitude of 4 V/π = 1.78 V. The filter has a center-frequency gain of 2, thus at v 1 the sine wave will have a peak-to-peak amplitude of approximately 3.6 V. The ninth harmonic = 14.21 The different harmonic components will be attenuated relative to the fundamental by the selective response of the bandpass circuit. Let us first determine the magnitude of the transmission of the bandpass filter at a frequency ω relative to that at the fundamental frequency ω0 , ω0 s Q T (s) = ω 0 s2 + s + ω02 Q ωω0 Q |T (jω)| = = 1/ 1 + Q2 ω02 − ω2 ωω0 2 ω ω0 − ω ω0 1/9 20 9 − 1 9 1 7 = 0.625 × 10−3 Thus, the rms of harmonics to the tenth = 6.252 + 2.082 + 1.042 + 0.6252 × 10−3 = 6.70 × 10−3 14.22 G sC2Vgs D sC2Vgs C2 Vgs L gmVgs S C1 RL Figure 1 (ω02 − ω2 )2 + = 1/ 1 + Q2 1/7 20 7 − V = 1.4 V The output amplitude can be doubled by adding a diode in series with each of the diodes in the limiter. The seventh harmonic = ωω0 Q 2 Figure 1 shows the equivalent circuit together with some of the analysis. The voltage at the gate, Vg , can be expressed as Vg = −s2 LC2 Vgs 2 (1) The voltage at the source, Vs , can be expressed as Vs = Vg − Vgs Chapter 14–10 Thus, Vs = −s2 LC2 Vgs − Vgs (2) A node equation at S provides 1 sC2 Vgs + gm Vgs = + sC1 Vs RL The voltage Ve can be expressed as Substituting for Vs from Eq. (2), we obtain 1 sC2 Vgs + gm Vgs = − + sC1 (s2 LC2 + 1)Vgs RL Dividing by Vgs and collecting terms, we obtain LC2 1 s3 LC1 C2 +s2 +s(C1 +C2 )+ gm + =0 RL RL For s = jω, we have jω[−ω2 LC1 C2 + (C1+ C2 )] + 1 LC2 gm + − ω2 =0 RL RL (3) This is the equation that governs the operation of the oscillator circuit. The frequency of oscillation ω0 is the value of ω at which the imaginary part is zero, thus C1 C2 2 ω0 = 1 L (4) C1 + C2 ⇒ ω0 = 1 L C1 C2 C1 + C2 The condition for sustained oscillations can be found by equating the real part of Eq. (3) to zero and making use of (4), thus 1 C1 + C2 1 gm + = RL C1 RL ⇒ gm RL = C2 C1 Ve = Vb − Vπ Thus, Ve = −sL 1 + sC2 Vπ − Vπ rπ C2 C1 Substituting for Ve from Eq. (2), we obtain 1 1 + sC2 Vπ − sL − sC1 + RL rπ 1 sC1 + Vπ RL 1 = gm + Vπ + sC2 Vπ rπ Dividing by Vπ and collecting terms, we obtain C1 C2 + + s3 LC1 C2 + s2 L rπ RL 1 1 L =0 + (C1 + C2 ) + gm + + s RL rπ rπ RL For s = jω, we have L + (C1 + C2 ) jω −ω2 LC1 C2 + RL rπ 1 1 C1 C2 + + − ω2 L + gm + rπ RL rπ RL (3) This is the equation that governs the operation of the oscillator circuit. The frequency of oscillation ω0 is the value of ω at which the imaginary part becomes zero, thus ω02 = 14.23 (2) Writing a node equation at E, we obtain 1 1 Ve = gm + Vπ + sC2 Vπ sC1 + RL rπ =0 To ensure that oscillations start, we use gm RL > Figure 1 shows the equivalent circuit together with some of the analysis. The voltage Vb can be expressed as 1 Vb = −sL + sC2 Vπ (1) rπ C1 + C2 1 + LC1 C2 RL rπ C1 C2 (4) Note that for rπ large so that the second term on the RHS can be neglected, we have C1 C2 L ω02 1 C1 + C2 ω0 = 1 Figure 1 L C1 C2 C1 + C2 which is the expected value. Taking rπ into account will shift the oscillation frequency slightly from this value. (5) Chapter 14–11 Substituting for Vc from (1), we obtain 1 1 −Vπ − gm + + sC2 Vπ = sC1 RL 1 + sC2 Vπ sL RL The condition for sustained oscillations can be obtained by equating the real part of Eq. (3) to zero and making use of (4), thus gm + 1 1 + = rπ RL 1 C2 C1 C1 + C2 + + L LC1 C2 RL rπ C1 C2 rπ RL (6) s3 LC1 C2 + s2 For rπ large, we have 1 C1 + C2 C2 gm + RL C1 C2 RL gm RL + 1 = 1 + ⇒ gm RL = jω[−ω2 LC1 C2 + (C1 +C2 )] + 1 LC1 −ω2 + gm + =0 RL RL C2 C1 C2 C1 (7) C2 C1 14.24 Vc C1 E C2 gmVp − Vp rp L C1 C2 C1 + C2 The condition for sustained oscillation can be found by equating the real part in Eq. (2) to zero at ω = ω0 and by making use of Eq. (3). Thus, I1 L C1 + C2 1 1 + gm + =0 C2 RL RL C1 C2 While to ensure that oscillations start, we make C1 gm RL > C2 Observe then in this circuit, we did not have to resort to assuming rπ to be large in order to obtain simplified expressions. Here rπ is simply included with RL to obtain RL and thus can be easily taken into account. A drawback of our analysis, however, is that ro was not taken into account. ⇒ gm RL = RL B RL RL rp Figure 1 Figure 1 shows the equivalent circuit where we have neglected ro . A node equation at E provides the following expression for I1 : 1 + sC2 I1 = Vπ gm + RL 14.25 The collector voltage Vc can now be found as 1 I1 sC1 1 1 Vc = −Vπ − + sC2 Vπ gm + sC1 RL Vc = −Vπ − A node equation at C provides 1 Vc = Vπ gm + + sC2 − gm Vπ sL RL 1 + sC2 = Vπ RL (2) This is the equation that governs the operation of the oscillator circuit. The frequency of oscillation ω0 is the value of ω at which the imaginary part is zero, thus 1 ω02 = (3) C1 C2 L C1 + C2 or ω0 = 1 C LC1 1 + s(C1 + C2 ) + gm + =0 RL RL For s = jω, we have To ensure that oscillations start, we use gm RL > Dividing by Vπ and collecting terms results in (1) Figure 1 Chapter 14–12 Figure 1 shows the equivalent circuit where ro has been absorbed into RL . We have neglected Rf with the assumption that Rf ω0 L. Some of the analysis is shown on Fig. 1. Note that, Vb = Vπ Vc = Vb + sL 1 + sC2 Vπ rπ The condition for sustained oscillations can be found from Eq. (2) by equating the real part to zero at ω = ω0 and making use of (3), thus 1 1 1 C1 C2 + = + gm + C1 C2 RL rπ RL rπ L C1 + C2 + RL rπ gm + Thus, 1 Vπ Vc = Vπ + sL sC2 + rπ (1) A node equation at E yields 1 1 Vπ + sC2 + gm Vπ + Vc + sC1 = 0 rπ RL 1 1 + = RL rπ C1 + C2 + (L/RL rπ ) C1 C2 C1 C2 + RL rπ Neglecting the terms containing rπ , we obtain 1 C2 1 = 1+ gm + RL C1 RL ⇒ gm RL = C2 C1 For oscillations to start, we need Substituting for Vc from Eq. (1), we obtain 1 1 Vπ + sC2 + gm Vπ + + sC1 Vπ rπ RL 1 1 + + sC1 sL sC2 + =0 RL rπ gm RL > C2 C1 14.26 (a) Dividing by Vπ and collecting terms gives LC1 LC2 s3 LC1 C2 + s2 + + RL rπ 1 L 1 s C1 + C2 + + =0 + gm + RL rπ rπ RL For s = jω, we have jω −ω2 LC1 C2 + C1 + C2 + 1 RL rπ Figure 1 1 1 C2 C1 + − ω2 L + = 0 (2) + gm + rπ RL RL rπ This is the equation that governs the operation of the oscillator circuit. The frequency of oscillation ω0 is the value of ω that makes the imaginary part zero, thus ⎡ ⎤ ⎢ ⎥ C1 C2 ⎥ (3) ω02 = 1 ⎢ ⎣L L ⎦ (C1 + C2 ) + RL rπ Observe that including rπ changes the frequency of oscillation slightly from that of the frequency of the resonance circuit. If we neglect the term containing rπ in Eq. (3), we obtain ω0 1 C1 C2 L C1 + C2 (4) Figure 1 shows the equivalent circuit. (b) Oscillations will occur at the frequency for which the tuned circuit has infinite impedance. This is because at this frequency the phase shift around the loop will be zero. Thus, √ ω0 = 1/ LC At this frequency, no current flows through R. Thus the voltage Vc2 will be Vc2 = (gm2 Veb2 )RC and the voltage Vo will equal Vc2 , thus (gm2 Veb2 )RC = Vo = 2Veb2 which yields the condition for sustained oscillation as gm2 RC = 2 Chapter 14–13 For oscillations to start, we impose the condition gm2 RC > 2 (1) But gm2 I /2 VT Thus, the condition in (1) can be expressed as IRC > 4VT that is, IRC > 0.1 V (c) Selecting IRC = 1 V means that oscillations will start and will grow in amplitude until Vo is large enough to cause Q1 and Q2 to alternately turn on and off. When this happens the collector current of Q2 will be 0 in half a cycle and equal to I in the other half cycle. Thus a square wave voltage of amplitude IRC = 1 V peak-to-peak will develop at the collector of Q2 . This square wave voltage is applied through R to the bandpass filter formed by the RLC circuit. Thus, the sinusoid that develops across the LC circuit—that is, Vo —will havea frequency ω0 and a peak-to-peak 4 4 ×1 = V . There will be amplitude of π π third, fifth, and other odd harmonics, but those will be attenuated because of the selectivity of the bandpass RLC circuit. 14.27 ω0 = 20 Grad/s = 20 × 109 rad/s 1 ω0 = √ LC ∴ f 0H = 20 × 10 = √ 5 × 10−9 × C ⇒ C = 0.5 pF 2π 0.52 × 0.01197 × 10−12 1/2 = 2.0173 MHz 1/2 −1 f0L = 2π 0.52 × 0.01198 × 10−12 = 2.0165 MHz Difference = 800 Hz 14.29 VTH = −VTL = 1 V L+ = −L− = 5 V VTH = βL+ 1= ⇒ R1 ×5 R1 + R2 R2 =4 R1 R2 = 40 k 14.30 Rp = ω0 LQ −9 = 20 × 10 × 5 × 10 9 × 10 V = 1000 = 1 k ro Rp = 5 1 = gm |min = 1 For R1 = 10 k, we have 1 9 C2 = 10 pF C1 = 1 to 10 pF 10 × 1 0.012 4 + 10 + 1 = 0.01197 pF CL = 10 0.012 + 4 + 11 10 × 10 0.012 4 + 10 + 10 = 0.01198 pF CH = 100 0.012 + 4 + 20 1 5 × 103 6 5 k 6 = 1.2 mA/V 14.28 From Exercise 14.13, we have L = 0.52 H Cs = 0.012 pF Cp = 4 pF C1 C2 Cs Cp + C1 + C 2 Ceq = C1 C2 Cs + Cp + C1 + C 2 R3 R2 R1 vI vO Figure 1 (a) Refer to Fig. 1. With v O = L+ , the voltage at the op amp positive input terminal will be VTH . Now, writing a node equation at the op amp positive input terminal, we have V − VTH L+ − VTH VTH = + R1 R3 R2 Chapter 14–14 1 1 V 1 L+ + + + = R1 R2 R3 R2 R3 L+ V ⇒ VTH = + (R1 R2 R3 ) R2 R3 ∴ V TL Similarly, we can obtain L− V + (R1 R2 R3 ) VTL = R2 R3 Similarly, VR − VTH L− − VR = R2 R1 (b) L+ = −L− = 10 V, V = 15 V, R1 = 10 k 10 15 + (R1 R2 R3 ) VTH = 5.1 = R2 R3 10 15 5.1 5.1 5.1 + + = + R1 R2 R3 R2 R3 4.9 9.9 + R2 R3 −10 15 = 4.9 = + (R1 R2 R3 ) R2 R3 0.51 = VTL −14.9 10.1 + R2 R3 (b) Given VTL = 0 VTH = V /10 Substituting these values, we get 0 = VR (1 + 10/R2 ) − (10/R2 )V 14.9 , we obtain 4.9 −14.9 30.1 + 1.55 = R2 R3 R1 L− R2 R1 = 10 k (1) (2) Multiplying Eq. (1) by VTH = VR (1 + R1 /R2 ) − L+ = −L− = V 10 15 4.9 4.9 4.9 + + =− + R1 R2 R3 R2 R3 0.49 = R1 R1 VR − L+ R2 R2 R1 R1 = VR 1 + − L+ R2 R2 VTL = VR + VTH V = VR (1 + 10/R2 ) + (10/R2 )V 10 (1) (2) Subtracting Eq. (2) from Eq. (1), we obtain − (3) Adding (2) and (3) gives 20 V =− ×V 10 R2 ⇒ R2 = 200 k 0 = VR (1 + 10/200) − 40.2 2.04 = R3 VR = ⇒ R3 = 19.7 k 10 V 200 V 10/200 V = 1 + 10/200 21 Substituting in Eq. (1), we obtain 0.51 = 14.32 Output levels = ±0.7 V 9.9 4.9 + R2 19.7 Threshold levels = ± 4.9 = 656.7 k ⇒ R2 = 0.0076 iD, max = 10 × 0.7 = 0.1 V 10 + 60 12 − 0.7 0.7 − = 1.12 mA 10 10 + 60 14.31 vO R1 R2 0.7 vI VR (a) For v I = VTL and v O = L+ initially VR − VTL L+ −VR = R2 R1 vO –0.1 0.1 –0.7 vI Chapter 14–15 14.33 (a) A 0.5-V peak sine wave is not large enough to change the state of the circuit. Hence, the output will be either +12 V or –12 V. 14.36 R2 R1 (b) The 1.1-V peak sine wave will change the state when 1.1 sin θ = 1 θ = 65.40 R3 vO R C 1.1 V 1V 0° u u 90° β = 0.462 For VD = 0.7 V and VO = ±5 V, we have VZ = 5 − 2VD ∴ The output is a symmetric square wave of frequency f, and it lags the sine wave by an angle of 65.4◦ . The square wave has a swing of ±12 V. Since VTH = −VTL = 1 V, if the average shifts by an amount so either the +ve or -ve swing is < 1 V, then no change of state will occur. Clearly, if the shift is 0.1 V, the output will be a DC voltage. 14.34 For L+ = −L− = 7.5 V, we have VZ = 6.8 V with VD = 0.7 V. For VTH = −VTL = 7.5, we have V ⇒ R1 = R2 . For v i = 0, we have IR2 = 0.5 mA = 7.5 R1 + R2 ⇒ R1 = R2 = 7.5 k ID = 1 mA = 1= VZ = 3.6 V 1+β T = 2τ ln 1−β 1.462 10−3 = 2τ ln ⇒ τ = 0.5 ms 1 − 0.462 τ = RC ⇒ R = τ /C = 50 k Thresholds = ±0.462 × 5 = ±2.31 V 1 Average current in R in cycle: 2 1 5 − 2.31 + 2.31 + 5 I∼ = R 2 = 5 5 = = 0.1 mA R 50 k Voltage across R 5 2.31 Vavg 5 5 2.31 12 − 7.5 7.5 − R 2R1 4.5 − 0.5 R R = 3 k Vavg 5 5 2.31 5 2.31 5V = 50 k 0.1 mA R1 10 1+β , β= = 1−β R1 + R2 26 1 + 10/26 T = 2 5 × 10−9 62 × 103 ln 1 − 10/26 R1 + R2 = T = 0.503 ms ⇒ f = 1989 Hz ∴ R2 = 26.9 k 14.35 T = 2τ ln R1 = 0.462 → R1 = 50 (0.462) R1 + R2 = 23.1 k Chapter 14–16 1= 13 − 5 − 0.1 − 0.1 R3 8 1.2 = 6.67 k R3 = 14.37 From Fig. 14.25(b), for ±5-V output, we have VZ = 5 − 2VDIODE = 5 − 1.4 = 3.6 V For ±5-V output: R1 = R2 , L+ = −L− = 5 V VTH = −V TL = 5 V Max current in feedback network = 0.2 mA 10 ∴ 0.2 = ⇒ R1 = R2 = 25 k R1 + R2 Minimum zener current = 1 mA 12 − 5 ∴ = (0.2 + 1) mA R3 7 = 5.83 k 1.2 Now from Fig. 14.27(c) we have R3 = Slope = −L− VTH − VTL = RC T /2 for f = 1 kHz T = 10−3 s C = 0.01 μF 5 10 = −3 ⇒ R = 25 k RC 10 /2 14.38 Refer to the circuit of Fig. P14.38. To obtain a square-wave voltage of ±7.5 V levels across the zeners, we need VZ + VD = 7.5 V Figure 1 For VD = 0.7 V, we have VZ = 6.8 V Now, R1 = R2 , thus for the bistable we obtain L+ = −L− = 7.5 V R1 β= = 0.5 R1 + R2 7.5 VTH = −VTL = V 2 As shown in Fig. 1, the voltage across the capacitor will be triangular, ranging between −VTL and +VTH . The slope of the triangular waveform edges is 7.5 7.5 1 Slope = × = R5 C T /2 For R5 = R, we have CR = R= T 1 1 = = 2 2f 2 × 10 × 103 1 = 100 k 2 × 10 × 103 × 0.5 × 10−9 Since all resistors, except R7 , are equal, we have R1 = R2 = R3 = R4 = R5 = R6 = 100 k To determine R7 , we note that the minimum zener current occurs when the current through R5 is at its maximum. The latter condition occurs when Chapter 14–17 the output of the bistable is at +7.5 V while v C is (−7.5/2) V at which time 14.41 See sketches that follow: v A (t = T ) = −Vref = − (L+ − L− ) e−T /RC 7.5 − (−7.5/2) IR5 = Rs = 0.1125 mA Thus, for a minimum zener current of 1 mA, we write 7.5 13 − 7.5 =1+ + 0.1125 R7 R1 + R2 7.5 + 0.1125 =1+ 200 ⇒ R7 = 4.8 k Vref = e−T /RC L+ − L− Vref T = −RC ln L+ − L− L+ − L− Q.E.D. = RC ln Vref Trigger: v vB: 14.39 Refer to Fig. 14.28. The recovery time, trec , is the time for v B to go from βL− to VD1 : Vref v B (t) = L+ − (L+ − βL− )e−t/C1 R3 Thus, vA: VD = L+ − (L+ − βL− )e−trec /C1 R3 ⇒ trec = C1 R3 ln 0 0 Vref L+ − βL− L+ − VD t/RC From Exercise 14.22, we have vA (LL) e (LL) C1 = 0.1 μF, R3 = 6171 , L+ = −L− = 12 V β = 0.1, and VD = 0.7 V, thus −6 trec = 0.1 × 10 12 + 1.2 × 6.171 × 10 ln 12 − 0.7 vO: L 3 = 96 μs T 14.40 Choose C1 = 1 nF and C2 = 0.1 nF: 1 R1 = R2 = 100 k ⇒ β ≡ 2 0.7 + 13 T = C1 R3 ln 0.5 × (−13) + 13 13.7 10−4 = 10−9 R3 ln 13 (0.5) 14.42 For v I > 2/3VCC , comp –1 = “1” and comp –2 = “0” and flip flop is reset, i.e. v O = 0 V. Now v O will not change until v I = 1/3VCC , when comp –2 = “1” and comp –1 = “0” and FF is set: i.e. v O = VCC R3 = 134.1 k For Need R4 R1 ⇒ choose R4 = 470 k L 1 2 VCC < v I < VCC , comp –1 = comp –2 3 3 = “0” and no change of state will occur. The trigger pulse must be sufficiently large to lower the voltage at node C from βL+ to VD , that is, from +6.5 V to +0.7 V; thus it must be at least 5.8 V. vO VCC For recovery we have v B = 13 − 13 − βL− e−t/τ = 13 − 19.5e−t/τ = 0.7 12.3 ∴ t recovery = −τ ln 19.5 −9 3 = − 134.1 × 10 10 (−0.4608) = 61.8 μs 0 VCC 3 2 V 3 CC i.e. an inverting bistable circuit. vI Chapter 14–18 VCC − VTH = e−TH /C(RA +RB ) VCC − VTL VCC − VTL TH = C(RA + RB ) ln VCC − VTH 14.43 C = 680 pF, f = 20 kHz, duty cycle = 80%. Using Eq. (14.46), we obtain T = 0.69C(RA + 2RB ) For exponential fall: Thus, v C = VTH e−t/CRB 1 = 0.69 × 680 × 10−12 (RA + 2RB ) 20 × 103 ⇒ RA + 2RB = ∴ V TL = VTH e−TL /CRB VTH TL = CRB ln VTL 1 20 × 0.69 × 0.68 × 10−6 RA + 2RB = 106.56 k (1) Using Eq. (14.47), we have for VTH = 2VTL ⇒ TL = CRB ln(2) (b) C = 1 nF, RA = 7.2 k, RB = 3.6 k RA + RB 0.8 = RA + 2RB VCC = 5 V, no external voltage to VTH . ∴ T H + TL = T = ln 2 × (RA + 2RB )C Thus, RA + RB = 0.8 × 106.6 = 85.25 k (2) Subtracting Eq. (2) from Eq. (1) gives RB = 21.31 k and using Eq. (2), we obtain RA = 63.94 k T = 9.94 μs → f = 100.6 kHz Duty cycle = ⇒ 75% (c) VCC = 5 V, VTH = 14.44 (a) C = 0.5 nF RA + RB TH = = 0.75 TH + TL RA + 2RB 2 10 ×5= = 3.33 V 3 3 Using Eq. (14.41), we obtain For 1-V input the high value of VTH will be VTH = 4.33 V T∼ = 1.1CR and, VTL = 10 × 10−16 = 1.1 × 0.5 × 10−9 × R ⇒ R = 18.2 k 1 V = 2.17 V 2 TH TH = 10−9(3.6 + 7.2) × 103 ln 5 − 2.17 5 − 4.33 (b) For T = 20 μs, R = 18.2 k, C = 0.5nF, VCC = 12 V, and using Eq. (14.40) with v C = VTH and t = T , we obtain −6 − 20×10 VTH = 12 1 − e 9.1×10−6 = 15.6 μs = 10.67 V Duty cycle = 14.45 For 1-V input the low value of VTH will be VTH = 2.33 VTH TL = 10−9 × 3.6 × 103 ln 2 = 2.5 μs ∴ f = 1 = 55.2 kHz (15.6 + 2.5)10−6 15.6 = 86.2% 2.5 + 15.6 and VTL = 1.17 VTL For the rise: v C = VCC − (VCC − VTL ) e−t/C(RA +RB ) VTH = VCC − (VCC − VTL ) e−TH /C(RA +RB ) 5 − 1.17 ∴ TH = 10 (3.6 + 7.2) 10 ln 5 − 2.33 −9 3 = 3.90 μs TL = TL = 2.5 μs ∴ f = 106 = 156 kHz (3.90 + 2.5) Duty cycle = 3.90 = 61% 2.5 + 3.90 Chapter 14–19 14.46 v I = v O + iD R (2) vI × 90◦ 1.1 (3) Ideal v O = 0.7 sin θ (4) θ= Percentage error in v O = v O − Ideal v O × 100 Ideal v O Figure 1 (5) Equations (1)–(5) can be used for each of the given values of v O to obtain the results given in the table below. For a sine wave, we have v O = 0.7 sin ωt Slope at zero crossings v O (V) = 0.7ω = 0.7 × 2πf 0.70 1.4π = T Slope of triangular wave = we obtain V 1.4π = T T /4 V . Equating slopes, T /4 1.4π = 1.1 V ⇒V = 4 Refer to Fig. 1(b). With v I = V = 1.1 V, we have v O = 0.7 V, thus 0.7 sin θ % Error 0.7 0 ◦ 90 ◦ 0.65 63.6 0.627 3.7 0.60 52.4◦ 0.554 8.2 ◦ 0.55 46.1 0.504 9.1 0.50 41.3◦ 0.462 8.2 0.40 32.80 0.379 5.5 ◦ 0.30 24.6 0.291 3.0 0.20 16.4◦ 0.198 1.2 0.0998 0.1 0 0.0 0.10 v R = 1.1 − 0.7 = 0.4 V θ 0.00 ◦ 8.2 ◦ 0 At VD = 0.7 V we have iD = 1 mA, thus 0.4 = 1 × R 16 = 16f. T Slope at zero crossings of a sine wave with peak amplitude of (VB + 0.7) V is 14.47 Slope of triangular wave = ⇒ R = 0.4 k = 400 The angle θ and the ideal value of the output voltage are determined as follows: = (VB + 0.7)ω Since v D changes by 0.1 V per decade change in current, we have 1 mA v O = 0.7 − 0.1 log iD ⇒ iD = 1010(v O −0.7) , mA Equating slopes, we obtain 16f = (VB + 0.7) × 2πf ⇒ VB = 1.85 V (1) This figure belongs to Problem 14.47. vI 6.8 k 4 V 0 t vI 4 V Slope 16 8V (T/2) s T Figure 1 D1 vO D2 VB VB Chapter 14–20 v O = −IS e 14.48 ln v 1v 2 IS v O = −v 1 v 2 Check: R vI vO 0V vI /R For v 1 = 0.5 V and v 2 = 1 V, we have iD1 = 0.5 mA 0.5 v D1 = 0.7 + 0.025 ln 1 vI > 0 = 0.683 V Voltage across diode is −v O vI = IS e−v O /VT iD = R vO vI − = ln VT RIS vI , vI > 0 v O = −VT ln RIS v A = −0.683 V iD2 = 1 mA v D2 = 0.7 V v B = −0.7 V Q.E.D. 14.49 From the statement of Problem 14.48, we have vI v O = −VT ln IS R Now, for the circuit in Fig. P14.49 we can write v1 v A = −VT ln IS v2 v B = −VT ln IS 1 v C = VT ln IS v1 v2 1 + ln − ln v D = VT ln IS IS IS (v 1 v 2 /IS ) = V ln T Q.E.D. iD3 = 1 mA v C = 0.7 V v D = −(−0.683 − 0.7 + 0.7) = 0.683 V iD4 = IS e0.683/0.025 But, 1 mA = IS e0.7/0.025 ⇒ IS = e−0.7/0.025 , mA iD4 = e(−0.7+0.683)/0.025 = 0.5 mA v O = −0.5 V which is −v 1 v 2 Q.E.D. Other combinations can be used to verify the operation of this analog multiplier. Exercise 15–1 Ex: 15.1 The parameters VOH , VOL , VIL , VIH and thus NML and NMH do not depend on the value R (but on Vx ) and thus their values will not change. VDD 1.8 V ID 30 A RD VOL 90 mV 1.8 V The current IDD drawn from the power supply during the low-output interval becomes VDD − VOL 1.8 − 0.12 = 168 μA = RD 10 IDD = and the power drawn from the supply during the low-output interval is PD = VDD ID = 1.8 × 168 = 302 μW Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1. VOL 90 mV = 3 k = = ID 30 μA rDS Substituting in the expression given for rDS , we get 3= 0.125 × W L 1 × (1.8 − 0.4) W = 1.9 L The value of RD can be obtained from ⇒ RD = VDD − VOL ID 1.8 − 0.09 = 57 k 0.03 When the switch is open, ID = 0 and = PDrawn = VDD ID = 0 When the switch is closed, ID = 30 μA, and PDrawn = VDD ID = 1.8 × 30 = 54 μW Ex: 15.2 VOH = VCC − 0 × RC1,2 = 5 V VOL = VCC − IEE RC1,2 =5−1×2=3V Ex: 15.3 If Vx remains unchanged at 0.089 V, then 1 1 k n RD = = = 11.24 Vx 0.089 For RD to be 10 k, 11.24 = 1.124 mA/V2 kn = 10 Thus, 1.124 = 0.3 × ⇒ W = 3.75 L W L Since the inverter spends half of the time in this state, we have PDaverage = 1 PD = 151 μW 2 Ex: 15.4 k n RD = 1 Vx For RD = 10 k and W = 0.3 × 1.5 = 0.45 mA/V2 kn = kn L we obtain Vx = 1 = 0.22 V 0.45 × 10 Now, VOH = 1.8 V From Eq. (15.22) we get 1.8 = 0.26 V 1.8 − 0.5 1+ 0.22 From Eq. (15.12) we obtain VOL = VIL = Vt + Vx = 0.5 + 0.22 = 0.72 V From Eq. (15.20) we have √ VIH = 0.5 + 1.63 1.8 × 0.22 − 0.22 = 1.31 V Thus, NML = VIL − VOL = 0.72 − 0.26 = 0.46 V NMH = VOH − VIH = 1.8 − 1.31 = 0.49 V During the output-low interval, we have IDD = VDD − VOL RD 1.8 − 0.26 = 154 μA 10 and = PD = 1.8 × 154 = 277.2 μW Thus, PDaverage = 1 PD = 138.6 μW 139 μW 2 Exercise 15–2 Ex: 15.5 Refer to the circuit in Figure 15.21. With v I = VM > Vt , QN will be conducting. Since v O = VM > |Vt | and the gate of QP is at ground, QP will be operating in the triode region, thus iDP = k p (VDD − |Vt |)(VDD − VM ) 1 − (VDD − VM )2 2 (1) Since v O = v I = VM , QN will be operating in saturation, thus (2) VIL = 1 (3VDD + 2Vt ) 8 1 (3 × 1.2 + 2 × 0.4) 8 = 0.55 V = NMH = VOH − VIH = 1.2 − 0.65 = 0.55 V 1 k n (VM − Vt )2 = 2 1 k p (VDD − Vt )(VDD − VM ) − (VDD − VM )2 2 1 r(VM2 − 2Vt VM + Vt2 ) 2 1 2 1 = VDD − VDD Vt + VM Vt − VM2 2 2 1 1 1 r+ VM2 − (r + 1) Vt VM + rVt2 2 2 2 1 2 V − VDD Vt 2 DD 2 (r + 1)VM2 − 2(r + 1)Vt VM + rVt2 = VDD − 2VDD Vt (r + 1)VM2 − 2(r + 1)Vt VM + (r + 1)Vt2 2 = VDD − 2VDD Vt + Vt2 NML = VIL − VOL = 0.55 − 0 = 0.55 V (c) With v I = VDD and v O low, the output resistance is rDSN : W (VDD − Vt ) rDSN = 1 μn Cox L n = 1 = 2.9 k 0.43 × 1(1.2 − 0.4) With v I = 0 V and v O = VDD , the output resistance is rDSP : W μp Cox (VDD − |Vt |) rDSP = 1 L p 1 = 2.9 k 0.43 × 4(1.2 − 0.4) 4 The two output resistances are equal because the inverter is matched. = (r + 1)(VM − Vt )2 = (VDD − Vt )2 VDD − Vt ⇒ VM = Vt + √ r+1 To obtain VIL , we use Eq. (15.36): The noise margins can now be found as 1 k n (VM − Vt )2 2 Equating (1) and (2) gives iDN = = 1 (5 × 1.2 − 2 × 0.4) 8 = 0.65 V = Q.E.D. For VDD = 1.8 V, Vt = 0.4 V, and r = 5, we get (d) Using Eq. (15.39), we obtain 1.8 − 0.4 VM = 0.4 + √ = 0.97 V 5+1 VM = r(VDD − |Vtp |) + Vtn r+1 where Ex: 15.6 (a) For VM = 0.6 V = inverter must be matched, thus Wp μn = Wn μp 1 VDD , the 2 Wp =4 0.13 ⇒ Wp = 0.52 μm ⇒ |Vtp | = Vtn = 0.4 V and r= μp Wp = μn Wn 1 1 ×1= 4 2 Thus, VM = 0.5(1.2 − 0.4) + 0.4 = 0.53 V 0.5 + 1 (b) VOH = VDD = 1.2 V VOL = 0 V Ex: 15.7 To obtain VM = 2.5 V = To obtain VIH , we use Eq. (15.35): inverter must be matched, thus W W = μp Cox μn Cox L n L p VIH = 1 (5VDD − 2Vt ) 8 1 VDD , the 2 Exercise 15–3 2μp Cox W L p W L = μp Cox n W =2 L n W L p (1) For v I = VDD = 5 V and v O = 0.2 V, QN will be operating in the triode region. Thus, W 1 2 (VDD − Vt )VDS − VDS iD = μn Cox L n 2 1 W (5 − 1) × 0.2 − × 0.22 0.2 = 0.05 × L n 2 W = 5.13 5 ⇒ L n W = 2 × 5.13 = 10.26 10 L p Ex: 15.8 ItPLH = C = VDD (1 − e−t/τ ) At t = tPLH , v O = VDD /2, thus VDD = VDD (1 − e−tPLH /τ ) 2 ⇒ e−tPLH /τ = 0.5 ⇒ tPLH = τ ln 2 = 0.69τ and tPLH = 0.69 × 200 = 138 ps 10 × 10−15 × 1.8 2I Next we determine tPHL by considering the situation depicted in Fig. 1(b). Here, PU has just opened, leaving v O (0+) = VDD . Capacitor C then discharges through the on resistance of the pull-down switch, Rond , toward 0 V, thus v O (∞) = 0, thus 1.8 × 10−14 = 0.9 mA 2 × 10−11 Ex: 15.9 v O = 0 − (0 − VDD )e−t/τ VDD = VDD e−t/τ vO At t = tPHL , v O = VDD /2 and we get Ronu VDD = VDD e−tPHL /τ 2 vO VDD C PD VDD 2 ⇒ tPHL = τ ln 2 = 0.69τ 0 tPLH t Here, τ = CRond Figure 1(a) = 10 × 10−15 × 10 × 103 = 100 ps VDD Thus, vO tPHL = 69 ps PU Rond = VDD − (VDD − 0)e−t/τ τ = 10 × 10−15 × 20 × 103 = 200 ps To obtain tPLH = 10 ps with C = 10 fF and VDD = 1.8 V, we need a current I obtained as follows: ⇒I = v O (t) = V∞ − (V∞ − V0+ )e−t/τ For C = 10 fF and Ronu = 20 k, then VDD 2 ⇒ tPLH = CVDD /2I 10 × 10−12 = To obtain tPLH , consider the situation in Fig. 1(a). Here, PD has just opened (at t = 0) leaving v O = 0 V at t = 0+. Capacitor C then charges through the on resistance of the pull-up switch, Ronu , toward VDD , thus vO C VDD VDD 2 0 Figure 1(b) The propagation delay tP can now be obtained as tP = tPHL t = 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) 2 1 (138 + 69) = 104 ps 2 Exercise 15–4 Ex: 15.10 tP = vO 1 (tPHL + tPLH ) 2 1 (24.8 + 49.6) 2 = 37.2 ps = VDD 0.9VDD 0.1VDD 0 tf t1 Ex: 15.12 tPHL = 0.69RN C t 50 × 10−12 = 0.69 × t2 12.5 × 103 × 20 × 10−15 (W/L)n ⇒ (W/L)n = 3.5 Figure 1 tPLH = 0.69RP C Figure 1 shows the exponential discharge curve and the two points that define the extent of the fall time, tf . Here, 50 × 10−12 = 0.69 × 30 × 103 × 20 × 10−15 (W/L)p ⇒ (W/L)p = 8.3 v O (t) = VDD e−t/τ v O (t1 ) = 0.9VDD = e−t1 /τ (1) Note: If the 0.69 factor is replaced by 1 to account for the fact that the pulse edges are not ideal, then v O (t2 ) = 0.1VDD = e−t2 /τ (2) (W/L)n = 5 Dividing (1) by (2) gives 9=e (W/L)p = 12 −(t1 −t2 )/τ Ex: 15.13 With an additional 0.1 pF, C becomes 9 = etf /τ ⇒ tf = τ ln 9 = 2.2τ C = 6.25 fF + 100 fF = 106.25 fF For C = 100 fF and R = 2 k, Thus, τ = 100 × 10−15 × 2 × 103 = 200 ps tPHL = 25.8 × and = 438.6 ps tf = 2.2 × 200 = 440 ps = 0.44 ns 7 3Vtn Vtn 2 Ex: 15.11 αn = 2 − + 4 VDD VDD 0.5 2 7 3 × 0.5 − + = 2.01 =2 4 1.8 1.8 tPHL = = αn C k n (W/L)n VDD −15 2.01 × 10 × 10 300 × 10−6 × 1.5 × 1.8 = 24.8 ps Vtp 2 7 3|Vtp | − + αp = 2 4 VDD VDD = 2.01 tPLH = αp C = k p (W/L)p VDD 2.01 × 10 × 10−15 75 × 10−6 × 3 × 1.8 = 49.6 ps tPLH = 31.5 × 106.25 6.25 106.25 6.25 = 535.5 ps Thus, 1 (438.6 + 535.5) 2 = 487 ps tP = Ex: 15.14 Original area = Wn L + Wp L = L(Wn + Wp ) = 0.25(0.375 + 1.125) = 0.375 μm2 New area = L(Wn + Wp ) = L × 2Wn = 0.25 × 2 × 0.375 = 0.1875 μm2 which is half the original area. Thus, the area is reduced by 50%. Next, we compute the new value of C as follows: C = 2Cgd 1 +2Cgd 2 +Cdb1 +Cdb2 +Cg3 +Cg4 +Cw Exercise 15–5 This component remains unchanged. The extrinsic component where Cgd 1 = 0.1125 fF Cgd 2 = 0.3 × Wp = 0.3 × 0.375 = 0.1125 fF tP,ext = 28.7 − 13.3 = 15.4 Cdb1 = 1 fF is reduced by a factor of 2. Thus, tP becomes Cdb2 = 1 fF tP = 13.3 + Cg3 = 0.7875 fF 15.4 = 21 ps 2 (d) Area = Wn L + Wp L Cg4 = 0.375 × 0.25 × 6 + 2 × 0.3 × 0.375 = 0.7875 fF = L(Wn + Wp ) By scaling Wn and Wp by a factor of 2, the area increases by a factor of 2. Cw = 0.2 fF Thus, C = 2 × 0.1125 + 2 × 0.1125 + 1 + 1 + 0.7875 + 0.7875 + 0.2 = 4.225 fF 4.225 tPHL = 25.8 × 6.25 = 17.4 ps 4.225 1.125 × tPLH = 31.5 × 6.25 0.375 = 63.9 ps tP = 1 (17.4 + 63.9) = 40.6 ps 2 Ex: 15.17 L = 0.18 μm, n = 1.5, p = 3 (a) Four-input NOR gate: Refer to Fig. 15.34. For NMOS transistors: W/L = n = 1.5 = 0.27 0.18 For PMOS transistors: W/L = 4p = 12 = 2.16 0.18 (b) Four-input NAND gate: Refer to Fig. 15.35. For NMOS transistors: W/L = 4n = 6 = For PMOS transistors: W/L = p = 3 = Ex: 15.15 fmax = = 1 2tP 1 = 17.4 GHz 2 × 28.7 × 10−12 1.08 0.18 0.54 0.18 Area of NOR gate = 4×0.18×0.27+4×0.18×2.16 = 1.7496 μm2 Area of NAND gate = 4 × 0.18 × 1.08 + 4 × 0.18 × 0.54 = 1.1664 Ex: 15.16 Refer to Example 15.7. (a) Cint = 2Cgd 1 + 2Cgd 2 + Cdb1 + Cdb2 Thus, 1.7496 NOR area = = 1.5 NAND area 1.1664 = 2 × 0.1125 + 2 × 0.3375 + 1 + 1 = 2.9 fF Cext = Cg3 + Cg4 + Cw = 0.7875 + 2.3625 + 0.2 = 3.35 fF (b) To reduce the extrinsic component of tP by a factor of 2, we need to scale (W/L)n and (W/L)p by a factor S=2 (c) The original value of tP = 28.7 ps is composed of an intrinsic component Cint C 2.9 = 13.3 ps = 28.7 × 6.25 tP,int = tP × Ex: 15.18 Refer to Fig. 15.35. (a) Maximum charging current is the current supplied by the four identical PMOS transistors. Minimum charging current is the current supplied by one of the PMOS transistors. Thus, the ratio of maximum to minimum currents is 4. (b) There is only one possible configuration for discharging a load capacitance, namely, when all 4 NMOS transistors are conducting. So, as far as capacitor discharge is concerned, the ratio is one. 2 Ex: 15.19 Pdyn = fCVDD = 1 × 109 × 6.25 × 10−15 × 2.52 = 39 μW Exercise 15–6 2 Ex: 15.20 Pdyn = fCVDD 2 Ex: 15.22 PDP = fCVDD tP = 100 × 106 × 100 × 10−15 × 1.82 When f = fmax = 1/2tP , = 32.4 μW PDP = 2 Ex: 15.21 Pdyn = fCVDD C decreases by a factor (0.13/0.5) and VDD decreases from 5 V to 1.2 V; thus for the same f , the power dissipation will decrease by a factor = 5 0.5 × = 66.8 0.13 1.2 1 1 CV 2 = × 6.25 × 10−15 × 2.52 2 DD 2 = 19.5 fJ 1 2 tP = 19.5 × 10−15 × 28.7 × 10−12 EDP = CVDD 2 = 5.6 × 10−25 Js Chapter 15–1 15.1 (a) Ron = rDSN = 15.3 1 W (μn Cox ) (VDD − Vtn ) L n (1) VDD 1 = 2.18 k = 0.470 × 1.5(1 − 0.35) (b) Ron = rDSP = = W (μp Cox ) L 1 A QPA B QPB C QPC (2) Y (VDD − |Vtp |) p 1 = 5.40 k 0.190 × 1.5(1 − 0.35) A QNA (c) From (1) and (2) since Vtn = −|Vtp |, then if Ron are to be equal, then W W (μn Cox ) = (μp Cox ) L n L p ⇒ W L p μn Cox W = μp Cox L n QNB B C QNC Figure 1 Y =A+B+C ⇒ Y = A + B + C ⇒ PDN Y = A B C ⇒ PUN The circuit realization is shown in Fig. 1. 470 = × 1.5 = 3.71 190 15.4 15.2 (a) For QN , we have VDD Ron = W (μn Cox ) L 1 (VDD − Vtn ) n A QPA B QPB C QPC For QP , we have Ron = Y 1 W (μp Cox ) (VDD − |Vtp )| L p A QNA Since Vtn = |Vtp |, then for Ron of QP to equal Ron of QN , B QNB W W (μp Cox ) = (μn Cox ) L p L n C QNC ⇒ = W L = p μn Cox W μp Cox L n 500 × 1.5 = 6.0 125 (b) For both devices, we have Ron = 1 = 1.67 k 0.5 × 1.5 × (1.2 − 0.4) Figure 1 Y = ABC ⇒ Y = ABC ⇒ PDN Y = A + B + C ⇒ PUN Figure 1 shows the circuit realization. Chapter 15–2 Figure 1 (left-hand column) shows the complete CMOS logic circuit where we have obtained the PDN as the dual of the given PUN. The logic function can be written from the PDN as 15.5 Y = A + BCD or equivalently Y = A + BCD 15.7 The given Boolean expression can be written as Y = (A + B)(C + D) from which the PDN of the complete circuit shown in Fig. 1 can be directly obtained. Figure 1 Figure 1 (left-hand column) shows the complete CMOS logic gate where the PUN is obtained as the dual of the given PDN. The function realized can be found from the PDN as Y = A + BC VDD A C B D or Y = A + BC 15.6 Y A B C D Figure 1 The PUN can then be found as the dual of the PDN. Figure 1 15.8 Figure 1 (top of next page) shows a CMOS realization of the Exclusive-OR function. This circuit is obtained by utilizing the PUN in Fig. 15.10(a) and then Chapter 15–3 VDD A A B B Direct realization of the given expression results in the PUN of the logic circuit shown in Fig. 1 (below, left-hand column). The PDN shown is obtained as the dual of the PUN. Not shown are the two inverters needed to obtain A and B. 15.10 Y = ABC + ABC + ABC Y A A B B Figure 1 finding the dual PDN. Note that two additional inverters are needed to generate A and B, for a total of 12 transistors. (1) Using this expression to directly synethesize the PUN we obtain the circuit shown in Fig. 1. See Figs. 1 and 2 on next page. This PUN circuit requires 9 transistors plus three inverters for a total of 15 transistors. This, of course, does not include the transistors required for the PDN which we shall consider shortly. Inspecting the PUN circuit reveals the potential for eliminating two transistors through what is known as "path merging." Specifically the two transistors in the top row that are controlled by A can be merged into a single transistor, and the two transistors in the bottom row that are controlled by C can be merged into a single transistor. The result is the 7-transistor PUN shown in Fig. 2. We next consider the realization of the PDN. A straightforward realization can be obtained by finding the dual of the PUN in Fig. 1. This is shown in Fig. 3. It requires nine transistors 15.9 Y A B C A B C A B C Figure 3 Figure 1 plus three inverters. The latter, of course are the same three inverters needed to obtain the complemented variables in PUN. The circuit in Fig. 3 does not lend itself to path merging, at least not in a straightforward way. Chapter 15–4 These figures belong to Problem 15.10. VDD A A VDD A A A Path B B B B B B merging C C C C C Y Y Figure 1 Figure 2 There is, however, an alternative way to synthesize a PDN with a lower number of transistors. We simply obtain Y from the expression in Eq. (1) using DeMorgan’s law as follows: = ABC + B C + A B + A C = ABC + A(B + C) + B C (3) A direct realization of this expression results in the PDN shown in Fig. 4. This circuit requires 8 transistors (not counting the inverters). Y = ABC.ABC.ABC = (A + B + C)(A + B + C)(A + B + C) (2) Direct synthesis of Eq. (2) results in the circuit of Fig. 3. However, further manipulation of the expression in (2) results in a more economical realization, as follows: Y = AB(A + B + C) + AC(A + B + C) Y A A B + B A(A + B + C) + B C(A + B + C) C B B C C + C A(A + B + C) + CB(A + B + C) + C(A + B + C) Figure 4 = ABC + AB C + A B + A BC + A B C +BC+AC+ABC = ABC + (A + A)B C + A B(1 + C) + (A + 1)B C + A C(1 + B) 15.11 Direct realization of the given expression results in the PUN portion of the circuit shown in Fig. 1 at the top of the next page. The PDN is obtained as the dual of the PUN. Not shown are the three inverters needed to obtain A, B and C. Chapter 15–5 15.12 (a) Even-parity checker: Y = A B C + ABC + ABC + ABC See Fig. 1 below. (b) This expression can be directly realized with the PDN shown in Fig. 1. Note that the circuit requires 12 transistors in addition to the three inverters needed to generate A, B, and C. (c) From inspection of the PDN in Fig. 1 we see that we can combine the two transistors controlled by A and the two transistors controlled by A. This results in the PDN realization shown in Fig. 2 which requires 10 transistors, not counting those in the inverters. See Fig. 2 below. Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 15.12, part (a). Y A A A A B B B B C C C C Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 15.12, part (c). Y A A B B B B C C C C Chapter 15–6 VDD shown in Fig. 4. However, it is not easy to obtain a PUN as a dual of this circuit. See Fig. 4 below. B C B C 15.13 The Boolean expression for an odd-parity checker in Eq. (1) can be directly realized by the PUN in Fig. 1. B C Y = AB C + A BC + AB C + ABC B C A A = A (BC + BC) + A(BC + B C) Y (1) Recall that we use for the switch control variables the complements of the variables in the equation. It requires 10 transistors in addition to the three inverters needed to provide A, B and C. The dual of the PUN can be obtained and results in the PDN shown in Fig. 1 on the next page. Figure 3 The equation S = AB C + A BC + AB C + ABC (d) The PUN in Fig. 3 can be obtained as the dual of the PDN in Fig. 2. Combining the PDN and the PUN gives the complete realization of the even-parity checker. Note: The number of transistors in the PDN of Fig. 2 can be reduced by 2 by combining the two transistors in the bottom row that are controlled by C, and the two transistors that are controlled by C. The resulting 8-transistor realization is = A(BC + BC) + A(BC + B C) is the same function as that of the odd-parity checker above. Thus the realization of the S function will be identical to that in Fig. 1. As for C0 we write C0 = ABC + ABC + ABC + ABC Y A B A B This expression can be minimized as follows: C0 = (A + A)BC + (B + B)AC + (C + C)AB = BC + AC + AB = A(B + C) + BC B C B C Figure 4 which can be realized directly by the PUN of the circuit in Fig. 2 where the PDN is obtained as the dual network of the PUN. In addition to the 10 transistors, we need three inverters to generate A, B and C. Chapter 15–7 This figure belongs to Problem 15.13. VDD A A B B B B PUN C C C C Y B C B C A PDN B C B C Figure 2 A Figure 1 15.14 NMH = VOH − VIH (b) = 1.8 − 1.2 = 0.6 V NML = VIL − VOL = 0.9 − 0.2 = 0.7 V 15.15 (a) NMH = VOH − VIH = 1.8 − 1.3 = 0.5 V NML = VIL − VOL = 1.2 − 0.4 = 0.8 V Figure 1 Chapter 15–8 Refer to Fig. 1 on the previous page. Slope of the VTC in the transition region is: VOH − VOL Slope = VIL − VIH = 1.8 − 0.4 = −14 V/V 1.2 − 1.3 But the slope can also be expressed as Slope = VM − VOH VM − VIH Thus, VM − 0.4 = −14 VM − 1.3 ⇒ VM = 1.24 V (c) The voltage gain in the transition region is equal to the slope found above, thus Gain = −14 V/V (b) Typical average power dissipation: PD = 1 (5 × 3 + 5 × 1) 2 = 10 mW 15.18 (a) Refer to Fig. 15.17. VOL = VDD = 2.5 × Ron R + Ron 0.1 = 0.12 V 2 + 0.1 VOH = VDD = 2.5 V NMH = VOH − VIH = 2.5 − 1 = 1.5 V NML = VIL − VOL = 0.8 − 0.12 = 0.68 V (b) 15.16 NMH = VOH − VIH = 0.8VDD − 0.6VDD = 0.2VDD NML = VIL − VOL = 0.4VDD − 0.1VDD = 0.3VDD Width of transition region = VIH − VIL Figure 1 = 0.6VDD − 0.4VDD = 0.2VDD For a minimum noise margin of 0.4 V, we have Refer to Fig. 1. NMH = 0.4 VOH = VDD − N × 0.2 × R ⇒ 0.2VDD = 0.4 = 2.5 − N × 0.2 × 2 ⇒ VDD = 2 V = 2.5 − 0.4N NMH = 2.5 − 0.4N − 1 15.17 VIH = 2 V = 1.5 − 0.4N VIL = 0.8 V For NMH = NML , we have VOH min = 2.4 V, VOH typ = 3.3 V 1.5 − 0.4N = 0.68 VOLmax = 0.4 V, VOLtyp = 0.22 V ⇒ N = 2.05 (a) Worst-case NMH = VOH min − VIH which means = 2.4 − 2 = 0.4 V N =2 Worst-case NML = VIL − VOLmax (c) (i) When the inverter output is low, = 0.8 − 0.4 = 0.4 V PD = 2 VDD 2.52 = 3 mW R + Ron 2 + 0.1 Chapter 15–9 (ii) When the output is high and the inverter is driving two inverters, the current drawn from the supply is 2 × 0.2 = 0.4 mA and thus the power dissipation is Thus, PD = VDD IDD = 2.5 × 0.4 = 1 mW and VIL = 0.615/1.769 = 0.349 V VIL = 0.923 − 0.769 (VIL + 0.4) = 0.615 − 0.769VIL whence VIH = 0.4 + 0.349 = 0.749 V Alternatively, NMH = 0.769NML and 15.19 For an ideal inverter: 1 VM = VDD = 1 V 2 VIL = VIH = VM = 1 V (VOH − VIH ) = 0.769 (VIL − VOL ) or 1.2 − VIH = 0.769VIL − 0 and VIH = 1.2 − 0.769VIL , with (1), VOL = 0 V VIL + 0.4 = 1.2 − 0.769VIL , and VOH = VDD = 2 V 1.769VIL = 0.8, whence VIL = 0.452 V NML = VIL − VOL and VIH = 0.4 + 0.452 = 0.852 =1−0=1V Thus, overall, VOH = 1.2 V, VOL = 0.0 V, NMH = VOH − VIH VIH ranges from 0.749 V to 0.852 V, and =2−1=1V VIL ranges from 0.349 V to 0.451 V, in which case the margins can be as low as NML = VIL − VOL = 0.349 V and NMH = VOH − VIH = 1.2 − 0.852 = 0.348 V and as high as 0.451 V, and 0.451 V. 15.21 VDD RD Figure 1 Ron ⯝ rDS vO The ideal transfer characteristic is shown in Fig. 1, from which we see that Gain in transition region = ∞ Equivalent circuit for output-low state 15.20 Here, VOH = 1.2 V, and VOL = 0.0 V Also, VIH − VIL ≤ 1.2/3 = 0.4 V (1) The output-high level for the simple inverter circuit shown in Fig. 15.12 of the text is Now, the noise margins are “within 30% of one other.” Thus, NMH = (1 + ±0.3) NML or NML = (1 + ±0.3) NMH . Thus, they remain “within” either NMH = 1.3NML or NML = 1.3NMH , in which case either NML = 0.769NMH or NMH = 0.769NML When the output is low, the current drawn from the supply can be calculated as For the former case: Therefore: RD + rDS = 0.769 (VOH − VIH ) = (VIL − VOL ) or 0.769 (1.2 − VIH ) = VIL − 0, whence VIL = 0.923 − 0.769VIH Now, from (1), VIH = VIL + 0.4 VOH = VDD ⇒ VDD = 1.2 V. I= VDD = 30 μA RD + Ron 1.2 = 40 k 30 × 10−6 Also: rDS × VDD RD + rDS 0.05 = 40 k × = 1.67 k 1.2 VOL = 0.05 V = ⇒ rDS Chapter 15–10 Hence: RD = 40 K − 1.67 K = 38.3 k 1 W μn Cox (VGS − Vt ) L 1 = W −6 500 × 10 × (1.2 − 0.4) L = 1.67 k W = 1.5 ⇒ L When the output is low: = rDS = PD = VDD IDD = 1.2 × 30 μA = 36 μW When the output is high, the transistor is off: PD = 0 W VDD = 0.054VDD VDD − 0.3VDD 1+ 0.04VDD NMH = VOH − VIH = VDD − 0.586VDD = 0.414VDD NML = VIL − VOL = 0.34VDD − 0.054VDD = 0.286VDD For VDD = 1.2 V: Vx = 0.048 V, VOH = 1.2 V, VIL = 0.408 V, VIH = 0.703 V, VOL = 0.065 V, NMH = 0.50 V, NML = 0.34 V PD = VDD ID = VDD × VDD − VOL RD 15.22 The output voltage swing = RC1 I = 0.5 V. Substituting for RD from with IEE = 0.5 mA, RC1 = 1.0 k, similarly, RD = RC2 = 1.0 k we obtain VOH = VCC = 2 V VOL = VCC − RC1 IEE = 1.5 V 15.23 Vt = 0.3VDD , VM = VDD /2 From Eq. (15.13) on page 1244 of text, we obtain 2 VDD − Vt 2 Vx V = VDD = M 2 VDD = (0.5VDD − 0.3VDD )2 VDD ⇒ Vx = 0.04VDD 1 k n Vx PD = VDD (VDD − 0.054VDD ) × k n × 0.04VDD W 3 PD = 0.038VDD × k n L W = 0.038 × 1.23 × 0.5 × 10−3 L W = 0.033 , mW L For PD = 100 μW = 0.1 mW, we obtain W 0.1 = 0.033 L ⇒ W =3 L RD = VOH = VDD 1 k n Vx 1 0.5 × 3 × 0.048 From Eq. (15.12), we get = VIL = Vt + Vx = 0.3VDD + 0.04VDD = 13.9 k = 0.34VDD From Eq. (15.20), we obtain VIH = Vt + 1.63 VDD Vx − Vx = 0.3VDD + 1.63 VDD × 0.04VDD − 0.04VDD 15.24 Refer to Example 15.2 on page 1243 of the text: = 0.586VDD The power drawn from the supply during the low-output state is From Eq. (15.22), we get VOL VDD = 1 + [(VDD − Vt )/Vx ] VOH = VDD = 1.2 V PDD = VDD IDD ⇒ 60 μW = 1.2 × IDD ⇒ IDD = 50 μA Chapter 15–11 (a) Figure 1 shows the i − v characteristic of the load diode-connected transistor Q2 . Observe that since v DG = 0, this transistor is always in saturation. The current i that feeds Q2 is provided by Q1 . Even when i is very small, Q2 will be operating at v = Vt and thus the output voltage of the inverter VOH will be In this case: VDD − VOL 1.2 − 0.05 ⇒ 50 μA = IDD = RD RD ⇒ RD = 23 k W , we note that L 1 W k n RD = 1/VX or k n RD = L VX In order to determine VOH = VDD − Vt This loss of Vt volts in VOH is a drawback of this form of logic circuit. Therefore, we need to first calculate VX using Eq. (15.22) on page 1246 of the text. VOL = (b) As v I increases and reaches Vt of Q1 , transistor Q1 begins to conduct an appreciable current and v increases above Vt2 , thus v O begins to decrease below VOH . The threshold voltage VIL is usually taken as Vt1 : VDD or equivalently VDD − Vt 1+ VX 0.05 V = 1.2 1.2 − 0.4 1+ VX VIL = Vt (c) When Q1 begins to conduct, it will be operating in saturation, thus 0.8 = 0.035 V 23 1 W gives Hence, k n RD = Vx L ⇒ VX = 1 (1) k n1 (v I − Vt )2 2 Transistor Q2 is always operating in saturation, thus 1 (2) iD2 = k 2 (VDD − v O − Vt )2 2 Since iD1 = iD2 = i, we can equate their values in Eqs. (1) and (2) and thus obtain iD1 = W W 1 ×23×103 = ⇒ = 2.5 L 0.035 L Using Eq. (15.12), we obtain 500×10−6 × VIL = Vt + VX = 0.4 + 0.035 = 0.435 V From Eq. (15.14) we obtain VM = Vt + 2 (VDD − Vt )Vx + V 2 x − Vx = 0.4 + 2 (1.2 − 0.4) 0.035 + 0.0352 − 0.035 k n1 (v I − Vt )2 = k n2 (VDD − v O − Vt )2 k n1 ⇒ (v I − Vt ) = VDD − v O − Vt k n2 VM = 0.6 V ⇒ v O = VDD + (k r − 1)Vt − k r v I From Eq. (15.20) we get VIH = Vt + 1.63 VDD Vx − Vx √ = 0.4 + 1.63 1.2 × 0.035 − 0.035 = 0.7 V where NMH = VOH − VIH = 1.2 − 0.7 = 0.5 V Equation (3) is that of the inverter VTC in the transition region. It is linear and has a slope of −k r . kr ≡ NML = VIL − VOL = 0.435 − 0.05 = 0.385 V i 1 k (v V )2 t 2 n2 PD |v O =VOL = VDD IDD 1 k n2 VDD (VDD − Vt )2 2 Since the inverter spends half the time in this state and the other half in the output-high state where = 0 v Vt Figure 1 k n1 k n2 (d) With v I = VDD , v O = VOL 0, the voltage v VDD and the current IDD that flows in the inverter is 1 IDD = k n2 (VDD − Vt )2 2 Thus, the power dissipated in the inverter in the low-output state is 15.25 i (3) Chapter 15–12 the power dissipation is essentially zero, the average power dissipation will be 1 PD = k n2 VDD (VDD − Vt )2 4 (e) For VDD = 1.8 V, Vt = 0.5 V, (W/L)1 = 5, 1 and μn Cox = 300 μA/V2 , we have 5 = VDD − Vt = 1.8 − 0.5 = 1.3 V (W/L)2 = VOH VIL = Vt = 0.5 V k n1 5 =5 = kr = k n2 1/5 ⇒ Wp = 2.5Wn = 2.5 × 1.5 × 65 = 244 nm Silicon area = Wn Ln + Wp Lp = 1.5 × 65 × 65 + 2.5 × 1.5 × 65 × 65 = 1.5 × 65 × 65(1 + 2.5) = 22, 181 nm2 (b) VOH = VDD = 1 V VOL = 0 V To obtain VIH , we use Eq. (15.35): VIH = 1 (5VDD − 2Vt ) 8 v O = 1.8 + (5 − 1) × 0.5 − 5v I 1 (5 × 1 − 2 × 0.35) 8 = 0.5375 V ⇒ v O = 3.8 − 5v I To obtain VIL , we use Eq. (15.36): In the transition region, we have 1 1 IDD = × 0.3 × × (1.8 − 0.5)2 2 5 = 0.05 mA 1 PD = × 1.8 × 0.05 = 45 μW 2 = VIL = 1 (3VDD + 2Vt ) 8 1 (3 × 1 + 2 × 0.35) 8 = 0.4625 V = The noise margins can now be found as 15.26 Refer to Example 15.3 (page 1248 of text) VOH = VDD = 1.2 V VOL = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − 1 − (k p /k n ) = (1.2 − 0.4) 1 − 1− 1 5 = 0.084 V 1 IDD = k p (VDD − Vt )2 2 1 = × 0.1(1.2 − 0.4)2 2 = 0.032 mA = 32 μA NMH = VOH − VIH = 1 − 0.5375 = 0.4625 V NML = VIL − VOL = 0.4625 − 0 = 0.4625 V The noise margins are equal at approximately 0.46 V; a result of the matched design of the inverter. (c) Since the inverter is matched, the output resistances in the two states will be equal. Thus, W rDSP = rDSN = 1 (μn Cox ) (VDD − Vt ) L n 1 = 2.18 k 0.47 × 1.5(1 − 0.35) Pav = 1 1 VDD IDD = × 1.2 × 32 = 19.2 μW 2 2 From the statement of Exercise 15.5, we have = VDD − Vt VM = Vt + √ r+1 15.28 VOH = 2.5 V where r = k n /k p = 5, thus 1.2 − 0.4 VM = 0.4 + √ 5+1 = 0.73 V 15.27 (a) To obtain VM = VDD /2, the inverter must be matched, thus Wp μn = = 2.5 Wn μp VOL = 0 V (a) For the matched case we have Wp = 3.5Wn 1 VDD = 1.25 V 2 1 Eq. (15.35): VIH = (5 VDD − 2 Vt ) 8 1 = (5 × 2.5 − 2 × 0.5) 8 = 1.4375 V VM = Chapter 15–13 Eq. (15.36): VIL = = 1 (3 VDD + 2 Vt ) 8 1 (3 × 2.5 + 2 × 0.5) 8 Silicon area = Wn Ln + Wp Lp = 1.5 × 0.25 × 0.25 + 2 × 1.5 × 0.25 × 0.25 = 3 × 1.5 × 0.252 = 1.0625 V = 0.28 μm2 NMH = NML = 1.0625 V Compared to the matched case, the silicon area is reduced by 33%. Silicon area = Wn Ln + Wp Lp = 1.5 × 0.25 × 0.25 + 3.5 × 1.5 × 0.25 × 0.25 = 4.5 × 1.5 × 0.252 = 0.42 μm2 (b) Wp = Wn (minimum-size design): μp Wp 1 × 1 = 0.53 = Eq. (15.40): r = μn Wn 3.5 r(VDD − |Vtp |) + Vtn Eq. (15.39): VM = r+1 0.53(2.5 − 0.5) + 0.5 = 0.53 + 1 = 1.02 V Thus, VM shifts to the left by 0.23 V. Assuming VIL shifts by approximately the same amount, then VIL 1.0625 − 0.23 0.83 V Since NML = VIL , NML will be reduced by approximately 22% (relative to the matched case). Silicon area = Wn Ln + Wp Lp 15.29 QN will be operating in the triode region, thus 1 W IDn = k n (VDD − Vtn )VO − VO2 L n 2 For Vtn = 0.3VDD and VO = 0.1VDD , we have IDn = k n W L n (VDD − 0.3VDD ) × 0.1VDD − 1 2 × 0.12 VDD 2 2 2 = k n (W/L)n (0.07VDD − 0.005VDD ) 2 = 0.065k n (W/L)n VDD Q.E.D. k n For VDD = 1.3 V, = 0.5 mA/V2 and IDn = 0.1 mA, we have 0.1 = 0.065 × 0.5(W/L)n × 1.32 W ⇒ = 1.82 L n = 1.5 × 0.25 × 0.25 + 1.5 × 0.25 × 0.25 = 3 × 0.252 = 0.19 μm2 which is a reduction of 55% relative to the matched case. (c) Wp = 2Wn (a compromise design): μp Wp 1 2 = × Eq. (15.40): r = μn Wn 3.5 1 = 0.756 Eq. (15.39): VM = = r(VDD − |Vtp |) + Vtn r+1 0.756(2.5 − 0.5) + 0.5 0.756 + 1 15.30 From Eq. (15.39) we have VM = r(VDD − |Vtp |) + Vtn r+1 rVM + VM = r(VDD − |Vtp |) + Vtn r(VDD − |Vtp | − VM ) = VM − Vtn ⇒r= VM − Vtn VDD − |Vtp | − VM Q.E.D. For VDD = 1.3 V, Vtn = |Vtp | = 0.4 V, to obtain VM = 0.6VDD , we need r= 0.6 × 1.3 − 0.4 1.3 − 0.4 − 0.6 × 1.3 = 3.167 = 1.15 V But, Thus, relative to the matched case the switching point (VM ) is shifted left by (1.25 − 1.15) = 0.1 V. Assuming that VIL is reduced by approximately the same amount, then r= VIL = 1.0625 − 0.1 = 0.9625 V μp Wp μn Wn 1 Wp × 3.167 = 4 Wn Thus, NML which equals VIL is reduced by about 9% (relative to the matched case). Wp = 3.1672 × 4 = 40.1 Wn Chapter 15–14 15.31 Refer to Example 15.4 (page 1257 of text) except here: From symmetry, we can obtain the value of v O corresponding to v I = VIL as VDD = 1.3 V, Vtn = |Vtp | = 0.4 V, μn = 4 μp , and μn Cox = 0.5 mA/V2 . Also, QN and QP have L = 0.13 μm and (W/L)n = 1.5. v O = VDD − 0.0625 (a) For VM = VDD /2 = 0.65 V, the inverter must be matched, thus Thus, the worst-case value of VOH is VOH min 1.24 V, and the noise margin NMH is reduced to Wp μn = =4 Wn μp = 1.3 − 0.0625 = 1.2375 V 1.24 V NMH = VOH min − VIH Since Wn /L = 1.5, Wn = 1.5 × 0.13 = 0.195 μm. Thus, Wp = 4 × 0.195 = 0.78 μm = 1.2375 − 0.7125 = 0.5250 V or approximately 0.53 V. Note that the reduction in the noise margin (about 0.06 V) is slight. For this design, the silicon area is A = Wn L + Wp L = L(Wn + Wp ) = 0.13(0.195 + 0.78) = 0.127 μm 2 (b) VOH = VDD = 1.3 V (c) The output resistance of the inverter in the low-output state is rDSN = VOL = 0 V To obtain VIH , we use Eq. (15.35): VIH = = 1 (5VDD − 2Vt ) 8 1 (5 × 1.3 − 2 × 0.4) 8 = 0.7125 V = 1 μn Cox (W/L)n (VDD − Vtn ) 1 = 1.48 k 0.5 × 1.5(1.3 − 0.4) Since QN and QP are matched, the output resistance in the high-output state will be equal, that is, rDSP = rDSN = 1.48 k = 0.5875 V (d) If the inverter is biased to operate at v I = v O = VM = 0.65 V, then each of QN and QP will be operating at an overdrive voltage VOV = VM − Vt = 0.65 − 0.4 = 0.25 V and will be conducting equal dc currents ID of 1 W V2 ID = μn Cox 2 L n OV We can now compute the noise margins as = NMH = VOH − VIH = 1.3 − 0.7125 = 23.4 μA To obtain VIL , we use Eq. (15.36): VIL = = 1 (3VDD + 2Vt ) 8 1 (3 × 1.3 + 2 × 0.4) 8 = 0.5875 V 0.59 V 1 × 500 × 1.5 × 0.252 2 NML = VIL − VOL = 0.5875 − 0 Thus, QN and QP will have equal transconductances: = 0.5875 V 0.59 V gmn = gmp = For v I = VIH = 0.7125 V, we can obtain the corresponding value of v O by substituting in Eq. (15.34): Transistors QN and QP will have output resistances ron and rop given by VDD = 0.7125 − 0.65 = 0.0625 V 2 ron = VAn ID Thus, the worst-case value of VOL is VOmax = 0.0625 0.06 V, and the noise margin NML reduces to rop = |VAp | ID v O = VIH − NML = 0.5875 − 0.0625 = 0.5250 V or approximately 0.53 V. 2ID 2 × 23.4 = = 0.19 mA/V VOV 0.25 Since no values are given for VAn and VAp we shall use the data in Table K.1, namely VAn = 5 V/μm and |VAp | = 6 V/μm Chapter 15–15 Thus, In this case, the silicon area required is VAn = 5 × 0.13 = 0.65 V A = L(Wn + Wp ) = L × 3Wn |VAp | = 6 × 0.13 = 0.78 V = 0.13 × 3 × 1.5 × 0.13 ron = 0.65 V = 27.8 k 23.4 μA rop = 0.78 V = 33.3 k 23.4 μA We can now compute the voltage gain at M as Av = −(gmn + gmp )(ron rop ) = −(0.19 + 0.19)(27.8 33.3) = −5.8 V/V When the straight line at M of slope −5.8 V/V is extrapolated, it intersects the line v O = 0 at 0.65 = 0.762 V and the line v O = VDD 0.65 + 5.8 0.65 at 0.65 − = 0.538 V. Thus the width of 5.8 the transition region can be considered (0.762 − 0.538) = 0.224 V. (e) For Wp = Wn , the parameter r can be found from Eq. (15.40): μp Wp 1 × 1 = 0.5 = r= μn Wn 4 The corresponding value of VM can be determined from Eq. (15.39) as 0.5(1.3 − 0.4) + 0.4 = 0.57 V 0.5 + 1 Thus, VM shifts by only −0.08 V. We can estimate the reduction in NML to be approximately equal to the shift in VM , that is, NML becomes VM = = 0.076 μm2 which represents a 40% reduction relative to the matched case. 15.32 The current reaches its peak at VDD v I = VM = . At this point, both QN and QP 2 are operating in the saturation region and conducting a current 2 1 W VDD IDP = IDN = k n − Vt 2 L n 2 2 1.3 1 − 0.4 = × 500 × 1.5 2 2 = 23.4 μA 15.33 (a) Switch opens at time t = 0, thus v O (0+) = 0 V. The capacitor then charge by a constant current I , thus It = Cv O (t) I t C (b) For I = 1 mA and C = 10 pF the time t for v O to reach 1 V can be found as ⇒ v O (t) = 1= 1 × 10−3 t 10 × 10−12 ⇒ t = 10−8 s = 10 ns NML = 0.5875 − 0.08 0.51 V The silicon area for this design can be computed as follows: A = L(Wn + Wp ) = 0.13(1.5 × 0.13 + 1.5 × 0.13) = 0.051 μm2 15.34 (a) Capacitor C is charged to 10 V and the switch closes at t = 0, thus v O (0+) = 10 V Capacitor C then discharges through R exponentially with v O (∞) = 0 v O (t) = 0 − (0 − 10) e−t/τ This represents a 60% reduction from the matched case! ⇒ v O (t) = 10e−t/τ (f) For Wp = 2Wn , we have (b) For C = 100 pF and R = 1 k, we have τ = 100 × 10−12 × 1 × 103 = 100 ns 1 1 × 2 = √ = 0.707 r= 4 2 0.707(1.3 − 0.4) + 0.4 VM = = 0.61 V 0.707 + 1 Thus, relative to the matched case, VM is reduced by only 0.04 V. Correspondingly, NML will be reduced by approximately an equal amount, thus NML becomes At t = 0, v I goes low and the transistor turns off instantly, thus NML 0.59 − 0.04 = 0.55 V v O (0+) = VOL tPHL = 0.69τ = 0.69 × 100 = 69 ns tf = 2.22τ = 2.2 × 100 = 220 ns 15.35 VOH = VDD Chapter 15–16 At t = tPLH , v O = VDD /2, thus Now capacitor C charges through R towards v O (∞) = VDD , thus v O (t) = VDD − (VDD − VOL ) e−t/τ VDD = VDD (1 − e−tPLH /τ ) 2 At t = tPLH , ⇒ e−tPLH /τ = 0.5 vO = 1 1 (VOL + VOH ) = (VOL + VDD ), thus 2 2 ⇒ tPLH = τ ln2 = 0.69τ For C = 50 fF, Ronu = 2 k, then 1 (VOL + VDD ) = VDD − (VDD − VOL )e−t/τ 2 ⇒ tPLH = 0.69τ tPLH = 0.69 × 50 × 10−15 × 2 × 103 For R = 10 k and we wish to limit τPLH to 100 ps then the maximum value that C can have is found from 0.69 × C × 10 × 103 = 100 × 10−12 ⇒ C = 1.45 × 10−14 F = 14.5 fF = 69 ps Next we determine tPHL by considering the situation depicted in Fig. 1(b). Here, PU has just opened, leaving v O (0+) = VDD . Capacitor C then discharges through the on resistance of the pull-down switch, Rond , toward 0 V, thus v O (∞) = 0, thus v O = 0 − (0 − VDD ) e−t/τ = VDD e−t/τ 15.36 At t = tPHL , v O = VDD /2 and we get VDD vO VDD = VDD e−tPHL /τ 2 Ronu ⇒ tPHL = 0.69τ vO VDD C PD Here, VDD 2 τ = CRond tPLH 0 t = 50 × 10−15 × 1 × 103 = 50 ps Thus, Figure 1(a) tPHL = 0.69 × 50 35 ps The propagation delay tP can now be obtained as VDD tP = vO PU vO Rond C = VDD VDD 2 0 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) 2 1 (69 + 35) = 52 ps 2 15.37 (a) VOL = 0 V tPHL t Figure 1(b) VOH = VDD = 1.8 V NML = VIL − VOL = VDD −0 2 = 0.9 V To obtain tPLH , consider the situation in Fig. 1(a). Here, PD has just opened (at t = 0), leaving v O = 0 V at t = 0+. Capacitor C then charges through the "on" resistance of the pull-up switch, Ronu , toward VDD , thus = 0.9 V v O (t) = V∞ − (V∞ − V0+ )e−t/τ (b) Capacitor C discharges through Ron of PD , = VDD − (VDD − 0)e−t/τ v O (0+) = VDD = 1.8 V = VDD (1 − e−t/τ ) v O (∞) = 0 V NMH = VOH − VIH = VDD − VDD 2 Chapter 15–17 15.38 See figure below. Thus, v O (t) = VDD e −t/τ (a) For a rising input, time to the full change of output of second gate is ⇒ tPHL = 0.69τ = 0.69 × 0.1 × 10−12 × 2 × 103 10 + 20 + = 138 ps 30 = 45 ns 2 (b) For a falling input, time to the full change of output of the second gate is (c) Here the capacitor charges through Ron of PU toward VDD . Thus, 20 + 10 + v O (0+) = 0, v O (∞) = VDD , 15 = 37.5 ns 2 v O (t) = VDD (1 − e−t/τ ) The propagation delay is At t = tPLH , v O (t) = VDD /2, thus tP = tPLH = 0.69τ = = 0.69 × 0.1 × 10−12 × 2 × 103 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) 2 1 (20 + 10) = 15 ns 2 = 138 ps 15.39 (a) tP = Finally, we obtain τP as τP = = 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) 2 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) 2 Since tP = 0.9 ns, then tPLH + tPHL = 1.8 ns 1 (138 + 138) = 138 ps 2 (1) This figure belongs to Problem 15.38. vI vO2 vO1 vI 0 20 40 60 80 100 vO1 120 112.5 2.5 50% 117.5 t 20 10 30 40 50 60 70 80 55 17.5 90 100 110 120 85 vO2 50% t 10 20 15 30 40 50 45 60 70 72.5 80 90 100 110 120 130 87.5 Chapter 15–18 For a matched inverter, we have Now, since Icharge is half Idischarge , then tPLH = 2tPHL (2) tPHL = tPLH = tP Using (1) together with (2) yields For tP ≤ 80 ps, tPLH = 1.2 ns tPHL ≤ 80 ps tPHL = 0.6 ns But, (b) Since the propagation delay is directly proportional to C, then the increase in propagation delay by 50%, when the capacitance is increased by 0.5 pF, indicates that the original total capacitance is 1.0 pF. tPHL = (c) The reduction of propagation delays by 40% when the load inverter is removed indicates that the load inverter was contributing 40% of the total capacitance found in (b), that is, αn C k n (W/L)n VDD 2.32 × 30 × 10−15 ≤ 80 × 10−12 430 × 10−6 (W/L)n × 1.2 (W/L)n ≥ 1.7 (W/L)p ≥ 6.8 15.42 RN = Cout = 0.6 pF 12.5 12.5 = 8.33 k = (W/L)n 1.5 tPHL = 0.69CRN Cload = 0.4 pF = 0.69 × 10 × 10−15 × 8.33 × 103 15.40 αn = 2 7 3 Vtn − + 4 VDD 7 3 × 0.4 − + 4 1.2 =2 0.4 1.2 Vtn VDD 2 RP = 2 = = 0.69 × 10 × 10−15 × 10 × 103 = 69 ps αn C k n (W/L)n VDD 15.43 For = 30 ps tPHL = tPLH = tP ≤ 50 ps αp = αn = 2.32 = we use αp C k p (W/L)p VDD tPHL = 0.69CRN 2.32 × 10 × 10−15 430 × 10−6 × 3 × 1.2 4 = 0.69C × 12.5 × 103 (W/L)n and thus obtain = 60 ps tP = 1 (57.5 + 69) = 63.3 ps 2 tP = 2.32 × 10 × 10−15 430 × 10−6 × 1.5 × 1.2 tPLH = 30 30 = 10 k = (W/L)p 3 tPLH = 0.69CRP = 2.32 tPHL = = 57.5 ps 0.69 × 10 × 10−15 × 1 (tPHL + tPLH ) 2 ⇒ 1 = (30 + 60) = 45 ps 2 W L 12.5 × 103 ≤ 50 × 10−12 (W/L)n ≥ 1.725 n Similarly, tPLH = 0.69 C RP 15.41 αn = 2 =2 = 2.32 7 3 Vtn − + 4 VDD 7 3 × 0.4 − + 4 1.2 0.4 1.2 2 Vtn VDD 2 = 0.69 C × 30 × 103 (W/L)p Thus, 0.69 × 10 × 10−15 × ⇒ (W/L)p ≥ 4.14 30 × 103 ≤ 50 × 10−12 (W/L)p Chapter 15–19 15.44 RN = 12.5 = 12.5 k 1 αp = αn = 2.01 tPLH = 30 RP = = 30 k 1 tPHL = 0.69CRN = 0.69 × 20 × 10−15 × 12.5 × 103 = 172.5 ps = k p αp C W VDD L p 2.01 × 11.16 × 10−15 0.27 380 × 10−6 × × 1.8 4 0.18 = 87.6 ps tPLH = 0.69CRP 1 (21.9 + 87.6) = 54.8 ps 2 = 0.69 × 20 × 10−15 × 30 × 103 tP = = 414 ps If the design is changed to a matched one, then tP = Wp = 4Wn = 4 × 0.27 = 1.08 μm 1 (172.5 + 414) 2 C = 4 × 0.27 + 4 × 1.08 + 2 + 2 + 5 = 293.3 ps = 14.4 fF αn = αp = 2.01 15.45 Refer to Example 15.6. The method of average currents yields tPHL = 41.2 ps The method of equivalent resistance yields tPHL = = 28.2 ps tPLH = tPHL = 57.5 ps If the discrepancy is entirely due to the reduction in current due to velocity saturation in the NMOS transistor, then the factor by which the current decreases is 41.2/57.5 = 0.716. The value of tPLH does not change (in fact there is a slight decrease due to various approximations). We may therefore conclude that the effect of velocity saturation is minimal in the PMOS transistor. = 11.16 fF 7 3 Vtn − + 4 VDD αn = 2 =2 7 3 × 0.5 − + 4 1.8 Vtn VDD 0.5 1.8 tP = 1 (28.2 + 28.2) = 28.2 ps 2 15.47 αn = 2 = 2 k n αn C W VDD L n 2.01 × 11.16 × 10−15 0.27 380 × 10−6 × × 1.8 0.18 = 21.9 ps 7 3 Vtn − + 4 VDD 7 3 × 0.35 − + 4 1 tPHL = = αn C k n (W/L)n VDD 2.43 × 10 × 10−15 470 × 10−6 × 1.5 × 1 = 34.4 ps αp C k p (W/L)p VDD Since |Vtp | = Vtn , we have αp = αn = 2.43 Thus, tPLH = 2.43 × 10 × 10−15 190 × 10−6 × 3 × 1 = 42.6 ps 0.35 1 = 2.43 tPLH = = 2.01 tPHL = 2 2.01 × 14.4 × 10−15 380 1.08 × 10−6 × × 1.8 4 0.18 = 28.2 ps =2 15.46 C = 4 × 0.27 + 4 × 0.27 + 2 + 2 + 5 2.01 × 14.4 × 10−15 0.27 380 × 10−6 × × 1.8 0.18 Vtn VDD 2 2 Chapter 15–20 1 (34.4 + 42.6) = 38.5 ps 2 tP = The theoretical maximum switching frequency is 1 1 = 13 GHz 2tP 2 × 38.5 × 10−12 fmax = 45 = 60 ps 45 + 15 tP = 80 × A reduction by 40 ps requires the use of a scale factor S, 15.48 Wn = 0.75 μm Wp = 15.49 To reduce tP by 40 ps, we need to reduce the extrinsic part by 40 ps. Now the original value of the extrinsic part is μn Cox × Wn μp Cox S=3 This is the factor by which (W/L)n and (W/L)p must be scaled. The inverter area will be increased by the same ratio, that is, 3. 180 × 0.75 = 3.0 μm = 45 C = 2Cgd 1 + 2Cgd 2 + Cdb1 + Cdb2 15.50 (a) Examination of Eq. (15.59) reveals that the NMOS transistors Q1 and Q3 contribute + Cg3 + Cg4 + Cw where Cn = 2 Cgd 1 + Cdb1 + Cg3 Cgd 1 = 0.4 × Wn = 0.4 × 0.75 = 0.3 fF Cgd 2 = 0.4 × Wp = 0.4 × 3 = 1.2 fF Cdb1 = 1 × Wn = 1 × 0.75 = 0.75 fF Cdb2 = 1 × Wp = 1 × 3 = 3 fF Cg3 = 0.75×0.5×3.7+2×0.4×0.75 = 1.9875 fF Cg4 = 3 × 0.5 × 3.7 + 2 × 0.4 × 3 = 7.95 fF and the PMOS transistors Q2 and Q4 contribute Cp = 2 Cgd 2 + Cdb2 + Cg4 7 3 Vt − + 4 VDD 7 3 × 0.7 − + 4 3.3 =2 Vt VDD 0.7 3.3 2 2 = 1.73 tPHL = Cp = Cn Wp Wn and the total capacitance C can be expressed as = 18.7 fF αn = 2 (2) The only difference in determining the corresponding capacitances in Eqs. (1) and (2) is the transistor width W. Thus each of the components in Eq. (2) can be written as the corresponding component in Eq. (1) multiplied by (Wp /Wn ). Overall, we can write Thus, C = 2×0.3+2×1.2+0.75+3+1.9875+7.95+2 (1) αn C = W k n VDD L n 1.73 × 18.7 × 10−15 0.75 180 × 10−6 × × 3.3 0.5 = 36.3 ps Since the inverter is matched, tPLH = tPHL = 36.3 ps and tP = 36.3 ps The propagation delay increases by 50% if C is increased by 50%, that is, by 18.7/2 = 9.35 fF. C = Cn + Cp + Cw = Cn + Cn Thus, Wp + Cw Wn C = Cn (b) RN = Wp 1+ Wn + Cw 12.5 k (W/L)n For (W/L)n = 1, we have RN = 12.5 k Thus, tPHL = 0.69CRN = 0.69 × 12.5 × 103 C = 8.625 × 103 C RP = = Q.E.D. 30 k (W/L)p 30 k (Wp /Wn )(W/L)n Q.E.D. Chapter 15–21 For (W/L)n = 1, we have RP = Here C is entirely extrinsic, thus scaling the PMOS transistors has resulted in a decrease in tP . 30 k Wp /Wn We conclude that using a matched design reduces tP only when C is dominated by external capacitances. The matched design, of course, has the drawback of increased area. and tPLH = 0.69CRP 30 × ×103 C Wp /Wn = 0.69 × = 20.7 × 103 C Wp /Wn (c) tP = = 15.51 Q.E.D. 1 (tPHL + tPLH ) 2 20.7 × 103 1 8.625 × 103 C + C 2 Wp /Wn For Wp = Wn , we have tP = 14.66 × 103 C Wp tP = 14.66 × 103 Cn 1 + + Cw Wn = 14.66 × 103 (2Cn + Cw ) (3) (d) In the matched case, we have tPLH = tPHL From the results in (b), the required ratio (Wp /Wn ) can be determined as 20.7 = 8.625 Wp /Wn ⇒ Wp = 2.4 Wn Figure 1 In this case, we have C = Cn (1 + 2.4) + Cw = 3.4 Cn + Cw and tP = tPLH = 8.625 × 103 (3.4 Cn + Cw ) (4) (e) (i) For Cw = 0, we have Wp = Wn : tP = 29.32 × 103 Cn Wp = 2.4 Wn : tP = 29.32 × 103 Cn Thus, in the case where C is entirely intrinsic, scaling does not affect tP . This is what we found in Eq. (15.65). (ii) For Cw Cn , we have Wp = Wn : tP = 14.66 × 10 Cw 3 Wp = 2.4 Wn : tP = 8.625 × 103 Cw Figure 1 shows the CMOS logic gate with the (W/L) ratios selected so that the worst-case tPLH and tPHL are equal to the corresponding values of the basic inverter with (W/L)n = n and (W/L)p = p. Observe that the worst case for discharging a capacitor occurs through the three series transistors QNA , QNC , and QND . To make the equivalent W/L for these three series transistors equal to n, we select each of their (W/L) ratios to be equal to 3n. Finally, for the discharge path (QNA , QNB ) to have an equivalent W/L equal to n, we selected W/L of QNB equal to 1.5n. For the PUN, the worst-case charging path is that through QPB and one of QPC or QPD . Thus we select each of these three transistors to have W/L = 2p. Finally, we selected W/L of QPA equal to p. Chapter 15–22 For the case in which all p-channel devices have W/L = p and all n-channel devices have W/L = n, we have 15.52 tPLH = 0.69 × 30 × 103 ×C p which is the same as in the first case. However, tPHL = 0.69 × 12.5 × 103 ×C n/4 4 × 12.5 × 103 ×C n which is four times the value obtained in the first case. = 0.69 × 15.54 L = 0.13 μm, Wn = 0.2 μm, Wp = 0.4 μm, n = 0.2/0.13, p = 0.4/0.13 (a) Circuit (a) uses a six-input NOR gate and one inverter. Figure 1 The six-input NOR requires: 6 NMOS transistors each with W/L = n 0.40 0.20 , p= n= 0.13 0.13 Figure 1 shows the circuit with the W/L ratio of each of the eight transistors indicated. Observe that the worst-case situation for both charging and discharging is two transistors in series. To achieve an equivalent W/L ratio for each path equal to that of the corresponding transistor in the basic inverter, each transistor is sized at twice that of the inverter. Including the two inverters required to obtain the complemented variable, the area is A = 2Wn L + 2Wp L + 4 × 2Wn L + 4 × 2Wp L = 10L(Wn + Wp ) = 10 × 0.13(0.2 + 0.4) = 0.78 μm2 15.53 When the devices are sized as in Fig. 15.35, tPLH that results when one PMOS transistor is conducting (worst case) is tPLH = 0.69RP C = 0.69 × 30 × 103 ×C p and tPHL is obtained by noting that the equivalent W/L of the discharge path is 4n/4 = n and thus tPHL = 0.69 RN C 12.5 × 103 ×C = 0.69 × n and 6 PMOS transistors each with W/L = 6p The inverter requires 1 NMOS transistor with W/L = n and 1 PMOS transistor with W/L = p Thus, Area = 6Wn L + 6 × 6Wp L + Wn L + Wp L = L(7 Wn + 37 Wp ) = 0.13(7 × 0.2 + 37 × 0.4) = 0.13 × 16.2 = 2.1 μm2 (b) Circuit (b) uses two three-input NOR gates and one two-input NAND gate. Each three-input NOR gate requires 3 NMOS transistors, each with W/L = n 3 PMOS transistors, each with W/L = 3p The two-input NAND gate requires 2 NMOS transistors, each with W/L = 2n 2 PMOS transistors, each with W/L = p Thus, Area = 2 × 3 × Wn L + 2 × 3 × 3 × Wp L + 2 × 2 × W n L + 2 × Wp L Chapter 15–23 = L(10 Wn + 20 Wp ) Thus, = 0.13(10 × 0.2 + 20 × 0.4) 1 RCL Q.E.D. (1) xn−1 (b) Differenting tP in Eq. (1) relative to x gives = 0.13 × 10 = 1.3 μm2 Thus circuit (a) required 2.1/1.3 = 1.62 times the area of circuit (b). 15.55 (a) n = 4 Minimum delay is obtained when the scaling factor x is given by xn = CL C Here, 1200C = 1200 C ⇒ x = 5.9 x4 = tP = 4xCR = 4 × 5.9CR = 23.6CR (b) Let the number of the inverters be n. Optimum performance is obtained when CL = 1200 xn = C and x = e = 2.718 ln 1200 = 7.09 7 n= ln e Thus, we use 7 inverters. The actual scaling factor required can be found from x7 = 1200 ⇒ x = (1200)1/7 = 2.75 The value of tP realized will be tP = 7 × 2.75CR = 19.25CR which represents a reduction in tP by about 17.4%. Thus adding three inverters reduces the delay by 17.4%. 15.56 (a) Refer to Fig. 15.37(c). By inspection we see that tP = τ1 + τ2 + ... + τn−1 + τn But, τ1 = τ2 = ... = τn−1 = xCR and τn = R x C n−1 L tP = (n − 1)xRC + ∂tP (n − 1) = (n − 1)RC − RCL ∂x xn ∂tP to zero gives Equating ∂x CL xn = Q.E.D. (2) C (c) Differenting tP in Eq. (1) relative to n gives ∂tP 1 = xRC − n−1 (ln x)RCL ∂n x ∂tP to zero gives Equating ∂n C xn = ln x Q.E.D. CL (3) To obtain the value of x for optimum performance, we combine the two optimality conditions in (2) and (3). Thus ln x = 1 ⇒x=e Q.E.D. 2 15.57 E = CVDD = 10 × 10−15 × 1.82 = 32.4 fJ For 2 × 106 inverters switched at f = 1 GHz, PD = 2 × 106 × 1 × 109 × 32.4 × 10−15 = 64.8 W PD 64.8 IDD = = = 36 A VDD 1.8 2 15.58 Pdyn = fCVDD = 2 × 109 × 5 × 10−15 × 1 = 10 μW IDD = 10 × 10−6 = 10 μA 1 2 15.59 Since Pdyn is proportional to VDD , reducing the power supply from 5 V to 3.3 V reduces the 3.3 2 = 0.436. power dissipation by a factor of 5 The power dissipation now becomes 0.436 × 10 = 4.36 mW. Since Pdyn is proportional to f, reducing f by the same factor as the supply voltage (0.66) results in reducing the power dissipation further by a factor of 0.66, i.e. Additional savings in power = (1 − 0.66) × 4.36 = 1.48 mW Chapter 15–24 Figure 1 shows the circuit as the switch is opened (t = 0+). Capacitor C will charge through R, and its voltage will increase from the initial value of VOL to the high value VOH , 15.60 Each cycle, the inverter draws an average current of 60 + 0 = 30 μA Iav = 2 Since Iav = 150 μA, then the average current corresponding to the dynamic power dissipation is 120 μA. Thus, v O = v O (∞) − [v O (∞) − v O (0+)]e−t/τ = VOH − (VOH − VOL )e−t/τ1 where Pdyn = 3.3 × 120 × 10−6 = 396 μW τ1 = CR But, 1 (VOH + VOL ) the time 2 required, tPLH , can be found as follows: 2 Pdyn = fCVDD To reach the 50% point, Thus, 1 (VOH + VOL ) = VOH − (VOH − VOL )e−tPLH /τ1 2 1 (VOH − VOL ) e−tPLH /τ1 = (VOH − VOL ) 2 ⇒ tPLH = τ1 ln2 396 × 10−6 = 100 × 106 × 3.32 × C ⇒ C = 0.36 pF 15.61 tPLH = 30 ns, tPHL = 50 ns tP = PDav Q.E.D. = 0.69τ1 = 0.69CR 1 (30 + 50) = 40 ns 2 1 = (1 + 0.6) = 0.8 mW 2 (b) Figure 2(a) shows the circuit after the switch closes (t = 0+). At this instant the capacitor voltage in VOH . The capacitor then discharges and eventually reaches the low level VOL . To determine τPHL , we simplify the circuit to that in Fig. 2(b). Using this circuit, we can express v O as PDP = 0.8 × 10−3 × 40 × 10−9 = 32 pJ 15.62 (a) Q.E.D. VDD v O (t) = v O (∞) − [v O (∞) − v O (0)]e−t/τ1 = VOL − (VOL − VOH )e−t/τ2 when R τ2 = C(Ron R) CRon The value of tPHL can be found from v O (tPHL ) = C vO 1 (VOH + VOL ) 2 = VOL − (VOL − VOH )e−tPLH /τ2 ⇒ tPHL = τ2 ln2 Figure 1 This figure belongs to Problem 15.62, part (b). VDD R R // Ron Ron C vO VDD Ron R Ron C vO (a) (b) Figure 2 Chapter 15–25 Selecting R = 1 k yields = 0.69τ2 = 0.69CRon (c) tP = = Q.E.D. 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) 2 1 (0.69CR + 0.69CRon ) 2 tP = 1 × 0.69C(R + Ron ) 2 Since Ron R, tP 0.35CR Q.E.D. (d) During the low-input state, the switch is open, the current is zero, and the power dissipation is zero. During the high-input state, the switch is closed and a current IDD VDD VDD = R + Ron R flows, and the power dissipation is PD = VDD IDD = 2 VDD R Now, if the inverter spends half the time in each state, the average power dissipation will be P= 2 1 VDD 2 R tP = 0.35 × 10 × 10−12 × 1 × 103 = 3.5 ns and 1 52 = 12.5 mW 2 1 Both values are within the design specifications. P= 15.63 (a) The currents decrease by a factor of 1.8 = 0.72; that is, the new current values are 2.5 0.72 of the old current values. However, the voltage swing is also reduced by the same factor. The result is that tP remains unchanged. The PDP will be reduced by a factor of 0.52. Since the maximum operating frequency is proportional to 1/tP , it also will remain unchanged. 2 (b) If current is proportional to VDD , the currents 2 become 0.72 of their old values. This together with the reduction of voltage swing by a factor of 0.72 will result in tP increasing by a factor of (1/0.72) and the maximum operating frequency being reduced by a factor of 0.72. The PDP decreases by a factor of 0.72. 15.64 vI Q.E.D. (e) For VDD = 5 V and C = 10 pF, we have 1.8 1.3 tP = 0.35 × 10 × 10−12 R If tP is to be smaller or equal to 5 ns, we must have 0.35 × 10 × 10−12 R ≤ 5 × 10−9 ⇒ R ≤ 1.43 k If P is to be smaller or equal to 15 mW, we must have 1 52 × ≤ 15 2 R where R is in k, thus 0.5 0.28 1 t (ns) 0.72 From Eq. (15.79), we have 2 1 W VDD Ipeak = μn Cox − Vtn 2 L n 2 2 1 μA 1.8 Ipeak = × 450 2 − 0.5 = 36 μA 2 V 2 R ≥ 0.83 k The time when the input reaches Vt is Thus, to satisfy both constraints, R must lie in the range 0.5 × 1 = 0.28 ns 1.8 The time when the input reaches VDD − Vt is 1.8 − 0.5 × 1 = 0.72 ns 1.8 0.83 k ≤ R ≤ 1.43 k Chapter 15–26 So the base of the triangle is t = 0.72 − 0.28 = 0.44 ns 1 E = Ipeak × VDD × t = 2 1 × 36 μA × 1.8 × 0.44 ns 2 = 14.3 fJ P = f ×E = 100×106 ×14.3×10−15 = 1.43 μW. Exercise 16–1 Ex: 16.1 Since dynamic power dissipation is 1 scaled by 2 and propagation delay is scaled by S 1 1 1 1 1 , hence, PDP is scaled by 2 × = 3 = . S S S S 8 Thus, PDP decreases by a factor of 8. VDS = VOV = (1.2 − 0.4) = 0.8 V to 1.2 V in the absence of velocity saturation. Ex: 16.2 If VDD and Vt are kept constant, the entries in Table 16.1 that change are as follows: iD = 1 110 × 10−6 × 1.5 × 0.6 1.2 − 0.4 − × 0.6 2 Obviously, VDD and Vt do not scale by anymore. They are kept constant! 1 S αC Vt : since α is a function of , then α k VDD VDD 1 remains unchanged, while C is scaled by , and S k is scaled by S, therefore tP is scaled by tP ∝ 1 1/S = 2 S S 2 Energy/Switching cycle, i.e., CVDD , is scaled 1 by S 2 CVDD 1/S and thus is scaled by =S 2tP 1/S 2 thus Pdyn increases. Pdyn ∝ For the PMOS transistor, we see that since |VGS | − Vtp = 0.8 V and |VDS | = 1.2 V are both larger than |VDSsat | = 0.6 V the device will be operating in velocity saturation and (1 + 0.1 × 1.2) = 55.4 μA 0.6 ≤ VDS ≤ 1.2 V Without velocity saturation iD = 1 × 110 × 10−6 × 1.5 × (1.2 − 0.4)2 (1 + 0.1 × 1.2) 2 = 59.1 μA VOV ≤ VDS ≤ 1.2 V or 0.8 V ≤ VDS ≤ 1.2 V Note that the velocity saturation reduces the NMOS current by 33% and the PMOS current by ∼ 6%. Ex: 16.5 (a) Using Eq. (16.13), we have Pdyn , is scaled by The power density, i.e., device area S = S3 1/S 2 Thus, Ex: 16.3 Using Eq. (16.5), we have log iD = log IS + VDSsat = L 0.25 × 10−6 νsat = × 107 × 10−2 μn 400 × 10−4 = 0.63 V Ex: 16.4 For the NMOS transistor, VGS = 1.2 V results in VGS − Vtn = 1.2 − 0.4 = 0.8 V, which is greater than VDSsat = 0.34 V. Also, VDS = 1.2 V is greater than VDSsat , thus both conditions in Eq. (16.12) are satisfied and the NMOS transistor will be operating in the velocity-saturation region and thus iD is given by Eq. (16.11), 1 iD = 430 × 10−6 × 1.5 × 0.34 1.2 − 0.4 − × 0.34 2 × (1 + 0.1 × 1.2) = 154.7 μA If velocity-saturation were absent, the current would be 1 iD = × 430 × 10−6 × 1.5(1.2 − 0.4)2 × 2 (1 + 0.1 × 1.2) = 231.2 μA Saturation is obtained over the range VDS = 0.34 V to 1.2 V compared to iD = IS ev GS /n VT v GS log(e) nVT Thus, the slope of the straight line that represents log iD versus v GS is Slope = 0.43 log(e) = nVT nVT or the inverse of the slope is = 2.3nVT Q.E.D. (b) n = 1.22, iD = 100 × 10−9 A at v GS = 0.21 V Substituting in Eq. (16.13), we obtain −3 ) 100 × 10−9 = IS e0.21/(1.22×25×10 ⇒ IS = 0.1 nA This is the value of iD at v GS = 0. (c) Itotal = 500 × 106 × 0.1 × 10−9 = 50 mA PD = VDD Itotal = 1.2 × 50 = 60 mW Exercise 16–2 1 k p(VDD − Vt )2 2 To lower PD to half its value, we must reduce Istat to half its value. This can be accomplished by reducing (W/L)p to half the original value, thus W = 0.5 L p Ex: 16.6 Istat = Since r is to remain unchanged, the value of (W/L)n must be reduced by a factor of 2, thus Using Eq. (16.25), we obtain Istat = PD = Istat VDD = 86.4 × 10−6 × 2.5 = 0.22 mW Using Eqs. (16.28) and (16.29), we get 7 0.5 0.5 2 −3 + = 1.68 αp = 2 4 2.5 2.5 tPLH = 1 (W/L)n = × 2.35 = 1.18 2 Both tPLH and tPHL will double, thus 1 (30) (1.44) (2.5 − 0.5)2 = 86.4 μA 2 1.68 × 7 × 10−15 = 0.11 ns 30 × 10−6 × 1.44 × 2.5 Using Eq. (16.30) and (16.31), we obtain αn = tPLH = 2 × 0.16 = 0.32 ns 3 1 1 0.5 0.5 2 2 1+ 1− − 3− + 4 r r 2.5 2.5 tPHL = 2 × 0.02 = 0.04 ns Thus, = 1.9 1 tP = (0.32 + 0.04) = 0.18 ns 2 Since all the VTC breakpoints are functions of VDD , Vt , and r only, they will remain unchanged and so will the noise margins. tPHL = 1.9 × 7 × 10−15 = 0.03 ns .375 115 × 10−6 × × 2.5 .25 1 1 (tPHL + tPLH ) = (0.11 + 0.03) 2 2 = 0.07 ns tP = Ex: 16.7 Using Eq. (16.24), we obtain 1 VOL = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − 1 − r 1 = (2.5 − 0.5) × 1 − 1 − 4 Substituting values, we get VOL = 0.27 V Vt = 0.5 + 0.3 1.8 − Vt + 0.85 − Using Eq. (16.26) and (16.27), we get Vt = 0.5 + 0.3 √ 2.65 − Vt − 0.3 0.85 NML = 1 1 Vt − (VDD − Vt ) 1 − 1 − − √ r r (r + 1) 1 1 NML = 0.5 − (2) 1 − 1 − − √ 4 4 (5) = 0.68 V 2 NMH = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − √ 3r 2 = 0.85 V = (2) × 1 − √ 3×4 W 0.375 μn Cox 115 L 0.25 =4 n = r= W W μp Cox 30 L p L p W = 1.44 ∴ L p Ex: 16.8 Vt = Vt0 + γ VOH + 2φ f − 2φ f since VOH = VDD − Vt , Vt = Vt0 + γ VDD − Vt + 2φ f − 2φ f √ 0.85 Vt − 0.223 = 0.3 2.65 − Vt Squaring both sides yields Vt2 − 0.446Vt + 0.05 = 0.09 (2.65 − Vt ) so that, Vt2 − 0.356Vt − 0.189 = 0 Solving this quadratic equation yields one practical value for Vt : Vt = 0.648 V VOH = VDD − Vt = 1.8 V − 0.648 V = 1.15 V Ex: 16.9 (a) Referring to Fig. 16.21, we obtain VOH = 5 V VOL = 0 V Exercise 16–3 (b) Referring to Fig. 16.21(a), we get 1 W iDN (0) = k n (VDD − Vt0 )2 2 L n 4 1 = (50) (5 − 1)2 = 800 μA 2 2 1 W iDP (0) = k P (VDD − Vt0 )2 2 L p 4 1 = × 20 × (5 − 1)2 = 320 μA 2 2 Capacitor current is iC (0) = iDN (0) + iDP (0) = 800 + 320 = 1120 μA To obtain iDN (tPLH ), we note that this situation is identical to that in Example 16.3 and we can use the result of part (c): iDN (tPLH ) = 50 μA W × iDP (tPLH ) = k p L p 1 VDD 2 VDD − (VDD − Vt0 ) 2 2 2 1 5 2 5 4 − = (20) (5 − 1) 2 2 2 2 = 275 μA Thus, iC (tPLH ) = 50 + 275 = 325 μA 1 (1120 + 325) = 722.5 μA 2 5 VDD −15 C 70 10 2 2 = = iC |av 722.5 10−6 iC |av = tPLH = 0.24 ns (c) Referring to Fig. 16.21(b), we obtain 1 W iDN (0) = k n (VDD − Vt0 )2 2 L n 1 4 = (50) (5 − 1)2 = 800 μA 2 2 1 W iDP (0) = k p (VDD − Vt0 )2 2 L p 1 4 = (20) (5 − 1)2 = 320 μA 2 2 iC (0) = iDN (0) + iDP (0) = 800 + 320 4 5 1 5 2 = 50 − (5 − 1) 2 2 2 2 = 688 μA To find iDP (tPHL ), we first determine Vtp when VDD VDD , which corresponds to VSB = 2 2 VDD Vtp = Vt0 + γ + 2φ f − 2φ f 2 √ 5 + 0.6 − 0.6 = 1.49 V = 1 + 0.5 2 1 W VDD 2 Thus, iDP (tPHL ) = k p − Vtp 2 L p 2 2 1 4 5 = (20) − 1.49 = 20 μA 2 2 2 vO = iC (tPHL ) = iDN (tPHL ) + iDP (tPHL ) = 688 + 20 = 708 μA iC |av = 1120 μA + 708 μA = 914 μA 2 So, 5 2 = 0.19 ns = tPHL = 914 10−6 Qp will turn off when v O = Vtp C VDD 2 iC |av 70 10−15 where Vtp = Vt0 + γ VDD − Vtp + 2φ f − 2φ f Solving for Vtp , we get √ Vtp = 1 + 0.5 5 − Vtp + 0.6 − 0.6 Vtp − 0.613 = 0.5 5.6 V − Vtp Squaring both sides, and setting one side equal to zero, we have the quadratic equation 2 Vtp − 0.976 Vtp − 1.024 V2 = 0 Solving, we get Vtp = 1.6 V 1 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) = (0.24 ns + 0.19 ns) 2 2 0.22 ns (d) tP = Ex: 16.10 RTGAV = RTG1 + RTG2 2 4.5 k + 6.5 k = 5.5 k 2 = 1120 μA = iDN (tPHL ) = VDD 1 VDD 2 W − × (VDD − Vt0 ) kn L n 2 2 2 tPLH = 0.69 RC = 0.69 (5.5 k) (70) 10−15 F tPLH = 0.27 ns, which is close to the value of 0.24 ns obtained in Exercise 16.9. Exercise 16–4 Ex: 16.11 W L = n W L = 1.5 P 12.5 12.5 = 8.3 k = 1.5 (W/L)n Ex: 16.12 Using Eq. (15.57), we obtain RP1 = 1 W (μn Cox ) (VDD − Vt )2 , 2 L eq W W will double and iD (VDD ) doubling L L eq iD (VDD ) = Using Eq. (16.49), we get RTG ≈ Ex: 16.14 Since 30 30 k = k = 15 k W (2) L p With Eq. (16.49), we see that 12.5 12.5 k = 12.5 k RTG = k = W (1) L n Using Eq. (16.51), we get tP = 0.69 [(Cout1 + CTG1 ) RP1 + (Cin2 + CTG2 ) × (RP1 + RTG )] = 0.69 [(10fF + 5fF) (15 k) + (10fF + 5fF) so iD (VDD ) = 2 (76.1 μA) = 152.2 μA VDD W : will also double iD This new L eq 2 VDD = 2 (68.9 μA) = 137.8 μA iD 2 This doubles Iav to 2 (72.5 μA) = 145 μA. The new tPHL is VDD C VDD − 2 tPHL = Iav 30 10−15 F (1.8 V − 0.9 V) = 0.19 ns = 145 10−6 A × (15 k + 12.5 k)] Ex: 16.15 The process technology parameters are those specified in Example 16.3 (page 1330). tP = 0.44 ns With a ramp input, the factor 0.69 is dropped resulting in tP = 0.64 ns. Ex: 16.13 B B A Y = A+B OR B = Y = AB = A + B NOR B B W 1 iD1 v y1 = Vt = k n (VDD − Vt ) Vt − Vt2 L eq1 2 1 = 50 × 1 (5 − 1) 1 − × 1 2 B = 175 μA A Y = AB + AB XOR iD1 |av = 400 + 175 = 288 μA 2 (c) iD1 |av t = CL1 v y1 A A 1 × 50 × 1(5 − 1)2 2 = 400 μA A A Refer to Fig. E16.15 W 1 W 1 4 (a) = = × =1 L eq1 2 L 2 2 1 W 1 4 W = = × =1 L eq2 2 L 2 2 1 W (b) iD1 (v Y 1 = VDD ) = k n (VDD − Vt )2 2 L eq1 Y = AB + AB XNOR t = CL1 (VDD − Vt ) 40 × 10−15 × 4 = iD1 |av 288 × 10−6 = 0.56 ns Exercise 16–5 (d) Following the hint, we assume that Qeq2 remains saturated during t. 1 W iD2 |av = iD2 v y1 = 3 V = k n (3 − 1)2 2 L eq2 1 iD2 |av = × 50 × 1(3 − 1)2 2 = 100 μA (e) v y2 =− iD2 |av · t =− CL2 100 × 10−6 × 0.56 × 10−9 40 × 10−15 = −1.4 V Thus, v y2 decreases to 3.6 V. Ex: 16.18 Refer to Fig. 16.35. IE = VR − VBE |QR − (−VEE ) RE −1.32 − 0.75 + 5.2 ≈ 4 mA 0.779 VC |QR = −α × 4 × RC2 ∼ = − 4 × 0.245 = −1 V = VC |QA QB = 0 V (because the current through RC1 is zero) Ex: 16.19 Refer to Fig. 16.38(e). VDD = 2.5 V 2 2.5 = VGSN + VBE2 Vth = = VGSN + 0.7 Ex: 16.16 VOH = 0 VOL = −4 × 0.22 = −0.88 V SHOULD BE SHIFTED BY −0.88 V VOH = −0.88 V AFTER SHIFTING VOL = −1.76 V AFTER SHIFTING Ex: 16.17 Refer to Fig. E16.17. Neglecting the base current of Q1 , the current through R1 , D1 , D2 , and R2 is I= = 5.2 − VD1 − VD2 R1 + R2 5.2 − 0.75 − 0.75 = 0.6285 mA 0.907 + 4.98 Thus, VB = −IR1 = −0.57 V VR = VB − VBE1 = −0.57 − 0.75 = −1.32 V ⇒ VGSN = 1.8 V 1 W (VGSN − Vt )2 IDN = k n 2 L n 1 W = kn (1.8 − 0.6)2 2 L n 2 1 W VDD VDD − − Vt IDP = k p 2 L p 2 1 W = k p (5 − 2.5 − 0.6)2 2 L p Equating (1) and (2) gives W W (1.2)2 = k p (1.9)2 k n L n L p Substituting k n = 2.5k p and Ln = Lp yields Wp =1 Wn (1) (2) Chapter 16–1 16.1 Here the scaling factor is 5 μm = 156.25 32 nm Therefore, Moore’s law predicts that the number of transistors on a chip of equal area, fabricated in the 32-nm process, would be S= Power density = Pdyn is thus scaled by area 2 2 =8 = 1 1 S2 4 PDP is scaled by 2 × 20,000 × S 2 = 20,000 × 156.252 = 4.88 × 108 or 488 million transistors. αC , and k is scaled by S, and C k VDD 1 are scaled by ; thus tP is scaled by S 16.2 (a) tP ∝ and VDD 1 1 S = 1 S S× S 1 (tP decreases) 2 1 and The maximum operating speed is 2tp therefore is scaled by 2. S = 2 ⇒ tP is scaled by Pdyn = fmax CV 2 DD and thus is scaled by 1 1 1 1 × 2 = 2 = (Pdyn decreases). S S S 4 Pdyn and thus is scaled by Power density = area 1 S 2 = 1, i.e., remains unchanged. 1 S2 1 1 PDP is scaled by 3 power is scaled by 2 and S S 1 1 delay by and thus it is scaled by (PDP S 8 decreases). S× (b) If VDD and Vtn remain unchanged while S = 2, we have tp = αC 2 and α = so α k VDD Vtn 2 7 3Vtn − + 4 VDD VDD remains unchanged and tP is scaled by 1 S = 1 = 1 S S2 4 1 and The maximum operating speed is 2tP therefore is scaled by 4. Pdyn = fmax CV 2 DD and thus is scaled by 4× 1 ×1=2 2 1 1 = 4 2 16.3 From Eq. (16.5), we have for the NMOS transistor 0.25 = 65 × 10−9 × 105 μn where we have assumed νsat = 107 cm/s = 105 m/s. Thus, μn = 260 cm2 /V.s For the PMOS transistor 0.45 = 65 × 10−9 × 105 μp ⇒ μp = 144.4 cm2 /V.s The value of Ecr can be determined using Eq. (16.3), VDSsat L For the NMOS transistor we have 0.25 = 3.85 × 106 V/m Ecr = 65 × 10−9 Ecr = = 3.85 × 104 V/cm and for the PMOS transistor 0.45 = 6.92 × 104 V/cm Ecr = 65 × 10−9 16.4 (a) From equation (16.9), we have W 1 VDSsat VGS − Vt − VDSsat IDsat = μn Cox L 2 Thus, for VGS = VDD we have 1 W VDSsat VDD − Vt − VDSsat IDsat = μn Cox L 2 In the absence of velocity saturation, we have 1 W ID = μn Cox (VGS − Vt )2 ; and for 2 L 1 W VGS = VDD , ID = μn Cox (VDD − Vt )2 2 L Therefore, IDsat ID μn Cox = 1 W VDSsat VDD − Vt − VDSsat L 2 W 1 μ Cox (VDD − Vt )2 2 n L Chapter 16–2 1 2VDSsat VDD − Vt − VDSsat 2 = (VDD − Vt )2 (b) Using Eqs. (14.45) and (14.56), we obtain Q.E.D. (b) For this 65-nm process, we have 1 2 × 0.25 1.0 − 0.35 − × 0.25 IDsat 2 = ID (1.0 − 0.35)2 tPHL = 0.69C 12.5 × 103 (W/L)n Q.E.D. (c) Equating the values of tPHL given by Eqs. (1) and (2), we obtain 12.5 × 103 CVDD = 0.69C 2IDsat (W/L)n = 0.62 ⇒ IDsat = 0.058 × 10−3 VDD (W/L)n 16.5 (a) From Eq. (16.9), we have Substituting VDD = 1.2 V, we get IDSsatn = W 1 μn Cox VDSsatn VGS − Vtn − VDSsatn L n 2 IDsat = 0.07 × 10−3 (W/L)n IDSsatp = W 1 μp Cox VDSsatp |VGS | − Vtp − VDSsatp L p 2 Since |VGS | = VDD (i.e., for NMOS) VGS = VDD and for PMOS |VGS | = VDD and IDSsatn = IDSsatp , we have W 1 VDSsatn VDD − Vtn − VDSsatn μn Cox L n 2 μp Cox W L VDSsatp VDD − Vtp − 1 VDSsatp 2 p (4) Substituting μn Cox = 325 × 10−6 A/V, VGS = VDD = 1.2 V, and Vt = 0.4 V and equating the resulting value of IDsat to that given by Eq. (3), we obtain W 1 VDSsat 1.2 − 0.4 − VDSsat 325 × 10−6 L 2 ⇒ VDSsat = 0.34 V 16.7 IS ∝ e−Vt /nVT 1 VDD − Vtn − VDSsatn Wp μ VDSsatn 2 = n 1 Wn μp VDSsatp VDD − Vtp − VDSsatp 2 1 VDD − Vtn − VDSsatn Wp μn VDSsatn 2 (b) = 1 Wn μp VDSsatp VDD − Vtp − VDSsatp 2 0.25 1.0 − 0.35 − 0.25 2 = 2.75 =4× 0.45 0.45 1.0 − 0.35 − 2 IS ∝ e−(Vt −0.1)/nVT ∝ e−Vt /nVT e0.1/nVT Thus IS increases by a factor = e0.1/nVT = e0.1/(2×0.025) Thus the static power dissipation increases by a factor of 7.4. If Vt is reduced by 0.2 V, a similar analysis to that above shows that IS increases by a factor = e0.2/(2×0.025) = e4 = 54.6 and the static power dissipation increases by the same factor. IDsat tPHL = C(VDD /2) which yields Q.E.D. If Vt is reduced by 0.1 V, then = e2 = 7.4 16.6 (a) Since QN provides a constant current IDsat to discharge C from a voltage of VDD to VDD /2, the discharge interval tPHL can be found by writing the charge equilibrium equation CVDD 2IDsat IDsat = W 1 μn Cox VDSsat VGS − Vt − VDSsat L 2 = 0.07 × 10−3 (W/L) Ln = Lp ⇒ Thus, tPHL = (3) But IDsat is given by Eq. (16.9) as and = (2) (1) We conclude that in process design, the higher the value one chooses for Vt , the lower the static power dissipation. Chapter 16–3 16.8 (a) iD = IS e−v GS /nVT Corresponding to iD changing by a factor of 10, v GS changes by 2.3nVT , thus 2.3nVT = 80 mV 80 = 1.4 2.3 × 25 Using the given information that iD = 20 nA at v GS = 0.16 V, we obtain ⇒n= −9 20 × 10 = IS e 0.16/(1.4×0.025) ⇒ IS = 207 pA This is the value of iD at v GS = 0 (b) For a chip with 1 billion transistors, the current drawn from the power supply as a result of subthreshold conduction will be Itotal = 207 × 10−12 × 109 16.10 (a) R = 27 m × = 27 × 10−3 × 5 mm 0.5 μm 5 × 10−3 0.5 × 10−6 = 270 (b) C = 0.1 × 5 mm 1 μm = 0.1 × 5 × 103 = 500 fF = 0.5 pF (c) tdelay = 0.69RC = 0.69 × 270 × 0.5 × 10−12 = 93.2 ps = 207 mA 16.11 (a) For the circuit in Fig. P16.11(a), assuming v O (0−) = 0, we can write and the power dissipation will be v O (t) = VDD − VDD e−t/τ PD = Itotal VDD where = 207 × 1 = 207 mW τ = CR Substituting, we obtain 1 16.9 ID = k n (VGS − Vtn )2 2 1 0.2 = × 0.4(VGS − 0.4)2 2 ⇒ VGS = 1.4V (a) For Vtn = 0.4 + 10% = 0.44 V, we have 1 × 0.4(1.4 − 0.44)2 = 0.184 mA 2 For Vtn = 0.4 − 10% = 0.36 V, we have ID = 1 × 0.4(1.4 − 0.36)2 2 = 0.216 mA ID = v O (tPLH ) = 1 VDD = VDD − VDD e−tPLH /τ 2 ⇒ tPLH = 0.69τ = 0.69CR I tPLH = C(VDD /2) ⇒ tPLH = (b) If the time for a 0.1-V change of the capacitor voltage is denoted T , then thus, ID T = CV tPLH = For ID = 0.184 mA, we have 100 × 10−15 × 0.1 = 54.3 ps T= 0.184 × 10−3 For ID = 0.216 mA, we have 100 × 10−15 × 0.1 = 46.3 ps T= 0.216 × 10−3 Thus, the discharge time ranges from 46.3 ps to 54.3 ps. 1 VDD C 2 I But, I= CV ID (1) (b) For the circuit in Fig. P16.11(b), assuming v O (t−) = 0, we can write Thus, ID will range from 0.184 mA to 0.216 mA (i.e., 0.2 ± 8%, mA). T= 1 VDD 2 VDD R VDD 1 C = 0.5CR 2 VDD /R (2) Comparing Eqs. (1) and (2), we see that using a current-source load reduces tPLH by 0.69 − 0.5 × 100 = 27.5% 0.69 16.12 VOH = VDD = 1.3 V Using Eq. (16.24), we find VOL = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − 1− 1 r Chapter 16–4 1 5 = 0.095 V 16.14 Using Eqs. (16.29) and (16.28), we find 0.4 0.4 2 7 αp = 2 −3× + 4 1.3 1.3 Using Eq. (16.25), we obtain = 2.17 1 k p (VDD − Vt )2 2 tPLH = = (1.3 − 0.4) 1 − Istat = 1− 1 = × 100(1.3 − 0.4)2 2 = 40.5 μA αp C k p VDD 2.17 × 10 × 10−15 100 × 10−6 × 1.3 = 167 ps = Using Eqs. (16.31) and (16.30), we obtain PD = Istat VDD = 40.5 × 1.3 = 52.7 μW αn = 1+ 2 3 1 1 0.4 0.4 2 1− − 3− + 4 5 5 1.3 1.3 = 2.4 16.13 Using Eq. (16.24), we obtain 1 VOL = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − 1 − r 1 = (1.3 − 0.4) 1 − 1 − 5 2.4 × 10 × 10−15 500 × 10−6 × 1.3 = 36.9 ps = 0.095 V tP = Using Eq. (16.20), we obtain = VDD − Vt VIL = Vt + √ r(r + 1) 1.3 − 0.4 = 0.4 + √ 5×6 tPHL = αn C k n VDD = 1 (tPLH + tPHL ) 2 1 (167 + 36.9) = 102 ps 2 16.15 = 0.56 V Using Eq. (16.21), we obtain VDD − Vt VM = Vt + √ r+1 = 0.4 + 1.3 − 0.4 √ 6 = 0.77 V Using Eq. (16.23), we find VIH 2 = Vt + √ (VDD − Vt ) 3r = 0.4 + √ 2 3×5 (1.3 − 0.4) = 0.86 V VOH = VDD = 1.3 V NML = VIL − VOL = 0.56 − 0.095 = 0.465 V NMH = VOH − VIH = 1.3 − 0.86 = 0.44 V Figure 1 VDD = 0.625 V 4 Figure 1 shows the inverter when v O = VDD /4 = 0.625 V. At this output value, if QN is off, QP will be operating in the triode region (because v DG = 0.625 V is greater than |Vt | = 0.5 V) and charging the capacitor with a current W [(VDD − |Vt |)(VDD − v O ) iDP = k p L p 1 − (VDD − v O )2 ] 2 Chapter 16–5 W (2.5 − 0.5)(2.5 − 0.625) = 30 L p 1 − (2.5 − 0.625)2 2 = 59.8(W/L)p , μA When v I is high at 2.5 V, QN will be operating in the triode region (because v I > Vtn + v O ) and will be conducting a current W 1 iDN = k n (v I − Vt )v O − v 2O L n 2 1 2 = 115 × 1.5 (2.5 − 0.5) × 0.625 − × 0.625 2 = 181.9 μA The capacitor discharge current will be = iDN − iDP = 181.9 − 59.8(W/L)p , μA The design is based on equal charging and discharging current, thus 59.8(W/L)p = 181.9 − 59.8(W/L)p = (2.5 − 0.5) 1 − 1− 1 3.78 = 0.28 V Now, NMH = VOH − VIH = 2.5 − 1.69 = 0.81 V NML = VIL − VOL = 0.97 − 0.28 = 0.69 V 16.16 From Eq. (16.27), we obtain 2 NMH = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − √ 3r Setting NMH = 0, we have 2 1− √ =0 3r Solving, r = 1.33 ⇒ (W/L)p = 1.52 Using Eqs. (16.27) and (16.26),we can find NMH and NM L , respectively, versus r: We now can find the value of r from k (W/L)n kn = n r= kp k p (W/L)p with VDD = 1.3 V and Vt = 0.4 V, 2 NMH = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − √ 3r 115 × 1.5 = 3.78 30 × 1.52 Using Eq. (16.20), we obtain VDD − Vt VIL = Vt + √ r(r + 1) 2.5 − 0.5 VIL = 0.5 + √ 3.78 × 4.78 = 0.97 V 1.8 2 = 0.9 − √ , (V) NMH = (1.3 − 0.4) 1 − √ 3r 3r = NML = Vt − (VDD − Vt ) 1 1 × 1− 1− − √ r r (r + 1) NML = 0.4 − 0.9 1 − Using Eq. (16.23), we obtain 2 VIH = Vt + √ (VDD − Vt ) 3r 2 = 0.5 + √ (2.5 − 0.5) 3 × 3.78 = 1.69 V Using Eq. (16.21), we obtain VDD − Vt VM = Vt + √ r+1 2.5 − 0.5 = 0.5 + √ 3.78 + 1 = 1.41 V 1− Table 1 below gives NMH and NML for r ranging from 2 to 10. Observe that equal values of NML Table 1 r NMH (V) NML (V) 2 0.17 0.50 3 0.30 0.49 4 0.38 0.48 5 0.44 0.47 6 0.48 0.46 VOH = VDD = 2.5 V 7 0.51 0.45 Using Eq. (16.24), we obtain 8 0.53 0.45 9 0.55 0.44 10 0.57 0.44 Using Eq. (16.18), we have VOL = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − 1− 1 r 1 1 −√ , (V) r r (r + 1) Chapter 16–6 and NMH can be obtained by selecting r between 5 and 6. To obtain a more precise value for r, we iterate to obtain the results shown in Table 2. From the latter table we see that the r value lies between 5.6 and 5.7. 1 1 1− r = r (2r + 1)2 (r + 1)3 r(2r + 1)2 r = r−1 (r + 1)3 Table 2 r Multiplying both sides by r 4 : NMH (V) NML (V) (r + 1)3 = (2r + 1)2 r−1 5.5 0.457 0.465 Multiplying out: 5.6 0.461 0.464 r 3 + 2r 2 + r + r 2 + 2r + 1 = 4r 3 − 3r − 1 5.7 0.465 0.463 Simplifying, we get r 3 − r 2 − 2r − 2/3 = 0 We can further iterate; however, it seems likely that a good estimate would be r = 5.65 Solving for the roots of this cubic equation can be done with a calculator or by hand. With these coefficients, there is only one real root: r = 2.1 (by hand) For this value, If VDD = 1.3 V and Vt = 0.4 V, NMH = 0.463 V NML = 0.4 V − (1.3 V − 0.4 V) × 1 1 −√ 1− 1− 2.1 2.1 (3.1) and NML = 0.463 V NML = 0.5 V 16.17 From Eq. (16.26), we get For r = 2.0, we obtain NML = 0.5 V NML = Vt − (VDD − Vt ) 1 1 × 1− 1− − √ r r (r + 1) For r = 5.0, we have NML = 0.47 V ∂ML = − (VDD − Vt ) ∂r 1 −1/2 1 1 1 1− × − − − 2 r r2 2 × (r (r + 1))−3/2 (2r + 1) Maximum NML is found by setting this equal to zero: 1 −1/2 1 1 1 0=− 1− + 2 2 r r2 −3/2 × (r (r + 1)) (2r + 1) −1/2 1 1 1− = (r (r + 1))−3/2 (2r + 1) r r2 Squaring both sides, we get 1 −1 1− r = r −3 (r + 1)−3 (2r + 1)2 r4 For r = 10, we have NML = 0.44 V We thus conclude that the maximum is a very broad one and that NML does not change greatly with r. 16.18 Substituting VDD = 1.3 V, Vt = 0.4 V, and r = 5.7 in Eqs. (16.26) and (16.27), we obtain: NML = Vt − (VDD − Vt ) 1 − = 0.4 − (1.3 − 0.4) 1 − = 0.463 V 1− 1 1 −√ r r(r + 1) 1− 1 1 −√ 5.7 5.7 × 6.7 2 NMH = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − √ 3r 2 = (1.3 − 0.4) 1 − √ 3 × 5.7 = 0.465 V Thus, NML NMH Q.E.D. Chapter 16–7 tPHL = Since r= kn = kp k n (W/L)n k p (W/L)p tP = then 1 (1.34 + 0.26) = 0.8 ns 2 2 Pdyn = fCVDD 4(W/L)n 5.7 = (W/L)p ⇒ tPLH = 0.26 ns 5.22 = f × 100 × 10−15 × 1.32 = 169f fW (W/L)n 5.7 = 1.425 = (W/L)p 4 Selecting The frequency at which Pdyn = Pstat is found from 169f × 10−15 = 65.8 × 10−6 ⇒ f = 389 MHz (W/L)p = 1 The theoretical maximum frequency of operation is found as follows: 1 fmax = 2tP we have (W/L)n = 1.425 Using Eq. (16.25), we find 1 Istat = k p (VDD − Vt )2 2 1 = × 125 × 1(1.3 − 0.4)2 2 = 50.6 μA = 1 = 625 MHz 2 × 0.8 × 10−9 Thus, it is possible to operate the inverter at 389 MHz. 16.19 Y = A + B (C + D), The static power dissipation is whence Y = A + B (C + D) PD = Istat VDD Thus the PDN can be formed directly as shown: = 50.6 × 1.3 = 65.8 μW Using Eq. (16.29), we obtain 7 |Vt | |Vt | 2 −3 + αp = 2 4 VDD VDD 2 0.4 0.4 7 −3× + =2 4 1.3 1.3 = 2.17 Using Eq. (16.31), we find 1 3 1− 1+ αn = 2 4 5.7 0.4 0.4 2 1 + − 3− 5.7 1.3 1.3 or Y = A B + AB = 2.37 The PDN results directly: 16.20 For an Exclusive OR, Y = AB + AB, and Y = AB + AB = AB · AB = A + B A + B VDD Now using Eqs. (16.28) and (16.30), we obtain αp kn tPLH = tPHL αn kp 2.17 × 5.7 = 5.22 2.37 Using Eq. (16.28), we obtain Y = tPLH = αp C = k p VDD −15 2.17 × 100 × 10 = 1.34 ns 125 × 10−6 × 1 × 1.3 A A B B Chapter 16–8 16.21 For a NOR gate similar to that of Fig. 16.13, the worst-case VOL will occur when only one input is high and one NMOS transistor is conducting. From Eq. (16.24), we obtain 1 VOL = (VDD − Vt ) 1 − 1 − r 1 0.1 = (1.3 − 0.4) 1 − 1 − r 0.1 1 ⇒ 1− =1− r 0.9 Transistor QN will be operating in the triode region and conducting an equal current, thus 1 2 36 = k n (VGS − Vt )VDS − VDS 2 1 2 36 = 500 (1.3 − 0.4)VOL − VOL 2 ⇒ r = 4.76 ⇒ VOL = 0.08 V Since which is indeed very small, as assumed. k n (W/L)n k p (W/L)p kn 4 × 1.5 = = kp (W/L)p W 6 then = = 1.26 L p 4.76 r= 1 2 0.072 = 0.9VOL − VOL 2 If VOL is very small, then we have 0.072 0.9VOL 16.23 16.22 VDD 1.3 V QP IDsat vI VDD 1.3 V VOL QN Figure 1 Figure 1 Refer to Fig. 1. For transistor QP , we have Refer to Fig. 1. |VSG | − |Vt | = 1.3 − 0.4 = 0.9 V (a) VO = 0 V which is greater than VDSsat = 0.6 V. Also, since we expect VOL to be very small, we have (b) VO = 0 V VSD > |VDSsat | Thus QP will be operating in the velocity saturation region and its current IDsat will be given by Eq. (16.9) (adapted for the p-channel case), IDsat = 1 W μp Cox |VDSsat | |VSG | − |Vt | − |VDSsat | L p 2 1 = 100 × 0.6 1.3 − 0.4 − × 0.6 2 = 36 μA (c) VO = VDD − Vtn where Vtn = Vtn0 + γ VO + 2φf − 2φf (d) VO = |Vtp | = |Vtp0 | + γ VDD − VO + 2φf − 2φf 16.24 Refer to Fig. 16.17. Since VOH is the value of v O at which Q stops conducting, VDD − VOH − Vt = 0 Chapter 16–9 At t = tPHL , Q will be operating in the triode region, and thus then VOH = VDD − Vt where Vt = Vt0 + γ VOH + 2φf − 2φf = Vt0 + γ VDD − Vt + 2φf − 2φf iD (t = tPHL ) = 1 500 × 1.5 (1.2 − 0.4) × 0.6 − × 0.62 2 = 225 μA Substituting Vt0 = 0.4 V, γ = 0.2 V1/2 , VDD = 1.2 V, and 2φf = 0.88 V, we obtain √ Vt = 0.4 + 0.2 1.2 − Vt + 0.88 − 0.88 √ Vt − 0.4 + 0.2 0.88 = 0.2 2.08 − Vt Thus, the average discharge current is given by (Vt − 0.212)2 = 0.04(2.08 − Vt ) tPHL = ⇒ Vt2 − 0.384 Vt − 0.038 = 0 ⇒ Vt = 0.466 V 1 (240 + 225) = 232.5 μA 2 iD |av = and tPHL can be determined as = C(VDD /2) iD |av 10 × 10−15 × 0.6 = 25.8 ps 232.5 × 10−6 VOH = 1.3 − 0.466 = 0.834 V 16.27 1.8 V 16.25 Refer to Fig. 16.17. We need to find the current iD at t = 0 (where v O = 0, Vt = Vt0 = 0.4 V) and at t = tPLH (where VDD vO = = 0.6 V, Vt to be determined), as 2 follows: 1 iD (0) = × 500 × 1.5 (1.2 − 0.4)2 = 240 μA 2 Vt (at v O = 0.6 V) = √ √ 0.6 + 0.88 − 0.88 0.4 + 0.2 QP 1.15 V Figure 1 1 × 500 × 1.5 (1.2 − 0.456 − 0.6)2 2 = 7.8 μA We can now compute the average charging current as 240 + 7.8 iD |av = = 123.9 μA 2 and tPLH can be found as tPLH = = VOL QN = 0.456 V iD (tPLH ) = iD C(VDD /2) iD |av 10 × 10−15 × 0.6 = 48.4 ps 123.9 × 10−6 16.26 Refer to the circuit in Fig. 16.18. Observe that, here, Vt remains constant at Vt0 = 0.4 V. At t = 0, Q will be operating in saturation, and the drain current will be 1 iD (0) = × 500 × 1.5 (1.2 − 0.4)2 2 = 240 μA From Exercise 16.8 we have the output voltage of the switch as 1.15 V. This is the voltage applied to the input of the CMOS inverter, as shown in Fig. 1. Because we expect VOL to be small, QP will be operating in the saturation region and its drain current will be 1 W iD = (μp Cox ) (1.8 − 1.15 − 0.4)2 2 L p = 0.54 1 × 75 × × 0.0625 2 0.18 = 7 μA This is also the current conducted by QN which is operating in the triode region, thus W 1 2 7 = (μn Cox ) (1.15 − 0.4)VOL − VOL L n 2 Assuming VOL to be very small, we obtain W × 0.75VOL 7 (μn Cox ) L n Chapter 16–10 7 = 300 × 1 0.54 × × 0.75 VOL 2 0.18 ⇒ VOL = 0.02 V The static power dissipation is PD = 7 μA × 1.8 V At t = tPLH , v O = VDD /2 = 0.6 V and Q will be operating in the triode region. Thus, iD (tPLH ) = k p (VDD − |Vt0 |) VDD 2 − 1 VDD 2 2 2 1 = 125 (1.2 − 0.4) × 0.6 − (0.6)2 2 = 12.6 μW = 37.5 μA 16.28 The average charging current can now be found as iD |av = 1 (40 + 37.5) = 33.75 μA 2 The propagation delay tPLH can then be determined from tPLH = Figure 1 = C(VDD /2) iD |av C × 0.6 = 17.8 × 103 C s 33.75 × 10−6 No value for C is given. If C = 10 fF, we get (a) Figure 1(a) shows the situation for t ≥ 0. In this case Vt remains constant at Vt0 and the capacitor charges to VDD . tPLH = 17.8 × 103 × 10 × 10−15 = 178 ps Thus, 16.29 For the switch gate and input both at VDD = 3.3V, the switch output is VOH = VDD VOH = VDD − Vt (b) Figure 1 (b) shows the situation for t ≥ 0. Here as C discharges through Q, the threshold voltage changes. The discharge current reduces to zero when v O = |Vt |. Thus, where Vt = Vt0 + γ VOL = |Vt | |Vt | = |Vt0 | + γ VDD − VOL + 2φf − 2φf Substituting |Vt | = VOL , we obtain VOL = |Vt0 | + γ VDD − VOL + 2φf − 2φf VOH + 2φ f − 2φ f Substituting for VOH , we get VDD − Vt + 2φ f − 2φ f Vt = Vt0 + γ = 0.8 + 0.5 where √ 3.3 − Vt + 0.6 − 0.6 so that Vt = 0.413 + 0.5 3.9 − Vt Vt − 0.413 = 0.5 3.9 − Vt Squaring both sides, we get (c) Refer to Fig. 1(a). Vt2 − 0.826Vt + 0.171 = 0.975 − 0.25Vt At t = 0, v O = 0 and Q will be operating in saturation. Thus, or Vt2 − 0.576Vt − 0.804 = 0 Solving this quadratic, we find that 1 iD (0) = k p (VDD − |Vt0 |)2 2 = 1 × 125 (1.2 − 0.4)2 2 = 40 μA Vt = 1.23 V VOH = VDD − Vt = 3.3 V − 1.23 V = 2.07 V With the input low and the switch gate high, VOL → 0 V Chapter 16–11 If VOH = 2.07 V, the PMOS transistor of the inverter is in the saturation region. Since the inverter transistors are matched, we get W k W = n so that L p kp L n 1 W iDP = μp Cox (VDD − VOH − Vt0 )2 2 L p iDP = 1 1.2 (25) (3) × (3.3 − 2.07 − 0.8)2 2 0.8 1 (352 + 311) = 332 μA 2 VDD C 100 10−15 (1.65) 2 = = iD |av 332 × 10−6 iD |av = tPHL = 0.5 ns 16.30 VDD = 10.4 μA For tPLH , at t = 0, we have 1 W iD (0) = μn Cox (VDD − Vt0 )2 2 L n 1.2 1 = (75) (3.3 − 0.8)2 = 352 μA 2 0.8 VDD At v O = , we have 2